Вы находитесь на странице: 1из 635

Daniel P.

Loucks
Eelco van Beek

Water Resource
Systems Planning
and Management
An Introduction to Methods,
Models, and Applications
Water Resource Systems Planning
and Management
Daniel P. Loucks Eelco van Beek

Water Resource
Systems Planning
and Management
An Introduction to Methods, Models,
and Applications

With Contributions by
Jery R. Stedinger  Jos P.M. Dijkman  Monique T. Villars

123
Daniel P. Loucks Eelco van Beek
Cornell University Deltares
Ithaca, NY Delft
USA The Netherlands

ISBN 978-3-319-44232-7 ISBN 978-3-319-44234-1 (eBook)


DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1

Jointly published with Deltares and UNESCO-IHE

Library of Congress Control Number: 2016950366

The Editor(s) (if applicable) and The Author(s) 2017. This book is published open access.
Open Access This book is distributed under the terms of the Creative Commons
Attribution-NonCommercial 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-
nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit to the original
author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if changes
were made.
The images or other third party material in this book are included in the works Creative
Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if such material is not included in
the works Creative Commons license and the respective action is not permitted by statutory
regulation, users will need to obtain permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
reproduce the material.
This work is subject to copyright. All commercial rights are reserved by the Publishers, whether
the whole or part of the material is concerned, specically the rights of translation, reprinting,
reuse of illustrations, recitation, broadcasting, reproduction on microlms or in any other
physical way, and transmission or information storage and retrieval, electronic adaptation,
computer software, or by similar or dissimilar methodology now known or hereafter developed.
The use of general descriptive names, registered names, trademarks, service marks, etc. in this
publication does not imply, even in the absence of a specic statement, that such names are
exempt from the relevant protective laws and regulations and therefore free for general use.
The publishers, the authors and the editors are safe to assume that the advice and information in
this book are believed to be true and accurate at the date of publication. Neither the publishers
nor the authors or the editors give a warranty, express or implied, with respect to the material
contained herein or for any errors or omissions that may have been made.

Printed on acid-free paper

This Springer imprint is published by Springer Nature


The registered company is Springer International Publishing AG
The registered company address is: Gewerbestrasse 11, 6330 Cham, Switzerland
Foreword

Water resources are special. In their natural states


they are beautiful. People like to live and vaca-
tion near rivers, lakes and coasts. Water is also
powerful. Water can erode rock, alter existing
landscapes and form new ones. Life on this
planet depends on water. Most of our economic
activities consume water. All the food we grow,
process and eat requires water. Much of our
waste is transported and assimilated by water.
The importance of water to our well-being is
beyond question. Our dependence on water will
last forever.
So, what is the problem? The answer is simply that water, although
plentiful, is not distributed as we might wish. There is often too much or too
little, or what exists is too polluted or too expensive. A further problem is that
the overall water situation is likely to further deteriorate as a result of global
changes. This is a result not only of climatic change but also of other global
change drivers such as population growth, land use changes, urbanization and
migration from rural to urban areas, all of which will pose challenges never
before seen. Water obviously connects all these areas and any change in these
drivers has an impact on it. Water has its own dynamics that are fairly non-
linear. For example, while population growth in the twentieth century
increased threefoldfrom 1.8 to 6 billion peoplewater withdrawal during
the same period increased sixfold! That is clearly unsustainable. Freshwater,
although a renewable resource, is nite and is very vulnerable. If one con-
siders all the water on Earth, 97.5 % is located in the seas and oceans and what
is available in rivers, lakes and reservoirs for immediate human consumption
comprises no more than a mere 0.007 % of the total. This is indeed very
limited and on average is roughly equivalent to 42,000 km3 per year.
If one looks at the past 30 years only in terms of reduction in per capita
water availability in a year the picture is even more disturbing. While in 1975
availability stood at around 13,000 m3 per person per year, it has now
dropped to 6000 m3; meanwhile water quality has also severely deteriorated.
While this cannot be extrapolated in any meaningful manner, it nevertheless
indicates the seriousness of the situation. This will likely be further exacer-
bated by the expected impacts of climate change. Although as yet unproven

v
vi Foreword

to the required rigorous standards of scientic accuracy, increasing empirical


evidence indicates that the hydrological cycle is accelerating while the
amount of water at a given moment in time is remains the same. If this
acceleration hypothesis is true then it will cause an increase in the frequency
and magnitude of flooding. At the other end of the spectrum, the prevailing
laws of continuity mean that the severity and duration of drought will also
increase. These increased risks are likely to have serious regional implica-
tions. Early simulation studies suggest that wet areas will become even more
humid while dry areas will become increasingly arid. This will not occur
overnight; similarly, appropriate countermeasures will need time to establish
policies that integrate the technical and social issues in a way that takes
appropriate consideration of the cultural context.
Tremendous efforts and political will are needed to substantially reduce
the number of human beings who have no access to safe drinking water and
adequate sanitation facilities respectively. The substantial growth of human
populationsespecially as half of humanity already lives in urban areas
and the consequent expansion of agricultural and industrial activities with a
high water demand, have only served to increase problems of water avail-
ability, qualityand in many regionswaterborne disease. There is now an
increasing urgency in the UN system to protect water resources through
better management. Data on the scale of deforestation with subsequent land
use conversion, soil erosion, desertication, urban sprawl, loss of genetic
diversity, climate change and the precariousness of food production through
irrigation, all reveal the growing seriousness of the problem. We have been
forced to recognize that societys activities can no longer continue unchecked
without causing serious damage to the very environment and ecosystems we
depend upon for our survival. This is especially critical in water scarce
regions, many of which are found in the developing world and are dependent
on water from aquifers that are not being recharged as fast as their water is
being withdrawn and consumed. Such practices are clearly not sustainable.
Proper water resources management requires consideration of both supply
and demand. The mismatch of supply and demand over time and space has
motivated the development of much of the water resources infrastructure that
is in place today. Some parts of the globe witness regular flooding as a result
of monsoons and torrential downpours, while other areas suffer from the
worsening of already chronic water shortages. These conditions are often
aggravated by the increasing discharge of pollutants resulting in a severe
decline in water quality.
The goal of sustainable water management is to promote water use in such
a way that societys needs are both met to the extent possible now and in the
future. This involves protecting and conserving water resources that will be
needed for future generations. UNESCOs International Hydrological Pro-
gramme (IHP) addresses these short- and long-term goals by advancing our
understanding of the physical and social processes affecting the globes water
resources and integrating this knowledge into water resources management.
This book describes the kinds of problems water managers can and do face
and the types of models and methods one can use to dene and evaluate
alternative development plans and management policies. The information
Foreword vii

derived from these models and methods can help inform stakeholders and
decision-makers alike in their search for sustainable solutions to water
management problems. The successful application of these tools requires
collaboration among natural and social scientists and those in the affected
regions, taking into account not only the water-related problems but also the
social, cultural and environmental values.
On behalf of UNESCO it gives me great pleasure to introduce this book. It
provides a thorough introduction to the many aspects and dimensions of
water resources management and presents practical approaches for analyzing
problems and identifying ways of developing and managing water resources
systems in a changing and uncertain world. Given the practical and academic
experience of the authors and the contributions they have made to our pro-
fession, I am condent that this book will become a valuable asset to those
involved in water resources planning and management. I wish to extend our
deepest thanks to Profs. Pete Loucks and Eelco van Beek for offering their
time, efforts and outstanding experience, which is summarized in this book
for the benet of the growing community of water professionals.

Andrs Szllsi-Nagy
Past Deputy Assistant Director-General, UNESCO
and Past Secretary, International Hydrological Programme
Past Rector Magnicus, UNESCO-IHE, Delft, The Netherlands
Preface

Water resource systems planning and management issues are rarely simple.
Demands for reliable supplies of clean water to satisfy the energy, food, and
industrial demands of an increasing population and to maintain viable natural
ecosystems are growing. This is happening at the same time changes in our
climate are increasing the risks of having to deal with too little or too much
water in many river basins, watersheds, and urban areas. Societies are
becoming increasingly aware of the importance of water and its management
and use; their governing institutions are becoming increasingly involved in
water resources development and management decision-making processes.
To gain a better understanding of the complex interactions among all the
hydrologic, ecologic, economic, engineering and social components of water
resource systems, analyses based on systems perspectives are useful. While
analyses of such complex systems can be challenging, integrated systems
approaches are fundamental for identifying and evaluating options for
improving system performance and security for the benet of all of us.
Just how well we are able to plan and manage our water availability,
quality, and variability is a major determinant of the survival of species, the
functioning and resilience of ecosystems, the strength of economies, and the
vitality of societies. To aid in the analysis of planning and managing options,
a variety of modelling approaches have been developed. This book intro-
duces the science and art of developing and applying various modelling
approaches in support of water resources planning and management. Its main
emphasis is on the practice of developing and using models to address
specic water resources planning and management issues and problems.
Their purpose is to provide relevant, objective, timely and meaningful
information to those who are responsible for deciding how we develop,
manage, and use our water resources.
Readers of this book are not likely to learn the art of systems modelling
and analyses unless they actually do it. The modelling approaches, examples
and case studies contained in this book, together with the exercises offered at
the end of most chapters, we believe and hope, will facilitate the process of
becoming a skilled water resources systems modeler, analyst and planner.
This has been our profession, indeed our hobby and source of enjoyment, and
we can highly recommend it to others.
Water resource systems planning and management is a multidisciplinary
activity. The modelling and analysis of water resources systems involves

ix
x Preface

inputs from the applicable natural and social sciences and from the people,
the stakeholders, who will be impacted. It is a challenge.
Although we have attempted to incorporate into each chapter current
approaches to water resources systems planning and analysis, this book does
not pretend to be a review of the state-of-the-art of water resources systems
analysis. Rather it is intended to introduce readers to the art of developing
and using models and modelling approaches applied to the planning and
managing of water resources systems. We have tried to organize our dis-
cussion in a way useful for teaching and self-study. The contents reflect our
belief that the most appropriate methods for planning and management are
often the simpler ones, chiefly because they are easier to understand and
explain, require less input data and time, and are easier to apply to specic
issues or problems. This does not imply that more sophisticated and complex
models are less useful. Sometimes their use is the only way one can provide
the needed information.
In this book, we attempt to give readers the knowledge to make appro-
priate choices regarding model complexity. These choices will depend in part
on factors such as the issues being addressed and the information needed, the
level of accuracy desired, the availability of data and their cost, and the time
required and available to carry out the analysis. While many analysts have
their favourite modelling approaches, the choice of a particular model and
solution method should be based on the knowledge of various modelling
approaches and their advantages and limitations. There is no one best
approach for analyzing all the issues one might face in this profession.
This book assumes readers have had some mathematical training in
algebra, calculus, geometry and the use of vectors and matrices. Readers will
also benet from some background in probability and statistics and some
exposure to micro-economic theory and welfare economics. Some knowl-
edge of hydrology, hydraulics and environmental engineering will also be
benecial, but not absolutely essential. Readers wanting an overview of some
of natural processes that take place in watersheds, river basins, estuaries and
coastal zones can refer to the Appendices (available on the internet along
with the book itself). An introductory course in optimization and simulation
methods, typically provided in either an operations research or an economic
theory course, can also benet the reader, but again it is not essential.
Chapter 1 introduces water resources systems planning and management
and reviews some examples of water resources systems projects in which
modelling has had a critical role. These projects also serve to identify some
of the current issues facing water managers in different parts of the world.
Chapter 2 introduces the general modelling approach and the role of models
in water resources planning and management activities. Chapter 3 begins the
discussion of optimization and simulation modelling and how they are
applied and used in practice. Chapter 4 focuses on the development and use
of various optimization methods for the preliminary denition of infras-
tructure design and operating policies. These preliminary results dene
alternatives that usually need to be further analyzed and improved using
simulation methods. The advantages and limitations of different
Preface xi

optimization/simulation approaches are illustrated using some simple water


allocation, reservoir operation and water quality management problems.
Chapter 5 extends this discussion of optimization to problems character-
ized by more qualitative objectives and/or constraints. In addition, it intro-
duces some of the more recently developed methods of statistical modelling,
including articial neural networks and evolutionary search methods
including genetic algorithms and genetic programming. This chapter expects
interested readers desiring more detail will refer to other books and papers,
many of which are solely devoted to just these topics. Chapters 6 through 8
are devoted to probabilistic models, uncertainty and sensitivity analyses.
These methods are useful not only for identifying more realistic, reliable, and
robust infrastructure designs and operating policies for the given hydrolog-
ical variability and uncertain parameter values and objectives but also for
estimating some of the major uncertainties associated with model predictions.
Such probabilistic and stochastic models can also help identify just what
model input data are needed and how accurate those data need be with
respect to their influence on the decisions being considered.
Water resources planning and management today inevitably involve
multiple goals or objectives, many of which may be conflicting. It is difcult,
if not impossible, to please all stakeholders all the time. Models containing
multiple objectives can be used to identify the tradeoffs among conflicting
objectives. This is the information useful to decision-makers who must
decide what to do given these tradeoffs among conflicting performance cri-
teria that stakeholders care about. Chapter 9 on multi-objective modelling
identies various types of economic, environmental and physical objectives,
and some commonly used ways of including multiple objectives in opti-
mization and simulation models.
Chapter 10 is devoted to various approaches for modelling water quality
in surface water bodies. Chapter 11 focuses on modelling approaches for
multiple purpose water quantity planning and management in river basins.
Chapter 12 zooms into urban areas and presents some ways of analyzing
urban water systems. Finally, Chap. 13 describes how projects involving the
analyses of water resource systems can be planned and executed.
Following these thirteen chapters are four appendices. They are not
contained in the book but are available on the internet where this book can be
downloaded. They contain descriptions of (A) natural hydrological and
ecological processes in river basins, estuaries and coastal zones, (B) moni-
toring and adaptive management, (C) drought management, and (D) flood
management.
For university teachers, the contents of this book represent more than can
normally be covered in a single quarter or semester course. A rst course
might include Chaps. 1 through 5, and possibly Chaps. 9 and 10 or 11 or 12
or 13 depending on the background and interest of the participants in the
class. A second course could include Chaps. 6 through 8 and/or any com-
bination of Chaps. 10 through 12, as desired. Exercises are offered at the end
of each chapter, and instructors using this text in their academic courses can
contact the authors for the solutions of those exercises if desired.
xii Preface

Many have helped us prepare this book. Jery Stedinger contributed to


Chaps. 6, 7 and 8, Nicki Villars helped substantially with Chap. 10, and Jozef
Dijkman contributed a major portion related to flood management. Tjitte
Nauta, Laura Basco Carrera and Thijs Stoffelen contributed to Chap. 13.
Others who offered advice and who helped review earlier chapter drafts
include Vladan Babovic, Martin Baptist, Henk van den Boogaard, Herman
Breusers, Harm Duel, Herman Gerritsen, Peter Gijsbers, Jos van Gils, Simon
Groot, Karel Heynert, Joost Icke, Hans Los, Marcel Marchand, Tony Minns,
Erik Mosselman, Arthur Mynett, Roland Price, Erik Ruijgh, Johannes Smits,
Mindert de Vries and Micha Werner. Engelbert Vennix and Hans van Ber-
gem created most of the gures and tables in this book. We again thank
Deltares and all these individuals and others who provided assistance and
support on various aspects during the entire time in 2005 and when this
second edition was being prepared.
We have also beneted from the comments of Profs. Jan-Tai Kuo at
National Taiwan University in Taipei, Jay Lund at the University of
California at Davis, Daene McKinney of the University of Texas in Austin,
Peter Rogers at Harvard University in Cambridge, MA, Tineke Ruijgh-van
der Ploeg at TU-Delft, Robert Traver at Villanova University in Philadelphia,
and Jinwen Wang at Huazhong University of Science and Technology in
Wuhan, all of whom have used earlier drafts of this book in their classes.
Finally we acknowledge with thanks the critical support of Andras Szll-
si-Nagy, recently retired as rector of UNESCO-IHE in Delft, NL, and the
publishing staff at UNESCO for publishing the rst edition of this book and
making its electronic version free and unrestricted. We are especially grateful
to Michael Luby of Springer for all his assistance and guidance, and to
Deltares and UNESCO-IHE in Delft, NL, for sharing the cost of publishing
this second edition. We have written this book for an international audience,
and hence we are especially grateful and pleased to have this connection to
and support from Deltares and UNESCO-IHE.
Most importantly, we wish to acknowledge and thank all our teachers,
students and colleagues throughout the world who have taught us all we
know and added to the quality of our professional and personal lives. We
have tried our best to make this book error free, but inevitably somewhere
there will be flaws. For that, we apologize and take responsibility for any
errors of fact, judgment or science that may be contained in this book. We
will be most grateful if you let us know of any or have other suggestions for
improving this book.

Ithaca, NY, USA Daniel P. Loucks


Delft, The Netherlands Eelco van Beek
July 2016
Contents

1 Water Resources Planning and Management:


An Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 1
1.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 1
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case
Studies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 2
1.2.1 Kurds Seek Land, Turks Want Water. . . . . . .. 3
1.2.2 Sharing the Water of the Jordan River
Basin: Is There a Way? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 5
1.2.3 Mending the Mighty and Muddy Missouri. .. 6
1.2.4 The Endangered Salmon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 8
1.2.5 Wetland Preservation: A Groundswell
of Support and Criticism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 10
1.2.6 Lake Source Cooling: Aid to Environment,
or Threat to Lake?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
1.2.7 Managing Water in the Florida Everglades . . . . 12
1.2.8 Restoration of Europes Rivers and Seas . . . . . 14
1.2.9 Flood Management on the Senegal River . . . . . 19
1.2.10 Nile Basin Countries Striving to Share
Its Benefits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 20
1.2.11 Shrinking Glaciers at Top of the World . . . . .. 22
1.2.12 China, a Thirsty Nation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 22
1.2.13 Managing Sediment in Chinas
Yellow River . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 23
1.2.14 Damming the Mekong (S.E. Asia),
the Amazon, and the Congo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
1.3 So, Why Plan, Why Manage?. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
1.3.1 Too Little Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
1.3.2 Too Much Water. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
1.3.3 Too Polluted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
1.3.4 Too Expensive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
1.3.5 Ecosystem Too Degraded . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
1.3.6 Other Planning and Management Issues . . . . . . 33
1.4 System Planning Scales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
1.4.1 Spatial Scales for Planning
and Management. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 33
1.4.2 Temporal Scales for Planning
and Management. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 34

xiii
xiv Contents

1.5 Planning and Management Approaches . . . . . . . . . . . . 34


1.5.1 Top-Down Planning and Management . . . . . . . 34
1.5.2 Bottom-Up Planning and Management . . . . . . . 34
1.5.3 Integrated Water Resources Management . . . . . 36
1.5.4 Water Security and the Sustainable
Development Goals (SDGs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.5 Planning and Management Aspects . . . . . . . . . 37
1.6 Planning and Management Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . 40
1.6.1 Integrated Policies and Development Plans . . . . 40
1.6.2 Sustainability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
1.7 Meeting the Planning and Management
ChallengesA Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... 43
References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... 45
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ... 48

2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role


in Planning and Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
2.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
2.2 Modeling Water Resource Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
2.2.1 An Example Modeling Approach . . . . . . . . . . 54
2.2.2 Characteristics of Problems to be Modeled . . . . 55
2.3 Challenges Involving Modeling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
2.3.1 Challenges of Planners and Managers . . . . . . . 57
2.3.2 Challenges of Modelers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
2.3.3 Challenges of Applying Models in Practice . . . 60
2.3.4 Evaluating Modeling Success . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
2.4 Developments in Modeling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
2.4.1 Technology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
2.4.2 Algorithms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
2.4.3 Interactive Model-Building Environments . . . . . 63
2.4.4 Open Modeling Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
2.5 Conclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71

3 Models for Identifying and Evaluating Alternatives . . . . . . . 73


3.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
3.1.1 Model Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
3.2 Plan Formulation and Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
3.2.1 Plan Formulation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
3.2.2 Plan Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
3.3 Conceptual Model Development . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
3.4 Simulation and Optimization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
3.4.1 Simulating a Simple Water Resources
System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
3.4.2 Defining What to Simulate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
3.4.3 Simulation Versus Optimization . . . . . . . . . . . 85
3.5 Conclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Contents xv

4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods . .... 93


4.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .... 93
4.2 Comparing Time Streams of Economic Benefits
and Costs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
4.2.1 Interest Rates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
4.2.2 Equivalent Present Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
4.2.3 Equivalent Annual Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
4.3 Nonlinear Optimization Models and Solution
Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
4.3.1 Solution Using Calculus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
4.3.2 Solution Using Hill Climbing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
4.3.3 Solution Using Lagrange Multipliers . . . . . . . . 99
4.4 Dynamic Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
4.4.1 Dynamic Programming Networks
and Recursive Equations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
4.4.2 Backward-Moving Solution Procedure . . . . . . . 108
4.4.3 Forward-Moving Solution Procedure . . . . . . . . 112
4.4.4 Numerical Solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
4.4.5 Dimensionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
4.4.6 Principle of Optimality. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
4.4.7 Additional Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
4.4.8 General Comments on Dynamic
Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
4.5 Linear Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
4.5.1 Reservoir Storage Capacity-Yield Models. . . . . 138
4.5.2 A Water Quality Management Problem . . . . . . 142
4.5.3 A Groundwater Supply Example . . . . . . . . . . . 151
4.5.4 A Review of Linearization Methods . . . . . . . . 158
4.6 A Brief Review . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165

5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling. . . . . . 179


5.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
5.2 Artificial Neural Networks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
5.2.1 The Approach. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
5.2.2 An Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
5.3 Evolutionary Algorithms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
5.3.1 Genetic Algorithms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
5.3.2 Example Iterations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
5.3.3 Differential Evolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
5.3.4 Covariance Matrix Adaptation Evolution
Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
5.4 Genetic Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
5.5 Qualitative Functions and Modeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
5.5.1 Linguistic Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
5.5.2 Membership Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
5.5.3 Illustrations of Qualitative Modeling . . . . . . . . 197
xvi Contents

5.6 Conclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207


References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209

6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics,


and Uncertainty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
6.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
6.2 Probability Concepts and Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
6.2.1 Random Variables and Distributions . . . . . . . . 215
6.2.2 Expected Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
6.2.3 Quantiles, Moments, and Their Estimators . . . . 219
6.2.4 L-Moments and Their Estimators . . . . . . . . . . 224
6.3 Distributions of Random Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
6.3.1 Parameter Estimation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
6.3.2 Model Adequacy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
6.3.3 Normal and Lognormal Distributions . . . . . . . . 234
6.3.4 Gamma Distributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
6.3.5 Log-Pearson Type 3 Distribution. . . . . . . . . . . 239
6.3.6 Gumbel and GEV Distributions. . . . . . . . . . . . 241
6.3.7 L-Moment Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
6.4 Analysis of Censored Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
6.5 Regionalization and Index-Flood Method . . . . . . . . . . . 247
6.6 Partial Duration Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
6.7 Stochastic Processes and Time Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
6.7.1 Describing Stochastic Processes . . . . . . . . . . . 250
6.7.2 Markov Processes and Markov Chains . . . . . . . 251
6.7.3 Properties of Time Series Statistics . . . . . . . . . 254
6.8 Synthetic Streamflow Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
6.8.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
6.8.2 Streamflow Generation Models . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
6.8.3 A Simple Autoregressive Model . . . . . . . . . . . 261
6.8.4 Reproducing the Marginal Distribution. . . . . . . 263
6.8.5 Multivariate Models. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
6.8.6 Multiseason, Multisite Models . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
6.9 Stochastic Simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
6.9.1 Generating Random Variables. . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
6.9.2 River Basin Simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
6.9.3 The Simulation Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
6.9.4 Simulation of the Basin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
6.9.5 Interpreting Simulation Output . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
6.10 Conclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286

7 Modeling Uncertainty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301


7.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
7.2 Generating Values from Known Probability
Distributions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
7.3 Monte Carlo Simulation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Contents xvii

7.4 Chance Constrained Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306


7.5 Markov Processes and Transition Probabilities . . . . . . . 308
7.6 Stochastic Optimization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
7.6.1 Probabilities of Decisions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
7.6.2 A Numerical Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
7.7 Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328

8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . 331


8.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
8.2 Issues, Concerns, and Terminology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
8.3 Variability and Uncertainty in Model Output . . . . . . . . 334
8.3.1 Natural Variability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
8.3.2 Knowledge Uncertainty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
8.3.3 Decision Uncertainty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
8.4.1 Uncertainty Analyses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
8.4.2 Sensitivity Analyses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
8.5 Performance Indicator Uncertainties. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
8.5.1 Performance Measure Target Uncertainty . . . . . 362
8.5.2 Distinguishing Differences Between
Performance Indicator Distributions . . . . . . . . . 366
8.6 Communicating Model Output Uncertainty. . . . . . . . . . 367
8.7 Conclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370
References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373

9 Performance Criteria . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375


9.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375
9.2 Informed Decision-Making . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376
9.3 Performance Criteria and General Alternatives . . . . . . . 377
9.3.1 Constraints on Decisions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
9.3.2 Tradeoffs Among Performance Criteria . . . . . . 379
9.4 Quantifying Performance Criteria . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380
9.4.1 Economic Criteria . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380
9.4.2 Environmental Criteria . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389
9.4.3 Ecological Criteria. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389
9.4.4 Social Criteria. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
9.5 Multicriteria Analyses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
9.5.1 Dominance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394
9.5.2 The Weighting Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
9.5.3 The Constraint Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
9.5.4 Satisficing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
9.5.5 Lexicography . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
9.5.6 Indifference Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
9.5.7 Goal Attainment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
xviii Contents

9.5.8 Goal Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401


9.5.9 Interactive Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402
9.5.10 Plan Simulation and Evaluation. . . . . . . . . . . . 402
9.6 Statistical Summaries of Performance Criteria . . . . . . . . 407
9.6.1 Reliability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
9.6.2 Resilience. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
9.6.3 Vulnerability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
9.7 Conclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411

10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417


10.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417
10.2 Establishing Ambient Water Quality Standards . . . . . . . 418
10.2.1 Water Use Criteria. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
10.3 Water Quality Model Use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
10.3.1 Model Selection Criteria. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421
10.3.2 Model Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422
10.3.3 Model Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425
10.4.1 Mass Balance Principles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425
10.4.2 Steady-State Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428
10.4.3 Design Streamflows for Setting
and Evaluating Quality Standards . . . . . . . . . . 430
10.4.4 Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 432
10.4.5 Sources and Sinks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433
10.4.6 First-Order Constituents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433
10.4.7 Dissolved Oxygen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433
10.4.8 Nutrients and Eutrophication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 437
10.4.9 Toxic Chemicals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 441
10.4.10 Sediments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446
10.4.11 Processes in Lakes and Reservoirs. . . . . . . . . . 446
10.5 Simulation Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452
10.5.1 Numerical Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452
10.5.2 Traditional Approach . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
10.5.3 Backtracking Approach . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 455
10.5.4 Model Uncertainty. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 457
10.6 ConclusionsImplementing a Water Quality
Management Policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 458
References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 459
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 462

11 River Basin Modeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 469


11.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 469
11.2 Model Time Periods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470
11.3 Streamflow Estimation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
11.4 Streamflow Routing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472
Contents xix

11.5 Lakes and Reservoirs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473


11.5.1 Estimating Active Storage Capacity . . . . . . . . . 474
11.5.2 Reservoir Storage-Yield Functions. . . . . . . . . . 476
11.5.3 Evaporation Losses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 478
11.5.4 Over- and Within-Year Reservoir Storage
and Yields . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479
11.6 Drought and Flood Risk Reduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 489
11.6.1 Drought Planning and Management . . . . . . . . . 489
11.6.2 Flood Protection and Damage Reduction . . . . . 490
11.7 Hydroelectric Power Production . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502
11.8 Withdrawals and Diversions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 504
11.9 Lake-Based Recreation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 505
11.10 Model Synthesis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 506
11.11 Project Scheduling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511
11.12 Conclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 515
References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 515
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 516

12 Urban Water Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527


12.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527
12.2 Water Treatment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529
12.3 Water Distribution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
12.3.1 Open-Channel Networks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
12.3.2 Pressure Pipe Networks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
12.3.3 Water Quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 535
12.4 Wastewater Collection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536
12.4.1 Sewer Networks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536
12.5 Wastewater Treatment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537
12.6 Urban Drainage Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 539
12.6.1 Rainfall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 539
12.6.2 Runoff . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
12.6.3 Surface Pollutant Loading and Washoff . . . . . . 549
12.6.4 Water Quality Impacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 553
12.6.5 Green Urban Infrastructure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 558
12.7 Urban Water System Modeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 558
12.7.1 Optimization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 558
12.7.2 Simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 560
12.8 Conclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561
References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561
Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564

13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567


13.1 Water Management Challenges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567
13.2 Water Resources System Components, Functions,
and Decisions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 568
13.2.1 Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 568
13.2.2 Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 569
13.2.3 Goals, Strategies, Decisions, and Scenarios. . . . 570
13.2.4 Systems Approaches to WRS Planning
and Decision Making. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 571
xx Contents

13.3 Conceptual Description of WRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572


13.3.1 Characteristics of the Natural Resources
System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573
13.3.2 Characteristics of the Socioeconomic
System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 574
13.3.3 Characteristics of the Administrative
and Institutional System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 575
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation . . . . . . . . 576
13.4.1 Step IInception Phase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 579
13.4.2 Step IISituation Analysis. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 584
13.4.3 Step IIIStrategy Building . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 592
13.4.4 Steps IV and VAction Planning
and Implementation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 596
13.5 Making It Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600
13.5.1 Stakeholder Engagement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600
13.5.2 Using Models in a Planning Process . . . . . . . . 605
13.6 Conclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 609
References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 614
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 617
Water Resources Planning
and Management: An Overview 1

1.1 Introduction ways of transporting bulk cargo. They have pro-


vided people water-based recreational opportuni-
Water resource systems have beneted both ties and have been a source of water for wildlife
people and their economies for many centuries. and their habitats. They have also served as a
The services provided by such systems are means of transporting and transforming waste
multiple. Yet in many regions of the world they products that are discharged into them. The
are not able to meet even basic drinking water quantity and quality regimes of streams and rivers
and sanitation needs. Nor can many of these have been a major factor in governing the type,
water resource systems support and maintain health, and biodiversity of riparian and aquatic
resilient biodiverse ecosystems. Typical causes ecosystems. Floodplains have provided fertile
include inappropriate, inadequate and/or degra- lands for agricultural crop production and rela-
ded infrastructure, excessive withdrawals of river tively flat lands for the siting of roads and railways
flows, pollution from industrial and agricultural and commercial and industrial complexes. In
activities, eutrophication resulting from nutrient addition to the economic benets that can be
loadings, salinization from irrigation return derived from rivers and their floodplains, the aes-
flows, infestations of exotic plant and animals, thetic beauty of most natural rivers has made lands
excessive sh harvesting, flood plain and habitat adjacent to them attractive sites for residential and
alteration from development activities, and recreational development. Rivers and their flood-
changes in water and sediment flow regimes. The plains have generated, and, if managed properly,
inability of water resource systems to meet the can continue to generate, substantial cultural,
diverse needs for water often reflect failures in economic, environmental, and social benets for
planning, management, and decision-making their inhabitants.
and at levels broader than water. Planning, Human activities undertaken to increase the
developing, and managing water resources to benets obtained from rivers and their flood-
ensure adequate, inexpensive, and sustainable plains may also increase the potential for costs
supplies and qualities of water for both humans and damages such as when the river is experi-
and natural ecosystems can only succeed if we encing periods of droughts, floods, and heavy
recognize and address the causal socioeconomic pollution. These costs and damages are physical,
factors, such as inadequate education, corruption, economic, environmental, and social. They result
population pressures, and poverty. because of a mismatch between what humans
Over the centuries, surface and ground waters expect or demand, and what nature offers or
have been a source of water supply for agricultural, supplies. Human activities tend to be based on
municipal, and industrial consumers. Rivers have the usual or normal range of river flow con-
provided hydroelectric energy and inexpensive ditions. Rare or extreme flow conditions

The Author(s) 2017 1


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_1
2 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

outside these normal ranges will continue to of hydrologic and hydraulic processes become
occur, and possibly with increasing frequency as more pronounced, and as stakeholder expecta-
climate change experts suggest. River-dependent tions of system performance increase in com-
human activities that cannot adjust to these plexity. The focus or goal is no longer simply to
extreme flow conditions will incur losses. maximize economic net benets while making
The planning of human activities involving sure the distribution of those benets is equitable.
rivers and their floodplains must consider certain There are also environmental and ecological
hydrologic facts. One of these facts is that sur- goals to consider. Rarely are management ques-
face water flows and aquifer storage volumes tions one-dimensional, such as how can we pro-
vary over space and time. They are also nite. vide, at acceptable costs, more high-quality water
There are limits to the amounts of water that can to municipalities, industry, or to irrigation areas in
be withdrawn from them. There are also limits to the basin. Now added to that question is how
the amounts of pollutants that can be discharged would those withdrawals affect the downstream
into them. Once these limits are exceeded, the hydrologic water quantity and quality regimes,
concentrations of pollutants in these waters may and in turn the riparian and aquatic ecosystems.
reduce or even eliminate the benets that could Problems and opportunities change over time.
be obtained from other users of the resource. Just as the goals of managing and using water
Water resources professionals have learned change over time, so do the processes of plan-
how to plan, design, build, and operate structures ning to meet these changing goals. Planning
that together with nonstructural measures processes evolve not only to meet new demands,
increase the benets people can obtain from the expectations, and objectives, but also in response
water resources contained in aquifers, lakes, to new perceptions of how to plan and manage
rivers, and estuaries. However, there is a limit to more effectively.
the services one can expect from these resources. This chapter reviews some of the issues
Rivers, estuaries, and coastal zones under stress requiring water resources planning and manage-
from over development and overuse cannot reli- ment. It provides some context and motivation
ably meet the expectations of those depending on for the following chapters that outline in more
them. How can these resources best be managed detail our understanding of how to plan and
and used? How can this be accomplished in an how to manage and how computer-based pro-
environment of uncertain and varying supplies grams and models can assist those involved in
and uncertain and increasing demands, and con- these activities. Additional information is avail-
sequently of increasing conflicts among individ- able in many of the references listed at the end of
uals having different interests in their this chapter.
management and use? The central purpose of
water resources planning, management, and
analysis activities is to address, and if possible 1.2 Planning and Management
answer, these questions. These questions have Issues: Some Case Studies
scientic, technical, political (institutional), and
social dimensions. Thus water resources plan- Managing water resources certainly requires
ning processes and products are must. knowledge of the relevant physical sciences and
River basin, estuarine, and coastal zone man- technology. But at least as important, if not more
agersthose responsible for managing the so, are the multiple institutional, social, or
resources in those areasare expected to manage political issues confronting water resources
those resources effectively and efciently, meet- planners and managers. The following brief
ing the demands or expectations of all users, and descriptions of some water resources planning
reconciling divergent needs. This is no small task, and management studies at various geographic
especially as demands increase, as the variability scales illustrate some of these issues.
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 3

1.2.1 Kurds Seek Land, Turks Want quarter of the countrys electric power needs.
Water Planners hope this can improve the standard of
living of six million of Turkeys poorest people,
The Tigris and Euphrates Rivers (Fig. 1.1) cre- most of the Kurds, and thus undercut the appeal
ated the Fertile Crescent where some of the of revolutionary separatism. It will also reduce
rst civilizations emerged. Today their waters are the amount of water Syria and Iraq believe they
critical resources, politically as well as geo- needwater that Turkey fears might ultimately
graphically. In one of the worlds largest public be used in anti-Turkish causes.
works undertakings, Turkeys Southeast Anatolia The region of Turkey where Kurds predom-
Project includes 13 irrigation and hydropower inate is more or less the same region covered by
schemes, and the construction of 22 dams and 19 the Southeast Anatolia Project, encompassing an
hydroelectric power plants on both the Tigris and area about the size of Austria. Giving that region
the Euphrates. Upon completion, it is expected to autonomy by placing it under Kurdish self-rule
provide up to 25% of the countrys electricity. could weaken the central Governments control
Its centerpiece, the Ataturk Dam (Fig. 1.2) on over the water resource that it recognizes as a
the Euphrates River, is already completed. In the keystone of its future power.
lake formed behind the dam, sailing and swim- In other ways also, Turkish leaders are using
ming competitions are being held on a spot their water as a tool of foreign as well as domestic
where for centuries there was little more than policy. Among their most ambitious projects
desert (Fig. 1.3). considered is a 50-mile undersea pipeline to carry
When the multireservoir project is completed water from Turkey to the parched Turkish enclave
it is expected to increase the amount of irrigated on northern Cyprus. The pipeline, if actually
land in Turkey by 40% and provide up to a built, will carry more water than northern Cyprus

Fig. 1.1 The Tigris and Euphrates Rivers in Turkey, northern Syria, and Iraq
4 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

Fig. 1.2 Ataturk Dam on the Euphrates River in Turkey (DSI)

Fig. 1.3 Water sports on Ataturk Reservoir on the Euphrates River in Turkey (DSI)
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 5

can use. Foreign mediators, frustrated by their reaches up to 2000 parts per million (ppm) in the
inability to break the political deadlock on lowest section, which renders it unt for crop
Cyprus, are hoping that the excess water can be irrigation. Only in flood years is fresh water
sold to the ethnic Greek republic on the southern released into the lower Jordan Valley.
part of the island as a way of promoting peace. One result of this increased pressure on fresh-
As everyone knows, the Middle East is cur- water resources is the deterioration of the regions
rently (2016) witnessing considerable turmoil so wetlands. These wetlands are important for water
who knows the fate of any water resources project purication and flood and erosion control. As
in this region, including the one just described in agricultural activities expand, wetlands are being
Turkey and the following example in Jordan. One drained, and rivers, aquifers, lakes, and streams
can only hope that the management and use of are being polluted with runoff containing fertiliz-
this scarce resource will lead to more peaceful ers and pesticides. Reversing these trends by
resolutions of conflicts not only involving water preserving natural ecosystems is essential to the
but of other political issues as well. future availability of fresh water in the region.
To ensure that an adequate supply of fresh,
high-quality water is available for future gener-
1.2.2 Sharing the Water of the ations, Israel, Jordan, and the Palestinian
Jordan River Basin: Is Authority will have to work together to preserve
There a Way? aquatic ecosystems (White et al. 1999). Without
these natural ecosystems, it will be difcult and
A growing populationapproximately 12 mil- expensive to sustain high-quality water supplies.
lion peopleand intense economic development The role of ecosystems in sustaining water sup-
in the Jordan River Basin (Fig. 1.4) are placing plies has largely been overlooked in the context
heavy demands on its scarce freshwater resour- of the regions water supplies. Vegetation con-
ces. This largely arid region receives less than trols storm water runoff and lters polluted water,
250 mm of rainfall each year, yet total water use and it reduces erosion and the amount of sedi-
for agricultural and economic activities has been ment that makes its way into water supplies.
steadily increasing. This plus encroaching urban Streams assimilate wastewater, lakes store clean
development have degraded many sources of water, and surface waters provide habitat for
high-quality water in the region. many plants and animals.
The combined diversions by the riparian water The Jordan River Basin just like most river
users have changed the river in its lower course basins should be evaluated and managed as a
into little better than a sewage ditch. From the whole system, to permit the comprehensive
1300 million cubic meters (mcm) of water that assessment of the effects of water management
flowed into the Dead Sea in the 1950s only a options on wetlands, lakes, the lower river, and
small fraction remains at present. In normal years the Dead Sea coasts. Damage to ecosystems and
the flow downstream from Lake Tiberias (also loss of animal and plant species should be
called the Sea of Galilee or Lake Kinneret) is weighed against the potential benets of devel-
some 60 million cubic meters (mcm)about oping land and creating new water resources. For
10% of the natural discharge in this section. It example, large river-management projects that
mostly consists of saline springs and sewage divert water to dry areas have promoted intensive
water. These flows are then joined by what year-round farming and urban development, but
remains of the Yarmouk, by some irrigation available river water is declining and becoming
return flows, and by winter runoff, adding up to increasingly polluted. Attempting to meet current
an annual total of from 200300 mcm. Both in demands solely by withdrawing more ground
quantity and quality this water is unsuitable for and surface water could result in widespread
irrigation and does not sufciently supply natural environmental degradation and depletion of
systems either. The salinity of the Jordan River freshwater resources.
6 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

Fig. 1.4 The Jordan River


between Israel and Jordan

There are policies that if implemented could among all those living in the basin. Will this be
help preserve the capacity of the Jordan River to possible?
meet future demands. Most of the options relate
to improving the efciency of water usethat is,
they involve conservation and better use of pro- 1.2.3 Mending the Mighty
ven technologies. Also being considered are and Muddy Missouri
policies that emphasize economic efciency and
reduce overall water use. Charging higher rates Nearly two centuries after an epic expedition
for water use in peak periods, and surcharges for through the Western US in search of a northwest
excessive use, would encourage conservation. In river passage to the Pacic Ocean, there is little
addition, new sources of fresh water can be enchantment left to the Missouri River. Shown in
obtained by capturing rainfall through rooftop Figs. 1.5 and 1.6, it has been dammed, diked,
cisterns, catchment systems, and storage ponds. and dredged since the 1930s mainly to control
However before such measures are required, one floods and float cargo barges. The river nick-
should assess the impact on local aquifer named the Mighty Missouri and the Big
recharge, storage, and withdrawals. Muddy by its explorers is today neither mighty
Thus there are alternatives to a steady deteri- nor muddy. The conservation group American
oration of the water resources of the Jordan Basin. Rivers perennially lists the Missouri among the
They will require coordination and cooperation USAs 10 most endangered rivers.
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 7

Fig. 1.5 Major river basins in the continental US

commercial towboats. Some of the rivers banks


are armored with rock and concrete retaining
walls that protect half a million acres of farm
elds from flooding. Once those floods produced
and maintained marshlands and side streams
habitats for a wide range of wildlife. Without
these habitats, many wild species are unable to
thrive, and in some cases even survive.
Changes to restore at least some of the Missouri
to a more natural state are being implemented.
These changes add protection of sh and wildlife
habitat to the list of objectives to be achieved by the
Fig. 1.6 The Missouri Basins Reservoirs (not to scale) government agencies managing the Missouri. The
constructed for navigation and flood control
needs of wildlife are now as important as other
competing interests on the river including naviga-
Its wilder upper reaches are losing their cot- tion and flood control. This is in reaction, in part, to
tonwood trees to dam operations and cattle that the booming $115 million-a-year outdoor recre-
trample seedlings along the rivers banks. Its vast ation industry. Just how much more emphasis will
middle contains multiple dams that hold back be given to these back-to-nature goals depends on
floods, generate power, and provide pools for whether the Missouri River Basin Association, an
boats and anglers. organization representing eight states and 28 Native
Its lower one-third is a narrow canal some- American tribes, can reach a compromise with the
times called The Ditch that is deep enough for traditional downstream uses of the river.
8 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

1.2.4 The Endangered Salmon development in one of the fastest growing


regions of the U.S.
Greater Seattle in the northwestern US state of Before the Columbia River and its tributaries in
Washington may be best known around the NW US were blocked with dozens of dams, about
world for Microsoft, but residents know it for 1016 million salmon made the annual run back
something less flashy: its dwindling stock of wild up to their spawning grounds (Fig. 1.7). In 1996, a
salmon. The Federal Government has placed little less than 1 million did. But the economy of
seven types of salmon and two types of trout on the NW depends on the dams and locks that have
its list of threatened or endangered species. been built in the Columbia that provide cheap
Saving the sh from extinction could slow land hydropower production and navigation.

Fig. 1.7 The Snake and Columbia River reservoirs identied by the Columbia and Snake Rivers Campaign for
modication or dismantling to permit salmon passage
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 9

For a long time, engineers tried to modify the place, sh are caught and trucked around the
system so that sh passage would be possible. As turbines. The costs of keeping these salmon
shown in Fig. 1.8b, this included even the use of alive, if not completely happy, are enormous.
trucks to transport captured juvenile salmon Over a dozen national and regional environ-
around dams for release downstream. (It is not mental organizations have joined together to
clear that the trucks will be there when the sh bring back salmon and steelhead by modifying or
return to spawn upstream of the dams.) These partially dismantling ve federal dams on the
measures have not worked all that well. Still too Columbia and Snake Rivers. Partial removal of
many young sh enter the hydropower turbines the four dams on the lower Snake River in
on their way down the river. Now, as the debate Washington State and lowering the reservoir
over whether or not to remove some dams takes behind John Day dam on the Columbia bordering

Fig. 1.8 A salmon


swimming upstream
(a) and measures taken to
protect young juvenile
salmon pass by
hydropower dams on their
way downstream (b) (US
Fish and Wildlife Service
and US Army Corps of
Engineers, Pacic region)
10 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

Oregon and Washington (see Fig. 1.8) should Environmentalists and some homeowners
help restore over 200 miles of vital river habitat. value wetlands because they help reduce water
Running the rivers more like rivers may return pollution and floods, as well as nurture a diverse
salmon and steelhead to harvestable levels of the wildlife population. But many landowners and
1960s before the dams were built. developers see the open wetlands as prime ter-
Dismantling part of the four Lower Snake ritory for building houses and businesses, rather
dams will leave most of each dam whole. Only than for breeding mosquitoes. They view exist-
the dirt bank connecting the dam to the riverbank ing federal wetland rules as onerous, illogical,
will be removed. The concrete portion of the dam and expensive.
will remain in place, allowing the river to flow While some areas such as Tiger Point have
around it. The process is reversible and, the residents who want stricter laws to limit wetlands
Campaign argues, it will actually save taxpayers development, otherssuch as the suburbs
money in planned dam maintenance, by elimi- around Seattlehave people who long for less
nating subsidies to shipping industries and strict rules.
agribusinesses, and by ending current salmon Federal regulators had tried to quell the con-
recovery measures that are costly. Only partially troversy with a solution known as wetlands miti-
removing the four Lower Snake River dams and gation. Anyone who destroys a wetland is required
modifying John Day dam will help restore rivers, to build or expand another wetland somewhere
save salmon, and return balance to the North- else. Landowners and developers also see miti-
wests major rivers. gation as a way out of the torturous arguments over
wetlands. However, studies have shown many
articial marshes do not perform as well as those
1.2.5 Wetland Preservation: created by nature (NRC 2001). Many of the new,
A Groundswell of Support articial wetlands are what scientists call the ring
and Criticism around the pond variety: open water surrounded
by cattails. Furthermore, the federal agency issu-
The balmy beach community of Tiger Point ing permits for wetland replacement do not have
near Pensacola, Florida, bordering the Gulf of the resources to monitor them after they are
Mexico, is booming with development. New approved. Developers know this.
subdivisions, a Wal-Mart discount retail store
and a recreation center dot the landscape.
Mostif not allof this neighborhood was 1.2.6 Lake Source Cooling:
once a wetland that soaked up rain during Aid to Environment,
downpours. Now, water runs off the parking lots or Threat to Lake?
and the roofs and into residents living rooms.
Some houses get flooded nearly every year. It seems to be an environmentalists dream: a
A federal agency oversees wetland develop- cost-effective system that can cool some
ment. Critics say the agency is permitting in this 10 million square feet of high school and
area one of the highest rates of wetland loss in the university buildings simply by pumping cold
nation. Obviously local developers wish they did water from the depths of a nearby lake (Fig. 1.9).
not have to deal with the agency at all. The ten- No more chlorofluorocarbons, the refrigerants
sion in Tiger Point reflects the debate throughout that can destroy protective ozone in the atmo-
the US about whether the government is doing sphere and at a cost substantially smaller than for
enoughor too muchto protect the nations conventional air conditioners. The lake water is
environment, and in this case, its wetlands. returned to the lake, with a few added calories.
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 11

Fig. 1.9 The cold deep waters of Lake Cayuga are being used to cool the buildings of a local school and university
(Ithaca City Environmental Laboratory)

However, a group of local opponents insists environmental impacts, and over the process that
that Cornell Universitys $55 million lake-source- took place in getting the required local, state, and
cooling plan that replaced its aging air condition- federal permits approved. This is in spite of the
ers is actually an environmental threat. They fact that the planning process, that took over
believe it could foster algal blooms. Pointing to 5 5 years, requested and involved the participation
years of studies, thousands of pages of data, and of all interested stakeholders (that would partic-
more than a dozen permits from local and state ipate) from the very beginning. Even the local
agencies, Cornells consultants say the system Sierra Club chapter and biology professors at
could actually improve conditions in the lake. Yet other universities have endorsed the project.
another benet, they say, is that the system would However, in almost every project where the
reduce Cornells contribution to global warming environmental impacts are uncertain, there will
by reducing the need to burn coal to generate be debates among scientists as well as stake-
electricity. holders. In addition, a signicant segment of
For the most part, government ofcials agree. society distrusts scientists anyway. This is a
But a small determined coalition of critics from major societal problem, wrote a professor and
the local community argue over the expected expert in the dynamics of lakes. A scientist says
12 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

X and someone else says Y and youre got chaos. distribution of water depths, flows, and flooding
In reality, we are the problem. Every time we durationscalled hydroperiods. Issues arise
flush our toilets, fertilize our lawns, gardens and because of variations from the natural/historical
elds, or wash our cars we contribute to the hydrologic regime, degraded water quality, and
nutrient loading of the lake. the sprawl from fast-growing urban areas.
The project has now been operating for over a To meet the needs of the burgeoning popula-
decade, and so far no adverse environmental tion and increasing agricultural demands for
effects have been noticed at any of the many water, and to begin the restoration of Everglades
monitoring sites. aquatic ecosystem to a more natural regime, an
ambitious plan has been developed by the U.S.
Army Corps of Engineers and its local sponsor,
1.2.7 Managing Water in the Florida the South Florida Water Management District.
Everglades The proposed Corps plan is estimated to cost over
$8 billion. The plan and its Environmental
The Florida Everglades (Fig. 1.10) is the largest Impact Statement (EIS) have received input from
single wetland in the continental United States. many government agencies and nongovernmental
In the mid-1800s it covered a little over nine organizations, as well as from the public at large.
million acres, but since that time the historical The plan to restore the Everglades is ambi-
Everglades has been drained and half of the area tious and comprehensive, involving change of
devoted to agriculture and urban development. the current hydrologic regime in the remnant
The remaining wetland areas have been altered Everglades to one that resembles a more natural
by human disturbances both around and within one, reestablishment of marshes and wetlands,
them. Water has been diverted for human uses, implementation of agricultural best management
flows have been lowered to protect against practices, enhancements for wildlife and recre-
floods, nutrient supplies to the wetlands from ation, and provisions for water supply and flood
runoff from agricultural elds and urban areas control.
have increased, and invasions of nonnative or Planning for and implementing the restoration
otherwise uncommon plants and animals have effort requires application of state-of-the-art large
out-competed native species. Populations of systems analysis concepts, hydrological and
wading birds (including some endangered spe- hydroecological data and models incorporated
cies) have declined by 8590% in the last within decision support systems, integration of
half-century, and many species of South Flor- social sciences, and monitoring for planning and
idas mammals, birds, reptiles, amphibians, and evaluation of performance in an adaptive man-
plants are either threatened or endangered. agement context. These large, complex chal-
The present management system of canals, lenges of the greater Everglades restoration effort
pumps, and levees (Fig. 1.11) will not be able to demand the most advanced, interdisciplinary,
provide adequate water supplies to agricultural and scientically sound analysis capabilities that
and urban areas, or sufcient flood protection, are available. They also require the political will
let alone support the natural (but damaged) to make compromises and to put up with the
ecosystems in the remaining wetlands. The sys- lawsuits by anyone possibly disadvantaged by
tem is not sustainable. Problems in the greater some restoration measure.
Everglades ecosystem relate to both water quality Who pays for all this? The taxpayers of
and quantity, including the spatial and temporal Florida and the taxpayers of the U.S.
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 13

Fig. 1.10 Scenes of the


Everglades in southern
Florida (South Florida
Water Management
District)
14 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

Fig. 1.11 Pump station on a drainage canal in southern Florida (South Florida Water Management District)

1.2.8 Restoration of Europes Rivers Those parts of the seas at greatest risk from
and Seas pollution are where the sediments come to rest,
where the water replacement is slowest and
1.2.8.1 North and Baltic Seas where nutrient concentrations and biological
The North and Baltic Seas (shown in Fig. 1.12) productivity are highest. A number of warning
are the most densely navigated seas in the world. signals have occurred.
Besides shipping, military, and recreational uses, Algal populations have changed in number
an offshore oil industry and telephone cables and species. There have been algal blooms,
cover the seabed. The seas are rich and produc- caused by excessive nutrient discharge from land
tive with resources that include not only sh but and atmospheric sources. Species changes show
also crucial minerals (in addition to oil) such as a tendency toward more short-lived species of
gas, sand, and gravel. These resources and the opportunistic type and a reduction, some-
activities play major roles in the economies of the times to the point of disappearance, of some
surrounding countries. mammals and sh species and the sea grass
Being so intensively used and surrounded by community. Decreases of ray, mackerel, sand eel,
advanced industrialized countries, pollution and echinoderms due to eutrophication have
problems are serious. The main pollution sources resulted in reduced plaice, cod, haddock and dab,
include various wastewater outfalls, dumping by mollusk and scoter.
ships (of dredged materials, sewage sludge, and The impact of shing activities is also con-
chemical wastes) and operational discharges siderable. Sea mammals, sea birds, and Baltic
from offshore installations. Deposition of atmo- sh species have been particularly affected by the
spheric pollutants is an additional major source widespread release of toxins and pollutants
of pollution. accumulate in the sediments and in the food web.
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 15

Fig. 1.12 Europes major rivers and seas


16 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

Some animals, such as the gray seal and the sea river during the past 150 years. The Rhine was
eagle, are threatened with extinction. originally a natural watercourse. It is the only
Particular concern has been expressed about river connecting the Alps with the North Sea. To
the Wadden Sea that serves as a nursery for many achieve greater economic benets from the river,
North Sea species. Toxic PCB contamination, for it was engineered for navigation, hydropower,
example, almost caused the disappearance of water supply, and flood protection. Flood plains
seals in the 1970s. Also, the 1988 massive seal now protected from floods, provided increased
mortality in the North and Wadden Seas, land areas suitable for development. The main
although caused by a viral disease, is still thought stream of the Rhine is now considerably shorter
by many to have a link with marine pollution. and narrower and deeper than it was originally.
Although the North Sea needs radical and From an economic development point of
lengthy treatment it is probably not a terminal view, the engineering works implemented in the
case. Actions are being taken by bordering river and its basin worked. The Rhine basin is
countries to reduce the discharge of wastes into now one of the most industrialized regions in the
the sea. A major factor leading to agreements to world. The basin is characterized by intensive
reduce discharges of wastewaters has been the industrial and agricultural activities. Some 20%
verication of predictive pollutant circulation of the worlds chemical industry is located in the
models of the sea that identify the impacts of Rhine River basin. The River is reportedly the
discharges from various sites along the sea busiest shipping waterway in the world, con-
boundary. taining long canals with regulated water levels.
These canals connect the Rhine and its tributaries
1.2.8.2 The Rhine with the rivers of almost all the surrounding river
The map of Fig. 1.13 shows the areas of the nine basins including the Danube River. This provides
countries that are part of river Rhine basin. In the water transport to and from the North and Black
Dutch area of the Rhine basin, water is partly Seas.
routed northward through the IJssel and west- From an environmental and ecological view-
ward through the highly interconnected river point, and from the viewpoint of flood control as
systems of the Rhine, Meuse, and Waal. well, the economic development that has taken
About 55 million people live in the Rhine place over the past two centuries has not worked
River basin and about 20 million of those people perfectly. The concerns growing from the recent
drink the river water. toxic spill and floods as from a generally
In the mid 1970s, some called the Rhine the increasing interest by the inhabitants of the basin
most romantic sewer in Europe. In November in environmental and ecosystem restoration and
1986, a chemical spill degraded much of the the preservation of natural beauty, has resulted in
upper Rhines aquatic ecosystem. This damaging basin-wide efforts to rehabilitate the basin to a
event was reported worldwide. The Rhine was more living sustainable entity.
again world news in the rst 2 months of 1995, A Rhine Action Programme was created to
when its water level reached a height that occurs revive the ecosystem. The goal of that program is
on average once in a century. In the Netherlands, the revival of the main stream as the backbone of
some 200,000 people, 1,400,000 pigs and cows, the ecosystem, particularly for migratory sh,
and 1,000,000 chickens had to be evacuated. and the protection, maintenance, and the revival
During the last 2 months of the same year there of ecologically important areas along the Rhine.
was hardly enough water in the Rhine for navi- The plan, implemented in the 1990s, was given
gation. It is fair to say these events have focused the name Salmon 2000. The return of salmon
increased attention on what needs to be done to to the Rhine is seen as a symbol of ecological
restore and protect the Rhine. revival. A healthy salmon population will need to
To address just how to restore the Rhine, it is swim throughout the river length. This will pose
useful to look at what has been happening to the a challenge, as no one pretends that the
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 17

Fig. 1.13 The Rhine River Basin of Western Europe and its extension in The Netherlands
18 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

engineering works that provide navigation and recreation, and tourism. It is considered to be an
hydropower benets, but which also inhibit sh ecosystem with irreplaceable environmental
passage, are no longer needed or desired. values.
More than 40 dams and large barrages plus
1.2.8.3 The Danube over 500 smaller reservoirs have been con-
The Danube River (shown in Fig. 1.14) is in the structed on the main Danube River and its
heartland of Central Europe. Its basin includes to tributaries. Flood control dikes conne most of
a larger extent the territories of 15 countries. It the length of the main stem of the Danube River
additionally receives runoff from small catch- and the major tributaries. Over the last 50 years
ments located in four other countries. About natural alluvial flood plain areas have declined
90 million people live in the basin. This river from about 26,000 km2 to about 6000 km2.
encompasses perhaps more political, economic, There are also signicant reaches with river
and social variations than arguably any other training works and river diversion structures.
river basin in Europe. These structures trap nutrients and sediment in
The river discharges into the Black Sea. The the reservoirs. This causes changes in down-
Danube delta and the banks of the Black Sea stream flow and sediment transport regimes that
have been designated a Biosphere Reserve by reduce the ecosystems habitats both longitudi-
UNESCO. Over half of the Delta has been nally and transversely, and decrease the ef-
declared a wet zone of international signi- ciency of natural purication processes. Thus
cance. Throughout its length the Danube River while these engineered facilities provide impor-
provides a vital resource for drainage, commu- tant opportunities for the control and use of the
nications, transport, power generation, shing, rivers resources, they also illustrate the

Germany CzechRepublic
Morava
Slovak Republic Ukraine
Munich

Inn Vienna Moldava


Austria
Mura Budapest
Drova Tisza
Hungary Romania

Slovenia
Zagreb
Croatia Oltul
Sava
Belgrade Bucarest
Bosnia and Serbia
Herzegovina
Danube
Morava
Montenegro Bulgaria
Kosovo

Fig. 1.14 The Danube River in Central Europe


1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 19

difculties of balancing these important eco- the social interactions and economic productivity
nomic activities with environmentally sound and of farmers, shers, and herders whose livelihoods
sustainable management. depend on the annual flooding of valley bottom-
The environmental quality of the Danube River lands. Although much of the Senegal River flows
is also under intense pressure from a diverse range through a low rainfall area, the naturally occur-
of human activities, including point source and ring annual flooding supported a rich and bio-
nonpoint source agricultural, industrial, and logically diverse ecosystem. Living in a
municipal wastes. Because of the poor water sustainable relationship with their environment,
quality (sometimes affecting human health) the small-land holders farmed sandy uplands during
riparian countries of the Danube river basin have the brief rainy season, and then cultivated the clay
been participating in environmental management plains as floodwaters receded to the main channel
activities on regional, national, and local levels for of the river. Livestock also beneted from the
several decades. All Danube countries signed a succession of rain-fed pastures on the uplands and
formal Convention on Cooperation for the Pro- flood-recession pastures on the plains. Fish were
tection and Sustainable Use of the Danube River in abundant. As many as 30,000 tons were caught
June 1994. The countries have agreed to take yearly. Since the early 1970s, small irrigated rice
all appropriate legal, administrative and technical schemes added a fth element to the production
measures to improve the current environmental array: rain-fed farming, recession farming, herd-
and water quality conditions of the Danube River ing, shing, and irrigation.
and of the waters in its catchment area and to Completion of the Diama salt intrusion barrage
prevent and reduce as far as possible adverse near the mouth of the river between Senegal and
impacts and changes occurring or likely to be Mauritania and Manantali High Dam more than
caused. 1000 km upstream in Mali (Fig. 1.15), and the
termination of the annual flood have had adverse
effects on the environment. Rather than insulating
1.2.9 Flood Management the people from the ravages of drought, the dam
on the Senegal River release policy can accelerate desertication and
intensify food insecurity. Furthermore, anticipa-
As on many rivers in the tropical developing tion of donor investments in huge irrigation
world, dam constructions on the Senegal (and schemes has, in this particular case, lead to the
conventional dam management strategies) can expulsion of non-Arabic-speaking black Mauri-
change not only the riverine environment but also tanians from their floodplain lands.

Fig. 1.15 Senegal River


and its Manantali Reservoir
more than 1000 km
upstream in Mali
20 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

This is a common impact of dam construction: Notwithstanding the basins natural and
increased hardships of generally politically pow- environmental endowments and rich cultural
erless people in order that urban and industrial history, its people face considerable challenges
sectors may enjoy electricity at reduced costs. including persistent poverty with millions living
Studies in the Senegal Valley by anthropolo- on less than a dollar a day; extreme weather
gists, hydrologists, agronomists, and others sug- events associated with climate variability and
gest that it may be entirely economically feasible change such as floods and droughts; low access
to create a controlled annual articial flood, to water and sanitation services; deteriorating
assuring satisfaction of both urban, industrial, water quality; and very low access rate to modern
and rural demands for the rivers water and energy with most countries below 20% access
supporting groundwater recharge, reforestation, level. The region also has a history of tensions
and biodiversity. and instability both between states and internal to
Because of these studies, the government of states.
Senegal ended its opposition to an articial flood, Cooperative management and development
and its development plans for the region are now could bring a vast range of benets including
predicated on its permanence. However, due to increased hydropower and food production; bet-
the common belief that releasing large quantities ter access to water for domestic use; improved
of water to create an articial flood is incompat- management of watersheds and reduced envi-
ible with maximum hydropower production, the ronmental degradation; reduced pollution and
other members of the three-country consortium more control over damage from floods and
managing the damsMali and Mauritaniahave droughts. Recognizing this the Nile Basin Ini-
resisted accepting this policy. tiative was created as a regional intergovern-
mental partnership that seeks to develop the
River Nile in a cooperative manner, share sub-
1.2.10 Nile Basin Countries Striving stantial socioeconomic benets, and promote
to Share Its Benefits regional peace and security. The partnership
includes 10 Member States namely Burundi, DR
The Nile River (Fig. 1.16) is one of the major Congo, Egypt, Ethiopia, Kenya, Rwanda, South
rivers of the world, serving millions and giving Sudan, The Sudan, Tanzania, and Uganda. Eri-
birth to entire civilizations. It is one of the worlds trea participates as an observer. NBI was con-
longest rivers, traversing about 6695 km from the ceived as a transitional institution until a
farthest source of its headwaters in Rwanda and permanent institution can be created.
Burundi through Lake Victoria, to its delta in The partnership is guided by a Shared
Egypt on the Mediterranean Sea. Its basin Vision: To achieve sustainable socio-economic
includes 11 African countries (Burundi, DR development through equitable utilization of,
Congo, Egypt, Eritrea, Ethiopia, Kenya, Rwanda, and benet from, the common Nile Basin Water
South Sudan, The Sudan, and Tanzania) and resources. The shared belief is that countries
extends for more than 3 million square kilometers can achieve better outcomes for all the peoples
which represents about 10% of Africas land mass of the Basin through cooperation rather than
area. The basin includes the Sudd wetland system competition. It is supported by a Shared Vision
in South Sudan. Planning Model built by experts from all the
Nile Basin countries are today home to more basin countries. The model is designed to run
than 437 million people and of these, 54% different scenarios and assess the basin-wide
(238 million) live within the basin and expect impacts of different management policies and
benets from the management and use of the assumptions that any country may wish to
shared Nile Basin water resources. perform.
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 21

E030127n
Lebanon
Syria
Mediterranean Sea Iraq
Israel/
Palestine
Jordan
Libya Cairo
Saudi Arabia

Egypt
High Aswan Dam
Africa

Lake Nasser

le
Ni Red Sea
Merowe

Atb
Eritrea
Chad
Khartoum Jebel Aulia ara
Khashm El Girba
Tekeze
Sennar
Rumela/Burdana
Sudan Roseires Lake Tana

Renaissance
Bahr El Nile
Machar Blue
Arab Malakal
swamp
So
ba
t Addis Ababa
Ghazal

Jonglei
El

Central hr Canal
African Ba Ghazal
swamp
Ethiopia
Republic
Sudd
swamp White
Nile

Uganda
Lake Lake
Democratic Albert Kyoga
Republic of Congo Kenya
Kampala Owen Falls
Lake
Edward
existing dam Lake
dam under Rwanda Victoria
construction
0 1 00 2 00 300 km Burundi Indian
Tanzania Ocean

Fig. 1.16 The Nile River Basin


22 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

1.2.11 Shrinking Glaciers at Top (Wong 2013). Together, these factors portend
of the World future water scarcity that could add to the
regions political volatility.
As shown in Fig. 1.17, Tibet lies north of India, Most important is that the regions glaciers are
Nepal, Bhutan, and Myanmar, west of China, and receding at one of the fastest rates anywhere in
south of East Turkistan. The highest and largest the world, and in some regions of Tibet by three
plateau on Earth, it stretches some 1500 miles 3 m per year (IPPC 2007). The quickening
(2400 km) from east to west, and 900 miles melting and evaporation is raising serious con-
(1448 km) north to south, an area equivalent in cerns in scientic and diplomatic communities,
size to the United States region east of the Mis- in and outside China, about Tibets historic
sissippi River. The Himalayas form much of its capacity to store more freshwater than anyplace
southern boundary, and Tibets average altitude is on earth, except the North and South Poles.
so high11,000 feet (3350 km) above sea Tibets water resources, they say, have become
levelthat visitors often need weeks to acclimate. an increasingly crucial strategic political and
The Tibetan Plateau serves as the headwaters cultural element that the Chinese are intent on
for many of Asias largest rivers, including the managing and controlling.
Yellow, Yangtze, Mekong, Brahmaputra, Sal-
ween, and Sutlej, among others. A substantial
portion of the worlds population lives in the 1.2.12 China, a Thirsty Nation
watersheds of the rivers whose sources lie on the
Tibetan Plateau. Why does China care about the freshwater in
Recent studiesincluding several by the Tibet? With more than a quarter of its land
Chinese Academy of Scienceshave docu- classied as desert, China is one of the planets
mented a host of serious environmental chal- most arid regions. Beijing is besieged each spring
lenges involving the quantity and quality of by raging dust storms born in Inner Mongolia
Tibets freshwater reserves, most of them caused where hundreds of square miles of grasslands are
by industrial activities. Deforestation has led to turning to desert each year. In other parts of the
large-scale erosion and siltation. Mining, manu- nation, say diplomats and economic development
facturing, and other human and industrial activ- specialists, Chinese rivers are either too polluted
ities are producing record levels of air and water or too lled with silt to provide all of Chinas
pollution in Tibet, as well as elsewhere in China people with adequate supplies of freshwater.

Fig. 1.17 China, India,


and Southeast Asia,
highlighting the Tibetan
Plateau
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 23

Chinese authorities have long had their eyes Another major management issue is the
on Tibets water resources. They have proposed ecosystem health of the river. The relative scar-
building dams for hydropower and spending city of water creates a tension between allocating
billions of dollars to build a system of canals to water for the benet of river health, and for direct
tap water from the Himalayan snowmelt and social and economic benet. Irrigation uses 80%
glaciers and transport it hundreds of miles north of the water consumed from the river, with the
and east to the countrys farm and industrial rest supplying industry, and drinking water for
regions. cities along the river and outside of the basin
But how long that frozen reservoir will last is (Tianjin, Cangzhou and Qingdao). During the
in doubt. In attempting to solve its own water 1980s and 1990s the lower river dried up nearly
crisis, China could potentially create widespread every year, resulting in lost cereal production,
water shortages among its neighbors. suspension of some industries, and insufcient
While the political issues involving Tibet are water supplies for more than 100,000 residents,
complex, there is no denying that water plays a who had to queue daily for drinking water. As
role in Chinas interest in the region. The water well as costing around RmB40 billion in lost
of Tibet may prove to be one of its most production, there was a serious decline in the
important resources in the long runfor China, ecological health of the river.
and for much of southern Asia. Figuring out how The diversity of habitat types and extensive
to sustainably manage that water will be a key to areas of wetlands within the Ramsar-listed Yel-
reducing political conflicts and tensions in the low River Delta support at least 265 bird species.
region. The birds, sh, and macroinvertebrates in the
delta rely on healthy and diverse vegetation
communities, which in turn depend upon on
1.2.13 Managing Sediment in Chinas annual freshwater flooding and the associated
Yellow River high sediment loads. Degradation of the
ecosystem of the Delta has been documented,
The scarcity of water is not the only issue China especially from the late-1990s, due to increased
has to address. So is sediment, especially in the human activities and a signicant decrease in the
Yellow River (Fig. 1.18). The Yellow River basin flow of freshwater to the Delta wetlands. This has
is the cradle of Chinese civilization, with agri- led to saltwater intrusion and increased soil
cultural societies appearing on the banks of the salinity. Restoration activities involving the
river more than 7000 years ago. The Yellow River articial delivery of freshwater to the wetlands
originates in the QinghaiTibetan plateau and began in 2002.
discharges into the Bohai Gulf in the Yellow sea.
The basin is traditionally divided into the upper,
middle, and lower reaches, which can be descri- 1.2.14 Damming the Mekong
bed as three down-sloping steps: the Tibetan (S.E. Asia), the Amazon,
Plateau, the Loess Plateau, and the alluvial plain. and the Congo
Key management issues are many, but the most
visible one is sediment (Figs. 1.19 and 1.20). The worlds most biodiverse river basinsthe
The high sediment load of the Yellow River is Amazon, Congo, and Mekongare attracting
a curse if the sediment deposits on the bed of the hydropower developers. While hydropower pro-
channel and reduces its capacity, thereby jects address energy needs and offer the potential
increasing the risk of flooding. Also, rapid of a higher standard of living, they also can
deposition of sediment in reservoirs situated impact the rivers biodiversity, especially sh-
along the river is a problem as it reduces their eries. The Amazon, Congo, and Mekong basins
effectiveness for flood control and water storage. hold roughly one-third of the worlds freshwater
24 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

Fig. 1.18 The Yellow River Basin in China

sh species, most of which are not found else- several decades due to regional conflicts, indeed
where. Currently more than 450 additional dams conflicts that have altered the history of the world.
are planned for these three rivers (see Figs. 1.22 Now that these conflicts are not resulting in mil-
and 1.23) (Winemiller et al. 2016). Many of the itary battles (at this writing), investment capital is
sites most appropriate for hydropower production becoming available to develop the Mekongs
also are the habitats of many sh species. Given resources for improved shing, irrigation, flood
recent escalation of hydropower development in control, hydroelectric power, tourism, recreation,
these basins, planning is needed to reduce bio- and navigation. The potential benets are sub-
diversity loss, as well as other adverse environ- stantial, but so are the environmental, ecological,
mental, social, and economic impacts while and social risks (Orr et al. 2012).
meeting the energy needs of the basins. The economic value of hydroelectric power
The Mekong River (Fig. 1.21) flows some currently generated from the Mekong brings in
4200 km through Southeast Asia to the South welcome income however the environmental
China Sea through Tibet, Myanmar (Burma), impacts are harder to quantify. Today some
Vietnam, Laos, Thailand, and Cambodia. Its 60 million people (12 million households) live in
development has been restricted over the past the Lower Mekong Basin, and 80% rely directly
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 25

Fig. 1.19 Sediment flows in Chinas Yellow River. http://yellowriver-china.blogspot.com/2011/09/book-review-on-


ood-discharge-and.html

on the river system for their food and livelihoods. Vietnamese delta region alone. The ecology of a
Most of these households would be affected by major lake, Tonle Sap, in Cambodia depends on
alterations to sh availability since sh is their these backed up waters.
main source of dietary protein. The food security While flooding imposes risks on the inhabi-
impacts on these people due to the existing and tants of the Mekong flood plain, there are also
proposed dam building and operation in Cam- distinct advantages. High waters deposit
bodia, Laos, Thailand, and Vietnam remain rel- nutrient-rich silts on the low-lying farmlands,
atively unexplored. Dam builders have often thus sparing the farmers from having to transport
failed to recognize, or wish to ignore, the crucial and spread fertilizers on their elds. Also, shal-
role of inland sheries in meeting food security low lakes and submerged lands provide spawn-
needs. ing habitats for about 90% of the sh in the
During some months of the year the lack of Mekong basin. Fish yield totals over half a mil-
rainfall causes the Mekong to fall dramatically. lion tons annually.
Salt water may penetrate as much as 500 km What will happen to the social fabric and to the
inland. In other months the flow can be up to natural environment if the schemes to build big
30 times the low flows, causing the water in the dams (see Fig. 1.22a) across the mainstream of
river to back up into wetlands and flood some the Mekong are implemented? Depending on
12,000 km2 of forests and paddy elds in the their design, location, and operation, they could
26 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

Fig. 1.20 Dams can be


designed and operated to
remove some of the
sediment that is trapped in
the upstream reservoir

disrupt the current fertility cycles and the habitats the Delta, its survival as a geologic feature, and as
and habits of the sh in the river resulting from a major source of food, is in doubt.
the natural flow and sediment regimes. Increased There have been suggestions that a proposed
erosion downstream from major reservoirs is also dam in Laos could cause deforestation in a
a threat. Add to these possible adverse impacts wilderness area of some 3000 km2. Much of the
the need to evacuate and resettle thousands of wildlife, including elephants, big cats, and other
people displaced by the lake behind the dams. rare animals, would have to be protected if they
How will they be resettled? And how long will it are not to become endangered. Malaria-carrying
take them to adjust to new farming conditions? mosquitoes, liver fluke, and other disease bearers
And will there even be a Delta? Together with sea might nd ideal breeding grounds in the mud
level rise and a blockage of Mekongs sediment to flats of the shallow reservoir. These are among
1.2 Planning and Management Issues: Some Case Studies 27

Fig. 1.21 The Lower Mekong River Basin including Tonle Sap Lake in Cambodia and the Mekong Delta in Vietnam
28 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

human populations and expanding deforestation


associated with new roads. Scheduled for com-
pletion in 2016, Brazils Belo Monte hydropower
complex was designed with installed capacity of
11,233 MW, ranking it the worlds third largest.
But it could also set a record for biodiversity loss
owing to selection of a site that is the sole habitat
for many species. The Congo has far fewer dams
than the Amazon or Mekong, yet most power
generated within the basin is from hydropower.
Inga Falls, a 14.5-km stretch of the lower Congo
that drops 96 m to near sea level, has greater
hydropower potential than anywhere else. The
Inga I and II dams, constructed in the 1970s and
1980s, currently yield 40% of the 2132-MW
installed capacity. Planned additional dams (Inga
III and Grand Inga) would harness as much as
83% of the Congos annual discharge, with most
of the energy to be exported. Grand Inga would
divert water and substantially reduce flow for at
least 20 km downstream from the falls. Again,
many trade-offs involved with dam building, and
all calling for comprehensive systems planning
and analyses to identify them.

Fig. 1.22 Lancang/Mekong River where reservoirs are 1.3 So, Why Plan, Why Manage?
being planned on the river itself (a) and on many of its
tributaries (b). a http://khmerization.blogspot.com/2013/ Water resources planning and management
10/wwf-expresses-alarm-over-laos-decision.html, 6/10/
activities are usually motivated, as they were in
13, and b reprinted from Wild and Loucks 2014, with
permission. 2014. American Geophysical Union each of the previous sections case examples, by
the realization that there are problems to solve
and/or opportunities to obtain increased benets
the types of issues that need to be considered by changing the management and use of water
now that increased development seems likely. and related land resources. These benets can be
Similar issues face those who are planning measured in many different ways. The best way
similar hydropower dam developments in the other to do it is often not obvious. Whatever way is
two most biodiverse river basins in the worldthe proposed may provoke conflict. Hence there is
Amazon and the Congo (Fig. 1.23). Clarifying the the need for careful study and research, as well as
trade-offs between energy (economic), environ- full stakeholder involvement, in the search for
mental, and social goals can inform governments the best compromise plan or management policy.
and funding institutions as they make their dam Reducing the frequency and/or severity of the
siting, design, and operating decisions. adverse consequences of droughts, floods, and
Hydropower accounts for more than excessive pollution are common goals of many
two-thirds of Brazils energy supply, and over planning and management exercises. Other rea-
300 new Amazon dams have been proposed. sons include the identication and evaluation of
Impacts of these dams would extend beyond alternative measures that may increase the
direct effects on rivers to include relocation of available water supplies, hydropower, improve
1.3 So, Why Plan, Why Manage? 29

Fig. 1.22 (continued)


30 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

Fig. 1.23 Fish diversity and dam locations in the number of species (black numbers) and the total species
Amazon and Congo basins. In addition to basin-wide richness (shades of green) found in ecoregions differ
biodiversity summaries (upper left), each basin can be widely (Winemiller et al. 2016)
divided into ecoregions (white boundaries). Approximate

recreation and/or navigation, and enhance water demands exceed the available supplies, conflicts
quality and aquatic ecosystems. Quantitative will exist over water allocations. Finding the best
system performance criteria can help one judge way to manage, if not resolve, these conflicts are
the relative net benets, however measured, of reasons for planning.
alternative plans and management policies.
System performance criteria of interest have
evolved over time. They have ranged from being 1.3.1 Too Little Water
primarily focused on safe drinking water just a
century ago to multipurpose economic develop- Issues involving inadequate supplies to meet
ment a half-century ago to goals that now include demands can result from too little rain or snow.
environmental and ecosystem restoration and They can also result from patterns of land and
protection, aesthetic and recreational experi- water use. They can result from growing urban-
ences, and more recently, sustainability (ASCE ization, the growing needs to meet instream flow
1998; GTT 2014). requirements, and conflicts over private property
Some of the multiple purposes served by a and public rights regarding water allocations.
river can be conflicting. A reservoir used solely Other issues can involve transbasin water trans-
for hydropower, or water supply, is better able to fers and markets, objectives of economic ef-
meet its objectives when it is full of water. On the ciency versus the desire to keep nonefcient
other hand, a reservoir used solely for down- activities viable, and demand management mea-
stream flood control is best left empty so it can sures, including incentives for water reuse and
store more of the flood flows when they occur. water reuse nancing.
A single reservoir serving all three purposes Measures to reduce the demand for water in
introduces conflicts over how much water to times of supply scarcity should be identied and
store in it and discharge from it, i.e., how it agreed upon before everyone must cope with an
should be operated. In basins where diversion actual water scarcity. The institutional authority
1.3 So, Why Plan, Why Manage? 31

to implement drought measures when their des-


ignated triggerssuch as storage volumes in
reservoirshave been met should be established
before they are needed. Such management mea-
sures may include increased groundwater
abstractions to supplement low-surface water
flows and storage volumes. Conjunctive use of
ground and surface waters can be sustainable as
long as the groundwater aquifers are recharged
during conditions of high flow and surface stor-
age volumes. Many aquifers are subject to with-
drawals exceeding recharge, and hence continued Fig. 1.24 The lowest risk of flooding on a floodplain
withdrawals from them cannot be sustained. does not always mean the best risk, and what risk is
acceptable may depend on the amount of insurance or
subsidy provided when flood damage occurs

1.3.2 Too Much Water


Analyses carried out during planning can help
identify the appropriate level of development and
Damage due to flooding is a direct result of
flood damage protection works based on the
floodplain development that is incompatible with
benecial as well as adverse economic, envi-
floods. This is a risk many take, and indeed on
ronmental, and ecological consequences of flood
average it may result in positive private net
plain development. People are increasingly rec-
benets, especially when public agencies subsi-
ognizing the economic as well as environmental
dize these private risk takers who incur losses in
and ecological benets of allowing floodplains to
times of flooding. In many river basins of
do what they were formed to dostore flood
developed regions, annual expected flood dam-
waters when floods occur.
ages are increasing over time, in spite of
Industrial development and related port
increased expenditures in flood damage reduc-
development may result in the demand for deeper
tion measures. This is in part due to increased
and wider rivers to allow the operation of larger
economic development taking place on river
draft cargo vessels in the river. River channel
flood plains, not only of increased frequencies
improvement cannot be detached from functions
and magnitudes of floods.
such as water supply and flood control. Widening
The increased economic value of developments
and deepening a river channel for shipping pur-
on floodplains often justies increased develop-
poses may also decrease flood water levels.
ment and increased expenditures on flood damage
reduction measures. Flood protection works
decrease the risks of flood damage, creating an 1.3.3 Too Polluted
even larger incentive for increased economic
development. Then when a flood exceeding the Wastewater discharges by industry and house-
capacity of existing flood protection works occurs, holds can have considerable detrimental effects
and it will, even more damage results. This cycle of on water quality and hence on public and
increasing flood damages and costs of protection is ecosystem health. Planning and management
a natural result of increasing values of flood plain activities should pay attention to these possible
development. Just what is the appropriate level of negative consequences of industrial development
risk? It may depend, as Fig. 1.24 illustrates, on the and the intensive use and subsequent runoff of
level of flood insurance or subsidy provided when pesticides and fertilizers in urban as well as in
flooding occurs. agricultural areas.
Flood damages will decrease only if there are Issues regarding the environment and water
restrictions placed on floodplain development. quality include:
32 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

Upstream versus downstream conflicts on effective it has to address all the root causes of
meeting water quality standards, such poverty, not only the need for clean water.
Threats from aquatic nuisance species,
Threats from the chemical, physical, and
biological water quality of the watersheds 1.3.5 Ecosystem Too Degraded
aquatic resources,
Quality standards for recycled water, Aquatic and riparian ecosystems may be subject
Nonpoint source pollution discharges includ- to a number of threats. The most important ones
ing sediment from erosion, and include habitat loss due to river training and
Inadequate groundwater protection, compacts, reclamation of floodplains and wetlands for
and concerned institutions. urban and industrial development, poor water
quality due to discharges of pesticides, fertilizers
We still know too little about the environ- and wastewater effluents, and the infestation of
mental and health impacts of many of the aquatic nuisance species.
wastewater constituents found in river waters. As Exotic aquatic nuisance species can be major
more is learned about, for example, the harmful threats to the chemical, physical, and biological
effects of heavy metals and dioxins, pharma- water quality of a rivers aquatic resources and a
ceutical products, and micropollutants and major interference with other uses. The destruc-
nanoparticles in our water supplies, water quality tion and/or loss of the biological integrity of
standards, plans and management policies should aquatic habitats caused by introduced exotic
be adjusted accordingly. The occurrence of major species is considered by many ecologists to be
sh kills and algae blooms also point to the need among the most important problems facing nat-
to manage water quality as well as quantity. ural aquatic and terrestrial ecosystems. Biologi-
cal integrity of natural ecosystems is controlled
by habitat quality, water flows or discharges,
1.3.4 Too Expensive water quality, and biological interactions
including those involving exotic species.
Too many of the worlds population do not have Once exotic species are established, they are
adequate water to meet all of their drinking and usually difcult to manage and nearly impossible
sanitation needs. Much of this is not due to the to eliminate. This creates a costly burden for
lack of technical options available to provide current and future generations. The invasion in
water to meet those needs. Rather those options North America of nonindigenous aquatic nui-
are deemed to be too expensive. Doing so is sance species such as the sea lamprey, zebra
judged to be beyond the ability of those living in mussel, purple loosestrife, European green crab,
poverty to pay and recover the costs of imple- and various aquatic plant species, for example,
menting, maintaining, and operating the needed has had pronounced economic and ecological
infrastructure. Large national and international consequences for all who use or otherwise ben-
aid grants devoted to reducing water stress et from aquatic ecosystems.
demands for clean water exceeding usable sup- Environmental and ecological effectiveness as
pliesin stressed communities have not been well as economic efciency should be a guiding
sustainable in the long run where recipients have principle in evaluating alternative solutions to
been unable to pay for the upkeep of whatever problems caused by aquatic nuisance organisms.
water resource systems are developed and pro- Funds spent in prevention and early detection
vided. If nancial aid is to be provided, to be and eradication of aquatic nuisance species may
1.3 So, Why Plan, Why Manage? 33

reduce the need to spend considerably more sediment load in the water released from the
funds on management and control once such reservoir. Lower sediment concentrations result
aquatic nuisance species are well established. in higher risks of scouring of downstream riv-
erbeds and consequently a lowering of their
elevations. Economic as well as social impacts
1.3.6 Other Planning include the risk of a dam break. Environmental
and Management Issues impacts may result from sedimentation control
measures (e.g., sediment flushing as shown in
1.3.6.1 Navigation Fig. 1.19) and reduced oxygen content of the
Dredging river beds is a common practice to outflowing water.
keep river channels open for larger draft cargo
ships. The use of jetties as a way to increase the
flow in the main channel and hence increase 1.4 System Planning Scales
bottom scour is a way to reduce the amount of
dredging that may be needed, but any modica- 1.4.1 Spatial Scales for Planning
tion of the width and depth of a river channel can and Management
impact its flood carrying capacity. It can also
alter the periodic flooding of the floodplain that Watersheds or river basins are usually considered
in turn can have ecological impacts. logical regions for water resources planning and
management. This makes sense if the impacts of
1.3.6.2 River Bank Erosion decisions regarding water resources management
Bank erosion can be a serious problem where are contained within the watershed or basin. How
towns are located close to morphologically active land and water are managed in one part of a river
(eroding) rivers. Predictions of changes in river basin can impact the land and water in other parts
courses due to bank erosion and bank accretion of the basin. For example, the discharge of pol-
are important inputs to land use planning in river lutants or the clearing of forests in the upstream
valleys and the choice of locations for bridges, portion of the basin may degrade the quality and
buildings, and hydraulic structures. increase the variability of the flows and sedi-
mentation downstream. The construction of a
1.3.6.3 Reservoir Related Issues dam or weir in the downstream part of a river
Degradation of the riverbeds upstream of reser- may block vessels and sh from traveling up- or
voirs may increase the risks of flooding in those downstream through the dam site. To maximize
areas. Reservoir construction inevitably results in the economic and social benets obtained from
loss of land and forces the evacuation of resi- the entire basin, and to insure that these benets
dents due to impoundment. Reservoirs can be and accompanying costs are equitably dis-
ecological barriers for migrating sh species such tributed, planning and management on a basin
as salmon. The water quality in the reservoir may scale is often undertaken.
deteriorate and the inflowing sediment may settle While basin boundaries make sense from a
and accumulate, reducing the active (useful) hydrologic point of view, they may be inade-
water storage capacity of the reservoir and quate for addressing particular water resources
causing more erosion downstream. Other poten- problems that are caused by events taking place
tial problems may include those stemming from outside the basin. What is desired is the highest
stratication, water-related diseases, algae level of performance, however dened, of the
growth, and abrasion of hydropower turbines. entire physical, social-economic, and adminis-
Environmental and morphological impacts trative water resource system. To the extent that
downstream of the dam are often due to a the applicable problems, stakeholders, and
changed river hydrograph and decreased administrative boundaries extend outside the
34 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

river basin, then the physically based river Both approaches, working together, can lead to an
basin focus of planning and management should integrated plan and management policy.
be expanded to include the entire applicable
problem-shed. Hence consider the term river
basin used in this book to mean problem-shed 1.5.1 Top-Down Planning
when appropriate. and Management

Over much of the past half-century water


1.4.2 Temporal Scales for Planning resources professionals have been engaged in
and Management preparing integrated, multipurpose master
development plans for many of the worlds river
Planning is a continuing iterative process. Water basins. These plans typically consist of a series of
resources plans need to be periodically updated reports, complete with numerous appendices,
and adapt to new information, new objectives, describing all aspects of water resources man-
and updated forecasts of future demands, costs, agement and use. In these documents alternative
and benets. Current decisions should not pre- structural and nonstructural management options
clude future generations from options they may are identied and evaluated. Based on these
want to consider, but otherwise current decisions evaluations, the preferred plan is recommended.
should be responsive to current needs and This master planning exercise has typically
opportunities, and have the ability to be adapt- been a top-down approach. Professionals have
able in the future to possible changes in those dominated the top-down approach. Using this
needs and opportunities. approach there is typically little if any active
The number and duration of within-year time participation of interested stakeholders. The
periods explicitly considered in the planning approach assumes that one or more institutions
process will depend in part on the need to con- have the ability and authority to develop and
sider the variability of the supplies of and implement the plan, i.e., to oversee and manage
demands for water resources and on the purposes the coordinated development and operation of
to be served by the water resources. Irrigation the basins activities impacting the surface and
planning and summer season water recreation ground waters of the basin. In todays environ-
planning may require a greater number of ment where publics are calling for less govern-
within-year periods during the summer growing ment oversight, regulation and control, and
and recreation season than might be the case if increasing participation in planning and man-
one were considering only municipal water agement activities, strictly top-down approaches
supply planning, for example. Assessing the are becoming less desirable or acceptable.
impacts of alternatives for conjunctive surface
and groundwater management, or for water
quantity and quality management, require atten- 1.5.2 Bottom-Up Planning
tion to processes that typically take place on and Management
different spatial and temporal scales.
Within the past several decades water resources
planning and management processes have
1.5 Planning and Management increasingly involved the active participation of
Approaches interested stakeholdersthose potentially affec-
ted by the decision being considered. Plans are
There are two general approaches to planning and being created from the bottom-up rather
management. One is from the top-down, often than top-down through a process of consensus
called command and control. The other is from the building. Concerned citizens, nongovernmen-
bottom-up, often called the grassroots approach. tal organizations, as well as professionals in
1.5 Planning and Management Approaches 35

governmental agencies are increasingly working table. Once the inevitable conflicts become
together toward the creation of adaptive com- identied, the settling of administrative matters
prehensive water management programs, poli- does not get any easier.
cies, and plans. Bottom-up planning must strive to achieve a
Experiences trying to implement plans common or shared vision among all stake-
developed primarily by professionals without holders. It must either comply with all applicable
signicant citizen involvement have shown that laws and regulations, or propose changes to
even if such plans are technically sound they them. It should strive to identify and evaluate
have little chance of success if they do not take multiple alternatives and performance criteria
into consideration the concerns and objectives of including sustainability criteria, and yet keep the
affected stakeholders. To gain their support, process from producing a wish list of everything
concerned stakeholders must be included in the each stakeholder wants. In other words, it must
decision-making process as early as possible. identify trade-offs among conflicting goals or
They must become part of the decision-making measures of performance, and prioritizing
process, not merely spectators, or even advisors, appropriate strategies. It must value and com-
to it. This will help gain their cooperation and pare, somehow, the intangible and nonmonetary
commitment to the plans eventually adopted. impacts of environmental and ecosystem pro-
Participating stakeholders will consider the tection and restoration with other activities
resulting plans as their plans as much as someone whose benets and costs can be expressed in
elses. They will have a sense of ownership, and monetary units. In doing all this, planners should
as such will strive to make them work. Such use modern information technology, as available,
adopted plans, if they are to be successfully to improve both the process and product. This
implemented, must t within existing legislative, technology, however, will not eliminate the need
permitting, enforcement, and monitoring pro- to reach conclusions and make decisions on the
grams. Stakeholder participation improves the basis of incomplete and uncertain data and sci-
chance that the system being managed will be entic knowledge.
sustainable. These process issues emphasize the need to
Successful planning and management make water resources planning and management
involves motivating all potential stakeholders as efcient and effective as possible and remain
and sponsors to join and participate in the water participatory. Many issues will arise in terms of
resources planning and management process. It evaluating alternatives and establishing perfor-
will involve building a consensus on goals and mance criteria (prioritizing issues and possible
objectives and on how to achieve them. Ideally actions), performing incremental cost analysis,
this should occur before addressing conflicting and valuing monetary and nonmonetary benets.
issues so that all involved know each other and Questions must be answered as to how much
are able to work together more effectively. data must be collected and with what precision,
Agreements on goals and objectives and on the and what types of modern information technol-
organization (or group formed from multiple ogy (e.g., geographic information systems (GIS),
organizations) that will lead and coordinate the remote sensing, Internet and mobile Internet
water resources planning and management pro- networks, decision support systems, etc.) can be
cess should be reached before stakeholders bring benecially used both for analyses as well as
their individual priorities or problems to the communication.
36 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

1.5.3 Integrated Water Resources


Management Box 1.1 Definition of IWRM
IWRM is a process which promotes the
The concept of integrated water resources man- coordinated development and management
agement (IWRM) has been developing over the of water, land, and related resources, in
past several decades. IWRM is the response to order to maximize the resultant economic
the growing pressure on our water resources and social welfare in an equitable manner
systems caused by growing populations and without compromising the sustainability of
socioeconomic developments. Water shortages vital ecosystems.
and deteriorating water quality have forced many (GWP 2000)
countries in the world to reconsider their devel-
opment policies with respect to the management
of their water resources. As a result water IWRM (Box 1.1) considers the use of the
resources management (WRM) has been under- resources in relation to social and economic
going a change worldwide, moving from a activities and functions. These determine the
mainly supply-oriented, engineering-biased need for laws and regulations pertaining to the
approach toward a demand-oriented, multisec- sustainable and benecial use of the water
toral approach, often labeled integrated water resources. Infrastructure together with regulatory
resources management. measures allows more effective use of the
The concept of IWRM moves away from resource including meeting ecosystem needs.
top-down water master planning that usually
focuses on water availability and development, and
toward comprehensive water policy planning 1.5.4 Water Security
that addresses the interaction between different and the Sustainable
subsectors (Fig. 1.25), seeks to establish priorities, Development Goals
considers institutional requirements, and deals with (SDGs)
the building of management capacity.
While IWRM focuses on the process to improve
water management (the how), the term water
security focuses on the output (the what). The
World Economic Forum has identied Water
Security as one of the biggest global economic
development issues. Water Security is dened by
UN-Water (2013) as
the capacity of a population to safeguard sustain-
able access to adequate quantities of acceptable
quality water for sustaining livelihoods, human
well-being, and socio-economic development, for
ensuring protection against water-borne pollution
and water-related disasters, and for preserving
ecosystems in a climate of peace and political
stability.

Attempts are being made to identify the many


dimensions of water security and to quantify
Fig. 1.25 Interactions among the natural, administrative,
them (van Beek and Arriens 2014; ADB 2016).
and socioeconomic water resource subsectors and In 2015 the UN adopted the Sustainable Devel-
between them and their environment opment Goals 20152030 that specify specic
1.5 Planning and Management Approaches 37

targets for various goals such as the provision of Engineering structures for making better use
water for drinking and sanitation, water produc- of scarce water.
tivity in agriculture, industry and energy, envi- Canals and water-lifting devices.
ronment, and reduction of floods and droughts. It Dams and storage reservoirs that can retain
is expected that many countries will expect their excess water from periods of high flow for
water managers to use the SDGs as objectives in use during the periods of low flow. By stor-
water resources planning. This means that our age of floodwater they may also reduce flood
planning and management proposals need to be damage below the reservoir.
able to quantify the impacts of possible plans and Open channels that may take the form of a
policies in terms of the SDG targets. canal, flume, tunnel, or partly lled pipe.
Pressure conduits.
Diversion structures, ditches, pipes, checks,
1.5.5 Planning and Management flow dividers, and other engineering facilities
Aspects necessary for the effective operation of irri-
gation and drainage systems.
1.5.5.1 Technical Municipal and industrial water intakes,
Technical aspects of planning include hydrologic including water purication plants and trans-
assessments. Hydrologic assessments identify mission facilities.
and characterize the properties of, and interac- Sewerage and industrial wastewater treatment
tions among, the resources in the basin or region. plants, including waste collection and ulti-
This includes the land, the rainfall, the runoff, the mate disposal facilities.
stream and river flows, and the groundwater. Hydroelectric power storage, run-of-river, or
Existing watershed land use and land cover, pumped storage plants.
and future changes in this use and cover, result in River channel regulation works, bank stabi-
part from existing and future changes in regional lization, navigation dams and barrages, navi-
population and economy. Planning involves gation locks, and other engineering facilities
predicting changes in land use/covers and eco- for improving a river for navigation.
nomic activities at watershed and river basin Levees and floodwalls for conning flows
levels. These will influence the amount of runoff, within predetermined channels.
and the concentrations of sediment and other
quality constituents (organic wastes, nutrients, Not only must the planning process identify
pesticides, etc.) in the runoff resulting from any and evaluate alternative management strategies
given pattern of rainfall over the land area. These involving structural and nonstructural measures
predictions will help planners estimate the that will incur costs and bring benets, but it
quantities and qualities of flows throughout a must also identify and evaluate alternative time
watershed or basin, associated with any land use schedules for implementing those measures. The
and water management policy. This in turn pro- planning of development over time involving
vides the basis for predicting the type and health interdependent projects, uncertain future supplies
of terrestrial and aquatic ecosystems in the basin. and demands as well as costs, benets, and in-
All of this may impact the economic develop- terest (discount) rates is part of all water
ment of the region, which is what, in part, resources planning and management processes.
determines the future demands for changes in With increasing emphasis placed on ecosystem
land use and land cover. preservation and enhancement, planning must
Technical aspects also include the estimation include ecologic impact assessments. The mix of
of the costs and benets of any measures taken to soil types and depths and land covers together with
manage the basins water resources. These mea- the hydrological quantity and quality flow and
sures might include: storage regimes in rivers, lakes, wetlands, and
38 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

aquifers all impact the riparian and aquatic ecol- Financial viability is often viewed as a con-
ogy of the basin. Water managers are being asked straint that must be satised. It is not viewed as
to consider ways of improving or restoring an objective whose maximization could result in
ecosystems by, for example, reducing the a reduction in economic efciency, equity, or
other nonmonetary objectives. In many devel-
destruction and/or loss of the biological oping countries a distinction is made between the
integrity of aquatic habitats caused by intro- recovery of investment costs and the recovery of
duced exotic species or changes in flow and O&M costs. Recovery of O&M costs is a mini-
sediment patterns due to upstream reservoir mum condition for a sustainable project. Without
operation. that, it is likely that the performance of the pro-
decline in number and extent of wetlands and ject will deteriorate over time.
the adverse impacts to wetlands of proposed Many past failures in water resources man-
land and water development projects. agement are attributable to the fact that waterits
conflicts between the needs of people for quantity, reliability, quality, pressure, location
water supply, recreational, energy, flood has been and still is viewed as a free good. Prices
control, and navigation infrastructure and the paid for irrigation and drinking water are in many
needs of ecological communities, including countries well below the full cost of the infras-
endangered species. tructure and personnel needed to provide that
water, which comprises the capital charges
And indeed there are and will continue to be involved, the operation and maintenance (O&M)
conflicts among alternative objectives and pur- costs, the opportunity cost, economic and envi-
poses of water management. Planners and man- ronmental externalities (see GWP 2000). Charg-
agers must identify the trade-offs among ing for water at less than full cost means that the
environmental, ecologic, economic, and social government, society, and/or environment subsi-
impacts, however measured, and the management dizes water use and leads to an inefcient use of
alternatives that balance these often-conflicting the resource.
interests.
1.5.5.3 Institutional and Governance
1.5.5.2 Financial and Economic The rst condition for the successful implemen-
The overriding nancial component of any plan- tation of plans and policies is to have an enabling
ning process is to make sure that the recom- environment. There must exist national, provin-
mended plans and projects will be able to pay for cial, and local policies, legislation and institu-
themselves. Revenues are needed to recover tions that make it possible for the desired
construction costs, if any, and to maintain, repair, decisions to be taken and implemented. The role
and operate any infrastructure designed to man- of the government is crucial. The reasons for
age the basins water resources. This may require governmental involvement are manifold:
cost-recovery policies that involve pricing the
outputs of projects. Recognizing water as an Water is a resource beyond property rights: it
economic good does not always mean that full cannot be owned by private persons. Water
costs should be charged. Poor people have the rights can be given to persons or companies,
right to safe water and how this is to be achieved but only the rights to use the water and not to
should be taken into account. Yet beneciaries own it. Conflicts between users automatically
should be expected to pay at least something for turn up at the table of the nal owner of the
the added benets they get. Planning must iden- resourcethe government.
tify equitable cost and risk-sharing policies and Water is a resource that often requires large
improved approaches to risk/cost management. investments to develop, treat, store, distribute,
1.5 Planning and Management Approaches 39

and use, and then to collect, treat, and dispose heavily dependent on the use of computer-based
or reuse. Examples are multipurpose reser- impact prediction models. Such models are used
voirs and the construction of dykes along to assist in the identication and evaluation of
coasts and rivers. The required investments alternative ways of meeting various planning and
are large and typically can only be made by management objectives. They provide an ef-
governments or state-owned companies. cient way of using spatial and temporal data in an
Water is a medium that can easily transfer effort to predict the interaction and impacts, over
external effects. The use of water by one space and time, of various river basin compo-
activity often has negative effects on other nents under alternative designs and operating
water using activities (externalities). The policies.
obvious example is the discharge of wastew- Many of the systems analysis approaches and
ater into a river may save the discharger models discussed in the following chapters of
money but it may have negative effects on this book have been, and continue to be, central
downstream users requiring cleaner water. to the planning and management process. Their
usefulness is directly dependent on the quality of
Only the government can address many of the data and models being used. Models can
these issues and hence good governance is assist planning and management at different
necessary for good water management. An levels of detail. Some models are used for pre-
insufcient institutional setting and the lack of a liminary screening of alternative plans and poli-
sound economic base are the main causes of cies, and as such do not require major data
water resources development project failure, not collection efforts. Screening models can also be
technical inadequacy of design and construction. used to estimate how signicant certain data and
This is also the reason why at present much assumptions are to the decisions being consid-
attention is given to institutional developments ered, and hence can help guide additional data
and governance in both developed and develop- collection activities. At the other end of the
ing regions and countries. planning and management spectrum, much more
In Europe, various types of water agencies are detailed models can be used for engineering de-
operational (e.g., the Agence de lEau in France sign. These more complex models are more data
and the water companies in England), each demanding, and typically require higher levels of
having advantages and disadvantages. The Water expertise for their proper use.
Framework Directive of the European Union The integration of modeling technology into
requires that water management be carried out at the social and political components of the plan-
the scale of a river basin, particularly when this ning and management processes in a way that
involves transboundary management. It is very enhances those processes continues to be the
likely that this will result in a shift in responsi- main challenge of those who develop planning
bilities of the institutions involved and the and management models. Efforts to build and
establishment of new institutions. In other parts apply interactive generic modeling programs or
of the world experiments are being carried out shells into which interested stakeholders can
with various types of river basin organizations, draw in their system, enter their data and op-
combining local, regional, and sometimes erating rules at the level of detail desired, simu-
national governments. late it, and discover the effect of alternative
assumptions and operating rules, has in many
1.5.5.4 Models for Impact Prediction cases helped to create a common or shared
and Evaluation understanding among these stakeholders. Getting
Planning processes have undergone a signicant stakeholders involved in developing and experi-
transformation over the past ve decades, mainly menting with their own interactive data-driven
due to the continuing development of improved models has been an effective way of building a
computational technology. Planning today is consensusa shared vision.
40 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

1.5.5.5 Models for Shared Vision new information and to respond to surprises
or Consensus Building impacts not forecasted. As we learn more about
Participatory planning involves conflict man- how river basins, estuaries, and coastal zones
agement. Each stakeholder or interest group has work, and how humans can better manage those
its objectives, interests, and agendas. Some of resources, we do not want to regret what we have
these may be in conflict. The planning and done in the past that may preclude this
management process is one of negotiation and adaptation.
compromise. This takes time but from it can In some situations, it may be desirable to
come decisions that have the best chance of create a rolling planone based on the results
being considered the right decisions by most of an optimization or simulation model of a
participants. Models can assist in this process of particular water resource system that can be
reaching a common understanding and agree- updated at any time. This permits responses to
ment among different stakeholders. This has a resource management and regulatory questions
greater chance of happening if the stakeholders when they are asked, not just at times when new
themselves are involved in the modeling process. planning and management exercises take place.
Involving stakeholders in collaborative model While this appears to be desirable, will planning
building accomplishes a number of things. It and management organizations have the nanc-
gives them a feeling of ownership. They will ing and support to maintain and update the
have a much better understanding of just what modeling software used to estimate various
their model can do and what it cannot do. If they impacts, collect and analyze new data, and
are involved in model building, they will know maintain the expertise, all of which are necessary
the assumptions built into their model. for continuous planning (rolling plans)?
Being involved in a modeling exercise is a
way to understand better the impacts of various
assumptions one must make when developing 1.6 Planning and Management
and running models. While there may be no Characteristics
agreement on the best of various assumptions to
make, stakeholders can learn which of those 1.6.1 Integrated Policies
assumptions matter and which do not. In addi- and Development Plans
tion, the involvement of stakeholders in the
process of model development will create dis- Clearly, a portion of any water resources plan-
cussions that will lead toward a better under- ning and management study report should con-
standing of everyones interests and concerns. tain a discussion of the particular site-specic
Though such model building exercises, it is just water resource management issues and options.
possible those involved will reach not only a Another part of the report might include a pri-
better understanding of everyones concerns, but oritized list of strategies for addressing existing
also a common or shared vision of at least how problems and available development or man-
their system (as represented by their model, of agement opportunities in the basin.
course) works. Recent emphasis has shifted from structural
engineering solutions to more nonstructural al-
1.5.5.6 Models for Adaptive ternatives, especially for environmental and
Management ecosystem restoration. Part of this shift reflects
Recent emphasis has shifted from structural the desire to keep more options open for future
engineering solutions to more nonstructural al- generations. It reflects the desire to be adaptive to
ternatives, especially for environmental and new information and to respond to surprises
ecosystem restoration. Part of this shift reflects impacts not forecasted. As we learn more about
the desire to keep more options open for future how river basins, estuaries, and coastal zones
generations. It reflects the desire to be adaptive to work, and how humans can better manage their
1.6 Planning and Management Characteristics 41

water resources, we do not want to be regretting compare with the costs of riparian mitigation
what we have done in the past that may preclude measures?
this adaptation. What are the economic and environmental
Consideration also needs to be given to quality trade-offs associated with different
improving the quality of the water resources areas of different classes of land use such as
planning and management review process and commercial/urban, residential, agriculture,
focusing on outcomes themselves rather than and forest?
output measures. One of the outcomes should be Can adverse effects on hydrology, aquatic
an increased understanding of some of the rela- ecology, and water quality of urban areas be
tionships between various human activities and better mitigated with upstream or downstream
the hydrology and ecology of the basin, estuary, management approaches? Can land controls
or coastal zone. Models developed for predicting like stream buffers be used at reasonable cost
the economic as well as ecologic interactions and within urban areas, and if so, how effective
impacts due to changes in land and water man- are they?
agement and use could be used to address Is there a threshold size for residential/
questions such as: commercial areas that yield marked ecologi-
cal effects?
What are the hydrologic, ecologic, and eco- What are the ecological states at the land-
nomic consequences of clustering or dis- scape scale that once attained become irre-
persing human land uses such as urban and versible with reasonable mitigation measures?
commercial developments and large residen- For example, once stream segments in an
tial areas? Similarly, what are the conse- urban setting become highly altered by direct
quences of concentrated versus dispersed and indirect effects (e.g., channel bank pro-
patterns of reserve lands, stream buffers, and tection and straightening and urban runoff),
forestland? can they be restored with feasible changes in
What are the costs and ecological benets of a urban land use or mitigation measures?
conservation strategy based on near-stream Mitigating flood risk by minimizing flood-
measures (e.g., riparian buffers) versus plain developments coincides with conserva-
near-source (e.g., upland/site edge) measures? tion of aquatic life in streams. What are
What is the relative cost of forgone upland the economic costs of this type of risk
development versus forgone valley or riparian avoidance?
development? Do costs strongly limit the use What are the economic limitations and eco-
of stream buffer zones as mitigating for logic benets of having light residential zones
agriculture, residential, and urban between waterways and commercial, urban,
developments? or agriculture lands?
Should large intensive developments be best What are the economic development deci-
located in upland or valley areas? Does the sions that are irreversible on the landscape?
answer differ depending on economic, envi- For example, once land is used for commer-
ronmental, or aquatic ecosystem perspec- cial development, it is normally too costly to
tives? From the same perspectives, is the return it to agricultural land. This would
most efcient and desirable landscape highly identify limits on planning and management
fragmented or highly zoned with centers of for conservation and development.
economic activity? What are the associated ecological and eco-
To what extent can riparian conservation and nomic impacts of the trend in residential,
enhancement mitigate upland human land use commercial and forests lands replacing agri-
effects? How do the costs of upland controls cultural lands?
42 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

The answers to these and similar questions increasingly related to broader societal structures,
may well differ in different regions. However, if demands, and goals.
we can address them on a regional scale, i.e., in What would future generations like us to do
multiple river basins, we just might begin to for them? We do not know, but we can guess. As
understand and predict better the interactions uncertain as these guesses will be, we should
among economy, environment ecology, and take them into account as we act to satisfy our
people as a function of how we manage and use own immediate needs, demands, and desires.
its land and water. This in turn may help us better There may be trade-offs between what we wish
manage and use our land and water resources for to do for ourselves in our current generation
the betterment of allnow and on into the future. versus what we think future generations might
wish us to do for them. These trade-offs, if any,
between what present and future generations
1.6.2 Sustainability would like should be considered. Once identied,
or at least estimated, just what decisions to make
Sustainable water resource systems are those should be debated and decided in the political
designed and managed to best serve people living arena. There is no scientic theory to help us
in the future as well as those of us living today. identify which trade-offs, if any, are optimal.
The actions that we as a society take now to The inclusion of sustainability criteria along
satisfy our own needs and desires should not with the more common economic, environmen-
only depend on what those actions will do for us tal, ecological, and social criteria used to evaluate
but also on how they will affect our descendants. alternative water resources development and
This consideration of the long-term impacts on management strategies may identify a need to
future generations of actions taken now is the change how we commonly develop and use our
essence of sustainable development. While the water resources. We need to consider the impacts
word sustainability can mean different things of change itself. Change over time is certain; just
to different people, it always includes a consid- what it will be is uncertain. These changes will
eration of the welfare of those living in the impact the physical, biological, and social
future. While the debate over a more precise dimensions of water resource systems. An
denition of sustainability will continue, and essential aspect in the planning, design and
questions over just what it is that should be management of sustainable systems is the antic-
sustained may remain unanswered, this should ipation of change. This includes change due to
not delay progress toward achieving water geomorphologic processes, to aging of infras-
resource systems that we judge best serves those tructure, to shifts in demands or desires of a
of us living today as well as our children and changing society, and even due to increased
their children living in the future. variability of water supplies, possibly because of
The concept of environmental and ecological a changing climate. Change is an essential fea-
sustainability has largely resulted from a growing ture of sustainable water resources development
concern about the long-run health of our planet. and management.
There is increasing evidence that our present Sustainable water resource systems are those
resource use and management activities and designed and operated in ways that make them
actions, even at local levels, can signicantly more adaptive, robust, and resilient to an uncer-
affect the welfare of those living within much tain and changing future. Sustainable water
larger regions in the future. Water resource resource systems must be capable of effectively
management problems at a river basin level are functioning under conditions of changing sup-
rarely purely technical and of interest only to plies, management objectives, and demands.
those living within the individual river basins Sustainable systems, like any others, may fail,
where those problems exist. They are but when they fail they must be capable of
1.6 Planning and Management Characteristics 43

recovering and operating properly without undue life cycles within river basins, estuaries, and
costs. coastal zones. Throughout the water resource
In the face of certain changes, but with system planning and management process, it is
uncertain impacts, an evolving and adaptive important to identify all the benecial and adverse
strategy for water resources development, man- ecological, economic, environmental, and social
agement, and use is a necessary condition of effectsespecially the long-term effectsasso-
sustainable development. Conversely, inflexibil- ciated with any proposed planning and manage-
ity in the face of new information and new ob- ment project.
jectives and new social and political
environments is an indication of reduced system
sustainability. Adaptive management is a process 1.7 Meeting the Planning
of adjusting management actions and directions, and Management
as appropriate, in light of new information on the ChallengesA Summary
current and likely future condition of our total
environment and on our progress toward meeting Planning (the formulation of development and
our goals and objectives. Water resources management plans and policies) is an important
development and management decisions can be and often indispensable means to support and
viewed as experiments, subject to modication improve operational management. Planning pro-
but with goals clearly in mind. Adaptive man- vides an opportunity to:
agement recognizes the limitations of current
knowledge and experience and that we learn by assess the current state of the water resources
experimenting. It helps us move toward meeting and the conflicts and priorities over their use,
our changing goals over time in the face of this formulate visions, set goals and targets, and
incomplete knowledge and uncertainty. It accepts thus orient operational management,
the fact that there is a continual need to review provide a framework for organizing policy
and revise management approaches because of relevant research and public participation,
the changing as well as uncertain nature of our increase the legitimacy, public acceptance of,
socioeconomic and natural environments. or even support for how the resources are to
Changing the social and institutional compo- be allocated or controlled, especially in times
nents of water resource systems are often the of stress, and
most challenging because they involve changing facilitate the interaction, discussion, and
the way individuals think and act. Any process coordination among managers and stake-
involving change will require that we change our holders, and generate a common point of
institutionsthe rules under which we as a referencea management plan or policy.
society function. Individuals are primarily
responsible for, and adaptive to, changing polit- Many of the concerns and issues being
ical and social situations. Sustainability requires addressed by water resources planners and
that public and private institutions also change managers today are similar to those faced by
over time in ways that are responsive to the needs planners and managers in the past. But some are
of individuals and society. different. Most of the new ones are the result of
Given the uncertainty of what future genera- two trends: (1) a growing concern for the sus-
tions will want, and the economic, environmental, tainability of natural ecosystems and (2) an
and ecological problems they will face, a guiding increased recognition for the need of the
principle for the achievement of sustainable water bottom-up grassroots participatory approach to
resource systems is to provide options that allow planning, managing, and decision-making.
future generations to alter such systems. One of Today planners work for economic develop-
the best ways to do this is to interfere as little as ment and prosperity as they did in the past,
possible with the proper functioning of natural keeping in mind environmental impacts and
44 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

goals as they have done in the past, but now often it is not clear what should be done. Pro-
recognizing ecological impacts and values as fessionals administering the science, often from
well. Water resources management may still be public agencies, nongovernmental organizations,
focused on controlling and mitigating the adverse or even from universities, are merely among all
impacts of floods and droughts and water pollu- the stakeholders having an interest in and con-
tion, on producing hydropower, on developing tributing to the management of water.
irrigation, on controlling erosion and sediment, Each governmental agency, consulting rm,
and on promoting navigation, but only as these environmental interest group, and citizen typi-
and similar activities are compatible with healthy cally has its own limitations, authorities, exper-
ecosystems. Natural ecosystems generally benet tise and conflicts with other people, agencies and
from the variability of natural hydrologic organizations, all tending to detract from
regimes. Other users prefer less variability. Much achieving a fully integrated approach to water
of our engineering infrastructure is operated so as resources planning and management. But just
to reduce hydrologic variability. Today water because of this, the participation and contribu-
resource systems are increasing, required to tions of all these stakeholders are needed. They
provide rather than reduce hydrologic (and must come together in a partnership if indeed an
accompanying sediment load) variability. integrated approach to water resources planning
Reservoir operators, for example, can modify and management is to be achieved and sustained.
their water release policies to increase this vari- All views must be heard, considered, and acted
ability. Farmers and land use developers must upon by all involved in the water resources
minimize rather than encourage land-disturbing planning and management process.
activities. Floodplains may need to get wet Water resources planning and management is
occasionally. Rivers and streams may need to not simply the application and implementation of
meander and sh species requiring habitats along science. It is creating a social environment that
the full length of rivers to complete their life gets all of us who should be involved, from the
cycles must have access to those habitats. Clearly beginning, in a continuing planning process. This
these ecological objectives, added to all the other process is one of
economic and environmental ones, can only
compound the conflicts and issues with respect to educating ourselves about how our systems
land and water management and use. work and function,
So, how can we manage all this conflict and identifying existing or potential options and
uncertainty? We know that water resources opportunities for enhancement and resource
planning and management should be founded on development and use,
sound science, efcient public program adminis- resolving the inevitable problems and con-
tration, and broad participation of stakeholders. flicts that will result over who gets what and
Yet obtaining each of these three conditions is a when and who pays who for what and when,
difcult challenge. While the natural and social making and implementing decisions, and
sciences can help us predict the economic, envi- nally of
ronmental, and ecological impacts of alternative monitoring the impacts of those decisions.
decisions, those predictions are never certain. In
addition, these sciences offer no help in deter- This process is repeated as surprises or new
mining the best decision to make in the face of opportunities or new knowledge dictates.
multiple conflicting goals held by multiple Successful water resources planning and
stakeholdersgoals that have changed, and no management requires the active participation of
doubt will continue to change. Water resources all community institutions involved in economic
planning and management and decision-making development and resource management. How
are not as easy as we professionals can tell you can this begin at the local stakeholder level? How
what to do. All you need is the will to do it. Very does anyone get others interested in preventing
1.7 Meeting the Planning and Management ChallengesA Summary 45

problems before those problems are apparent, or objectivity on the part of planners, and inadequate
especially before unacceptable solutions are funding. These deciencies need addressing if
offered to deal with them? And how do you deal integrated holistic planning and management is to
with the inevitable group or groups of stake- be more than just something to write about.
holders who see it in their best interest not to Effective water resources planning and man-
participate in the planning process, but to just agement is a challenge today, and will be an
criticize it from the outside? Who is in a position increasing challenge into the foreseeable future.
at the local level to provide that leadership and This book introduces some of the tools that are
needed nancial support? In some regions, non- being used to meet these challenges. We consider
governmental institutions have been instrumental it only a rst step toward becoming an accom-
in initiating and coordinating this process at local plished planner or manager.
grassroot levels.
Water resources planning and management
processes should identify a vision that guides
development and operational activities in the References
affected region. Planning and management pro-
cesses should ADB (Asia Development Bank). (2016). Asian Water
Development Outlook, Strengthening Water Security
in Asia and the Pacic. Mandaluyong City,
recognize and address the goals and expec- Philippines.
tations of the regions stakeholders, ASCE (American Society of Civil Engineers). (1998).
identify and respond to the regions Sustainability criteria for water resource systems.
Reston, VA: ASCE.
water-related problems, Gulbenkian Think Tank (GTT). (2014). Water and the
function effectively within the regions future of humanity. Revaluating Water Security,
legal/institutional frameworks, Calouste Gulbenkian Foundation, New York:
accommodate both short- and long-term issues, Springer. ISBN: 978-3-319-01456-2. doi:10.1007/
978-3-319-01457-9_1
generate a diverse menu of alternatives, GWP (Global Water Partnership). (2000). Integrated
integrate the biotic and abiotic parts of the water resources management. TAC Background
basin, Papers No. 4. Stockholm, Sweden: GWP.
take into account the allocation of water for IPPC. (2007). Report of the intergovernmental panel on
climate change, May.
all needs, including those of natural systems, NRC (National Research Council). (2001). Compensating
be stakeholder-driven, for wetland losses under the clean water act. Com-
take a global perspective, mittee on Mitigating Wetland Losses, Board on
be flexible and adaptable, Environmental Studies and Toxicology, Water
Science and Technology Board.
drive regulatory processes, not be driven by them, Orr, S., Pittock, J., Chapagain, A., & Dumaresq, D.
be the basis for policy making, (2012). Dams on the Mekong River: Lost sh protein
foster coordination among planning partners and the implications for land and water resources,
and consistency among related plans, Global Environmental Change, 22, 925932.
UN-Water. (2013). UN-water analytical brief on water
be accommodating of multiple objectives, security and the global water agenda.
be a synthesizer, recognize and deal with van Beek, E., & Arriens, W. L. (2014). Water security,
conflicts, and putting the concept into practise. TEC Background
produce recommendations that can be Paper No. 20. Stockholm: GWP.
Winemiller, K. O., McIntyre, P. B. , Castello, L.,
implemented. Fluet-Chouinard, E., Giarrizzo, T., Nam, S., et al.
(2016). Balancing hydropower and biodiversity in
All too often integrated planning processes are the Amazon, Congo, and Mekong Basin-scale
hampered by the separation of planning, manage- planning is needed to minimize impacts in
mega-diverse rivers. In Insights perspectives (Vol.
ment and implementing authorities, turf-protection 351 Issue 6269 p. 129). AAAS Science. science-
attitudes, shortsighted focusing of efforts, lack of mag.org. January 8, 2016.
46 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

Additional References Gershon, M., & Duckstein, L. (1983). Multiobjective


approaches to river basin planning. Journal-Water-
(Further Reading) Resources-Planning-Management-Division, American
Society of Civil Engineers USA), 109(1), 1328.
Abdullah, A., Masih, I.,Van Der Zaag, P., Karim, U. F.A., Gleick, P. H. (2002). Soft water paths. Nature, 418, 373.
Popescu, I., Suhail, Q. A. (2015). Shatt al Arab River Gleick, P. H. (2003). Water use. Annual Review of
system under escalating pressure: A preliminary explo- Environment and Resources, 28, 275314.
ration of the issues and options for mitigation. International Gleick, P. H., & Palaniappan, M. (2010). Peak water:
Journal of River Basin Management, 13(2), 215227. Conceptual and practical limits to freshwater with-
Abu-Zeid, M. A., & Biswas, A. K. (Eds.). (1996). River drawal and use. Proceedings of the National Academy
basin planning and management. Calcutta: Oxford of Sciences of the United States of America, 107(25),
University Press. 1115511162.
American Society of Civil Engineers (ASCE). (1998). Global Water Partnership (GWP). (2000). Water as a
Sustainability criteria for water resource systems. social and economic good: How to put the principle
Reston, VA: ASCE Press. into practice. TAC Background Papers No. 2. Stock-
American Society of Civil Engineers (ASCE). (2011). holm, Sweden: GWP.
Toward a sustainable water future: Visions for 2050. Global Water Partnership (GWP). (2000). Effective water
Reston, VA, USA: ASCE Press. governance. TAC Background Papers No. 7. Stock-
Barrow, C. J. (1998). River basin development planning and holm, Sweden: GWP.
management: A critical review. World-Development, Global Water Partnership (GWP). (2012). The handbook
Oxford, United Kingdom, 26(1), 171186. for integrated water resources management in trans-
Bateman, B., & Rancier, R. (Eds.). (2012). Case studies in boundary basins of rivers, lakes and aquifers
integrated water resources management: From local (120 pp). International Ofce for Water (Permanent
stewardship to national vision. American Water Technical Secretariat of the International Network of
Resources Association Policy Committee, 4 West Basin Organizations). ISBN: 978-91-85321-85-8.
Federal Street, P.O. Box 1626, Middleburg, Virginia Goulter, I. C. (1985). Equity issues in the implementation
20118-1626, 60 pp. of river basin planning. Strategies for river basin
Bates, B. C., Kundzewicz, Z. W., Wu, S., & Palutikof, management: Environmental integration of land and
J. P. (2008). Climate change and water. IPCC water in a river basin (pp. 287292, 15 refs.).
Technical Paper VI. Geneva, Switzerland: Intergov- Dordrecht, Holland: D. Reidel Publishing Co.
ernmental Panel on Climate Change. Gulbenkian Think Tank. (2014). Water and the future of
Biswas, A. K. (Ed.). (1997). Water resources: Environ- humanity. Revisiting water security (241 pp). New
mental planning, management, and development York: Springer. doi:10.1007/978-3-319-01457-9
(738 pp). New York, NY: McGraw-Hill. Haasnoot, M., Kwakkel, J. H., Walker, W. E., & ter Maat,
Cai, X., Vogel, R., & Ranjithan, R. (Eds.). (2013). Role of J. (2013). Dynamic adaptive policy pathways: A
systems analysis in watershed management. Journal of method for crafting robust decisions for a deeply
Water Resources Planning and Management, 139(5), uncertain world. Global Environmental Change, 23,
461592. 485498.
Chartres, C., & Varma, S. (2010). Out of water: From Habersack, H., Haspel, D., & Campbell, I. (Eds.). (2013).
abundance to scarcity and how to solve the worlds Integrated management of large river systems. Inter-
water problems. Upper Saddle River, NJ, USA: national Journal of River Basin Management, 11(2),
Pearson Education Inc. 137236.
Cooper, A. B., & Bottcher, A. B. (1993). Basin-scale Hoekstra, A. Y., & Chapagain, A. K. (2008). Globaliza-
modeling as a tool for water-resource planning. Journal tion of water. Sharing the planets freshwater
of Water Resources Planning and Management resources. Oxford, UK: Blackwell Publishing.
(ASCE), 119(3), 306323. May/June 6 g, 4 tab, 41 ref. Hoekstra, A. Y., & Mekonnem, M. M. (2012). The water
Priscoli, J. D. (2004). What is public participation in water footprint of humanity. Proceedings of the National
resources management and why is it important? Water Academy of Sciences, Washington DC, 109(9),
International, 29(2). 32323237.
Diamantini, C., & Zanon, B. (1996). River basin planning Howe, C. W. (1996). Water resources planning in a
in Italy: Resource and risk management. European- federation of states: Equity versus efciency. Natural
Environment (United Kingdom), 6(4), 119125. Resources Journal, 36(1), 2936.
Eckstein, O. (1958). Water resource development: The Huaicheng, Guo, & Beanlands, G. (1994). A comparative
economics of project evaluation. Cambridge, MA: study on Canadian and Chinese river basin planning.
Harvard University Press. Journal of Environmental Science China, 6(2), 224233.
Frederick, K. D., Major, D. C., & Stakhiv, E. Z. (1997). IPCC (Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change).
Water resources planning principles and evaluation (2001). Climate change 2001: Synthesis report, sum-
criteria for climate change: Summary and conclusions. mary for policymakers. Third Assessment Report,
Climate Change, 37(1), 291313. IPCC.
References 47

IPCC (Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change). Board on Environmental Studies and Toxicology,
(2007). Climate change 2007: The physical science Water Science and Technology Board.
basis. Fourth Assessment Report, IPCC. Nijhuis, M. (2015). Harnessing the Mekong, or killing it?
IWMI (International Water Management Institute). (2007). National Geographic, Journal of National Geo-
Water for food, water for life. A comprehensive graphic Society, 227(5), 102129.
assessment of water management in agriculture. Lon- ORiordan, J. (1981). New strategies for water resource
don, UK: Earthscan, and Colombo, Sri Lanka: IWMI. planning in British Columbia. Canadian Water
Karamouz, M., Szidarovszky, F., & Banafsheh, Z. (2003). Resources Journal, 6(4), 1343. 6 Figs, 5 Tabs.
Water resources systems analysis. Boca Raton, FL: Razavian, D.,Bleed, A. S., Supalla, R. J., & Gollehon, N.
Lewis. R. (1990). Multistage screening process for river basin
Kulshreshtha, S. (1998). A global outlook for water planning. Journal of Water Resources Planning and
resources to the year 2025. Water Resources Man- Management (ASCE), 116(3), 323334. May/June 3
agement, 12(3), 167184. g, 1 tab, 19 refs, 3 append.
Krutilla, J. V., & Eckstein, O. (1958). Multiple purpose Reitsma, R. F., & Carron, J. C. (1997). Object-oriented
river development. Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins simulation and evaluation of river basin operations.
Press. Journal of Geographic Information and Decision
Lee, D. J., & Dinar, A. (1996). Integrated models of river Analysis, 1(1), 924.
basin planning, development, and management. Water Reynolds, P. J. (1985). Ecosystem approaches to river
International, 21(4), 213222. Also see: (1995). basin planning strategies for river basin management:
Review of integrated approaches to river basin Environmental integration of land and water in a river
planning, development and management. World basin (pp. 4148, 1 g, 18 refs). Dordrecht, Holland:
Bank, Agriculture and Natural Resources Department, D. Reidel Publishing Co.
Washington, DC. Sadoff, C. W., Hall, J. W., Grey, D., Aerts, J. C. J. H.,
Lins, H. F., Wolock, D. M., & McCabe, G. J. (1997). Ait-Kadi, M., Brown, C., et al. (2015). Securing
Scale and modeling issues in water resources plan- water, sustaining growth: Report of the GWP/OECD
ning. Climate Change, 37(1), 6388. task force on water security and sustainable growth
Loucks, D. P., Stedinger, J.R., & Haith, D.A. (1981). (180 pp). UK: University of Oxford.
Water resources systems planning and analysis Saha, S. K., & Barrow, C. J. (Eds.). (1981). River basin
(559 pp). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall. planning: Theory and practice (357 pp). Chichester,
Loucks, D. P., & da Costa, J. R. (Eds.). (1991). Decision UK: Wiley Interscience.
support systems: Water resources planning and Savenije, H. H. G., & van der Zaag, P. (Eds.). (1998). The
research. Berlin: Springer. management of shared river basins (164 pp). The
Loucks, D. P. (Ed.). (1998). Restoration of degraded Hague, NL: Ministry of Foreign Affairs, Neda.
rivers: Challenges, issues and experiences (484 pp). Schramm, G. (1980). Integrated river basin planning in a
Dordrecht, NL: Kluwer Academic Publishers. holistic universe. Natural Resources Journal, 20(4),
Maidment, D. R. (Ed.). (1993). Handbook of hydrology. 787806. 2 Fig, 1 tab, 48 refs.
New York, NY: McGraw-Hill. Smith, S. C., & Castle, E. N. (Eds.). (1964). Economics
Maass, A., et al. (1962). Design of water resource and public policy in water resources development.
systems. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. Ames, Iowa: Iowa University Press.
Major, D. C., & Lenton, R. L. (Eds.). (1979). Applied Somlyody, L. (1997). Use of optimization models in river
water resource systems planning (248 pp). Engle- basin water quality planning. In M. B. Beck &
wood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall, Inc. P. Lessard (Eds.), WATERMATEX 97. Systems anal-
Mays, L. W. (Ed.). (1996). Water Resources Handbook. ysis and computing in water quality management.
NY, NY: McGraw-Hill. Towards a new agenda (391 pp).
McMillan, T. (1990). Water resource planning in Canada. Stout, G.E. (1998). Sustainable development requires the
Journal of Soil and Water Conservation, 45 full cooperation of water users. Water International,
(6),614616. 23(1), 37.
Mimikou, M. A., Baltas, E. A., & Tsihrintzis, V. A. Thanh, N. C., & Biswas, A. K. (Eds.). (1990).
(2016). Hydrology and water resource systems anal- Environmentally-sound water management (276 pp).
ysis (456 pp). CRC Press. Delhi: Oxford University Press.
Mitchell, B. (1983). Comprehensive river basin planning Thiessen, E. M., Loucks, D. P., & Stedinger, J. R. (1998).
in Canada: Problems and opportunities. Water Inter- Computer-assisted negotiations of water resources
national, 8(4), 146153. conflicts. Group Decision and Negotiation, 7(2).
MRC (Mekong River Commission) Secretariat. (2009). Thissen, W. A. H., & Walker, W. E. (Eds.). (2013).
Inception report: MRC SEA for hydropower on the Public policy analysis: New developments (286 pp).
Mekong mainstream. Phnom Penh, Cambodia: MRC New York, Heidelberg, Dordrecht, London: Springer.
and International Center for Environmental ISBN: 978-1-4614-4601-9; ISBN: 978-1-4614-4602-6
Management. (eBook). doi:10.1007/978-1-4614-4602-6
National Research Council (NRC). (2001). Compensating Tolley, G. S., & Riggs, F. E. (Eds.). (1961). Economics of
for Wetland Losses Under the Clean Water Act watershed planning. Ames, Iowa: Iowa State Univer-
(348 pp). Committee on Mitigating Wetland Losses, sity Press.
48 1 Water Resources Planning and Management: An Overview

UN WWAP (United Nations World Water Assessment Wood, A. W., Lettenmaier, D. P., & Palmer, R. N. (1997).
Programme). (2009). The United Nations World Water Assessing climate change implications for water
Development Report 3: Water in a changing world. resources planning. Climate Change, 37(1), 203228.
Paris, France: UNESCO and London, UK: Earthscan. Wright, W. C., Cohen, R., & Heath, J. H. (1982).
UN WWAP (United Nations World Water Assessment Decentralizing water resource planning and manage-
Programme). (2011). World water scenarios to 2050, ment. Journal of the American Water Works Associ-
exploring alternative futures of the worlds water and ation, 74(7), 6, 334345. July, 5 Fig, 2 Tab, 37 Ref.
its use to 2050. Paris, France: UNESCO. WWAP, (United Nations World Water Assessment
UN WWAP (United Nations World Water Assessment Programme). (2012). World water development report
Programme). (2012). The United Nations World Water 4, 2012. Managing water under uncertainty and risk
Development Report 4: Managing water under risk (867 pp). Paris: UNESCO.
and uncertainty. Paris, France: UNESCO. WWAP (United Nations World Water Assessment Pro-
UNDP (United Nations Development Programme). gramme). (2015). World water development report
(2011). Human Development Report. In Sustainability 2015. Water for a sustainable world (224 pp; Case
and equity: A better future for all. New York, NY, studies, 61 pp). Paris: UNESCO.
USA: UNDP. WWAP (United Nations World Water Assessment Pro-
UNEP (United Nations Environment Programme). gramme). (2014). The United Nations world water
(2002). Global environmental outlook 3: Past, present development report 2014: Water and energy (133 pp).
and future perspectives. London, UK: Earthscan and Paris: UNESCO.
Nairobi, Kenya: UNEP. Xie, J., Liebenthal, A., Warford, J. J., et al. (2009).
UNEP (United Nations Environment Programme). (2006). Addressing Chinas water scarcity: Recommendations
Marine and coastal ecosystems and human well-being: A for selected water resource management issues.
synthesis report based on the ndings of the millennium Washington, DC, USA: World Bank.
ecosystem assessment. Nairobi, Kenya: UNEP. Zhang, R., Zhou, J., Zhang, H., Liao, X., & Wang, X.
UNEP (United Nations Environment Programme). (2014). Optimal operation of large-scale cascaded
(2009). Towards sustainable production and sustain- hydropower systems in the Upper Reaches of the
able use of resources: Assessing biofuels. France: Yangtze River, China. Journal of Water Resources
UNEP, produced by the International Panel for Planning and Management, 140(4), 480495.
Sustainable Resource Management, Division of Tech-
nology Industry and Economics, France.
Viessman, W. (1996). Integrated water management.
Water Resources Update, (106), 212). Exercises
Viessman, W. (1998). Water policies for the future. Water
Resources Update, (111), 47, 104110.
1:1 How would you dene Integrated Water
Vrsmarty, C. J., Green, P., Salisbury, J., & Lammers,
R. B. (2000). Global water resources: Vulnerability Resources Management and what distin-
from climate change and population growth. Science, guishes it from Sustainable Water
289(5477), 284288. Resources Management?
Vrsmarty, C. J., McIntyre, P. B., Gessner, M. O.,
1:2 Can you identify some common water
Dudgeon, D., Prusevich, A., Green, P., et al. (2010).
Global threats to human water security and river management issues that are found in many
biodiversity. Nature, 467, 555561. parts of the world?
Walker, W. E., Haasnoot, M., & Kwakkel, J. H. (2013). 1:3 Comment on the common practice of gov-
Adapt or perish: A review of planning approaches for
ernments giving aid to those in drought or
adaptation under deep uncertainty. Sustainability, 5,
955979. flood areas without any incentives to alter
Watkins, D. W. Jr. (Ed.). (2013). Water resources systems land use management practices in anticipa-
analysis through case studies: Data and models for tion of the next drought or flood.
decision making (168 pp). Reston, VA: ASCE Press.
1:4 What tools and information are available for
WCD. (2000). Dams and developmentsA new frame-
work for decision-making: The report of the World developing integrated water resources plans
Commission on Dams. UK: Earthscan. and management policies?
White, G. F. et al. (1999). Water for the future: The West 1:5 What structural and nonstructural measures
Bank and Gaza Strip, Israel, and Jordan. Water
Science and Technology Board and the Board on
can be taken to address water resources
Environmental Studies and Toxicology, National issues?
Research Council, National Academy Press, Wash- 1:6 Find the following statistics:
ington, DC. Percent of all freshwater resources
Wong, E. (2013). Pollution rising, Chinese fear for soil
and food. NY Times. December 31, 2013.
worldwide available for drinking;
Exercises 49

Number of people who die each year provide additional economic, environmen-
from diseases associated with unsafe tal, or social benets.
drinking water; 1:9. Describe some water resource systems con-
Percent of total freshwater resources in sisting of various interdependent natural,
polar regions; physical, and social components. What are
Per capita annual withdrawal of cubic the inputs to the systems and what are their
meters of freshwater in various countries; outputs? How did you decide what to include
Average world per capita annual with- in the system and what not to include?
drawal of cubic meters of freshwater; 1:10. Sustainability is a concept applied to
Tons of pollutants entering lakes and renewable resource management. In your
rivers daily in various regions; words dene what that means and how it
Average number of gallons of water can be used in a changing and uncertain
consumed by humans in a lifetime; environment both with respect to water
Average number of kilometers per day a supplies and demands. Over what space and
woman in a developing country must timescales is it applicable, and how can one
walk to fetch fresh water. decide whether or not some plan or man-
1:7 Identify and briefly describe the six greatest agement policy will be sustainable? How
rivers in the world. does this concept relate to the adaptive
1:8. Identify some of the major water resource management concept?
management issues in the region where you 1:11. Identify and discuss briefly some of the
live. What management alternatives might major issues and challenges facing water
effectively reduce some of the problems or managers today.

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
Water Resource Systems Modeling:
Its Role in Planning and Management 2

Planning, designing, and managing water systems have improved our understanding of
resource systems today inevitably involve impact such systems, and hence have often contributed to
prediction. Impact prediction can be aided by the improved system design, management, and
use of models. While acknowledging the operation. They have also taught us how limited
increasingly important role of modeling in water our modeling skills remain.
resource planning and management, we also When design and management decisions are
acknowledge the inherent limitation of models as made, they are based on what the decision-
representations of any real system. Model struc- makers assume will take place as a result of their
ture, input data, objectives, and other assumptions decisions. These predictions are based on quali-
related to how the real system functions or will tative information and beliefs in peoples heads,
behave under alternative infrastructure designs as illustrated in Fig. 2.1, possibly informed by
and management policies or practices may be quantitative information provided by mathemat-
controversial or uncertain. Future events are ical or computer-based models as illustrated in
always unknown and of course any assumptions Fig. 2.2. Computer-based modeling is used to
about them may affect model outputs, i.e., their enhance mental models. These quantitative
predictions. As useful as they may be, the results mathematical models are often considered
of any quantitative analysis are always only a part essential for carrying out environmental impact
of the information that should be considered by assessments. Mathematical simulation and opti-
those involved in the overall planning and man- mization models packaged within interactive
agement decision-making process. computer programs provide a common way for
planners and managers to predict the behavior of
any proposed water resources system design or
2.1 Introduction management policy before it is implemented.
Water resource systems are typically far more
Modeling provides a way, perhaps the principal complex than what analysts can model and
way, of predicting the behavior or performance of simulate. The reason is not primarily due to
proposed system infrastructure designs or man- computational limitations but rather it is because
agement policies. The past 50 years have wit- we do not understand sufciently the multiple
nessed major advances in our abilities to model interdependent physical, biochemical, ecological,
the engineering, economic, ecologic, hydrologic, social, legal, and political (human) processes that
and sometimes even the institutional or political govern the behavior of such water resource sys-
aspects of large complex multipurpose water tems. People and their institutions impact the
resource systems. Applications of models to real performance of such systems, and the

The Author(s) 2017 51


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_2
52 2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role in Planning

Fig. 2.1 Using mental models for prediction

performance of these systems impacts people. model, and what features are not, will depend in
System performance is affected by uncertainties part on what the modeler thinks is important with
in things we can measure and processes we can respect to the issues being discussed or the
predict. They are also affected by the unpre- questions being asked. How well this is done will
dictable actions of individuals and institutions as depend on the skill of the modeler, the time and
they manage and use water in response to a money available, and, perhaps most importantly,
multitude of impacts they experience in their the modelers understanding of the real system
physical and social environment. Some of these and decision-making process.
impacts are water related. Others have nothing Developing models is an art. It requires
directly to do with water. knowledge of the system being modeled, the
The development and application of models, clients objectives, goals, and information needs,
i.e., the art, science, and practice of modeling, as and some analytical and programming skills.
will be discussed in the following chapters, Models are always based on numerous assump-
should be preceded by a recognition of what can tions or approximations, and some of these may
and cannot be achieved from the use of models. be at issue. Applying these approximations of
Models of real-world systems are always sim- reality in ways that improve understandings and
plied representations of those systems. What eventually lead to a good decision clearly
features of the actual system are represented in a requires not only modeling skills but also the
2.1 Introduction 53

ability to communicate and effectively work with poorly, professional practitioners and researchers
stakeholders and decision-makers. have done over the past ve decades or more in
Models produce information. They do not applying various modeling approaches or tools to
make decisions or replace those individuals that real problems with real clients (also see, for
do. But they can inform them. Water resource example, Austin 1986; Brown et al. 2015; Cai
planners and managers must accept the fact that et al. 2013; Castelletti and Soncini-Sessa 2007;
decisions may not be influenced by the results of Gass 1990; Kindler 1987, 1988; Loucks et al.
their planning and management models. If model 1985; Reynolds 1987; Rogers and Fiering 1986;
results are not available when needed, they are Russell and Baumann 2009; Watkins 2013).
likely to be ignored when they become available. In attempting to understand how modeling
If model results do not support the preferences of can better support planners and managers, it may
decision-makers, they may also not be consid- be useful to examine just what planners and
ered. To know, for example, that cloud seeding managers of complex water resource systems do.
may, on average, reduce the strength of hurri- What planners or managers do governs to some
canes over a large region does not mean that such extent what they need to know. And what they
cloud-seeding activities will or should be need to know governs to a large extent what
undertaken. And it is unlikely everyone, even modelers or analysts should be trying to provide.
so-called experts, will agree on any recom- In this book the terms analysts or modelers,
mended course of action. Managers or operators planners, and managers can be the same person
may know that not everyone may benet from or group of individuals. These terms are used to
what they would like to do, and those who lose distinguish the activities of individuals, not nec-
will likely scream louder than those who gain. essarily the individuals themselves.
In addition, decision-makers may feel safer in First, we offer some general thoughts on the
inaction than action (Shapiro 1990; Simon 1998). major challenges facing water resource systems
There is a strong feeling in many cultures and planners and managers, the information they
legal systems that fail to act (nonfeasance) is need to meet these challenges, and the role ana-
considered more acceptable than acts that fail lysts have in helping to provide this information.
(misfeasance or malfeasance). We all feel greater Next, we review some criteria for evaluating the
responsibility for what we do than for what we success of any modeling activity designed to help
do not do. Yet our aversion to risks of failure planners or managers solve real problems.
should not deter us from addressing sensitive Finally, we argue why we think the practice of
planning or policy issues in our models. modeling is in a continual state of transition, and
Modeling efforts should be driven by the need for how current research and development in mod-
information and improved understanding. It is eling as well as improvements in computing
that improved understanding (not improved technology are affecting that transition.
models per se) that may eventually lead to
improved system design, management, and/or
operation. Models used to aid water resource 2.2 Modeling Water Resource
planners and managers are not intended to be, Systems
and rarely are (if ever), a replacement of their
judgment. This we have learned, if nothing else, As will be discussed in greater detail in the fol-
in our over 50 years of modeling experience. lowing chapters of this book, there are many
This brief chapter serves to introduce this art of types of models and modeling approaches that
modeling and its applications. The emphasis have been developed and used to identify, study,
throughout this book is on application. This and evaluate alternative water resource designs,
chapter is about modeling in practice more than in management plans, and operating policies. But
theory. It is based on the considerable experience before outlining these model types and modeling
and literature pertaining to how well, or how approaches and how they can be used to best
54 2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role in Planning

Fig. 2.2 Using


computer-based
mathematical models for
prediction

meet the needs of planners and managers, it may stocks is to maintain sufcient levels of oxygen
be useful to describe a specic modeling exam- in the estuary. The way to do this is to control
ple based on Borsuk et al. (2001). In this algae blooms. This in turn requires limiting the
example, a sequence of models are used to assess nutrient loadings to the estuary that can cause
how effective reductions in upstream nutrient algae blooms and subsequent dissolved oxygen
runoff may be in improving the habitat for sh decits. The modeling challenge is to link
and shellsh in a downstream estuary. nutrient loading to sh and shellsh survival. In
This example is followed by a discussion of other words, can some quantitative relationship
the conditions needed that motivate the use of be dened relating the amount of nutrient loading
models, whether solely mental (Fig. 2.1) or both to the amount of sh and shellsh survival?
mental and mathematical (Fig. 2.2). The negative effects of excessive nutrients
(e.g., nitrogen) in an estuary are shown in
Fig. 2.3. Nutrients stimulate the growth of algae.
2.2.1 An Example Modeling Algae die and accumulate on the bottom where
Approach bacteria consume them. Under calm wind con-
ditions density stratication occurs. Oxygen is
Consider for example the sequence or chain of depleted in the bottom water. As a consequence,
models illustrated in Fig. 2.3 required for the sh and shellsh may die or become weakened
prediction of sh and shellsh survival as a and more vulnerable to disease.
function of nutrient loadings into an estuary. The A sequence of models, each providing input
condition of the sh and shellsh are important data to the next model, can be dened to predict
to the economy of the region and the income of shellsh and sh abundance in the estuary based
many stakeholders. One way to maintain healthy on upstream nutrient loadings. These models, for
2.2 Modeling Water Resource Systems 55

Fig. 2.3 The impacts of excessive nutrients in an estuary

each link shown in Fig. 2.4, can be a mix of 2.2.2 Characteristics of Problems
judgmental, mechanistic, and/or statistical ones. to be Modeled
Statistical models could range from simple
regressions to complex articial neural networks. Problems motivating modeling and analyses
Any type of model selected will have its exhibit a number of common characteristics.
advantages and its limitations. Its appropriateness These are reviewed here because they provide
may largely depend on the amount and precision insight into whether a modeling study of a par-
of the data available for model calibration and ticular problem may be worthwhile. If the plan-
verication. ners objectives are very unclear, if few
The results of any modeling exercise should alternative courses of action exist, or if there is
be expressed in terms meaningful and of interest little scientic understanding of the issues
to those that will be making decisions taking into involved, then mathematical modeling and other
account those results. In this example shell-sh more sophisticated methodologies are likely to
abundance and number of sh-kills are mean- be of little use.
ingful indicators to stakeholders and can be Successful applications of modeling are often
related to designated water body use. characterized by:
56 2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role in Planning

Fig. 2.4 Cause and effect diagram for estuary eutrophication due to excessive nutrient loadings (after Borsuk et al.
2001)

A systems focus or orientation. In such situ- The use of interdisciplinary teams. In many
ations attention needs to be devoted to the complex and nontraditional problems, it is not
interdependencies and interactions of ele- at all clear from the start what mix of disci-
ments or components within the system as a plinary viewpoints will turn out to be most
whole, as well as to the elements or compo- appropriate or acceptable. It is essential that
nents themselves. participants in such workcoming from
2.2 Modeling Water Resource Systems 57

different established disciplinesbecome 2.3.1 Challenges of Planners


familiar with the techniques, vocabulary, and and Managers
concepts of the other disciplines involved.
Participation in interdisciplinary modeling Planners and managers of water resource systems
often requires a willingness to make mistakes are responsible for solving particular
at the fringes of ones technical competence water-related problems or meeting special water
and to accept less than the latest advances in resource needs. When they fail, they hear about
ones own discipline. it. The public lets them know. (Example: the lead
The use of formal mathematics. Most analysts contamination in the drinking water of Flint,
prefer to use mathematical models to assist in Michigan USA, after a switch in the water source
system description and the identication and to reduce costs.) What makes their job particu-
evaluation of efcient tradeoffs among larly challenging is that stakeholders often have
conflicting objectives, and to provide an different needs and expectations. Furthermore,
unambiguous record of the assumptions and institutions where water resource planners and
data used in the analysis. managers work (or hire consultants to work for
them) are like most institutions these days. They
Not all water resources planning and man- must do what they have been asked to do with
agement problems are suitable candidates for limited nancial and human resources. Their
study using modeling methods. Modeling is most clients include all of us who use water, or at least
likely to be appropriate when: all of us who are impacted by the decisions they
make.
The planning and management objectives are The overall objective of planners, managers,
reasonably well dened, and organizations and operators and their institutions is to provide a
and individuals can be identied who can service, such as reliable and inexpensive supplies
benet from obtaining and understanding the of water, assurance of water quality, production
model results. of hydropower, protection from floods, provision
There are many alternative decisions that may of commercial navigation and recreational
satisfy the stated objectives, and the best opportunities, preservation of wildlife and
decision is not obvious. enhancement of ecosystems, or some combina-
The water resources system and the objectives tion of these or other purposes. Furthermore they
being analyzed are describable by reasonably are expected to do this at a cost no greater than
tractable mathematical representations. what people are willing to pay. Meeting these
The information needed, such as the hydro- goals, i.e., keeping everyone happy, is not always
logical, economic, environmental, and eco- easy, or even possible.
logical impacts resulting from any decision, Simple technical measures or procedures are
can be better estimated through the use of rarely available that will ensure a successful
models. solution to any particular set of water resource
The values of the model parameters are management problems. Furthermore, everyone
estimable from readily obtainable data. who has had any exposure to water resources
planning and management knows one cannot
design or operate a water resource system with-
out making compromises. These compromises
2.3 Challenges Involving Modeling often involve competing purposes (such as
hydropower and flood control) or competing
Modeling activities present challenges to those objectives (such as who benets and who pays,
who do it as well as those who sponsor it and and how much and where and when). After
may potentially benet from model results. analysts, using their models of course, identify
58 2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role in Planning

possible ways of achieving various goals and legal rules and regulations;
objectives and provide estimates of associated history of previous decisions;
economical, environmental, ecological, and preferences of important actors and interest
social impacts, it is the decision-makers who groups;
have the more difcult job. They must work with probable reactions of those affected by any
and influence everyone who will be affected by decision;
any decision. relative importance of various issues being
Planning and managing involves not only addressed; and nally;
decision-making, but also developing among all sciences, engineering, and economicsthe
interested and influential individuals an under- technical aspects of their work.
standing and consensus that legitimizes the
decisions and enhances their successful imple- We mention these technical aspects last not to
mentation. Planning and managing are processes suggest that they are the least important factor to
that take place in a social or political environ- be considered. We do this to emphasize that they
ment. These processes involve leadership and are only among many factors and, probably in
communication among people and institutions. the eyes of planners and managers, not the most
Leadership and communication skills are learned decisive or influential (Ahearne 1988; Carey
from experience working with people, not sitting 1988; Pool 1990; Thissen and Walker 2013;
alone working with computers or models. Walker 1987).
Moving an organization or institution into action So, does the scientic, technical, systematic
to achieve specic goals involves a number of approach to modeling for planning and man-
activities, including goal-setting, debating, coordi- agement really matter? We believe it can if it
nating, motivating, deciding, implementing, and addresses the issues of concern to their clients,
monitoring. Many of these must be done simulta- the planners, and managers. Analysts need to be
neously and continuously, especially as conditions prepared to interact with the political or social
(goals and objectives, water supplies, water structure of the institutions they are attempting to
demands, nancial budgets) change over time. assist, as well as with the public and the press.
These activities create a number of challenges that Analysts should also be prepared to have their
are relevant to modelers or analysts. Some include: work ignored. Even if analysts are presenting
facts based on the current state of the sciences,
1. identifying creative ways of solving sometimes these sciences are not considered
problems. relevant. Happily for scientists and engineers,
2. nding out what each interest group wants to this is not always the case. The challenge of
know in order to reach an understanding of modelers or analysts interested in having an
the issues and a consensus on what to do. impact on the performance of water resource
3. developing and using models and presenting systems is to become a part of the largely polit-
their results so that everyone can reach a ical planning and management process and to
common or shared understanding and agree- contribute towards its improvement.
ment that is consistent with their individual
values.
4. making decisions and implementing them 2.3.2 Challenges of Modelers
given differences in opinions, social values,
and objectives. To engage in a successful water resource systems
study, the modeler must possess not only the
In addressing these needs or challenges, requisite mathematical and systems modeling
planners, and managers must consider the skills, but also an understanding of the environ-
relevant mental engineering, economic, political, cultural,
2.3 Challenges Involving Modeling 59

and social aspects of water resources planning 3. The times normally available to study par-
problems. Consider, for example, the study of a ticular water resources problems are shorter
large land development plan. The planner should than the times needed to do a thorough study,
be able to predict how the proposed development or if there is sufcient time, the objectives of
would affect the quantity and quality of the surface the original study will likely have signi-
and subsurface runoff and how this will impact the cantly shifted by the time the study is
quantity and quality of surface waters and ground completed.
waters and their ecosystems. These impacts, in
turn, might affect the planned development itself, This experience emphasizes some of the lim-
or others downstream. To do this the analysts must itations and difculties that any water resource
have an understanding of the biological, chemical, systems study may encounter, but more impor-
and physical and even social processes that are tantly, it underscores the need for constant
involved in water resources management. communication among the analysts, system
A reasonable knowledge of economic theory, planners, managers and operators, and policy-
law, regional planning, and political science can makers. The success or failure of many past
be just as important as an understanding of water resource studies is due largely to the efforts
hydraulic, hydrogeologic, hydrologic, ecologic, expended or not expended in ensuring adequate,
and environmental engineering disciplines. It is timely and meaningful communicationcom-
obvious that the results of most water resources munication among systems analysts, planners,
management decisions have a direct impact on those responsible for system operation and de-
people and their relationships. Hence, inputs sign, and public ofcials responsible for major
from those having knowledge of these disciplines decisions and setting general policies.
are useful during the comprehensive planning of Decision-makers, who can benet from the
water resource systems. information that can be derived from various
Some of the early water resource systems models and analyses, need it at particular times
studies were often undertaken with a naive view and in a form useful and meaningful to them.
of the appropriate role and impact of models and Once their window of opportunity for
modelers in the policymaking process. Policy- decision-making has passed, such information,
makers could foresee the need to make a deci- no matter how well presented, is often useless.
sion. They would ask the systems group to study At the beginning of any study, objectives are
the problem. These analysts would then model usually poorly dened. As more is learned about
the problem, identify feasible solutions and their what can be achieved, stakeholders are better
consequences, and recommend one or at most a able to identify what they want to achieve. Close
few alternative solutions. The policymakers, after communication among analysts and all interested
waiting patiently for these recommendations, stakeholders and decision-makers throughout the
would then make a yes or no decision. Experi- modeling process is essential if systems studies
ence to date suggests the following: are to make their greatest contribution to the
planning process. Objectives as stated at the
1. A nal solution to a water resources planning beginning of a study often differ from the ob-
problem rarely exists; plans and policies are jectives as understood at the end of a study.
dynamic. They evolve over time as facilities Furthermore, it is helpful if those who will use
are added and modied to adapt to changes in models, and present the information derived from
management objectives and in the demands models to those responsible for making deci-
placed on the facilities. sions, are intimately involved with model de-
2. For every major decision there are many velopment, solution, and analysis. Only then can
minor decisions, made by different agencies they appreciate the assumptions upon which any
or management organizations responsible for particular model output is based, and hence
different aspects of a system. adequately evaluate the reliability of the results.
60 2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role in Planning

Any water resource systems study that involves what tools are needed and how they can be better
only outside consultants, and minimal commu- applied in practice. We could extend the thoughts
nication between consultants and planners within of those who, in a more general way, addressed
a responsible management agency or involved these issues over four decades ago (Majoni and
stakeholders, is not likely to have a signicant Quade 1980; Tomlison 1980; Miser 1980; Sto-
impact on the planning process. Models that are key and Zeckhauser 1977).
useful tend to be those that are constantly being There is always a gap between what
modied and applied by those involved in plan researchers in water resource systems modeling
preparation, evaluation, and implementation. produce and publish, and what the practitioner
nds useful and uses. Those involved in research
are naturally interested in developing new and
2.3.3 Challenges of Applying Models improved tools and methods for studying, iden-
in Practice tifying, and evaluating alternative water resource
system designs and management and operation
The clients of modelers or analysts are typically policies. If there were no gap between what is
those who have problems to solve and who could being developed or advocated by researchers and
benet from a better understanding of what that which is actually used by practitioners, either
options they have and what impacts may result. the research community would be very ineffec-
They want advice on what to do and why, what tive in developing new technology or the prac-
will happen given what they do, and who will care titioners would be incredibly skilled in reading,
and how much. The aim of analysts is to provide assimilating, evaluating, and adapting what is
them with meaningful (understandable), useful, worth adapting from this research to meet their
accurate, and timely information. This informa- needs. Evaluation, testing, and inevitable modi-
tion is to help them better understand their system, cations take time. Not all published research is
its problems, and alternative ways to address ready or suited for implementation. By denition
them. In short, the purpose of water resource research is a work in progress.
systems planning and management modeling is to How can modelers help reduce the time it
provide useful and timely information to those takes for new ideas and approaches to be adopted
involved in managing such systems. and used in practice? Clearly, practitioners are
Modeling is a process or procedure intended not likely to accept a new modeling approach or
to focus and force clearer thinking and to pro- even modeling itself unless it is obvious that it
mote better decision-making. The approach will improve the performance of their work as
involves problem recognition, system denition, well as help them address problems they are
and bounding; identication of various goals or trying to solve. Will some new model or com-
objectives; identication and evaluation of vari- puter program make it easier for practitioners to
ous alternatives; and very importantly, effective carry out their responsibilities? If it will, there is
communication of this information to those who a good chance that the model or computer pro-
can benet from it. gram might be successfully used, eventually.
The focus of most books and articles on water Successful use of the information derived from
resource systems modeling is on modeling models or programs is, after all, the ultimate test
methods. This book is no different. But what all of the value of those models or programs. Peer
of us should also be interested in, and discuss review and publication is only one, and perhaps
more than we do, is the use of these tools in the not even a necessary, step towards that ultimate
processes of planning and management. If we test or measure of value of a particular model or
did, we could learn much from each other about modeling approach.
2.3 Challenges Involving Modeling 61

2.3.4 Evaluating Modeling Success actions to take. The extent to which this occurs is
the extent to which a modeling study will have
There are a number of ways one can judge suc- achieved application or implementation success.
cess (or failure) in applying models in practice. Outcome success is based on what happened
Goeller (1988) suggested three measures as a to the problem situation once a decision (that was
basis for judging success: largely influenced by the results of modeling)
was made and implemented. The extent to which
1. How the analysis was performed and pre- the information and understanding resulting from
sented (analysis success); modeling helped solve the problems or resolve
2. How it was used or implemented in the the issues, if it can be determined, is a measure of
planning and management processes (appli- the extent of outcome success.
cation success); and It is clear that success based on any of the last
3. How the information derived from the model two of the three criteria will be strongly depen-
and its application affected the system design dent on the success of the preceding criteria.
or operation and the lives of those who used Modeling applications may be judged successful
the system (outcome success). based on the rst two measures, but perhaps
because of unpredicted events, the problems
The extent to which the models and methods being addressed have become worse rather than
and style of presentation are appropriate for the improved, or while those particular problems
problem being addressed, the resources and time were eliminated, their elimination caused one or
available for the study, and the institutional more even more severe problems. All of us can
environment of the client, are often hard to judge. think of examples where this has happened. The
Publishing in peer-review journals and review previously mentioned lead contamination in the
panels are two ways of judging. No model or drinking water of Flint, Michigan, resulting from
method is without its limitations. Two other trying to reduce costs is one example. Any river
obvious indications are the feeling analysts have restoration project involving the removal of
about their own work and, very importantly, the engineering infrastructure is another example of
feeling the clients have about the analysts work. changing objectives or new knowledge following
Client satisfaction may not be an appropriate previous decisions that no longer work very well.
indicator if, for example, they are unhappy only Who knowsa broader systems study might
because they are learning something they do not have helped planners, managers, and decision-
want to accept. Producing results primarily to makers foresee such consequences, but one
reinforce a clients prior position or opinions cannot count on that. Hindsight is always clearer
might result in client satisfaction but, most would than foresight. Much of what takes place in the
agree, this is not an appropriate goal of modeling. world is completely unpredictable. Given this, it
Application or implementation success is not clear whether we should hold modelers or
implies that the methods and/or results developed analysts, or even planners or managers, com-
in the study were seriously considered by those pletely responsible for any lack of outcome
involved in the planning and management pro- success if unforeseen events change societys
cess. One should not, it seems to us, judge suc- goals, priorities, and understanding.
cess or failure based on whether or not any of the Problem situations and criteria for judging the
model results, i.e., the computer printout, were extent of success are likely to change over time.
directly implemented. What one hopes for is that By the time one can evaluate outcome success,
the information and understanding resulting from the system itself may have changed enough for
model application helped dene and focus the the outcome to be quite different than what was
problem and possible solutions, and helped predicted in the analysis. Monitoring the perfor-
influence the debate among stakeholders and mance of any decision, whether or not based on a
decision-makers about what decisions to make or successfully analyzed and implemented
62 2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role in Planning

modeling effort, is often neglected. But moni- 3. Geographic information systems that provide
toring is very important if changes in system improved spatial analysis and display
design, management, and operation are to be capabilities;
made to adapt to changing and unforeseen 4. Expert systems that can help the user under-
conditions. stand better how complex decision problems
If the models, data, computer programs, doc- might be solved and at the same time explain
umentation, and know-how are successfully to the users why one particular decision may
maintained, updated, and transferred to and used be better than another;
by the client institutions, there is a good chance 5. Cloud computing, electronic mail, and the
that this methodology will be able to provide Internet that lets analysts, planners, and
useful information relevant to the changes that are managers communicate and share data and
needed in system design, management, or oper- information with others worldwide, and to
ation. Until relatively recently, the successful run models that are located and maintained at
transfer of models and their supporting technol- distant sites;
ogy have involved a considerable commitment of 6. Multimedia systems that permit the use of
time and money for both the analysts as well as sound and video animation in analyses, all
the potential users of the tools and techniques. It aimed at improved communication and
has been a slow process. Developments in inter- understanding.
active computer-based decision support systems
that provide a more easily understood human These and other software developments are
modeldatacomputer interface have substan- giving planners and managers improved oppor-
tially facilitated this technology transfer process. tunities for increasing their understanding of their
These interactive interface developments have water resource systems. Such developments in
had a major impact on the state of the practice in technology should continue to aid all of us in
using models in the processes of water resources converting model output data to information, i.e.,
planning and management. it should provide us with a clearer knowledge
and understanding of the alternatives, issues, and
impacts associated with potential solutions to
2.4 Developments in Modeling water resource systems problems. But once
again, this improved information and under-
2.4.1 Technology standing will only be a part of what planners and
managers must consider.
The increasing developments in computer tech- Will all the potential benets of new technol-
nologyfrom mobile devices to microcomputers ogy actually occur? Will analysts be able to
and workstations to supercomputersand all develop and apply these continual improvements
their software applicationshave motivated the in new technology wisely? Will we avoid another
concurrent development of an impressive set of case of oversell or unfullled promises? Will we
new models and accompanying software. This avoid the temptation of generating fancy ani-
software is aimed at facilitating model use and, mated, full-color computer displays just because
more importantly, interaction and communica- we are easily able to, rather than being motivated
tion between the analysts or modelers and their by the hope that such methods will add to
clients. This new software includes improved understanding of how to solve problems
more effectively? Will we provide the safeguards
1. Interactive approaches to model operation needed to ensure the proper use and interpretation
that put users more in control of their com- of the information derived from increasingly
puters, models, and data; user-friendly computer programs? Will we keep a
2. Computer graphics that facilitate data input, problem-solving focus, and continue to work
editing, display, and comprehension; towards increasing our understanding of how to
2.4 Developments in Modeling 63

improve the development and management of our and study increasingly complex issues in water
water resources whether or not our planning resource systems planning and management,
models are incorporated into some sort of inter- improvements made in the mathematical and
active computer-aided support system? We can, computational algorithms have permitted the
but it will take discipline. modeling of more complex systems problems.
As modelers or researchers, we must discipline All our algorithms that have been applied to the
ourselves to work more closely with our clients analysis of water resource systems, have their
the planners, managers, and other specialists who strengths and limitations. We still lack the per-
are responsible for the development and operation fect all-purpose algorithm. And it is not likely
of our water resource systems. We must study that we will nd one in the future. Probably the
their systems and their problems, and we must major determinant of a particular algorithm or
identify their information needs. We must software package chosen to address a particular
develop better tools that they themselves can use problem or development opportunity is that
to model their water resource systems and obtain which the analyst is most familiar with and
an improved understandinga shared visionof experienced in using.
how their system functions and of their available Nevertheless, the menu of available algo-
management options and associated impacts or rithms that can be used for analyses is consid-
consequences. We must be willing to be multi- erably larger today than what it was when the
disciplinary and capable of including all relevant seminal book on the design of water resource
data in our analyses. We must appreciate and see systems (Maas et al. 1962) was published over
the perspectives of the agronomists, ecologists, six decades ago. At that time mathematical pro-
economists, engineers, hydrologists, lawyers, or gramming (constrained optimization) software
political and regional scientistsyou name itas applied to mainly deterministic linear and non-
appropriate. Viewing a water resource system linear problems dominated the interests of those
from a single-discipline perspective is rarely working toward improved models for prelimi-
sufcient to meet todays water resource systems nary screening of water resource systems prior to
planning challenges. more detailed simulation modeling. Simulations
Even if we have successfully incorporated all were based on software and constrained by the
relevant disciplines and data in our analyses, we internal and magnetic tape memory capacity of
should have a healthy skepticism about our computers available at that time. Today our focus
resulting information. We must admit that this is more on methods suited for enhancing stake-
information, especially concerning what might holder participation. Much of it based on the
happen in the future, is uncertain. If we are looking results of research in articial intelligence,
into the future (whether using crystal balls or examples including evolutionary search methods
mathematical models), we must admit that many based on biological processes, multi-agent mod-
of our assumptions, e.g., parameter values, cannot eling, articial neural networks, and data mining
even be calibrated let alone veried. Our conclu- methods.
sions or estimates can be very sensitive to our
assumptions. One of our major challenges is to
communicate this uncertainty in understandable 2.4.3 Interactive Model-Building
ways to those who ask for our predictions. Environments

Water resources planners and managers today


2.4.2 Algorithms must consider the interests and goals of numer-
ous stakeholders. The planning, managing, and
Accompanying the improvements in the tech- decision-making processes involve negotiation
nology of computing that has had an enormous and compromise among these numerous stake-
impact on the capability of analysts to address holders, such as those shown in Fig. 2.5, who
64 2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role in Planning

Fig. 2.5 Stakeholders


involved in river basin
planning and management,
each having different goals
and information needs

typically have different interests, objectives and this modeling simply to be able to estimate, or
opinions about how their water resource system identify, and compare and evaluate the multiple
should be managed. How do we model to meet impacts resulting from different design and
the information needs of all these different management decisions we might make. Such
stakeholders? How can we get them to believe in information, we assume, should be of value to
and accept these models and their results? How those responsible for choosing the best decision.
do we help them reach a commonsharedvi- If our goal is to help contribute to the solution
sion? How can we help create a shared vision of, water resources problems, simply having
among all stakeholders of at least how their information from the worlds best models and
system works and functions, if not how they technology, as judged by our peers, is not a
would like it to? guarantee of success. To be useful in the political
Today we know how to build some rather decision-making process, the information we
impressive models of environmental systems. We analysts generate with all our models and com-
know how to incorporate within our models the puter technology must be understandable, credi-
essential biology, chemistry and physics that ble, and timely. It must be just what is needed
govern how the environmental system works. We when it is needed. It must be not too little and not
have also learned a little about how to include the too much.
relevant economics, ecology, and engineering The optimal format and level of detail and
into these models. Why do we do this? We do all precision of any information generated from
2.4 Developments in Modeling 65

models should depend on the needs and back- display, and control of model (or computer)
grounds of each individual involved in the operations. Depending on the particular issue at
decision-making process. The value of such hand, and more importantly the particular indi-
information, even if the format and content are viduals and institutions involved, a decision
optimal, will also depend on when it is available. support system in the broadest sense can range
Information on an issue is only of value if it is from minimal if any computer model use
available during the time when the issue is being where the decision-makers provide all the data
consideredi.e., when there is an interest in that and analyses, make the decision, and they or their
issue and a decision concerning what to do about institutions implement those decisionsto deci-
it has not yet been made. That is the window of sion support systems that are fully automated and
opportunity when information can have an where no human involvement is present. The
impact. Information is of no value after the latter are rare, but they do exist. The automatic
decision is made unless of course that informa- closing of the flood gates when there is a high
tion results in opening up another window of risk of flooding in Rotterdam harbor is an
opportunity. example of this.
If there is truth in the expression decision Involving stakeholders in model building
makers dont know what they want until they gives them a feeling of ownership. They will
know what they can get, how do modelers know have a much better understanding of just what
what decision-makers will need before even they their model can do and what it cannot do. If they
do? How will modelers know what is the right are involved in model building, they will know
amount and detail of information? How will they the assumptions built into their model. Being
know especially if they are to have that infor- involved in a joint modeling exercise is a way to
mation available, and in the proper form, before understand better the impacts of various
or at, the time it is needed? Obviously modelers assumptions. While there may be no agreement
cannot know this. However, over the past three on the best of various assumptions to make,
decades or so this challenge has been addressed stakeholders can learn which of those assump-
by developing and implementing decision sup- tions matter and which do not. In addition, just
port systems (DSSs) (Fedra 1992; Georgakakos the process of model development by numerous
and Martin 1996; Loucks and da Costa 1991). stakeholders will create discussions that can lead
These interactive modeling and display tech- toward a better understanding of everyones
nologies can, within limits, adapt to the level of interests and concerns. Though such
information needed and can give decision-makers model-building exercises, it is just possible those
some control over data input, model operation, involved will gain not only a better understand-
and data output. But will each decision-maker, ing of everyones concerns, but also a common
each stakeholder, trust the model output? How or shared vision of at least how their water
can they develop any condence in the models resource system (as represented by their model,
contained in a DSS? How can they modify those of course) works. Experience in stakeholder
models within a DSS to address issues the DSS involvement in model building suggests such
developer may not have considered? An answer model-building exercises can also help multiple
to these questions has been the idea of involving stakeholders reach a consensus on how their real
the decision-makers themselves not only in system should be developed and managed.
interactive model use, but in interactive model In the US, one of the major advocates of
building as well. This approach is commonly shared vision or collaborative modeling is the
termed collaborative modeling. Institute for Water Resources of the US Army
Figure 2.6 gives a general view of the com- Corps of Engineers. They have applied their
ponents of many decision support systems. The interactive general-purpose model-building plat-
essential feature is the interactive interface that form in a number of exercises where conflicts
permits easy and meaningful data entry and existed over the design and operation of water
66 2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role in Planning

Fig. 2.6 Common components of many decision support systems

systems (Hamlet et al. 1996a, b, c; Palmer et al. Now the question is how to get all the
1995; Werick et al. 1996). Each of these stakeholders, many who may not really want to
model-building shared-vision exercises inclu- work together, involved in a model-building
ded numerous stakeholders together with experts exercise. This is our challenge! One step in that
in the use of the software. Bill Werick of the direction is the development of improved tech-
Corps writes: nologies that will facilitate model development
Because experts and stakeholders can build these
and use by stakeholders having various back-
models together, including elements that interest grounds and interests. We need better tools for
each group, they become a trusted, consensus view building DSSs, not just better DSSs themselves.
of how the water system works as a whole, and We need to develop better modeling environ-
how it affects stakeholders and the environment.
Without adding new bureaucracies or reassigning
ments that people can use to make their own
decision making authority, the shared vision model models. Researchers need to be building the
and the act of developing it create a connectedness model-building blocks, as opposed to the models
among problems solvers that resembles the natural themselves. Researchers need to focus our
integration of the conditions they study.
attention on improving those building blocks that
2.4 Developments in Modeling 67

can be used by others to build their own models. understandable. They will have to be relatively
Clearly if stakeholders are going to be involved easy and transparent, and even fun, to build.
in model-building exercises, it will have to be an They must be capable of simulating and pro-
activity that is enjoyable and require minimal ducing different levels of detail with regard to
training and programming skills. natural, engineering, economic, and ecological
Traditional modeling experiences seem to processes that take place at different spatial and
suggest that there are ve steps in the modeling temporal scales. And they must require no pro-
process. First, the information the model is to gramming and debugging by the users. Just how
provide is identied. This includes measures of can this be done?
system performance that are of interest to stake- One approach is to develop interactive mod-
holders. These system performance measures are eling shells specically suited to modeling
dened as functions of the behavior or state of environmental problems. Modeling shells are
the system being modeled. Next this behavior data-driven programs that become models once
needs to be modeled so the state of the system sufcient data have been entered into them.
associated with any external inputs can be There are a number of such generic modeling
predicted. This requires modeling the physical, shells for simulating water resource systems.
chemical, biological, economic, ecological, and AQUATOOL, RIBASIM, MIKE-BASIN and
social processes that take place, as applicable, in WEAP are representative of interactive river-
the represented system. Third, these two parts are aquifer simulation shells that require the system
put together along with a means of entering the to be represented by, and drawn in as, a network
external inputs and obtaining in meaningful of nodes and links (e.g., Fig 2.7 from WEAP).
ways the outputs. Next the model must be cali- Each node and link require data, and these data
brated and veried or validated, to the extent it depend on what that node and link represent, as
can. Only now can the model be used to produce well as what the user wants to get from the output.
the information desired. If what is of interest is the time series of quantities
This traditional modeling process is clearly of water flowing, or stored, within the system
not going to work for those who are not espe- resulting from reservoir operation and/or water
cially trained or experienced or even interested in allocation policies, then water quality data need
these modeling activities. They need a not be entered, even though there is the capability
model-building environment where they can of modeling water quality. If water quality out-
easily create models that puts are desired, then the user can choose the
desired various water quality constituents. Obvi-
they understand, ously, the more types of information desired or
are compatible with available data, the greater spatial or temporal resolution desired,
work and provide the level and amount of in the model output, the more input data required.
information needed, Interactive shells provide an interactive and
are easily calibrated and veried when pos- adaptive way to dene models and their input
sible, and data. Once a model is dened, the shell provides
give them the interactive control over data the interface for input data entry and editing,
input, editing, model operation and output model operation, and output data display.
display that they can understand and need in To effectively use such shells, some training is
order to make informed decisions. useful. This training pertains to the use of the
shell and what it can and cannot do. The devel-
The challenge in creating such model-building opers of such shells have removed the need to
environments is in making them sufciently worry about data base management, solving
useful and attractive so that multiple stakeholders systems of equations, developing an interactive
will want to use them. They will have to be interface, preserving mass balances and
68 2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role in Planning

Fig. 2.7 The main interface of the WEAP program, which is typical of a variety of generic river basin models that are
able to simulate any river system drawn into the computer using a node-link network

continuity of flow, and the like. Any assumptions example, in transboundary water resources
built into the shell should be readily transparent issues, different countries may want to include
and acceptable by all before its use in any shared their own hydrodynamic models for the river
vision exercises. reaches in their country.
Various developments on open modeling
systems are taking place in Europe and the United
2.4.4 Open Modeling Systems States, although most of them are still in a
research phase. The implementation of the Water
The next step in shared-vision modeling will be Framework Directive in Europe has stimulated
to create a modeling environment that will enable the development of OpenMI (European Open
all stakeholders to include their own models in Modelling Interface and Environment). OpenMI
the overall system description. Stakeholders tend will simplify the linking of water-related models
to believe their own models more than those that will be used in the strategic planning required
provided by governmental agencies or research by the Water Framework Directive (Gijsbers et al.
institutes. Their own models include the data 2002). An initiative in the United States aims to
they trust, and are based on their own assump- establish a similar framework for Environmental
tions and views on how the system works. For Models (Whelan and Nicholson 2002).
2.5 Conclusions 69

2.5 Conclusions priorities of different interest groups, the concept


of an optimal plan is not very helpful or real-
In our opinion the most important aspect of istic. What modelers can do, however, is to
model use today is communication. Unless water dene and evaluate, in different levels of detail,
resource planners and managers can articulate numerous alternatives that represent various
well their needs for information, it will be dif- possible compromises among conflicting groups,
cult for modelers to generate such information. If values, and management objectives. A rigorous
the modelers cannot communicate effectively and objective analysis should help to identify the
their modeling assumptions and results, or how possible tradeoffs among quantiable objectives
others can use their tools to obtain their own so that further debate and analysis can be more
results, little understanding will be gained from informed. The art of modeling is to identify those
such models. Both users and producers of mod- issues and concerns that are important and sig-
eling analyses must work together to improve nicant and to structure the analysis to shed light
communication. This takes time, patience, and on these issues.
the willingness to understand what each has to Although water resources planning and man-
say and what is really meant by what is said. agement processes are not restricted to mathe-
To expect everyone to communicate effec- matical modeling, such modeling is an important
tively and to fully understand one another may be part of those processes. Models can represent in a
asking too much. As written in the Bible (Gen- fairly structured and ordered manner the impor-
esis; Chapter 11, Verses 19) there was a time tant interdependencies and interactions among
when everyone on the earth was together and the various control structures and users of a water
spoke one language. It seems these people deci- resource system. Models permit an evaluation of
ded to build a tower whose top may reach into the economic and physical consequences of
the heaven. Apparently this activity got the alternative engineering structures, of various
attention of the Lord, who for some reason did operating and allocating policies, and of different
not like this tower building idea. So, according to assumptions regarding future supplies, demands,
the Bible, the Lord came down to earth and technology, costs, and social and legal require-
confounded the peoples language so they could ments. Although models cannot dene the best
not understand one another. They could no objectives or set of assumptions, they can help
longer work together to build their tower. identify the decisions that best meet any partic-
Is it any wonder we have to work hard to ular objective and assumptions.
communicate more effectively with one another, We should not expect, therefore, to have the
even in our single, but multidisciplinary, eld of precise results of any quantitative systems study
water resources planning and management? accepted and implemented. A measure of the
Let all of us modelers or analysts, planners, and success of any systems study resides in the
managers work together to build a new tower of answer to the following questions: Did the study
understanding. To do this we need to control our have a benecial impact in the planning and
jargon and take the time to listen, communicate, decision-making process? Did the results of such
and learn from each other and from all of our studies lead to a more informed debate over the
experiences. Who knows, if we are successful, proper choice of alternatives? Did it introduce
we may even have another visit from the Lord. competitive alternatives that otherwise would not
Those who are involved in the development of have been considered?
water resource systems modeling methodology There seems to be no end of challenging water
know that the use of these models cannot guar- resource systems planning problems facing water
antee development of optimal plans for water resources planners and managers. How one
resources development and management. Given models any specic water resource problem
the competing and changing objectives and depends on (a) the objectives of the analysis;
70 2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role in Planning

(b) the data required to evaluate the projects; Goeller B. (1988). A framework for evaluating success in
(c) the time, data, money, and computational systems analysis. In H. J. Miser & E. S. Quade (Eds.),
Handbook of systems analysis, craft issues and
facilities available for the analysis; and (d) the procedural choices. Chichester: Wiley.
modelers knowledge and skill. Model develop- Hamlet, A., et al. (1996a). Simulating basinwide alterna-
ment is an art, requiring judgment in abstracting tives using the ACT-ACF shared vision models.
from the real world the components that are Mobile District, Mobile, Al.: USACE.
Hamlet, A., et al. (1996b). A history of shared vision
important to the decision to be made and that can modeling in the ACT-ACF comprehensive study.
be illuminated by quantitative methods, and Mobile District, Mobile, Al.: USACE.
judgment in expressing those components and Hamlet, A., et al. (1996c). Basic Stella II users manual for
their interrelationships mathematically in the the ACT-ACF shared vision models. Mobile District,
Mobile, Al.: USACE.
form of a model. This art is to be introduced in Kindler, J. (1987). Systems analysis approach to water
Chap. 3. resources management: State of the art. In Symposium
on Recent Developments and Perspectives in Systems
Analysis in Water Resources Management. Perugia,
Italy: WARREDOC.
References Kindler, J. (1988). Systems analysis and water resources
planning. In Fourth IFAC International Symposium on
Systems Analysis Applied to Management of Water
Ahearne, J. F. (1988). Addressing public concerns in Resources. Rabat, Morocco: IFAC. October 1113.
science. Physics Today, 41(9), 3642. Loucks, D. P., & da Costa, J. R. (Eds.). (1991). Decision
Austin, T. A. (1986). Utilization of models in water support systems. NATO Series G. (Vol. 26). Berlin:
resources. Water Resources Bulletin, 22(1), 4956. Springer.
Borsuk, M. E., Stow, C. A., Higdon, D., & Reckhow, K. Loucks, D. P., Stedinger, J. R., & Shamir, U. (1985).
H. (2001). A Bayesian hierarchical model to predict Modelling water resources systems: Issues and expe-
benthic oxygen demand from organic matter loading riences. Civil Engineering Systems, 2, 22331.
in estuaries and coastal zones. Ecological Modelling, Maas, A., Hufschmidt, M. A., Dorfman, R., Thomas, H.
143, 165181. A., Jr., Marglin, S. A., & Fair, G. M. (1962). Design of
Brown, C. M., Lund, J. R., Cai, X., Reed, P. M., Zagona, water-resource systems: New techniques for relating
E. A., Ostfeld, A., et al. (2015, August). The future of economic objectives, engineering analysis, and gov-
water resources systems analysis: Toward a scientic ernmental planning. Cambridge, Mass: Harvard
framework for sustainable water management. Water University Press.
Resources Research, 51(8), 61106124. Majoni, H., & Quade, E. S. (1980). Pitfalls of analysis.
Cai, X., Vogel, R., & Ranjithan, R., (Eds.). (2013, New York: Wiley.
September/October). Role of systems analysis in Miser, H. J. (1980). Operations research and systems
watershed management. Journal of Water Resources analysis. Science, 209, 174182.
Planning and Management, 139(5), 461592. Palmer, R. N., Keys, A. M., & Fisher, S. (1995).
Carey, W. D. (1988). Scientists and sandboxes: Regions Empowering stakeholders through simulation in water
of the mind. American Scientist, 76, 143145. resources planning. In Proceedings of the 20th
Castelletti, A. & Soncini-Sessa, R. (2007). Topics on Conference on Water Resources Planning and Man-
system analysis and integrated water resources man- agement Division. New York: ASCE.
agement. Amsterdam: Elsevier Ltd. ISBN: 978-0-08- Pool, R. (1990). Struggling to do science for society.
044967-8. Science, 248, 672673.
Fedra, K. (1992). Advanced computer applications. Reynolds, P. J. (1987). Future research needs in systems
Options, December. analysis and to application to water resources man-
Gass, S. I. (1990). Model world: 1-lave model, will travel. agement. In International Symposium on Recent
Interfaces, 20(2), 6771. Developments and Perspectives in Systems Analysis
Georgakakos, A. P., & Martin, Q. W. (Eds.). (1996, in Water Resources Management. Perugia, Italy:
March). An international review of decision support WARREDOC.
systems in river basin operation. In Proceedings of the Rogers, P. P., & Fiering, M. B. (1986). Use of systems
Fifth Water Resources Operations Management analysis in water management. Water Resources
Workshop. Arlington, VA.: ASCE. Research, 22(9), 146S158S.
Gijsbers, P. J. A., Moore, R. V., & Tindall, C. I. (2002). Russell, C. S., & Baumann, D. D. (Eds.). (2009). The
Hamonil T: Towards OMI, an open modelling inter- evolution of water resource planning and decision
face and environment to harmonise European devel- making. Northampton, MA, USA: Edward Elgar.
opments in water related simulation software. The Shapiro, H. T. (1990). The willingness to risk failure.
Netherlands, Delft: Delft Hydraulics (internal paper). Science, 250(4981), 609.
References 71

Simon, H. A. (1998). Prediction and prescription in Raskin, P., Sieber, J. & Huber-Lee, A. (2001). Water
system modelling. In 15th Anniversary of IIASA, evaluation and planning system: User guide for
International Institute for Applied Systems Analysis. WEAP21. Boston, Mass: Tellus Institute.
Laxenburg, Austria: IIASA.
Stokey, E., & Zeckhauser, R. (1977). A primer for policy
analysis. New York, W.W: Norton.
Thissen, W. A. H., & Walker, W. E. (Eds.). (2013).
Public policy analysis: New developments (286 pp). Exercises
New York, Heidelberg, Dordrecht, London: Springer.
doi:10.1007/978-1-4614-4602-6 (ISBN
978-1-4614-4601-9; ISBN 978-1-4614-4602-6 2:1 What is a system?
(eBook)). 2:2 What is systems analysis?
Tomlison, R. (1980). Doing something about the future. 2:3 What is a mathematical model?
Journal of the Operational Research Society, 31, 467
476. 2:4 Why develop and use models?
Walker, W. E. (1987). Important hard problems in public 2:5 What is a decision support system?
policy analysis (Report P-7282). Santa Monica, Cal- 2:6 What is shared vision modeling and
ifornia: Rand Corporation. planning?
Watkins, D. W. Jr., (Ed.). (2013). Water resources
systems analysis through case studies: Data and 2:7 What characteristics of water resources
models for decision making (168 pp). Reston, VA: planning or management problems make
ASCE Press. them suitable for analysis using quanti-
Werick, W. J., Whipple, W. Jr., & Lund, J. (1996). tative systems analysis techniques?
ACTACF basinwide study. Mobile District, Mobile,
Al.: USACE. 2:8 Identify some specic water resource
Whelan, G., & Nicholson, T. J. (Eds.). (2002). Proceed- systems planning problems and for each
ings of the Environmental Software Systems Compa- problem specify in words possible
bility and Linkage Workshop (NRC report objectives, the unknown decision vari-
NUREG/CP-0177). March 79, 2000. Richland and
Washington.: Pacic Northwest National Laboratory. ables whose values need to be deter-
wrm_ch02.qxd 8/31/2005 Page 56. mined, and the constraints or that must be
met by any solution of the problem.
2:9 From a review of the recent issues of var-
ious journals pertaining to water resources
and the appropriate areas of engineering,
Additional References economics, planning, and operations
(Further Reading) research, identify those journals that con-
tain articles on water resources systems
Andreu, J., Capilla, J., & Sanchis, E. (1991). Aquatool.
planning and analysis, and the topics or
A computer assisted support system for water
resources research management including conjunctive problems currently being discussed.
use. In D. P. Loucks & J. R. da Costa (Eds.), Decision 2:10 Many water resource systems planning
support systems (pp. 333355). Berlin: Springer. problems involve considerations that are
Danish Hydraulic Institute (DHI). (1997). Mikebasin:
very difcult if not impossible to quantify,
Operating manual and description. Hrsholm:
Denmark. and hence they cannot easily be incorpo-
Delft Hydraulics. (2004). RIBASIM River basin simula- rated into any mathematical model for
tion program operating manual and description. The dening and evaluating various alternative
Netherlands, Delft.
Loucks, D. P. (1995, August). Developing and implement-
solutions. Briefly discuss what value these
ing decision support systems: A critique and a chal- admittedly incomplete quantitative mod-
lenge. Water Resources Bulletin, Journal of American els may have in the planning process when
Water Resources Association. 31(4), 57182. nonquantiable aspects are also important.
OCallaghan, J. R. (Ed.). (1996). The interaction of
economic, ecology and hydrology. London: Chapman
Can you identify some planning problems
& Hall. that have such intangible objectives?
72 2 Water Resource Systems Modeling: Its Role in Planning

2:11 Dene integrated water management and 2:14 Suppose you live in an area where the
what that entails as distinct from just only source of water (at a reasonable
water management. cost) is from an aquifer that receives no
2:12 Water resource systems serve many recharge. Briefly discuss how you might
purposes and can satisfy many objec- develop a plan for its use over time.
tives. What is the difference between
purposes and objectives?
2:13 How would you characterize the steps of
a planning process aimed at solving a
particular problem?

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
Models for Identifying
and Evaluating Alternatives 3

Water resources systems are characterized by associated with any set of decisions and
multiple interdependent components that produce assumptions, and to predict just how well various
multiple economic, environmental, ecological, economic, environmental, ecosystem, and social
and social impacts. Planners and managers or political objectives or goals will be met.
working to improve the performance of these One important criterion for plan identication
complex systems must identify and evaluate and evaluation is the economic benet or cost a
alternative designs and operating policies, com- plan would entail were it to be implemented.
paring their predicted performance with desired Other criteria can include the extent to which any
goals or objectives. These alternatives are plan meets environmental, ecological, and social
dened by the values of numerous design, targets. Once planning or management perfor-
management, and operating policy variables. mance measures (objectives) and various general
Constrained optimization together with simula- alternatives for achieving desired levels of these
tion modeling is the primary way we have of performance measures have been identied,
identifying the values of the unknown decision models can be developed and used to help
variables that will best achieve specied goals identify specic alternative plans that best
and objectives. This chapter introduces opti- achieve those objectives.
mization and simulation modeling approaches Some system performance objectives may be
and describes what is involved in developing and in conflict, and in such cases models can help
applying them to dene and evaluate alternative identify the efcient tradeoffs among these
designs and operating policies. conflicting measures of system performance.
These tradeoffs indicate what combinations of
performance measure values can be obtained
3.1 Introduction from various system design and operating policy
variable values. If the objectives are the right
There are typically many different options ones (that is, they are what the stakeholders
available to those planning and managing water really care about), such quantitative tradeoff
resource systems. It is not always clear what set information should be of value during the debate
of particular design, management, and operating over what decisions to make (Hipel et al. 2015).
policy decisions will result in the best overall Regional water resources development plans
system performance. That is precisely why designed to achieve various objectives typically
modeling is done, to estimate the performance involve investments in land and infrastructure.

The Author(s) 2017 73


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_3
74 3 Models for Identifying and Evaluating Alternatives

Achieving the desired economic, environmental, The emphasis here is on the art of model de-
ecological, and social objective values over time velopment: just how one goes about constructing
and space may require investments in storage a model that will provide information needed to
facilities, pipes, canals, wells, pumps, treatment study and address particular problems, and vari-
plants, levees, and hydroelectric generating ous ways models might be solved. It is unlikely
facilities, or in fact the removal of some of them. anyone will ever use any of the specic models
Many capital investments can result in irre- developed in this or other chapters, simply
versible economic and ecological impacts. Once because they will not be solving the specic
the forest in a valley is cleared and replaced by a example problems used to illustrate the different
lake behind a dam, it is almost impossible to approaches to model development and solution.
restore the site to its original condition. In parts However, it is quite likely that water resources
of the world where river basin or coastal managers and planners will use the modeling
restoration activities require the removal of approaches and solution methods presented in
engineering structures, such as in the Florida this book to develop the models needed to ana-
Everglades discussed in Chap. 1, engineers are lyze their own particular problems.
learning just how difcult and expensive that The water resource planning and management
effort can be. problems and issues used here, or any others that
The use of planning models is not going to could have been used to illustrate model devel-
eliminate the possibility of making mistakes. opment, can be the core of more complex models
These models can, however, inform. They can addressing more complex problems in practice.
provide estimates of the different impacts asso- Water resources planning and management today
ciated with, say, a natural unregulated river sys- is dominated by the use of optimization and
tem and a regulated river system. The former can simulation models. While computer software is
support a healthier ecosystem that provides a becoming increasingly available for solving
host of flood protection and water quality various types of optimization and simulation
enhancement services. The latter can provide models, no software currently exists that will
more reliable and cheaper water supplies for build those models themselves. What to include
off-stream users and increased hydropower and and what not to include and what parameter
some protection from at least small floods for values to assume in models of water resource
those living on flood-prone lands. In short, systems requires judgment, experience, and
models can help stakeholders assess the future knowledge of the particular problem(s) being
consequences, the benets and costs, and a addressed, the system being modeled and the
multitude of other impacts associated with decision-making environment. Understanding
alternative plans or management policies. the contents of, and performing the exercises
This chapter introduces some mathematical pertaining to, this chapter will be a rst step
modeling approaches commonly used to study toward gaining some judgment and experience in
and analyze water resources systems. The mod- model development and solution.
eling approaches are illustrated by their applica-
tion to some relatively simple water resources
planning and management problems. The pur- 3.1.1 Model Components
pose here is to introduce and compare some
commonly used modeling methods. This is not a Mathematical models typically contain one or
text on the state of the art of modeling. More more algebraic equations or inequalities. These
realistic and more complex problems usually expressions include variables whose values are
require much bigger and more complex models assumed to be known and others that are
than those introduced in this book, but these unknown and to be determined. Variables that
bigger and more complex models are often based are assigned known values are usually called
on the principles and techniques presented here. parameters. Variables having unknown values
3.1 Introduction 75

that are to be determined by solving the model just how important uncertain parameter values or
are called decision variables. Models are devel- uncertain model structures are with respect to the
oped for the primary purpose of identifying the output of the model. This is called sensitivity
best values of the latter and for determining how analysis. Sensitivity analyses will be discussed in
sensitive those derived values are to the assumed Chap. 8 in much more detail.
parameter values. Solving a model means nding values of its
Decision variables can include design and unknown decision variables. The values of these
operating policy variables of various water decision variables can dene a plan or policy.
resources system components. Design variables They can also determine the costs and benets or
can include the active and flood storage capaci- the values of other measures of system perfor-
ties of reservoirs, the power generating capacity mance associated with that particular manage-
of hydropower plants, the pumping capacity of ment plan or policy. While the components of
pumping stations, the waste removal efciencies optimization and simulation models can include
of wastewater treatment plants, the dimensions or system performance indicators, model parame-
flow capacities of canals and pipes, the heights of ters and constraints, the process of model de-
levees, the hectares of an irrigation area, the velopment and use also includes people. The
targets for water supply allocations, and so on. drawing shown in Fig. 3.1 (and in Chap. 2 as
Operating variables can include releases of water well) illustrates some interested stakeholders
from reservoirs or the allocations of water to busy studying their river basin, in this case per-
various users over space and time. Unknown haps with the use of a physical simulation model.
decision variables can also include measures of (Further discussion of stakeholder involvement
system performance, such as net economic ben- in the planning and management process is in
ets, concentrations of pollutants at specic sites Chap. 13).
and times, ecological habitat suitability values or Whether a mathematical model or physical
deviations from particular ecological, economic, model is being used, one important consideration
or hydrological targets. is that if the modeling exercise is to be of any
Models describe, in mathematical terms, the value, it must provide the information desired
system being analyzed and the conditions that the and in a form that the interested stakeholders and
system has to satisfy. These conditions are often decision-makers can understand.
called constraints. Consider, for example, a
reservoir serving various water supply users
downstream. The conditions included in a model 3.2 Plan Formulation and Selection
of this reservoir would include the assumption
that water will flow in the direction of lower Plan formulation can be thought of as assigning
heads (that is, downstream unless it is pumped particular values to each of the relevant decision
upstream), and the volume of water stored in a variables. Plan selection is the process of evalu-
reservoir cannot exceed its storage capacity. Both ating alternative plans and choosing the one that
the storage volume over time and the reservoir best satises a particular objective or set of ob-
capacity might be unknown and are to be deter- jectives. The processes of plan formulation and
mined. If the capacity is known or assumed, then selection involve modeling and communication
it is among the known model parameters. among all interested stakeholders, as the picture
Model parameter values, while assumed to be in Fig. 3.1 suggests.
known, can often be uncertain. The relationships The planning and management issues being
among various decision variables and assumed discussed by the stakeholders in the basin pic-
known model parameters (i.e., the model itself) tured in Fig. 3.1 could well include surface and
may be uncertain. In these cases, the models can ground water allocations, reservoir operation,
be solved for a variety of assumed conditions and water quality management, and infrastructure
parameter values. This provides an estimate of capacity expansion over time.
76 3 Models for Identifying and Evaluating Alternatives

Fig. 3.1 These stakeholders have an interest in how their planning and management issues. Mathematical models
watershed or river basin is managed. Here they are using a often replace physical models, especially for planning and
physical model to help them visualize and address management studies

3.2.1 Plan Formulation performance, such as costs and benets. They


may also include environmental and social
Model building for dening alternative plans or measures not expressed in monetary units. (More
policies involves a number of steps. The rst is to detail on performance criteria is contained in
clearly specify the issue or problem or decision Chap. 9).
(s) to be made. What are the fundamental To illustrate this plan formulation process,
objectives and possible alternatives? Such alter- consider the task of designing a tank that can
natives might require dening allocations of store a xed volume, say V, of water. Once the
water to various water users, the level of desired shape has been determined, the task is to
wastewater treatment needed to maintain a build a model that can determine the values of all
desired water quality in a receiving stream, the the design variables and the resulting cost. Dif-
capacities, and operating rules of multipurpose ferent designs result in different sizes and
reservoirs and hydropower plants, and the extent amounts of materials, and hence different costs.
and reliability of floodplain protection derived Assume the purpose of the model is to dene the
from levees. Each of these decisions may affect set of design variable values that results in the
system performance criteria or objectives. Often minimum total cost, for a range of values of the
these objectives include economic measures of required volume, V.
3.2 Plan Formulation and Selection 77

The model of this problem must somehow The total side area is twice the products of
relate the unknown design variable values to the length times height and width times height.
cost of the tank. Assume, for example, a rectan- Cost of the base is the cost-per-unit area of
gular tank shape. The unknown design variables the base times the total base area.
are the tank length, L, width, W, and height, Cost of the top is the cost-per-unit area of the
H. These are the unknown decision variables. The top times the total top area.
objective is to nd the combination of L, W, and The top and base area is the product of length
H values that minimizes the total cost of provid- times width.
ing a tank capacity of at least V units of water. The volume of the tank must at least equal the
This volume V will be one of the model param- required volume capacity.
eters. Its value is assumed known even though in The volume of the tank is the product of the
fact it may be unknown and dependent in part on length, width, and height of the tank.
its cost. But for now assume V is known.
The cost of the tank will be the sum of the Converting each of the above conditions to
costs of the base, the sides, and the top. These mathematical expressions using the notation
costs will depend on the area of the base, sides, dened above and inventing new notation when
and top. Assume that we know the average costs needed results in:
per unit area of the base, sides, and top of the
tank. These average unit costs of the base, sides, Total cost equals the sum of the costs of the
and top will probably differ. They can be denoted base, the sides, and the top.
as Cbase, Cside, and Ctop, respectively. These unit Cost = sidecost + basecost + topcost
costs together with the tanks volume, V, are the Cost of the sides is the cost-per-unit area of
parameters of the model. If L, W, and H are the sides times the total side area.
measured in meters, then the areas will be sidecost = Cside (sidearea)
expressed in units of square meters and the vol- The total side area is twice the products of
ume will be expressed in units of cubic meters. length times height and width times height.
The average unit costs will be expressed in sidearea = 2(LH+WH)
monetary units per square meter. Cost of the base is the cost-per-unit area of
The nal step of model building is to specify the base times the total base area.
all the relations among the model parameters and basecost = Cbase (basearea)
decision variables. This includes dening the Cost of the top is the cost-per-unit area of the
objective (cost) function (in this case just one top times the total top area.
unknown variable, Cost) and all the conditions topcost = Ctop (toparea)
that must be satised while achieving that The top and base area is the product of length
objective. It is often helpful to rst state these times width.
relationships in words. The result is a word toparea = basearea = LW
model. Once that is written, mathematical nota- The volume of the tank must at least equal the
tion can be dened and used to convert the word required volume capacity.
model to a mathematical model. tankvolume V
The word model for this tank design problem The volume of the tank is the product of the
is to minimize total cost where: length, width, and height of the tank.
tankvolume = LWH
Total cost equals the sum of the costs of the
base, the sides, and the top. Combining some of the above conditions, a
Cost of the sides is the cost-per-unit area of mathematical optimization model can be written
the sides times the total side area. as:
78 3 Models for Identifying and Evaluating Alternatives

Minimize Cost 3:1 a unit percent change in some parameter value


(what economists call elasticity)?
Subject to: If indeed the decision variable values do not
change signicantly with respect to a change in
Cost Cbase Ctop LW 2Cside LH WH an uncertain parameter value, there is no need to
3:2 devote more effort to reducing that uncertainty.
Any time and money available for further study
should be directed toward those parameters or
LWH  V 3:3 assumptions that substantially influence the
models decision variable values.
Equation 3.3 permits the tanks volume to be This capability of models to help identify
larger than that required. While this is allowed, it what data or assumptions are important and what
will cost more if the tanks capacity is larger than are not can guide monitoring and data collection
V, and hence the least-cost solution of this model efforts. This is a benecial attribute of modeling
will surely show that the product LWH will equal often overlooked.
the required volume V. In practice, however, Continuing with the tank example, after
there may be practical, legal, and/or safety rea- determining, or estimating, all the values of the
sons why the decisions with respect to L, W, and model parameters and then solving the model to
H may result in a capacity that exceeds V. obtain the cost-effective values of L, W and H,
In this model, the unknown decision variables we now have a design. It is just one of a number
include Cost, L, W, and H of designs that could be proposed. Another de-
The least-cost solution (using methods dis- sign might be for a cylindrical tank having a
cussed in the next chapter) is radius and height as well as cost decision vari-
ables. For the same volume V and unit area costs,
W L 2Cside V = Cbase Ctop 1=3 3:4 we would nd that the total cost is less, simply
because the areas of the base, side, and top are
and less.
In the above discussion, the required volume
H V = 2Cside V = Cbase Ctop 2=3 3:5 capacity, V, has been assumed to be known. In
reality, it too may be a decision variable, and
or what would be of greater value to
decision-makers is knowing the relationship
H V 1=3 Cbase Ctop = 2Cside 2=3 3:6 between various assumed values of V and their
respective minimum costs. Such a cost function
The modeling exercise should not end here. If can be dened by solving the model (dened by
there is any doubt about the value of any of the Eqs. 3.1, 3.2 and 3.3) for various values of V.
parameters, a sensitivity analyses can be per- Whatever the nal outcome of our modeling
formed on those uncertain parameters or efforts, there might be other considerations or
assumptions. In general, these assumptions could criteria that are not expressed or included in the
include the values of the cost parameters (e.g., model that might be important to those respon-
the costs-per-unit area) as well as the relation- sible for plan (tank design) selection.
ships expressed in the model (that is, the model
itself). How much does the total cost change with
respect to a change in any of the cost parameters 3.2.2 Plan Selection
or with the required volume V? How much does
any decision variable change with respect to There are various approaches to nding the
changes in those parameter values? What is the best plan or best set of decision variable values
percent change in a decision variable value given that satisfy an objective or goal. By trial and
3.2 Plan Formulation and Selection 79

error, one could identify alternative plans, eval- be able to contain a given amount of water. In a
uate the performance of each plan, and select the water allocation problem, any water allocated to
particular plan whose performance is judged and completely consumed by one user cannot
better than the others. This process could include simultaneously or subsequently be allocated to
a systematic simulation of a range of possible another user. Storage reservoirs cannot store
solutions in a search for the best. When there are more water than their maximum storage capaci-
a large number of feasible alternativesthat is, ties. Technological restrictions may limit the
many decision variables and many possible val- capacities and sizes of pipes, generators, and
ues for each of themit may no longer be pumps to those commercially available. Water
practical to identify and simulate all feasible quality concentrations should not exceed those
combinations of decision variable values, or even specied by water quality standards or regula-
a small percentage of them. It would simply take tions. There may be limited funds available to
too long. In this case it is often convenient to use spend on water resources development or
an optimization procedure. infrastructure projects. These are a few examples
Equations 3.13.3 represent an optimization of physical, legal, and nancial conditions or
problem. There are an innite number of feasible constraints that may restrict the ranges of deci-
tank designs, i.e., alternative values of L, W, and sion variable values in the solution of a model.
H that satisfy the volume requirement. Our job is Equations or inequalities can generally
to nd the least-cost one. We can do this using a express any physical, economic, legal, or social
mathematical optimization method. Mathemati- restrictions on the values of the decision vari-
cal optimization methods are designed to make ables. Constraints can also simply dene rela-
this search for the best solution (or better solu- tionships among decision variables. For example,
tions) more efcient. Optimization methods are Eq. 3.2 above denes a new decision variable
used to identify those values of the decision called Cost as a function of other decision vari-
variables that satisfy specied objectives and ables and model parameters. In general, con-
constraints without requiring complete straints describe in mathematical terms the
enumeration. system being analyzed. They dene the system
While optimization models might help iden- components and their interrelationships, and the
tify the decision variable values that will produce permissible ranges of values of the decision
the best plan directly, they are based on all the variables, either directly or indirectly.
assumptions incorporated in the model. Often Typically, there exist many more decision
these assumptions are limiting. In these cases, the variables than constraints, and hence, if any
solutions resulting from optimization models feasible solution exists, there may be many such
should be analyzed in more detail, perhaps solutions that satisfy all the constraints. The
through simulation methods, to improve the existence of many feasible alternatives is a
values of the decision variables and to provide characteristic of most water resources systems
more accurate estimates of the impacts associated planning problems. Indeed it is a characteristic of
with those decision variable values. In these sit- most engineering design and operation problems.
uations, optimization models are used for The particular feasible solution or plan that sat-
screening out the clearly inferior solutions, not ises the objective functionthat is, that maxi-
for nding the very best one. Just how screening mizes or minimizes itis called optimal. It is the
can be performed using optimization models will optimal solution of the mathematical model, but
be discussed in the next chapter. it may not necessarily be considered optimal by
The values that the decision variables may any decision-maker. What is optimal with respect
assume are rarely unrestricted. Usually various to a model may not be optimal with respect to
functional relationships among these variables those involved in a planning or decision-making
must be satised. This is what is expressed in process. To repeat what was written in Chap. 2,
constraint Eq. 3.3. For example, the tank has to models are used to provide information (useful
80 3 Models for Identifying and Evaluating Alternatives

information, one hopes), to the decision-making the relationships between what land and water
process. Model solutions are not replacements managers can do and the eventual ecological
for judgments of individuals involved in the impacts of those actions. Once a conceptual
decision-making process. model has been quantied (expressed in mathe-
matical terms), it becomes a mathematical model.
The models equations typically include vari-
3.3 Conceptual Model ables whose values are unknown and can vary,
Development and parameters whose values are assumed
known.
Prior to the selection or development of a quan- The values of the models parameters need to
titative model, it is often useful to develop a be determined. Model calibration involves nd-
conceptual one. Conceptual models are non- ing the best values for these parameters. Cali-
quantitative representations of a system. The bration is based on comparisons of the model
system components and their interactions are results with observed data. Optimization methods
dened often by diagrams similar to Fig. 3.2. can sometimes be used to identify the values of
Figure 3.2 illustrates the form of a conceptual model parameters. This is called model calibra-
model. This example conceptual model denes tion or identication. (Illustrations of the use of

Fig. 3.2 An outline of a conceptual model without its components and between management decisions and
detail (i.e., what exactly each component or box repre- specic system impacts
sents), showing the links representing interactions among
3.3 Conceptual Model Development 81

optimization for estimating model parameter be included in an optimization model. The


values are presented in the following chapter.) resulting outputs can better identify the variations
Sensitivity analysis may serve to identify the of multiple system performance indicator values:
impacts of uncertain parameter values and show that is, the multiple hydrological, ecological,
which parameter values substantially influence economic, environmental, and social impacts that
the models results or solutions. Following cali- might be observed over time, given any partic-
bration, the remaining uncertainties in the model ular system design and operating policy.
predictions may be quantied in an uncertainty Simulating multiple sets of values dening the
analysis as discussed in Chap. 8. designs and operating policies of a water
In addition to being calibrated, simulation resources system can take a long time. Consider,
models should also be validated or veried. In for example, 30 infrastructure capacity variables
the validation or verication process, the model whose values are to be determined. Even if only
results are compared with an independent set of two possible values are assumed for each of the
measured observations that were not used in 30 variables (such as to exist at some predeter-
calibration. This comparison is made to deter- mined capacity or not), the number of combina-
mine whether or not the model describes the tions that could be simulated amounts to 230 or in
system behavior sufciently accurately. excess of 109. Simulating and comparing even
1% of these billion at a minute per simulation
amounts to over twenty years, continuously
3.4 Simulation and Optimization 24 h per day. Most simulation models of water
resources systems contain many more variables,
The modeling approach to tank design discussed each having a larger range of feasible values, and
in the previous section focused on the use of are much more complex than this simple
optimization methods to identify the preferred 30-binary-variable example. Mathematically, if
design variable values. Similar optimization not in reality, there could be an innite combi-
methods can be used to identify preferred design nation of feasible values for each of the decision
variable values and operating policies for urban variables.
stormwater runoff control or multiple reservoir Simulation works well when there are only a
systems, given various assumptions regarding relatively few alternatives to be evaluated, not
parameter values and design and operating ob- when there are a large number of them. The trial
jectives. Once these preferred designs and oper- and error process of simulation can be time con-
ating policies have been identied, unless there is suming. An important role of optimization meth-
reason to believe that a particular alternative is ods is to reduce the number of alternatives for
really the best and needs no further analysis, each simulation analyses. However, if only one method
of these preferred alternatives can be further of analysis is to be used to evaluate a complex
evaluated with the aid of more detailed and ro- water resources system, simulation together with
bust simulation models. human judgment concerning which alternatives to
Simulation models address what if ques- simulate is often the method of choice.
tions: What will likely happen over time at one or Simulation can be based on either discrete
more specic places if a particular design and/or events or discrete time periods. Most simulation
operating policy is implemented? Simulation models of water resources systems are designed
models are not limited by many of the assump- to simulate a sequence of events over a number
tions incorporated into optimization models. For of discrete time periods. In each discrete time
example, the inputs to simulation models can period, the simulation model converts all the
include a much longer time series of hydrologi- initial conditions and inputs to outputs. The
cal, economic, and environmental data such as duration of each period depends in part on the
rainfall or streamflows, water supply demands, particular system being simulated and the ques-
pollutant loadings and so on, than would likely tions being addressed.
82 3 Models for Identifying and Evaluating Alternatives

3.4.1 Simulating a Simple Water operating policy, shown as a red line in upper
Resources System Fig. 3.4, attempts to meet a release target. If
insufcient water is available, all the water will
Consider the case of a potential reservoir releasing be released in the time period. If the inflow
water to downstream users (Fig. 3.3). A reservoir exceeds the target flow and the reservoir is full, a
and its operating policy can increase the benets spill will occur.
each user receives over time by providing This operating policy is sometimes called the
increased flows during periods of otherwise low standard operating policy. It is not usually
flows relative to the user demands. Of interest is followed in practice. Most operators, as indeed
whether or not the increased benets the water specied by most reservoir operating policies,
users obtain from an increased and more reliable will reduce releases in times of drought in an
downstream flow conditions will offset the costs attempt to save some water in the reservoir for
of the reservoir. future releases in case of an extended period of
Before this system can be simulated, one has low inflows. This is called a hedging policy. Any
to dene the active storage capacity of the reser- reservoir release policy, including a hedging
voir and how much water is to be released policy, can be dened within the blue portion of
depending on the storage volume and time period. the release policy plot shown in Fig. 3.4. The
In other words, one has to dene the reservoir dashdot line in Fig. 3.4 is one such hedging
operating policy. In addition, one must also dene function. Once dened, any reservoir operating
the allocation policy: how much of the released policy can be simulated.
water to allocate to each user and to the river The simulation process for the three-user
downstream of the users. system is shown in Fig. 3.5. It proceeds from
There are literally an innite number of pos- one time period to the next. The reservoir inflow,
sible design and operating policy variable values. obtained from a database, is added to the existing
The next section will address the problem of storage volume, and a release is determined
screening these alternatives to nd those values based on the release policy (upper Fig. 3.4).
that are most worthy of further study using Once the release is known, the nal storage
simulation. volume is computed and this becomes the initial
For this simple illustration assume the oper- volume for the next simulation time period. The
ating and allocation policies are as shown in reservoir release is then allocated to the three
Fig. 3.4. Also for simplicity assume they apply downstream users and to the river downstream of
to each discrete time period. The reservoir those users as dened by the allocation policy

Fig. 3.3 Conceptual model of a reservoir water allocation system to be simulated


3.4 Simulation and Optimization 83

Fig. 3.4 Reservoir operating policy dening the reser- in the reservoir release policy indicates the zone of
voir release to be made as a function of the current storage feasible releases. It is physically impossible to make
volume and current inflow and the allocation policy for releases represented by points outside that blue zone
the river flow downstream of the reservoir. The blue zone

(lower Fig. 3.4). The resulting benets can be simulation process continues for the duration of
calculated and stored in an output database. the simulation run. Then the output data can be
Additional data including storage volumes, summarized for later comparison with other sim-
releases, and the allocations themselves can also ulation results based on other reservoir capacities,
be stored in the output database, as desired. The operation policies and/or allocation policies.
84 3 Models for Identifying and Evaluating Alternatives

Fig. 3.5 Flow diagram of the reservoiruser allocation system simulation process. The simulation terminates after
some predened number of simulation time steps

It would not be too difcult to write a com- and qualities under a variety of system infras-
puter program to perform this simulation. In fact, tructure designs and operating policies.
it can be done on a spreadsheet. However as easy
as that might be for anyone familiar with com-
puter programming or spreadsheets, one cannot 3.4.2 Defining What to Simulate
expect it to be easy for many practicing water
resources planners and managers who are not Before the simple system shown in Fig. 3.3 can
doing this type of work on a regular basis. Yet be simulated the design and operating policy of
they might wish to perform a simulation of their the system, i.e., the information shown in
particular system, and to do it in a way that Fig. 3.4 needs to be dened. One way to do this
facilitates changes in many of its assumptions. is to use optimization. Optimization is driven by
Computer programs capable of simulating a wide an objective function. Assume an overall mea-
variety of water resources systems are becoming sure of system performance has been decided
increasingly available. Simulation programs upon, and can be expressed as a function of the
together with their interfaces that facilitate the decision variables. These decision variables
input and editing of data and the display of include all the information in Fig. 3.3, namely
output data are typically called decision support the reservoir capacity and reservoir storage and
systems. Their input data dene the components release and water user allocation decisions in
of the water resources system and their congu- each time period. Of interest are the values of
ration. Inputs also include hydrological data and these decision variables that achieve the highest
design and operating policy data. These generic level of system performance. The use of an
simulation programs are capable of simulating optimization model will help in dening those
surface and ground water flows, storage volumes variable values.
3.4 Simulation and Optimization 85

Expressed in words, the optimization model is single-period optimization model containing only
to be developed and used to identify the decision the allocation benets as the objective, B(A), and
variable values that maximize system perfor- constraint 3.10 for a single period, and various
mance. Let B(K, S, R, A) represent the overall values of the water available, R Q, assuming
system performance measure, as a function of the the benets, B(A), do not change over time.
reservoir capacity K, and all the initial storage
volumes, S(t), releases, R(t), and water alloca- Maximize BA1; A2; A3 3:11
tions to users i, A(i,t), in each time period t for a
total of T time periods. Hence the objective is to Subject to:

maximize B K; S; R; A 3:7 A1 A2 A3  R  Q
3:12
for various values of R; given Q:
while making sure that a mass balance of water is
maintained in the reservoir over time.
3.4.3 Simulation Versus Optimization
St InflowtRt St 1 for each period t
and period T 1 1 Unlike simulation models, the solutions of opti-
3:8 mization models are based on objective functions
that are to be maximized or minimized. The
These mass balance equations dene the objective function and constraints of an opti-
relationship between initial, S(t), and nal, S mization model contain decision variables that are
(t + 1) storage volume values in each period t, unknown and parameters whose values are
and equate the nal storage value in each period assumed known. Constraints are expressed as
to the initial value in the following period. equations and inequalities. The tank model
Finally, it assumes the entire simulation process (Eqs. 3.1, 3.2 and 3.3) is an example of an opti-
repeats itself after every T years. mization model. So is the reservoir water alloca-
The next set of constraints ensure that the tion model, Eqs. 3.73.10 and the single-period
storage volumes, S(t), do not exceed the reservoir allocation model Eqs. 3.11 and 3.12.
storage capacity K and that the allocations, A(i, The solution of an optimization model, if one
t), to the three water users i do not exceed the exists, contains the values of all of the unknown
reservoir release, R(t), less the amount to remain decision variables. It is mathematically optimal
in the stream, Q(t). in that the values of the decision variables satisfy
all the constraints and maximize or minimize an
St  K for each period t: 3:9 objective function. This optimal solution is of
course based on the assumed values of the model
parameters, the chosen objective function and the
A1; t A2; t A3; t  RtQt
3:10 structure of the model itself. At best these
for each period t:
assumptions can only approximate reality.
The assumptions made to permit model solu-
This simple example ignores many of the
tion by optimization solution procedures (algo-
details one should consider when modeling
rithms), may justify a more detailed and more
reservoirs and water users, and many of these
realistic simulation to check and improve on any
details will be discussed, and modeled, in sub-
solution obtained from that optimization. While
sequent chapters. But for now the model is suf-
the results from a simulation model may be more
cient to nd values for each decision variable
realistic, both optimization and simulation models
shown in upper portion of Fig. 3.4. The alloca-
are approximations of the real system being
tion policies shown in the lower portion of
modeled. The optimal solution of any model is
Fig. 3.4 can be obtained by solving a separate
optimal only with respect to the particular model,
86 3 Models for Identifying and Evaluating Alternatives

Fig. 3.6 Distinguishing between simulation and opti- questions. Both types of models are typically used in
mization modeling. Simulation addresses what if ques- water resources planning and management studies
tions; optimization can address what should be

not necessarily with respect to the real system. It is of plans and policies to a few that can then be
important to realize this limited meaning of the simulated and better evaluated is often called
word optimal, a term commonly found in papers preliminary screening.
published by water resources and other systems
analysts, planners, and engineers.
Figure 3.6 illustrates the broad differences 3.5 Conclusions
between simulation and optimization. Optimiza-
tion models need explicit expressions of objec- This chapter has reviewed some basic types of
tives. Simulation models do not. Simulation models and presented guidelines for their use.
simply addresses what-if scenarioswhat may Generic models for water resources system anal-
happen if a particular scenario is assumed or if a yses are increasingly becoming available, saving
particular decision is made. Users of simulation many organizations from having to develop their
models must specify the values of design and own individual models. While many readers of
operating decision variables before a simulation this book may get involved in writing their own
can be performed. Once these values of all models, most of those involved in water resources
decision variables are dened, simulation can planning and management will be using existing
provide more precise estimates of the impacts models and analyzing and presenting their results.
that may result from those decisions. The information provided in this book is intended
While optimization will tell us what we should to help those who wish to build their modeling
dowhat the best decision isthat solution is skills. Such skills will be useful to those involved
often based on many limiting assumptions. in water resource systems planning and manage-
Because of this, we need to use optimization not ment activities. Such skills may be useful even to
as a way to nd the best solution, but to dene a those who are expected to oversee or evaluate the
relatively small number of good alternatives that model results of others (say from various UN,
can later be tested, evaluated, and improved by World Bank, or national aid agencies) who are
means of more detailed simulations. This process involved in analyzing particular water resource
of using optimization to reduce the large number systems in particular regions of the world.
Reference 87

Reference Loucks, D. P., Stedinger, J. S., & Haith, D. A. (1981).


Water resources systems planning and analysis.
Englewood Clifts, N.J.: Prentice Hall.
Hipel, K. W., Fang, L., Cullmann, J., & Bristow, M. Maass, A., Hufschmidt, M. M., Dorfman, R., Thomas, H.
(Eds.). (2015). Conflict resolution in water resources A., Marglin, S. A., & Fair, G. M. (1962). Design of
and environmental management. Cham, Heidelberg, water resources systems. Cambridge, UK: Harvard
New York, Dordrecht, London: Springer. University Press.
Reitsma, R. F., & Carron, J. C. (1997). Object-oriented
simulation and evaluation of river basin operations.
Journal of Geographic Information and Decision
Additional References Analysis, 1(1), 924.
(Further Reading) Rizzoli, A. E., Davis, J. R., & Abel, D. J. (1998). Model
and data integration and re-use in environmental
decision support systems. Decision Support Systems,
Abbott, M. B. (1999). Introducing hydroinformatics. 24(2), 127144.
Journal of Hydroinformatics, 1(1), 320. Rizzoli, A. E., & Young, W. J. (1997). Delivering
Beck, M. B. (1987). Water quality modeling: A review of environmental decision support systems: Software
the analysis of uncertainty. Water Resources tools and techniques. Environmental Modeling &
Research, 23, 13931442. Software, 12(23), 237249.
Biswas, A. K. (Ed.). (1997). Water resources: Environ- Sargent, R. G. (1982). Verication and validation of
mental planning, management, and development. New simulation models. In F. E. Cellier (Ed.), Progress in
York: McGraw-Hill. modelling and simulation (pp. 159169). London:
Bobba, A., Ghosh, S., Vijay, P., & Bengtsson, L. (2000). Academic Press.
Application of environmental models to different hydro- Sargent, R. G. (1984a). A tutorial on verication and
logical systems. Ecological Modelling, 125, 1549. validation of simulation models. In: S. Sheppard, U.
Booch, G. (1994). Object-oriented analysis with applica- Pooch, & D. Pegden (Eds.), Proceedings of the 1984
tions. Benjamin Cummings: Redwood City. Winter Simulation Conference (pp. 11521). Piscat-
Chan, H. W., & Lam, P. F. (1997). Visualizing Input and away: N.J. Institute of Electrical and Electronics
output analysis for simulation. Simulation Practice Engineers.
and Theory, 5(5), 425453. Sargent, R. G. (1984b). Simulation model validation. In:
Edsall, R. M., Harrower, M., & Mennis, J. L. (2000). T. I. ren, B. P. Zeigler, & M. S. Elzas (Eds.),
Tools for visualizing properties of spatial and temporal Simulation and model-based methodologies: An inte-
periodicities in geographic data. Computers & Geo- grative view (pp. 53755). Berlin: Springer (No. 10 in
sciences, 26(1), 109118. the series: NATO ASI Series F: Computer and
Fedra, K., & Jamieson, D. G. (1996). An object-oriented Systems Sciences).
approach to model integration: A river basin informa- Scholten, H., Van Waveren, R. H., Groot, S., Van Geer, F.
tion system example. In: K. Kowar & H. P. Nachtnebel C., Wsten, J. H. M., Koeze, R. D., et al. (2000). Good
(Eds.), Proceedings of the HydroGIS96 Conference, Modelling Practice in Water Management, Proceed-
(vol. 235, pp. 669676). Vienna: IAHS Press. ings Hydroinformatics 2000. Cedar Rapids, Iowa:
Guariso, G., & Werthner, H. (1989). Environmental decision International Association for Hydraulic Research.
support systems. New York: Ellis Horwood-Wiley. Singh, V. P. (Ed.). (1995). Computer models of watershed
Ho, J. K. K., & Sculli, D. (1997). The scientic approach hydrology. Littleton, Colorado: Water Resources
to problem solving and decision support systems. Publications.
International Journal of Production Economics, 48 Sun, L., & Liu, K. (2001). A method for interactive
(3), 249257. articulation of information requirements for strategic
Hufschmidt, M. M., & Fiering, M. B. (1966). Simulation decision support. Information and Software Technol-
in the design of water resource systems. Cambridge, ogy, 43(4), 247263.
Massachusetts: Harvard University Press. Van Waveren, R. H., Groot, S., Scholten, H., Van Geer,
Lam, D. C. L., Mayeld, C. I., & Sawyne, D. A. (1994). F. C., Wsten, J. H. M., Koeze, R. D., et al. (1999).
A prototype information system for watershed man- Good modelling practice handbook (STOWA report
agement and planning. Journal of Biological Systems, 9905). Lelystad, The Netherlands: Dutch Department
2(4), 499517. of Public Works, Institute for Inland Water Manage-
Lam, D., & Swayne, D. (2001). Issues of EIS software ment and Waste Water Treatment (report 99.036).
design: Some lessons learned in the past decade. Watkins, D. W. Jr., (Ed.). (2013). Water resources
Environmental Modeling and Software, 16(5), 419425. systems analysis through case studies: Data and
LAW, A. M., & KELTON, W. D. (2000). Simulation models for decision making (168 pp). Reston, VA:
modeling and analysis (3rd ed.). Boston, Mass: ASCE Press.
McGraw-Hill.
88 3 Models for Identifying and Evaluating Alternatives

Young, P. (1998). Data-based mechanistic modeling of 3:6 Consider the following ve alternatives
environmental, ecological, economic and engineering for the production of energy
systems. Environmental Modeling & Software, 13,
105122. (103 kwh/day) and irrigation supplies
Young, W. J., Lam, D. C. L., Ressel, V., & Wong, J. W. (106 m3/month):
(2000). Development of an environmental flows
decision support system. Environmental Modeling & Alternative Energy production Irrigation supply
Software, 15, 257265.
Zeigler, B. P. (1976). Theory of modelling and simulation. A 22 20
Malabar, Florida: Robert E. Krieger. B 10 35
Zeiler, M. (1999). Modeling our world: The ESRI guide to
geodatabase design. Redlands, California: ESRI. C 20 32
D 12 21
E 6 25

Exercises Which alternative would be the best in your


opinion and why? Why might a decision-
3:1 Briefly outline why multiple disciplines maker select alternative E even realizing
are needed to efciently and effectively other alternatives exist that can give more
manage water resources in major river hydropower energy and irrigation supply?
basins, or even in local watersheds. 3:7 Dene a model similar to Eqs. 3.13.3 for
3:2 Describe in a page or two what some of nding the dimensions of a cylindrical
the water management issues are in the tank that minimizes the total cost of stor-
region where you live. ing a specied volume of water. What are
3:3 Dene adaptive management, shared the unknown decision variables? What are
vision modeling, and sustainability. the model parameters? Develop an itera-
3:4 Distinguish what a manager does from tive approach for solving this model.
what an analyst (modeler) does. 3:8 Briefly distinguish between simulation and
3:5 Identify some typical or common water optimization.
resources planning or management prob- 3:9 Consider a tank, a lake or reservoir or an
lems that are suitable for analysis using aquifer having inflows and outflows as
quantitative systems analysis techniques. shown in the graph below.

Flows (m3/day)

Inflow

0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Time (days)
Exercises 89

(a) When was the inflow its maximum (e) Write a mass balance equation for the
and minimum values? time series of storage volumes
(b) When was the outflow its minimum assuming constant inflows and out-
value? flows during each time period.
(c) When was the storage volume its
maximum value? 3:10 Given the changing inflows and constant
(d) When was the storage volume its outflow from a tank or reservoir, as shown
minimum value? in the graph below, sketch a plot of the

Flows (m3/day)
100

Inflow
Oulow
50

0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Time (days)

Relave Storage
(m3)
300

150

0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Time (days)
90 3 Models for Identifying and Evaluating Alternatives

storage volumes over the same period of Find the values of the storage capacity K
time, beginning at 150. Show how to required for yields of 2, 3, 3.5, 4, 4.5, and 5.
determine the value of the slope of the 3:14 How many different simulations of a water
storage volume plot at any time from the resource system would be required to
inflow and outflow (= 50 m3/day) graph ensure that there is at least a 95% chance
below. that the best solution obtained is within the
3:11 Describe, using words and a flow diagram, better 5% of all possible solutions that
how you might simulate the operation of a could be obtained? What assumptions must
storage reservoir over time. To simulate a be made in order for your answer to be
reservoir, what data do you need to have valid? Can any statement be made com-
or know? paring the value of the best solution
3:12 Identify and discuss a water resources obtained from the all the simulations to the
planning situation that illustrates the need value of the truly optimal solution?
for a combined optimization-simulation 3:15 Assume in a particular river basin 20
study in order to identify the best plan and development projects are being proposed.
its impacts. Assume each project has a xed capacity
3:13 Write a flow chart/computer simulation and operating policy and it is only a ques-
program for computing the maximum tion of which of the 20 projects would
yield of water that can be obtained given maximize the net benets to the region.
any value of active reservoir storage Assuming 5 min of computer time is
capacity, K, using. required to simulate and evaluate each
combination of projects, show that it would
require 36 days of computer time even if
Year y Flow Qy Year y Flow Qy 99% of the alternative combinations could
1 5 9 3 be discarded using good judgment. What
2 7 10 6 does this suggest about the use of simula-
3 8 11 8 tion for regional interdependent multipro-
4 4 12 9
ject water resources planning?
3:16 Assume you wish to determine the alloca-
5 3 13 3
tion of water Xj to three different users j,
6 3 14 4
who obtain benets Rj(Xj). The total water
7 2 15 9 available is Q. Write a flow chart showing
8 1 how you can nd the allocation to each user
that results in the highest total benets.
3:17 Consider the allocation problem illustrated
below.

User 2

Gage site
User 1
User 3
Exercises 91

The allocation priority in each simulation per- This will be a graph of the allocation as a
iod t is: function of the flow at the allocation site.
First 10 units of streamflow at the gage remain (b) Simulate this allocation policy using any
in the stream. river basin simulation model such as
Next 20 units go to User 3. RIBASIM, WEAP, Modsim, or other
Next 60 units are equally shared by Users 1 selected model, including your own, for
and 2. any specied inflow series ranging from 0
Next 10 units go to User 2. to 130 units.
Remainder goes downstream.

(a) Assume no incremental flow along the


stream and no return flow from users.
Dene the allocation policy at each site.

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
An Introduction to Optimization
Models and Methods 4

Water resource systems are characterized by modeling approaches are illustrated by their
multiple interdependent components that toge- application to some relatively simple water
ther produce multiple economic, environmental, resources planning and management problems.
ecological, and social impacts. As discussed in The purpose here is to introduce and compare
the previous chapter, planners and managers some commonly used optimization methods and
working toward improving the design and per- approaches. This is not a text on the state of the
formance of these complex systems must identify art of optimization modeling. More realistic and
and evaluate alternative designs and operating more complex problems usually require much
policies, comparing their predicted performance bigger and more complex models than those
with desired goals or objectives. Typically, this developed and discussed in this chapter, but
identication and evaluation process is accom- these bigger and more complex models are often
plished with the aid of optimization and simula- based on the principles and techniques intro-
tion models. While optimization methods are duced here.
designed to provide preferred values of system The emphasis here is on the art of model
design and operating policy variablesvalues developmentjust how one goes about con-
that will lead to the highest levels of system structing and solving optimization models that
performancethey are often used to eliminate will provide information useful for addressing
the clearly inferior options. Using optimization and perhaps even solving particular problems. It
for a preliminary screening followed by more is unlikely anyone will ever use any of the
detailed and accurate simulation is the primary specic models developed in this or other chap-
way we have, short of actually building physical ters simply because the specic examples used to
models, of estimating effective system designs illustrate the approach to model development and
and operating policies. This chapter introduces solution will not be the ones they face. However,
and illustrates the art of optimization model de- it is quite likely water resource managers and
velopment and use in analyzing water resources planners will use these modeling approaches and
systems. The models and methods introduced in solution methods to analyze a variety of water
this chapter are extended in subsequent chapters. resource systems. The particular systems mod-
eled and analyzed here, or any others that could
have been used, can be the core of more complex
4.1 Introduction models needed to analyze more complex prob-
lems in practice.
This chapter introduces some optimization Water resources planning and management
modeling approaches for identifying ways of today is dominated by the use of optimization
satisfying specied goals or objectives. The and simulation models. Computer software is

The Author(s) 2017 93


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_4
94 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

becoming increasingly available for solving mutually exclusive alternatives (only one of
various types of optimization and simulation which can be selected) each characterized by a
models. However, no software currently exists time series of benets and costs. Using various
that will build models of particular water methods involving the discount rate, the time
resource systems. What and what not to include series of benets and costs are converted to a
and assume in models requires judgment, expe- single net benet that can be compared with
rience, and knowledge of the particular problems other such net benets in order to identify the one
being addressed, the system being modeled and that is best. The values of the decision variables
the decision-making environmentincluding (e.g., the design and operating policy variable
what aspects can be changed and what cannot. values) are known for each discrete alternative
Understanding the contents of this and following being considered. For example, consider again
chapters and performing the suggested exercises the tank design problem presented in the previ-
at the end of each chapter can only be a rst step ous chapter. Alternative tank designs could be
toward gaining some judgment and experience in identied, and then each could be evaluated, on
model development. the basis of cost and perhaps other criteria as
Before proceeding to a more detailed discus- well. The best would be called the optimal one, at
sion of optimization, a review of some methods least with respect to the objective criteria used
of dealing with time streams of economic and the discrete alternatives being considered.
incomes or costs (engineering economics) may The optimization methods introduced in the
be useful. Those familiar with this subject that is following sections of this chapter extend those
typically covered in applied engineering eco- engineering economics methods. Some methods
nomics courses can skip this next section. are discrete, some are continuous. Continuous
optimization methods, such as the model dened
by Eqs. 3.13.3 in Sect. 3.2 of the previous
4.2 Comparing Time Streams chapter can identify the best tank design
of Economic Benefits and Costs directly without having to identify and compare
numerous discrete, mutually exclusive alterna-
All of us make decisions that involve future tives. Just how such models can be solved will be
benets and costs. The extent to which we value discussed later in this chapter. For now, consider
future benets or costs compared to present the comparison of alternative discrete plans
benets or costs is reflected by what is called a p having different benets and costs over time.
discount rate. While economic criteria are only Let the net benet generated at the end of time
one aspect of everything we consider when period t by plan p be designated simply as Bp(t).
making decisions, they are often among the Each plan is characterized by the time stream
important ones. Economic evaluation methods of net benets it generates over its planning
involving discount rates can be used to consider period Tp.
and compare alternatives characterized by vari-
ous benets and costs that are expected to occur fBp 1; Bp 2; Bp 3; . . .; Bp Tp 4:1
now and in the future. This section offers a quick
and basic review of the use of discount rates that Clearly, if in any time period t the benets
enable comparisons of alternative time series of exceed the costs, then Bp t [ 0; and if the costs
benets and costs. Many economic optimization exceed the benets, Bp t\0. This section
models incorporate discount rates in their eco- denes two ways of comparing different benet,
nomic objective functions. cost or net-benet time streams produced by
Engineering economic methods typically different plans perhaps having different planning
focus on the comparison of a discrete set of period durations Tp.
4.2 Comparing Time Streams of Economic Benefits and Costs 95

4.2.1 Interest Rates each amount in the time series to what it is worth
today, its present worth, that is, a single value at
Fundamental to the conversion of a time series of the present time. This present worth will depend
incomes and costs to an equivalent single value, so on the prevailing interest rate in each future time
that it can be compared to other equivalent single period. Assuming a value V0 is invested at the
values of other time series, is the concept of the beginning of a time period, e.g., a year, in a
time value of money. From time to time, individ- project or a savings account earning interest at a
uals, private corporations, and governments need rate r per period, then at the end of the period the
to borrow money to do what they want to do. The value of that investment is (1 + r)V0.
amount paid back to the lender has two compo- If one invests an amount V0 at the beginning
nents: (1) the amount borrowed and (2) an addi- of period t = 1 and at the end of that period
tional amount called interest. The interest amount immediately reinvests the total amount (the
is the cost of borrowing money, of having the original investment plus interest earned), and
money when it is loaned compared to when it is continues to do this for n consecutive periods at
paid back. In the private sector the interest rate, the the same period interest rate r, the value, Vn, of
added fraction of the amount owed that equals the that investment at the end of n periods would be
interest, is often identied as the marginal rate of
return on capital. Those who have money, called Vn V0 1 r n 4:2
capital, can either use it themselves or they can
lend it to others, including banks, and receive This results from V1 V0 =1 r at the end of
interest. Assuming people with capital invest their period 1, V2 V1 =1 r V0 1 r2 at the end
money where it yields the largest amount of of period 2, and so on until at the end of period n.
interest, consistent with the risk they are willing to The initial amount V0 is said to be equivalent
take, most investors should be receiving at least the to Vn at the end of n periods. Thus the present
prevailing interest rate as the return on their capital. worth or present value, V0, of an amount of
Any interest earned by an investor or paid by money Vn at the end of period n is
a debtor depends on the size of the loan, the
duration of the loan, and the interest rate. The V0 Vn = 1 r n 4:3
interest rate includes a number of considerations.
One is the time value of money (a willingness to Equation 4.3 is the basic compound interest
pay something to obtain money now rather than discounting relation needed to determine the
to obtain the same amount later). Another is the present value at the beginning of period 1 (or end
risk of losing capital (not getting the full amount of period 0) of net benets Vn that accrue at the
of a loan or investment returned at some future end of n time periods.
time). A third is the risk of reduced purchasing The total present value of the net benets
capability (the expected inflation over time). The generated by plan p, denoted V0p , is the sum of
greater the risks of losing capital or purchasing the values of the net benets Vp(t) accrued at the
power, the higher the interest rate compared to end of each time period t times the discount
the rate reflecting only the time value of money factor for that period t. Assuming the interest or
in a secure and inflation-free environment. discount rate r in the discount factor applies for
the duration of the planning period, i.e., from
t = 1 to t = Tp.
4.2.2 Equivalent Present Value
X
V0p V p t=1 r t 4:4
To compare projects or plans involving different t1;Tp
time series of benets and costs, it is often con-
venient to express these time series as a single The present value of the net benets achieved
equivalent value. One way to do this is to convert by two or more plans having the same economic
96 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

planning horizons Tp can be used as an economic This factor is often used to compute the
basis for plan selection. If the economic lives or equivalent annual end-of-year cost of engineer-
planning horizons of projects differ, then the ing structures that have a xed initial construc-
present value of the plans may not be an appro- tion cost C0 and annual end-of-year operation,
priate measure for comparison and plan selection. maintenance, and repair (OMR) costs. The
A valid comparison of alternative plans using equivalent uniform end-of-year total annual cost,
present values is possible if all plans have the TAC, equals the initial cost times the capital
same planning horizon or if funds remaining at recovery factor plus the equivalent annual
the end of the shorter planning horizon are end-of-year uniform OMR costs.
invested for the remaining time up until the longer
planning horizon at the same interest rate r. TAC CRFn C0 OMR 4:8

For private investments requiring borrowed


4.2.3 Equivalent Annual Value
capital, interest rates are usually established, and
hence xed, at the time of borrowing. However,
If the lives of various plans differ, but the same
benets may be affected by changing interest
plans will be repeated on into the future, then one
rates, which are not easily predicted. It is com-
need to only compare the equivalent constant
mon practice in benetcost analyses to assume
annual net benets of each plan. Finding the
constant interest rates over time, for lack of any
average or equivalent annual amount Vp is done
better assumption.
in two steps. First, one can compute the present
Interest rates available to private investors or
value, V0p , of the time stream of net benets,
borrowers may not be the same rates that are used
using Eq. 4.4. The equivalent constant annual
for analyzing public investment decisions. In an
benets, Vp, all discounted to the present must
economic evaluation of public-sector invest-
equal the present value, V0p .
ments, the same relationships are used even
X though government agencies are not generally
V0p V p = 1 r t or free to loan or borrow funds on private money
t1;Tp
X 4:5 markets. In the case of public-sector investments,
V p V0p = 1=1 r t the interest rate to be used in an economic anal-
t1;Tp
ysis is a matter of public policy; it is the rate at
which the government is willing to forego current
Using a little algebra the average annual
benets to its citizens in order to provide benets
end-of-year benets Vp of the project or plan p is
to those living in future time periods. It can be
   
V p V0p r1 rTp = 1 rTp  1 4:6 viewed as the governments estimate of the time
value of public monies or the marginal rate of
The capital recovery factor CRFn is the return to be achieved by public investments.
    These denitions and concepts of engineering
expression r1 rTp = 1 rTp  1 in Eq. 4.6
economics are applicable to many of the prob-
that converts a xed payment or present value V0p
lems faced in water resources planning and
at the beginning of the rst time period into an
management. Each of the equations above is
equivalent xed periodic payment Vp at the end
applicable to discrete alternatives whose decision
of each time period. If the interest rate per period
variables (investments over time) are known. The
is r and there are n periods involved, then the
equations are used to identify the best alternative
capital recovery factor is
from a set of mutually exclusive alternatives
CRFn r1 rn =1 rn  1 4:7 whose decision variable values are known. More
detailed discussions of the application of
4.2 Comparing Time Streams of Economic Benefits and Costs 97

engineering economics are contained in numer- as well as other constrained optimization proce-
ous texts on the subject. In the next section, we dures is highly dependent on the mathematical
introduce methods that can identify the best structure of the model that in turn is dependent
alternative among those whose decision variable on the system being analyzed. Individuals tend to
values are not known. For example, engineering construct models in a way that will allow them to
economic methods can identify, for example, the use a particular optimization technique they think
most cost-effective tank from among those whose is best. Thus, it pays to be familiar with various
dimension values have been previously selected. types of optimization methods since no one
The optimization methods that follow can iden- method is best for all optimization problems.
tify directly the values of the dimensions of most Each has its strengths and limitations. The
cost-effective tank. remainder of this chapter introduces and illus-
trates the application of some of the most com-
mon constrained optimization techniques used in
4.3 Nonlinear Optimization Models water resources planning and management.
and Solution Procedures Consider a river from which diversions are
made to three water-consuming rms that belong
Constrained optimization involves nding the to the same corporation, as illustrated in Fig. 4.1.
values of decision variables given specied Each rm makes a product. Water is needed in
relationships that have to be satised. Con- the process of making that product, and is the
strained optimization is also called mathematical critical resource. The three rms can be denoted
programming. Mathematical programming tech- by the index j = 1, 2, and 3 and their water al-
niques include calculus-based Lagrange multi- locations by xj. Assume the problem is to deter-
pliers and various methods for solving linear and mine the allocations xj of water to each of three
nonlinear models including dynamic program- rms (j = 1, 2, 3) that maximize the total net
P
ming, quadratic programming, fractional pro- benets, j NBj xj , obtained from all three
gramming, and geometric programming, to rms. The total amount of water available is
mention a few. The applicability of each of these constrained or limited to a quantity of Q.

Fig. 4.1 Three water-using rms obtain water from a river. The amounts xj allocated to each rm j will depend on the
river flow Q
98 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Fig. 4.2 Concave net benet functions for three water users, j, and their slopes at allocations xj

Assume the net benets, NBj(xj), derived from units must remain in the river. Introducing this
water xj allocated to each rm j, are dened by constraint renders the previous solution infeasi-
ble. In this case we want to nd the allocations
NB1 x1 6x1  x21 4:9 that maximize the total net benets obtained from
all rms subject to having only 6 flow units
available for allocations. Using simple calculus
NB2 x2 7x2  1:5x22 4:10 will not sufce.

NB3 x3 8x3  0:5x23 4:11 4.3.2 Solution Using Hill Climbing


These are concave functions exhibiting
One approach for nding, at least approximately,
decreasing marginal net benets with increasing
the particular allocations that maximize the total
allocations. These functions look like hills, as
net benet derived from all rms in this example
illustrated in Fig. 4.2.
is an incremental steepest-hill-climbing method.
This method divides the total available flow
Q into increments and allocates each successive
4.3.1 Solution Using Calculus increment so as to get the maximum additional
net benet from that incremental amount of
Calculus can be used to nd the allocations that water. This procedure works in this example
maximize each users net benets, simply by because each of the net benet functions is con-
nding where the slope or derivative of the net cave; in other words, the marginal benets
benet function for each rm equals zero. The decrease as the allocation increases. This proce-
derivative, dNB(x1)/dx1, of the net benet func- dure is illustrated by the flow diagram in Fig. 4.3.
tion for Firm 1 is (6 2x1) and hence the allo- Table 4.1 lists the results of applying the
cation to Firm 1 that maximizes its net benets procedure shown in Fig. 4.3 to the problem when
would be 6/2 or 3. The corresponding allocations (a) only 8 and (b) only 20 flow units are avail-
for Firms 2 and 3 are 2.33 and 8, respectively. able. Here a minimum river flow of 2 is required
The total amount of water desired by all rms is and is to be satised, when possible, before any
the sum of each rms desired allocation, or allocations are made to the rms.
13.33 flow units. However, suppose only 8 units The hill-climbing method illustrated in
of flow are available for all three rms and 2 Fig. 4.3 and Table 4.1 assigns each incremental
4.3 Nonlinear Optimization Models and Solution Procedures 99

Fig. 4.3 Steepest hill-climbing approach for nding allocation of a flow Qmax to the three rms, while meeting
minimum river flow requirements R

flow Q to the use that yields the largest addi- using any calculus-based optimization procedure
tional (marginal) net benet. An allocation is or algorithm.
optimal for any total flow Q when the marginal
net benets from each nonzero allocation are
equal, or as close to each other as possible given 4.3.3 Solution Using Lagrange
the size of the increment Q. In this example, Multipliers
with a Q of 1 and Qmax of 8, it just happens that
the marginal net benets associated with each 4.3.3.1 Approach
allocation are all equal (to 4). The smaller the As an alternative to hill-climbing methods, con-
Q, the more precise will be the optimal allo- sider a calculus-based method involving
cations in each iteration, as shown in the lower Lagrange multipliers. To illustrate this approach,
portion of Table 4.1, where Q approaches 0. a slightly more complex water-allocation exam-
Based on the allocations derived for various ple will be used. Assume that the benet, Bj(xj),
values of available water Q, as shown in each water-using rm receives is determined, in
Table 4.1, an allocation policy can be dened. part, by the quantity of product it produces and
For this problem, the allocation policy that the price per unit of the product that is charged.
maximizes total net benets for any particular As before, these products require water and water
value of Q is shown in Fig. 4.4. is the limiting resource. The amount of product
This hill-climbing approach leads to optimal produced, pj, by each rm j is dependent on the
allocations only if all of the net benet functions amount of water, xj, allocated to it.
whose sum is being maximized are concave: that Let the function Pj(xj) represent the maximum
is, the marginal net benets decrease as the amount of product, pj, that can be produced by
allocation increases. Otherwise, only a local rm j from an allocation of water xj. These are
optimum solution can be guaranteed. This is true called production functions. They are typically
100 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Table 4.1 Hill-climbing iterations for nding allocations that maximize total net benet given a flow of Qmax and a
required (minimum) streamflow of R = 2

Fig. 4.4 Water-allocation


policy that maximizes total
net benets derived from
all three water-using rms
4.3 Nonlinear Optimization Models and Solution Procedures 101

concave: as xj increases the slope, dPj(xj)/dxj, of be demanded and sold. These are the demand
the production function, Pj(xj), decreases. For functions for that product. These unit price or
this example, assume the production functions demand functions are shown in Fig. 4.5, where
for the three water-using rms are the pj s are the amounts of each product pro-
duced. The vertical axis of each graph is the unit
P1 x1 0:4x1 0:9 4:12 price. To simplify the problem we are assuming
linear demand functions, but this assumption is
not a necessary condition.
P2 x2 0:5x2 0:8 4:13 The optimization problem is to nd the water
allocations, the production levels, and the unit
prices that together maximize the total net benet
P3 x3 0:6x3 0:7 4:14 obtained from all three rms. The water alloca-
tions plus the amount that must remain in the
Next consider the cost of production. Assume river, R, cannot exceed the total amount of water
the associated cost of production can be expres- Q available.
sed by the following convex functions: Constructing and solving a model of this
problem for various values of Q, the total amount
C1 3P1 x1 1:3 4:15
of water available, will dene the three allocation
policies as functions of Q. These policies can be
displayed as a graph, as in Fig. 4.4, showing the
C2 5P2 x2 1:2 4:16
three best allocations given any value of Q. This
of course assumes the rms can adjust to varying
C3 6P3 x3 1:15 4:17 allocations. In reality this may not be the case
(Chapter 9 examines this problem using more
Each rm produces a unique patented product, realistic benet functions that reflect the degree
and hence it can set and control the unit price of to which rms can adapt to changing inputs over
its product. The lower the unit price, the greater time.)
the demand and thus the more each rm can sell. The model:
Each rm has determined the relationship
Maximize Net benefit 4:18
between the unit price and the amount that will

Fig. 4.5 Unit prices that will guarantee the sale of the specied amounts of products pj produced in each of the three
rms (linear functions are assumed in this example for simplicity)
102 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Subject to Derivatives:
Denitional constraints:
@Net benefit)=@p1 0
Net benefit Total return  Total cost 12  2p1  1:33p0:3
1
4:19 4:27

Total return 12  p1 p1 20  1:5p2 p2 @Net benefit)=@p2 0


28  2:5p3 p3 20  3p2  1:25p0:2
2
4:20 4:28

Total cost 3p1 1:30 5p2 1:20 6p3 1:15 @ Net benefit=@p3 0
4:21 28  5p3  1:156p0:15
3
4:29
Production functions dening the relationship
between water allocations xj and production pj
The result (rounded off) is p1 = 3.2, p2 = 4.0,
0:9 and p3 = 3.9 to be sold for unit prices of 8.77,
p1 0:4x1 4:22
13.96, and 18.23, respectively, for a maximum
p2 0:5x2 0:8 4:23 net revenue of 155.75. This would require water
allocations x1 = 10.2, x2 = 13.6, and x3 = 14.5,
p3 0:6x3 0:7 4:24 totaling 38.3 flow units. Any amount of water
less than 38.3 will restrict the allocation to, and
Water-allocation restriction hence the product production at, one or more of
the three rms.
R x1 x2 x3 Q 4:25 If the total available amount of water is less
than that desired, constraint Eq. 4.25 can be
One can rst solve this model for the values of written as an equality, since all the water avail-
each pj that maximize the total net benets, able, less any that must remain in the river, R,
assuming water is not a limiting constraint. This is will be allocated. If the available water supplies
equivalent to nding each individual rms are less than the desired 38.3 plus the required
maximum net benets, assuming all the water that streamflow R, then Eqs. 4.224.25 need to be
is needed is available. Using calculus we can added. These can be rewritten as equalities since
equate the derivatives of the total net benet they will be binding. Equation 4.25 in this case
function with respect to each pj to 0 and solve can always be an equality since any excess water
each of the resulting three independent equations: will be allocated to the river, R.
To consider values of Q that are less than the
Total Net benefit 12  p1 p1 20  1:5p2 p2
h desired 38.3 units, constraints 4.224.25 can be
28  2:5p3 p3   3p1 1:30 included in the objective function, Eq. 4.26, once
i the right-hand side has been subtracted from the
5p2 1:20 6p3 1:15
left-hand side so that they equal 0. We set this
4:26 function equal to L.
4.3 Nonlinear Optimization Models and Solution Procedures 103

L 12  p1 p1 20  1:5p2 p2 28  2:5p3p3  @L=@p3 0 28  5p3  1:156p0:15


3  k3
h i
 3p1 1:30 5p2 1:20 6p3 1:15 4:33
h i h i
 k1 p1  0:4x1 0:9  k2 p2  0:5x2 0:8 @L=@x1 0 k1 0:90:4x0:1
1  k4 4:34
h i
 k3 p3  0:6x3 0:7  k4 R x1 x2 x3  Q
@L=@x2 0 k2 0:80:5x0:2
2  k4 4:35
4:30
@L=@x3 0 k3 0:70:6x0:3
3  k4 4:36
Since each of the four constraint Eqs. 4.22
4.25 included in Eq. 4.30 equals zero, each can @L=@k1 0 p1  0:4x1 0:9 4:37
be multiplied by a variable i without changing
the value of Eq. 4.30, or equivalently, Eq. 4.26. @L=@k2 0 p2  0:5x2 0:8 4:38
These unknown variables i are called the
Lagrange multipliers of constraints i. The value @L=@k3 0 p3  0:6x3 0:7 4:39
of each multiplier, i, is the marginal value of the
original objective function, Eq. 4.26, with
respect to a change in the value of the amount @L=@k4 0 R x1 x2 x3  Q 4:40
produced, p, or in the case of constraint Eq. 4.25,
the amount of water available, Q. We will show These ten equations are the conditions neces-
this shortly. sary for a solution that maximizes Eq. 4.30, or
Differentiating Eq. 4.30 with respect to each equivalently 4.26. They can be solved to obtain
of the ten unknowns and setting the resulting the values of the ten unknown variables. The
equations to 0 yields: solutions to these equations for various values of
Q, (found in this case using LINGO) are shown in
@L=@p1 0 12  2p1  1:33p0:3
1  k1
Table 4.2. (A free demo version of LINGO can be
obtained (downloaded) from www.LINDO.com.)
4:31
4.3.3.2 Meaning of Lagrange
@L=@p2 0 20  3p2  1:25p0:2
2  k2
Multiplier
4:32 In this example, Eq. 4.30 is the objective func-
tion that is to be maximized. It is maximized or

Table 4.2 Solutions to Eqs. 4.314.40


104 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

minimized by equating to zero each of its partial There is no guarantee that a global optimum
derivatives with respect to each unknown vari- solution will be found using calculus-based
able. Equation 4.30 consists of the original net methods such as this one. Boundary conditions
benet function plus each constraint i multiplied need to be checked. Furthermore, since there is
by a weight or multiplier i. This equation is no difference in the Lagrange multipliers proce-
expressed in monetary units. The added con- dure for nding a minimum or a maximum
straints are expressed in other units: either the solution, one needs to check whether in fact a
quantity of product produced or the amount of maximum or minimum is being obtained. In this
water available. Thus the units of the weights or example, since each net benet function is con-
multipliers i associated with these constraints cave, a maximum will result.
are expressed in monetary units per constraint The meaning of the values of the multipliers i
units. In this example, the multipliers 1, 2, and at the optimum solution can be derived by
3 represent the change in the total net benet manipulation of L/i = 0. Taking the partial
value of the objective function (Eq. 4.26) per derivative of the Lagrange function, Eq. 4.43,
unit change in the products p1, p2, and p3 pro- with respect to an unknown variable xj and set-
duced. The multiplier 4 represents the change in ting it to zero results in
the total net benet per unit change in the water X
available for allocation, Q R. @L=@xj 0 @F=@xj  ki @ gi X =@xj
Note in Table 4.2 that as the quantity of i

available water increases, the marginal net ben- 4:44


ets decrease. This is reflected in the values of
each of the multipliers, i. In other words, the net Multiplying each term by xj yields
revenue derived from a quantity of product pro- X
duced at each of the three rms, and from the @F ki @ gi X 4:45
i
quantity of water available, is a concave function
of those quantities, as illustrated in Fig. 4.2. Dividing each term by bk associated with a
To review the general Lagrange multiplier particular constraint, say k, denes the meaning
approach and derive the denition of the multi- of k.
pliers, consider the general constrained opti-
X
mization problem containing n decision variables @F=@bk ki @gi X=@bk kk 4:46
xj and m constraint equations i. i

Maximize or minimize) FX 4:41 Equation 4.46 follows from the fact that
@gi X=@bk equals 0 for constraints i k and
subject to constraints equals 1 for the constraint i = k. The latter is true
since bi = gi(X) and thus (gi(X)) = bi.
gi X bi i 1; 2; 3; . . .; m; 4:42 From Eq. 4.46, each multiplier i is the mar-
ginal change in the original objective function F
where X is the vector of all xj. The Lagrange
(X) with respect to a change in the constant bi
function L(X, ) is formed by combining
associated with the constraint i. For nonlinear
Eq. 4.42, each equaling zero, with the objective
problems, it is the slope of the objective function
function of Eq. 4.41.
plotted against the value of bi.
X Readers can work out a similar proof if a slack
LX; k F X  ki gi X  bi 4:43
or surplus variable, Si, is included in inequality
i
constraints to make them equations. For a less-
Solutions of the equations L/xj = 0 for all than-or-equal constraint gi(X) bi a squared
decision variables xj and L/i = 0 for all con- slack variable S2i can be added to the left-hand
straints gi are possible local optima.
side to make it an equation gi X S2i bi . For a
4.3 Nonlinear Optimization Models and Solution Procedures 105

greater-than-or-equal constraint gi(X) bi a A possible solution method for constrained


squared surplus variable S2i can be subtracted optimization problems containing continuous
from the left-hand side to make it an equation and/or discontinuous functions of any shape is
gi X  S2i bi . These slack or surplus variables called discrete dynamic programming. Each
are squared to ensure they are nonnegative, and decision variable value can assume one of a set
also to make them appear in the differential of discrete values. For continuous valued objec-
equations. tive functions, the solution derived from discrete
dynamic programming may therefore be only an
@L=@Si 0 2Si ki Si ki 4:47 approximation of the best one. For all practical
purposes this is not a signicant limitation,
Equation 4.47 shows that either the slack or especially if the intervals between the discrete
surplus variable, S, or the multiplier, , will values of the decision variables are not too large
always be zero. If the value of the slack or sur- and if simulation modeling is used to rene the
plus variable S is nonzero, the constraint is solutions identied using dynamic programming.
redundant. The optimal solution will not be Dynamic programming is an approach that
affected by the constraint. Small changes in the divides the original optimization problem, with all
values, b, of redundant constraints will not of its variables, into a set of smaller optimization
change the optimal value of the objective func- problems, each of which needs to be solved before
tion F(X). Conversely, if the constraint is bind- the overall optimum solution to the original
ing, the value of the slack or surplus variable problem can be identied. The water supply allo-
S will be zero. The multiplier can be nonzero if cation problem, for example, needs to be solved
the value of the function F(X) is sensitive to the for a range of water supplies available to each rm.
constraint value b. Once this is done the particular allocations that
The solution of the set of partial differential maximize the total net benet can be determined.
Equations Eqs. 4.47 often involves a trial-and-
error process, equating to zero a or a S for each
inequality constraint and solving the remaining 4.4.1 Dynamic Programming
equations, if possible. This tedious procedure, Networks and Recursive
along with the need to check boundary solutions Equations
when nonnegativity conditions are imposed,
detracts from the utility of classical Lagrange A network of nodes and links can represent each
multiplier methods for solving all but relatively discrete dynamic programming problem.
simple water resources planning problems. Dynamic programming methods nd the best
way to get to, or go from, any node in that net-
work. The nodes represent possible discrete
4.4 Dynamic Programming states of the system that can exist and the links
represent the decisions one could make to get
The water-allocation problems in the previous from one state (node) to another. Figure 4.6
section assumed a net-benet function for each illustrates a portion of such a network for the
water-using rm. In those examples, these func- three-rm allocation problem shown in Fig. 4.1.
tions were continuous and differentiable, a con- In this case the total amount of water available,
venient attribute if methods based on calculus Q R, to all three rms is 10.
(such as hill-climbing or Lagrange multipliers) are Thus, dynamic programming models involve
to be used to nd the best solution. In many states, stages, and decisions. The relationships
practical situations, these functions may not be so among states, stages, and decisions are repre-
continuous, or so conveniently concave for max- sented by networks, such as that shown in
imization or convex for minimization, making Fig. 4.6. The states of the system are the nodes
calculus-based methods for their solution difcult. and the values of the states are the numbers in the
106 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Fig. 4.6 A network


representing some of the
possible integer allocations
of water to three
water-consuming rms
j assuming 10 units of
water are available. The
circles or nodes represent
the discrete quantities of
water available to users not
yet allocated any water, and
the links represent feasible
allocation decisions xj to
the next rm j

nodes. Each node value in this example is the river, is 10. Note from the rst row of Table 4.2
quantity of water available to allocate to all the exact allocation solution is x1 = 1.2,
remaining rms, that is, to all connected links to x2 = 3.7, and x3 = 5.1. Normally, we would not
the right of the node. These state variable values know this solution before solving for it using
typically represent some existing condition either dynamic programming, but since we do we can
before making, or after having made, a decision. reduce the complexity (number of nodes and
The stages of the system are the different com- links) of the dynamic programming network so
ponents (e.g., rms) or time periods. Links that the repetitive process of nding the best
between (or connecting) initial and nal states solution is clearer. Thus assume the range of x1
represent decisions. The links in this example is limited to integer values from 0 to 2, the range
represent possible allocation decisions for each of x2 is from 3 to 5, and the range of x3 is from 4
of the three different rms. Each stage is a sep- to 6. These range limits are imposed here just to
arate rm. Each state is an amount of water that reduce the size of the network. In this case, these
remains to be allocated in the remaining stages. assumptions will not affect or constrain the
Each link connects two nodes, the left node optimal integer solution. If we did not make
value indicating the state of a system before a these assumptions the network would have, after
decision is made, and the right node value indi- the rst column of one node, three columns of
cating the state of a system after a decision is 11 nodes, one representing each integer value
made. In this case, the state of the system is the from 0 to 10. Finer (noninteger) discretizations
amount of water available to allocate to the would involve even more nodes and connecting
remaining rms. links.
In the example shown in Fig. 4.6, the state The links of Fig. 4.6 represent the water allo-
and decision variables are represented by integer cations. Note that the link allocations, the num-
valuesan admittedly fairly coarse discretiza- bers on the links, cannot exceed the amount of
tion. The total amount of water available, in water available, that is, the number in the left
addition to the amount that must remain in the node of the link. The number in the right node is
4.4 Dynamic Programming 107

Fig. 4.7 Network as in


Fig. 4.6 representing
integer value allocations of
water to three
water-consuming rms.
The circles or nodes
represent the discrete
quantities of water
available, and the links
represent feasible allocation
decisions. The numbers on
the links indicate the net
benets obtained from
these particular integer
allocation decisions

the quantity of water remaining after an allocation (representing the allocation decisions we could
has been made. The value in the right node, state make) at each node (state) for each rm (stage).
Sj+1, at the beginning of stage j + 1, is equal to the Figure 4.7 shows the same network as in
value in the left node, Sj, less the amount of water, Fig. 4.6; however the numbers on the links rep-
xj, allocated to rm j as indicated on the link. resent the net benets obtained from the associ-
Hence, beginning with a quantity of water S1 that ated water allocations. For the three rms j = 1,
can be allocated to all three rms, after allocating 2, and 3, the net benets, NBj(xj), associated with
x1 to Firm 1 what remains is S2: allocations xj are

S1  x1 S2 4:48 NB1 x1 maximum12  p1 p1  3p1 1:30


where p1  0:4x1 0:9
Allocating x2 to Firm 2, leaves S3.
4:51
S2  x2 S3 4:49
NB2 x2 maximum20  1:5p2 p2  5p2 1:20
Finally, allocating x3 to Firm 3 leaves S4. where p2  0:5x2 0:8
4:52
S3  x3 S4 4:50
NB3 x3 maximum28  2:5p3 p3  6p3 1:15
Figure 4.6 shows the different values of each
of these states, Sj, and decision variables xj where p3  0:6x3 0:7
beginning with a quantity S1 = Q R = 10. Our 4:53
task is to nd the best path through the network,
beginning at the leftmost node having a state The discrete dynamic programming algorithm
value of 10. To do this we need to know the net or procedure is a systematic way to nd the best
benets we will get associated with all the links path through this network, or any other suitable
108 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

network. What makes a network suitable for problem up into many optimization problems,
dynamic programming is the fact that all the nodes one for each possible discrete state (e.g., for each
can be lined up in a sequence of vertical columns node representing an amount of water available)
and each link connects a node in one column to in each stage (e.g., for each rm). Given a par-
another node in the next column of nodes. No link ticular state Sj and stage jthat is, a particular
passes over or through any other column(s) of node in the networkwhat decision (link) xj will
nodes. Links also do not connect nodes in the result in the maximum total net benets, desig-
same column. In addition, the contribution to the nated as Fj(Sj), given this state Sj for this and all
overall objective value (in this case, the total net remaining stages or rms j, j + 1, j + 2 ? This
benets) associated with each discrete decision question must be answered for each node in the
(link) in any stage or for any rm is strictly a network before one can nd the overall best set
function of the allocation of water to the rm. It is of decisions for each stage: in other words, the
not dependent on the allocation decisions associ- best allocations to each rm (represented by the
ated with other stages (rms) in the network. best path through the network) in this example.
The main challenge in using discrete dynamic Dynamic programming networks can be
programming to solve an optimization problem is solved in two waysbeginning at the most right
to structure the problem so that it ts this column of nodes or states and moving from right
dynamic programming network format. Perhaps to left, called the backward-moving (but forward-
surprisingly, many water resources planning and looking) algorithm, or beginning at the leftmost
management problems do. But it takes practice to node and moving from left to right, called the
become good at converting optimization prob- forward-moving (but backward-looking) algo-
lems to networks of states, stages, and decisions rithm. Both methods will nd the best path
suitable for solution by discrete dynamic pro- through the network. In some problems, how-
gramming algorithms. ever, only the backward-moving algorithm pro-
In this problem the overall objective is to duces a useful solution. We will revisit this issue
X when we get to reservoir operation where the
Maximize NBj xj ; 4:54 stages are time periods.
j

where NBj(xj) is the net benet associated with an 4.4.2 Backward-Moving Solution
allocation of xj to rm j. Equations 4.514.53 Procedure
dene these net benet functions. As before, the
index j represents the particular rm, and each Consider the network in Fig. 4.7. Again, the
rm is a stage for this problem. Note that the index nodes represent the discrete stateswater avail-
or subscript used in the objective function often able to allocate to all remaining users. The links
represents an object (like a water-using rm) at a represent particular discrete allocation decisions.
place in space or a time period. These places or The numbers on the links are the net benets
time periods are called the stages of a dynamic obtained from those allocations. We want to
programming problem. Our task is to nd the best proceed through the node-link network from the
path from one stage to the next: in other words, the state of 10 at the beginning of the rst stage to the
best allocation decisions for all three rms. end of the network in such a way as to maximize
Dynamic programming can be viewed as a total net benets. But without looking at all
multistage decision-making process. Instead of combinations of successive allocations we cannot
deciding all three allocations in one single opti- do this beginning at a state of 10. However, we
mization procedure, like Lagrange multipliers, can nd the best solution if we assume we have
the dynamic programming procedure divides the already made the rst two allocations and are at
4.4 Dynamic Programming 109

any of the nodes or states at the beginning of the F3 5 MaximumfNB3 x3 g


nal, third, stage with only one allocation deci- x3  5
sion remaining. Clearly at each node representing
4  x3  6
the water available to allocate to the third rm, the
Maximumf27:9; 31:1g 31:1 when x3 5
best decision is to pick the allocation (link) hav-
ing the largest net benets. 4:57
Denoting F3(S3) as the maximum net benets
we can achieve from the remaining amount of
F3 4 MaximumfNB3 x3 g
water S3, then for each discrete value of S3 we
can nd the x3 that maximizes F3(S3). Those x3  4
shown in Fig. 4.7 include: 4  x3  6
Maximumf27:9g 27:9 when x3 4
F3 7 MaximumfNB3 x3 g
x3  7; the total flow available:
4:58
4  x3  6; the allowable range of allocations
These computations are shown on the network
= Maximumf27:9; 31:1; 33:7g 33:7 when x3 6
in Fig. 4.8. Note that there are no benets to be
4:55 obtained after the third allocation, so the decision
to be made for each node or state prior to allo-
F3 6 MaximumfNB3 x3 g
cating water to Firm 3 is simply that which
x3  6
maximizes the net benets derived from that last
4  x3  6
(third) allocation. In Fig. 4.8 the links repre-
Maximumf27:9; 31:1; 33:7g 33:7 when x3 6
senting the decisions or allocations that result in
4:56 the largest net benets are shown with arrows.

Fig. 4.8 Using the backward-moving dynamic program- Stage 1 to obtain the allocation policy that maximizes
ming method for nding the maximum remaining net total net benets, F1(10). The minimum flow to remain in
benets, Fj(Sj), and optimal allocations (denoted by the the river, R, is in addition to the ten units available for
arrows on the links) for each state in Stage 3, then for allocation and is not shown in this network
each state in Stage 2 and nally for the initial state in
110 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Having computed the maximum net benets, Having computed the maximum net benets
F3(S3), associated with each initial state S3 for obtainable for each discrete state at the beginning
Stage 3, we can now move backward (to the left) to of Stage 2, that is, all the F2(S2) values, we can
the discrete states S2 at the beginning of the second move backward or left to the beginning of Stage
stage. Again, these states represent the quantity of 1. For this beginning stage there is only one state,
water available to allocate to Firms 2 and 3. Denote the state of 10 we are actually in before making
F2(S2) as the maximum total net benets obtained any allocations to any of the rms. In this case,
from the two remaining allocations x2 and x3 given the maximum net benets, F1(10), we can obtain
the quantity S2 water available. The best x2 depends from given 10 units of water available, is
not only on the net benets obtained from the
allocation x2 but also on the maximum net benets F1 10 MaximumfNB1 x1 F2 S2 10  x1 g
obtainable after that, namely the just-calculated x1  10
F3(S3) associated with the state S3 that results from 0  x1  2
the initial state S2 and a decision x2. As dened in Maximumf0 52:3; 3:7
Eq. 4.49, this nal state S3 in Stage 2 obviously 49:7; 6:3 46:8g 53:4 when x1 1
equals S2 x2. Hence for those nodes at the
4:62
beginning of Stage 2 shown in Fig. 4.8:
The value of F1(10) in Eq. 4.62 is the same as
F2 10 MaximumfNB2 x2 F3 S3 10  x2 g
the value of Eq. 4.54. This value is the maximum
x2  10 net benets obtainable from allocating the
3  x2  5 available 10 units of water. From Eq. 4.62 we
Maximumf15:7 33:7; 18:6 know that we will get a maximum of 53.4 net
33:7; 21:1 31:1g 52:3 when x2 4 benets if we allocate 1 unit of water to Firm 1.
4:59 This leaves 9 units of water to allocate to the two
remaining rms. This is our optimal state at the
F2 9 MaximumfNB2 x2 F3 S3 9  x2 g beginning of Stage 2. Given a state of 9 at the
x2  9 beginning of Stage 2, we see from Eq. 4.60 that
3  x2  5
we should allocate 4 units of water to Firm 2.
This leaves 5 units of water for Firm 3. Given a
Maximumf15:7 33:7; 18:6
state of 5 at the beginning of Stage 3, Eq. 4.57
31:1; 21:1 27:9g 49:7 tells us we should allocate all 5 units to Firm 3.
when x2 4 All this is illustrated in Fig. 4.8.
4:60 Compare this discrete solution with the con-
tinuous one dened by Lagrange multipliers as
F2 8 MaximumfNB2 x2 F3 S3 8  x2 g shown in Table 4.2. The exact solution, to the
x2  8 nearest tenth, is 1.2, 3.7, and 5.1 for x1, x2, and
3  x2  5 assume 4 instead of 5 since both x3, respectively. The solution just derived from
will not affect optimal solution discrete dynamic programming that assumed
only integer allocation values is 1, 4, and 5,
Maximumf15:7 31:1; 18:6
respectively.
27:9g 46:8 when x2 3 To summarize, a dynamic programming
4:61 model was developed for the following problem:

These maximum net benet functions, F2(S2), Maximize Net benefit 4:63
could be calculated for the remaining discrete
states from 7 to 0.
4.4 Dynamic Programming 111

Subject to The values of each NBj(xj) are obtained from


Eqs. 4.51 to 4.53.
Net benefit Total return  Total cost To solve for F1(S1) and each optimal alloca-
4:64 tion xj we must rst solve for all values of F3(S3).
Once these are known we can solve for all values
Total return 12  p1 p1 20  1:5p2 p2 of F2(S2). Given these F2(S2) values, we can
28  2:5p3 p3 solve for F1(S1). Equations 4.71 need to be
solved before Eqs. 4.72 can be solved, and
4:65 Eqs. 4.72 need to be solved before Eqs. 4.73 can
be solved. They need not be solved simultane-
Total cost 3p1 1:30 5p2 1:20 6p3 1:15 ously, and they cannot be solved in reverse order.
4:66 These three equations are called recursive equa-
tions. They are dened for the backward-moving
p1  0:4x1 0:9 4:67 dynamic programming solution procedure.
There is a correspondence between the non-
linear optimization model dened by Eqs. 4.63
p2  0:5x2 0:8 4:68 4.70 and the dynamic programming model
dened by the recursive Eqs. 4.714.73. Note
that F3(S3) in Eq. 4.71 is the same as
p3  0:6x3 0:7 4:69
F3 S3 Maximum NB3 x3 4:74

x1 x2 x3  10 4:70 Subject to

The discrete dynamic programming version of x 3  S3 ; 4:75


this problem required discrete states Sj repre-
senting the amount of water available to allocate where NB3(x3) is dened in Eq. 4.53.
to rms j, j + 1, . It required discrete alloca- Similarly, F2(S2) in Eq. 4.72 is the same as
tions xj. Next it required the calculation of the
maximum net benets, Fj(Sj), that could be F2 S2 Maximum NB2 x2 NB3 x3
obtained from all rms j, beginning with Firm 3, 4:76
and proceeding backward as indicated in
Eqs. 4.714.73. Subject to

F3 S3 maximumfNB3 x3 g over all x3  S3 ; x2 x3  S 2 ; 4:77


for all discrete S3 values between 0 and 10
where NB2(x2) and NB3(x3) are dened in
4:71 Eqs. 4.52 and 4.53.
Finally, F1(S1) in Eq. 4.73 is the same as
F2 S2 maximumfNB2 x2 F3 S3 g
F1 S1 Maximum NB1 x1 NB2 x2 NB3 x3
over all x2  S2 and S3 S2  x2 ; 0  S2  10
4:78
4:72
Subject to
F1 S1 maximumfNB1 x1 F2 S2 g x1 x2 x3  S1 10; 4:79
over all x1  S1 and S2 S1  x1 and S1 10
4:73 where NB1(x1), NB2(x2), and NB3(x3) are dened
in Eqs. 4.514.53.
112 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Alternatively, F3(S3) in Eq. 4.71 is the same as successive states Sj and Sj+1 and the decision xj.
In the above example, these transition functions
F3 S3 Maximum28  2:5p3 p3  6p3 1:15 are dened by Eqs. 4.484.50, or, in general
4:80 terms for all rms j, by
Subject to Sj 1 S j  x j 4:92

p3  0:6x3 0:7 4:81

x 3  S3 4:82 4.4.3 Forward-Moving Solution


Procedure
Similarly, F2(S2) in Eq. 4.72 is the same as
We have just described the backward-moving
F2 S2 Maximum20  1:5p2 p2
dynamic programming algorithm. In that
28  2:5p3 p3  5p21:20 6p31:15 approach at each node (state) in each stage we
4:83 calculated the best value of the objective function
that can be obtained from all further or remaining
Subject to decisions. Alternatively one can proceed for-
ward, that is, from left to right, through a
p2  0:5x2 0:8 4:84 dynamic programming network. For the
forward-moving algorithm at each node we need
p3  0:6x3 0:7 4:85 to calculate the best value of the objective
function that could be obtained from all past
x 2 x 3  S2 4:86 decisions leading to that node or state. In other
words, we need to nd how best to get to each
Finally, F1(S1) in Eq. 4.73 is the same as state Sj+1 at the end of each stage j.
Returning to the allocation example, dene
F1 S1 Maximum12  p1 p1
fj(Sj+1) as the maximum net benets from the
20  1:5p2 p2 28  2:5p3 p3 allocation of water to rms 1, 2, , j, given the
h i
 3p1 1:30 5p2 1:20 6p3 1:15 remaining water, state Sj+1. For this example, we
begin the forward-moving, but backward-looking,
4:87 process by selecting each of the ending states in the
rst stage j = 1 and nding the best way to have
Subject to arrived at (or to have achieved) those ending states.
Since in this example there is only one way to get
p1  0:4x1 0:9 4:88
to each of those states, as shown in Fig. 4.7 or
Fig. 4.8 the allocation decisions, x1, given a value
p2  0:5x2 0:8 4:89
for S2 are obvious.
p3  0:6x3 0:7 4:90 f1 S2 maximumfNB1 x1 g
4:93
x1 x2 x3  S1 10 4:91 x1 10  S2

The transition function of dynamic program- Hence, f1(S2) is simply NB1(10 S2). Once
ming denes the relationship between two the values for all f1(S2) are known for all discrete
4.4 Dynamic Programming 113

S2 between 0 and 10, move forward (to the right) water at the end of Stage 3. The arrow tells us
to the end of Stage 2 and nd the best allocations that if we are to get to that state optimally, we
x2 to have made given each nal state S3. should allocate 5 units of water to Firm 3. Thus
we must begin Stage 3, or end Stage 2, with
f2 S3 maximumfNB2 x2 f1 S2 g 10 5 = 5 units of water. To get to this state at
0  x2  10  S3 4:94 the end of Stage 2 we should allocate 4 units of
S2 S3 x 2 water to Firm 2. The arrow also tells us we
should have had 9 units of water available at the
Once the values of all f2(S3) are known for all end of Stage 1. Given this state of 9 at the end of
discrete states S3 between 0 and 10, move for- Stage 1, the arrow tells us we should allocate 1
ward to Stage 3 and nd the best allocations x3 to unit of water to Firm 1. This is the same allo-
have made given each nal state S4. cation policy as obtained using the backward-
moving algorithm.
f3 S4 maximumfNB3 x3 f2 S3 g
for all discrete S4 between 0 and 10:
4.4.4 Numerical Solutions
0  x3  10  S4
S3 S4 x 3 The application of discrete dynamic program-
4:95 ming to most practical problems will usually
require writing some software. There are no
Figure 4.9 illustrates a portion of the network general dynamic programming computer pro-
represented by Eqs. 4.934.95, and the fj(Sj+1) grams available that will solve all dynamic pro-
values. gramming problems. Thus any user of dynamic
From Fig. 4.9, note the highest total net ben- programming will need to write a computer
ets are obtained by ending with 0 remaining program to solve a particular problem unless they

Fig. 4.9 Using the


forward-moving dynamic
programming method for
nding the maximum
accumulated net benets,
fj(Sj + 1), and optimal
allocations (denoted by the
arrows on the links) that
should have been made to
reach each ending state,
beginning with the ending
states in Stage 1, then for
each ending state in Stage 2
and nally for the ending
states in Stage 3
114 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

do it by hand. Most computer programs written and to get this we should allocate 1 unit to Firm
for solving specic dynamic programming 1. This leaves 9 units of water for the remaining
problems create and store the solutions of the two allocations. From Table 4.4 we see that for a
recursive equations (e.g., Eqs. 4.934.95) in state of 9 units of water available we should
tables. Each stage is a separate table, as shown in allocate 4 units to Firm 2. This leaves 5 units.
Tables 4.3, 4.4, and 4.5 for this example From Table 4.3 for a state of 5 units of water
water-allocation problem. These tables apply to available we see we should allocate all 5 of them
only a part of the entire problem, namely that part to Firm 3.
of the network shown in Figs. 4.8 and 4.9. The Performing these calculations for various
backward solution procedure is used. discrete total amounts of water available, say
Table 4.3 contains the solutions of Eqs. 4.55 from 0 to 38 in this example, will dene an
4.58 for the third stage. Table 4.4 contains the allocation policy (such as the one shown in
solutions of Eqs. 4.594.61 for the second stage. Fig. 4.5 for a different allocation problem) for
Table 4.5 contains the solution of Eq. 4.62 for situations when the total amount of water is less
the rst stage. than that desired by all the rms. This policy can
From Table 4.5 we see that, given 10 units of then be simulated using alternative time series of
water available, we will obtain 53.4 net benets available amounts of water, such as streamflows,

Table 4.3 Computing the values of F3(S3) and optimal allocations x3 for all states S3 in Stage 3

Table 4.4 Computing the values of F2(S2) and optimal allocations x2 for all states S2 in Stage 2
4.4 Dynamic Programming 115

Table 4.5 Computing the values of F1(S1) and optimal allocations x1, for all states S1, in Stage 1

to obtain estimates of the time series (or statis- (Bellman 1957). The backward-moving solution
tical measures of those time series) of net benets algorithm is based on the principal that no matter
obtained by each rm, assuming the allocation what the state and stage (i.e., the particular node
policy is followed over time. you are at), an optimal policy is one that pro-
ceeds forward from that node or state and stage
optimally. The forward-moving solution algo-
4.4.5 Dimensionality rithm is based on the principal that no matter
what the state and stage (i.e., the particular node
One of the limitations of dynamic programming you are at), an optimal policy is one that has
is handling multiple state variables. In our arrived at that node or state and stage in an
water-allocation example, we had only one state optimal manner.
variable: the total amount of water available. We This principle of optimality is a very simple
could have enlarged this problem to include other concept but requires the formulation of a set of
types of resources the rms require to make their recursive equations at each stage. It also requires
products. Each of these state variables would that either in the last stage (j = J) for a
need to be discretized. If, for example, only backward-moving algorithm, or in the rst stage
m discrete values of each state variable are con- (j = 1) for a forward-moving algorithm, the
sidered, for n different state variables (e.g., types future value functions, Fj+1(Sj+1), associated with
of resources) there are mn different combinations the ending state variable values, or past value
of state variable values to consider at each stage. functions, f0(S1), associated with the beginning
As the number of state variables increases, the state variable values, respectively, all equal some
number of discrete combinations of state variable known value. Usually that value is 0 but not
values increases exponentially. This is called always. This condition is needed in order to
dynamic programmings curse of dimensional- begin the process of solving each successive
ity. It has motivated many researchers to search recursive equation.
for ways of reducing the number of possible
discrete states required to nd an optimal solu-
tion to large multistate-variable problems. 4.4.7 Additional Applications

Among the common dynamic programming


4.4.6 Principle of Optimality applications in water resources planning are
water allocations to multiple uses, infrastructure
The solution of dynamic programming models or capacity expansion, and reservoir operation.
networks is based on a principal of optimality The previous three-user water-allocation problem
116 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

(Fig. 4.1) illustrates the rst type of application. each future period t is no less than the capacity
The other two applications are presented below. required Dt at the end of that period.

4.4.7.1 Capacity Expansion st 1  D t for t 1; 2; . . .; T 4:99


How much infrastructure should be built, when
and why? Consider a municipality that must plan There may also be constraints on the possible
for the future expansion of its water supply sys- expansions in each period dened by a set t of
tem or some component of that system, such as a feasible capacity additions in each period t:
reservoir, aqueduct, or treatment plant. The
xt 2 Xt 4:100
capacity needed at the end of each future period
t has been estimated to be Dt. The cost, Ct(st, xt) Figure 4.10 illustrates this type of capacity
of adding capacity xt in each period t is a function expansion problem. The question is how much
of that added capacity as well as of the existing capacity to add and when. It is a signicant
capacity st at the beginning of the period. The problem for several reasons. One is that the cost
planning problem is to nd that time sequence of functions Ct(st, xt) typically exhibit xed costs
capacity expansions that minimizes the present and economies of scale, as illustrated in Fig. 4.11.
value of total future costs while meeting the Each time any capacity is added there are xed as
predicted capacity demand requirements. This is well as variable costs incurred. Fixed and variable
the usual capacity expansion problem. costs that show economies of scale (decreasing
This problem can be written as an optimiza- average costs associated with increasing capacity
tion model: The objective is to minimize the additions) motivate the addition of excess
present value of the total cost of capacity capacity, capacity not needed immediately but
expansion. expected to be needed in the future to meet an
X increased demand for additional capacity.
Minimize Ct st ; xt ; 4:96
The problem is also important because any
t
estimates made today of future demands, costs
where Ct(st, xt) is the present value of the cost of and interest rates are likely to be wrong. The
capacity expansion xt in period t given an initial future is uncertain. Its uncertainties increase the
capacity of st. further the future. Capacity expansion planners
The constraints of this model dene the mini- need to consider the future if their plans are to be
mum required nal capacity in each period t, or cost-effective and not myopic from assuming
equivalently the next periods initial capacity, st+1,
as a function of the known existing capacity s1
and each expansion xt up through period t.
X
st 1 s1 xs for t 1; 2; . . .; T
s1;t

4:97

Alternatively these equations may be expres-


sed by a series of continuity relationships:

st 1 st xt for t 1; 2; . . .; T 4:98
Fig. 4.10 A demand projection (solid blue line) and a
In this problem, the constraints must also possible capacity expansion schedule (red line) for
ensure that the actual capacity st+1 at the end of meeting that projected demand over time
4.4 Dynamic Programming 117

Fig. 4.11 Typical cost function for additional capacity


given an existing capacity. The cost function shows the
xed costs, C0, required if additional capacity is to be
added, and the economies of scale associated with the
concave portion of the cost function Fig. 4.12 Network of discrete capacity expansion deci-
sions (links) that meet the projected demand
there is no future. Just how far into the future do
they need to look? And what about the uncer- Hence, for each nal discrete state s2 in stage
tainty in all future costs, demands, and interest t = 1 ranging from D1 to the maximum demand
rate estimates? These questions will be addressed DT, dene
after showing how the problem can be solved for f1 s2 minfC1 s1 ; x1 g in which the discrete x1
any xed-planning horizon and estimates of s2 and s1 0
future demands, interest rates, and costs. 4:101
The constrained optimization model dened
by Eqs. 4.964.100 can be restructured as a Moving to stage t = 2, for the nal discrete
multistage decision-making process and solved states s3 ranging from D2 to DT,
using either a forward or backward-moving dis-
crete dynamic programming solution procedure. f2 s3 minfC2 s2 ; x2 f1 s2 g
The stages of the model will be the time periods over all discrete x2 between 0 4:102
t. The states will be either the capacity st+1 at the and s3  D1 and s2 s3  x2
end of a stage or period t if a forward-moving
solution procedure is adopted, or the capacity st, Moving to stage t = 3, for the nal discrete
at the beginning of a stage or period t if a states s4 ranging from D3 to DT,
backward-moving solution procedure is used. f3 s4 minfC3 s3 ; x3 f2 s3 g
A network of possible discrete capacity states
over all discrete x3 between 0
and decisions can be superimposed onto the
demand projection of Fig. 4.9, as shown in and s4  D2 and s3 s4  x3
Fig. 4.12. The solid blue circles in Fig. 4.12 4:103
represent possible discrete states, St, of the sys-
tem, the amounts of additional capacity existing In general for all stages t between the rst and
at the end of each period t 1 or equivalently at last:
the beginning of period t. ft st 1 minfCt st ; xt ft1 st g
Consider rst a forward-moving dynamic over all discrete xt between 0
programming algorithm. To implement this, and st 1  Dt1 and st st 1  xt
dene ft(st+1) as the minimum cost of achieving a
4:104
capacity st+1, at the end of period t. Since at the
beginning of the rst period t = 1, the accumu- For the last stage t = T and for the nal dis-
lated least cost is 0, f0(s1) = 0. crete state sT+1 = DT,
118 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

fT sT 1 minfCT sT ; xT fT1 sT g same network with the present value of the ex-
pansion costs on each link. The values of the
over all discrete xT
states, the existing capacities, represented by the
between 0 and DT  DT1 nodes, are shown on the left vertical axis. The
where sT sT 1  xT capacity expansion problem is solved on
4:105 Fig. 4.14 using the forward-moving algorithm.
From the forward-moving solution to the
The value of fT(sT+1) is the minimum present dynamic programming problem shown in
value of the total cost of meeting the demand for Fig. 4.14, the present value of the cost of the
T time periods. To identify the sequence of optimal capacity expansion schedule is 23 units
capacity expansion decisions that results in this of money. Backtracking (moving left against the
minimum present value of the total cost requires arrows) from the farthest right node, this sched-
backtracking to collect the set of best decisions xt ule adds 10 units of capacity in period t = 1, and
for all stages t. A numerical example will illus- 15 units of capacity in period t = 3.
trate this. Next consider the backward-moving algo-
rithm applied to this capacity expansion problem.
A numerical example
The general recursive equation for a
Consider the ve-period capacity expansion
backward-moving solution is
problem shown in Fig. 4.12. Figure 4.13 is the

Fig. 4.13 A discrete capacity expansion network show- path through the network can be done using forward or
ing the present value of the expansion costs associated backward-moving discrete dynamic programming
with each feasible expansion decision. Finding the best
4.4 Dynamic Programming 119

Fig. 4.14 A capacity-expansion example, showing the minimum cost to have reached that particular state at
results of a forward-moving dynamic programming the end of the particular time period t
algorithm. The numbers next to the nodes are the

Ft st minimumfCt st ; xt Ft 1 st 1 g gives us a time series of future capacity expan-


over all discrete xt from Dt  st to DT  st ;
sion decisions for the next 5 time periods, what is
important to decision-makers is what additional
for all discrete states st from Dt1 to DT
capacity to add in the current period, i.e., now,
4:106 not what capacity to add in future periods. Does
the uncertainty of future demands and costs and
where FT+1(DT) = 0 and as before each cost the 5-period planning horizon affect this rst
function is the discounted cost. decision, x1? This is the question to ask. If the
Once again, as shown in Fig. 4.14, the mini-
answer is no, then one can place some condence
mum total present value cost is 23 if 10 units of in the value of x1. If the answer is yes, then more
additional capacity are added in period t = 1 and study may be warranted to determine which
15 in period t = 3.
demand and cost scenario to assume, or, if
Now consider the question of the uncertainty applicable, how far into the future to extend the
of future demands, Dt, discounted costs, Ct(st, xt), planning horizon.
as well as to the fact that the planning horizon Future capacity expansion decisions in time
T is only 5 time periods. Of importance is just periods 2, 3, and so on can be based on updated
how these uncertainties and nite planning information and analyses carried out closer to the
horizon affect our decisions. While the model
120 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Fig. 4.15 A capacity-expansion example, showing the minimum remaining cost to have the particular capacity
results of a backward-moving dynamic programming required at the end of the planning horizon given the
algorithm. The numbers next to the nodes are the existing capacity of the state

time those decisions are to be made. At those distant time horizon, one can then ignore all but
times, the forecast demands and economic cost that rst decision, x1: that is, what to add now.
estimates can be updated and the planning hori- Then just before the beginning of the second
zon extended, as necessary, to a period that again period, the forecasting and analysis can be
does not affect the immediate decision. Note that redone with updated data to obtain an updated
in the example problem shown in Figs. 4.14 and solution for what if any capacity to add in period
4.15, the use of 4 periods instead of 5 would have 2, and so on into the future. Thus, these
resulted in the same rst-period decision. There sequential decision making dynamic program-
is no need to extend the analysis to 6 or more ming models can be designed to be used in a
periods. sequential decision-making process.
To summarize: What is important to
decision-makers is what additional capacity to 4.4.7.2 Reservoir Operation
add now. While the current periods capacity Reservoir operators need to know how much
addition should be based on the best estimates of water to release and when. Reservoirs designed to
future costs, interest rates and demands, once a meet demands for water supplies, recreation,
solution is obtained for the capacity expansion hydropower, the environment and/or flood con-
required for this and all future periods up to some trol need to be operated in ways that meet those
4.4 Dynamic Programming 121

demands in a reliable and effective manner. Since zones are associated with higher reservoir relea-
future inflows or storage volumes are uncertain, ses. If the actual storage is relatively low, then
the challenge, of course, is to determine the best less water is usually released so as to hedge
reservoir release or discharge for a variety of against a continuing water shortage or drought.
possible inflows and storage conditions that could Release rules may also specify the desired
exist or happen in each time period t in the future. storage level for the time of year. The operator is
Reservoir release policies are often dened in to release water as necessary to achieve these
the form of what are called rule curves. Fig- target storage levels. Maximum and minimum
ure 4.17 illustrates a rule curve for a single release constraints might also be specied that
reservoir on the Columbia River in the north- may affect how quickly the target storage levels
western United States. It combines components can be met. Some rule curves dene multiple
of two basic types of release rules. In both of target storage levels depending on hydrological
these, the year is divided into various discrete (e.g., snow pack) conditions in the upstream
within-year time periods. There is a specied watershed, or on the forecast climate conditions
release for each value of storage in each as affected by ENSO cycles, solar geomagnetic
within-year time period. Usually higher storage activity, ocean currents and the like.

Fig. 4.16 An example reservoir rule curve specifying and maximum release rates and the maximum down-
the storage targets and some of the release constraints, stream channel rate of flow and depth changes that can
given the particular current storage volume and time of occur in each month
year. The release constraints also include the minimum
122 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Reservoir release rule curves for a year, such it is useful to have at least an approximate idea of
as that shown in Fig. 4.16, dene a policy that the expected impact of different alternative poli-
does not vary from one year to the next. The cies on various system performance measures or
actual releases will vary, however, depending on objectives. Policy objectives could be the maxi-
the inflows and storage volumes that actually mization of expected annual net benets from
occur. The releases are often specied indepen- downstream releases, reservoir storage volumes,
dently of future inflow forecasts. They are typi- hydroelectric energy and flood control, or the
cally based only on existing storage volumes and minimization of deviations from particular
within-year periodsthe two axes of Fig. 4.16. release, storage volume, hydroelectric energy or
Release rules are typically derived from trial flood flow targets or target ranges. Discrete
and error simulations. To begin these simulations dynamic programming can be used to obtain

Fig. 4.17 Network representation of the four-season inflow of Qt during season t, the links indicate the
reservoir release problem. Given any initial storage possible release decisions corresponding to those in
volume St at the beginning of a season t, and an expected Table 4.7
4.4 Dynamic Programming 123

initial estimates of reservoir-operating policies evaporation and seepage losses based on different
that meet these and other objectives. The results discrete combinations of initial and nal storage
of discrete dynamic programming can be volumes for each within-year period t.
expressed in the form shown in Fig. 4.17. Rounding these losses to the nearest integer
value, Table 4.7 shows the net releases associ-
A numerical example
ated with initial and nal storage volumes. They
As a simple example, consider a reservoir having
are computed using Eq. 4.107. The information
an active storage capacity of 20 million cubic
in Table 4.7 allows us to draw a network repre-
meters, or for that matter any specied volume
senting each of the discrete storage volume states
units. The active storage volume in the reservoir
(the nodes), and each of the feasible releases (the
can vary between 0 and 20. To use discrete
links). This network for the four seasons t in the
dynamic programming, this range of possible
year is illustrated in Fig. 4.17.
storage volumes must be divided into a set of
This reservoir-operating problem is a multi-
discrete values. These will be the discrete state
stage decision-making problem. As Fig. 4.17
variable values. In this example let the range of
illustrates, at the beginning of any season t, the
storage volumes be divided into intervals of 5
storage volume can be in any of the ve discrete
storage volume units. Hence, the initial storage
states. Given the state, a release decision is to be
volume, St, can assume values of 0, 5, 10, 15, and
made. This release will depend on the state: the
20 for all periods t.
initial storage volume and the mean inflow, as
For each period t, let Qt be the mean inflow,
well as the losses that may be estimated based on
Lt(St, St+1) the evaporation and seepage losses
the initial and nal storage volumes, as dened in
that depend on the initial and nal storage vol-
Table 4.6. The release will also depend on what
umes in the reservoir, and Rt the release or dis-
is to be accomplishedthat is, the objectives to
charge from the reservoir. Each variable is
be satised.
expressed as volume units for the period t.
For this example, assume there are various
Storage volume continuity requires that in
targets that water users would like to achieve.
each period t the initial active storage volume, St,
Downstream water users want reservoir operators
plus the inflow, Qt, less the losses, Lt(St, St+1),
to meet their flow targets. Individuals who use
and release, Rt, equals the nal storage, or
the lake for recreation want the reservoir opera-
equivalently the initial storage, St+1, in the fol-
tors to meet storage volume or storage level
lowing period t + 1. Hence
targets. Finally, individuals living on the down-
stream floodplain want the reservoir operators to
St Qt  Rt  Lt St ; St 1 St 1 for each period t:
provide storage capacity for flood protection.
4:107 Table 4.8 identies these different targets that are
to be met, if possible, for the duration of each
To satisfy the requirement (imposed for con-
season t.
venience in this example) that each storage vol-
Clearly, it will not be possible to meet all
ume variable be a discrete value over the range
these storage volume and release targets in all
from 0 to 20 in units of 5, the releases, Rt, must
four seasons, given inflows of 24, 12, 6, and 18,
be such that when Qt Rt Lt(St, St+1) is added
respectively. Hence, the objective in this example
to St the resulting value of St+1 is one of the ve
will be to do the best one can: to minimize a
discrete numbers between 0 and 20.
weighted sum of squared deviations from each of
Assume four within-year periods t in each year
these targets. The weights reflect the relative
(kept small for this illustrative example). In these
importance of meeting each target in each season
four seasons assume the mean inflows, Qt, are 24,
t. Target deviations are squared to reflect the fact
12, 6, and 18, respectively. Table 4.6 denes the
124 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Table 4.6 Evaporation and seepage losses based on initial and nal storage volumes for example reservoir-operating
problem
4.4 Dynamic Programming 125

Table 4.7 Discrete releases associated with initial and nal storage volumes for example reservoir-operating problem
126 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Table 4.8 Storage volume and release targets for the example reservoir operation problem

that the marginal losses associated with devi- In the above equation, when t = 4, the last
ations increase with increasing deviations. Small period of the year, the following period t + 1 = 1,
deviations are not as serious as larger deviations, the rst period in the following year. Each ESt is
and it is better to have numerous small deviations the storage volume in excess of the flood storage
rather than a few larger ones. target volume, TF. Each DRt is the difference
During the recreation season (periods 2 and 3), between the actual release, Rt, and the target
deviations below or above the recreation storage release, TRt, when the release is less than the target.
lake volume targets are damaging. During the The excess storage, ESt, above the flood target
flood season (period 1), any storage volume in storage TF at the beginning of each season t can
excess of the flood control storage targets of 15 be dened by the constraint:
reduces the flood storage capacity. Deviations
below that flood control target are not penalized. St  TF ESt for periods t 1 and 2:
Flood control and recreation storage targets dur-
4:110
ing each season t apply throughout the season,
thus they apply to the initial storage St as well as The decit release, DRt, during period t can
to the nal storage St+1 in appropriate periods t. be dened by the constraint:
The objective is to minimize the sum of total
weighted squared deviations, TSDt, over all Rt  TRt  DRt for all periods t: 4:111
seasons t from now on into the future:
X The rst component of the right side of
Minimize TSDt ; 4:108 Eq. 4.109 denes the weighted squared devia-
t tions from a recreation storage target, TS, at the
beginning and end of season t. In this example
where the recreation season is during periods 2 and 3.
h i The weights, wst, associated with the recreation
TSDt wst TS  St 2 TS  St 1 2 component of the objective are 1 in periods 2 and
h i   3. In periods 1 and 4 the weights, wst, are 0.
wf t ESt 2 ESt 1 2 wrt DR2t
The second component of Eq. 4.109 is for
4:109 flood control. It denes the weighted squared
4.4 Dynamic Programming 127

deviations associated with storage volumes in volume St and inflow Qt), we can calculate the
excess of the flood control target volume, TF, at release or nal storage volume in that period that
the beginning and end of the flood season, period minimizes the remaining sum of weighted
t = 1. In this example, the weights, wft, are 1 for squared deviations for all remaining seasons.
period 1 and 0 for periods 2, 3, and 4. Note the Denote this minimum sum of weighted squared
conflict between flood control and recreation at deviations for all n remaining seasons t as
the end of period 1 or equivalently at the Ftn St ; Qt . This value is dependent on the state
beginning of period 2. (St, Qt), and stage, t, and the number n of
Finally, the last component of Eq. 4.109 remaining seasons. It is not a function of the
denes the weighted squared decit deviations decision Rt or St+1.
from a release target, TRt, In this example all This minimum sum of weighted squared
release weights, wrt, equal 1. deviations for all n remaining seasons t is equal
Associated with each link in Fig. 4.17 is the to
release, Rt, as dened in Table 4.7. Also associ- X
ated with each link is the sum of weighted Ftn St ; Qt min TSDt St ; Rt ; St 1
squared deviations, TSDt, that result from the t1;n

particular initial and nal storage volumes and the over all feasible values of Rt ;
storage volume and release targets identied in 4:112
Table 4.8. They are computed using Eq. 4.109,
with the releases dened in Table 4.7 and targets where
dened in Table 4.8, for each feasible combina-
tion of initial and nal storage volumes, St and St 1 St Qt  Rt  Lt St ; St 1 4:113
St+1, for each of the four seasons or periods in a
year. These computed weighted squared devia- and
tions for each link are shown in Table 4.9.
The goal in this example problem is to nd the St  K; the capacity of the reservoir 4:114
path through a multiyear networkeach year of
which is as shown in Fig. 4.17that minimizes The policy we want to derive is called a
the sum of the squared deviations associated with steady-state policy. Such a policy assumes the
each of the paths links. Again, each links reservoir will be operating for a relatively long
weighted squared deviations are given in time with the same objectives and a repeatable
Table 4.9. Of interest is the best path into the hydrologic time series of seasonal inputs. We can
future from any of the nodes or states (discrete nd this steady-state policy by rst assuming that
storage volumes) that the system could be in at at some time all future benets, losses or penal-

the beginning of any season t. ties, Ft St ; Qt , will be 0.
These paths can be found using the We can begin in that last season t of reservoir
backward-moving solution procedure of discrete operation and work backwards toward the pre-
dynamic programming. This procedure begins at sent, moving left through the network one season
any arbitrarily selected time period or season t at a time. We can continue for multiple years
when the reservoir presumably produces no fur- until the annual policy begins repeating itself
ther benets to anyone (and it does not matter each year. In other words, when the optimal Rt
when that time isjust pick any time) and pro- associated with a particular state (St, Qt) is the
ceeds backward, from right to left one stage (i.e., same in two or more successive years, and this
one time period) at a time, toward the present. At applies for all states (St, Qt) in each season t, a
each node (representing a discrete storage steady-state policy has probably been obtained.
128 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Table 4.9 Total sum of squared deviations, TSDt, associated with initial and nal storage volumes

These are calculated using Eqs. 4.1094.111


4.4 Dynamic Programming 129

(A more denitive test of whether or not a If the decision variable is the nal storage
steady-state policy has been reached will be volume, St+1, the constraints on that nal storage
discussed later.) A steady-state policy will occur volume are
if the inflows, Qt, and objectives, TSDt (St, Rt,
St+1), remain the same for specic within-year 0  St 1  20 4:119
periods from year to year. This steady-state pol-
icy is independent of the assumption that the
operation will end at some point. St 1  St Qt  Lt St ; St 1 4:120
To nd the steady-state operating policy for
this example problem, assume the operation ends and
in some distant year at the end of season 4 (the
right-hand side nodes in Fig. 4.17). At the end of Rt St Qt  St 1  Lt St ; St 1 4:121
this season the number of remaining seasons, n,
Note that if the decision variable is St+1 in
equals 0. The values of the remaining minimum
 season t, this decision becomes the state variable
sums of weighted squared deviations, Ft St ; Qt
in season t + 1. In both cases, the storage vol-
associated with each state (St, Qt), i.e., each node,
umes in each season are limited to discrete values
equal 0. Since for this problem there is no future.
0, 5, 10, 15, and 20.
Now we can begin the process of nding the best
Tables 4.10, 4.11, 4.12, 4.13, 4.14, 4.15, 4.16,
releases Rt in each successive season t, moving
4.17, 4.18 and 4.19 show the values obtained
backward to the beginning of stage t = 4, then
from solving the recursive equations for 10 suc-
stage t = 3, then to t = 2, and then to t = 1, and
cessive seasons or stages (2.5 years). Each table
then to t = 4 of the preceding year, and so on,
represents a stage or season t, beginning with
each move to the left increasing the number of
Table 4.10 at t = 4 and the number of remaining
remaining seasons n by one.
seasons n = 1. The data in each table are
At each stage, or season t, for each discrete
obtained from Tables 4.7 and 4.9. The last two
state (St, Qt) we can compute the release Rt or
columns of each table represent the best release
equivalently the nal storage volume St+1, that
and nal storage volume decision(s) associated
minimizes
with the state (initial storage volume and inflow).
Fnt St ; Qt MinimumfTSDt St ; Rt ; St 1 Note that the policy dening the release or
Ftn1
1 St 1 ; Qt 1 g for all 0  St  20
nal storage for each discrete initial storage
volume in season t = 3 in Table 4.12 is the same
4:115
as in Table 4.16, and similarly for season t = 4 in
The decision variable can be either the release, Tables 4.13 and 4.17, and for season t = 1 in
Rt, or the nal storage volume, St+1. If the deci- Tables 4.14 and 4.18, and nally for season t = 2
sion variable is the release, then the constraints in Tables 4.15 and 4.19. The policy differs over
on that release Rt are each state, and over each different season, but not
Rt  St Qt  Lt St ; St 1 4:116 from year to year for any specied state and
season. This indicates we have reached a
steady-state policy. If we kept on computing the
Rt  St Qt  Lt St ; St 1  20 the capacity
release and nal storage policies for preceding
4:117 seasons, we would get the same policy as that
found for the same season in the following year.
and
The policy is dependent on the statethe initial
storage volume in this caseand on the season t,
St 1 St Qt  Rt  Lt St ; St 1 4:118
130 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Table 4.10 Calculation of minimum squared deviations associated with various discrete storage states in season t = 4
with only n = 1 season remaining for reservoir operation

Table 4.11 Calculation of minimum squared deviations associated with various discrete storage states in season t = 3
with n = 2 seasons remaining for reservoir operation
4.4 Dynamic Programming 131

Table 4.12 Calculation of minimum squared deviations associated with various discrete storage states in season t = 2
with n = 3 seasons remaining for reservoir operation

Table 4.13 Calculation of minimum squared deviations associated with various discrete storage states in season t = 1
with n = 4 seasons remaining for reservoir operation
132 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Table 4.14 Calculation of minimum squared deviations associated with various discrete storage states in season t = 4
with n = 5 seasons remaining for reservoir operation

Table 4.15 Calculation of minimum squared deviations associated with various discrete storage states in season t = 3
with n = 6 seasons remaining for reservoir operation
4.4 Dynamic Programming 133

Table 4.16 Calculation of minimum squared deviations associated with various discrete storage states in season t = 2
with n = 7 seasons remaining for reservoir operation

Table 4.17 Calculation of minimum squared deviations associated with various discrete storage states in season t = 1
with n = 8 seasons remaining for reservoir operation
134 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Table 4.18 Calculation of minimum squared deviations associated with various discrete storage states in season t = 4
with n = 9 seasons remaining for reservoir operation

Table 4.19 Calculation of minimum squared deviations associated with various discrete storage states in season t = 3
with n = 10 seasons remaining for reservoir operation
4.4 Dynamic Programming 135

Table 4.20 The discrete steady-state reservoir-operating policy as computed for this example problem in Tables 4.16,
4.17, 4.18 and 4.19

but not on the year. This policy as dened in volume condition at the beginning of any season
Tables 4.16, 4.17, 4.18 and 4.19 is summarized t. This can be simulated under different flow
in Table 4.20. patterns to determine just how well it satises the
This policy can be dened as a rule curve, as overall objective of minimizing the weighted
shown in Fig. 4.18. It provides a rst approxi- sum of squared deviations from desired, but
mation of a reservoir release rule curve that one conflicting, storage and release targets. There are
can improve upon using simulation. other performance criteria that may also be
Table 4.20 and Fig. 4.18 dene a policy that evaluated using simulation, such as measures of
can be implemented for any initial storage reliability, resilience, and vulnerability (Chap. 9).

Fig. 4.18 Reservoir rule


curve based on policy
dened in Table 4.20. Each
season is divided into
storage volume zones. The
releases associated with
each storage volume zone
are specied. Also shown
are the storage volumes that
would result if in each year
the actual inflows equaled
the inflows used to derive
this rule curve
136 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Table 4.21 A simulation of the derived operating policy in Table 4.20

The storage volumes and releases in each period twill repeat themselves each year, after the rst year. The annual total squared
deviations, TSDt for the specic initial and nal storage volumes and release conditions are obtained from Table 4.9

Assuming the inflows that were used to derive begin to repeat themselves once a steady-state
this policy actually occurred each year, we can condition has been reached. Once reached, the
simulate the derived sequential steady-state pol- storage volumes and releases will be the same
icy to nd the storage volumes and releases that each year (since the inflows are the same). These
would occur in each period, year after year, once storage volumes are denoted as a blue line on the
a repetitive steady-state condition were reached. rule curve shown in Fig. 4.18. The annual total
This is done in Table 4.21 for an arbitrary initial squared deviations will also be the same each
storage volume of 20 in season t = 1. You can year. As seen in Table 4.21, this annual mini-
try other initial conditions to verify that it mum weighted sum of squared deviations for this
requires only 2 years at most to reach a repetitive example equals 186. This is what would be
steady-state policy. observed if the inflows assumed for this analysis
As shown in Table 4.21, if the inflows were repeated themselves.
repetitive and the optimal policy was followed, Note from Tables 4.12, 4.13, 4.14, 4.15 and
the initial storage volumes and releases would 4.16, 4.17, 4.18, 4.19 that once the steady-state
4.4 Dynamic Programming 137

sequential policy has been reached for any applications presented. The rst is that the net
specied storage volume, St, and season t, the benets or costs or other objective values
annual difference of the accumulated minimum resulting at each stage of the problem are
sum of squared deviations equals a constant, dependent only on the state and decision variable
namely the annual value of the objective func- values in each stage. They are independent of
tion. In this case that constant is 186. decisions made at other stages. If the returns at
any stage are dependent on the decisions made at
Ftn 1 St ; Qt  Ftn St ; Qt 186 other stages, then dynamic programming, with
4:122
for all St ; Qt and t: some exceptions, becomes more difcult to
apply. Dynamic programming models can be
This condition indicates a steady-state policy applied to design problems, such as the capacity
has been achieved. expansion problem or to operating problems,
This policy in Table 4.21 applies only for the such as the water-allocation and reservoir oper-
assumed inflows in each season. It does not ation problems, but rarely to problems having
dene what to do if the initial storage volumes or both unknown design and operating policy
inflows differ from those for which the policy is decision variables at the same time. While there
dened. Initial storage volumes and inflows can are some tricks that may allow dynamic pro-
and will vary from those specied in the solution gramming to be used to nd the best solutions to
of any deterministic model. One fact is certain: both design and operating problems encountered
no matter what inflows are assumed in any in water resources planning, management and
model, the actual inflows will always differ. operating policy studies, other optimization
Hence, a policy as dened in Table 4.20 and methods, perhaps combined with dynamic pro-
Fig. 4.18 is much more useful than that in gramming where appropriate, are often more
Table 4.21. In Chap. 8 we will modify this useful.
reservoir operation model to dene releases or
nal storage volumes as functions of not only
discrete storage volumes St but also of discrete 4.5 Linear Programming
possible inflows Qt. However, the policy dened
by any relatively simple optimization model If the objective function and constraints of an
policy should be simulated, evaluated, and fur- optimization model are all linear, many readily
ther rened in an effort to identify the policy that available computer programs exist for nding its
best meets the operating policy objectives. optimal solution. Surprisingly many water
resource systems problems meet these conditions
of linearity. These linear optimization programs
4.4.8 General Comments are very powerful, and unlike many other opti-
on Dynamic mization methods, they can be applied success-
Programming fully to very large optimization problems
containing many variables and constraints. Many
Before ending this discussion of using dynamic water resources problems are too large to be
programming methods for analyzing water easily solved using nonlinear or dynamic pro-
resources planning, management and operating gramming methods. The number of variables and
policy problems, we should examine a major constraints simply dening mass balances and
assumption that has been made in each of the capacity limitations in numerous time periods
138 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

can become so big as to preclude the practical The general structure of a linear programming
use of most other optimization methods. Linear model is
programming procedures or algorithms for solv- X
ing linear optimization models are often the most Maximize or minimize Pj xj 4:123
efcient ways to nd solutions to such problems. j

Hence there is an incentive to convert large


optimization models to a linear form. Some ways Subject to
of doing this are discussed later in this chapter. X
Because of the availability of computer pro- aij xj  or  bi for i 1; 2; 3; . . .; m
j
grams that can solve linear programming prob-
lems, linear programming is arguably the most 4:124
popular and commonly applied optimization
algorithm in practical use today. It is used to
xj  0 for j 1; 2; 3; . . .; n: 4:125
identify and evaluate alternative plans, designs
and management policies in agriculture, busi- If any model ts this general form, where the
ness, commerce, education, engineering, nance, constraints can be any combination of equalities
the civil and military branches of government, (=) and inequalities ( or ), then a large variety
and many other elds. of linear programming computer programs can
In spite of its power and popularity, for most be used to nd the optimal values of all the
real-world water resources planning and man- unknown decision variables xj. Variable non-
agement problems, linear programming, like the negativity is enforced within the solution algo-
other optimization methods already discussed in rithms of most commercial linear programming
this chapter, is best viewed as a preliminary programs, eliminating the need to have to specify
screening tool. Its value is more for reducing the these conditions in any particular application.
number of alternatives for further more detailed Potential users of linear programming algo-
simulations than for nding the best decision. rithms need to know how to construct linear
This is not just because approximation methods models and how to use the computer programs
may have been used to convert nonlinear func- that are available for solving them. They do not
tions to linear ones, but more likely because it is have to understand all the mathematical details of
difcult to incorporate all the complexity of the the solution procedure incorporated in the linear
system and all the objectives considered impor- programming codes. But users of linear pro-
tant to all stakeholders into a linear model. gramming computer programs should understand
Nevertheless, linear programming, like other what the solution procedure does and what the
optimization methods, can provide initial designs computer program output means. To begin this
and operating policy information that simulation discussion of these topics, consider some simple
models require before they can simulate those examples of linear programming models.
designs and operating policies.
Equations 4.41 and 4.42 dene the general
structure of any constrained optimization prob- 4.5.1 Reservoir Storage
lem. If the objective function F(X) of the vector Capacity-Yield Models
X of decision variables xj is linear and if all the
constraints gi(X) in Eq. 4.42 are linear, then the Linear programming can be used to dene stor-
model becomes a linear programming model. age capacity-yield functions for a single or
4.5 Linear Programming 139

natural flow is 1, increasing the minimum


dependable flow to 2 units in each year. Storing 2
units when the flow is 5, releasing 1 and the
natural flow when that natural flow is 2, and
storing 1 when the flow is 4, and then releasing
the stored 2 units along with the natural flow
when the natural flow is 1, will permit a yield of
3 in each time period with 2 units of active
capacity. This is the maximum annual yield that
is possible at this site, again based on these ve
annual inflows and their sequence. The maxi-
Fig. 4.19 Two storage-yield functions for a single mum annual yield cannot exceed the mean
reservoir dening the maximum minimum dependable annual flow, which in this example is 3. Hence,
release. These functions can be dened for varying levels the storage capacity-yield function equals 1 when
of yield reliability
the active capacity is 0, 2 when the active
capacity is 1, and 3 when the active capacity is 2.
multiple reservoirs. A storage capacity-yield The annual yield remains at 3 for any active
function denes the maximum constant de- storage capacity in excess of 2.
pendable reservoir release or yield that will be This storage-yield function is dependent not
available, at a given level of reliability, during only on the natural unregulated annual flows but
each period of operation, as a function of the also on their sequence. For example if the
active storage volume capacity. The yield from sequence of the same 5 annual flows were 5, 2, 1,
any reservoir or group of reservoirs will depend 3, 4, the needed active storage capacity is 3
on the active storage capacity of each reservoir instead of 2 volume units as before to obtain a
and the water that flows into each reservoir, i.e., dependable flow or yield of 3 volume units. In
their inflows. Figure 4.19 illustrates two typical spite of these limitations of storage
storage-yield functions for a single reservoir. capacity-yield functions, historical records are
To describe what a yield is and how it can be still typically used to derive them. (Ways of
increased, consider a sequence of 5 annual flows, augmenting the historical flow record are dis-
say 2, 4, 1, 5, and 3, at a site in an unregulated cussed in Chap. 6.)
stream. Based on this admittedly very limited There are many methods available for deriv-
record of flows, the minimum (historically) de- ing storage-yield functions. One very versatile
pendable annual flow yield of the stream at that method, especially for multiple reservoir sys-
site is 1, the minimum observed flow. Assuming tems, uses linear programming. Others are dis-
the flow record is representative of what future cussed in Chap. 10.
flows might be, a discharge of 1 can be guar- To illustrate a storage capacity-yield model,
anteed in each period of record. (In reality, that consider a single reservoir that must provide at
or any nonzero yield will have a reliability less least a minimum release or yield Y in each period
than 1, as will be considered in Chaps. 6 and 10.) t. Assume a record of known (historical or syn-
If a reservoir having an active storage capacity thetic) streamflows at the reservoir site is avail-
of 1 is built, it could store 1 volume unit of flow able. The problem is to nd the maximum
when the flow is greater than 2. It could then constant yield Y obtainable from a given active
release it along with the natural flow when the storage capacity. The objective is to
140 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

maximize Y 4:126 beginning of each period t are no greater than the


active reservoir capacity K.
This maximum yield is constrained by the
water available in each period, and by the St  K t l; 2; 3; . . .; T 4:128
reservoir capacity. Two sets of constraints are To derive a storage-yield function, the model
needed to dene the relationships among the dened by Eqs. 4.1264.128 must be solved for
inflows, the reservoir storage volumes, the various assumed values of capacity K. Only the
yields, any excess release, and the reservoir inflow values Qt and reservoir active storage
capacity. The rst set of continuity equations capacity K are assumed known. All other storage,
equate the unknown nal reservoir storage vol- release and yield variables are unknown. Linear
ume St+1 in period t to the unknown initial programming will be able to nd their optimal
reservoir storage volume St plus the known values. Clearly, the upper bound on the yield
inflow Qt, minus the unknown yield Y and excess regardless of reservoir capacity will equal the mean
release, Rt, if any, in period t. (Losses are being inflow (less any losses if they were included).
ignored in this example.) Alternatively, one can solve a number of lin-
ear programming models that minimize an
St Qt  Y  Rt St 1 for each period t unknown storage capacity K needed to achieve
1; 2; 3; . . .; T: T 1 1 various specied yields Y. The resulting
4:127 storage-yield functions will be same. The mini-
mum capacity needed to achieve a specied yield
If, as indicated in Eq. 4.127, one assumes that will be the same as the maximum yield obtain-
period 1 follows the last period T, it is not nec- able from the corresponding specied capacity
essary to specify the value of the initial storage K. However, the specied yield Y cannot exceed
volume S1 and/or nal storage volume ST+1. the mean inflow. If an assumed value of the yield
They are set equal to each other and that variable exceeds the mean inflow, there will be no feasi-
value remains unknown. The resulting ble solution to the linear programming model.
steady-state solution is based on the inflow Box 4.1 illustrates an example storage-yield
sequence that is assumed to repeat itself as well model and its solutions to nd the storage-yield
as the available storage capacity, K. function. For this problem, and others in this
The second set of required constraints ensures chapter, the program LINGO (freely obtained
that the reservoir storage volumes St at the from www.lindo.com) is used.
4.5 Linear Programming 141

Box 4.1. Example storage capacity-yield model and its solution from LINGO

E020903a
! Reservoir Storage-Yield Model:
Define St as the initial active res. storage, period t,
Y as the reliable yield in each period t,
Rt as the excess release from the res., period t,
Qt as the known inflow volume to the res., period t
K as the reservoir active storage volume capacity.
;
Max = Y ; !Applies to Model 1. Must be omitted for Model 2;
Min = K ; !Applies to Model 2. Must be omitted for Model 1;
!
Subject to:
Mass balance constraints for each of 5 periods t.
;
S1 + Q1 - Y - R1 = S2;
S2 + Q2 - Y - R2 = S3;
S3 + Q3 - Y - R3 = S4;
S4 + Q4 - Y - R4 = S5;
S5 + Q5 - Y - R5 = S1; ! assumes a steady-state condition;
!
Capacity constraints on storage volumes.
;
S1 < K; S2 < K; S3 < K; S4 < K; S5 < K;
Data:
Q1 = 10; Q2 = 5; Q3 = 30; Q4 = 20; Q5 = 15;
!Note mean = 16;
K = ? ; ! Use for Model 1 only. Allows user to enter
any value of K during model run.;
Y = ? ; ! Use for Model 2 only. Allows user to enter
any value of Y during model run.
;
Enddata

0 5 0 0 0 0 0 5 0 25 15 10
5 10 5 5 0 5 5 0 0 15 10 5
10 12.5 10 7.5 0 2.5 10 0 0 15 0 2.5
15 15 10 10 0 15 15 0 0 0 5 0
18 16 17 11 0 14 18 0 0 0 0 0

Before moving to another application of linear function provides a good exercise in dynamic
programming, consider how this storage-yield programming. The dynamic programming net-
problem, Eqs. 4.1264.128, can be formulated as work has the same form as shown in Fig. 4.19,
a discrete dynamic programming model. The use of where each node is a discrete storage and inflow
discrete dynamic programming is clearly not the state, and the links represent releases. Let Ftn St be
most efcient way to dene a storage-yield func- the maximum yield obtained given a storage
tion but the problem of nding a storage-yield volume of St at the beginning of period t of a year
142 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

with n periods remaining of reservoir operation. volumes will result in higher yields than will
For initial conditions, assume all values of Ft0 St lower ones. The highest yield will be that asso-
for some nal period t with no more periods n re- ciated with the highest storage volumes and it
maining equal a large number that exceeds the will equal the same value obtained from either of
mean annual inflow. Then for the set of feasible the two linear programming models.
discrete total releases Rt:
  
Fnt St max min Rt ; Ftn1
1 St 1 4:129 4.5.2 A Water Quality Management
Problem
This applies for all discrete storage volumes St
and for all within-year periods t and remaining Some linear programming modeling and solu-
periods n. The constraints on the decision vari- tion techniques can be demonstrated using the
ables Rt are simple water quality management example
shown in Fig. 4.21. In addition, this example can
Rt  S t Q t serve to illustrate how models can help identify
Rt  St Qt  K; and 4:130 just what data are needed and how accurate they
S t 1 St Q t  Rt must be for the decisions that are being
considered.
These recursive Eqs. 4.129 together with The stream shown in Fig. 4.20 receives
constraint Eqs. 4.130 can be solved, beginning wastewater effluent from two point sources
with n = 1 and then for successive values of located at sites 1 and 2. Without some wastew-
seasons t and remaining periods n, until a ater treatment at these sites, the concentration of
steady-state solution is obtained, that is, until some pollutant, Pj mg/l, at sites j = 2 and 3, will
continue to exceed the maximum desired con-
Ftn St Ftn1 St centration Pmax
j . The problem is to nd the level
4:131
for all values of St and periods t: of wastewater treatment (waste removed) at sites
i = 1 and 2 that will achieve the desired con-
The steady-state yields Ft(St) will depend on centrations just upstream of site 2 and at site 3 at
the storage volumes St. High initial storage a minimum total cost.

Fig. 4.20 A stream pollution problem that requires standards at sites 2 and 3 at minimum total cost. W1 and
nding the waste removal efciencies (x1, x2) of wastew- W2 are the amounts of pollutant prior to treatment at sites
ater treatment at sites 1 and 2 that meet the stream quality 1 and 2
4.5 Linear Programming 143

This is the classic water quality management will decrease as it travels downstream to site 3.
problem that is frequently found in the literature, The fraction ij of the mass at site i that reaches
although least-cost solutions have rarely if ever site j is often assumed to be
been applied in practice. There are valid reasons  
for this that we will review later. Nevertheless, aij exp ktij ; 4:133
this particular problem can serve to illustrate the
development of some linear models for deter- where k is a rate constant (1/time unit) that
mining data needs as well as for nding, in this depends on the pollutant and the temperature,
case, cost-effective treatment efciencies. This and tij is the time (number of time units) it takes a
problem can also serve to illustrate graphically particle of pollutant to flow from site i to site
the general mathematical procedures used for j. The actual concentration at the downstream
solving linear programming problems. end of a reach will depend on the streamflow at
The rst step is to develop a model that pre- that site as well as on the initial pollutant mass,
dicts the pollutant concentrations in the stream as the time of travel and decay rate constant k.
a function of the pollutants discharged into it. To In this example problem, the fraction of pol-
do this we need some notation. Dene Wj as the lutant mass at site 1 that reaches site 3 is the
mass of pollutant generated at site j (j = 1, 2) product of the transfer coefcients 12 and 23:
each day. Without any treatment and assuming
no upstream pollution concentration, the dis- a13 a12 a23 4:134
charge of W1 (in units of mass per unit time,
In general, for any site k between sites i and j:
(M/T) at site j = 1 results in pollutant concen-
tration of P1 in the stream at that site. This aij aik akj 4:135
concentration, (M/L3) equals the discharge W1
(M/T) divided by the streamflow Q1 (L3/T) at Knowing the ij values for any pollutant and
that site. For example, assuming the concentra- the time of flow tij permits the determination of
tion is expressed in units of mg/l and the flow is the rate constant k for that pollutant and reach, or
in terms of m3/s, and mass of pollutant dis- contiguous series of reaches, from sites i to j,
charged is expressed as kg/day, and the flow using Eq. 4.133. If the value of k is 0, the pol-
component of the wastewater discharge is neg- lutant is called a conservative pollutant; salt is an
ligible compared to the streamflow, the resulting example of this. Only increased dilution by less
streamflow concentration P1 at site j = 1 is saline water will reduce its concentration.
W1/86.4 Q1: For the purposes of determining wastewater
treatment efciencies or other capital investments
P1 mg=l Mass W1 discharged at site 1 kg=day=
  in infrastructure designed to control the pollutant
streamflow Q1 at site 1 m3 =s = concentrations in the stream, some design
   
kg=106 mg 86; 400 s=day 103 L=m3 streamflow conditions have to be established.
W1 =86:4 Q1 Usually the design streamflow conditions are set
4:132 at low-flow values (e.g., the lowest monthly
average flow expected once in twenty years, or
Each unit of a degradable pollutant mass in the minimum 7-day average flow expected once
the stream at site 1 in this example will decrease in ten years). Low design flows are based on the
as it travels downstream to site 2. Similarly each assumption that pollutant concentrations will be
unit of the pollutant mass in the stream at site 2 higher in low-flow conditions than in higher flow
144 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

conditions because of less dilution. While P3 W1 a12 W2  a23 =86:4Q3 4:137


low-flow conditions may not provide as much
dilution, they result in longer travel times, and
hence greater reductions in pollutant masses 4.5.2.1 Model Calibration
between water quality monitoring sites. Hence Sample measurements are needed to estimate the
the pollutant concentrations may well be greater values of each reachs pollutant transport coef-
at some downstream site when the flow condi- cients aij. Assume ve pairs of sample pollutant
tions are higher than those of the design low-flow concentration measurements have been taken in
value. the two stream reaches (extending from site 1 to
In any event, given particular design stream- site 2, and from site 2 to site 3) during design
flow and temperature conditions, our rst job is flow conditions. For this example, also assume
to determine the values of these dimensionless that the design streamflow just downstream of
transfer coefcients ij. They will be independent site 1 and just upstream of site 2 are the same and
of the amount of waste discharged into the equal to 12 m3/s. The concentration samples
stream as long as the stream stays aerobic. To taken just downstream from site 1 and just
determine both 12 and 23 in this example upstream of site 2 during this design flow con-
problem (Fig. 4.20) requires a number of pollu- dition can be used to solve for the transfer
tant concentration measurements at sites 1, 2 and coefcients 12 and 23 after adding error terms.
3 during design streamflow conditions. These More than one sample is needed to allow for
measurements of pollutant concentrations must measurement errors and other random effects
be made just downstream of the wastewater such as those from varying temperature, wind,
effluent discharge at site 1, just upstream and incomplete mixing or varying wasteload dis-
downstream of the wastewater effluent discharge charges within a day.
at site 2, and at site 3. Denote the concentrations of each pair of
Assuming no change in streamflow and no sample measurements s in the rst reach (just
extra pollutant entering the reach that begins at downstream of site 1 and just upstream of site 2)
site 1 and ends just upstream of site 2, the mass as P1s and P2s and their combined error as Es.
(kg/day) of pollutants just upstream of site 2 will Thus
equal the mass at site 1, W1, times the transfer
coefcient 12: P2s Es P1s a12 Q1 =Q2 4:138

Mass just upstream of site 2 W1 a12 4:136 The problem is to nd the best estimates of
the unknown 12. One way to do this is to dene
From this equation and 4.132 one can calcu- best as those values of 12 and all Es that
late the concentration of pollutants just upstream minimize the sum of the absolute values of all the
of site 2. error terms Es. This objective could be written
The mass of additional pollutant discharged X
Minimize jEs j 4:139
into site 2 is W2. Hence the total mass just
s
downstream of site 2 is W112 + W2. At site 3 the
pollutant mass will equal the mass just down- The set of Eqs. 4.138 and 4.139 is an opti-
stream of site 2, times the transfer coefcient a23. mization model. The absolute value signs in
Given a streamflow of Q3 m3/s and pollutant Eq. 4.139 can be removed by writing each error
masses W1 and W2 kg/day, the pollutant con- term as the difference between two nonnegative
centration P3 expressed in mg/l will equal variables, PEs NEs. Thus for each sample pair s:
4.5 Linear Programming 145

Es PEs  NEs 4:140 illustrated in Fig. 4.20, involves nding the


fractions xi of waste removal at sites i = 1 and 2
If any Es is negative, PEs will be 0 and NEs that meet the stream quality standards at the end
will equal Es. The actual value of NEs is nonneg- of the two reaches at a minimum total cost.
ative. If Es is positive, it will equal PEs, and NEs The pollutant concentration, P2, just upstream
will be 0. The objective function, Eq. 4.139, that of site 2 that results from the pollutant concen-
minimizes the sum of absolute value of error terms, tration at site 1 equals the total mass of pollutant
can now be written as one that minimizes the sum at site 1 times the fraction 12 that remains at site
of the positive and negative components of Es: 2, divided by the streamflow Q2 at site 2. The
X total mass of pollutant at site 1 at the wastewater
Minimize PEs NEs 4:141 discharge point is the sum of the mass just
s upstream of the discharge site, P1Q1, plus the
mass discharged into the stream, W1(1 x1), at
Equations 4.139 and 4.140, together with site 1. The parameter W1 is the total mass of
objective function 4.141 and a set of measure- pollutant entering the treatment plant at site 1.
ments, P1s and P2s, upstream and downstream of Similarly for site 2. The fraction of waste
the reach between sites 1 and 2 dene a linear removal, x1, at site 1 is to be determined. Hence
programming model that can be solved to nd the concentration of pollutant just upstream of
the transfer coefcient 12. An example illus- site 2 is
trating the solution of this model for the stream
reach between site 1 and just upstream of site 2 is P2 P1 Q1 W1 1  x1 a12 =Q2 4:142
presented in Box 4.2. (In this model the mea-
sured concentrations are denoted as SPjs rather The terms P1 and Q1 are the pollutant con-
than Pjs. Again, the program LINGO (www. centration (M/L3) and streamflow (L3/T) just
lindo.com) is used to solve the model). upstream of the wastewater discharge outfall at
Box 4.3 contains the model and solution for site 1. Their product is the mass of pollutant at
the reach beginning just downstream of site 2 to that site per unit time period (M/T).
site 3. In this reach the design streamflow is The pollutant concentration, P3, at site 3 that
12.5 m3/s due to the addition of wastewater flow results from the pollutant concentration at site 2
at site 2. equals the total mass of pollutant at site 2 times
As shown in Boxes 4.2 and 4.3, the values of the fraction a23. The total mass of pollutant at site
the transfer coefcients are 12 = 0.25 and 2 at the wastewater discharge point is the sum of
23 = 0.60. Thus from Eq. 4.134, 12 what is just upstream of the discharge site, P2Q2,
23 = 13 = 0.15. plus what is discharged into the stream,
W2(1 x2). Hence the concentration of pollutant
4.5.2.2 Management Model at site 3 is
Now that these parameter values ij are known, a
P3 P2 Q2 W2 1  x2 a23 =Q3 4:143
water quality management model can be devel-
oped. The water quality management problem,
146 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Box 4.2. Calibration of water quality model transfer coefficient parameter a12

Equations 4.142 and 4.143 will become the represent the cost function of wastewater treat-
predictive portion of the water quality manage- ment at sites i = 1 and 2, the objective can be
ment model. The remaining parts of the model written:
include the restrictions on the pollutant concen-
trations just upstream of site 2 and at site 3, and Minimize C1 x1 C2 x2 4:146
limits on the range of values that each waste
The complete optimization model consists of
removal efciency, xi, can assume.
Eqs. 4.1424.146. There are four unknown
Pj  Pmax for j 2 and 3 4:144 decision variables, x1; x2, P2, and P3.
j
Some of the constraints of this optimization
0  xi  1:0 for i 1 and 2: 4:145 model can be combined to remove the two
unknown concentration values, P2 and P3.
Finally, the objective is to minimize the total Combining Eqs. 4.142 and 4.144, the concen-
cost of meeting the stream quality standards Pmax
2 tration just upstream of site 2 must be no greater
and Pmax
3 specied in Eqs. 4.144. Letting Ci(xi) than Pmax
2 :
4.5 Linear Programming 147

P1 Q1 W1 1  x1 a12 =Q2  Pmax 4:147 Equation 4.148 assumes that each pollutant
2
discharged into the stream can be tracked
Combining Eqs. 4.143 and 4.144, and using downstream, independent of the other pollutants
the fraction 13 (see Eq. 4.134) to predict the in the stream. Alternatively, Eq. 4.148 computes
contribution of the pollutant concentration at site the sum of all the pollutants found at site 2 and
1 on the pollutant concentration at Site 3: then uses that total mass to compute the con-
centration at site 3. Both modeling approaches
fP1 Q1 W1 1  x1 a13 W2 1  x2 a23 g=Q3  Pmax
3 give the same results if the parameter values and
4:148 cost functions are the same.

Box 4.3. Calibration of water quality model transfer coefficient parameter a23
148 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Table 4.22 Parameter values selected for the water quality management problem illustrated in Fig. 4.20

To illustrate the solution of either of these x1 1:28x2  1:79: 4:150


models, assume the values of the parameters are
as listed in Table 4.22. Rewriting the water Restrictions on fractions of waste removal,
quality management model dened by Eq. 4.145, must also be added to this model.
Eqs. 4.1454.148 and substituting the parameter The feasible combinations of x1 and x2 can be
values in place of the parameters, and recalling shown on a graph, as in Fig. 4.21. This graph is a
that kg/day = 86.4 (mg/l)(m3/s): plot of each constraint, showing the boundaries
The water quality constraint at site 2, of the region of combinations of x1 and x2 that
Eq. 4.147, becomes satisfy all the constraints. This red shaded region
is called the feasible region.
3210 250; 0001  x1 =86:40:25=12  20 To nd the least-cost solution we need the cost
functions C1(x1) and C2(x2) in Eqs. 4.146. Suppose
that when simplied is these functions are not known. Can we determine
the least-cost solution without knowing these costs?
x1  0:78: 4:149 Models like the one just developed can be used to
determine just how accurate these cost functions (or
The water quality constraint at site 3,
the values of any of the model parameters) need to
Eq. 4.148, becomes
be for the decisions being considered.
f3210 250; 0001  x1 =86:40:15 While the actual cost functions are not known
80; 0001  x2 =86:40:60g=13  20 in this example, their general form can be
assumed, as shown in Fig. 4.22. Since the
that when simplied is wasteloads produced at site 1 are substantially
4.5 Linear Programming 149

Fig. 4.21 Plot of the


constraints of water quality X2
management model
identifying those values of
the unknown (decision) 1.5
variables x1 and x2 that equation 150 equation 145
satisfy all the constraints.
These feasible values are equation 157
contained in and on the 1.0
boundaries of the red feasible region
region
0.5
equation 149

0.0
0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0
E020103o

X1

Fig. 4.22 General form of


total cost functions for
wastewater treatment
efciencies at sites 1 and 2
in Fig. 4.20. The dashed
straight-line slopes c1 and
c2 are the average cost per
unit (%) removal for 80%
treatment. The actual
average costs clearly
depend on the values of the
waste removal efciencies
x1 and x2, respectively

greater than those produced at site 2, and given any given treatment efciency. The relative
similar site, labor, and material cost conditions, it positions of the cost functions shown in Fig. 4.23
seems reasonable to assume that the cost of are based on these assumptions.
providing a specied level of treatment at site 1 Rewriting the cost function, Eq. 4.146, as a
would exceed (or certainly be no less than) the linear function converts the model dened by
cost of providing the same specied level of Eqs. 4.1454.148 into a linear programming
treatment at Site 2. It would also seem the mar- model. For this example problem, the linear
ginal costs at site 1 would be greater than, or at programming model can be written as:
least no less than, the marginal costs at site 2 for
150 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Fig. 4.23 Plots of various


objective functions (dashed
lines) together with the
constraints of the water
quality management model

Minimize c1 x1 c2 x2 4:151 Note this particular least-cost solution also


applies for any value of c1 greater than c2 (for
Equation 4.151 is minimized subject to con- example line c in Fig. 4.23). If the marginal
straints 4.145, 4.149 and 4.150. The values of c1 cost of 80% treatment at site 1 is no less than the
and c2 depend on the values of x1 and x2 and both marginal cost of 80% treatment at site 2, then
pairs are unknown. Even if we knew the values of c1 c2 and indeed the 80% treatment efciencies
x1 and x2 before solving the problem, in this will meet the stream standards for the design
example the cost functions themselves (Fig. 4.22) streamflow and wasteload conditions at a total
are unknown. Hence, we cannot determine the minimum cost. In fact, from Fig. 4.23 and
values of the marginal costs c1 and c2. However, Eq. 4.150, it is clear that c2 has to exceed c1 by a
we might be able to judge which marginal cost multiple of 1.28 before the least-cost solution
will likely be greater than the other for any par- changes to another solution. For any other
ticular values of the decision variables x1 and x2. assumption regarding c1 and c2, 80% treatment at
In this example that is all we need to know. both sites will result in a least-cost solution to
First, assume c1 equals c2. Let c1 x1 + c2 x2 meeting the water quality standards for those
equal c and assume c/c1 = 1. Thus the cost design wasteload and streamflow conditions.
function is x1 + x2 = 1.0. This line can be plotted If c2 exceeds 1.28c1, as illustrated by line d,
onto the graph in Fig. 4.21, as shown by line a then the least-cost solution would be x1 = 100%
in Fig. 4.23. and x2 = 62%. Clearly, in this example the
Line a in Fig. 4.23 represents equal values marginal cost, c1, of providing 100% wasteload
for c1 and c2, and the total cost, c1 x1 + c2 x2, removal at site 1 will exceed the marginal cost,
equal to 1. Keeping the slope of this line constant c2, of 60% removal at site 2, and hence, that
and moving it upward, representing increasing combination of efciencies would not be a
total costs, to line b, where it covers the nearest least-cost one. Thus we can be condent that the
point in the feasible region, will identify the least-cost solution is to remove 80% of the waste
least-cost combination of x1 and x2, again produced at both waste-generating sites.
assuming the marginal costs are equal. In this Note the least-cost wasteload removal ef-
case the solution is approximately 80% treatment ciencies have been determined without knowing
at both sites. the cost functions. Why spend money dening
4.5 Linear Programming 151

these functions more precisely? The answer: the problem is linear (at least in theory), there is
costs need to be known for nancial planning, if an incentive to use linear programming to solve
not for economic analyses. No doubt the actual large optimization problems. Especially for large
costs of installing the least-cost treatment ef- optimization problems, linear programming is
ciencies of 80% will have to be determined for often the only practical alternative for nding at
issuing bonds or making other arrangements for least an approximate optimal solution. Yet
paying the costs. However, knowing the models representing particular water resources
least-cost removal efciencies means we do not systems may not be linear. This motivates the use
have to spend money dening the entire cost of methods that can approximate nonlinear
functions Ci(xi). Estimating the construction and functions with linear ones, or the use of other
operating costs of achieving just one wastewater search algorithms such as those discussed in
removal efciency at each site, namely 80%, Chap. 5).
should be less expensive than dening the total The following simple groundwater supply
costs for a range of practical treatment plant problem illustrates the application of some lin-
efciencies that would be required to dene the earization methods commonly applied to non-
total cost functions, such as shown in Fig. 4.22. linear separable functionsfunctions of only one
Admittedly this example is relatively simple. unknown variable.
It will not always be possible to determine the These approximation methods typically
optimal solutions to linear programming increase the number of variables and constraints
problems, or other optimization problems, with- in a model. Some of these methods require integer
out knowing more about the objective function variables, or variables that can have values of
than was assumed for this example. However, only 0 or 1. There is a practical limit on the
this exercise illustrates the use of modeling for number of integer variables any linear program-
purposes other than nding good or optimal ming software program can handle. Hence, for
solutions. Models can help dene the necessary large models there may be a need to perform
precision of the data needed to nd those some preliminary screening designed to reduce
solutions. the number of alternatives that should be con-
Modeling and data collection and analysis sidered in more detail. This example can be used
should take place simultaneously. All too often to illustrate an approach to preliminary screening.
planning exercises are divided into two stages:
data collection and then analysis. Until one
knows what data one will need, and how accurate 4.5.3 A Groundwater Supply
those data must be, one need not spend money Example
and time collecting them. Conversely, model
development in the absence of any knowledge of Consider a water-using industry that plans to
the availability and cost of obtaining data can obtain water from a groundwater aquifer. Two
lead to data requirements that are costly, or even welleld sites have been identied. The rst
impossible, to obtain, at least in the time avail- question is how much will the water cost, and the
able for decision-making. Data collection and second, given any specied amount of water
model development are activities that should be delivered to the user, is how much should come
performed simultaneously. from each welleld. This situation is illustrated
Because software is widely available to solve in Fig. 4.24.
linear programming programs, because these Wells and pumps must be installed and oper-
software programs can solve very large problems ated to obtain water from these two wellelds.
containing thousands of variables and con- The annual cost of welleld development will
straints, and nally because there is less chance depend on the pumping capacity of the welleld.
of obtaining a local nonoptimal solution when Assume that the annual costs associated with
152 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

gure, the maximum flow capacity of Wellelds


A and B are 17 and 13, respectively.
In Fig. 4.25, the nonlinear functions on the
left have been approximated by piecewise linear
functions on the right. This is a rst step in lin-
earizing nonlinear separable functions. Increas-
ing the number of linear segments can reduce the
difference between the piecewise linear approxi-
mation of the actual nonlinear function and the
function itself. At the same time it will increase
the number of variables and possibly constraints.
When approximating a nonlinear function by a
Fig. 4.24 Schematic of a potential groundwater supply
system that can serve a water-using industry. The series of straight lines, model developers should
unknown variables are the flows, QA and QB, from each consider two factors. The rst is just how accurate
welleld need be the approximation of the actual function
for the decisions that will be made, and second is
various capacities QA and QB for Wellelds A and just how accurate is the actual (in this case non-
B, respectively, are as shown in Fig. 4.25. These linear) function in the rst place. There is little
are nonlinear functions that contain both xed value in trying to eliminate relatively small errors
and variable costs and hence are discontinuous. caused by the linearization of a function when the
The xed costs result from the fact that some of function itself is highly uncertain. Most cost and
the components required for welleld develop- benet functions, especially those associated with
ment come in discrete sizes. As indicated in the future activities, are indeed uncertain.

Fig. 4.25 Annual cost functions associated with the Wellelds A and B as shown in Fig. 4.24. The actual functions are
shown on the left, and two sets of piecewise linear approximations are shown on the right
4.5 Linear Programming 153

4.5.3.1 A Simplified Model QB  13IB limits QB to 13 and forces IB 1


Two sets of approximations are shown in if QB [ 0
Fig. 4.26. Consider rst the approximations
4:157
represented by the light blue dot-dash lines.
These single straight lines are very crude
QA QB Q mass balance 4:158
approximations of each function. In this example
these straight-line cost functions are lower
Q; QA ; QB  0
bounds of the actual nonlinear costs. Hence, the
non-negativity of all decision variables
actual costs may be somewhat higher than those
identied in the solution of a model. 4:159
Using the blue dot-dash linear approximations
in Fig. 4.26, the linear programming model can Q some specified amount from 0 to 30:
be written as follows: 4:160

The expressions within the square brackets,


Minimize CostA CostB 4:152
[ ], in Eqs. 4.154 and 4.155 above represent the
Subject to slopes of the dot-dash linear approximations of
the cost functions. The integer 0, 1 variables are
CostA 8IA 40  8=17QA required to include the xed costs in the model.
linear approximation of CQA Solving this linear model for various values of
the water demand Q provides some interesting
4:153 results. Again, they are based on the dot-dash
linear cost functions in Fig. 4.25. As Q increases
CostB 15IB 26  15=13QB from 0 to just under 6.8, all the water will come
linear approximation of CQB from the less expensive Welleld A. For any
4:154 Q from 6.8 to 13, Welleld B becomes less
expensive and all the water will come from it. For
IA ; IB are 0; 1 integer binary variables any Q greater than the capacity of Welleld B of 13
but no greater than the capacity of Welleld A, 17,
4:155
all of it will come from Welleld A. Because of the
xed costs, it is cheaper to use one rather than both
QA  17IA limits QA to 17 and forces IA 1 wellelds. Beyond Q = 17, the maximum capac-
if QA [ 0
ity of A, water needs to come from both wellelds.
4:156 Welleld B will pump at its capacity, 13, and the
additional water will come from Welleld A.

Fig. 4.26 Least-cost


welleld use given total
demand Q based on model
dened by Eqs. 4.152 to
4.160
154 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Figure 4.26 illustrates these solutions. One IA1 IA2 IA3  1 limits solution to at most
can understand why in situations of increasing
only one cost function segment i:
demands for Q over time, capacity expansion
modeling might be useful. One would not close 4:168
down a welleld once developed, just to achieve
QB1  3IB1 ;
what would have been a least-cost solution if the
existing welleld had not been developed. QB2  10  3IB2 ;
QB3  13  10IB2 limits QBi to width of
4.5.3.2 A More Detailed Model segment i and forces IBi 1 if QBi [ 0:
A more accurate representation of these cost 4:169
functions may change these solutions for various
values of Q, although not signicantly. However IB1 IB2  1 4:170
consider the more accurate cost minimization
Q QA QB mass balance 4:171
model that includes the red solid-line piecewise
linearizations shown in Fig. 4.26.
Minimize CostA CostB 4:161 Q; QA ; QB  0
non-negativityof all decision variables
Subject to 4:172
linear approximation of cost functions:
Q some specified amount from 0 to 30
CostA f8IA1 20  8=5QA1 g
4:173
f26IA2 30  26=10  5QA2 g
f35IA3 40  35=17  10QA3 g Constraint (4.170) limits the solution to at
4:162 most only the rst segment or to the second and
third segments of the cost function for welleld
B. Note that a 0, 1 integer variable for the xed
CostB f15IB1 18  15=3QB1 g cost of the third segment of this function is not
f18IB2 20  18=10  3QB2 needed since its slope exceeds that of the second
26  20=13  10QB3 g segment. However the flow, QB3, in that segment
4:163 must be bounded using the integer 0, 1 variable,
QA and QB dened. IB2, associated with the second segment, as
shown in the third of Eqs. 4.169.
QA QA1 5IA2 QA2 10IA3 QA3 The solution to this model, shown in Fig. 4.27,
4:164 differs from the solution of the simpler model, but
only in the details. Welleld A supplies all the
QB QB1 3IB2 QB2 QB3 4:165 water for Q 4.3. For values of Q in excess of 4.3
up to 13 all the water comes from Welleld B. For
IAi and IBi are 0; 1 integer variables values of Q in excess of 13 up to 14.8, the capacity
4:166
for all segments i of Welleld B remains at its maximum capacity of
13 and Welleld A provides the additional amount
QA1  5IA1 of needed capacity over 13. As Q increases from
QA2  10  5IA2 ; 14.9 to 17, the capacity of Welleld B drops to 0
QA3  17  10IA3 limits QAi to width of and the capacity of Welleld A increases from 14.9
segment i and forces I Ai 1 if QAi [ 0 to 17. For values of Q between 17 and 18 Welleld
B provides 13, its maximum capacity, and the
4:167 capacity of A increases from 4 to 5. For values of
4.5 Linear Programming 155

Fig. 4.27 Least-cost


welleld use given total
demand Q based on
Eqs. 4.161 to 4.173

Q from 18.1 to 20, Welleld B decreases to a way of providing a specied amount of water to
constant 10, and Welleld A increases from 8.1 to a water user. It does not address the problem of
10. For values of Q from 20 to 23, Welleld planning for an increasing demand for Q over
A remains at 10 and Welleld B increases from 10 time. Clearly it makes no sense to implement the
to 13. For values of Q from 23 to 27, Welleld particular cost-effective solution for any value of
B again drops to a constant 10 and Welleld A in- Q, as shown in Fig. 4.27, as the demand for
creases from 13 to 17. For values of Q in excess of Q increases, as in this example, from 0 to 30.
27, Welleld A remains at its maximum capacity of This is the capacity expansion problem, the
17, and Welleld B increases from 10 to 13. solution of which will benet from models that
As in the previous example, this shows the take time into account and that are not static as
effect on the least-cost solution when one cost illustrated previously in this chapter.
function has relatively lower xed and higher Next, consider a costbenet analysis in
variable costs compared with another cost func- which the question is just how much water
tion having relatively higher xed and lower should users use. To address this question we
variable costs. assume the user has identied the annual benets
associated with various amounts of water. The
4.5.3.3 An Extended Model annual benet function, B(Q), and its piecewise
In this example, the simpler model (Eqs. 4.152 linear approximations, are shown in Fig. 4.28.
4.160) and the more accurate model (Eqs. 4.161 The straight, blue, dot-dash linear approxima-
4.173) provided essentially the same allocations tion of the benet function shown in Fig. 4.28 is an
of welleld capacities associated with a specied upper bound of the benets. Incorporating it into a
total capacity Q. If the problem contained a lar- model that uses the dot-dash linear lower bound
ger number of wellelds, the simpler (and approximations of each cost function, as shown in
smaller) model might have been able to eliminate Fig. 4.25 will produce an optimistic solution. It is
some of these wellelds from further considera- unlikely that the value of Q that is based on more
tion. This would reduce the size of any new accurate and thus less optimistic benet and cost
model that approximates the cost functions of the functions will be any greater than the one identi-
remaining wellelds more accurately. ed by this simple optimistic model. Furthermore,
The model just described, like the capacity if any welleld is not in the solution of this opti-
expansion model and water quality management mistic model, with some care we might be able to
model, is another example of a cost-effective eliminate that welleld from further consideration
model. The objective was to nd the least-cost when developing a more accurate model.
156 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Fig. 4.28 Benet function of the amount of water provided to the water user. Piecewise linear approximations of that
function of flow are shown on the right

Any component of a water resources system the more detailed model that incorporates the red,
that does not appear in the solution of a model solid-line linear approximations of the cost and
that includes optimistic approximations of per- benet functions shown in Figs. 4.25 and 4.28.
formance measures that are to be maximized, Note that the approximation of the generally
such as benets, or that are to be minimized, such concave benet function in Fig. 4.29 will result
as costs, are candidates for omission in any more in negative values of the benets for small values
detailed model. This is an example of the process of Q. For example, when the flow Q, is 0 the
of preliminary screening. approximated benets are 10. Yet the actual
The model dened by Eqs. 4.1524.160 can benets are 0 as shown in the left part of
now be modied. Equation 4.160 is eliminated Fig. 4.28. Modeling these initial xed benets
and the cost minimization objective Eq. 4.152 is the same way as the xed costs have been
replaced with: modeled, using another 0, 1 integer variable,
would allow a more accurate representation of
Maximize Benefits  CostA CostB the actual benets for small values of Q.
4:174 Alternatively, to save having to add another
integer variable and constraint to the model, one
where can allow the benets to be negative. If the
model solution shows negative benets for some
Benefits 10 45  25=21  9Q small value of Q, then obviously the more pre-
linear approximation of BQ ferred value of Q, and benets, would be 0. This
4:175 more approximate trial-and-error approach is
often preferred in practice, especially when a
The solution of this model, Eqs. 4.1534.159, model contains a large number of variables and
4.174, and 4.175 (plus the condition that the constraints. This is the approach taken here.
xed benet of 10 only applies if Q > 0, added
because it is clear the benets would be 0 with a 4.5.3.4 Piecewise Linear Model
Q of 0) indicates that only Welleld B needs to There are a number of ways of modeling the
be developed, and at a capacity of 10. This would piecewise linear concave benet function shown
suggest that Welleld A can be omitted in any on the right side of Fig. 4.28. Several are dened
more detailed modeling exercise. To see if this in the next several sets of equations. Each
assumption, in this example, is valid, consider method will result in the same model solution.
4.5 Linear Programming 157

One approach to modeling the concave benet The linearized benet function can now be
function is to dene a new unrestricted (possibly written as the sum over all three segments of
negative valued) variable. Let this variable be each segment slope times the variable qi:
Benets. When being maximized this variable
cannot exceed any of the linear functions that Benefits 10 25 10=9q1
bound the concave benet function:
45  25=21  9q2
Benefits   10 25  10=9Q 4:176 50  45=30  21q3
4:183
Benefits  10 45  25=21  9Q Since the function being maximized is con-
4:177 cave (decreasing slopes as Q increases), we are
assured that each qi + 1 will be greater than 0
only if qi is at its upper limit, as dened by
Benefits  33 50  45=30  21Q constraint Eqs. 4.1794.181.
4:178 A third method is to dene unknown weights
wi associated with the breakpoints of the lin-
Since most linear programming algorithms earized function. The value of Q can be expres-
assume the unknown variables are nonnegative sed as the sum of a weighted combination of
(unless otherwise specied), unrestricted vari- segment endpoint values. Similarly, the benets
ables, such as Benets, can be replaced by the associated with Q can be expressed as a weighted
difference between two nonnegative variables, combination of the benets evaluated at the
such as Pben Nben. Pben will equal Benets if segment endpoint values. The unknown weights
its value is greater than 0. Otherwise Nben will must also sum to 1. Hence, for this example:
equal Benets. Thus in place of Benets in
Eqs. 4.1764.178, and those below, one can Benefits 10w1 25w2 45w3 50w4
substitute Pben Nben. 4:184
Another modeling approach is to divide the
variable Q into parts, qi, one for each segment
i of the function. These parts sum to Q. Each qi, Q 0w1 9w2 21w3 30w4 4:185
ranges from 0 to the width of the user-dened
segment i. Thus for the piecewise linear benet
function shown on the right of Fig. 4.28: 1 w1 w2 w3 w4 4:186

q1  9 4:179 For this method to provide the closest


approximation of the original nonlinear function,
the solution must include no more than two
q2  21  9 4:180 nonzero weights and those nonzero weights must
be adjacent to each other. For concave functions
that are to be maximized, this condition will be
q3  30  21 4:181 met, since any other situation would yield less
benets.
and
The solution to the more detailed model
Q q1 q2 q3 4:182 dened by Eqs. 4.174, 4.1624.172, and either
4.1764.178, 4.1794.183, or 4.1844.186,
158 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

indicates a value of 10 for Q will result in the binary (0, 1) variables. Note the constraints are
maximum net benets. This flow is to come from all linear.
Welleld B. This more precise solution is iden-
tical to the solution of the simpler model. Clearly (a) If Y  50 then X  10; else X  15:
the simpler model could have successfully served Dene constraints:
to eliminate Welleld A from further
consideration. Y  50 Z Ymax 1  Z
Y  501  Z
X  10Z Xmax 1  Z
4.5.4 A Review of Linearization
X  151  Z
Methods
(b) If Y  50 then X  Y; else X  Y:
This section reviews the piecewise linearization
Dene constraints:
methods just described and some other approa-
ches for incorporating nonlinear conditions into
Y  50Z
linear programming models. All of these meth-
ods maintain linearity. Y  501  Z Ymax Z
X  Y Xmax Z
If-then-else conditions
X  Y  Ymax 1  Z
There exist a number of ways if-then-else and
and and or conditions (that is, decision trees)
(c) If Y  20 or Y  80 then X 5; else X  10:
can be included in linear programming models.
Dene constraints:
To illustrate some of them, assume X is an
unknown decision variable in a model whose
Y  20Z1 80Z2 Ymax 1  Z1  Z2
value may depend on the value of another
unknown decision variable Y. Assume the maxi- Y  20Z2 801  Z1  Z2
mum value of Y would not exceed Ymax and the Z1 Z2  1
maximum value of X would not exceed Xmax. X  5Z1 1  Z1  Z2 Xmax Z2
These upper bounds and all the linear constraints X  5Z1 1  Z1  Z2
representing if-then-else conditions must not
X  10Z2
restrict the values of the original decision variable
Y. Four if-then-else (with and/or) conditions
(d) If 20 Y 50 or 60 Y 80, then X 5,
are presented below using additional integer 0.1
else X 10.
variables, denoted by Z. All the X, Y, and Z vari-
Dene constraints:
ables in the constraints below are assumed to be
unknown. These constraints would be included in Y  20Z1 50Z2 60Z3 80Z4
the any linear programming model where the Ymax 1  Z1  Z2  Z3  Z4 :
particular if-then-else conditions apply.
Y  20Z2 50Z3 60Z4
These illustrations are not unique. At the
801  Z1  Z2  Z3  Z4
boundaries of the if constraints in the examples
Z1 Z2 Z3 Z4  1
below, either of the then or else conditions
can apply. All variables (X, Y) are assumed X  5Z2 Z4 Xmax 1  Z2  Z4
nonnegative. All variables Z are assumed to be a X  10Z1 Z3 1  Z1  Z2  Z3  Z4
4.5 Linear Programming 159

Minimizing the absolute value of the dif- Linearization of convex functions for
ference between two unknown nonnegative maximization or concave function for mini-
variables: mization involves 0, 1 binary variables.
Minimize |X Y| is equivalent to
Minimize D Fixed costs in cost functions

subject to
X  Y  D;
Y  X  D;
X; Y; D  0:

or
Minimize PD ND

subject to
X  Y PD  ND;
PD; ND; X; Y  0:
Consider functions that have xed compo-
Minimizing the maximum or maximizing nents if the argument of the function is greater
the minimum than 0.
Let the set of variables be {X1, X2, X3, , Xn},
Minimizing the maximum of {X1, X2, X3, , Xn} Cost C0 CX if X [ 0;
is equivalent to 0 otherwise:
Minimize U
To include these xed costs in a LP model,
subject to dene
U  Xj ; j 1; 2; 3; . . .; n: Cost C0 I CX

Maximizing the minimum of {X1, X2, X3, , Subject to


Xn} is equivalent to
Maximize L X  MI

subject to where M is the maximum value of X, and I is an


unknown 0, 1 binary variable.
L  Xj ; j 1; 2; 3; . . .; n:
160 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Minimizing convex functions or maximiz-


ing concave functions.

Subject to
Maximize G X Maximize B
X x1 x2 x3
Subject to x1  a
I 1 S1 X  B x2  b  a
I 2 S2 X  B
I 3 S3 X  B

Minimize F X S1 x1 S2 x2 S3 x3
Maximize G X S1 x1 S2 x2 S3 x3
4.5 Linear Programming 161

Minimize G X 5x1 20z2 3x2 44z3 2x3


Minimize F X F0w1 F aw2 F bw3 F cw4
Maximize GX G0w1 Gaw2 Gbw3 Gcw4
Subject to

Subject to x1 4z2 x2 12z3 x3 X


zs 0 or 1 for all segments s
X 0w1 aw2 b w3 c w4
w1 w2 w3 w4 1
x1  4z1 ;
Minimizing concave functions or maximiz- x2  8z2 ;
ing convex functions
x3  99z3 ;
z1 z2 z3 1:
162 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Minimizing or maximizing combined con-


caveconvex functions

Maximize
C X 5z1 6x1 3x2 17z3 5x3

Subject to
Maximize
x1 x2 x3 X
C X 5z1 6x1 3x2 53z3 5x3
z1 ; z3 0; 1
Subject to x1  4z1
x2  8z1
x1 x2 12z3 x3 X
x3  99z3
x1  4z1
z1 z3 1;
x2  8z1
x3  99z3
z1 z3 1 Minimize
C X 5z1 6x1 17z2 3x2 5x3
z1 ; z3 0; 1
Subject to
Minimize
x1 4z2 x2 x3 X
CX 5z1 6x1 29z2 3x2 5x3
z1 ; z2 0; 1:
Subject to x1  4z1
x2  12z2
z1 ; z2 0; 1:
x3  99z2
x1 4z2 x2 x3 X
z1 z2  1
x1  4z1
x2  8z2
x3  99z2
z1 z2  1
4.5 Linear Programming 163

Maximize or Minimize F(X) counterparts, there are multiple feasible solutions


to each of these problems. Hence, the task is to
F X 5z1 6x1 35z2 3x2 32z3 2x3 22z4 nd the best solution, or a number of near-best
solutions. Each solution must satisfy all the
Subject to constraints.
Constraints can reflect physical conditions,
x1 4z2 x2 12z3 x3 17z4 x4 X environmental regulations and/or social or eco-
x1  4z1 nomic targets. Especially with respect to envi-
x2  8z2 ronmental or social conditions and goals, it is
often a matter of judgment to decide what is
x3  5z3 :
considered an objective that is to be minimized
x4  99z4 or maximized and what is considered a constraint
z1 z2 z3 z4 1; that has to be met. For example, do we mini-
zs 0; 1 for all segments s mize the costs of meeting specied maximum
levels of pollutant concentrations or minimize
pollutant concentrations without exceeding
specied costs?
4.6 A Brief Review Except for relatively simple problems, the use
of these optimization models and methods is
Before proceeding to other optimization and primarily for reducing the number of alternatives
simulation methods in the following chapters, it that need to be further analyzed and evaluated
may be useful to review the topics covered so far. using simulation methods. Optimization is gen-
The focus has been on model development as erally used for preliminary screeningeliminat-
well as model solution. Several types of water ing inferior alternatives before more detailed
resources planning and management problems analyses are carried out. Presented were some
have been used to illustrate model development approaches to preliminary screening involving
and solution processes. Like their real-world hill-climbing, calculus-based Lagrange multi-
counterparts, the example problems all had plier, numerical nonlinear programming, discrete
multiple unknown decision variables and multi- dynamic programming, and linear programming
ple constraints. Also like their real-world methods. Each method has its strengths and
164 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

limitations. Both linear and nonlinear program- Hillier, F. S., & Lieberman, G. J. (1990b). Introduction to
ming models are typically solved using software stochastic models in operations research. New York:
McGraw-Hill.
packages. Many of these software programs are Hufschmidt, M. M., & Fiering, M. B. (1966). Simulation
free and readily available. But before any model techniques for design of water-resource systems.
can be solved, it has to be built. Building models Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
is an art and that is what this chapter has Kapamoyz, M., Szidarovszky, F., & Zahpaie, B. (2003).
Water resources systems analysis. Boca Raton, FL:
attempted to introduce. Lewis.
The example problems used to illustrate these Loucks, D. P., & da Costa, J. R. (Eds.). (1990). Decision
modeling and model solution methods have been support systems: water resources planning. Berlin:
relatively simple. However, simple applications Springer.
Loucks, D. P., Stedinger, J. S., & Haith, D. A. (1981).
such as these can form the foundation of models Water resource systems planning and analysis. Pren-
of more complex problems, as will be shown in tice Hall: Englewood Cliffs, NJ.
following chapters. Maass, A., Hufschmidt, M. M., Dorfman, R., Thomas, H.
A., Jr., Marglin, S. A., & Fair, G. M. (1962). Design
of water-resource systems. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press.
Reference Major, D. C., & Lenton, R. L. (1979). Applied water
resources systems planning. Prentice Hall: Englewood
Cliffs, NJ.
Bellman, R. E. (1957). Dynamic programming. Princeton, Mays, L. W., & Tung, Y.-K. (1992). Hydrosystems
NJ: Princeton University Press. engineering and management. New York:
McGraw-Hill.
Newnan, D. G., Lavelle, J. P., & Eschenbach, T. G.
Additional References (2002). Essentials of engineering economic analysis
(2nd ed.). New York: Oxford University Press.
(Further Reading) Rardin, R. L. (1998). Optimization in operations
research. Prentice Hall: Upper Saddle River, NJ.
Bassson, M. S., Allen, R. B., Pegram, G. G. S., & Van Revelle, C. (1999). Optimizing reservoir resources. New
Rooyen, J. A. (1994). Probabilistic management of York: Wiley.
water resource and hydropower systems. Highlands Somlyody, L. (1997). Use of optimization models in river
Ranch, CO: Water Resources Publications. basin water quality planning: WATERMATEX97.
Beroggi, G. E. G. (1999). Decision modeling in policy In M. B. Beck & P. Lessard (Eds.), Systems analysis
management: An introduction to analytic concepts. and computing in water quality management:
Boston, MA: Kluwer Academic. Towards a new agenda. London: IWA.
Blanchard, B. S., & Fabrycky, W. J. (1998). Systems Taylor, B. W., III. (1999). Introduction to management
engineering and analysis (3rd ed.). Prentice Hall: science (6th ed.). Prentice Hall: Upper Saddle River,
Upper Saddle River, NJ. NJ.
Buras, N. (1966). Dynamic programming and water Willis, R., & Yeh, W. W.-G. (1987). Groundwater
resources development, advances in hydroscience systems planning and management. Prentice Hall:
(Vol. 3). New York: Academic Press. Englewood Cliffs, NJ.
Dorfman, R., Jacoby, H. D., & Thomas, H. A., Jr. (1972). Winston, W. L. (1994). Operations research: Applications
Models for managing regional water quality. Cam- and algorithms (3rd edn.). Boston, MA: Duxbury.
bridge, MA: Harvard University Press. Winston, W. L., & Albright, S. C. (2001). Practical
Esogbue, A. O. (Ed.). (1989). Dynamic programming for management science (2nd edn.). Pacic Grove, CA:
optimal water resources systems analysis. Prentice Duxbury.
Hall: Englewood Cliffs, NJ. Wright, J. R., & Houck, M. H. (1995). Water resources
Hall, W. A., & Dracup, J. A. (1970). Water resources planning and managementm, Chap. 37. In W. F. Chen
systems engineering. New York: McGraw-Hill. (Ed.), Civil engineering handbook. Boca Raton: CRC.
Hillier, F. S., & Lieberman, G. J. (1990a). Introduction to Wurbs, R. A. (1996). Modeling and analysis of reservoir
operations research (5th ed.). New York: system operations. Prentice Hall: Upper Saddle River,
McGraw-Hill. NJ.
Exercises 165

Exercises (b) Show that when compounding is con-


tinuous (i.e., when the number of
Engineering economics: periods m ), the compound
interest factor required to convert a
4:1 Consider two alternative water resource present value to a future value in year
projects, A and B. Project A will cost T is erT. [Hint: Use the fact that
$2,533,000 and will return $1,000,000 at lim 1 1=kk e, the base of natural
k!1
the end of 5 years and $4,000,000 at the
logarithms.]
end of 10 years. Project B will cost
$4,000,000 and will return $2,000,000 at
4:4 The term capitalized cost refers to the
the end of 5 and 15 years, and another
present value PV of an innite series of
$3,000,000 at the end of 10 years. Pro-
end-of-year equal payments, A. Assuming
ject A has a life of 10 years, and B has a
an interest rate of r, show that as the ter-
life of 15 years. Assuming an interest rate
minal period T , PV = A/r.
of 0.1 (10%) per year:
4:5 The internal rate of return of any project or
(a) What is the present value of each plan is the interest rate that equals the pre-
project? sent value of all receipts or income with the
(b) What is each projects annual net present value of all costs. Show that the
benet? internal rate of return of projects A and B in
(c) Would the preferred project differ if Exercise 4.1 are approximately 8 and 6%,
the interest rates were 0.05? respectively. These are the interest rates r,
(d) Assuming that each of these projects for each project, that essentially satisfy the
would be replaced with a similar equation
project having the same time stream of
costs and returns, show that by X
T
Rt  Ct 1 rt 0
extending each series of projects to a
t0
common terminal year (e.g.,
30 years), the annual net benets of 4:6 In Exercise 4.1, the maximum annual
each series of projects will be same as benets were used as an economic crite-
found in part (b). rion for plan selection. The maximum
PT T
benetcost ratio, or annual benets divi-
4:2 Show that A t1 1 rt 1r1 r r1
T A, ded by annual costs, is another criterion.
the present value of a series of equal pay- Benetcost ratios should be no less than
ments, A, at the end of each year for one if the annual benets are to exceed the
T years. What is the impact of an increasing annual costs. Consider two projects, I
interest rate over time on the present value? and II:
4:3 (a) Show that if compounding occurs at
Project
the end of m equal length periods
within a year in which the nominal I II
interest rate is r, then the effective Annual benets 20 2
annual interest rate, r, is equal to Annual costs 18 1.5
 r m
Annual net benets 2 0.5
r0 1 1 Benetcost ratio 1.11 1.3
m
166 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

What additional information is needed Maximize Benefit X  Cost X


before one can determine which project is Subject to: X  23
the most economical project?
4:7 Bonds are often sold to raise money for 4:9 Assume water can be allocated to three
water resources project investments. Each users. The allocation, xj, to each use j pro-
bond is a promise to pay a specied vides the following returns: R
amount of interest, usually semiannually, (x1) = (12x1 x21), R(x2) = (8x2 x22) and
and to pay the face value of the bond at R(x3) = (18x3 3x23). Assume that the
some specied future date. The selling objective is to maximize the total return, F
price of a bond may differ from its face (X), from all three allocations and that the
value. Since the interest payments are sum of all allocations cannot exceed 10.
specied in advance, the current market (a) How much would each use like to have?
interest rates dictate the purchase price of (b) Show that at the maximum total return
the bond. solution the marginal values, (R(xj))/xj,
Consider a bond having a face value of are each equal to the shadow price or
$10,000, paying $500 annually for Lagrange multiplier (dual variable) asso-
10 years. The bond or coupon interest ciated with the constraint on the amount of
rate based on its face value is 500/10,000, water available. (c) Finally, without
or 5%. If the bond is purchased for resolving a Lagrange multiplier problem,
$10,000, the actual interest rate paid to the what would the solution be if 15 units of
owner will equal the bond or coupon water were available to allocate to the three
rate. But suppose that one can invest users and what would be the value of the
money in similar quality (equal risk) Lagrange multiplier?
bonds or notes and receive 10% interest. 4:10 In Exercise 4.9, how would the Lagrange
As long as this is possible, the $10,000, multiplier procedure differ if the objective
5% bond will not sell in a competitive function, F(X), were to be minimized?
market. In order to sell it, its purchase 4:11 Assume that the objective was to minimize
price has to be such that the actual interest the sum of squared deviations of the actual
rate paid to the owner will be 10%. In this allocations xj from some desired or known
case, show that the purchase price will be target allocations Tj. Given a supply of
$6927. water Q less than the sum of all target al-
The interest paid by the some bonds, locations Tj, structure a planning model
especially municipal bonds, may be and its corresponding Lagrangian. Will a
exempt from state and federal income global minimum be obtained from solving
taxes. If an investor is in the 30% income the partial differential equations derived
tax bracket, for example, a 5% municipal from the Lagrangian? Why?
tax-exempt bond is equivalent to about a 4:12 Using Lagrange multipliers, prove that the
7% taxable bond. This tax exemption least-cost design of a cylindrical storage
helps reduce local taxes needed to pay the tank of any volume V > 0 has one-third of
interest on municipal bonds, as well as its cost in its base and top and two-thirds
providing attractive investment opportu- of its cost in its side, regardless of the cost
nities to individuals in high tax brackets. per unit area of its base or side. (It is these
Lagrange Multipliers types of rules that end up in handbooks in
4:8 What is the meaning of the Lagrange engineering design.)
multiplier associated with the following 4:13 An industrial rm makes two products,
model? A and B. These products require water and
Exercises 167

other resources. Water is the scarce (d) What is the value of the dual variable,
resourcethey have plenty of other nee- or shadow price, associated with the
ded resources. The products they make are 10 units of available water?
unique, and hence they can set the unit
Dynamic programming
price of each product at any value they
want to. However experience tells them 4:14 Solve for the optimal integer allocations x1,
that the higher the unit price for a product, x2, and x3 for the problem dened by
the less amount of that product they will Exercise 4.9 assuming the total available
sell. The relationship between unit price water is 3 and 4. Also solve for the optimal
and quantity that can be sold is given by allocation policy if the total water available
the following two demand functions. is 7 and each xj must not exceed 4.
Assume for simplicity that the unit price 4:15 Consider a three-season reservoir opera-
for product A is (8 A) and for product B tion problem. The inflows are 10, 50 and
is (6 1.5B). 20 in seasons 1, 2, and 3, respectively.

Po Po
8 A
Unit 61.5B
Unit Price
price

Quantity of product A Quantity of product B

(a) What are the amounts of A and B, and Find the operating policy that minimizes
their unit prices, that maximize the the sum of total squared deviations from a
total revenue obtained? constant storage target of 20 and a con-
(b) Suppose the total amount of A and stant release target of 25 in each of the
B could not exceed some amount three seasons. Develop a discrete dynamic
Tmax. What are the amounts of A and programming model that considers only 4
B, and their unit prices, that maximize discrete storage values: 0, 10, 20 and 30.
total revenue, if Assume the releases cannot be less than 10
or greater than 40. Show how the models
(i) Tmax = 10 recursive equations change depending on
(ii) Tmax = 5 whether the decisions are the releases or
Water is needed to make each unit of the nal storage volumes. Verify the
A and B. The production functions optimal operating policy is the same
relating the amount of water XA nee- regardless of whether the decision vari-
ded to make A, and the amount of ables are the releases or the nal storage
water XB needed to make B, are volumes in each period. Which model do
A = 0.5XA, and B = 0.25XB, you think is easier to solve? How would
respectively. each model change if more importance
(c) Find the amounts of A and B and their were given to the desired releases than to
unit prices that maximize total revenue the desired storage volumes?
assuming the total amount of water 4:16 Show that the constraint limiting a reser-
available is 10 units. voir release, rt, to be no greater than the
168 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

initial storage volume, st, plus inflow, it, is 4:19 Consider a wastewater treatment plant in
redundant to the continuity equation which it is possible to include ve differ-
s t + i t r t = s t + 1. ent treatment processes in series. These
4:17 Develop a general recursive equation for a treatment processes must together remove
forward-moving dynamic programming at least 90% of the 100 units of influent
solution procedure for a single waste. Assuming the Ri is the amount of
reservoir-operating problem. Dene all waste removed by process i, the following
variables and functions used. Why is this conditions must hold:
not a very useful approach to nding a
reservoir-operating policy? 20  R1  30
4:18 The following table provides estimates for 0  R2  30
the recent values of the costs of additional 0  R3  10
wastewater treatment plant capacity nee-
0  R4  20
ded at the end of each 5-year period for the
next 20 years. Find the capacity expansion 0  R5  30
schedule that minimizes the present values
of the total future costs. If there is more (a) Write the constrained optimization-
than one least-cost solution, indicate planning model for nding the
which one you think is better, and why? least-cost combination of the removals
Ri that together will remove 90% of
Discounted cost of Total required the influent waste. The cost of the
additional capacity capacity at end of various discrete sizes of each unit
Units of additional period process i depend upon the waste
capacity entering the process i as well as the
Period 2 4 6 8 10 amount of waste removed, as indi-
years cated in the table below.
1 15 12 15 18 23 26 2
2 6 8 11 13 15 6 Process i 1 2 3 4 5
10 Influent, Ii Removal, Ri Annual cost = Ci(Ii, Ri)
3 11 6 8 8 100 20 5
15
100 30 10
4 16 4 10
20 80 10 3 3 1
80 20 9 2
The cost in each period t must be paid at 80 30 13
the beginning of the period. What was the 70 10 4 5 2
discount factor used to convert the costs at 70 20 10 3
the beginning of each period t to present 70 30 15
value costs shown above? In other words 60 10 6 2 3
how would a cost at the beginning of
60 20 4 6
period t be discounted to the beginning of
60 30 9
period 1, given an annual interest rate of r?
(Only the algebraic expression of the dis- 50 10 7 3 4
count factor is asked, not the numerical 50 20 5 8
value of r.) 50 30 10
(continued)
Exercises 169

Process i 1 2 3 4 5 stages, states, decision variables, and


Influent, Ii Removal, Ri Annual cost = Ci(Ii, Ri)
the recursive equation for each stage.
(c) Now assume P1 = 20; P2 = 15;
40 10 8 5 5
P3 = 25; and P = 20. Make up some
40 20 7 12
cost data and check the model if it
40 30 18 works.
30 10 8 8
30 20 10 12 4:21 Find (draw) a rule curve for operating a
20 10 8 single reservoir that maximizes the sum of
the benets for flood control, recreation,
(b) Draw the dynamic programming net- water supply and hydropower. Assume
work and solve this problem by the average inflows in four seasons of a
dynamic programming. Indicate on year are 40, 80 60, 20, and the active
the network the calculations required reservoir capacity is 100. For an average
to nd the least-cost path from state storage S and for a release of R in a sea-
100 at stage 1 to state 10 at stage 6 son, the hydropower benets are 2 times
using both forward- and backward- the square root of the product of S and R,
moving dynamic programming solu- 2(SR)0.5, and the water supply benets are
tion procedures. 3R0.7 in each season. The recreation ben-
(c) Could the following conditions be ets are 40 (70 S)2 in the third sea-
included in the original dynamic pro- son. The flood control benets are
gramming model and still be solved 20 (40 S)2 in the second season.
without requiring R4 to be 0 in the rst Specify the dynamic programming recur-
case and R3 to be 0 in the second case? sion equations you are using to solve the
problem.
(i) R4 = 0 if R3 = 0, or 4:22 How would the model dened in Exercise
(ii) R3 = 0 if R2 20. 4.21 change if there were a water user
upstream of this reservoir and you were to
4:20 The city of Eutro Falls is under a court order nd the best water-allocation policy for
to reduce the amount of phosphorus that that user, assuming known benets asso-
which it discharges in its sewage to Lake ciated with these allocations that are to be
Algae. The city presently has three included in the overall maximum benets
wastewater treatment plants. Each plant objective function?
i currently discharges Pi kg/day of phos- 4:23 Suppose there are four water users along a
phorus into the lake. Some or all plants must river who benet from receiving water
reduce their discharges so that the total for from the river. Each has a water target,
the three plants does not exceed P kg/day. i.e., each expects and plans for a specied
Let Xi be the fraction or percent of the amount. These known water targets are W
phosphorus removed by additional treat- (1), W(2), W(3), and W(4) for the four
ment at plant i, and the Ci(Xi) the cost of users, respectively. Show how dynamic
such treatment ($/year) at each plant i. programming can be used to nd two
allocation policies. One is to be based on
(a) Structure a planning model to deter- minimizing the maximum decit deviation
mine the least-cost (i.e., a cost effec- from any target allocation. The other is to
tive) treatment plant for the city. be based on minimizing the maximum
(b) Restructure the model for the solution percentage decit from any
by dynamic programming. Dene the target allocation.
170 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Gradient Hill-climbing methods into a river. Denote the discharge sites by


4:24 Solve Exercise 4.13(b) using hill-climbing the subscript i and let Wi be the kg of
techniques and assuming discrete integer waste discharged into the river each day at
values and Tmax = 5. For example, which those sites i. To improve the river water
product would you produce if you could quality downstream, wastewater treatment
make only 1 unit of either A or B? If you plants may be required at each site i. Let xi
could make another unit of A or B, which be the fraction of waste removed by
would you make? Continue this process treatment at each site i. Develop a model
up to 5 units of products A and/or B. for estimating how much waste removal is
4:25 Under what conditions will hill-climbing required at each site to maintain accept-
methods for maximization or minimiza- able water quality in the river at a mini-
tion not work? mum total cost. Use the following
additional notation:
Linear and nonlinear programming
4:26 Consider the industrial rm that makes aij decrease in quality at site j per unit of waste
two products A and B as described in discharged at site i
Exercise 4.13(b). Using Lingo (or any qj quality at site j that would result if all
other program you wish): controlled upstream discharges were
eliminated (i.e., W1 = W2 = 0)
(a) Find the amounts of A and B and their Qj minimum acceptable quality at site j
unit prices that maximize total revenue Ci cost per unit (fraction) of waste removed at
assuming the total amount of water site i.
available is 10 units.
(b) What is the value of the dual variable, 4:28 Assume that there are two sites along a
or shadow price, associated with the stream, i = 1, 2, at which waste (BOD) is
10 units of available water? discharged. Currently, without any
(c) Suppose the demand functions are not wastewater treatment, the quality (DO), q2
really certain. How sensitive are the and q3, at each of sites 2 and 3 is less than
allocations of water to changes in the the minimum desired, Q2 and Q3, respec-
parameter values of those functions? tively. For each unit of waste removed at
How sensitive are the allocations to site i upstream of site j, the quality
the parameter values in the production improves by Aij. How much treatment is
functions? required at sites 1 and 2 that meets the
standards at a minimum total cost?
4:27 Assume that there are m industries or
municipalities that discharge their wastes

W1
Site 3
Site 2
Stream
Site 1
Park
W2
Exercises 171

Following are the necessary data: guaranteed in each season) and the
reservoir capacity.
Ci cost per unit fraction of waste treatment at
(b) Find the tradeoff between the yield
site i (both C1 and C2 are unknown but for
and the maximum total net benets
the same amount of treatment, whatever that
that can be obtained from allocating
amount, C1 > C2)
that yield among the three users.
Ri decision variables, unknown waste removal
(c) Find the tradeoff between the reservoir
fractions at sites i = 1, 2
capacity and the total net benets one
A12 1=20 W 1 100 Q2 6 can obtain from allocating the total
A13 1=40 W 2 75 Q3 4 releases, not just the reliable yield, to
A23 1=30 q2 3 q3 1 the downstream users.
(d) Assuming a reservoir capacity of 7,
and dividing the release into integer
4:29 Dene a linear programming model for increments of 2 (i.e., 2, 4, 6 and 8),
nding the tradeoff between active storage using linear programming, nd the
capacity and the maximum percentage optimal operating policy. Assume the
deviation from a known target storage maximum release cannot exceed 8,
volume and a known target release in each and the minimum release cannot be
period. How could the solution of the less than 2. How does this solution
model be used to dene a reservoir policy? differ from that obtained using
4:30 Consider the possibility of building a dynamic programming?
reservoir upstream of three demand sites (e) If you were maximizing the total net
along a river. benet obtained from the three users
and if the water available to allocate to

1 3

The net benets derived from each use the three users were 15 in a particular
depend on the reliable amounts of water time period, what would be the value
allocated to each use. Letting xit be the of the Lagrange multiplier or dual
allocation to use i in period t, the net variable associated with the constraint
benets for each period t equal that you cannot allocate more than 15
to the three uses?
1. 6x1t x21t (f) There is the possibility of obtaining
2. 7x2t 1.5x22t recreational benets in seasons 2 and
3. 8x3t 0.5x23t 3 from reservoir storage. No recre-
ational benets can occur in seasons 1
Assume the average inflows to the
and 4. To obtain these benets facili-
reservoir in each of four seasons of the
ties must be built, and the question is
year equal 10, 2, 8, 12.
at what elevation (storage volume)
(a) Find the tradeoff between the yield should they be built. This is called the
(the expected release that can be recreational storage volume target.
172 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

Recreational benets in each recre- labor, respectively, per unit of


ation season equal 8 per unit of stor- crop. Assume that the available quantities
age target if the actual storage equals of water, land, fertilizer, and labor are
the storage target. If the actual storage known, and equal W, L, F, and H,
is less than the target the losses are 12 respectively.
per unit decitthe difference (a) Structure a linear programming model
between the target and actual storage for estimating the quantities of each of
volumes. If the actual storage volume the two crops that should be produced
is greater than the target volume the in order to maximize total income.
losses are 4 per unit excess. What is (b) Solve the problem graphically, using
the reservoir capacity and recreation the following data:
storage target that maximizes the
annual total net benets obtained from Requirements
downstream allocations and recreation per unit of
in the reservoir less the annual cost of Resource Crop Crop Maximum available
the reservoir, 3K1.5, where K is the A B resources
reservoir capacity? Water 2 3 60
(g) In (f) above, suppose the allocation Land 5 2 80
benets and net recreation benets Fertilizer 3 2 60
were given weights indicating their
Labor 1 2 40
relative importance. What happens to
Unit 30 25
the relationship between capacity price
K and recreation target as the total
allocation benets are given a greater
(c) Dene the meaning of the dual vari-
weight in comparison to recreation net
ables, and their values, associated with
benets?
each constraint.
(d) Write the dual model of this problem
4:31 Using the network representation of the
and interpret its objective and
wastewater treatment plant design problem
constraints.
dened in Exercise 4.19, write a linear
(e) Solve the primal and dual models using
programming model for dening the
an existing computer program, and
least-cost sequence of unit treatment pro-
indicate the meaning of all output data.
cess (i.e., the least-cost path through the
(f) Assume that one could purchase
network). [Hint: Let each decision variable
additional water, land, fertilizer, and
xij indicate whether or not the link between
labor with capital that could be bor-
nodes (or states) i and j connecting two
rowed from a bank at an annual
successive stages is on the least-cost or
interest rate r. How would this
optimal path. The constraints for each
opportunity alter the linear program-
node must ensure that what enters the
ming model? The objective continues
node must also leave the node.]
to be a maximization of net income.
4:32 Two types of crops can be grown in par-
Assume there is a maximum limit on
ticular irrigation area each year. Each unit
the amount of money that can be
quantity of crop A can be sold for a price
borrowed from the bank.
PA and requires WA units of water, LA units
(g) Assume that the unit price Pj of crop
of land, FA units of fertilizer, and HA units
j is a decreasing linear function
of labor. Similarly, crop B can be sold at a
(Poj bj xj ) of the quantity, xj, pro-
unit price of PB and requires WB, LB, FB
and HB units of water, land, fertilizer, and duced. How could the linear model be
Exercises 173

restructured also as to identify not Task B: Determine structural and nonstructural


only how much of each crop to pro- alternatives that will influence
duce, but also the unit price at which objectives. Duration: 1 month.
each crop should be sold in order to Task C: Develop an optimization model for
maximize total income? preliminary screening of alternatives
and for estimating tradeoffs among
4:33 Using linear programming model, derive objectives. Duration: 1 month.
an annual storage-yield function for a Task Identify data requirements and collect
reservoir at a site having the following D: data. Duration: 2 months.
record of annual flows: Task E: Develop a data management system
for the project. Duration: 3 months.
Year y Flow Qy Year y Flow Qy Task F: Develop an interactive shared vision
1 5 9 3 simulation model with the
2 7 10 6 stakeholdes. Duration: 2 Months.
3 8 11 8
Task Work with stakeholders in an effort to
G: come to a consensus (a shared vision)
4 4 12 9
of the best plan. Duration: 4 months.
5 3 13 3
Task Prepare, present and submit a report.
6 3 14 4 H: Duration: 2 months.
7 2 15 9
8 1
B
A
(a) Find the values of the storage capacity
required for yields of 2, 3, 3.5, 4, 4.5, C G H
and 5.
E
(b) Develop a flow chart dening a pro- F
cedure for nding the yields for vari- D
ous increasing values of K.
4:35 In Exercise 4.34 suppose the project is
4:34 Water resources planning usually involves
penalized if its completion time exceeds a
a set of separate tasks. Let the index i de-
target T. The difference between 14 months
note each task, and Hi the set of tasks that
and T months is , and the penalty is P().
immediately precede task i. The duration
You could reduce the time it takes to
of each task i is estimated to be di.
complete task E by one month at a cost of
$200, and by two months at a cost of $500.
(a) Develop a linear programming model
Similarly, suppose the cost of task A could
to identify the starting times of tasks
be reduced by a month at a cost of $600 and
that minimizes the time, T, required to
two months at a cost of $1400. Construct a
complete the total planning project.
model to nd the most economical project
(b) Apply the general model to the fol-
completion time. Next modify the linear
lowing planning project:
programming model to nd the minimum
Task A: Determine planning objectives and total added cost if the total project time is to
stakeholder interests. Duration: be reduced by 1 or 2 months. What is that
4 months. added cost and for which tasks?
174 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

4:36 Solve the reservoir operation problem 1 2


described in Exercise 4.15 using linear
programming. If the reservoir capacity is
unknown, show how a cost function (that 10 5
includes xed costs and economies of
scale) for the reservoir capacity could be
included in the linear programming model. 3 4
4:37 An upstream reservoir could be built to 15
2 5
serve two downstream users. Each user 8
has a constant water demand target. The
rst users target is 30; the second users 5
target is 50. These targets apply to each of 5 6
6 within-year seasons. Find the tradeoff 12
between the required reservoir capacity 4 3
14 20 5
and maximum decit to any user at any
time, for an average year. The average
flows into the reservoir in each of the six 7
successive seasons are: 40, 80, 100, 130,
70, 50. 4:39 Referring to Exercise 4.38 above, assume
4:38 Two groundwater well elds can be used cost functions 5 and 6 represent the cost of
to meet the water demands of a single adding additional capacity to well elds
user. The maximum capacity of the A well A and B, respectively, in any of the next ve
eld is 15 units of water per period, and 5-year construction periods, i.e., in the next
the maximum capacity of the B well eld 25 years. Identify and plot the least-cost
is 10 units of water per period. The annual capacity expansion schedule (one that
cost of building and operating each well minimizes the total present value of current
eld, each period, is a function of the and future expansions), assuming demands
amount of water pumped and transported of 5, 10, 15, 20 and 25 are to be met at the
from that well eld. Three sets of cost end of years 5, 10, 15, 20 and 25, respec-
functions are shown below: Construct a tively. Costs, including xed costs, of ca-
LP model and use it to dene and then plot pacity expansion in each construction
the total least-cost function and the asso- period have to be paid at the beginning of
ciated individual well eld capacities the construction period. Determine the
required to meet demands from 0 to 25, sensitivity of your solution to the interest
assuming cost functions 1 and 2 apply to rate used to compute present value.
well elds A and B, respectively. Next 4:40 Consider a crop production problem
dene another least-cost function and involving three types of crops. How many
associated capacities assuming cost func- hectares of each crop should be planted to
tions 3 and 4 apply to A and B, respec- maximize total income?
tively. Finally dene a least-cost function
and associated capacities assuming well Resources Max limits Resource requirements

eld cost functions 5 and 6 apply. You can Crops: Corn Wheat Oats

check your model results just using com- Water 1000/week 3.0 1.0 1.5 units/week/ha

mon sensethe least-cost functions Labor 300/week 0.8 0.2 0.3 person
h/week/ha
should be obvious, even without using
Land 625 ha
optimization.
Yield $/ha 400 200 250
Exercises 175

Show a graph that identies the tradeoffs the policies. What are the unknown vari-
among crops that can be made without reducing ables and what are the known variables?
the total income. Specify the model in words as well as
mathematically.
4:41 Releases from a reservoir are used for 4:43 In Indonesia there exists a wet season
water supply or for hydropower. The followed by a dry season each year. In one
benet per unit of water allocated to area of Indonesia all farmers within an
hydropower is BH and the benet per unit irrigation district plant and grow rice dur-
of water allocated to water supply is BW. ing the wet season. This crop brings the
For any given release the difference farmer the largest income per hectare; thus
between the allocations to the two uses they would all prefer to continue growing
cannot exceed 50% of the total amount of rice during the dry season. However, there
water available. Show graphically how to is insufcient water during the dry season
determine the most protable allocation of to irrigate all 5000 ha of available irriga-
the water for some assumed values of BH ble land for rice production. Assume an
and BW. From the graph identify which available irrigation water supply of
constraints are binding and what their 32 106 m3 at the beginning of each dry
dual prices mean (in words). season, and a minimum requirement of
4:42 Suppose there are four water users along a 7000 m3/ha for rice and 1800 m3/ha for
river who benet from receiving water. the second crop.
Each has a known water target, i.e., each (a) What proportion of the 5000 ha
expects and plans for a specied amount. should the irrigation district manager
These known water targets are W1, W2, allocate for rice during the dry season
W3, and W4 for the four users, respec- each year, provided that all available
tively. Find two allocation policies. One is hectares must be given sufcient water
to be based on minimizing the maximum for rice or the second crop?
decit deviation from any target alloca- (b) Suppose that crop production func-
tion. The other is to be based on mini- tions are available for the two crops,
mizing the maximum percentage decit indicating the increase in yield per
from any target allocation. hectare per m3 of additional water, up
Decit allocations are allocations that are to 10, 000 m3/ha for the second
less than the target allocation. For example crop. Develop a model in which the
if a target allocation is 30 and the actual water allocation per hectare, as well as
allocation is 20, the decit is 10. Water in the hectares allocated to each crop, is
excess of the targets can remain in the to be determined, assuming a specied
river. The policies are to indicate what the price or return per unit of yield of each
allocations should be for any particular crop. Under what conditions would
river flow Q. The policies can be expres- the solution of this model be the same
sed on a graph showing the amount of as in part (a)?
Q on the horizontal axis, and each users
allocation on the vertical axis. 4:44 Along the Nile River in Egypt, irrigation
Create the two optimization models that farming is practiced for the production of
can be used to nd the two policies and cotton, maize, rice, sorghum, full and short
indicate how they would be used to dene
176 4 An Introduction to Optimization Models and Methods

berseem for animal production, wheat, (a) Summer and winter fodder (berseem)
barley, horsebeans, and winter and summer requirements for the animals.
tomatoes. Cattle and buffalo are also pro- (b) Monthly labor limitations.
duced, and together with the crops that (c) Monthly water limitations.
require labor, water. Fertilizer, and land (d) Land availability each month.
area (feddans). Farm types or management (e) Minimum number of animals required
practices are fairly uniform, and hence in for cultivation.
any analysis of irrigation policies in this (f) Upper bounds on summer and winter
region this distinction need not be made. tomatoes (assume these are known).
Given the accompanying data develop a (g) Lower bounds on cotton areas (as-
model for determining the tons of crops and sume this is known).
numbers of animals to be grown that will
Other possible constraints:
maximize (a) net economic benets based
on Egyptian prices, and (b) net economic (a) Crop balances.
benets based on international prices. (b) Fertilizer balances.
Identify all variables used in the model. (c) Labor balance.
Known parameters: (d) Land balance.
Ci miscellaneous cost of land preparation per
feddan 4:45 In Algeria there are two distinct cropping
PEi Egyptian price per 1000 tons of crop i intensities, depending upon the availability
PIi international price per 1000 tons of crop i of water. Consider a single crop that can be
v value of meat and dairy production per grown under intensive rotation or exten-
animal sive rotation on a total of A hectares.
g annual labor cost per worker Assume that the annual water requirements
fP cost of P fertilizer per ton for the intensive rotation policy are
16,000 m3 per ha, and for the extensive
fN cost of N fertilizer per ton
rotation policy they 4000 m3 per ha. The
Yi yield of crop i, tons/feddan
annual net production returns are 4000 and
a feddans serviced per animal
2000 dinars, respectively. If the total water
b tons straw equivalent per ton of berseem
available is 320,000 m3, show that as the
carryover from winter to summer
available land area A increases, the rotation
rw berseem requirements per animal in winter
policy that maximizes total net income
swh straw yield from wheat, tons per feddan
changes from one that is totally intensive to
sba straw yield from barley, tons per feddan
one that is increasingly extensive.
rs straw requirements per animal in summer
Would the same conclusion hold if instead
lNi N fertilizer required per feddan of crop i
of xed net incomes of 4000 and
lPi P fertilizer required per feddan of crop i 2000 dinars per hectares of intensive and
lim labor requirements per feddan in month m, extensive rotation, the net income depen-
man-days ded on the quantity of crop produced?
wim water requirements per feddan in month Assuming that intensive rotation produces
m, 1000 m3 twice as much produced by extensive
him land requirements per month, fraction rotation, and that the net income per unit
(1 = full month) of crop Y is dened by the simple linear
function 5 0.05 Y, develop and solve a
Required Constraints (assume known linear programming model to determine
resource limitations for labor, water, and the optimal rotation policies if A equals
land): 20, 50, and 80. Need this net income or
Exercises 177

price function be linear to be included in a the amount of wastewater to treat at each


linear programming model? site and then release to the river. Any
4:46 Current stream quality is below desired wastewater at any site that is not under-
minimum levels throughout the stream in going additional treatment can be piped to
spite of treatment at each of the treatment other sites. Identify other issues that could
plant and discharge sites shown below. affect the eventual decision.
Currently effluent standards are not being

met, and minimum desired streamflow Assume known current wastewater flows at site
concentrations can be met by meeting i = qi .
effluent standards. All current wastewater Additional treatment to meet effluent standards
discharges must undergo additional treat- cost = ai bi Di ci where Di is the total
ment. The issue is where additional treat- wastewater flow undergoing additional treatment
ment is to occur and how much. at site i and ci < 1.
Develop a model to identify cost-effective Pipeline and pumping for each pipeline segment
options for meeting effluent standards costs approximately ij + (qij).
where ever wastewater is discharged into where qij is pipeline flow between adjacent sites
the stream. The decisions variables include i and j and < 1.

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
Data-Fitting, Evolutionary,
and Qualitative Modeling 5

Clearly, all model outputs depend on model a reliable supply of clean water at a reasonable
inputs. The optimization and simulation models cost, where there can be disagreements among
discussed in the previous chapters are no different stakeholders and decision makers with
exception. This chapter introduces some alter- respect to specifying just how reliable, how
native modeling approaches that depend on clean, and how affordable.
observed data. These approaches include arti-
cial neural networks and various evolutionary
models. The chapter ends with some qualitative 5.1 Introduction
modeling. These data-driven models can serve as
substitutes for more process-based models in Most models used for water resources planning
applications where computational speed is criti- and management describe, in mathematical
cal or where the underlying relationships are terms, the interactions and processes that take
poorly understood or too complex to be easily place among the various components of the
incorporated into calculus-based, linear, nonlin- system. These mechanistically or process-based
ear, or dynamic programming models. Evolu- models usually contain parameters whose values
tionary algorithms involve random searches are determined from observed data during model
based on evolutionary or biological processes for calibration. These types of models are contrasted
nding the values of parameters and decision to what are typically called black-box models,
variables that best satisfy system performance or statistical models. Such models do not
criteria. Evolutionary algorithms are popular describe physical processes. They attempt to
methods for analyzing systems that require convert observed inputs (e.g., rainfall and runoff,
complex simulation models to determine values inflows to a reservoir, pollutants entering a
of performance measures. Qualitative modeling wastewater treatment plant or effluent concen-
approaches are useful when performance mea- trations discharged to a river) to observed outputs
sures are expressed qualitatively, such as I want (e.g., runoff, reservoir releases, pollutant

The Author(s) 2017 179


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_5
180 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

concentrations) using any set of mathematical outputs. While these statistical models are better
equations or expressions that does the job. One at interpolating within the range of data used to
type of such models is regression. calibrate them, rather than extrapolating outside
Regression equations, such as of the forms that range (as illustrated in Fig. 5.1), many have
proven quite successful in representing complex
Output variable value a binput variable value physical systems.
5:1 Other examples of data-driven models are
based on biological principles and concepts.
Output variable value a binput variable valueC
These are a class of probabilistic search proce-
5:2 dures known as evolutionary algorithms (EAs).
Such algorithms include genetic algorithms
Output variable value
(GAs), genetic or evolutionary programming (GP
a b1 input variable1 valueC1 5:3 or EP), and evolutionary strategy (ES). Each of
C2
b2 input variable2 value these methods has many varieties but all use
computational methods based on natural evolu-
are examples of such data-tting or statistical tionary processes and learning. Perhaps the most
models. robust and hence the most common of these
They depend on observed inputs and observed methods are genetic algorithms and their vari-
outputs for the estimation of the values of their eties used to nd the values of parameters and
parameters (a, b, c, etc.) and for further rene- variables that best satisfy some objective. Alter-
ment of their structure. They lack an explicit, natively, an extension of regression is articial
well-dened representation of the processes neural networks (ANN). The development and
involved in the transformation of inputs to application of black-box models like GA, GP,

Fig. 5.1 Data-tting models are able to estimate rela- relative density of data used in model calibration. The
tively accurately within their calibrated ranges, but not arrows point to where the model does not predict well
outside those ranges. The bottom curve represents the
5.1 Introduction 181

and ANNs emulate larger, deterministic, process- many different processing elements (PEs) (Prin-
oriented models. Once calibrated, their use may cipe et al. 2000). Each processing element
be advantageous if and when it is quicker to use receives inputs from other processing elements
them to obtain the information needed rather than and/or from itself. The inputs are scaled by
using process-oriented models that typically take adjustable parameters called weights. The pro-
longer to solve. Process-oriented models are cessing elements sum all of these weighted
sometimes used to calibrate articial neural net- inputs to produce an output that is a nonlinear
works, which are then used to more quickly (static) function of the sum. Learning (calibra-
explore and evaluate the range of solution out- tion) is accomplished by adjusting the weights.
puts associated with varying inputs. The weights are adjusted directly from the
Examples of such situations where multiple training data (data used for calibration) without
solutions of a model must be obtained include any assumptions about the datas statistical dis-
sensitivity or uncertainty analysis, scenario tribution or other characteristics (Hagan et al.
evaluations, risk assessment, optimization, 1996; Hertz et al. 1991).
inverse modeling to obtain parameter values The following sections are intended to pro-
given the values of the decision variables, and/or vide some background helpful to those who may
when model runs must be extremely fast, as for be selecting one among all the available com-
rapid assessment and decision support systems, puter codes for implementing a genetic algo-
real-time predictions/management/control, and rithm, genetic program, or articial neural
so on. Examples of the use of data-tting models network.
for model emulation are given in the next several
sections.
Genetic algorithms and genetic programming 5.2 Artificial Neural Networks
are automated, domain-independent methods for
evolving solutions to existing models or for 5.2.1 The Approach
producing new models that emulate actual sys-
tems, such as rainfallrunoff relationships in a Before the development of digital computers, any
watershed, wastewater removal processes in a information processing necessary for thinking
treatment plant, or discharges of water from a and reasoning was carried out in our brains.
system of natural lakes, each subject to random Much of it still is. Brain-based information pro-
inputs. Search methods such as genetic algo- cessing continues today (e.g., see Fig. 2.1) and
rithms and genetic programming are inspired by will continue in the future even given our con-
our understanding of biology and natural evolu- tinually improving electronic digital processing
tion. They start initially with a number of sets of capabilities. While recent developments in
randomly created values of the unknown vari- information technology (IT) have mastered and
ables or a number of black-box models, respec- outperformed much of the information process-
tively. The variable values or structure of each of ing one can do just using brain power, IT has not
these models are progressively improved over a mastered the reasoning power of our brains.
series of generations. The evolutionary search Perhaps because of this, some computer scien-
uses the Darwinian principal of survival of the tists have been working on creating information
ttest and is patterned after biological opera- processing devices that mimic the human brain.
tions including crossover (sexual recombination), This has been termed neurocomputing. It uses
mutation, gene duplication, and gene deletion. ANNs representing simplied models of the
Articial neural networks are distributed, brain. In reality, it is just a more complex type of
adaptive, generally nonlinear networks built from regression or statistical (black-box) model.
182 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

Fig. 5.2 A typical multilayer articial neural network showing the input layer for ten different inputs, the hidden layer
(s), and the output layer having three outputs

An example of the basic structure of an ANN pass the output to the next adjacent layer,
is shown in Fig. 5.2. There are a number of input which can be another hidden layer or the
layer nodes on the left side of the gure and a output layer.
number of output layer nodes on the right. The The output layer consists of nodes that
middle column(s) of nodes between these input receive the hidden layer output and send it to
and output nodes are called hidden layers. The the user.
number of hidden layers and the number of
nodes in each layer are two of the design The ANN shown in Fig. 5.2 has links only
parameters of any ANN. Most applications between nodes in immediately adjacent layers or
require networks that contain at least these three columns and is often referred to as a multilayer
types of layers: perceptron (MLP) network, or a feedforward
(FF) network. Other architectures of ANNs,
The input layer consists of nodes that receive which include recurrent neural networks (RNN),
an input from the external environment. self-organizing feature maps (SOFMs), Hopeld
These nodes do not perform any transforma- networks, radial basis function (RBF) networks,
tions upon the inputs but just send their support vector machines (SVMs), and the like,
weighted values to the nodes in the immedi- are described in more detail in other publications
ately adjacent, usually hidden, layer. (for example, Haykin 1999; Hertz et al. 1991).
The hidden layer(s) consist(s) of nodes that Essentially, the strength (or weight) of the
typically receive the transferred weighted connection between adjacent nodes is a design
inputs from the input layer or previous hidden parameter of the ANN. The output values Oj that
layer, perform their transformations on it, and leave a node j on each of its outgoing links are
5.2 Artificial Neural Networks 183

multiplied by a weight, wj. The input Ik to each


node k in each middle and output layer is the sum
of each of its weighted inputs, wjOj, from all
nodes j providing inputs (linked) to node k.
Input value to node k:
X
Ik wj Oj 5:4

Again, the sum in Eq. 5.4 is over all nodes


j providing inputs to node k.
At each node k of hidden and output layers,
the input Ik is an argument to a linear or nonlinear
function fk(Ik + k), which converts the input Ik to
output Ok. The variable k represents a bias or
Fig. 5.4 A middle-layer node k converting input values
threshold term that influences the horizontal
to an output value using a nonlinear function f (such as
offset of the function. This transformation can dened by Eq. 5.5) in a multilayer ANN
take on a variety of forms. A commonly used
transformation is a sigmoid or logistic function as
dened in Eq. 5.5 and graphed in Fig. 5.3. getting the best t of observed and predicted
output data based on the same input data. These
Ok 1=1 expfIk hk g 5:5 design decisions, and most importantly the
determination of the values of the weights and
The process of converting inputs to outputs at thresholds of each connection, are learned
each hidden layer node is illustrated in Fig. 5.4. during the training of the ANN using prede-
The same process also happens at each output ned (or measured) sets of input and output data.
layer node. Some of the present-day ANN packages pro-
The design issues in articial neural networks vide options for building networks. Most provide
are complex and are major concerns of ANN xed network layers and nodes. The design of an
developers. The number of nodes in the input as ANN can have a signicant impact on its
well as in the output layer is usually predeter- data-processing capability.
mined from the problem to be solved. The There are two major connection topologies
number of nodes in each hidden layer and the that dene how data flows between the input,
number of hidden layers are calibration parame- hidden, and output nodes. These main categories
ters that can be varied in experiments focused on are:

Feedforward networks in which the data


flow through the network in one direction
from the input layer to the output layer
through the hidden layer(s). Each output
value is based solely on the current set of
inputs. In most networks, the nodes of one
layer are fully connected to the nodes in the
next layer (as shown in Fig. 5.2); however,
this is not a requirement of feedforward
networks.
Recurrent or feedback networks in which, as
their name suggests, the data flow not only in
Fig. 5.3 The sigmoid or logistic threshold function with
threshold k one direction but in the opposite direction as
184 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

well for either a limited or a complete part of 1. Design a network.


the network. In recurrent networks, informa- 2. Divide the data set into training, validation,
tion about past inputs is fed back into and and testing subsets.
mixed with inputs through recurrent (feed- 3. Train the network on the training data set.
back) connections. The recurrent types of 4. Periodically stop the training and measure the
articial neural networks are used when the error on the validation data set.
answer is based on current data as well as on 5. Save the weights of the network.
prior inputs. 6. Repeat Steps 2, 3, and 4 until the error on the
validation data set starts increasing. This is
Determining the best values of all the weights the moment where the overtting has started.
is called training the ANN. In a so-called 7. Go back to the weights that produced the
supervised learning mode, the actual output of lowest error on the validation data set, and
a neural network is compared to the desired use these weights for the trained ANN.
output. Weights, which are usually randomly set 8. Test the trained ANN using the testing data
to begin with, are then adjusted so that the next set. If it shows good performance, use it. If
iteration will produce a closer match between the not, redesign the network and repeat entire
desired and the actual output. Various learning procedure from Step 3.
methods for weight adjustments try to minimize
the differences or errors between observed and There is a wide selection of available neural
computed output data. Training consists of pre- network models. The most popular is probably
senting input and output data to the network. the multilayer feedforward network, which is
These data are often referred to as training data. typically trained with static back propagation.
For each input provided to the network, the They are easy to use, but they train slowly, and
corresponding desired output set is provided as require considerable training data. In fact, the
well. best generalization performance is produced if
The training phase can consume a lot of time. there are at least 30 times more training samples
It is considered complete when the articial than network weights (Haykin 1999). Adding
neural network reaches a user-dened perfor- local recurrent connections can reduce the
mance level. At this level the network has required network size, making it less sensitive to
achieved the desired statistical accuracy as it noise, but it may get stuck on a solution that is
produces the required outputs for a given inferior to what can be achieved.
sequence of inputs. When no further learning is
judged necessary, the resulting weights are typ-
ically xed for the application. 5.2.2 An Example
Once a supervised network performs well on
the training data, it is important to see what it To illustrate how an ANN might be developed,
can do with data it has not seen before. If a consider the simple problem of predicting a
system does not give a reasonable output for downstream pollutant concentration based on an
this test set, this means that the training period upstream concentration and the streamflow.
should continue. Indeed, this testing is critical Twelve measurements of the streamflow quan-
to ensure that the network has learned the tity, velocity, and pollutant concentrations at two
general patterns involved within an application sites (an upstream and a downstream site) are
and has not simply memorized a given set of available. The travel times between the two
data. measurement sites have been computed and
Smith (1993) suggests the following proce- these, plus the pollutant concentrations, are
dure for preparing and training an ANN: shown in Table 5.1.
5.2 Artificial Neural Networks 185

Table 5.1 Streamflow travel times and pollutant concentrations

Assume at rst that the ANN structure con- the worse the t. This structure is simply too
sists of two input nodes, a hidden node, and a simple. Hence, another node was added to the
single output node. One of the input nodes is for middle layer. This ANN is shown in Fig. 5.6.
the upstream concentration and the other input Using only half the data (six data sets) for
node is for the travel time. The single output training or calibration, the weights obtained
node represents the downstream concentration provided a near perfect t. The weights obtained
expressed as a fraction of the upstream concen- are shown in Table 5.2.
tration. This is shown in Fig. 5.5. Next the remaining six data sets were applied
The model output is the fraction of the to the network with weights set to those values
upstream concentration that reaches the down- shown in Table 5.2. Again the sum of absolute
stream site. That fraction can be any value from 0 deviations was essentially 0. Similar results were
to 1. Hence the sigmoid function (Eq. 5.5) is obtained with increasing numbers of data sets.
applied at the middle node and at the output The values of the weights in Table 5.2 indi-
node. Using two or more data sets to train or cate something water quality modelers typically
calibrate this ANN (Fig. 5.5) results in a poor t assume, and that is that the fraction of the
as measured by the minimum sum of absolute upstream pollutant concentration that reaches a
deviations between calculated and measured downstream site is independent of the actual
concentration data. The more data samples used, upstream concentration (see Chap. 4). This ANN
186 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

Fig. 5.5 Initial ANN for


example problem

Fig. 5.6 Modied ANN


for example problem

Table 5.2 Weights for each link of the ANN shown in Fig. 5.6 based on six data sets from Table 5.1. All bias
variables (k in Eq. 5.5) were 0

could have had only one input node, namely that where the parameter k is the decay rate constant
for travel time. This conforms to the typical having units of 1/travel time (travel time units1).
rst-order decay function:

Fraction of pollutant concentration downstream 5.3 Evolutionary Algorithms


per unitconcentration upstream
expfktravel timeg; Evolutionary algorithms (EA) represent a broad
spectrum of heuristic approaches for simulating
5:6
biological evolution in the search for improved
5.3 Evolutionary Algorithms 187

tness, i.e., the best values of decision vari- flexible tools that can be applied to the solution
ables and parameters based on an objective or of a wide variety of complex water resources
tness function. Evolutionary algorithms are problems. Nicklow et al. (2010) provides a
broadly based on the repeated mutation and comprehensive review of state-of-the-art meth-
recombination and selection: in each generation ods and their applications in the eld of water
(iteration) to dene new individuals (candidate resources planning and management. EAs have
solutions). These are generated by variation, been successfully applied to the study of water
usually in a stochastic way, and then some distribution systems, urban drainage and sewer
individuals are selected for the next generation systems, water supply and wastewater treatment,
based on their relative tness or objection func- hydrologic and fluvial modeling, groundwater
tion value. Over the generation sequence, indi- systems, and parameter identication, to name a
viduals with increasingly better tness values are few. Nicklow et al. also identify major challenges
generated (Simon 2013). and opportunities for the future, including a call
Primary examples include genetic algorithms to address larger scale problems that involve
(Holland 1975), evolutionary strategies uncertainty and an expanded need for collabo-
(Rechenberg 1973; Schwefel 1981), evolutionary ration among multiple stakeholders and disci-
programming (Fogel et al. 1966), and genetic plines. Evolutionary computation methods will
programming (Koza 1992). These methods are surely continue to evolve in the future as analysts
comprised of algorithms that operate using a encounter increased problem complexities and
population of alternative solutions or designs, uncertainty and as the societal pressure for more
each represented by a potential decision vector. innovative and efcient solutions rises.
They rely on randomized operators that simulate
mutation and recombination to create new indi-
viduals, i.e., solutions, who then compete to 5.3.1 Genetic Algorithms
survive via the selection process, which operates
according to a problem-specic tness or objec- Genetic algorithms are randomized general-
tive function. In some cases this function can be purpose search techniques used for nding the
a complex simulation model dependent on the best values of the parameters or decision vari-
values of its parameters and decision variables ables of existing models. It is not a model-
derived from the EA. EA popularity is, at least in building tool like genetic programming. Genetic
part, due to their potential to solve nonlinear, algorithms and their variations are based on the
nonconvex, multimodal, and discrete problems mechanisms of natural selection (Goldberg
for which deterministic gradient-based search 1989). Unlike conventional optimization search
techniques incur difculty or fail completely. The approaches based on gradients, genetic algo-
growing complexity and scope of environmental rithms work on populations of possible solutions,
and water resources applications has served to attempting to nd a solution set that either
expand EAs capabilities. maximizes or minimizes the value of a function
Currently, the eld of biologically inspired of those parameters and decision variables. This
search algorithms mostly include variations of function is called an objective function. Some
evolutionary algorithms and swarm intelligence populations of solutions may improve the value
algorithms, e.g., ant colony optimization (ACO), of the objective function, others may not. The
particle swarm optimization (PSO), bees algo- ones that improve its value play a greater role in
rithm, bacterial foraging optimization (BFO), and the generation of new populations of solutions
so on, many of which have been used to analyze than those that do not. This process continues
water resources planning and management until no signicant improvement in model output
problems. This is especially true for application is apparent. Just how good or t a particular
of genetic algorithms, arguably among the most population of parameter and decision variable
popular of the several types of EAs. EAs are values is must be evaluated using a model of the
188 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

Fig. 5.7 Water allocation to three users from a stream having a flow of Q

system that contains these parameters and deci- genetic algorithms focuses on the use of binary
sion variables. This system model is separated numbers, numbers of any base may be used.
from the GA model. This model separation To illustrate the main features of genetic
makes GA applicable for estimating the best algorithms, consider the problem of nding the
parameter and decision variable values of a wide best allocations of water to the three water-
variety of simulation models used for planning, consuming rms shown in Fig. 5.7. Assume only
design, operation, and management. integer solutions are to be considered. The
Each individual solution set of a GA model maximum allocation, xi, to any single user i can-
contains the values of all the parameters or not exceed 5, and the sum of all allocations
variables whose best values are being sought. cannot exceed the value of Q, say 6.
These solutions are expressed as strings of val-
ues. For example, if the values of three variables 0  xi  5 for i 1; 2; and 3: 5:7
x, y, and z are to be obtained, these variables are
arranged into a string, xyz. Assuming each vari-
x1 x2 x3  6 5:8
able is expressed using three digits, then the
string 056004876 would represent x = 56, y = 4,
The objective is to nd the values of each
and z = 876. These strings are called chromo-
allocation that maximizes the total benets, B(X),
somes. A chromosome is an array of numbers.
while satisfying (5.7) and (5.8).
The numbers of the chromosome are called
genes. Pairs of chromosomes from two parents Maximize BX 6x1  x21 7x2  1:5x22
join together and produce offspring, who in turn
inherit some of the genes of the parents. Altered 8x3  0:5x23
genes may result in improved values of the 5:9
objective function. These genes will tend to
survive from generation to generation, while A population of possible feasible solutions is gen-
those that are inferior will tend to die and not erated randomly. The best size of the sample solu-
reappear in future population sets. tion populationthe number of solutions being
Chromosomes are usually represented by strings consideredis usually determined by trial and
of binary numbers. While much of the literature on error.
5.3 Evolutionary Algorithms 189

Using numbers to the base 10, a sample are used as they are here, mutation processes
individual solution (chromosome) could be 312, have to be dened. Any reasonable mutation
representing the allocations x1 = 3, x2 = 1, and scheme can be dened. For example, suppose the
x3 = 2. Another individual solution, picked at mutation of a base 10 number reduces it by 1,
random, might be 101. These two individuals or unless the resulting number is infeasible. Hence
chromosomes, each containing three genes, can in this example, a mutation could be dened such
pair up and have two children. that if the current value of the gene being
The genes of the children are determined by mutated (reduced) is 0, then the new number is 5.
crossover and mutation operations. These pair- Suppose the middle digit 1 of the second new
ing, crossover and mutation operations are ran- individual, 112, is randomly selected for muta-
dom. Suppose a crossover is to be performed on tion. Thus, its value changes from 1 to 0. The
the pair of strings, 312 and 101. Crossover new string is 102. Mutation could just as well
involves splitting the two solution strings into increase any number by 1 or by any other integer
two parts, each string at the same place. Assume value. The probability of a mutation is usually
the location of the split was randomly determined much smaller than that of a crossover.
to be after the rst digit, Suppose these paring, crossover, and mutation
operations have been carried out on numerous
3j12 parent strings representing possible feasible
1j01 solutions. The result is a new population of
individuals (children). Each childs tness, or
Crossover usually involves switching one part objective value, can be determined. Assuming
of one string with the corresponding part of the the objective function (or tness function) is to
other string. After a crossover, the two new be maximized, the higher the value the better.
individuals are 301 and 112. Adding up all the objective values associated
Another crossover approach is to determine with each child in the population, and then
for each corresponding pair of genes whether or dividing each childs objective value by this total
not they will be exchanged. This would be based sum yields a fraction for each child. That fraction
on some preset probability. For example, sup- is the probability of that child being selected for
pose the probability of a crossover was set at the new population of possible solutions. The
0.30. Thus, an exchange of each corresponding higher the objective value of a child, the higher
pair of genes in a string or chromosome has a the probability of its being selected to be a parent
30% chance of being exchanged. Assume as the in a new population.
result of this uniform crossover procedure, In this example, the objective is to maximize
only the middle gene in the pair of strings 312 the total benet derived from the allocation of
and 101 is exchanged. This would result in 302 water, Eq. 5.9. Referring to Eq. 5.9, the string
and 111. The literature on genetic algorithms 301 has a total benet of 16.5. The string 102 has
describes many crossover methods for both bin- a total benet of 19.0. Considering just these two
ary as well as base 10 numbers. The interesting children, the sum of these two individual benets
aspect of GA approaches is that they can be, and is 35.5. Thus the child (string) 301 has a proba-
are, modied in many ways to suit the analyst in bility of 16.5/35.5 = 0.47 of being selected for
the search for the best solution set. the new population, and the other child (string
Next consider mutation. Random mutation 102) has a probability of 19/35.5 = 0.53 of being
operations can apply to each gene in each string. selected. Drawing from a uniform distribution of
Mutation involves changing the value of the gene numbers ranging from 0 to 1, if a random number
being mutated. If these strings contain binary is in the range 00.47, then the string 301 would
numbers, a 1 would be changed to 0, and a 0 be selected. If the random number exceeds 0.47,
would be changed to 1. If numbers to the base 10 then the string 102 would be selected. Clearly in
190 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

a more realistic example the new population size randomly generates the new population. This
should be much greater than two, and indeed it process repeats itself with the new population
typically involves hundreds of strings. and continues until there is no signicant
This selection or reproduction mechanism improvement in the best solution found from all
tends to transfer to the next generation the better past iterations.
(more t) individuals of the current generation. For this example, we will
The higher the tness (i.e., the objective value)
of an individualin other words, the larger the 1. Randomly generate an initial population of
relative contribution to the sum of objective strings of allocation variable values, ensuring
function values of the entire population of indi- that each allocation value (gene) is no less
vidual solutionsthe greater will be the chances than 0 and no greater than 5. In addition, any
of that individual string of solution values being set of allocations A1, A2, and A3 that sum to
selected for the next generation. more than 6 will be considered infeasible and
Genetic algorithms involve numerous itera- discarded.
tions of the operations just described. Each iter- 2. Pair individuals and determine if a crossover
ation (or generation) produces populations that is to be performed on each pair, assuming the
tend to contain better solutions. The best solution probability of a crossover is 50%. If a cross-
of all populations of solutions should be saved. over is to occur, we will determine where in
The genetic algorithm process can end when the string of numbers it will take place,
there is no signicant change in the values of the assuming an equal probability of a crossover
best solution that has been found. In this search between any two numbers.
process, there is no guarantee this best solution 3. Determine if any number in the resulting
will be the best that could be found, that is, a individual strings is to be mutated, assuming
global optimum. the probability of mutation of any particular
This general genetic algorithm process just number (gene) in any string (chromosome) of
described is illustrated in the flow chart in numbers as 0.10. For this example, a mutation
Fig. 5.8. reduces the value of the number by 1, or if the
original number is 0, mutation changes it to 5.
After mutation, all strings of allocation values
5.3.2 Example Iterations (the genes in the chromosome) that sum to
more than 6 are discarded.
A few iterations with a small population of ten 4. Using Eq. 5.9, evaluate the tness (total
individual solutions for this example water allo- benets) associated with the allocations rep-
cation problem can illustrate the basic processes resented by each individual string in the
of genetic algorithms. In practice, the population population. Record the best individual string
typically includes hundreds of individuals and of allocation values from this and previous
the process involves hundreds of iterations. It populations.
would also likely include some procedures the 5. Return to Step 1 above if the change in the
modeler/programmer may think would help best solution and its objective function value
identify the best solution. Here we will keep the is signicant; Otherwise terminate the
process relatively simple. process.
The genetic algorithm process begins with the
random generation of an initial population of These steps are performed in Table 5.3 for
feasible solutions, proceeds with the paring of three iterations using a population of 10.
these solution strings, performs random cross- The best solution found so far is 222: that is,
over and mutation operations, computes the x1 = 2, x2 = 2, x3 = 2. This process can and
probability that each resulting child will be should continue. Once the process has converged
selected for the next population, and then on the best solution it can nd, it may be prudent
5.3 Evolutionary Algorithms 191

Fig. 5.8 Flow chart of genetic algorithm procedure

to repeat the process, but this time, change the solutions, and for selecting preferred ones. The
probabilities of crossover or mutation or let search procedure is independent of the particular
mutation be an increase in the value of a number characteristics of the water resource system being
rather than a decrease. It is easy to modify the analyzed. This tness function can be a com-
procedures used by genetic algorithms in an plex groundwater quality model, for example, the
attempt to derive the best solution in an efcient parameter values of which are being suggested
manner. by the outcome of the GA procedure. Thus in
Note that the above description of how ge- such an application, both simulation and opti-
netic algorithms work permits the use of any mization procedures are combined and there are
tness function for comparing alternative no restrictions on the features of either. As might
192 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

Table 5.3 Several iterations for solving the allocation problem using genetic algorithms

230 23|0 220 210 13.5 0.09 0.09 230


220 22|0 230 230 15.5 0.10 0.19 201
021 021 021 021 15.5 0.10 0.29 211
201 201 201 201 15.5 0.10 0.39 132
301 3|01 321 321 (became infeasible) 301
221 2|21 201 101 12.5 0.08 0.47 132
301 30|1 301 301 16.5 0.11 0.58 301
211 21|1 211 211 21.0 0.14 0.72 021
132 132 132 132* 26.5 0.19 0.91 230
310 310 310 210 13.5 0.09 1.00 132
150.0

230 230 230 220 16.0 0.08 0.08 221

201 201 201 201 15.5 0.08 0.16 132


211 21|1 212 212* 27.5 0.14 0.30 230
132 13|2 131 121 20.5 0.10 0.40 212

301 301 301 301 16.5 0.08 0.48 201


132 132 132 132 26.5 0.14 0.62 132
301 3|01 001 001 7.5 0.04 0.66 301

021 0|21 321 221 23.5 0.12 0.78 221


230 230 230 230 15.5 0.08 0.86 212
132 132 132 132 26.5 0.14 1.00 001
195.5

221 22|1 222 222* 30.0 0.15 0.15 221

132 13|2 131 121 20.5 0.10 0.25 222


230 230 230 230 15.5 0.07 0.32 230
212 212 212 112 24.5 0.12 0.44 202
201 20|1 202 202 22.0 0.09 0.53 131
132 13|2 131 131 20.0 0.11 0.64 222
301 301 301 201 15.5 0.08 0.72 012
221 221 221 221 23.5 0.11 0.83 121
212 2|12 201 201 15.5 0.08 0.91 202

001 0|01 012 012 19.5 0.09 1.00 121


206.5
E020820e
5.3 Evolutionary Algorithms 193

be expected, this has opened up a wide variety of 5.3.4 Covariance Matrix Adaptation
planning and management problems that now Evolution Strategy
can be analyzed in the search for effective
solutions. Covariance Matrix Adaptation Evolution Strat-
egy (CMA-ES) is another stochastic,
derivative-free method for numerical solution of
5.3.3 Differential Evolution nonlinear or nonconvex continuous optimization
problems. They belong to the class of evolu-
Differential evolution (DE) operates through tionary algorithms. Pairwise dependencies
similar computational steps as employed by a between the variables are represented by a
standard evolutionary algorithm (EA) such as covariance matrix. The covariance matrix adap-
genetic algorithms. DE is an optimization tech- tation (CMA) method updates the covariance
nique that iteratively modies a population of matrix in a way that improves the value of the
candidate solutions to make it converge to an tness function. Adaptation of the covariance
optimum value. However, unlike traditional EAs, matrix is similar to the approximation of the
DE programs create new-generation population inverse Hessian matrix in calculus-based opti-
members by adding a weighted difference mization. In contrast to most classical methods,
between two population vectors to a third vector. fewer assumptions on the nature of the underly-
To illustrate, after initializing multiple candidate ing objective function are made. Only the rank-
solutions with random values, begin an iterative ing between candidate solutions is exploited for
process where for each candidate solution x you learning the sample distribution and neither
produce a trial vector v = a + (b c)/2, where a, derivatives nor even the function values them-
b, c are three distinct candidate solutions picked selves are required by the method (Hansen 2006;
randomly among the population of possible Igel et al. 2007).
solutions. Next, you randomly swap vector Some software programs for DE are at (http://
components between x and v to produce v. At www1.icsi.berkeley.edu/*storn/code.html), for
least one component from v must be swapped. CMA-ES at (https://www.lri.fr/*hansen/
Finally, you replace x in your population with v cmaesintro.html) and for multiobjective EAs at
only if v is a better candidate (i.e., it improves (http://moeaframework.org/).
the value your objective or tness function). This
process is repeated until no better solution can be
found. No separate probability distribution need 5.4 Genetic Programming
be used for generating the offspring.
Since its inception in 1995, many variants of One of the challenges in computer science is to
the basic algorithm have been developed with program computers to perform tasks without
improved performance. Books and web pages are telling them how. In other words, how to enable
available that present detailed reviews of the computers to learn to program themselves for
basic concepts of DE and of its major variants, as solving particular problems? Since the 1950s,
well as its application to multiobjective, con- computer scientists have tried, with varying
strained, large-scale, and uncertain optimization degrees of success, to give computers the ability
problems. Numerous computer software pack- to learn. The name for this eld of study is
ages are also available for solving problems machine learning (ML), a phrase used in 1959
using DE. For example, see Das and Suganthan by the rst person to make a computer perform a
(2011), Storn and Price (1997), Price et al. serious learning task, Arthur Samuel. Originally,
(2006), and Schwefel (1995) to mention a few. machine learning meant the ability of
194 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

computers to program themselves. That goal has, tries to build the model using sequences of the
for many years, proven very difcult. As a con- specied building blocks.
sequence, computer scientists have pursued more One of the successful applications of GP in
modest goals. A good present-day denition of automatic model building is that of symbolic
machine learning is given by Mitchell (1997), regression. Here GP searches for a mathematical
who identies machine learning as the study of regression expression in symbolic form that best
computer algorithms that improve automatically produces the observed output given the associ-
through experience. ated input. To perform this task GP uses a
Genetic programming (GP) aspires to do just physical symbol system divided into two sets.
that: to induce a population of computer pro- The rst set contains the symbols for indepen-
grams or models (objects that turn inputs to dent variables as well as parameter constants as
outputs) that improve automatically as they appropriate. The content of this set is based on
experience the data on which they are trained the nature of the problem to be solved. The
(Banzhaf et al. 1998). Genetic programming is second set contains the basic operators used to
one of the many machine-learning methods. form a function. For example, the second set can
Within the machine-learning community, it is contain the arithmetic operators (+, , *, /) and
common to use genetic programming as perhaps others such as log, square root, sine, and
shorthand for any machine-learning system that cosine as well, again based on the perceived
evolves tree structures (Koza 1992). degree of complexity of the regression.
While there is no GP today that will auto- To produce new expressions (individuals)
matically generate a model to solve any problem, GP requires that two parent expressions from
there are some examples where GP has evolved the previous generation be divided and recom-
programs that are better than the best programs bined into two offspring expressions. An exam-
written by people to solve a number of difcult ple of this is the parse tree for the expression
engineering problems. Some examples of these a + (b/c) illustrated in Fig. 5.9. The crossover
human-competitive GP achievements can be seen operation simply exchanges a branch of one
in Koza et al. (1999), as well as in a longer list on parent with a branch of the other.
the Internet (www.genetic-programming.com/ Software programs have been written to
humancompetitive.html). Since Babovic (1996) implement GP. For example, GPKernel devel-
introduced the GP paradigm in the eld of water oped by Babovic and Keijzer (2000) at the
engineering, a number of researchers have used Danish Hydraulic Institute (DHI) has been used
the technique to analyze a variety of water in applications such as: rainfallrunoff modeling
management problems. (Babovic and Abbott 1997; Drecourt 1999;
The main distinctive feature of GP is that it Liong et al. 2000), sediment transport modeling,
conducts its search for a solution to a given salt intrusion in estuaries, and roughness esti-
problem by changing model structure rather than mation for a flow over a vegetation bed (Babovic
by nding better values of model parameters or and Abbott 1997). More details about GPKernel
variables. There is no guarantee, however, that can be seen in Aguilera (2000).
the resulting structure (which could be as simple The challenge in applying genetic program-
as regression Eqs. 5.1, 5.2, or 5.3) will give us ming for model development is not only getting
any insight into the actual workings of the a close t between observed and predicted
system. outputs, given a set of input data, but also of
The task of genetic programming is to nd at interpreting the model that is generated to
the same time both a suitable functional form of a obtain additional understanding of the actual
model and the numerical values of its parameters. processes taking place. There are also potential
To implement GP, the user must dene the basic problems in creating a dimensionally correct
building blocks (mathematical operations and model if the input data are not dimensionless.
variables) that may be used; the algorithm then As a consequence, many applications using
5.4 Genetic Programming 195

Fig. 5.9 An illustration of


a crossover operation and
mutation operation for
genetic programming

GP seem to require some guidance based on a parameter or decision variable values are indeed
mix of both physically based and data-driven hot, or cold, or clean or dirty, etc., can be used to
approaches. quantify these qualitative descriptions. Both
probability distributions and membership func-
tions of these uncertain or qualitative variables
5.5 Qualitative Functions can be included in quantitative models. This
and Modeling section introduces how qualitative variables can
be included within models used for the prelimi-
So far the discussion in this chapter has been nary screening of alternative water resources
focused on quantitative data that have numerical plans and management policies.
values. The precise quantication of many sys-
tem performance criteria and parameter and
decision variables is not always possible, nor is it 5.5.1 Linguistic Functions
always necessary. When the values of variables
cannot be precisely specied, they are said to be Large, small, pure, polluted, satisfactory, unsat-
uncertain or fuzzy. If the values are uncertain, isfactory, sufcient, insufcient, excellent, good,
probability distributions may be used to quantify fair, poor, and so on are words often used to
them. (The next chapter describes this approach describe various attributes or performance mea-
in some detail.) Alternatively, if they are best sures of water resources systems. These
described by qualitative adjectives, such as dry or descriptors do not have crisp, well-dened
wet, hot or cold, expensive or cheap, clean or boundaries that separate them from their oppo-
dirty, and high or low, membership functions sites. A particular mix of economic and envi-
indicating the fraction of stakeholders who ronmental impacts may be more acceptable to
believe particular quantitative descriptions of some and less acceptable to others. Plan A is
196 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

better than Plan B. The quality and temperature The form or shape of a function depends on the
of water is good for swimming. These qualita- individual subjective feelings of the members
tive, or so-called fuzzy, statements convey or individuals who are asked their opinions. To
information despite the imprecision of the itali- dene this particular function, each individual
cized adjectives. The next section illustrates how i could be asked to dene his or her comfortable
these linguistic qualitative descriptors can be water temperature interval (T1i, T2i). The value
incorporated into optimization models using associated with any temperature value T equals
membership functions. the number of individuals who place that
T within their range (T1i, T2i), divided by the total
number of individual opinions obtained. It is the
5.5.2 Membership Functions fraction of the total number of individuals that
consider the water temperature T suitable for
Assume a set A of real or integer numbers swimming. For this reason such functions are
ranging from 18 to 25. Thus A = [18, 25]. Any often called membership functions (Figs. 5.10,
number x is either in or not in the set A. The 5.11 and 5.12).
statement x belongs to A is either true or false The assignment of membership values is
depending on the value of x. The set A is called a based on subjective judgments, but such judg-
crisp set. If one is not able to say for certain ments seem to be sufcient for much of human
whether or not any number x is in the set, then communication.
the set A could be referred to as fuzzy. The degree Now suppose the water temperature applied to
of truth attached to that statement is dened by a a swimming pool where the temperature could be
membership function. Membership functions regulated. The hotter the temperature the more it
range from 0 (completely false) to 1 (completely will cost. If we could quantify the economic
true). benets associated with various temperatures we
Consider the statement, The water tempera- could perform a benetcost analysis by maxi-
ture should be suitable for swimming. Just what mizing the net benets. Alternatively, we could
temperatures are suitable will depend on the maximize the fraction of people who consider the
persons asked. It would be difcult for anyone to temperature good for swimming subject to a cost
dene precisely those temperatures that are constraint using a membership function such as
suitable if it is understood that temperatures in Fig. 5.10 in place of an economic benet
outside that range are absolutely not suitable. function (Chap. 4 discusses ways of doing this.).
A function dening the interval or range of Continuing with this example, assume you are
water temperatures suitable for swimming is asked to provide the desired temperature at a
shown in Fig. 5.10. Such functions may be reasonable cost. Just what is reasonable can also
dened on the basis of the responses of many be dened by another membership function, but
potential swimmers. There is a zone of impreci- this time the function applies to cost, not tem-
sion or disagreement at both ends of the range. perature. Both the objective and constraint of this

Fig. 5.10 A membership


function for suitability of
water temperature for
swimming
5.5 Qualitative Functions and Modeling 197

Fig. 5.11 Two membership functions relating to swim- is too cold, and Set B denes the fraction of all individuals
ming water temperature. Set A is the set dening the who think the water temperature is too hot
fraction of all individuals who think the water temperature

Fig. 5.12 Membership


function for water
temperatures that are
considered too cold
or too hot

problem are described qualitatively. In this case These allocations cannot exceed the amount
one could consider there are in fact two objec- of water available, Q, less any that must remain
tives, suitable temperature and acceptable cost. in the river, R. Assuming the available flow for
A model that maximizes the minimum value of allocations, Q R, as 6, the crisp optimization
both membership functions is one approach for problem is to maximize Eq. (5.10) subject to the
nding an acceptable policy for controlling the resource constraint:
water temperature at this swimming pool.
x1 x2 x3  6 5:11

5.5.3 Illustrations of Qualitative The optimal solution is x1 = 1, x2 = 1, and


Modeling x3 = 4 as previously obtained in Chap. 4 using
any of several different optimization methods.
5.5.3.1 Water Allocation The maximum total benet, TB(X), from
Consider the application of qualitative modeling Eq. (5.10), equals 34.5.
to the water allocation problem illustrated in To create a qualitative equivalent of this crisp
Fig. 5.7. Assume, as in the previous uses of this model, the objective can be expressed as a
example, the problem is to nd the allocations of membership function of the set of all possible
water to each rm that maximize the total ben- objective values. The higher the objective value
ets TB(X): the greater the membership function value. Since
    membership functions range from 0 to 1, the
Maximize TBX 6x1 x21 7x2  1:5x22 objective needs to be scaled so that it also ranges
 
8x3  0:5x23 from 0 to 1.
5:10
198 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

Fig. 5.13 Membership


function for about 6 units
more or less

The highest value of the objective occurs constraint. Assume the membership function
when there is sufcient water to maximize each describing this constraint is dened by Eq. (5.14)
rms benets. This unconstrained solution and is shown in Fig. 5.13.
would result in a total benet of 49.17 and this
happens when x1 = 3, x2 = 2.33, and x3 = 8. mC X 1 if x 1 x2 x3  5
Thus, the objective membership function can mC X 7  x1 x2 x3 =2 if 5  x1 x2 x3  7
be expressed by mC X 0 if x1 x2 x3  7

    5:15
mX 6x1 x21 7x2  1:5x22
  5:12 Let the membership function of (5.12) be
8x3  0:5x23 =49:17
called mG(X). The qualitative optimization
problem becomes one of maximizing the mini-
It is obvious that the two functions (Eqs. 5.10 mum value of the two membership functions
and 5.12) are equivalent. However, the goal of (mG(X), mC(X)) subject to their denitions in
maximizing objective function 5.10 is changed to Eqs. (5.12) and (5.15).
that of maximizing the degree of reaching the This yields x1 = 0.91, x2 = 0.94, x3 = 3.81,
objective target. The optimization problem mG(X) = mC(X) = 0.67, and the total net benet,
becomes Eq. (5.10), is TB(X) = 33.1. Compare this with
    the crisp solution of x1 = 1, x2 = 1, x3 = 4, and
maximize mX 6x1 x21 7x2  1:5x22 the total net benet of 34.5.
 
8x3  0:5x23 =49:17
5:13 5.5.3.2 Qualitative Reservoir Storage
and Release Targets
subject to Consider the problem of trying to identify a
reservoir storage volume target, TS, for recreation
x1 x2 x3  6 5:14 facilities given a known minimum release target,
TR, and reservoir capacity K. Assume, in this
The optimal solution of (5.13) and (5.14) simple example, these known release and
results in the same values of each allocation as do unknown storage targets must apply in each of
Eqs. (5.10) and (5.11). The optimal degree of the three seasons in a year. The objective will be
satisfaction is m(X) = 0.70. to nd the highest value of the storage target, TS,
Next, assume the total amount of resources that minimizes the sum of squared deviations
available to be allocated is limited to about 6 from actual storage volumes and releases that are
units more or less, which is a qualitative less than the minimum release target.
5.5 Qualitative Functions and Modeling 199

Table 5.4 The solution to the reservoir optimization problem

Given a sequence of inflows, Qt, the opti- satisfying the reservoir storage volume and
mization model is release targets.
Xh i X
Minimize D T s  St 2 DR2  0:001T S Maximize wS mSt wR mRt 5:20
t t

5:16
where wS and wR are weights indicating the rel-
subject to ative importance of storage volume targets and
release targets, respectively. The variables mSt
St Qt  Rt St 1 t 1; 2; 3; are the degrees of satisfying the storage volume
5:17
if t 3; t 1 1 target in the three periods t, expressed by
Eq. (5.21). The variables mRt are the degrees of
satisfying the release target in periods t, expres-
St  K t 1; 2; 3 5:18 sed by Eq. (5.22).

mSt St =TS for St  TS and


Rt  T R  DRt t 1; 2; 3 5:19 5:21
K  St =K  TS for TS  St

Assume K = 20, TR = 25 and the inflows Qt are


5, 50, and 20 for periods t = 1, 2, and 3. The mRt Rt =TR for Rt  TR and
5:22
optimal solution, yielding an objective value of 1 for Rt [ TR
184.4, is listed in Table 5.4.
Now consider changing the objective function Equations (5.21) and (5.22) are shown in
into maximizing the weighted degrees of Figs. 5.14 and 5.15, respectively.
200 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

Fig. 5.14 Membership


function for storage
volumes

Fig. 5.15 Membership


function for releases

Box 5.1. Reservoir model written for solution using LINGO.


5.5 Qualitative Functions and Modeling 201

Table 5.5 Solution of qualitative model for reservoir storage volumes and releases based on objective (5.20)

This optimization model written for solution Maximize


using LINGO is as shown in Box 5.1. mmin maximize minimummSt ; mRt
Given weights ws = 0.4 and wR = 0.6, the
optimal solution obtained from solving the model 5:23
shown in Box 5.1 using LINGO is listed in To include the objective Eq. 5.23 in the opti-
Table 5.5. mization model a common lower bound, mmin, is
If the objective Eq. 5.20 is changed to one of set on each membership function, mSt and mRt, and
maximizing the minimum membership function this variable is maximized. The optimal solution
value, the objective becomes changes somewhat and is as shown in Table 5.6.
202 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

Table 5.6 Optimal solution of reservoir operation model based on objective (5.23)

This solution differs from that shown in standards at sites 2 and 3 at a minimum total cost.
Table 5.5 primarily in the values of the mem- The data used for the problem shown in Fig. 5.16
bership functions. The target storage volume are dened and listed in Table 5.7.
operating variable value, Ts, stays the same value Using the notation dened in Table 5.7, the
in this example. crisp model for this problem, as discussed in the
previous chapter, is
5.5.3.3 Qualitative Water Quality
Management Objectives Minimize C1 X1 C2 X2 5:24
and Constraints
Consider the stream pollution problem illustrated subject to
in Fig. 5.12. The stream receives waste, Wi from Water quality constraint at site 2:
sources located at sites i = 1 and 2. Without
some waste treatment at these sites, the pollutant P1 Q1 W1 1  X1 a12 =Q2  Pmax
2

concentrations at sites 2 and 3 will exceed the


3210 250;0001  X1 =86:4 0:25=12
maximum desired concentration. The problem is
to nd the fraction of wastewater removal, xi, at  20 which; when simplified; is : X1  0:78
sites i = 1 and 2 required to meet the quality 5:25
5.5 Qualitative Functions and Modeling 203

Table 5.7 Parameter values selected for the water quality management problem illustrated in Fig. 5.12

Water quality constraint at site 3: To consider a more qualitative version of this


problem, suppose the maximum allowable pol-
fP1 Q1 W1 1  X1 a13 lutant concentrations in the stream at sites 2 and
3 were expressed as about 20 mg/l more or
W2 1  X2 a23 =Q3  Pmax
3
less. Obtaining opinions of individuals of what
f3210 250;0001  X1 =86:4 0:15 they consider to be 20 mg/l more or less, a
80;0001  X2 =86:40:60g=13  20 membership function can be dened. Assume it
is as shown in Fig. 5.17.
5:26
Next, assume that the government environ-
which, when simplied, is: X1 + 1.28X2 1.79 mental agency expects each polluter to install
Restrictions on fractions of waste removal: best available technology (BAT) or to carry out
best management practices (BMP) regardless of
0  Xi  1:0 for sites i 1 and 2 5:27 whether or not this is required to meet stream
quality standards. Asking experts just what BAT
For a wide range of reasonable costs, the or BMP means with respect to treatment ef-
optimal solution found using linear programming ciencies could result in a variety of answers.
was 0.78 and 0.79, or essentially 80% removal These responses can be used to dene member-
efciencies at sites 1 and 2. Compare this ship functions for each of the two rms in this
solution with that of the following qualitative example. Assume these membership functions
model. for both rms are as shown in Fig. 5.18.
204 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

Fig. 5.16 A stream pollution problem of nding the waste removal efciencies (x1, x2) that meet the stream quality
standards at least cost

Fig. 5.17 Membership


function for about 20 mg/l
more or less

Finally, assume there is a third concern that optimization models can be dened. One is to nd
has to do with equity. It is expected that no the treatment efciencies that maximize the
polluter should be required to treat at a much minimum value of each of these membership
higher efciency than any other polluter. functions.
A membership function dening just what dif-
ferences are acceptable or equitable could quan- Maximize m max minfmP ; mT ; mE g
tify this concern. Assume such a membership 5:28
function is as shown in Fig. 5.19.
Considering each of these membership func- If we assume that the pollutant concentrations
tions as objectives, a number of fuzzy at sites j = 2 and 3 will not exceed 23 mg/l, the
5.5 Qualitative Functions and Modeling 205

Fig. 5.18 Membership


function for best available
treatment technology

Fig. 5.19 Equity


membership function in
terms of the absolute
difference between the two
treatment efciencies
expressed as a percent

pollutant concentration membership functions and 2, the treatment technology membership


mPj are functions mTi are
mPj 1  P2j =5 5:29
mTi x2i =0:05  x4i =0:10 5:33
The pollutant concentration at each site j is the
and the treatment efciencies, expressed as
sum of two components:
fractions, are
Pj P1j P2j 5:30
Xi 0:70 x2i x3i x4i 5:34
where
where
P1j  18 5:31 x2i  0:05 5:35

P2j  23  18 5:32 x3i  0:05 5:36

If we assume the treatment plant efciencies


will be between 70 and 90% at both sites i = 1 x4i  0:10 5:37
206 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

Finally, assuming the difference between P1 Q1 W1 1  X1 a12 =Q2 P2


treatment efciencies will be no greater than 14, 3210 250;0001  X1 =86:40:25=12 P2
the equity membership function, mE, is 5:44
mE Z  0:5=0:05D1 0:51  Z Water quality constraint at site 3:
 0:5=0:14  0:05D2 5:38
fP1 Q1 W1 1  X1 a13 W2 1  X2  a23 g=Q3 P3
where f3210 250;0001  X1 =86:4 0:15
D1  0:05Z 5:39 80;0001  X2 =86:40:60g=13 P3
5:45
D2  0:14  0:051  Z 5:40
Restrictions on fractions of waste removal:

0  Xi  1:0 for sites i 1 and 2: 5:46


X1  X2 DP  DM 5:41
Solving this model using LINGO yields the
DP DM D1 0:051  Z D2 5:42 results shown in Table 5.8.
This solution conrms the assumptions made
when constructing the representations of the
Z is a binary 0; 1 variable: 5:43 membership functions in the model. It is also
very similar to the least-cost solution found
The remainder of the water quality model from solving the crisp linear programming (LP)
remains the same: Water quality constraint at site 2: model containing no membership functions.

Table 5.8 Solution to water quality management model Eqs. 5.28 to 5.46
5.6 Conclusions 207

5.6 Conclusions showing how this can be done using some simple
example problems associated with water alloca-
Most computer-based models used for water tions, reservoir operation, and pollution control.
resources planning and management are physi- The information presented in this chapter
cal, mechanistic, or process-based quantitative serves only as an introduction. Those interested
models. Builders of such models attempt to in more detailed and complete explanations and
incorporate the important physical, biological, applications may refer to any of the additional
chemical, geomorphological, hydrological, and references listed in the next section.
other types of interactions among all system
components, as appropriate for the problem
being addressed and the system being modeled. References
This is done in order to be able to predict pos-
sible economic, ecologic, environmental, or Aguilera, D. R. (2000). Genetic programming with
social impacts that might result from the imple- GPKER-NEL. DHI, Copenhagen: Unpublished.
mentation of some plan or policy. These types of Babovic, V. (1996). Emergence, evolution, intelligence:
Hydroinformatics. Delft: Delft University of
models almost always contain parameters. These Technology.
need values, and the values of the parameters Babovic, V., & Abbott, M. B. (1997). The evolution of
affect the accuracy of the impact predictions. equations from hydraulic data. Part II: Applications.
This chapter has outlined some data-tting Journal of Hydraulic Research, 35(3), 411427.
Babovic, V., & Keijzer, M. (2000). Genetic programming
methods of modeling that do not attempt to as a model induction engine. Journal of Hydroinfor-
model natural, economic, or social processes. matics, 2(1), 3560.
These have included ANN and two evolutionary Banzhaf, W., Nordin, P., Keller, R. E., & Frannkone, F.
search approaches: genetic algorithms (GA) for D. (1998). Genetic programming: An introduction:
On the automatic evolution of computer programs and
estimating the parameter and decision variable its applications. San Francisco, California: Morgan
values, and genetic programming for nding Kaufmann Publishers, Inc. and dpunktVerlag fur
models that replicate the real system. In some Digitale Technologie GmbH.
situations, these biologically motivated search Das, S., & Suganthan, P. N. (2011). Differential evolu-
tion: A survey of the state-of-the-art. IEEE Transac-
methods, which are independent of the particular tions on Evolutionary Computation, 15(1), 431.
system model, provide the most practical way to Drecourt, J.-P. (1999). Application of neural networks
calibrate model parameters. and genetic programming to rainfall-runoff modeling,
Fortunately for potential users of GA, GP, and D2K Technical Report 0699-1. Copenhagen: DHI.
Fogel, L. J., Owens, A. J., & Walsh, M. J. (1966).
ANN methods, software programs implementing Articial intelligence through simulated evolution.
many of these methods are available on the Hoboken: Wiley.
Internet. Applications of such methods to Goldberg, D. E. (1989). Genetic algorithms in search,
groundwater modeling, sedimentation processes optimization, and machine learning.
Addison-Westley: Reading.
along coasts and in harbors, rainfall runoff pre- Hagan, M. T., Demuth, H. B., & Beale, M. (1996). Neural
diction, reservoir operation, data classication, network design. Boston, Massachusetts: PWS.
and predicting surge water levels for navigation Hansen, N. (2006). The CMA evolution strategy: A
represent only a small sample of what can be comparing review. In Towards a new evolutionary
computation. Advances on estimation of distribution
found in the current literature. algorithms (pp. 17691776). Berlin: Springer.
Not all data are quantitative. In many cases Haykin, S. (1999). Neural networks: A comprehensive
objectives and constraints are expressed as quali- foundation (2nd ed.). N.J., Prentice-Hall: Upper
Saddle River.
tative expressions. Optimization models incorpo-
Hertz, J., Krogh, A., & Palmer, R. G. (1991). Introduction
rating such expressions or functions are to the theory of neural computation. Reading, Mas-
sometimes appropriate when only qualitative sachusetts: Addison Wesley.
statements apply to a particular water management Holland, J. H. (1975). Adaptation in natural and articial
systems. Ann Arbor, Michigan: University of Michi-
problem or issue. This chapter concludes by
gan Press.
208 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

Igel, C., Hansen, N., & Roth, S. (2007). Covariance Bardossy, A., & Duckstein, L. (1995). Fuzzy rule- based
matrix adaptation for multi-objective optimization. modeling with applications to geoPhysical, biological,
Evolutionary Computation, 15(1), 128. and engineering systems. Boca Raton, Florida: CRC
Koza, J. R. (1992). Genetic programming: On the Press.
programming of computers by means of natural Babovic, V. (1998). A data mining approach to time
selection (complex adaptive systems). Cambridge, series modeling and forecasting. In V. Babovic & L.
Massachusetts: MIT Press. C. Larsen (Eds.), Proceedings of the Third Interna-
Koza, J. R., Bennett, F. H., III, Andre, D., & Keane, M. tional Conference on Hydroinformatics (Hydroinfor-
A. (1999). Genetic programming III: Darwinian matics 98) (pp. 847856). Rotterdam: Balkema.
invention and problem solving. San Francisco, Cali- Babovic, V., & Bojkov, V. H. (2001). D2K technical
fornia: Morgan Kaufmann. report D2K TR 0401-1. Copenhagen: DHI.
Liong, S.-Y., Khu, S. T., Babovic, V., Havnoe, K., Chan, Beale, R., & Jackson, T. (1990). Neural computing: An
W. T., & Phoon, K. K. (2000). Construction of introduction. Bristol: IOP.
non-linear models in water resources with evolution- Chen, S. Y. (1994). Theory and application of fuzzy
ary computation. Singapore: National University of system decision-making. Dalian, China: Dalian
Singapore. University of Technology Press. (In Chinese.).
Mitchell, T. M. (1997). Machine learning. New York: Clair, T. A., & Ehrman, J. M. (1998). Using neural
McGraw-Hill. networks to assess the influence of changing seasonal
Nicklow, J. W., Reed, P. M., Savic, D., Dessalegne, T., climates in modifying discharge, dissolved organic
Harrell, L., Chan-Hilton, A., et al. (2010). State of the carbon, and nitrogen export in eastern Canadian rivers.
art for genetic algorithms and beyond in water resources Water Resources Research, 34(3), 447455.
planning and management. Journal of Water Resources Cybenko, G. (1989). Approximation by superpositions of
Planning and Management, 136(4), 412432. a sigmoidal function. Mathematics of Control, Sig-
Price, K. V., Storn, R. M., & Lampinen, J. A. (2006). nals, and Systems, 2, 303314.
Differential evolutionA practical approach to global Hornik, K., Stinchcombe, M., & White, H. (1989).
optimization. Berlin Heidelberg: Springer-Verlag. Multilayer feedforward networks are universal
ISBN 3540209506. approximators. Neural Networks, 2, 359366.
Principe, J. C., Euliano, N. R., & Lefebvre, W. C. (2000). Hsieh, W. W., & Tang, B. (1998). Applying neural
Neural and adaptive systems: Fundamentals through network models to prediction and data analysis in
simulation. New York: Wiley. meteorology and oceanography. Bulletin of the Amer-
Rechenberg, I. (1973). Evolutionsstrategie: Optimierung ican Meteorological Society, 79, 18551870.
technischer Systeme nach Prinzipien der biologischen Kindler, J. (1992). Rationalizing water requirements with
Evolution. Stuttgart: Frommann-Holzboog. aid of fuzzy allocation model. Journal of Water
Schwefel, H. P. (1981). Numerical optimization of Resources Planning and Management, ASCE, 118(3),
computer models. Hoboken: Wiley. ISBN 10: 308323.
471099880 | ISBN-13: 9780471099888. Kundzewicz, W. (Ed.). (1995). New uncertainty concepts
Schwefel, H. P. (1995). Evolution and optimum seeking. in hydrology and water resources. Cambridge, UK:
Hoboken: Wiley. Cambridge University Press.
See, L., & Openshaw, S. (1999). Applying soft computing Lange, N. T. G. (1998). Advantages of unit hydrograph
approaches to river level forecasting. Hydrological derivation by neural networks. In V. Babovic & L.
Sciences Journal, 44(5), 763778. C. Larsen (Eds.), Hydroinformatics 98 (pp. 783789).
Simon, D. (2013). Evolutionary optimization algorithms. Rotterdam: Balkema.
Hoboken: Wiley. Lootsma, F. A. (1997). Fuzzy logic for planning and
Smith, M. (1993). Neural networks for statistical model- decision-making. Boston, Massachusetts: Kluwer
ing. New York: Van Nostrand Reinhold. Academic.
Storn, R., & Price, K. (1997). Differential evolution: a McKinney, D. C., & Lin, M. D. (1994). Genetic algorithm
simple and efcient heuristic for global optimization solution of groundwater management models. Water
over continuous spaces. J Global Optimiz, 11, 341 Resources Research, 30(6), 18971906.
359. Minns, A. W. (1996). Extended rainfall-runoff modeling
using articial neural networks. In A. Mller (Ed.),
Hydroinformatics 96 (pp. 207213). Rotterdam:
Balkema.
Minns, A. W., & Hall, M. J. (1996). Articial neural
Additional References networks as rainfall-runoff models. Hydrological
(Further Reading) Sciences Journal, 41(3), 399417.
Olivera, R., & Loucks, D. P. (1997). Operating rules for
multi-reservoir operation. Water Resources Research,
Abrahart, R. J., Kneale, P. E., & See, L. M. (Eds.). (2004). 33(4), 839852.
Neural networks for hydrological modeling. Leiden, Price, R. K., Samedov, J. N., & Solomatine, D. P. (1998).
The Netherlands: AA Balkema. An articial neural network model of a generalized
References 209

channel network. In V. Babovic & L. C. Larsen (Eds.), van den Boogaard, H. F. P., Ten Brummelhuis, P. G. J., &
Hydroinformatics 98 (pp. 813818). Rotterdam: Mynett, A. E. (2000). On-line data assimilation in
Balkema. auto-regressive neural networks. In Proceedings of the
Proano, C. O., Verwey, A., van den Boogaard, H. F. P., & Hydroinformatics 2000 Conference, The University of
Minns, A. W. (1998). Emulation of a sewerage system Engineering, Iowa, USA, July 2327, 2000. Iowa
computational model for the statistical processing of City: University of Iowa.
large number of simulations. In V. Babovic & L. Van Gent, M. R. A., & Van Den Boogaard, H.
C. Larsen (Eds.), Hydroinformatics 98 (Vol. 2, F. P. (1998). Neural network modeling of forces on
pp. 11451152). Rotterdam: Balkema. vertical structures. In: Proceedings of the 27th Inter-
Recknagel, F., French, M., Harkonen P., & Yanunaka, K. national Conference on Coastal Engineering,
I. (1997). Articial neural network approach for pp. 2096109. Reston, Virginia: ASCE press.
modeling and prediction of algal blooms. Ecological Wen, C.-G., & Lee, C.-S. (1998). A neural network
Modeling, 96, 1128. approach to multiobjective optimization for water
Reed, P. M., Hadka, D., Herman, J. D., Kasprzyk, J. R., & quality management in a river basin. Water Resources
Kollat, J. B. (2013). Evolutionary multiobjective Research, 34(3), 427436.
optimization in water resources: The past, present, Wst, J. C. (1995). Current prediction for shipping
and future. Advances in Water Resources, 51, 438 guidance. In B. Kappen & S. Gielen (Eds.), Neural
456, doi:10.1016/j.advwatres.2012.01.005 networks: Articial intelligence and industrial appli-
Sanchez, L., Arroyo, V., Garcia, J., Koev, K., & Revilla, cations (pp. 366-73). Proceedings of the 3rd
J. (1998). Use of neural networks in design of coastal Annual SNN Symposium on Neural Networks, Nijme-
sewage systems. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering, gen, The Netherlands, September 1415, 1995. Lon-
124(5), 457464. don: Springer-Verlag.
Scardi, M. (1996). Articial neural networks as empirical Zhou, H.-C. (2000). Notes on fuzzy optimization and
models for estimating phytoplankton production. applications. Dalian, China: Dalian University of
Marine Ecology Progress Series, 139, 289299. Technology Press.
Shen, Y., Solomatine, D. P., & van den Boogaard, H. Zimmermann, H.-J. (1987). Fuzzy sets, decision-making,
F. P. (1998). Improving performance of chlorophyl and expert systems. Boston, Massachusetts: Kluwer
concentration time series simulation with articial Academic.
neural networks. Annual Journal of Hydraulic Engi-
neering, JSCE, 42, 751756.
Simonovic, S. P. (2009). Managing water resources:
Methods and tools for a systems approach (pp. 576). Exercises
Paris; London: UNESCO; Earthscan James & James.
ISBN 978-1-84407-554-6. 5:1 An upstream reservoir serves as a recreation
Solomatine, D. P., & Avila Torres, L. A. (1996). Neural
network application of a hydrodynamic model in site for swimmers, wind surfers, and boaters.
optimizing reservoir operation. In: A. Mller (Ed.), It also serves as a flood storage reservoir in the
Hydroinformatics 96 (pp. 201206). Rotterdam: second of four seasons or time periods in a
Balkema. year. The reservoirs releases can be diverted
Stelling, G. S. (2000). A numerical method for inundation
simulations. In: Y. N. Yoon, B. H. Jun, B. H. Seoh, & to an irrigation area. A wetland area further
G. W. Choi (Eds.), Proceedings of the 4th Interna- downstream receives the unallocated portion
tional Conference on Hydro-Science and Engineering, of the reservoir release plus the return flow
Seoul, September 2626, 2000. Seoul: Korea Water from the irrigation area. The irrigation return
Resources Association.
Terano, T., Asai, K., & Sugeno, M. (1992). Fuzzy systems flow contains a salinity concentration that can
theory and its application. San Diego, California: damage the ecosystem.
Academic Press.
Tilmant, A., Vancloster, M., Duckstein, L., & Persoons, E. (a) Assume there exist recreation lake level
(2002). Comparison of fuzzy and nonfuzzy optimal
reservoir operating policies. Journal of Water Resources targets, irrigation allocation targets, and
Planning and Management, ASCE, 128(6), 390398. wetland flow and salinity targets. The
van den Boogaard, H. F. P., Gautam, D. K., & Mynett, A. challenge is to determine the reservoir
E. (1998). Auto-regressive neural networks for the releases and irrigation allocations so as
modeling of time series. In V. Babovic & L. C. Larsen
(Eds.), Hydroinformatics 98 (pp. 741748). Rotter- to best meet these targets. This is the
dam: Balkema. crisp problem.
210 5 Data-Fitting, Evolutionary, and Qualitative Modeling

Data: discharge site i. This will be based on


Reservoir storage capacity: 30 mcm; observed values of mass inputs, Wi, and
During period 2 the flood storage ca- concentrations, Cj, and flows, Qj, at a
pacity is 5 mcm; downstream site j.
Irrigation return flow fraction: 0.3 (i.e., X
30% of that diverted for irrigation); Cj Wi aij =Qj
Salinity concentration of reservoir i

water: 1 ppt;
Salinity concentration of irrigation The objective to be used for tness is to
return flow: 20 ppt; minimize the sum of the differences
Reservoir average inflows for four sea- between the observed Cj and the computed
sons, respectively: 5, 50, 20, 10 mcm; Cj. To convert this to a maximization
objective you could use something like the
Targets for part (a): following:
Target maximum salinity concentration
Max1=1 D
in wetland: 3 ppt;
Target storage target for all four sea- where
sons: 20 mcm;
Minimum flow target in wetland in each  
D  Cj obsCj calculated
season, respectively: 10, 20, 15,  
D  Cj calculatedCj obs:
15 mcm;
Maximum flow target in wetland in
5:3 Use a genetic algorithm program to predict
each season, respectively: 20, 30, 25,
the parameter values asked for in problem
25 mcm;
5.2, and then an articial neural network
Target irrigation allocations: 0, 20, 15,
ANN to obtain a predictor of downstream
5 mcm;
water quality based on the values of these
(b) Next create fuzzy membership functions
parameters. You may use the model and
to replace the targets and solve the prob-
data presented in Sect. 5.2 of Chap. 4 if you
lem. Assume that the targets used in
wish.
(a) above are expressed in qualitative
5:4. Using a genetic algorithm program to
terms as membership functions. The
ndthe allocations Xi that maximize the
membership functions indicate the degree
total benets to the three water users i along
of satisfaction for these targets. Solve for
a stream, whose individual benets are
the best reservoir release and allocation
policy that maximizes the minimum
Use 1: 6X1  X12
membership function value. Each mem-
bership function denes the relative level Use 2: 7X2  X22
of satisfaction, where a value of 1 indi- Use 3: 8X3  X32
cates complete stakeholder satisfaction.
This is the qualitative problem. Assume the available stream flow is some
known value (ranging from 0 to 20).
5:2 Develop a flow chart showing how you Determine the effect of different genetic
would apply genetic algorithms to nding the algorithm parameter values on the ability to
parameters, aij, of a water quality prediction nd the best solution.
model, such as the one we have used to nd 5:5 Consider the wastewater treatment problem
the concentration downstream of an upstream illustrated in the drawing below.
Exercises 211

The initial stream concentration just Time period Upstream flow Downstream flow
upstream of site 1 is 32. The maximum
1 450 366
concentration of the pollutant just upstream
2 685 593
of site 2 is 20 mg/l (g/m3), and at site 3 it is
25 mg/l. Assume the marginal cost per 3 830 755
fraction (or percentage) of the waste load 4 580 636
removed at site 1 is no less than that cost at 5 200 325
site 2, regardless of the amount removed. 1 550 439
Using a suitable genetic algorithm program, 2 255 304
solve for the least-cost wastewater treatment 3 830 678
at sites 1 and 2 that will satisfy the quality
4 680 679
constraints at sites 2 and 3, respectively.
5 470 534
Discuss the sensitivity of the GA parameter
values in nding the best solution. You can
get the exact solution using LINGO as [These outflows come from the following
discussed in Sect. 4.5.3. model, assuming an initial storage in period
5:6 Develop an articial neural network for flow 1 of 50, the detention storage that will
routing given the following two sets of remain in the reach even if the inflows go to
upstream and downstream flows. Use one set 0. For each period t:
of 5-periods for training (nding the unknown
Outflowt 1:550 initial storaget inflowt0:9 ;
weights and other variables) and the other set
for validation of the calculated parameter
values (weights and bias constants). where the outflow is the downstream flow
Develop the simplest articial neural net- and inflow is the upstream flow.]
work you can that does an adequate job of
prediction.

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
An Introduction to Probability,
Statistics, and Uncertainty 6

Processes that are not fully understood, and social, technical, and political conditions, all of
whose outcomes cannot be precisely predicted, which may influence future benets, costs, envi-
are often called uncertain. Most of the inputs to, ronmental impacts, and social acceptability.
and processes that occur in, and outputs resulting Uncertainty also arises due to the stochastic
from water resource systems are not known with (random over time) nature of meteorological and
certainty. Hence so too are the future impacts of hydrological processes such as rainfall and
such systems, and even peoples reactions and evaporation. Similarly, future populations of
responses to these impacts. Ignoring this uncer- towns and cities, per capita water usage rates,
tainty when performing analyses in support of irrigation patterns, and priorities for water uses,
decisions involving the development and man- all of which impact water demand, are not known
agement of water resource systems could lead to with certainty. This chapter introduces methods
incorrect conclusions, or at least more surprises, for describing and dealing with uncertainty, and
than will a more thorough analysis taking into provides some simple examples of their use in
account these uncertainties. This chapter intro- water resources planning. These methods are
duces some commonly used approaches for extended in the following two chapters.
dealing with model input and output uncertainty. There are many ways to deal with uncertainty.
Further chapters incorporate these tools in more The simplest approach is to replace each uncer-
detailed optimization, simulation, and statistical tain quantity either by its expected or average
models designed to identify and evaluate alter- value or by some critical (e.g., worst-case)
native plans and policies for water resource value and then proceed with a deterministic
system development and operation. approach. Use of expected values or alternatively
median values of uncertain quantities can be
adequate if the uncertainty or variation in a
6.1 Introduction quantity is reasonably small and does not criti-
cally affect the performance of the system. If
Uncertainty is always present when planning and expected values of uncertain parameters or vari-
operating water resource systems. It arises ables are used in a deterministic model, the
because many factors that affect the performance planner can then assess the importance of uncer-
of water resource systems are not and cannot be tainty with sensitivity and uncertainty analyses,
known with certainty when a system is planned, discussed later in this and subsequent chapters.
designed, built, and operated. The success and Replacement of uncertain quantities by either
performance of each component of a system often expected or worst-case values can adversely
depends on future meteorological, demographic, affect the evaluation of project performance

The Author(s) 2017 213


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_6
214 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Table 6.1 Data for determining reservoir recreation potential

when important parameters are highly variable. VD 0:10VD10 0:25VD20 0:30VD30


To illustrate these issues, consider the evaluation
0:25VD40 0:10VD50
of the recreation potential of a reservoir.
0:1025 0:2575 0:30100
Table 6.1 shows that the elevation of the water
surface varies from year to year depending on the 0:2580 0:1070
inflow and demand for water. The table indicates 78:25 visitor-days per day
the pool levels and their associated probabilities 6:4
as well as the expected use of the recreation
facility with different pool levels. Clearly, the average visitation rate,
The average pool level L is simply the sum of V D 78:25, the visitation rate corresponding to
each possible pool level times its probability, or the average pool level VD(L) = 100, and the
worst-case assessment VD(Llow) = 25, are very
L 100:10 200:25 300:30
6:1 different.
400:25 500:10 30 The median and the most likely are other
measures that characterize a data set. They have
This pool level corresponds to 100
the advantage that they are less influenced by
visitor-days per day
extreme outliers. For the symmetric data set
VDL 100 visitor-days per day 6:2 shown in Table 6.1, the median, most likely, and
the mean are the same, namely 30. But if instead
A worst-case analysis might select a pool the probabilities of the respective pool levels were
level of 10 as a critical value, yielding an esti- 0.30, 0.25, 0.20, 0.15, and 0.10, (instead of 0.10,
mate of system performance equal to 25 visitor- 0.25, 0.30, 0.25, 0.10) the expected value or mean
days per day is 25, the value having the highest probability of
VDLlow VD10 25 visitor-days per day 6:3 occurring (the most likely) is 10, and the median
or value that is greater or equal to half of the other
Neither of these values is a good approxima- values and less than or equal to the other half of
tion of the average visitation rate, which is the values in the data set is 20.
6.1 Introduction 215

Thus using only average values in a complex 6.2 Probability Concepts


model can produce a poor representation of both and Methods
the average performance and the possible per-
formance range. When important quantities are This section introduces basic concepts of proba-
uncertain, one should evaluate both the expected bility and statistics. These are used throughout
performance of a project and the risk and possi- this chapter and in later chapters in the book.
ble magnitude of project failures and their
consequences.
This chapter reviews many of the methods of 6.2.1 Random Variables
probability and statistics that are useful in and Distributions
water resources planning and management.
Section 6.2 reviews the important concepts and A basic concept in probability theory is that of
methods of probability and statistics that are the random variable. A random variable is a
needed in this and other chapters of this book. function whose value cannot be predicted with
Section 6.3 introduces several probability dis- certainty. Examples of random variables are
tributions that are often used to model or (1) the number of years until the flood stage of a
describe uncertain quantities. The section also river washes away a small bridge, (2) the number
discusses methods for tting these distributions of times during a reservoirs life that the level of
using historical information, and methods of the pool will drop below a specied level, (3) the
assessing whether the distributions are adequate rainfall depth next month, and (4) next years
representations of the data. Sections 6.4, 6.5, maximum flow at a gage site on an unregulated
and 6.6 expand upon the use of these distribu- stream. The values of all of these quantities
tions, and discuss alternative parameter estima- depend on events that are not knowable before
tion methods. the event has occurred. Probability can be used to
Section 6.7 presents the basic ideas and con- describe the likelihood these random variables
cepts of stochastic processes or time series. will equal specic values or be within a given
These are used to model streamflows, rainfall, range of specic values.
temperature, or other phenomena whose values The rst two examples illustrate discrete ran-
change with time. The section contains a dom variables, random variables that take on
description of Markov chains, a special type of values in a discrete set (such as the positive
stochastic process used in many stochastic opti- integers). The second two examples illustrate
mization and simulation models. Section 6.8 continuous random variables. Continuous ran-
illustrates how synthetic flows and other time dom variables take on values in a continuous set.
series inputs can be generated for stochastic A property of all continuous random variables is
simulations. The latter is introduced with an that the probability that they equal any specic
example in Sect. 6.9. number is zero. For example, the probability that
Many topics receive only brief treatment here. the total rainfall depth in a month will be exactly
Readers desiring additional information should 5.0 cm is zero, while the probability that the total
consult applied statistical texts such as Benjamin rainfall will lie between 4 and 6 cm can be non-
and Cornell (1970), Haan (1977), Kite (1988), zero. Some random variables are combinations of
Stedinger et al. (1993), Kottegoda and Rosso continuous and discrete random variables.
(1997), Ayyub and McCuen (2002), and Let X denote a random variable and x a pos-
Pishro-Nik (2014). sible value of that random variable X. Random
216 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

variables are generally denoted by capital letters the probability mass function of a discrete ran-
and particular values they take on by lowercase dom variable. The probability density function,
letters. For any real-valued random variable X, its often called the pdf, is the derivative of the
cumulative distribution function FX(x), often cumulative distribution function so that
denoted as just the cdf, equals probability that the
value of X is less than or equal to a specic value dFX x
fX x 0 6:11
or threshold x dx

FX x PrX  x 6:5 The area under a probability density function


always equals 1.
This cumulative distribution function FX(x) is
a non-decreasing function of x because Z 1
fX x 1 6:12
PrX  x  PrX  x d for d [ 0 6:6 1

In addition, If a and b are any two constants, the cumu-


lative distribution function or the density func-
lim FX x 1 6:7 tion may be used to determine the probability
x! 1
that X is greater than a and less than or equal to
and b where

lim FX x 0 6:8 Zb
x!1
Pra\X  b FX b  FX a fX xdx
The rst limit equals 1 because the probability a
that X takes on some value less than innity must 6:13
be unity; the second limit is zero because the
probability that X takes on no value must be zero. The probability density function species the
If X is a real-valued discrete random vari- relative frequency with which the value of a
able that takes on specic values x1, x2, , continuous random variable falls in different
the probability mass function pX(xi) is the prob- intervals.
ability X takes on the value xi. Thus one would Life is seldom so simple that only a single
write quantity is uncertain. Thus, the joint probability
distribution of two or more random variables
pX xi PrX xi  6:9 can also be dened. If X and Y are two con-
tinuous real-valued random variables, their joint
The value of the cumulative distribution cumulative distribution function is
function FX(x) for a discrete random variable is
the sum of the probabilities of all xi that are less FXY x; y PrX  x and Y  y
than or equal to x. Zx Zy
X fXY u; vdudv 6:14
FX x pX xi 6:10 1 1
xi  x

If two random variables are discrete, then


Figure 6.1 illustrates the probability mass
XX
function pX(xi) and the cumulative distribution FXY x; y pXY xi ; yi 6:15
function of a discrete random variable. x i  x yi  y
The probability density function fX(x) for a
continuous random variable X is the analogue of where the joint probability mass function is
6.2 Probability Concepts and Methods 217

pXY xi ; yi PrX xi ; and Y yi  6:16 which implies for continuous random variables
that
If X and Y are two random variables, and the fXY x; y fX xfY y 6:19
distribution of X is not influenced by the value
taken by Y, and vice versa, the two random vari- and for discrete random variables that
ables are said to be independent. Independence is
an important and useful idea when attempting to pXY x; y pX xpY y 6:20
develop a model of two or more random variables.
Other useful concepts are those of the mar-
For independent random variables
ginal and conditional distributions. If X and Y are
Pra  X  b and c  Y  d two random variables whose joint cumulative
Pra  X  b Prc  Y  d 6:17 distribution function FXY(x, y) has been specied,
then FX(x), the marginal cumulative distribution
for any a, b, c, and d. As a result, of X, is just the cumulative distribution of X ig-
noring Y. The marginal cumulative distribution
FXY x; y FX xFY y 6:18 function of X equals

(a) (b)

Fig. 6.1 Cumulative distribution and probability density or mass functions of random variables: a continuous
distributions; b discrete distributions
218 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

FX x PrX  x lim FXY x; y 6:21 mass function of a discrete random variable,


y!1 allows one to calculate the expected value of any
function of the random variable. Such an expec-
where the limit is equivalent to letting Y take on tation may represent the average rainfall depth,
any value. If X and Y are continuous random average temperature, average demand shortfall, or
variables, the marginal density of X can be expected economic benets from system opera-
computed from tion. If g is a real-valued function of a continuous
random variable X, the expected value of g(X) is
Z 1
fX x fXY x; ydy 6:22 Z 1
1 EgX gxfX xdx 6:26
1
The conditional cumulative distribution func-
tion is the cumulative distribution function for whereas for a discrete random variable
X given that Y has taken a particular value
X
y. Thus the value of Y may have been observed EgX gxi pX xi 6:27
and one is interested in the resulting conditional xi
distribution, for the so far unobserved value of
X. The conditional cumulative distribution func- E[ ] is called the expectation operator. It has
tion for continuous random variables is given by several important properties. In particular, the
Rx expectation of a linear function of X is a linear
1 fxy s; yds function of the expectation of X. Thus if a and
FXjY xjy PrX  xjY y
fy y b are two nonrandom constants,
6:23
Ea bX a bEX 6:28
It follows that the conditional density function
is The expectation of a function of two random
variables is given by
fXY x; y
fXjY xjy 6:24
fY y Z 1 Z 1
EgX; Y gx; yfXY x; ydx dy
For discrete random variables, the probability 1 1
of observing X = x, given that Y = y equals
or
pxy x; y
pXjY xjy 6:25 XX
py y EgX; Y gxi ; yi pXY xi ; yi 6:29
i j
These results can be extended to more than
two random variables. See Kottegoda and Rosso If X and Y are independent, the expectation of
(1997) for a more advanced discussion. the product of a function h() of X and a function
g() of Y is the product of the expectations

6.2.2 Expected Values EgXhY EgXEhY 6:30

Knowledge of the probability density function of a This follows from substitution of Eqs. 6.19
continuous random variable, or of the probability and 6.20 into Eq. 6.29.
6.2 Probability Concepts and Methods 219

6.2.3 Quantiles, Moments, and Their the 10 percentile of the distribution of the annual
Estimators minima of the seven-day average flows.
The natural sample estimate of the median
While the cumulative distribution function pro- x0.50 is the median of the sample. In a sample of
vides a complete specication of the properties of size n where x(1) x(2)  x(n) are the
a random variable, it is useful to use simpler and observed observations ordered by magnitude,
more easily understood measures of the central and for a nonnegative integer k such that n = 2k
tendency and range of values that a random vari- (even) or n = 2k + 1 (odd), the sample estimate
able may assume. Perhaps the simplest approach of the median is
to describing the distribution of a random variable 
is to report the value of several quantiles. The pth xk
 1  for n 2k 1
^x0:50 1
quantile of a random variable X is the smallest 2 xk xk 1 for n 2k
value xp such that X has a probability p of 6:33
assuming a value equal to or less than xp
Sample estimates of other quantiles may be
PrX\xp   p  PrX  xp  6:31 obtained using x(i) as an estimate of xq for q =
i/(n + 1) and then interpolating between obser-
Equation 6.31 is written to insist if at some vations to obtain ^xp for the desired p. This only
point xp, the cumulative probability function works for 1/(n + 1) p n/(n + 1) and can
jumps from less than p to more than p, then that yield rather poor estimates of xp when (n + 1)p is
value xp will be dened as the pth quantile even near either 1 or n. An alternative approach is to
though FX(xp) p. If X is a continuous random t a reasonable distribution function to the
variable, then in the region where fX(x) > 0, the observations, as discussed in Sects. 6.3.1 and
quantiles are uniquely dened and are obtained 6.3.2, and then estimate xp using Eq. 6.32, where
by solution of FX(x) is the tted distribution.
  Another simple and common approach to
FX xp p 6:32
describing a distributions center, spread, and
shape is by reporting the moments of a distri-
Frequently reported quantiles are the median
bution. The rst moment about the origin X is
x0.50 and the lower and upper quartiles x0.25 and
the mean of X and is given by
x0.75. The median describes the location or cen-
tral tendency of the distribution of X because the Z 1
random variable is, in the continuous case, lX EX xfX xdx 6:34
equally likely to be above as below that value.
1
The interquartile range [x0.25, x0.75] provides an
easily understood description of the range of Moments other than the rst are normally
values that the random variable might assume. measured about the mean. The second moment
The pth quantile is also the 100 p percentile. measured about the mean is the variance, deno-
In a given application, particularly when ted Var(X) or r2X , where
safety is of concern, it may be appropriate to use
other quantiles. In floodplain management and r2X VarX EX  lX 2  6:35
the design of flood control structures, the
100-year flood x0.99 is often the selected design The standard deviation X is the square root
value. In water quality management, a rivers of the variance. While the mean X is a measure
minimum seven-day-average low flow expected of the central value of X, the standard deviation
once in 10 years is often used as the critical X is a measure of the spread of the distribution
planning value: Here the one-in-ten year value is of X about its mean X.
220 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Another measure of the variability in X is the The sample estimate of skewness


coefcient of variation,
X n
^kX n
rX Xi  X3 6:39c
CVX 6:36 n  1n  2 i1
lX

The coefcient of variation expresses the The sample estimate of the coefcient of
standard deviation as a proportion of the mean. It variation
is useful for comparing the relative variability of
d
CV X SX =X 6:39d
the flow in rivers of different sizes, or of rainfall
variability in different regions, which are both
strictly positive values. The sample estimate of the coefcient of
The third moment about the mean denoted X, skewness
measures the asymmetry or skewness of the
^cX ^kX =S3X 6:39e
distribution
The sample estimate of the mean and variance
kX EX  lX 3  6:37
are often denoted x and s2X . All of these sample
Typically, the dimensionless coefcient of estimators only provide estimates. Unless the
skewness X is reported rather than the third sample size n is very large, the difference between
moment X. The coefcient of skewness is the the estimators from the true values of lX ; r2X ; kX ;
third moment rescaled by the cube of the stan- CVX ; and cX may be large. In many ways, the eld
dard deviation so as to be dimensionless and of statistics is about the precision of estimators of
hence unaffected by the scale of the random different quantities. One wants to know how well
variable the mean of 20 annual rainfall depths describes the
true expected annual rainfall depth, or how large
kX the difference between the estimated 100-year
cX 6:38
r3X flood and the true 100-year flood is likely to be.
As an example of the calculation of moments,
Streamflows and other natural phenomena that consider the flood data in Table 6.2. These data
are necessarily nonnegative often have distribu- have the following sample moments:
tions with positive skew coefcients, reflecting
the asymmetric shape of their distributions. x 1549:2
When the distribution of a random variable is sX 813:5
not known, but a set of observations {x1, , xn} d
CV X 0:525
is available, the moments of the unknown dis-
tribution of X can be estimated based on the ^cX 0:712
sample values using the following equations.
The sample estimate of the mean As one can see, the data are positively skewed
and have a relatively large coefcient of variance.
n
X When discussing the accuracy of sample
X Xi =n 6:39a
i1
estimates, two quantities are often considered,
bias and variance. An estimator ^h of a known or
The sample estimate of the variance unknown quantity h is a function of the values of
the random variable X1, , Xn that will be
n
1 X available to estimate the value of ; ^h may be
^2X S2X
r Xi  X2 6:39b
n  1 i1 written ^h[X1, X2, , Xn] to emphasize that ^h
6.2 Probability Concepts and Methods 221

Table 6.2 Annual Maximum Discharges on Magra River, Italy, at Calamazza, 19301970

E021101b
date discharge date discharge
cu ft/s cu ft/s

1930 410 1951 3070


1931 1150 1952 2360
1932 899 1953 1050
1933 420 1954 1900
1934 3100 1955 1130
1935 2530 1956 674
1936 758 1957 683
1937 1220 1958 1500
1938 1330 1959 2600
1939 1410 1960 3480
1940 3100 1961 1430
1941 2470 1962 809
1942 929 1963 1010
1943 586 1964 1510
1944 450 1965 1650
1946 1040 1966 1880
1947 1470 1967 1470
1948 1070 1968 1920
1949 2050 1969 2530
1950 1430 1970 1490

The value for 1945 ismissing

itself is a random variable because its value The estimator S2X of the variance of X is an
depends on the sample values of the random
unbiased estimator of the true variance r2X for
variable that will be observed. An estimator ^h of independent observations (Benjamin and Cornell
a quantity h is biased if E^h 6 h and unbiased if 1970):
E^h h. The quantity fE^h  hg is generally  
called the bias of the estimator. E S2X r2X 6:41
An unbiased estimator has the property that its
expected value equals the value of the quantity to However, the corresponding estimator of the
be estimated. The sample mean is an unbiased standard deviation, SX, is in general a biased
estimate of the population mean X because estimator of x because
" #
n n ESX  6 rX 6:42
  1X 1X
E X E Xi EXi  lX
n i1 n i1 The second important statistic often used to
6:40 assess the accuracy of an estimator ^h is the
222 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

p
variance of the estimator Var^h, which equals j^cX j  n 6:45
Ef^h E^ h2 g. For the mean of a set of inde-
pendent observations, the variance of the sample where n is the sample size. The bounds do not
mean is depend on the true skew X. However, the bias
  r2 and variance of ^cX do depend on the sample size
Var X X 6:43 and the actual distribution of X. Table 6.3 con-
n
tains the expected value and standard deviation
p
It is common to call rx = n the standard error of the estimated coefcient of skewness ^cX when
of X rather than its standard deviation. The X has either a normal distribution, for which
standard error of an average is the most com- X = 0, or a gamma distribution with X = 0.25,
monly reported measures of the precision. 0.50, 1.00, 2.00, or 3.00. These values are
The bias measures the difference between the adapted from Wallis et al. (1974a, b) who
average value of an estimator and the quantity to employed moment estimators slightly different
be estimated. The variance measures the spread than those in Eq. 6.39a.
or width of the estimators distribution. Both For the normal distribution, E^cX  0 and
contribute to the amount by which an estimator Var^cX  5/n. In this case, the skewness esti-
deviates from the quantity to be estimated. These mator is unbiased but highly variable. In all the
two errors are often combined into the mean other cases in Table 6.3 it is also biased.
square error. Understanding that is xed, and To illustrate the magnitude of these errors,
the estimator ^ h is a random variable, the mean consider the mean square error of the skew
squared error is the expected value of the squared estimator ^cX calculated from a sample of size 50
distance (error) between the two when X has a gamma distribution with X = 0.50,
a reasonable value for annual streamflows. The

 2 expected value of ^cX is 0.45; its variance equals
^ ^
MSE h E h  h (0.37)2, its standard deviation squared. Using
n h i o2  h i 2 Eq. 6.44, the mean square error of ^cX is
^
E h  h E h  E ^h^

MSE^cX 0:45  0:502 0:372
Bias2 Var ^h
0:0025 0:1369 0:139 0:14
6:44 6:46

where [Bias] is E^h  h. Equation 6.44 shows An unbiased estimate of X is simply


that the MSE, equal to the expected average (0.50/0.45)^cX . Here the estimator provided by
squared deviation of the estimator ^h from the true Eq. 6.39a has been scaled to eliminate bias. This
value of the parameter , can be computed as the unbiased estimator has mean squared error
bias squared plus the variance of the estimator. 
 2
0:50^cX 0:50
MSE is a convenient measure of how closely ^h MSE 0:50  0:502 0:37
0:45 0:45
approximates because it combines both bias
and variance in a logical way. 0:169 0:17
Estimation of the coefcient of skewness x 6:47
provides a good example of the use of the MSE
for evaluating the total deviation of an estimate The mean square error of the unbiased esti-
from the true population value. The sample mator of ^cX is larger than the mean square error
estimate ^cX of cX is often biased, has a large of the biased estimate. Unbiasing ^cX results in a
variance, and was shown by Kirby (1974) to be larger mean square error for all the cases listed in
bounded so that Table 6.3 except for the normal distribution for
6.2 Probability Concepts and Methods 223

Table 6.3 Sampling properties of coefcient of skewness estimator

Source Wallis et al. (1974b) who divided just by n in the estimators of the moments, whereas in Eqs. 6.39b and 6.39c
we use the generally adopted coefcients of 1/(n 1) and n/(n 1)(n 2) for the variance and skew

which X = 0, and the gamma distribution with of an estimator from the quantity being esti-
X = 3.00. mated, this result demonstrates that the strict or
As shown here for the skew coefcient, biased unquestioning use of unbiased estimators is not
estimators often have smaller mean square errors advisable. Additional information on the sam-
than unbiased estimators. Because the mean pling distribution of quantiles and moments is
square error measures the total average deviation contained in Stedinger et al. (1993).
224 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

6.2.4 L-Moments and Their br EfX FXr g 6:52


Estimators
where F(X) is the cumulative distribution func-
L-moments are another way to summarize the tion of X. Recommended (Landwehr et al. 1979;
statistical properties of hydrologic data based on Hosking and Wallis 1995) unbiased PWM esti-
linear combinations of the original sample mators, br, of r are computed as
(Hosking 1990). Recently, hydrologists have
found that regionalization methods (to be b0 X
discussed in Sect. 6.5) using L-moments are X n
1
superior to methods using traditional moments b1 j  1Xj
nn  1 j2
(Hosking and Wallis 1997; Stedinger and Lu
X n
1995). L-moments have also proved useful for 1
b2 j  1j  2Xj
construction of goodness-of-t tests (Hosking nn  1n  2 j3
et al. 1985; Chowdhury et al. 1991; Fill and
Stedinger 1995), measures of regional homo- 6:53
geneity and distribution selection methods (Vogel
These are examples of the general formula for
and Fennessey 1993; Hosking and Wallis 1997).
computing estimators br of r.
The rst L-moment designated as 1 is simply
the arithmetic mean n  
1X i n1
br Xi =
k1 EX 6:48 n ir r r
X n  
1 i n
Xi = 6:54
Now let X(i|n) be the ith largest observation in r 1 ir r r1
a sample of size n (i = n corresponds to the lar-
gest). Then, for any distribution, the second for r = 1, , n 1.
L-moment, 2, is a description of scale based L-moments are easily calculated in terms of
upon the expected difference between two ran- probability weighted moments (PWMs) using
domly selected observations.
  k 1 b0
k2 1=2E X2j1  X1j2 6:49 k2 2b1  b0
6:55
k3 6b2  6b1 b0
Similarly, L-moment measures of skewness
and kurtosis use three and four randomly selected k4 20b3  30b2 12b1  b0
observations, respectively.
Formulas for directly calculating L-moment
 
k3 1=3E X3j3  2X2j3 X1j3 6:50 estimators, b, of , are provided by Wang (1997).
Measures of the coefcient of variation, skew-
  ness, and kurtosis of a distribution can be com-
k4 1=4E X4j4  3X3j4 3X2j4  X1j4 puted with L-moments, as they can with
6:51 traditional product moments. Whereas skew pri-
marily measures the asymmetry of a distribution,
Sample estimates are often computed using the kurtosis is an additional measure of the
intermediate statistics called probability weighted thickness of the extreme tails. Kurtosis is par-
moments (PWMs). The rth probability weighted ticularly useful for comparing symmetric distri-
moment is dened as butions that have a skewness coefcient of
6.2 Probability Concepts and Methods 225

Table 6.4 Denitions of dimensionless product-moment and L-moment ratios

zero. Table 6.4 provides denitions of the tradi- ^k1 b0 1549


tional coefcient of variation, coefcient of
skewness, and coefcient of kurtosis, as well as ^k2 2b1  b0 458 6:57
the L-moment, L-coefcient of variation, ^k3 6b2  6b1 b0 80
L-coefcient of skewness, and L-coefcient of
kurtosis. Thus the sample estimates of the L-Coefcient
The flood data in Table 6.2 can be used to of Variation, t2, and L-Coefcient of Skewness,
provide an example of L-moments. Equa- t3, are
tion 6.53 yields estimates of the rst three
Probability Weighted Moments t2 0:295
6:58
t3 0:174
b0 1549:20
b1 1003:89 6:56
b2 759:02
6.3 Distributions of Random Events
Recall b0 is just the sample average x. The
sample L-moments are easily calculated using A frequent task in water resources planning is the
the probability weighted moments (PWMs). One development of a model of some probabilistic or
obtains stochastic phenomena such as streamflows, flood
226 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

flows, rainfall, temperatures, evaporation, sedi- be more easily estimated compared to those
ment or nutrient loads, nitrate or organic com- computed from the empirical distribution.
pound concentrations, or water demands. This 2. It provides a compact and easy to use repre-
often requires that one t a probability distribu- sentation of the data.
tion function to a set of observed values of the 3. It is likely to provide a more realistic
random variable. Sometimes, ones immediate description of the range of values that the
objective is to estimate a particular quantile of random variable may assume and their like-
the distribution, such as the 100-year flood, lihood; for example, using the empirical dis-
50-year 6-h-rainfall depth, or the minimum tribution one often assumes that no values
seven-day-average expected once-in-10-year larger or smaller than the sample maximum or
flow. Then the tted distribution and its statisti- minimum can occur. For many situations this
cal parameters can characterize that random is unreasonable.
variable. In a stochastic simulation, tted distri- 4. Often one needs to estimate the likelihood of
butions are used to generate possible values of extreme events that lie outside of the range of
the random variable in question. the sample (either in terms of x values or in
Rather than tting a reasonable and smooth terms of frequency); such extrapolation makes
mathematical distribution, one could use the little sense with the empirical distribution.
empirical distribution represented by the data to 5. In many cases one is not interested in X, but
describe the possible values that a random variable instead is interested in derived variables
may assume in the future and their frequency. In Y that are functions of X. This could be a
practice, the true mathematical form for the dis- performance function for some system. If Y is
tribution that describes the events is not known. the performance function, interest might be
Moreover, even if it was, its functional form may primarily in its mean value E[Y], or the
have too many parameters to be of much practical probability some standard is exceeded, Pr
use. Thus using the empirical distribution repre- {Y > standard}. For some theoretical X-dis-
sented by the data itself has substantial appeal. tributions, the resulting Y-distribution may be
Generally the free parameters of the theoretical available in closed form making the analysis
distribution are selected (estimated) so as to make rather simple. (The normal distribution works
the tted distribution consistent with the available with linear models, the lognormal distribution
data. The goal is to select a physically reasonable with product models, and the gamma distri-
and simple distribution to describe the frequency bution with queuing systems.)
of the events of interest, to estimate that distri-
butions parameters, and ultimately to obtain This section provides a brief introduction to
quantiles, performance indices, and risk estimates some useful techniques for estimating the
of satisfactory accuracy for the problem at hand. parameters of probability distribution functions
Use of a theoretical distribution does have several and determining if a tted distribution provides a
advantages over use of the empirical distribution reasonable or acceptable model of the data.
Subsections are also included on families of
1. It presents a smooth interpretation of the distributions based on the normal, gamma, and
empirical distribution. As a result quantiles, generalized-extreme-value distributions. These
performance indices, and other statistics three families have found frequent use in water
computed using the tted distribution should resource planning (Kottegoda and Rosso 1997).
6.3 Distributions of Random Events 227

6.3.1 Parameter Estimation recommended with moderate and large samples,


even though the iterative solution of nonlinear
Given a set of observations to which a distribu- equations is often required.
tion is to be t, one rst selects a distribution An example of the maximum likelihood pro-
function to serve as a model of the distribution of cedure for which closed-form expressions for the
the data. The choice of a distribution may be parameter estimates are obtained is provided by
based on experience with data of that type, some the lognormal distribution. The probability den-
understanding of the mechanisms giving rise to sity function of a lognormally distributed random
the data, and/or examination of the observations variable X is
themselves. One can then estimate the parame- 
1 1
ters of the chosen distribution and determine if fX x p exp  2 lnx  l2
x 2pr2 2r
the observed data could have been drawn from
the tted distribution. If not, the tted distribu- 6:60
tion is judged to be unacceptable.
In many cases, good estimates of a distribu- Here the parameters and 2 are the mean and
tions parameters are obtained by the maximum variance of the logarithm of X, and not of X itself.
likelihood-estimation procedure. Given a set of Maximizing the logarithm of the joint density
n independent observations {x1, , xn} of a for {x1, , xn} is more convenient than maxi-
continuous random variable X, the joint proba- mizing the joint probability density itself. Hence
bility density function for the observations is the problem can be expressed as the maximiza-
tion of the log-likelihood function
fX1 ;X2 ;X3 ; . . .Xn x1 ; . . .; xn jh " #
n
Y
fX x1 jh  fX x2 jh . . . fX xn jh 6:59
L ln f xi jl; r
i1
where is the vector of the distributions n
X
parameters. ln f xi jl; r
The maximum likelihood estimator of is that i1
6:61
vector which maximizes Eq. 6.59 and thereby
n
X  p
 ln xi 2p
makes it as likely as possible to have observed i1
the values {x1, , xn}. n
1 X
Considerable work has gone into studying the  n lnr  lnxi  l2
2r2 i1
properties of maximum likelihood parameter
estimates. Under rather general conditions,
asymptotically the estimated parameters are The maximum can be obtained by equating to
normally distributed, unbiased, and have the zero the partial derivatives L/ and L/
smallest possible variance of any asymptotically whereby one obtains
unbiased estimator (Bickel and Doksum 1977). n
@L 1X
These, of course, are asymptotic properties, valid 0 2 lnxi  l
for large sample sizes n. Better estimation pro- @l r i1
n
6:62
cedures, perhaps yielding biased parameter esti- @L n 1X
0  3 lnxi  l2
mates, may exist for small sample sizes. @r r r i1
Stedinger (1980) provides such an example. Still,
maximum likelihood procedures are to be highly These equations yield the estimators
228 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

n  
1X ^2 ln 1 s2X =x2
r
^
l lnxi !
n i1 x 1 2 6:66
n
6:63 ^ ln p
l ln x  r^
1X 1 s2X =x2 2
^ 2
2
^
r lnxi  l
n i1
The data in Table 6.2 provide an illustration
The second-order conditions for a maximum of both tting methods. One can easily compute
are met and these values do maximize Eq. 6.59. It the sample mean and variance of the logarithms
is useful to note that if one denes a new random of the flows to obtain
variable Y = ln(X), then the maximum likelihood
estimates of the parameters and 2, which are the ^ 7:202
l
6:67
mean and variance of the Y distribution, are the ^2 0:3164 0:56252
r
sample estimates of the mean and variance of Y
Alternatively, the sample mean and variance
^ y
l of the flows themselves are
6:64
^2 n  1=ns2Y
r x 1549:2
6:68
The correction [(n 1)/n] in this last equation is s2X 661;800 813:52
often neglected.
Substituting those two values in Eq. 6.66
The second commonly used parameter esti-
yields
mation procedure is the method of moments. The
method of moments is often a quick and simple
^ 7:224
l
method for obtaining parameter estimates for 6:69
many distributions. For a distribution with m = 1, ^2 0:2435 0:49352
r
2, or 3 parameters, the rst m moments of postu-
lated distribution in Eqs. 6.34, 6.35, and 6.37 are Method of moments and maximum likelihood
equated to the estimates of those moments calcu- are just two of many possible estimation meth-
lated using Eqs. 6.39a. The resulting nonlinear ods. Just as method of moments equates sample
equations are solved for the unknown parameters. estimators of moments to population values and
For the lognormal distribution, the mean and solves for a distributions parameters, one can
variance of X as a function of the parameters simply equate L-moment estimators to popula-
and are given by tion values and solve for the parameters of a
distribution. The resulting method of L-moments
 has received considerable attention in the
1 2
lX exp l r hydrologic literature (Landwehr et al. 1978;
2 6:65
     Hosking et al. 1985; 1987; Hosking 1990; Wang
rX exp 2l r2 exp r2  1
2
1997). It has been shown to have signicant
advantages when used as a basis for regional-
Substituting x for X and s2x for r2X and solving ization procedures that will be discussed in
for and 2 one obtains Sect. 6.5 (Lettenmaier et al. 1987; Stedinger and
Lu 1995; Hosking and Wallis 1997).
6.3 Distributions of Random Events 229

Bayesian procedures provide another approach available for special cases such as normal data,
that is related to maximum likelihood estimation. and binomial and Poisson samples (Raiffa and
Bayesian inference employs the likelihood func- Schlaier 1961; Benjamin and Cornell 1970;
tion to represent the information in the data. That Zellner 1971). However, a new and very general
information is augmented with a prior distribution set of Markov Chain Monte Carlo (MCMC)
that describes what is known about constraints on procedures allow numerical computation of the
the parameters and their likely values beyond the posterior distributions of parameters for a very
information provided by the recorded data avail- broad class of models (Gilks et al. 1996). As a
able at a site. The likelihood function and the prior result, Bayesian methods are now becoming
probability density function are combined to much more popular, and are the standard
obtain the probability density function that approach for many difcult problems that are not
describes the posterior distribution of the easily addressed by traditional methods (Gelman
parameters et al. 1995; Carlin and Louis 2000). The use of
Monte Carlo Bayesian methods in flood fre-
fh hjx1 ; x2 ; . . .; xn / fX x1 ; x2 ; . . .; xn jhnh quency analysis, rainfall-runoff modeling, and
6:70 evaluation of environmental pathogen concen-
trations are illustrated by Wang (2001), Bates
The symbol means proportional to and and Campbell (2001) and Crainiceanu et al.
() is the probability density function for the (2002) respectively.
prior distribution for (Kottegoda and Rosso Finally, a simple method of tting flood fre-
1997). Thus, except for a constant of propor- quency curves is to plot the ordered flood values
tionality, the probability density function on special probability paper and then to draw a
describing the posterior distribution of the line through the data (Gumbel 1958). Even
parameter vector is equal to the product of the today, that simple method is still attractive when
likelihood function fX(x1, x2, , xn|) and the some of the smallest values are zero or unusually
probability density function for the prior distri- small, or have been censored as will be discussed
bution () for . in Sect. 6.4 (Kroll and Stedinger 1996). Plotting
Advantages of the Bayesian approach are that the ranked annual maximum series against a
it allows the explicit modeling of uncertainty in probability scale is always an excellent and rec-
parameters (Stedinger 1997; Kuczera 1999), and ommended way to see what the data look like
provides a theoretically consistent framework for and for determining whether a tted curve is or is
integrating systematic flow records with regional not consistent with the data (Stedinger et al.
and other hydrologic information (Vicens et al. 1993).
1975; Stedinger 1983; and Kuczera 1983). Statisticians and hydrologists have investi-
Martins and Stedinger (2000) illustrate how a gated which of these methods most accurately
prior distribution can be used to enforce realistic estimates the parameters themselves or the quan-
constraints upon a parameter as well as providing tiles of the distribution (Stedinger 1997). One also
a description of its likely values. In their case use needs to determine how accuracy should be
of a prior of the shape parameter of a GEV measured. Some studies have used average
distribution allowed denition of generalized squared deviations, some have used average
maximum likelihood estimators that over the absolute weighted deviations with different
-range of interest performed substantially better weights on under- and over-estimation, and some
than maximum likelihood, moment, and have used the squared deviations of the
L-moment estimators. log-quantile estimator (Slack et al. 1975; Kroll
While Bayesian methods have been available and Stedinger 1996). In almost all cases, one is
for decades, the computational challenge posed also interested in the bias of an estimator, which is
by the solution of Eq. 6.70 has been an obstacle the average value of the estimator minus the true
to their use. Solutions to Eq. 6.70 have been value of the parameter or quantile being estimated.
230 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Special estimators have been developed to com- This beta distribution has mean and variance
pute design events that on average are exceeded of
with the specied probability, and have the
anticipated risk of being exceeded (Beard 1960, i
1997; Rasmussen and Rosbjerg 1989, 1991a, b; E U i  6:72a
n1
Stedinger 1997; Rosbjerg and Madsen 1998).
and

6.3.2 Model Adequacy in  i 1


VarUi 6:72b
n 12 n 2
After estimating the parameters of a distribution,
some check of model adequacy should be made. A good graphical check of the adequacy of a
Such checks vary from simple comparisons of tted distribution G(x) is obtained by plotting the
the observations with the tted model using observations x(i) versus G1[i/(n + 1)] (Wilk and
graphs or tables, to rigorous statistical tests. Gnanadesikan 1968). Even if G(x) exactly
Some of the early and simplest methods of equaled the true X-distribution FX[x], the plotted
parameter estimation were graphical techniques. points will not fall exactly on a 45-degree line
Although quantitative techniques are generally through the origin of the graph. This would only
more accurate and precise for parameter estima- occur if FX[x(i)] exactly equaled i/(n + 1) and
tion, graphical presentations are invaluable for therefore each x(i) exactly equaled F1 X [i/(n + 1)].
comparing the tted distribution with the obser- An appreciation for how far an individual
vations for the detection of systematic or unex- observation x(i) can be expected to deviate from
plained deviations between the two. The G1[i/(n + 1)] can be obtained by plotting
observed data will plot as a straight line on G1[u(0.75)
i ] and G1[u(0.25)
i ], where u(0.75)
i and
(0.25)
probability graph paper if the postulated distri- ui are the upper and lower quantiles of the
bution is the true distribution of the observation. distribution of Ui obtained from integrating the
If probability graph paper does not exist for the probability density function in Eq. 6.71. The
particular distribution of interest, more general required incomplete beta function is also available
techniques can be used. in many software packages, including Microsoft
Let x(i) be the ith largest value in a set of Excel. Stedinger et al. (1993) report that u(1) and
observed values {xi} so that x(1) x(2)  (1 u(n)) fall between 0.052/n and 3(n + 1) with a
x(n). The random variable X(i) provides a rea- probability of 90%, thus illustrating the great
sonable estimate of the pth quantile xp of the true uncertainty associated with those values.
distribution of X for p = i/(n + 1). In fact, if one Figure 6.2a, b illustrate the use of this quan-
thinks of the cumulative probability Ui associated tile-quantile plotting technique by displaying the
with the random variable X(i), Ui = FX(X(i)), then results of tting a normal and a lognormal
if the observations X(i) are independent, the Ui distribution to the annual maximum flows in
have a beta distribution (Gumbel 1958) with Table 6.2 for the Magra River, Italy, at Cala-
probability density function mazza for the years 19301970. The observa-
tions of X(i), given in Table 6.2, are
n! plotted on the vertical axis against the quantiles
fUi u ui1 1  uni
i  1!n  1! G1[i/(n + 1)] on the horizontal axis.
0u1 A probability plot is essentially a scatter plot
of the sorted observations X(i) versus some
6:71
approximation of their expected or anticipated
6.3 Distributions of Random Events 231

value, represented by G1(pi), where, as sug-



i

i1

Pr G1  Ca  Xi  G1 Ca for every i
gested, pi = i/(n + 1). The pi values are called n n
plotting positions. A common alternative to i/ 1a
(n + 1) is (i 0.5)/n, which results from a 6:73
probabilistic interpretation of the empirical dis-
tribution of the data. Many reasonable plotting where C is the critical value of the test at sig-
position formula have been proposed based upon nicance level . Formulas for C as a function
the sense in which G1(pi) should approximate of n are contained in Table 6.5 for three cases:
X(i). The Weibull formula i/(n + 1) and the Hazen (1) when G is completely specied independent
formula (i 0.5)/n bracket most of the reason- of the samples values; (2) when G is the normal
able choices. Popular formulas are summarized distribution and the mean and variance are esti-
in Stedinger et al. (1993), who also discuss the mated from the sample with x and s2x ; and
generation of probability plots for many distri- (3) when G is the exponential distribution and the
butions commonly employed in hydrology. scale parameter is estimated as 1=x. Chowd-
Rigorous statistical tests are available for hury et al. (1991) provide critical values for the
trying to determine whether or not it is reason- Gumbel and GEV distribution with known shape
able to assume that a given set of observations parameter . For other distributions, the values
could have been drawn from a particular family obtained from Table 6.5 may be used to con-
of distributions. Although not the most powerful struct approximate simultaneous condence
of such tests, the KolmogorovSmirnov test intervals for every X(i).
provides bounds within which every observation Figures 6.2 contain 90% condence intervals
should lie if the sample is actually drawn from for the plotted points constructed in this manner.
the assumed distribution. In particular, for For the normal distribution, the critical value of
G = FX, the test species that p p
C equals 0:819= n  0:01 0:85= n,

Table 6.5 Critical values of Kolmogorov-Smirnov statistic as a function of sample size n


232 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Fig. 6.2 Plots of annual (a)


maximum discharges of
Magra River, Italy, versus
quantiles of tted a normal
and b lognormal
distributions

(b)
6.3 Distributions of Random Events 233

where 0.819 corresponds to = 0.10. For plot providing a quantitative assessment of t. If


n = 40, one computes C = 0.127. As can be x denotes the average value of the observations
seen in Fig. 6.2a, the annual maximum flows are and w denotes the average value of the tted
not consistent with the hypothesis that they were quantiles, then
drawn from a normal distribution; three of the P 
xi  x wi  w
observations lie outside the simultaneous 90% r h 6:74
P 2 P 2 i0:5
condence intervals for all points. This demon- xi  x 
wi  w
strates a statistically signicant lack of t. The
tted normal distribution underestimates the Table 6.6 provides critical values for r for the
quantiles corresponding to small and large normal distribution, or the logarithms of log-
probabilities while overestimating the quantiles normal variates, based upon the Blom plotting
in an intermediate range. In Fig. 6.2b, deviations position that has pi = (i 3/8)/(n + 1/4). Values
between the tted lognormal distribution and the for the Gumbel distribution are reproduced in
observations can be attributed to the differences Table 6.7 for use with the Gringorten plotting
between FX(x(i)) and i/(n + 1). Generally, the position pi = (i 0.44)/(n + 0.12). The table
points are all near the 45-degree line through the also applies to logarithms of Weibull variates
origin, and no major systematic deviations are (Stedinger et al. 1993). Other tables are available
apparent. for the GEV (Chowdhury et al. 1991), the
The KolmogorovSmirnov test conveniently Pearson type 3 (Vogel and McMartin 1991), and
provides bounds within which every observation exponential and other distributions (DAgostion
on a probability plot should lie if the sample is and Stephens 1986).
actually drawn from the assumed distribution, and L-moment ratios appear to provide
thus is useful for visually evaluating the adequacy goodness-of-t tests that are superior to both the
of a tted distribution. However, it is not the most KolmogorovSmirnov and the Probability Plot
powerful test available for evaluating from which Correlation test (Hosking 1990; Chowdhury
of several families a set of observations is likely et al. 1991; Fill and Stedinger 1995). For normal
to have been drawn. For that purpose several data, the L-skewness estimator ^s3 (or t3) would
other more analytical tests are available (Filliben have mean zero and Var[^s3 ] = (0.1866 + 0.8/n)/
1975; Hosking 1990; Chowdhury et al. 1991; n, allowing construction of a powerful test of
Kottegoda and Rosso 1997). normality against skewed alternatives using the
The Probability Plot Correlation test is a normally distributed statistic
popular and powerful test of whether a sample
p
has been drawn from a postulated distribution, Z t3 = 0:1866 0:8=n=n 6:75
though it is often weaker than alternative tests at
rejecting thin-tailed alternatives (Filliben 1975; with a reject region |Z| > z/2.
Fill and Stedinger 1995). A test with greater Chowdhury et al. (1991) derive the sampling
power has a greater probability of correctly variance of the L-CV and L-skewness estimators
determining that a sample is not from the pos- ^s2 and ^s3 as a function of for the GEV distri-
tulated distribution. The Probability Plot Corre- bution. These allow construction of a test of
lation Coefcient test employs the correlation whether a particular data set is consistent with a
r between the ordered observations x(i) and the GEV distribution with a regionally estimated
corresponding tted quantiles wi = G1(pi), value of , or a regional and CV. Fill and
determined by plotting positions pi for each x(i). Stedinger (1995) show that the ^s3 L-skewness
Values of r near 1.0 suggest that the observations estimator provides a test for the Gumbel versus a
could have been drawn from the tted distribu- general GEV distribution using the normally
tion: r measures the linearity of the probability distributed statistic
234 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Table 6.6 Lower critical values of the probability plot correlation test statistic for the normal distribution using
pi = (i 3/8)/(n + 1/4) (Vogel 1987)

p probability plot correlation test is a popular and


Z ^s3  0:17= 0:2326 0:70=n=n
powerful goodness-of-t statistic. Goodness-of-
6:76 t tests based upon sample estimators of the
L-skewness ^s3 for the normal and Gumbel dis-
with a reject region |Z| > z/2.
tribution provide simple and useful tests that are
The literature is full of goodness-of-t tests.
not based on a probability plot.
Experience indicates that among the better tests
there is often not a great deal of difference
(DAgostion and Stephens 1986). Generation of 6.3.3 Normal and Lognormal
a probability plot is most often a good idea Distributions
because it allows the modeler to see what the
data look like and where problems occur. The The normal distribution and its logarithmic
KolmogorovSmirnov test helps the eye interpret transformation, the lognormal distribution, are
a probability plot by adding bounds to a graph arguably the most widely used distributions in
illustrating the magnitude of deviations from a science and engineering. The density function of
straight line that are consistent with expected a normal random variable is
variability. One can also use quantiles of a beta

distribution to illustrate the possible error in 1 1 2
fX x p exp  2 x  l
individual plotting positions, particularly at the 2pr2 2r 6:77
extremes where that uncertainty is largest. The for  1\x\ 1
6.3 Distributions of Random Events 235

Table 6.7 Lower critical values of the probability plot correlation test statistic for the Gumbel distribution using
pi = (i 0.44)/(n + 0.12) (Vogel 1987)

where and 2 are equivalent to X and r2X , the 


1 1 dnx
mean and variance of X. Interestingly, the maxi- fX x p exp  2 nx  l2
2pr2 2r dx
mum likelihood estimators of and 2 are almost 
1 1
identical to the moment estimates x and s2X . p exp  2 nx=g2
x 2pr2 2r
The normal distribution is symmetric about its
mean X and admits values from to +. 6:78
Thus it is not always satisfactory for modeling
for x > 0 and = ln(). Here is the median of the
physical phenomena such as streamflows or
X-distribution. The coefcient of skewness for the
pollutant concentrations, which are necessarily
three-parameter lognormal distribution is given by
nonnegative and have skewed distributions.
A frequently used model for skewed distributions  
c 3t t3 where t exp r2  10:5
is the lognormal distribution. A random variable
X has a lognormal distribution if the natural 6:79
logarithm of X, ln(X), has a normal distribution.
If X is lognormally distributed, then by denition A lognormal random variable takes on values
ln(X) is normally distributed, so that the density in the range [0, +]. The parameter deter-
function of X is mines the scale of the X-distribution whereas 2
236 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Fig. 6.3 Lognormal


probability density
functions with various
standard deviations

determines the shape of the distribution. The and 1.72, which is substantially greater than the
mean and variance of the lognormal distribution sample skew of 0.712.
are given in Eq. 6.65. Figure 6.3 illustrates A useful generalization of the two-parameter
the various shapes the lognormal probability lognormal distribution is the shifted lognormal or
density function can assume. It is highly skewed three-parameter lognormal distribution obtained
with a thick right-hand tail for > 1, and when ln(X ) is described by a normal distri-
approaches a symmetric normal distribution as bution, where X . Theoretically, should be
0. The density function always has a value positive if for physical reasons X must be posi-
of zero at x = 0. The coefcient of variation tive; practically, negative values of can be
and skew are allowed when the resulting probability of nega-
tive values of X is sufciently small.
CVX expr2  11=2 Unfortunately, maximum likelihood estimates
6:80 of the parameters , 2, and are poorly behaved
cX 3CVX CV3X
because of irregularities in the likelihood func-
tion (Giesbrecht and Kempthorne 1976). The
The maximum likelihood estimates of and
method of moments does fairly well when the
2 are given in Eq. 6.63 and the moment esti-
skew of the tted distribution is reasonably
mates in Eq. 6.66. For reasonable-size samples,
small. A method that does almost as well as the
the maximum likelihood estimates are generally
moment method for low-skew distributions, and
performed as well or better than the moment
much better for highly skewed distributions,
estimates (Stedinger 1980).
estimates by
The data in Table 6.2 were used to calculate
the parameters of the lognormal distribution that x1 xn  ^x20:50
^s 6:81
would describe the flood flows and the results are x1 xn  2^x0:50
reported after Eq. 6.66. The two-parameter
maximum likelihood and method of moments provided that x(1) + x(n) 2^x 0.50 > 0, where x(1)
estimators identify parameter estimates for which and x(n) are the smallest and largest observations
the distribution skewness coefcients are 2.06 and ^x0:50 is the sample median (Stedinger 1980;
6.3 Distributions of Random Events 237

Hoshi et al. 1984). If x(1) + x(n) 2^x0:50 < 0, the 6.3.4 Gamma Distributions
sample tends to be negatively skewed and a
three-parameter lognormal distribution with a The gamma distribution has long been used to
lower bound cannot be t with this method. model many natural phenomena, including daily,
Good estimates of and 2 to go with ^s in monthly, and annual streamflows as well as flood
Eq. 6.81 are (Stedinger 1980) flows (Bobee and Ashkar 1991). For a gamma
2 3 random variable X,

6 x  ^s 7 j bj
^ n4q5
l fX x bxa1 ebx bx  0
2 Ca
1 s2x =x  ^s 6:82
" # a
s2x lX
2
^ n 1
r b
a 6:83
x  ^s2 r2X 2
b
For the data in Table 6.2, Eq. 6.82 yields the 2
cX p 2CVX
hybrid moment-of-moments estimates for the a
three-parameter lognormal distribution
The gamma function, (), for integer is
^ 7:606
l ( 1)!. The parameter > 0 determines the
^2 0:1339 0:36592
r shape of the distribution; is the scale parameter.
Figure 6.4 illustrates the different shapes that the
^s 600:1
probability density function for a gamma variable
can assume. As , the gamma distribution
This distribution has a coefcient of skewness
approaches the symmetric normal distribution,
of 1.19, which is more consistent with the sample
whereas for 0 < < 1, the distribution has a
skewness estimator than was the value obtained
highly asymmetric J-shaped probability density
when a two-parameter lognormal distribution
function whose value goes to innity as x ap-
was t to the data. Alternatively, one can esti-
proaches zero.
mate and 2 by the sample mean and variance
The gamma distribution arises naturally in
of ln(X ^s) that yields the hybrid maximum
many problems in statistics and hydrology. It
likelihood estimates
also has a very reasonable shape for such non-
^ 7:605
l negative random variables as rainfall and
streamflow. Unfortunately, its cumulative distri-
^2 0:1407 0:37512
r bution function is not available in closed form,
^s 600:1 except for integer , though it is available in
many software packages including Microsoft
The two sets of estimates are surprisingly Excel. The gamma family includes a very special
close in this instance. In this second case, the case: the exponential distribution is obtained
tted distribution has a coefcient of skewness of when = 1.
1.22. The gamma distribution has several general-
Natural logarithms have been used here. One izations (Bobee and Ashkar 1991). If a constant
could have just as well used base 10 common is subtracted from X so that (X ) has a gamma
logarithms to estimate the parameters; however, distribution, the distribution of X is a
in that case the relationships between the log three-parameter gamma distribution. This is also
space parameters and the real-space moments called a Pearson type 3 distribution, because the
change slightly (Stedinger et al. 1993, resulting distribution belongs to the third type of
Eq. 18.2.8). distributions suggested by the statistician
238 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Fig. 6.4 The gamma


distribution functions for
various values of the shape
parameter

Karl Pearson. Another variation is the procedures. Using the rst three sample
log-Pearson type 3 distribution obtained by t- moments, one would obtain for the three-
ting the logarithms of X with a Pearson type 3 parameter gamma distribution the parameter
distribution. The log-Pearson distribution is dis- estimates
cussed further in the next section.
^s 735:6
The method of moments may be used to
estimate the parameters of the gamma distribu- a^ 7:888
tion. For the three-parameter gamma distribution ^ 0:003452 1=289:7
b

sX Using only the sample mean and variance
^s x  2
^cX yields the method of moment estimators of the
4 parameters of the two-parameter gamma distri-
^
a 6:84
^cX 2 bution ( = 0)
^ 2
b ^a 3:627
s X cX
^
b 0:002341 1=427:2
where x; s2X ; and ^cX are estimates of the mean,
variance, and coefcient of skewness of the dis- The tted two-parameter gamma distribution
tribution of X (Bobee and Robitaille 1977). has a coefcient of skewness of 1.05 whereas
For the two-parameter gamma distribution, the tted three-parameter gamma reproduces the
sample skew of 0.712. As occurred with the
x2 three-parameter lognormal distribution, the esti-
^a
s2x mated lower bound for the three-parameter
6:85 gamma distribution is negative (^s 735:6)
^ x
b
s2x resulting in a three-parameter model that has a
smaller skew coefcient than was obtained with
Again the flood record in Table 6.2 can be the corresponding two-parameter model. The
used to illustrate the different estimation reciprocal of b^ is often reported. While b
^ has
6.3 Distributions of Random Events 239

inverse x-units, 1/b^ is a natural scale parameter Fortunately the availability of excellent approx-
that has the same units as x and thus can be easier imations of the gamma cumulative distribution
to interpret. function and its inverse in Microsoft Excel and
Studies by Thom (1958) and Matalas and other packages has reduced the need for such
Wallis (1973) have shown that maximum likeli- simple approximations.
hood parameter estimates are superior to the
moment estimates. For the two-parameter gamma
distribution, Greenwood and Durand (1960) give 6.3.5 Log-Pearson Type 3
approximate formulas for the maximum likeli- Distribution
hood estimates (also Haan 1977). However, the
maximum likelihood estimators are often not The log-Pearson type 3 distribution (LP3)
used in practice because they are very sensitive describes a random variable whose logarithms
to the smallest observations that sometimes suffer have a Pearson type 3 distribution. This distri-
from measurement error and other distortions. bution has found wide use in modeling flood
When plotting the observed and tted quan- frequencies and has been recommended for that
tiles of a gamma distribution, an approximation purpose (IACWD 1982). Bobee (1975), Bobee
to the inverse of the distribution function is often and Ashkar (1991) and Grifs and Stedinger
useful. For || 3, the WilsonHilferty (2007a) discuss the unusual shapes that this
transformation hybrid distribution may take allowing negative
" values of . The LP3 distribution has a proba-
3 #
2 cxN c2 2 bility density function given by.
xG l r 1   6:86
c 6 36 c
fX x jbjfblnx  nga1
6:87
gives the quantiles xG of the gamma distribution expfblnx  ng=fxCag
in terms of xN, the quantiles of the standard
normal distribution. Here , , and are the with > 0, and either positive or negative. For
mean, standard deviation, and coefcient of < 0, values are restricted to the range
skewness of xG. Kirby (1972) and Chowdhury 0 < x < exp(). For > 0, values have a lower
and Stedinger (1991) discuss this and other more bound so that exp() < X. Figure 6.5 illustrates
complicated but more accurate approximations. the probability density function for the LP3

Fig. 6.5 Log-Pearson type


3 probability density
functions for different
values of coefcient of
skewness
240 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

distribution as a function of the skew of the P3 of variation of a log-Pearson type 3 variate X as a


distribution describing ln(X), with lnX = 0.3. function of the standard deviation Y and coef-
The LP3 density function for || 2 can assume cient of skew Y of the log-transformation Y = ln
a wide range of shapes with both positive and (X). Thus the standard deviation Y and skew Y
negative skews. For || = 2, the log-space P3 of Y are in log space. For Y = 0, the log-Pearson
distribution is equivalent to an exponential dis- type 3 distribution reduces to the two-parameter
tribution function which decays exponentially as lognormal distribution discussed above, because
x moves away from the lower bound ( > 0) or in this case Y has a normal distribution. For the
upper bound ( < 0): as a result the LP3 distri- lognormal distribution, the standard deviation Y
bution has a similar shape. The space with serves as the sole shape parameter, and the
1 < may be more realistic for describing coefcient of variation of X for small Y is just
variables whose probability density function Y. Figure 6.7 shows that the situation is more
becomes thinner as x takes on large values. For complicated for the LP3 distribution. However,
= 0, the 2-parameter lognormal distribution is for small Y, the coefcient of variation of X is
obtained as a special case. approximately Y.
The LP3 distribution has mean and variance Again, the flood flow data in Table 6.2 can be
a used to illustrate parameter estimation. Using
n b
lX e natural logarithms, one can estimate the
b1 log-space moments with the standard estimators
( a 2a )
2 2n b b 6:88 in Eqs. 6.39a that yield
rX e 
b2 b1
^ 7:202
l
for b [ 2; or b\0:
^ 0:5625
r
For 0 < < 2, the variance is innite. ^c 0:337
These expressions are seldom used, but they
do reveal the character of the distribution. For the LP3 distribution, analysis generally
Figures 6.6 and 6.7 provide plots of the focuses on the distribution of the logarithms
real-space coefcient of skewness and coefcient Y = ln(X) of the flows, which would have a

Fig. 6.6 Real-space


coefcient of skewness X
for LP3 distributed X as a
function of log-space
standard deviation Y and
coefcient of skewness Y
where Y = ln(X)
6.3 Distributions of Random Events 241

Fig. 6.7 Real-space


coefcient of variation CVX
for LP3 distributed X as a
function of log-space
standard deviation Y and
coefcient of skewness Y
where Y = ln(X)

Pearson type 3 distribution with moments Y, Y would belong to the set of extreme value distri-
and Y (IACWD 1982; Bobe and Ashkar 1991). butions (Gumbel 1958; Kottegoda and Rosso
As a result, flood quantiles are calculated as 1997). These are the distributions obtained in the
limit, as the sample size n becomes large, by
xp expflY rY K p cY g 6:89 taking the largest of n independent random
variables. The Extreme Value (EV) type I dis-
where Kp[Y] is a frequency factor corresponding tribution or Gumbel distribution has often been
to cumulative probability for skewness coef- used to describe flood flows. It has the cumula-
cient Y. (Kp[Y] corresponds to the quantiles of a tive distribution function
three-parameter gamma distribution with zero
mean, unit variance, and skewness coefcient Y.) FX x expf expx  n=ag 6:90
Since 1967, the recommended procedure for
flood frequency analysis by federal agencies in with mean and variance of
the United States uses this distribution. Current
guidelines in Bulletin 17B (IACWD 1982) sug- lX n 0:5772a
6:91
gest that the skew Y be estimated by a weighted r2X p2 a2 =6 1:645a2
average of the at-site sample skewness coefcient
and a regional estimate of the skewness coef- Its skewness coefcient has the xed value
cient. Grifs and Stedinger (2007b) compare a equal to X = 1.1396.
wide range of methods that have been recom- The generalized extreme value (GEV) distri-
mended for tting the LP3 distribution. bution is a general mathematical expression that
incorporates the type I, II, and III extreme value
(EV) distributions for maxima (Gumbel 1958;
6.3.6 Gumbel and GEV Distributions Hosking et al. 1985). In recent years, it has been
used as a general model of extreme events
The annual maximum flood is the largest flood including flood flows, particularly in the context
flow during a year. One might expect that the of regionalization procedures (NERC 1975;
distribution of annual maximum flood flows Stedinger and Lu 1995; Hosking and Wallis
242 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

1997). The GEV distribution has cumulative j 7:8590c 2:9554c2


distribution function
a jk2 =C1 j1  2j  6:94
FX x expf1  jx  n=a 1=j
g for j 6 0 n k1 a=jC1 j  1
6:92
where
For > 0, floods must be less than the upper
c 2k2 =k3 3k2  ln2= ln3
bound for < 0, < x < , whereas for > 0,
2=s3 3  ln2= ln3
< x < + / (Hosking and Wallis 1987). The
mean, variance, and skewness coefcient are (for
As one can see, the estimator of the shape
> 1/3)
parameter will depend only upon the
lX n a=j1  C1 j; L-skewness estimator ^s3 . The estimator of the
r2X a=j2 fC1 2j  C1 j2 g scale parameter will then depend on the esti-
cX SignjfC1 3j 3C1 jC1 2j
mate of and of 2. Finally, one must also use
the sample mean 1 (Eq. 6.48) to determine the
 2C1 j3 g=fC1 2j  C1 j2 g3=2
estimate of the location parameter .
6:93 Using the flood data in Table 6.2 and the
sample L-moments computed in Sect. 6.2, one
where (1 + ) is the classical gamma function. obtains rst
The Gumbel distribution is obtained when = 0.
For || < 0.3, the general shape of the GEV dis- c 0:000896
tribution is similar to the Gumbel distribution,
that yields
though the right-hand tail is thicker for < 0, and
thinner for > 0, as shown in Figs. 6.8 and 6.9. ^ 0:007036
j
The parameters of the GEV distribution are ^n 1165:20
easily computed using L-moments and the rela-
^a 657:29
tionships (Hosking et al. (1985)

Fig. 6.8 GEV density


distributions for selected
shape parameter values
6.3 Distributions of Random Events 243

Fig. 6.9 Right-hand tails


of GEV distributions
shown in Fig. 6.8

The small value of the tted parameter Stedinger 2000). Other estimators implicitly have
means that the tted distribution is essentially a similar constraints. For example, L-moments
Gumbel distribution. Here is a location restricts to the range > 1, and the method
parameter, not a lower bound, so its value of moments estimator employs the sample stan-
resembles a reasonable x value. dard deviation so that > 0.5. Use of the sam-
Madsen et al. (1997a) show that moment esti- ple skew introduces the constraint that > 0.3.
mators can provide more precise quantile esti- Then given a set of independent observations
mators. Yet Martins and Stedinger (2001a, b) {x1, , xn} drawn for a GEV distribution, the
found that with occasional uninformative sam- generalized likelihood function is
ples, the MLE estimator of could be entirely
lnfLn; a; jjx1 ; . . .; xn g
unrealistic resulting in absurd quantile estimators.
X n

However the use of a realistic prior distribution on 1
n lna  1 lnyi  yi 1=j
yielded better generalized maximum likelihood i1
j
estimators (GLME) than moment and L-moment lnpj
estimators over the range of of interest.
The GMLE estimators are obtained my with
maximizing the log-likelihood function, aug-
mented by a prior density function on . A prior yi 1  j=axi  n 6:96
distribution that reflects general worldwide geo-
For feasible values of the parameters yi is
physical experience and physical realism is in the
greater than 0 (Hosking et al. 1985). Numerical
form of a beta distribution
optimization of the generalized likelihood func-
tion is often aided by the additional constraint
pj CpCq0:5 jp1 that min{y1, , yn } for some small > 0 so
6:95
0:5  jq1 =Cp q as to prohibit the search generating infeasible
values of the parameters for which the likelihood
for 0.5 < < +0.5 with p = 6 and q = 9. function is undened. The constraint should not
Moreover, this prior assigns reasonable proba- be binding at the nal solution.
bilities to the values of within that range. For The data in Table 6.2 again provide a conve-
outside the range 0.4 to +0.2 the resulting GEV nient data set for illustrating parameter estimators.
distributions do not have density functions con- The L-moment estimators were used to generate
sistent with flood flows and rainfall (Martins and an initial solution. Numerical optimization of the
244 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

likelihood function Eq. 6.96 yielded the maxi- hydrology. It shows that distributions with the
mum likelihood estimators of the GEV same coefcient of skewness still differ in the
parameters thickness of their tails, described by their kurto-
sis. Tail shapes are important if an analysis is
^ 0:0359
j sensitive to the likelihood of extreme events.
^
n 1165:4 The normal and Gumbel distributions have a
xed shape and thus are presented by single
^
a 620:2
points that fall on the Pearson type 3 (P3) curve
for = 0, and the generalized extreme value
Similarly, use of the geophysical prior
(GEV) curve for = 0, respectively. The
(Eq. 6.95) yielded the generalized maximum
L-kurtosis/L-skewness relationships for the
likelihood estimators
two-parameter and three-parameter gamma or P3
^ 0:0823
j distributions are identical, as they are for the
two-parameter and three-parameter lognormal
^
n 1150:8 distributions. This is because the addition of a
^
a 611:4 location parameter does not change the range of
fundamental shapes that can be generated.
Here the record length of 40 years is too short However, for the same skewness coefcient, the
to reliably dene the shape parameter so that lognormal distribution has a larger kurtosis than
result of using the prior is to increase slightly the gamma or P3 distribution and thus assigns
toward the mean of the prior. The other two larger probabilities to the largest events.
parameters adjust accordingly. As the skewness of the lognormal and gamma
distributions approaches zero, both distributions
become normal and their kurtosis/skewness
6.3.7 L-Moment Diagrams relationships merge. For the same L-skewness,
the L-kurtosis of the GEV distribution is gener-
This chapter has presented several families of ally larger than that of the lognormal distribu-
distributions. The L-moment diagram in tion. For positive yielding almost symmetric or
Fig. 6.10 illustrates the relationships between the even negatively skewed GEV distributions, the
L-kurtosis (3) and L-skewness (2) for a number GEV has a smaller kurtosis than the three-
of the families of distributions often used in parameter lognormal distribution. The latter can

Fig. 6.10 Relationships


between L-skewness and
L-kurtosis for various
distributions
6.3 Distributions of Random Events 245

be negatively skewed when is used as an upper probability models, and maximum likelihood
bound. estimators (Haas and Scheff 1990; Helsel 1990;
Figurer 6.10 also includes the three-parameter Kroll and Stedinger 1996; MacBerthouex and
generalized Pareto distribution, whose cdf is Brown 2002).
Historical and physical paleoflood data pro-
FX x 1  1  jx  n=a1=j 6:97 vide another example of censored data. Before the
beginning of a continuous measurement program
(Hosking and Wallis 1997). For = 0 it cor- on a stream or river, the stages of unusually large
responds to the exponential distribution (gamma floods can be estimated based on the memories of
with = 1). This point is where the Pareto and humans who have experienced these events
P3 distribution L-kurtosis/L-skewness lines and/or physical markings in the watershed
cross. The Pareto distribution becomes increas- (Stedinger and Baker 1987). Before continuous
ing more skewed for < 0, which is the range of measurements were taken that provided this
interest in hydrology. The generalized Pareto information, the annual maximum floods that
distribution with < 0 is often used to describe were not unusual were not recorded. These
peaks-over-a-threshold and other variables missing data are censored data. They cover peri-
whose density function has its maximum at their ods between occasionally large floods that have
lower bound. In that range for a given been recorded or that have left some evidence of
L-skewness, the Pareto distribution always has a their occurrence (Stedinger and Cohn 1986).
larger kurtosis than the gamma distribution. In The discussion below addresses probability
these cases the parameter for the gamma dis- plot methods for use with censored data. Proba-
tribution would need to be in the range bility plot methods have a long history of use
0 < < 1, so that both distributions would be with censored data because they are relatively
J-shaped. simple to use and to understand. Moreover,
As shown in Fig. 6.10, the GEV distribution recent research has shown that they are relatively
has a thicker right-hand tail than either the efcient when the majority of values are
gamma/Pearson type 3 distribution or the log- observed, and unobserved values are known only
normal distribution. to be below (or above) some detection limit or
perception threshold that serves as a lower (or
upper) bound. In such cases, probability plot
6.4 Analysis of Censored Data regression estimators of moments and quantiles
are as accurate as maximum likelihood estima-
There are many instances in water resources tors. They are almost as good as estimators
planning where one encounters censored data. computed with complete samples (Helsel and
A data set is censored if the values of observa- Cohn 1988; Kroll and Stedinger 1996).
tions that are outside a specied range of values Perhaps the simplest method for dealing with
are not specically reported (David 1981). For censored data is adoption of a conditional prob-
example, in water quality investigations many ability model. Such models implicitly assume
constituents have concentrations that are reported that the data are drawn from one of two classes of
as <T, where T is a reliable detection threshold observations: those below a single threshold, and
(MacBerthouex and Brown 2002). Thus the those above the threshold. This model is appro-
concentration of the water quality variable of priate for simple cases where censoring occurs
interest was too small to be reliably measured. because small observations are recorded as
Likewise, low-flow observations and rainfall zero, as often happens with low-flow, low
depths can be rounded to or reported as zero. pollutant concentration, and some flood records.
Several approaches are available for analysis The conditional probability model introduces an
of censored data sets including probability extra parameter P0 to describe the probability
plots and probability plot regression, conditional that an observation is zero. If r of a total of
246 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

n observations were observed because they The idea behind the probability plot regres-
exceeded the threshold, then P0 is estimated as sion estimators is to use the probability plot for
(n r)/n. A continuous distribution GX(x) is the observed data to dene the parameters of the
derived for the strictly positive nonzero values whole distribution. And if a sample mean, sam-
of X. Then the parameters of the G distribution ple variance, or quantiles are needed, then the
can be estimated using any procedure appropriate distribution dened by the probability plot is
for complete uncensored samples. The uncondi- used to ll in the missing (censored) observations
tional cumulative distribution function so that standard estimators of the mean, of the
(cdf) FX(x) for any value x > 0, is then standard deviation, and of the quantiles can be
employed. Such ll-in procedures are efcient
FX x P0 1  P0 Gx 6:98 and relatively robust for tting a distribution and
estimating various statistics with censored water
This model completely decouples the value of quality data when a modest number of the
P0 from the parameters that describe the smallest observations are censored (Helsel 1990;
G distribution. Kroll and Stedinger 1996).
Section 6.3.2 discusses probability plots and Unlike the conditional probability approach,
plotting positions useful for graphical displaying here the below threshold probability P0 is linked
of data to allow a visual examination of the with the selected probability distribution for the
empirical frequency curve. Suppose that among above-threshold observations. The observations
n samples a detection limit is exceeded by the below the threshold are censored but are in all
observations r times. The natural estimator of the other respects envisioned as coming from the
exceedance probability P0 of the perception same distribution that is used to describe the
threshold is again (n r)/n. If the r values that observed above-threshold values.
exceeded the threshold are indexed by i = 1, , When water quality data are well described by
r, wherein x(r) is the largest, then reasonable a lognormal distribution, available values ln
plotting positions within the interval [P0, 1] arerno [X(1)]  ln[X(r)] can be regressed upon
F1[pi] = + F1[pi] for i = 1, , r, where
pi P0 1  P0 i  a=r 1  2a the r largest observation in a sample of size n are
6:99 available. If regression yields constant m and
slope s, corresponding to population moments
where a denes the plotting position that is used. and , a good estimator of the pth quantile is
Helsel and Cohn (1988) show that reasonable
choices for a generally make little difference.  
xp exp m szp 6:101
Letting a = 0 is reasonable (Hirsch and Stedinger
1987). Both papers discuss development of
where zp is the pth quantile of the standard nor-
plotting positions when there are different
mal distribution. To estimate sample means and
thresholds, as occurs when the analytical preci-
other statistics one can ll in the missing obser-
sion of instrumentation changes over time. If
vations with
there are many exceedances of the threshold so
that r (1 2a), pi is indistinguishable from
xj expfyjg for j 1; . . . ; n  r
p0i i n r  a=n 1  2a: 6:100 6:102

where again, i = 1, , r. These values corre- where


spond to the plotting positions that would be
yj m sF 1 fP0 j  a=n  r 1  2ag
assigned to the largest r observations in a com-
plete sample of n values. 6:103
6.4 Analysis of Censored Data 247

Once a complete sample is constructed, stan- Here (n r) observations were below the
dard estimators of the sample mean and variance threshold T, and the probability an observation is
can be calculated, as can medians and ranges. By below T is F(T|) which then appears in
lling in the missing small observations, and Eq. 6.104 to represent that observation. In addi-
then using complete-sample estimators of statis- tion the specic values of the r observations
tics of interest, the procedure is relatively x1, , xr are available. The probability an
insensitive to the assumption that the observa- observation is in a small interval of width r
tions actually have a lognormal distribution. around xi is r f(xi|). Thus strictly speaking the
Maximum likelihood estimators are quite likelihood function also includes a term r. Here
flexible, and are more efcient than plotting what is known of the magnitude of all of the
position methods when the values of the obser- n observations is included in the likelihood
vations are not recorded because they are below function in the appropriate way. If all that were
the perception threshold (Kroll and Stedinger known of some observation was that it exceeded
1996). Maximum likelihood methods allow the a threshold M, then that value should be repre-
observations to be represented by exact values, sented by a term [1 F(M|)] in the likelihood
ranges, and various thresholds that either were or function. Similarly, if all that was known was
were not exceeded at various times. This can be that the value was between L and M, then a term
particularly important with historical flood data [F(M|) F(L|)] should be included in the
sets because the magnitudes of many historical likelihood function. Different thresholds can be
floods are not recorded precisely, and it may be used to describe different observations, corre-
known that a threshold was never crossed or was sponding to changes in the quality of measure-
crossed at most once or twice in a long period ment procedures. Numerical methods can be
(Stedinger and Cohn 1986; Stedinger 2000; used to identify the parameter vector that maxi-
OConnell et al. 2002). Unfortunately, maximum mizes the likelihood function for the data
likelihood estimators for the LP3 distribution available.
have proven to be problematic. However,
expected moment estimators seem to do as well
as MLEs with the LP3 distribution (Cohn et al.
6.5 Regionalization
1997, 2001).
and Index-Flood Method
While often a computational challenge, max-
imum likelihood estimators for complete sam-
Research has demonstrated the potential advan-
ples, and samples with some observations
tages of index flood procedures (Lettenmaier
censored, pose no conceptual challenge. One
et al. 1987; Stedinger and Lu 1995; Hosking and
need to only write the maximum likelihood
Wallis 1997; Madsen and Rosbjerg 1997a). The
function for the data and proceed to seek the
idea behind the index-flood approach is to use
parameter values that maximizes that function.
the data from many hydrologically similar
Thus if F(x|) and f(x|) are the cumulative dis-
basins to estimate a dimensionless flood distri-
tribution and probability density functions that
bution (Wallis 1980). Thus this method substi-
should describe the data, and are its parameters,
tutes space for time using regional information
then for the case described above wherein
to compensate for having relatively short records
x1, , xr are r of n observations that exceeded a
at each site. The concept underlying the
threshold T, the likelihood function would be
index-flood method is that the distributions of
(Stedinger and Cohn 1986)
floods at different sites in a region are the same
nr except for a scale or index-flood parameter that
Lhjr; n; x1 ; . . .; xr FTjh f x1 jhf x2 jh . . . f xr jh
reflects the size, rainfall, and runoff characteris-
6:104 tics of each watershed. Research is revealing
248 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

when this assumption may be reasonable. Often a GEV distribution. In both studies, only a binary
more sophisticated multi-scaling model is variable representing region was found useful
appropriate (Gupta and Dawdy 1995a; Robinson in explaining variations in these two shape
and Sivapalan 1997). parameters.
Generally the mean is employed as the index Once a regional model of alternative shape
flood. The problem of estimating the pth quantile parameters is derived, there may be some
xp is then reduced to estimating the mean for a advantage to combining such regional estimators
site x, and the ratio xp/x of the pth quantile to with at-site estimators employing an empirical
the mean. The mean can often be estimated Bayesian framework or some other weighting
adequately with the record available at a site, schemes. For example, Bulletin 17B recom-
even if that record is short. The indicated ratio is mends weighting at-site and regional skewness
estimated using regional information. The British estimators, but almost certainly places too much
Flood Studies Report (NERC 1975) calls these weight on the at-site values (Tasker and
normalized flood distributions growth curves. Stedinger 1986). Examples of empirical Baye-
Key to the success of the index-flood sian procedures are provided by Kuczera (1982),
approach is identication of sets of basins that Madsen and Rosbjerg (1997b) and Fill and
have similar coefcients of variation and skew. Stedinger (1998). Madsen and Rosbjergs
Basins can be grouped geographically, as well as (1997b) computation of a -model with a New
by physiographic characteristics including drai- Zealand data set demonstrates how important it
nage area and elevation. Regions need not be can be to do the regional analysis carefully,
geographically contiguous. Each site can poten- taking into account the cross-correlation among
tially be assigned its own unique region con- concurrent flood records.
sisting of sites with which it is particularly When one has relatively few data at a site, the
similar (Zrinji and Burn 1994), or regional index-flood method is an effective strategy for
regression equations can be derived to compute deriving flood frequency estimates. However, as
normalized regional quantiles as a function of a the length of the available record increases it
sites physiographic characteristics and other becomes increasingly advantageous to also use
statistics (Fill and Stedinger 1998). the at-site data to estimate the coefcient of
Clearly the next step for regionalization pro- variation as well. Stedinger and Lu (1995) found
cedures, such as the index-flood method, is to that the L-moment/GEV index-flood method did
move away from estimates of regional parame- quite well for humid regions (CV 0.5) when
ters that do not depend upon basin size and other n < 25, and for semiarid regions (CV 1.0) for
physiographic parameters. Gupta et al. (1994) n < 60, if reasonable care is taken in selecting
argue that the basic premise of the index-flood the stations to be included in a regional analysis.
method, that the coefcient of variation of floods However, with longer records it became advan-
is relatively constant, is inconsistent with the tageous to use the at-site mean and L-CV with a
known relationships between the coefcient of regional estimator of the shape parameter for a
variation CV and drainage area (see also GEV distribution. In many cases this would
Robinson and Sivapalan 1997). Recently, Fill be roughly equivalent to tting a Gumbel dis-
and Stedinger (1998) built such a relationship tribution corresponding to a shape parameter
into an index-flood procedure using a regression = 0. Gabriele and Arnell (1991) develop the
model to explain variations in the normalized idea of having regions of different size for dif-
quantiles. Tasker and Stedinger (1986) illustrated ferent parameters. For realistic hydrologic
how one might relate log-space skew to physio- regions, these and other studies illustrate the
graphic basin characteristics (see also Gupta and value of regionalizing estimators of the shape,
Dawdy 1995b). Madsen and Rosbjerg (1997b) and often the coefcient of variation of a
did the same for a regional model of for the distribution.
6.6 Partial Duration Series 249

6.6 Partial Duration Series expected damages from hydrologic events when
more than one damage-causing event can occur
Two general approaches are available for mod- in a season or within a year (North 1980).
eling flood and precipitation series (Langbein A model of a PDS series has at least two
1949). An annual maximum series considers components: rst, one must model the arrival rate
only the largest event in each year. A partial of events larger than the threshold level; second,
duration series (PDS) or peaks-over-threshold one must model the magnitudes of those events.
(POT) approach includes all independent peaks For example, a Poisson distribution has often
above a truncation or threshold level. An objec- been used to model the arrival of events, and an
tion to using annual maximum series is that it exponential distribution to describe the magni-
employs only the largest event in each year, tudes of peaks that exceed the threshold.
regardless of whether the second largest event in There are several general relationships
a year exceeds the largest events of other years. between the probability distribution for annual
Moreover, the largest annual flood flow in a dry maximum and the frequency of events in a partial
year in some arid or semiarid regions may be duration series. For a PDS model, let be the
zero, or so small that calling them floods is average arrival rate of flood peaks greater than
misleading. When considering rainfall series or the threshold x0 and let G(x) be the probability
pollutant discharge events, one may be interested that flood peaks, when they occur, are less than
in modeling all events that occur within a year x > x0, and thus those peaks fall in the range [x0,
that exceed some threshold of interest. x]. The annual exceedance probability for a
Use of a partial duration series (PDS) frame- flood, denoted 1/Ta, corresponding to an annual
work avoids such problems by considering all return period Ta, is related to the corresponding
independent peaks that exceed a specied thresh- exceedance probability qe = [1 G(x)] for level
old. And, one can estimate annual exceedance x in the partial duration series by
probabilities from the analysis of PDS. Arguments
in favor of PDS are that relatively long and reliable 1=Ta 1  expfkqe g 1  expf1=Tp g
PDS records are often available, and if the arrival 6:105
rate for peaks over the threshold is large enough
(1.65 events/year for the Poisson arrival with where Tp = 1/(qe) is the average return period
exponential-exceedance model), PDS analyses for level x in the PDS.
should yield more accurate estimates of extreme Many different choices for G(x) may be rea-
quantiles than the corresponding annual maximum sonable. In particular, the Generalized Pareto
frequency analyses (NERC 1975; Rosbjerg 1985). distribution (GPD) is a simple distribution useful
However, when tting a three-parameter distri- for describing floods that exceed a specied
bution, there seems to be little advantage from lower bound. The cumulative distribution func-
using a PDS approach over an annual maximum tion for the generalized three-parameter Pareto
approach, even when the partial duration series distribution is
includes many more peaks than the maximum
series because both contain the same largest events FX x 1  1  jx  n=a1=j 6:106
(Martins and Stedinger 2001a).
A drawback of PDS analyses is that one must with mean and variance
have criteria to identify only independent peaks
(and not multiple peaks corresponding to the lX n a=1 jj
6:107
same event). Thus PDS analysis can be more r2X a2 =1 j2 1 2j
complicated than analyses using annual maxima.
Partial duration models, perhaps with parameters where for < 0, < x < , whereas for > 0,
that vary by season, are often used to estimate < x < + / (Hosking and Wallis 1987).
250 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

A special case of the GPD is the two-parameter This means that the observations are not inde-
exponential distribution obtain with = 0. pendent. Time series are conceptualized as being
Method of moment estimators work relatively a single observation of a stochastic process,
well (Rosbjerg et al. 1992). which is a generalization of the concept of a
Use of a generalized Pareto distribution for G random variable.
(x) with a Poisson arrival model yields a GEV This section has three parts. The rst presents
distribution for the annual maximum series the concept of stationarity and the basic statistics
greater than x0 (Smith 1984; Stedinger et al. generally used to describe the properties of a
1993; Madsen et al. 1997a). The Poisson-Pareto stationary stochastic process. The second pre-
and Poisson-GPD models are a very reasonable sents the denition of a Markov process and the
description of flood risk (Rosbjerg et al. 1992). Markov chain model. Markov chains are a con-
They have the advantage that they focus on the venient model for describing many phenomena,
distribution of the larger flood events, and and are often used in synthetic flow generation
regional estimates of the GEV distributions and optimization models. The third part discusses
shape parameter from annual maximum and the sampling properties of statistics used to
PDS analyses can be used interchangeably. describe the characteristics of many time series.
Martins and Stedinger (2001a, b) compare PDS
estimation procedures a well as demonstrating
that use of the three-parameter Poisson-GPD 6.7.1 Describing Stochastic Processes
model instead of a three-parameter GEV distri-
bution generally results in flood quantile esti- A random variable whose value changes through
mators with the same precision. time according to probabilistic laws is called a
Madsen and Rosbjerg (1997a) use a Poisson- stochastic process. An observed time series is
GPD model as the basis of a PDS index-flood considered to be one realization of a stochastic
procedure. Madsen et al. (1997b) show that the process, just as a single observation of a random
estimators are fairly efcient. They pooled variable is one possible value the random vari-
information from many sites to estimate the able may assume. In the development here, a
single shape parameter and the arrival rate stochastic process is a sequence of random
where the threshold was a specied percentile of variables {X(t)} ordered by a discrete time index
the daily flow duration curve at each site. Then t = 1, 2, 3, .
at-site information was used to estimate the mean The properties of a stochastic process must
above-threshold flood. Alternatively one could generally be determined from a single time series
use the at-site data to estimate the arrival rate as or realization. To do this several assumptions are
well. usually made. First, one generally assumes that
the process is stationary, at least in the short run.
This means that the probability distribution of the
6.7 Stochastic Processes and Time process is not changing over some specied
Series interval of time. In addition, if a process is
strictly stationary, the joint distribution of the
Many important random variables in water random variables X(t1), , X(tn) is identical to
resources are functions whose values change the joint distribution of X(t1 + t), , X
with time. Historical records of rainfall or (tn + t) for any t; the joint distribution depends
streamflow at a particular site are a sequence of only on the differences ti tj between the times
observations called a time series. In a time series, of occurrence of the events. In other words, its
the observations are ordered by time, and it is shape does not change over time if the distribu-
generally the case that the observed value of the tion is stationary. In the long run, however,
random variable at one time influences the dis- because of climate and land changes, many
tribution of the random variable at later times. hydrologic distributions are not stationary, and
6.7 Stochastic Processes and Time Series 251

just how much they will change in the future is simulation, the variances of the estimated
uncertain. x and r^2X are larger than would be the case if the
For a stationary stochastic process, one can observations were independent. It is sometimes
write the mean and variance as wise to take this inflation into account.
Section 6.7.3 discusses the sampling distribution
lX EXt 6:109 of these statistics.
All of this analysis depends on the assumption
and of stationarity for only then do the quantities
dened in Eqs. 6.1096.111 have the intended
r2X Var Xt 6:110
meaning. Stochastic processes are not always
stationary. Urban development, deforestation,
Both are independent of time t. The autocor-
agricultural development, climatic variability,
relations, the correlation of X with itself, are
and changes in regional resource management
given by
can alter the distribution of rainfall, streamflows,
CovXt; Xt k pollutant concentrations, sediment loads, and
qX k 6:111 groundwater levels over time. If a stochastic
r2X
process is not essentially stationary over the time
for any positive integer k (the time lag). These span in question, then statistical techniques that
are the statistics most often used to describe rely on the stationary assumption cannot be
stationary stochastic processes. employed and the problem generally becomes
When one has available only a single time much more difcult.
series, it is necessary to estimate the values of X,
r2X , and X(k) from values of the random variable
that one has observed. The mean and variance
6.7.2 Markov Processes and Markov
are generally estimated essentially as they were Chains
in Eq. 6.39a.
A common assumption in many stochastic water
T resources models is that the stochastic process X
1X
^X X
l Xt 6:112 (t) is a Markov process. A rst-order Markov
T t1
process has the property that the dependence of
future values of the process on past values
T 
depends only on the current value. In symbols for
1X 2
^2X
r Xt  X 6:113 k > 0,
T t1
FX Xt kjXt; Xt  1; Xt  2; . . .
while the autocorrelations X(k) can be estimated FX Xt kjXt
as (Jenkins and Watts 1968) 6:115
PTk
t1xt k  xxt  x For Markov processes, the current value
^ x k rk
q PT 6:114
t1 xt   x2 summarizes the state of the processes. As a
consequence, the current value of the process is
The sampling distribution of these estimators often referred to as the state. This makes physical
depends on the correlation structure of the sense as well when one refers to the state or level
stochastic process giving rise to the time series. of an aquifer or reservoir.
In particular, when the observations are posi- A special kind of Markov process is one
tively correlated as is usually the case in natural whose state X(t) can take on only discrete values.
streamflows or annual benets in a river basin Such a processes is called a Markov chain. Often
252 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

in water resources planning, continuous probability that the process resides in state i in
stochastic processes are approximated by Mar- year y. Then the probability that Qy+1 = qj is the
kov chains. This is done to facilitate the con- sum of the probabilities pyi that Qy = qi times the
struction of simpler stochastic models. This probability pij that the next state is Qy+1 given that
section presents the basic notation and properties Qy = qi. In symbols, this relationship is written
of Markov chains.
n
X
Consider a stream whose annual flow is to be
pjy 1 py1 p1j py2 p2j    pyn pnj pyi pij
represented by a discrete random variable. i1
Assume that the distribution of streamflows is
6:119
stationary. In the following development, the
continuous random variable representing the Letting py be the row vector of state resident
annual streamflows (or some other process) is  
probabilities pyi ; . . .; pyn , this relationship may
approximated by a random variable Qy in year y,
be written
which takes on only n discrete values qi (each
value representing a continuous range or interval
py 1 py P 6:120
of possible streamflows) with unconditional
probabilities pi where To calculate the probabilities of each stream-
n
X flow state in year y + 2, one can use p(y+1)
pi 1 6:116 in Eq. 6.120 to obtain p(y+2) = p(y+1)P or
i1 p(y+2) = pyP2
Continuing in this matter, it is possible to
It is frequently the case that the value of Qy+1
compute the probabilities of each possible
is not independent of Qy. A Markov chain can
streamflow state for years y + 1, y + 2,
model such dependence. This requires speci-
y + 3, , y + k, as
cation of the transition probabilities pij,

pij PrQy 1 qj jQy qi  6:117 py k py Pk 6:121

Returning to the four-state example in


A transition probability is the conditional
Fig. 6.11, assume that the flow in year y is in the
probability that the next state is qj, given that the
interval represented by q2. Hence in year y the
current state is qi. The transition probabilities
must satisfy unconditional streamflow probabilities pyi are
(0, 1, 0, 0). Knowing each pyi , the probabilities
n
X pjy 1 corresponding to each of the four stream-
pij 1 for all i 6:118
j1
flow states can be determined. From Fig. 6.11,
the probabilities pyj 1 are 0.2, 0.4, 0.3, and 0.1
Figure 6.11a, b show a possible set of tran- for j = 1, 2, 3, and 4, respectively. The proba-
sition probabilities in a matrix and as histograms. bility vectors for nine future years are listed in
Each element pij in the matrix is the probability Table 6.8.
of a transition from streamflow qi in one year to As time progresses, the probabilities generally
streamflow qj in the next. In this example, a low reach limiting values. These are the uncondi-
flow tends to be followed by a low flow, rather tional or steady-state probabilities. The quantity
than a high flow, and vice versa. pi has been dened as the unconditional proba-
Let P be the transition matrix whose elements bility of qi. These are the steady-state probabili-
are pij. For a Markov chain, the transition matrix ties which p(y+k) approaches for large k. It is clear
contains all the information necessary to describe from Table 6.8 that as k becomes larger,
the behavior of the process. Let pyi be the Eq. 6.119 becomes
6.7 Stochastic Processes and Time Series 253

(a)

(b)

Fig. 6.11 a Matrix of streamflow transition probabilities transition probabilities showing probability of streamflow
showing probability of streamflow qj (represented by qj (represented by index j) in year y + 1 given streamflow
index j) in year y + 1 given streamflow qi (represented by qi (represented by index i) in year y
index i) in year y. b Histograms (below) of streamflow
254 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Table 6.8 Successive streamflow probabilities based on transition probabilities in Fig. 6.11

n
X are 12 months in a year, there would be 12
pj pi pij 6:122 transition matrices, the elements of which could
i1 be denoted as ptij . Each denes the probability of
or in vector notation, Eq. 6.122 becomes a streamflow ptj 1 y in month t + 1, given a
streamflow pti y in month t. The steady-state
p pP 6:123 stationary probability vectors for each month can
be found by the procedure outlined above, except
where p is the row vector of unconditional that now all 12 matrices are used to calculate all
probabilities (p1, , pn). For the example in 12 steady-state probability vectors. However,
Table 6.8, the probability vector p equals (0.156, once the steady-state vector p is found for one
0.309, 0.316, 0.219). month, the others are easily computed using
The steady-state probabilities for any Markov Eq. 6.121 with t replacing y.
chain can be found by solving simultaneous
Eqs. 6.123 for all but one of the states j together
with the constraint 6.7.3 Properties of Time Series
Statistics
n
X
pi 1 6:124
i1 The statistics most frequently used to describe
the distribution of a continuous-state stationary
Annual streamflows are seldom as highly stochastic process are the sample mean, variance,
correlated as the flows in this example. However, and various autocorrelations. Statistical depen-
monthly, weekly, and especially daily stream- dence among the observations, as is frequently
flows generally have high serial correlations. the case in time series, can have a marked effect
Assuming that the unconditional steady-state on the distribution of these statistics. This part of
probability distributions for monthly stream- Sect. 6.7 reviews the sampling properties of
flows are stationary, a Markov chain can be these statistics when the observations are a real-
dened for each months steamflow. Since there ization of a stochastic process.
6.7 Stochastic Processes and Time Series 255

The sample mean variables of the same length with the same
n variance.
1X
X Xi 6:125 A common model of stochastic series has
n i1
qX k qX 1k qk 6:128
when viewed as a random variable is an unbiased
estimate of the mean of the process X, because This correlation structure arises from the
n autoregressive Markov model discussed at length
1X
EX EXi  lX 6:126 in Sect. 6.8. For this correlation structure
n i1
( )
However, correlation among the Xis, so that   r2 2q n1  q  1  qn 
Var X X 1
X(k) 0 for k > 0, affects the variance of the n n 1  q2
estimated mean X. 6:129
  h 2 i
Var X E X  lX
( ) Substitution of the sample estimates for r2X
Xn X n and X(1) in the equation above often yields a
1
2E Xt  lX Xs  lX more realistic estimate of the variance of X than
n t1 s1
(
n1  ) does the estimate s2X =n if the correlation structure
r2X X k
12 1  qX k X(k) = k is reasonable; otherwise, Eq. 6.127
n k1
n may be employed. Table 6.9 illustrates the affect
6:127 of correlation among the Xt values on the stan-
dard error of their mean, equal to the square root
The variance of X, equal to r2X =n for inde- of the variance in Eq. 6.127.
pendent observations, is inflated by the factor The properties of the estimate of the variance
within the brackets. For X(k) 0, as is often the of X,
case, this factor is a non-decreasing function of n,
n 
so that the variance of X is inflated by a factor 1X 2
^2X v2X
r Xt  X 6:130
whose importance does not decrease with n t1
increasing sample size. This is an important
observation, because it means the average of a are also affected by correlation among the Xts.
correlated time series will be less precise than the Here v rather than s is used to denote the variance
average of a sequence of independent random estimator because n is employed in the

Table 6.9 Standard error of X when x = 0.25 and X(k) = k


256 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

denominator rather than n 1. The expected and X(k) = k. This would be the coefcient of
value of v2x becomes variation of v2X were it not biased.
( ) A fundamental problem of time series analy-
n1
X 
 2 1 2 k ses is the estimation or description of the rela-
E vX r2X 1   1  qX k
n n k1 n tionship between the random variable at different
times. The statistics used to describe this rela-
6:131 tionship are the autocorrelations. Several esti-
mates of the autocorrelations have been
The bias in v2X depends on terms involving
suggested; a simple and satisfactory estimate
X(1) through X(n 1). Fortunately, the bias in
recommended by Jenkins and Watts (1968) is
v2X decreases with n and is generally unimportant
when compared to its variance. Pnk
Correlation among the Xts also affects the t1xt  xxt k  x
^X k rk
q Pn
variance of v2X . Assuming that X has a normal t1 xt  x 2
distribution (here the variance of v2X depends on 6:134
the fourth moment of X), the variance of v2X for
large n is approximately (Kendall and Stuart Here, rk is the ratio of two sums where the
1966, Sect. 48.1). numerator contains n k terms and the denom-
inator contains n terms. The estimate rk is biased,
( )
  r4 1
X but unbiased estimates frequently have larger
Var v2X 2 X 12 q2X k 6:132 mean square errors (Jenkins and Watts 1968).
n k1 A comparison of the bias and variance of r1 is
provided by the case when the Xts are inde-
where for X(k) = k, Eq. 6.132 becomes pendent normal variates. Then (Kendall and
 Stuart 1966)
 2 r4X 1 q2
Var vX 2 6:133
n 1  q2 1
Er1   6:135a
n
Like the variance of X, the variance of v2X is
inflated by a factor whose importance does not and
decrease with n. This is illustrated by Table 6.10
that gives the standard deviation of v2X divided by n  2 2 1
the true variance r2X as a function of n and Varr1 6:135b
n2 n  1 n
when the observations have a normal distribution

Table 6.10 Standard deviation of (v2X =r2X when observations have a normal distribution and X(k) = k
6.7 Stochastic Processes and Time Series 257

For n = 25, the expected value of r1 is 0.04 In particular for rl, this gives
rather than the true value of zero; its standard
1 
deviation is 0.19. This results in a mean square Varr1 1  q2 6:139
error of (E[r1])2 + Var(r1) = 0.0016 + 0.0353 = n
0.0369. Clearly, the variance of r1 is the domi-
Approximate values of the standard deviation
nant term.
of rl for different values of n and are given in
For Xt values that are not independent, exact
Table 6.11.
expressions for the variance of rk generally are
The estimates of rk and rk+j are highly corre-
not available. However, for normally distributed
lated for small j; this causes plots of rk versus k to
Xt and large n (Kendall and Stuart 1966),
exhibit slowly varying cycles when the true
1  values of X(k) may be zero. This increases the
1 X
Varrk q2 l qx l kqx l  k difculty of interpreting the sample
n l1 x
autocorrelations.
 4qx kqx lqx k  l 2q2x kq2x l
6:136
6.8 Synthetic Streamflow
If X(k) is essentially zero for k > q, then the Generation
simpler expression (Box et al. 1994)
6.8.1 Introduction
" #
q
X
1
Varrk 12 q2x l 6:137 This section is concerned primarily with ways of
n t1
generating sample data such as streamflows,
temperatures, and rainfall that are used in water
is valid for rk corresponding to k > q; thus for
resource systems simulation studies (e.g., as
large n, Var(rk) l/n and values of rk will fre-
p introduced in the next section). The models and
quently be outside the range of 1.65/ n, even
techniques discussed in this section can be used
though x(k) may be zero.
to generate any number of quantities used as
If X(k) = k, Eq. 6.137 reduces to
inputs to simulation studies. For example Wilks

  (1998, 2002) discusses the generation of wet and
1 1 q2 1  q2k 2k
Varr k  2kq dry days, rainfall depths on wet days, and asso-
n 1  q2
ciated daily temperatures. The discussion here is
6:138 directed toward the generation of streamflows

Table 6.11 Approximate standard deviation of r1 when observations have a normal distribution and X(k) = k
258 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

because of the historic development and frequent information in that historical record. That infor-
use of these models in that context (Matalas and mation is not fully used if only the historical
Wallis 1976). In addition, they are relatively sequence is simulated. By tting continuous dis-
simple compared to more complete daily weather tributions to the set of historical flows and then
generators and many other applications. Gener- using those distributions to generate other
ated streamflows have been called synthetic to sequences of flows, all of which are statistically
distinguish them from historical observations similar and equally likely, gives one a broader
(Fiering 1967). The eld has been called range of inputs to simulation models. Testing
stochastic hydrologic modeling. More detailed designs and policies against that broader range of
presentations can be found in Marco et al. (1989) flow sequences that could occur more clearly
and Salas (1993). identies the variability and range of possible
River basin simulation studies can use many future performance indicator values. This in turn
sets of streamflow, rainfall, evaporation, and/or should lead to the selection of more robust system
temperature sequences to evaluate the statistical designs and policies.
properties of the performance of alternative water The use of synthetic streamflows is particu-
resources systems. For this purpose, synthetic larly useful for water resource systems having
flows and other generated quantities should large amounts of over-year storage. Use of only
resemble, statistically, those sequences that are the historical hydrologic record in system simu-
likely to be experienced during the planning lation yields only one time history of how the
period. Figure 6.12 illustrates how synthetic system would operate from year to year. In water
streamflow, rainfall, and other stochastic resource systems having relatively little storage
sequences are used in conjunction with projec- so that reservoirs and/or groundwater aquifers
tions of future demands and other economic data rell almost every year, synthetic hydrologic
to determine how different system designs and sequences may not be needed if historical
operating policies might perform. sequences of a reasonable length are available. In
Use of only the historical flow or rainfall this second case, a 25-year historic record pro-
record in water resource studies does not allow vides 25 descriptions of the possible within-year
for the testing of alternative designs and policies operation of the system. This may be sufcient
against the range of sequences that are likely to for many studies.
occur in the future. We can be very condent that Generally, use of stochastic sequences is
the future historical sequence of flows will not be thought to improve the precision with which
the historical one, yet there is important water resource system performance indices can

Fig. 6.12 Structure of a simulation study, indicating the transformation of a synthetic streamflow sequence, future
demands and a system design and operating policy into system performance statistics
6.8 Synthetic Streamflow Generation 259

be estimated, and some studies have shown this just model the N-year output series that results
to be the case (Vogel and Shallcross 1996; Vogel from simulation of the historical series?
and Stedinger 1988). In particular, if the opera- The answer seems to depend upon how well
tion of the system and performance indices have behaved the input and output series are. If the
thresholds and shape breaks, then the coarse simulation model is linear, it does not make
description provided by historical series are much difference. If the simulation model were
likely to provide relative inaccurate estimates of highly nonlinear, then modeling the input series
the expected values of such statistics. For would appear to be advisable. Or if one is
example, suppose that shortages only invoke a developing reservoir operating policies, there is a
nonlinear penalty function on average one year in tendency to make a policy sufciently complex
20. Then in a 60-year simulation there is a 19% that it deals very well with the few droughts in
probability that the penalty will be invoked at the historical record but at the same time giving a
most once, and an 18% probability it will be false sense of security and likely misrepresenting
invoked ve or more times. Thus the calculation the probability of system performance failures.
of the annual average value of the penalty would Another situation where stochastic
be highly unreliable unless some smoothing of data-generating models are useful is when one
the input distributions is allowed associated with wants to understand the impact on system per-
a long simulation analysis. formance estimates of the parameter uncertainty
On the other hand, if one is only interested in stemming from short historical records. In that
the mean flow, or average benets that are mostly case, parameter uncertainty can be incorporated
a linear function of flows, then use of stochastic into streamflow generating models so that the
sequences will probably add little information to generated sequences reflect both the variability
what is obtained simply by simulating the histor- that one would expect in flows over time as well
ical record. After all, the tted models are ulti- as the uncertainty of the parameter values of the
mately based on the information provided in the models that describe that variability (Valdes et al.
historical record, and their use does not produce 1977; Stedinger and Taylor 1982a, b; Stedinger
new information about the hydrology of the basin. Pei and Cohn 1985; Vogel and Stedinger 1988).
If in a general sense one has available N years If one decides to use a stochastic data gener-
of record, the statistics of that record can be used ator, the challenge is to use a model that appro-
to build a stochastic model for generating thou- priately describes the important relationships, but
sands of years of flow. These synthetic data can does not attempt to reproduce more relationships
now be used to estimate more exactly the system than are justied or that can be estimated with
performance, assuming, of course, that the available data sets.
flow-generating model accurately represents Two basic techniques are used for streamflow
nature. But the initial uncertainty in the model generation. If the streamflow population can be
parameters resulting from having only N years of described by a stationary stochastic process, a
record would still remain (Schaake and Vicens process whose parameters do not change over
1980). An alternative is to run the historical time, and if a long historical streamflow record
record (if it is sufcient complete at every site exists, then a stationary stochastic streamflow
and contains no gaps of missing data) through model may be t to the historical flows. This
the simulation model to generate N years of statistical model can then generate synthetic
output. That output series can be processed to sequences that describe selected characteristics of
produce estimates of system performance. So the the historical flows. Several such models are
question is: is it better to generate multiple input discussed below.
series based on uncertain parameter values and The assumption of stationarity is not always
use those to determine average system perfor- plausible, particularly in river basins that have
mance with great precision, or is it sufcient to experienced marked changes in runoff
260 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

characteristics due to changes in land cover, land One may want to model as closely as possible
use, climate, or the use of groundwater during the the true marginal distribution of seasonal flows
period of flow record. Similarly, if the physical and/or the marginal distribution of annual flows.
characteristics of a basin will change substan- These describe both how much water may be
tially in the future, the historical streamflow available at different times and also how variable is
record may not provide reliable estimates of the that water supply. Also, modeling the joint distri-
distribution of future unregulated flows. In the bution of flows at a single site in different months,
absence of the stationarity of streamflows or a seasons, and years may be appropriate. The per-
representative historical record, an alternative sistence of high flows and of low flows, often
scheme is to assume that precipitation is a sta- described by their correlation, affects the reliabil-
tionary stochastic process and to route either ity with which a reservoir of a given size can
historical or synthetic precipitation sequences provide a given yield (Fiering 1967; Lettenmaier
through an appropriate rainfall-runoff model of and Burges 1977a, b; Thyer and Kuczera 2000).
the river basin. For multicomponent reservoir systems, repro-
duction of the joint distribution of flows at different
sites and at different times will also be important.
Sometimes, a streamflow model is said to
6.8.2 Streamflow Generation Models statistically resemble the historical flows if the
streamflow model produces flows with the same
A statistical streamflow generation model is used mean, variance, skew coefcient, autocorrela-
to generate streamflow data that can supplement tions, and/or cross-correlations as were observed
or replace historical streamflow data in various in the historic series. This denition of statistical
analyses requiring such data. If the past flow resemblance is attractive because it is operational
record is considered representative of what the and requires that an analyst need only nd a
future one might be, at least for a while, then the model that can reproduce the observed statistics.
statistical characteristics of the historical flow The drawback of this approach is that it shifts the
record can be used as a basis for generating new modeling emphasis away from trying to nd a
flow data. While this may be a reasonable good model of marginal distributions of the
assumption in the near future, changing land uses observed flows and their joint distribution over
and climate may lead to entirely different statis- time and over space, given the available data, to
tical characteristics of future streamflows, if not just reproducing arbitrarily selected statistics.
now, certainly in the more distant future. By then, Dening statistical resemblance in terms of
improved global climate models (GCMs) and moments may also be faulted for specifying that
downscaling methods together with improved the parameters of the tted model should be
rainfall-runoff predictions given future land use determined using the observed sample moments,
scenarios may be a preferred way to generate or their unbiased counterparts. Other parameter
future streamflows. This section of the chapter estimation techniques, such as maximum likeli-
will focus on the use of historical records. hood estimators, are often more efcient. Deni-
The rst step in the construction of a statistical tion of resemblance in terms of moments can also
streamflow generating model based on historical lead to confusion over whether the population
flow records is to extract from the historical parameters should equal the sample moments, or
streamflow record the fundamental information whether the tted model should generate flow
about the joint distribution of flows at different sites sequences whose sample moments equal the
and at different times. A streamflow model should historical valuesthe two concepts are different
ideally capture what is judged to be the fundamental because of the biases (as discussed in Sect. 6.7) in
characteristics of the joint distribution of the flows. many of the estimators of variances and correla-
The specication of what characteristics are fun- tions (Matalas and Wallis 1976; Stedinger 1980,
damental is of primary importance. 1981; Stedinger and Taylor 1982a).
6.8 Synthetic Streamflow Generation 261

For any particular river basin study, one must of a stationary stochastic process Qy. The genera-
determine what streamflow characteristics need tion of annual streamflows and other variables
to be modeled. The decision should depend on would be a simple matter if annual flows were
what characteristics are important to the opera- independently distributed. In general, this is not the
tion of the system being studied, the data avail- case and a generating model for many phenomena
able, and how much time can be spared to build should capture the relationship between values in
and test a stochastic model. If time permits, it is different years or in different periods. A common
good practice to see if the simulation results are and reasonable assumption is that annual flows are
in fact sensitive to the generation model and its the result of a rst-order Markov process.
parameter values using an alternative model and Assume also that annual streamflows are
set of parameter values. If the models results are normally distributed. In some areas, the distri-
sensitive to changes, then, as always, one must bution of annual flows is in fact nearly normal.
exercise judgment in selecting the appropriate Streamflow models that produce nonnormal
model and parameter values to use. streamflows are discussed as an extension of this
This section presents a range of statistical simple model.
models for the generation of synthetic data. The The joint normal density function of two
necessary sophistication of a data-generating streamflows Qy and Qw in years y and w having
model depends on the intended use of the data. mean , variance 2, and year-to-year correlation
Section 6.8.3 below presents the simple autore- between flows is
gressive Markov model for generating annual
  1
flow sequences. This model alone is too simple f qy ; qw
2pr2 1  q2 0:5
for many practical studies, but is useful for " 2   #
illustrating the fundamentals of the more com- qy  l 2q qy  l qw  l qw  l2
 exp
2r2 1  q2
plex models that follow. Therefore, considerable
time is spent exploring the properties of this 6:140
basic model.
Subsequent sections discuss how flows with The joint normal distribution for two random
any marginal distribution can be produced and variables with the same mean and variance
present models for generating sequences of flows depend only on their common mean , variance
that can reproduce the persistence of historical 2, and the correlation between the two (or
flow sequences. Other parts of this section pre- equivalently the covariance 2).
sent models to generate concurrent flows at The sequential generation of synthetic stream-
several sites and to generate seasonal or monthly flows requires the conditional distribution of the
flows while preserving the characteristics of flow in one year given the value of the flows in
annual flows. For those wishing to study syn- previous years. However, if the streamflows are a
thetic streamflow models in greater depth more rst-order (lag 1) Markov process, then the
advanced material can be found in Marco et al. dependence of the distribution of the flow in year
(1989) and Salas (1993). y + 1 on flows in previous years depends entirely
on the value of the flow in year y. In addition, if the
annual streamflows have a multivariate normal
distribution, then the conditional distribution of
6.8.3 A Simple Autoregressive Model Qy+1 is normal with mean and variance
A simple model of annual streamflows is the EQy 1 jQy qy  l qqy  l
autoregressive Markov model. The historical 6:141
annual flows qy are thought of as a particular value VarQy 1 jQy qy r2 1  q2
262 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

where qy is the value of Qy in year y. Notice that VarQy 1 jqy  EfQy 1  EQy 1 jqy g2 jqy 
the larger the absolute value of the correlation p
between the flows, the smaller the conditional Efl qqy  l Vy r 1  q2
variance of Qy+1, which in this case does not  l qqy  lg2
p
depend at all on the value qy. EVy r 1  q2 2 r2 1  q2 
Synthetic normally distributed streamflows 6:146
that have mean , variance 2, and year-to-year
correlation , are produced by the model Thus this model produces flows with the
p
Qy 1 l qQy  l Vy r 1  q2 correct conditional mean and variance.
To compute the unconditional mean of Qy+1
6:142
one rst takes the expectation of both sides of
Eq. 6.142 to obtain
where Vy is a standard normal random variable,
meaning that it has zero mean, E[Vy] = 0, and    
h i E Qy 1 l qE Qy  l
unit variance, E Vy2 1. The random variable   p 6:147
E V y r 1  q2
Vy is added here to provide the variability in Qy+1
that remains even after Qy is known. By con- where E[Vy] = 0. If the distribution of stream-
struction, each Vy is independent of past flows flows is independent of time so that for all y,
Qw where w y, and Vy is independent of Vw for E[Qy+1] = E[Qy] = E[Q], it is clear that (1 )
w y. These restrictions imply that E[Q] = (1 ) or
 
E Vw Vy 0 w 6 y 6:143 EQ l 6:148

and Alternatively, if Qy for y = 1 has mean , then


Eq. 6.147 indicates that Q2 will have mean .
EQw  lVy  0 wy 6:144 Thus repeated application of the Eq. 6.147 would
demonstrate that all Qy for y > 1 have mean .
Clearly, Qy+1 will be normally distributed if The unconditional variance of the annual
both Qy and Vy are normally distributed because flows can be derived by squaring both sides of
sums of independent normally distributed ran- 6.142 to obtain
dom variables are normally distributed.
p 2
It is a straightforward procedure to show that EQy 1  l2  EfqQy  l Vy r
1  q2 g 
p
this basic model indeed produces streamflows 2 2
q EQy  l  2qr 1  q2 EQy  lVy 
h i
with the specied moments, as demonstrated r2 1  q2 E Vy2
below.
Using the fact that E[Vy] = 0, the conditional 6:149
mean of Qy+1 given that Qy equals qy is
Because Vy is independent of Qy (Eq. 6.144),
p the second term on the right-hand side of
EQy 1 jqy  El qqy  l Vy r 1  q2 
l qqy  l Eq. 6.149 vanishes. Hence the unconditional
variance of Q satises
6:145
EQy 1  l2  q2 EQy  l2  r2 1  q2
Since E{V2y ] = Var[Vy] = 1, the conditional
variance of Qy+1 is 6:150
6.8 Synthetic Streamflow Generation 263

Assuming that Qy+1 and Qy have the same It is important to note that the results in
variance yields Eqs. 6.145 to 6.153 do not depend on the
assumption that the random variables Qy and Vy
EQ  l2  r2 6:151 are normally distributed. These relationships
apply to all autoregressive Markov processes of
so that the unconditional variance is 2, as the form in Eq. 6.142 regardless of the distribu-
required. tions of Qy and Vy. However, if the flow Qy in year
Again, if one does not want to assume that y = 1 is normally distributed with mean and
Qy+1 and Qy have the same variance, a recursive variance 2, and if the Vy are independent normally
argument can be adopted to demonstrate that if distributed random variables with mean zero and
Q1 has variance 2, then Qy for y 1 has vari- unit variance, then the generated Qy for y 1 will
ance 2. also be normally distributed with mean and
The covariance of consecutive flows is variance 2. The next section considers how this
another important issue. After all the whole idea and other models can be used to generate stream-
of building these time series models is to flows that have other than a normal distribution.
describe the year-to-year correlation of the flows.
Using Eq. 6.142 one can compute that the
covariance of consecutive flows must be. 6.8.4 Reproducing the Marginal
Distribution
EQy 1  lQy  l EfqQy  l
p
Vy r 1  q2 Qy  lg Most models for generating stochastic processes
2 2 deal directly with normally distributed random
qEQy  l  qr
variables. Unfortunately, flows are not always
6:152
adequately described by the normal distribution.
where E[(Qy )Vy] = 0 because Vy and Qy are In fact, streamflows and many other hydrologic
independent (Eq. 6.144). data cannot really be normally distributed because
Over a longer time scale, another property of of the impossibility of negative values. In general,
this model is that the covariance of flows in year distributions of hydrologic data are positively
y and y + k is skewed having a lower bound near zero and, for
practical purposes, an unbounded right-hand tail.
EQy k  lQy  l qk r2 6:153 Thus they look like the gamma or lognormal dis-
tribution illustrated in Figs. 6.3 and 6.4.
This equality can be proven by induction. It The asymmetry of a distribution is often
has already been shown for k = 0 and 1. If it is measured by its coefcient of skewness. In some
true for k = j 1, then streamflow models, the skew of the random
elements Vy is adjusted so that the models gen-
EQy j  lQy  l EfqQy j1  l erate flows with the desired mean, variance, and
p
Vy j1 r 1  q2 Qy  lg skew coefcient. For the autoregressive Markov
qEQy  lQy j1  l model for annual flows
qqj1 r2  q j r2 h pi3
EQy 1  l3  E qQy  l Vy r 1  q2
6:154
q3 EQy  l3 
where E[(Qy )Vy+j1] = 0 for j 1. Hence h i
r3 1  q2 3=2 E Vy3
Eq. 6.153 is true for any value of k.
6:155
264 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

so that denoted X(k; s, u), and their variances r2X s and


r2X u, where
EQ  l3  1  q2 3=2
cQ 6:156 expqX k; s; urX srX u  1
r3 1  q3 qQ k; s; u 1=2 1=2
fexpr2X s  1g fexpr2X u  1g
By appropriate choice of the skew of Vy, the 6:160
desired skew coefcient of the annual flows can
be produced. This method has often been used to The correlations of the X sy can be adjusted, at
generate flows that have approximately a gamma least in theory, to produce the observed correla-
distribution using Vys with a gamma distribution tions among the Qsy variates. However, more
and the required skew. The resulting approxi- efcient estimates of the true correlation of the
mation is not always adequate (Lettenmaier and Qsy values are generally obtained by transforming
Burges 1977a).
the historical flows qsy into their normal equiva-
The alternative and generally preferred
method is to generate normal random variables lent xsy nqsy  s and using the historical
and then transform these variates to streamflows correlations of these xsy values as estimators of
with the desired marginal distribution. Common X(k; s, u) (Stedinger 1981).
choices for the distribution of streamflows are the Some insight into the effect of this logarithmic
two-parameter and three-parameter lognormal transformation can be gained by considering the
distributions or a gamma distribution. If Qy is a resulting model for annual flows at a single site.
lognormally distributed random variable, then If the normal variates follow the simple autore-
gressive Markov model
Qy s expXy 6:157 q
Xy 1  l qX Xy  l Vy rX 1  q2X
where Xy is a normal random variable; when the
lower bound is zero, Qy has a two-parameter 6:161
lognormal distribution. Equation 6.157 trans-
forms the normal variates Xy into lognormally then the corresponding Qy follow the model
distributed streamflows. The transformation is (Matalas 1967)
easily inverted to obtain
Qy 1 s Dy fexplx 1  qX gQy  sqX
Xy lnQy  s for Qy  s 6:158
6:162
where Qy must be greater than its lower bound .
where
The mean, variance, skewness of Xy and Qy
are related by the formulas (Matalas 1967)
Dy exp1  q2X 1=2 rX Vy  6:163
1 2
lQ s explX r The conditional mean and standard deviation
2 X
of Qy+1 given that Qy = qy now depend on
r2Q exp2lX r2X expr2X  1 6:159 qy  sqX . Because the conditional mean of Qy+1
exp3r2X  3 expr2X 2 is no longer a linear function of qy, the stream-
cQ
expr2X  13=2 flows are said to exhibit differential persistence:
low flows are now more likely to follow low
If normal variates Xys and Xyu are used to flows than high flows are to follow high flows.
generate lognormally distributed streamflows This is a property often attributed to real
Qsy and Quy at sites s and u, then the lag-k corre- streamflow distributions. Models can be con-
lation of the Qys, denoted Q(k; s, u), is deter- structed to capture the relative persistence of wet
mined by the lag-k correlation of the X variables, and dry periods (Matalas and Wallis 1976; Salas
6.8 Synthetic Streamflow Generation 265

 T
1993; Thyer and Kuczera 2000). Many weather In addition, let Vy Vy1 ; . . .; Vyn be a
generators for precipitation and temperature nat- column vector of standard normal random vari-
ural include such differences by employing a ables, where V sy is independent of V rw for (r, w)
Markov chain description of the occurrence of
(s, y) and independent of past flows Zwr where
wet and dry days (Wilks 1998).
y w. The assumption that the variables have
zero mean implicitly suggests that the mean
value has already been subtracted from all the
6.8.5 Multivariate Models
variables. This makes the notation simpler and
eliminates the need to include a constant term in
If long concurrent streamflow records can be
the models. With all the variables having zero
constructed at the several sites at which synthetic
mean, one can focus on reproducing the vari-
streamflows are desired, then ideally a general
ances and covariances of the vectors included in
multisite streamflow model could be employed.
a model.
OConnell (1977), Ledolter (1978), Salas et al.
A sequence of synthetic flows can be gener-
(1980) and Salas (1993) discuss multivariate
ated by the model
models and parameter estimation. Unfortunately,
model identication (parameter value estimation)
Zy 1 AZy BVy 6:165
is very difcult for the general multivariate
models. where A and B are (n n) matrices whose ele-
This section illustrates how the basic uni- ments are chosen to reproduce the lag 0 and lag 1
variate annual flow model in Sect. 8.3 can be cross-covariances of the flows at each site. The
generalized to the multivariate case. This exer- lag 0 and lag 1 covariances and cross-covariances
cise reveals how easily multivariate models can can most economically be manipulated by use of
be constructed to reproduce specied variances the two matrices S0 and S1; the lag-zero covari-
and covariances of the flow vectors of interest, or ance matrix, denoted S0, is dened as
some transformation of those values. This mul-
tisite generalization of the annual AR(1) or S0 EZy ZTy  6:166
autoregressive Markov model follows the
approach taken by Matalas and Wallis (1976). and has elements
This general approach can be further extended to h i
multisite/multiseason modeling procedures, as is S0 i; j E Z iy Z yj 6:167
done in the next section employing what have
been called disaggregation models. However, The lag-one covariance matrix, denoted S1, is
while the size of the model matrices and vectors dened as
increases, the models are fundamentally the same
from a mathematical viewpoint. Hence this sec- S1 EZy 1 ZTy  6:168
tion starts with the simpler case of an annual flow
model. and has elements
For simplicity of presentation and clarity,
h i
vector notation is employed. Let Zy S1 i; j E Z iy 1 Z yj 6:169
Zy1 ; . . . ; Zyn T
be the column vector of trans-
formed zero-mean annual flows at sites s = 1, The covariances do not depend on y because
2, , n, so that the streamflows are assumed to be stationary.
Matrix S1 contains the lag 1 covariances and
EZ sy  0 6:164 lag 1 cross-covariances. S0 is symmetric because
266 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

h i
the cross covariance S0(i, j) equals S0(j, i). In mean. E Vy VTy equals the identity matrix
general, S1 is not symmetric.
The variancecovariance equations that dene because the components of Vy are independently
the values of A and B in terms of S0 and S1 are distributed with unit variance. Thus
obtained by manipulations of Eq. 6.165. Multi-
S0 AS0 AT BBT 6:174
plying both sides of that equation by ZTy and
taking expectations yields
Solving of the B matrix one nds that it
h i h i h i should satisfy
E Zy 1 ZTy E AZy ZTy E BVy ZTy
6:170 BBT S0  AS0 AT S0  S1 S1
0 S1 6:175
T

The second term on the right-hand side van- The last equation results from substitution of
ishes because the components of Zy and Vy are the relationship for A given in Eq. 6.172 and the
independent. Now the rst term in Eq. 6.170,
h i fact that S0 is symmetric; hence S1 0 is
E AZy ZTy , is a matrix whose (i, j)th element symmetric.
It should not be too surprising that the ele-
equals
ments of B are not uniquely determined by
" # Eq. 6.175. The components of the random vector
n
X n
X
E aik Zyk Zyi aik EZyk Zyi  6:171 Vy may be combined in many ways to produce
k1 k1 the desired covariances as long as B satises
Eq. 6.175. A lower triangular matrix that satises
The matrix with these elements is the same as Eq. 6.175 can be calculated by Cholesky
h i
the matrix AE Zy ZTy . decomposition (Young 1968; Press et al. 1986).
Matalas and Wallis (1976) call Eq. 6.165 the
Hence, Athe matrix of constantscan be
lag-1 model. They did not call the lag-1 model a
pulled through the expectation operator just as is
Markov model because the streamflows at indi-
done in the scalar case where E[aZy + b] = aE
vidual sites do not have the covariances of an
[Zy] + b for xed constants a and b.
autoregressive Markov process given in
Substituting S0 and S1 for the appropriate
Eq. 6.153. They suggest an alternative model
expectations in Eq. 6.170 yields
they call the Markov model. It has the same
S1 AS0 or A S1 S1 6:172 structure as the lag-1 model except it does not
0
preserve the lag-1 cross-covariances. By relaxing
A relationship to determine the matrix B is this requirement, they obtain a simpler model
obtained by multiplying both sides of Eq. 6.165 with fewer parameters that generates flows that
by its own transpose (this is equivalent to have the covariances of an autoregressive Mar-
squaring both sides of the scalar equation a = b) kov process at each site. In their Markov model,
and taking expectations to obtain the new A matrix is simply a diagonal matrix
whose diagonal elements are the lag-1 correla-
EZy 1 ZTy 1  EAZy ZTy AT  EAZy VTy BT  tions of flows at each site
 
E BVy Zy AT EBVy VTy BT  A diagq1; i; i 6:176
6:173
where (1; i, i) is the lag-one correlation of flows
The second and third terms on the right-hand at site i.
side of Eq. 6.173 vanish because the components The corresponding B matrix depends on the
of Zy and Vy are independent and have zero new A matrix and S0, where as before
6.8 Synthetic Streamflow Generation 267

BBT S0  AS0 AT 6:177 reproduce statistics both at the annual level and
at the seasonal level. Subsequent improvements
The idea of tting time series models to each and variations are described by Stedinger and
site separately and then correlating in innovations Vogel (1984), Maheepala and Perera (1996),
in those separate models to reproduce the Koutsoyiannis and Manetas (1996) and Tarboton
cross-correlation between the series is a very et al. (1998).
general and powerful modeling idea that has seen Disaggregation models can be used for either
a number of applications with different time multiseason single-site or multisite streamflow
series models (Matalas and Wallis 1976; generation. They represent a very flexible mod-
Stedinger et al. 1985; Camacho et al. 1985; Salas eling framework for dealing with different time
1993). or spatial scales. Annual flows for the several
sites in question or the aggregate total annual
flow at several sites can be the input to the model
(Grygier and Stedinger 1988). These must be
6.8.6 Multiseason, Multisite Models generated by another model, such as those dis-
cussed in the previous sections. These annual
In most studies of surface water systems it is flows or aggregated annual flows are then dis-
necessary to consider the variations of flows aggregated to seasonal values.
within each year. Streamflows in most areas have  T
within-year variations, exhibiting wet and dry Let Zy Z 1y ; . . .; Z Ny be the column vec-
periods. Similarly, water demands for irrigation, tor of N transformed normally distributed annual
municipal, and industrial uses also vary, and the or aggregate annual flows for N separate sites or

variations in demand are generally out of phase 1 1 2
basins. Next let Xy = X1;y ; . . .; XT;y ; X1;y ; . . .;
with the variation in within-year flows; more T
2 n n
water is usually desired when streamflows are XTy ; . . .; X1y ; . . .; XTy be the column vector
low and less is desired when flows are high. This
of nT transformed normally distributed seasonal
increases the stress on water delivery systems
flows X sty for season t, year y, and site s.
and makes it all the more important that time
series models of streamflows, precipitation and Assuming that the annual and seasonal series,
other hydrological variables correctly reproduce Z sy and X sty , have zero mean (after the appro-
the seasonality of hydrological processes. priate transformation), the basic disaggregation
This section discusses two approaches to model is
generating within-year flows. The rst approach Xy AZy BVy 6:178
is based on the disaggregation of annual flows
produced by an annual flow generator to seasonal where Vy is a vector of nT independent standard
flows. Thus the method allows for reproduction normal random variables, and A and B are,
of both the annual and seasonal characteristics of respectively, nT N and nT nT matrices. One
streamflow series. The second approach gener- selects values of the elements of A and B to
ates seasonal flows in a sequential manner, as reproduce the observed correlations among the
was done for the generation of annual flows. elements of Xy and between the elements of Xy and
Thus the models are a direct generalization of the Zy. Alternatively, one could attempt to reproduce
annual flow models already discussed. the observed correlations of the untransformed
flows as opposed to the transformed flows,
6.8.6.1 Disaggregation Model although this is not always possible (Hoshi et al.
The disaggregation model proposed by Valencia 1978) and often produces poorer estimates of the
and Schaake (1973) and extended by Mejia and actual correlations of the flows (Stedinger 1981).
Rousselle (1976) and Tao and Delleur (1976) The values of A and B are determined using
allows for the generation of synthetic flows that the matrices Szz EZy ZTy , Szz EZy ZTy ,
268 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Sxx EXy XTy , Sxz EXy ZTy , and Szy transformed into synthetic flows Qsty , the con-
EZy XTy  where Szz was called S0 earlier. Clearly, straint that these seasonal flows should sum to
the given value of the annual flow is lost. Thus
STxz Szx . If Sxz is to be reproduced, then by
the generated annual flows (equal to the sums of
multiplying Eq. 6.178 on the right by ZTy and
the seasonal flows) will deviate from the values
taking expectations, one sees that A must satisfy that were to have been the annual flows. Some
h i h i distortion of the specied distribution of the
E Xy ZTy E AZy ZTy 6:179 annual flows results. This small distortion can be
ignored, or each years seasonal flows can be
or scaled so that their sum equals the specied value
of the annual flow (Grygier and Stedinger 1988).
Sxz ASzz 6:180 The latter approach eliminates the distortion in
the distribution of the generated annual flows by
Solving for the coefcient matrix A one distorting the distribution of the generated sea-
obtains sonal flows. Koutsoyiannis and Manetas (1996)
improve upon the simple scaling algorithm by
A Sxz S1
zz 6:181 including a step that rejects candidate vectors Xy
if the required adjustment is too large and instead
To obtain an equation that determines the
generates another vector Xy. This reduces the
required value of the matrix B, one can multiply
distortion in the monthly flows that results from
both sides of Eq. 6.178 by their transpose and
the adjustment step.
take expectations to obtain
The disaggregation model has substantial data
requirements. When the dimension of Zy is n and
Sxx ASzz AT BBT 6:182
the dimension of the generated vector Xy is m,
Thus to reproduce the covariance matrix Sxx the A matrix has mn elements. The lower diag-
the B matrix must satisfy onal B matrix and the symmetric Sxx matrix,
upon which it depends, each have m(m + 1)/2
BBT Sxx  ASzz AT 6:183 nonzero or nonredundant elements. For example,
when disaggregating two aggregate annual flow
Equations 6.181 and 6.183 for determining series to monthly flows at ve sites, n = 2 and
A and B are completely analogous to Eqs. 6.172 m = 12 5 = 60 so that A has 120 elements
and 6.175 for the A and B matrices of the lag-1 while B and Sxx each have 1830 nonzero or
models developed earlier. However, for the dis- nonredundant parameters. As the number of sites
aggregation model as formulated, BBT and hence included in the disaggregation increases, the size
the matrix B can actually be singular or nearly so of Sxx and B increases rapidly. Very quickly the
(Valencia and Schaake 1973). This occurs model can become over parameterized, and there
because the real seasonal flows sum to the will be insufcient data to estimate all parameters
observed annual flows. Thus given the annual (Grygier and Stedinger 1988).
flow at a site and (T 1) of the seasonal flows, In particular, one can think of Eq. 6.178 as a
the value of the unspecied seasonal flow can be series of linear models generating each monthly
determined by subtraction. flow X kty for k = 1, t = 1, , 12; k = 2,
If the seasonal variables Xtys correspond to t = 1, , 12 up to k = n, t = 1, , 12 that
nonlinear transformations of the actual flows Qsty , reproduces the correlation of each X kty with all
then BBT is generally sufciently non-singular n annual flows, Z ky , and all previously generated
that a B matrix can be obtained by Cholesky monthly flows. Then when one gets to the last flow
decomposition. On the other hand, when the in the last month, the model will be attempting to
model is used to generate values of Xtys to be reproduce n + (12n 1) = 13n 1 annual to
6.8 Synthetic Streamflow Generation 269

monthly and cross-correlations. Because the random variables Zty. These can then be mod-
model implicitly includes a constant, this means eled by an extension of the annual flow genera-
one needs k* = 13n years of data to obtain a tors that have already been discussed. This
unique solution for this critical equation. For transformation can be accomplished by tting a
n = 3, k* = 39. One could say that with a record reasonable marginal distribution to the flows in
length of 40 years, there would be only 1 degree of each season so as to be able to convert the
freedom left in the residual model error variance observed flows qsty into their transformed coun-
described by B. That would be unsatisfactory. terparts zsty , and vice versa. Particularly, when
When flows at many sites or in many seasons shorter streamflow records are available, these
are required, the size of the disaggregation model simple approaches may yield a reasonable model
can be reduced by disaggregation of the flows in of some streams for some studies. However, it
stages and not attempting to explicitly reproduce implicitly assumes that the standardized series is
every season-to-season correlation by construct- stationary in the sense that the season-to-season
ing what have been called condensed and con- correlations of the flows do not depend on the
temporaneous models (Lane 1979; Stedinger and seasons in question. This assumption seems
Vogel 1984; Gryier and Stedinger 1988; highly questionable.
Koutsoyiannis and Manetas 1996). Condensed This theoretical difculty with the standard-
models do not attempt to reproduce the ized series can be overcome by introducing a
cross-correlations among all the flow variates at separate streamflow model for each month. For
the same site within a year (Lane 1979; Stedinger example, the classic Thomas-Fiering model
et al. 1985), whereas contemporaneous models (Thomas and Fiering 1962) of monthly flows
are like the Markov model developed earlier in may be written
Sect. 8.5 and are essentially models developed q
for individual sites whose innovation vectors Vy Zt 1;y bt Zty 1  b2t Vty 6:184
have the needed cross-correlations to reproduce
the cross-correlations of the concurrent flows where the Ztys are standard normal random vari-
(Camacho et al. 1985), as was done in Eq. 6.177. ables corresponding to the streamflow in season
Grygier and Stedinger (1991) describe how this t of year y, t is the season-to-season correlation of
can be done for a condensed disaggregation the standardized flows, and Vty are independent
model without generating inconsistencies. standard normal random variables. The problem
with this model is that it often fails to reproduce
6.8.6.2 Aggregation Models the correlation among months during a year and
One can start with annual or seasonal flows, and thus misrepresents the risk of multi-month and
break them down into flows in shorter periods multi-year droughts (Hoshi et al. 1978).
representing months or weeks. Or instead one For an aggregation approach to be attractive it
can start with a model that describes flows and is necessary to use a model with greater persis-
the shortest time step included in the model; this tence than the Thomas-Fiering model. Time
latter approach has been referred to as aggrega- series models that allow reproduction of different
tion model to distinguish it from the disaggre- correlation structures are the Box-Jenkins
gation approach. Autoregressive-Moving average models
One method for generating multiseason flow (Box et al. 1994). These models are presented by
sequences is to convert the time series of sea- the notation ARMA(p, q) for a model which
sonal flows Qty into a homogeneous sequence of depends on p previous flows, and q extra inno-
normally distributed zero-mean unit-variance vations Vty. For example, Eq. 6.142 would be
270 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

called an AR(1) or AR(1, 0) model. A simple better job of reproducing the correlation of sea-
ARMA(1, 1) model is sonal flows beyond lag one (see for example,
Bartolini and Salas 1993).
Zt 1 /1  Zt Vt 1  h1  Vt 6:185

The correlations of this model have the values


6.9 Stochastic Simulation
 
q1 1  h1 /1 /1  h1 = 1 h21  2/1 h1
This section introduces stochastic simulation.
6:186
Much more detail on simulation is contained in
later parts of this chapter and in the next chapter.
for the rst lag. For i > 1
Simulation is the most flexible and widely used
qi /i1 q1 6:187 tool for the analysis of complex water resources
systems. Simulation is trial and error. One must
For / values near one and 0 < 1 < 1 the dene the system being simulated, both its
autocorrelations k can decay much slower than design and operating policy, and then simulate it
those of the standard AR(1) model. to see how it works. If the purpose is to nd the
The correlation function k of general ARMA best design and policy, many such alternatives
(p, q) model must be simulated.
p
X q
X As with optimization models, simulation
Zt 1 /i  Zt 1i Vt 1  hj  Vt 1j models may be deterministic or stochastic. One
i1 j1 of the most useful tools in water resource
6:188 systems planning is stochastic simulation.
While optimization can be used to help dene
is a complex function that must satisfy a number reasonable design and operating policy alter-
of conditions to ensure the resultant model is natives to be simulated, it takes those simula-
stationary and invertible (Box et al. 1994). tions to obtain the best insights of just how
ARMA(p, q) models have been extended to each such alternative will perform. Stochastic
describe seasonal flow series by having their simulation of complex systems on digital
coefcients depend upon the seasonthese are computers provides planners with a way to
called periodic Autoregressive-Moving average dene the probability distribution of perfor-
models, or PARMA. Salas and Obeysekera mance indices of complex stochastic water
(1992), Salas and Fernandez (1993), and Claps resources systems.
et al. (1993) discuss the conceptual basis of such When simulating any system, the modeler
stochastic streamflow models. For example, Salas designs an experiment. Initial flow, storage,
and Obeysekera (1992) found that low-order and water quality conditions must be specied
PARMA models, such as a PARMA(2,1), arise if these are being simulated. For example,
from reasonable conceptual representations of reservoirs can start full, empty, or at random
persistence in rainfall, runoff, and groundwater representative conditions. The modeler also
recharge and release. Claps et al. (1993, p. 2553) determines what data are to be collected on
observe that the PARMA(2, 2) model which may system performance and operation and how
be needed if one wants to preserve year-to-year they are to be summarized. The length of time
correlation poses a parameter estimation challenge the simulation is to be run must be specied
(see also Rasmussen et al. 1996). The PARMA (1, and, in the case of stochastic simulations, the
1) model is more practical and easy to extend to the number of runs to be made must also be
multivariate case (Hirsch 1979; Stedinger et al. determined. These considerations are discussed
1985; Salas 1993; Rasmussen et al. 1996). Expe- in more detail by Fishman (2001) and in other
rience has shown that PARMA(1, 1) models do a books on simulation. The use of stochastic
6.9 Stochastic Simulation 271

simulation and the analysis of the output of Fu u 0 for u  0;


such models are introduced here primarily in
u for 0  u  1 and 1 if u  1
the context of an example to illustrate what
goes into a simulation model and how one can 6:189
deal with the information that is generated.
and
fU u 1 if 0  u  1 and 0 otherwise
6.9.1 Generating Random Variables
6:190
Included in any stochastic simulation model is
These uniform random variables can then be
some provision for the generation of sequences of
transformed into random variables with any
random numbers that represent particular values
desired distribution. If FQ(qt) is the cumulative
of events such as rainfall, streamflows, or floods.
distribution function of a random variable Qt in
To generate a sequence of values for a random
period t, then Qt can be generated using the
variable, probability distributions for the vari-
inverse function, as
ables must be specied. Historical data and an
understanding of the physical processes are used Qt FQ1 Ut  6:191
to select appropriate distributions and to estimate
their parameters (as discussed in Sect. 6.3.2). Here Ut is the uniform random number used
Most computers have algorithms for generat- to generate Qt. This is illustrated in Fig. 6.13.
ing random numbers uniformly distributed Analytical expressions for the inverse of many
between zero and one. This uniform distribution distributions, such as the normal distribution, are
is dened by its cdf and pdf; not known, so that special algorithms are

Fig. 6.13 The probability


distribution of a random
variable can be inverted to
produce values of the
random variable
272 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

employed to efciently generate deviates with points where the farmers withdraw water. The
these distributions (Fishman 2001). dam would be used to increase the quantity and
reliability of irrigation water available to the
farmers during the summer growing season.
6.9.2 River Basin Simulation After preliminary planning, a reservoir with an
active capacity of 4 107 m3 has been proposed
An example will demonstrate the use of for a natural dam site. It is anticipated that because
stochastic simulation in the design and analysis of the increased reliability and availability of irri-
of water resource systems. Assume that farmers gation water, the quantity of water desired will
in a particular valley have been plagued by fre- grow from an initial level of 3 107 m3/yr after
quent shortages of irrigation water. They cur- construction of the dam to 4 107 m3/yr within
rently draw water from an unregulated river to 6 years. After that, demand will grow more
which they have water rights. A government slowly, to 4.5 107 m3/yr, the estimated maxi-
agency has proposed construction of a mum reliable yield. The projected demand for
moderate-size dam on the river upstream from summer irrigation water is shown in Table 6.12.

Table 6.12 Projected water demand for irrigation water


6.9 Stochastic Simulation 273

Table 6.13 Characteristics of the river flow

A simulation study will evaluate how the (summer) in year y are denoted by S1y and S2y.
system can be expected to perform over a The reservoirs winter operating policy is to store
20-year planning period. Table 6.13 contains as much of the winters inflow Q1y as possible.
statistics that describe the hydrology at the dam The winter release R1y is determined by the rule
site. The estimated moments are computed from 8
the 45-year historic record. . < S1y Q1y  K if S1y Q1y  Rmin > K
Using the techniques discussed in the previ- R1y Rmin if K  S1y Q1y  Rmin  0
:
S1y Q1y otherwise
ous section, a Thomas-Fiering model is used to
generate 25 lognormally distributed synthetic 6:192
streamflow sequences. The statistical character-
istics of the synthetic flows are those listed in where K is the reservoir capacity of 4 107 m3
Table 6.14. Use of only the 45-year historic flow and Rmin is 0.50 107 m3, the minimum release
sequence would not allow examination of the to be made if possible. The volume of water in
systems performance over the large range of storage at the beginning of the years summer
streamflow sequences which could occur during season is
the 20-year planning period. Jointly, the syn-
S2y S1y Q1y  R1y 6:193
thetic sequences should be a description of the
range of inflows that the system might experi-
The summer release policy is to meet each
ence. A larger number of sequences could be
years projected demand or target release Dy, if
generated.
possible, so that
R2y S2y Q2y  K if S2y Q2y  Dy [ K
6.9.3 The Simulation Model Dy if 0  S2y Q2y  Dy  K
S2y Q2y otherwise
The simulation model is composed primarily of 6:194
continuity constraints and the proposed operating
policy. The volume of water stored in the reser- This operating policy is illustrated in
voir at the beginning of seasons 1 (winter) and 2 Fig. 6.14.
274 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Fig. 6.14 Summer reservoir operating policy. The shaded area denotes the feasible region of reservoir releases

The volume of water in storage at the begin- The next step is to simulate the proposed
ning of the next winter season is system to evaluate the specied indices. For our
reservoir-irrigation system, the reservoirs oper-
S1;y 1 S2y Q2y  R2y 6:195 ation was simulated 25 times using the 25 syn-
thetic streamflow sequences, each 20 years in
length. Each of the 20 simulated years consisted
6.9.4 Simulation of the Basin of rst a winter and then a summer season. At the
beginning of the rst winter season, the reservoir
The question to be addressed by this simulation was taken to be empty (S1y = 0 for y = 1)
study is how well will the reservoir meet the because construction would just have been
farmers water requirements. Three steps are completed. The target release or demand for
involved in answering this question. First, one water in each year is given in Table 6.12.
must dene the performance criteria or indices to After simulating the system, one must pro-
be used to describe the systems performance. ceed to interpret the resulting information so as
The appropriate indices will, of course, depend to gain an understanding of how the system
on the problem at hand and the specic concerns might perform both with the proposed design
of the users and managers of a water resource and operating policy and with modications in
system. In our reservoir-irrigation system, several either the systems design or its operating pol-
indices will be used relating to the reliability with icy. To see how this may be done, consider the
which target releases are met and the severity of operation of our example reservoir-irrigation
any shortages. system.
6.9 Stochastic Simulation 275

Fig. 6.15 Number of


failures in each year of 25
twenty-year simulations

The reliability py of the target release in year simulation, which equals the number of years the
y is the probability that the target release Dy is target release was not met divided by 20, the
met or exceeded in that year: number of years simulated. At the bottom of
column 2 and the other columns are several
Py PrR2y  Dy  6:196 statistics that summarize the 25 values of the
different performance indices. The sample esti-
The systems reliability is a function of the mates of the mean and variance of each index are
target release Dy, the hydrology of the river, the given as one way of summarizing the distribution
size of the reservoir, and the operating policy of of the observations. Another approach is speci-
the system. In this example, the reliability also cation of the sample median, the approximate
depends on the year in question. Figure 6.15 interquartile range [x(6) x(20)], and/or the range
shows the total number of failures that occurred in [x(1) x(25)] of the observations, where x(i) is the
each year of the 25 simulations. In 3 of the 25 ith largest observation. Either set of statistics
simulations, the reservoir did not contain sufcient could be used to describe the center and spread of
water after the initial winter season to meet the each indexs distribution.
demand the rst summer. After year 1, few failures Suppose that one is interested in the distri-
occur in years 2 through 9 because of the low bution of the systems failure frequency or,
demand. Surprisingly few failures occur in years equivalently, the reliability with which the
10 and 13, when demand has reached its peak; this target can be met. Table 6.14 reports that the
results because the reservoir was normally full at mean failure rate for the 25 simulations is
the beginning of this period as a result of lower 0.084, implying that the average reliability over
demand in the earlier years. Starting in years 14 the 20-year period is 1 0.084 = 0.916 or
and after, failures occurred more frequently 92%. The median failure rate is 0.05, implying
because of the high demand placed on the system. a median reliability of 95%. These are both
Thus one has a sense for how the reliability of the reasonable estimates of the center of the dis-
target releases changes over time. tribution of the failure frequency. Note that the
actual failure frequency ranged from 0 (seven
6.9.5 Interpreting Simulation Output times) to 0.30. Thus the systems reliability
ranged from 100% to as low as 70, 75, and
Table 6.14 contains several summary statistics of 80% in runs 17, 8, and 11. Certainly, the
the 25 simulations. Column 2 of the table con- farmers are interested not only in knowing the
tains the average failure frequency in each mean or median failure frequency but also the
276 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Table 6.14 Results of 25 20-year simulations


6.9 Stochastic Simulation 277

range of failure frequencies they are likely to probability of at least k/(n + 1). For k equal to 20
experience. and 25, the corresponding probabilities are 77
If one knew the form of the distribution and 96%.
function of the failure frequency, one could use Often, the analysis of a simulated systems
the mean and standard deviation of the obser- performance centers on the average value of
vations to determine a condence interval within performance indices, such as the failure rate. It is
which the observations would fall with some important to know the accuracy with which the
prespecied probability. For example, if the mean value of an index approximates the true
observations are normally distributed, there is a mean. This is done by the construction of con-
90% probability that the index falls within the dence intervals. A condence interval is an
interval x 1.65x. Thus, if the simulated interval that will contain the unknown value of a
failure rates are normally distributed, there is parameter with a specied probability. Con-
about a 90% probability the actual failure rate is dence intervals for a mean are constructed using
within the interval x 1.65sx. In our case this the t statistic,
interval would be [0.084 1.65(0.081),
0.084 + 1.65(0.081)] = [0.050, 0.218]. x  lx
t p 6:198
Clearly, the failure rate cannot be less than sx = n
zero, so that this interval makes little sense in our
example. which for large n has approximately a standard
A more reasonable approach to describing the normal distribution. Certainly, n = 25 is not very
distribution of a performance index whose large, but the approximation to a normal distri-
probability distribution function is not known is bution may be sufciently good to obtain a rough
to use the observations themselves. If the estimate of how close the average frequency of
observations are of a continuous random vari- failure x is likely to be to x. A 100(1 2)%
able, the interval [x(i) x(n+1i)] provides a rea- condence interval for x is, approximately,
sonable estimate of an interval within which the
sx sx
random variable falls with probability x  ta p  lx  x ta p
n n
n1  i i n 1  2i
P  6:197 or
n1 n1 n1
 
In our example, the range [x(1) x(25)] of the 0:081 0:081
0:084  ta p  lx  0:084 ta p
25 observations is an estimate of an interval in 25 25
which a continuous random variable falls with 6:199
probability (25 + 1 2)/(25 + 1) = 92%, while
[x(6) x(20)] corresponds to probability If = 0.05, then t = 1.65 and Eq. 6.199
(25 + 1 2 6)/(25 + 1) = 54%. becomes 0.057 x 0.11.
Table 6.14 reports that for the failure fre- Hence, based on the simulation output, one
quency, [x(1) x(25)] equals [0 0.30], while can be about 90% sure that the true mean
[x(6) x(20)] equals [0 0.15]. Reflection on failure frequency lies between 5.7 and 11%.
how the failure frequencies are calculated This corresponds to a reliability between 89
reminds us that the failure frequency can only and 94%. By performing additional simulations
take on the discrete, nonnegative values 0, 1/20, to increase the size of n, the width of this
2/20, , 20/20. Thus, the random variable condence interval can be decreased. However,
X cannot be less than zero. Hence, if the lower this increase in accuracy may be an illusion,
endpoint of an interval is zero, as is the case here, because the uncertainty in the parameters of the
then [0 x(k)] is an estimate of an interval within streamflow model has not been incorporated
which the random variable falls with a into the analysis.
278 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Failure frequency or system reliability knows that half the time the total shortage was
describes only one dimension of the systems greater and half the time less than this value.
performance. Table 6.14 contains additional The mean average decit AD  is 0.106, or
information on the systems performance related 11%. However, this mean includes an average
to the severity of shortages. Column 3 lists the decit of zero in the seven runs in which no
frequencies with which the shortage exceeded shortages occurred. The average decit in the
20% of that years demand. This occurred in 18 years in which shortages occurred is (11%)
approximately 2% of the years, or in 24% of the (25/18) = 15%. The average decit in individual
years in which a failure occurred. Taking another simulations in which shortages occurred ranges
point of view, failures in excess of 20% of from 4 to 43%, with a median of 11.5%.
demand occurred in 9 out of 25, or in 36% of the After examining the results reported in
simulation runs Table 6.14, the farmers might determine that the
Columns 4 and 5 of Table 6.14 contain two probability of a shortage exceeding 20% of a
other indices that pertain to the severity of the years target release is higher than they would
failures. The total shortfall in Column 4 is cal- like. They can deal with more frequent minor
culated as shortages, not exceeding 20% of the target, with
little economic hardship, particularly if they are
20 
X  warned at the beginning of the growing season
TS  D2y  R2y
y1
that less than the targeted quantity of water will
be delivered. Then they can curtail their planting
where or plant crops requiring less water.
 In an attempt to nd out how better to meet
Q if Q [ 0 the farmers needs, the simulation program was
Q 6:200
0 otherwise rerun with the same streamflow sequences and a
new operating policy in which only 80% of the
The total shortfall equals the total amount by growing seasons target release is provided (if
which the target release is not met in years in possible) if the reservoir is less than 80% full at
which shortages occur. the end of the previous winter season. This gives
Related to the total shortfall is the average the farmers time to adjust their planting sched-
decit. The decit is dened as the shortfall in ules and may increase the quantity of water
any year divided by the target release in that year. stored in the reservoir to be used the following
The average decit is year if the drought persists.
20
  As the simulation results with the new policy
1X D2y  R2y in Table 6.15 demonstrate, this new operating
AD 6:201
m y1 D2y policy appears to have the expected effect on the
systems operation. With the new policy, only six
where m is the number of failures (decits) or severe shortages in excess of 20% of demand
nonzero terms in the sum. occur in the 25 twenty-year simulations, as
Both the total shortfall and the average decit opposed to 10 such shortages with the original
measure the severity of shortages. The mean total policy. In addition, these severe shortages are all
shortfall TS, equal to 1.00 for the 25 simulation less severe than the corresponding shortages that
runs, is a difcult number to interpret. While no occur with the same streamflow sequence when
shortage occurred in seven runs, the total short- the original policy is followed.
age was 4.7 in run 8, in which the shortfall in two The decrease in the severity of shortages is
different years exceeded 20% of the target. The obtained at a price. The overall failure frequency
median of the total shortage values, equal to has increased from 8.4 to 14.2%. However, the
0.76, is an easier number to interpret in that one latter gure is misleading because in 14 of the 25
6.9 Stochastic Simulation 279

Table 6.15 Results of 25 20-Year simulations with modied operating policy to avoid severe shortages
280 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

simulations, a failure occurs in the rst simula- the new policy has increased the failure
tion year with the new policy, whereas only three frequency.
failures occur with the original policy. Of course, A similar analysis can be made of the fre-
these rst-year failures occur because the reser- quency with which the release is less than 80% of
voir starts empty at the beginning of the rst the target. Failure frequencies differ in the two
winter and often does not ll that season. policies in only four of the 25 simulation runs.
Ignoring these rst-year failures, the failure However, in all 4 cases where they differ, the
rates with the two policies over the subsequent new policy resulted in fewer severe failures. The
19 years are 8.2 and 12.0%. Thus the frequency probability of such a lopsided result, were it
of failures in excess of 20% of demand is equally likely that either policy would result in a
decreased from 2.0 to 1.2% by increasing the lower frequency of failures in excess of 20% of
frequency of all failures after the rst year from the target, is 24 = 0.0625. This is fairly strong
8.2 to 12.0%. Reliability increases while vul- evidence that the new policy indeed decreases
nerability decreases. If the farmers are willing to the frequency of severe failures.
put up with more frequent minor shortages, it Another approach to this problem is to ask if
appears they can reduce their risk of experiencing the difference between the average failure rates
shortages of greater severity. x1 and x2 is statistically signicant; that is, can
The preceding discussion has ignored the the difference between x1 and x2 be attributed
statistical issue of whether the differences to the fluctuations that occur in the average of
between the indices obtained in the two simula- any nite set of random variables? In this
tion experiments are of sufcient statistical reli- example, the signicance of the difference
ability to support the analysis. If care is not between the two means can be tested using the
taken, observed changes in a performance index random variable Yi dened as X1i X2i for
from one simulation experiment to another may i equal 1 through 25. The mean of the observed
be due to sampling fluctuations rather than to yis is
modications of the water resource systems 25
1 X
design or operating policy. y x1i  x2i x1  x2
As an example, consider the change that 25 i1
occurred in the frequency of shortages. Let X1i 0:084  0:142 0:058 6:202
and X2i be the simulated failure rates using the ith
streamflow sequence with the original and and their variance is
modied operating policies. The random vari-
25
ables Yi = X1i X2i for i equal 1 through 25 are 1 X
s2y x1i  x2i  y2 0:04002
independent of each other if the streamflow 25 i1
sequences are generated independently, as they 6:203
were.
One would like to conrm that the random Now if the sample size n, equal to 25 here, is
variable Y tends to be negative more often than it sufciently large, then t dened by
is positive and hence that policy 2 indeed results
in more failures overall. A direct test of this y  lY
t p 6:204
theory is provided by the sign test. Of the 25 sY = n
paired simulation runs, yi < 0 in 21 cases and
yi = 0 in four cases. We can ignore the times has approximately a standard normal distribution.
when yi = 0. Note that if yi < 0 and yi > 0 were The closer the distribution of Y is to that of the
equally likely, then the probability of observing normal distribution, the faster the convergence of
yi < 0 in all 21 cases when yi 0 is 221 or the distribution of t is to the standard normal
5 107. This is exceptionally strong proof that distribution with increasing n. If X1i X2i is
6.9 Stochastic Simulation 281

normally distributed, which is not the case here, than 0.040 (Eq. 6.203). A standard deviation of
then each Yi has a normal distribution and t has 0.119 yields a value of the test statistic
Students t-distribution.
If E[x1i] = E[x2i], then Y equals zero and y  lY 
t p lY0 2:44 6:208
upon substituting the observed values of y and s2Y 0:119= 25
into Eq. 6.204, one obtains
If t is normally distributed, the probability of
0:0580 observing a value less than 2.44 is about 0.8%.
t p 7:25 6:205 This illustrates that use of the same streamflow
0:0400= 25
sequences in the simulation of both policies
The probability of observing a value of t equal allows one to better distinguish the differences in
to 7.25 or smaller is less than 0.1% if n is the policies performance. Using the same
sufciently large that t is normally distributed. streamflow sequences, or other random inputs,
Hence it appears very improbable that Y equals one can construct a simulation experiment in
zero. which variations in performance caused by dif-
This example provides an illustration of the ferent random inputs are confused as little as
advantage of using the same streamflow possible with the differences in performance
sequences when simulating both policies. Sup- caused by changes in the systems design or
pose that different streamflow sequences were operating policy.
used in all the simulations. Then the expected
value of Y would not change, but its variance
would be given by 6.10 Conclusions

VarY EX1  X2  l1  l2 2 This chapter has introduced some approaches


EX1  l1 2  2EX1  l1 X2  l2  analysts can consider and use when working with
EX2  l2 2  the randomness or uncertainty of their data. Most
of the data water resource systems analysts use is
r2x1  2 CovX1 ; X2 r2X2
uncertain. This uncertainty comes from not
6:206 understanding as well as we would like how our
water resource systems (including its ecosys-
where Cov(X1, X2) = E[(X1 1)(X2 2)] and tems) function as well as not being able to
is the covariance of the two random variables. forecast, perfectly, the future. It is that simple.
The covariance between X1 and X2 will be zero if We do not know the exact amounts, qualities,
they are independently distributed as they would and their distributions over space and time of
be if different randomly generated streamflow both the supplies of water we manage and the
sequences were used in each simulation. Esti- water demands we try to meet. We also do not
mating r2x1 and r2x2 by their sample estimates, an know the benets and costs, however measured,
estimate of what the variance of Y would be if of any actions we take to manage both water
Cov(X1, X2) were zero is supply and water demand.
The chapter began with an introduction to
^2Y s2x1 s2x2 0:0812 0:0872 0:1192
r some probability concepts and methods for
6:207 describing random variables and parameters of
their distributions. It then reviewed some of the
The actual sample estimate sY equals 0.040; if commonly used probability distributions and
independent streamflow sequences are used in all how to determine the distributions of sample
simulations, sY will take a value near 0.119 rather data, how to work with censored and partial
282 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

duration series data, methods of regionalization, Bates, B. C., & Campbell, E. P. (2001). A Markov chain
stochastic processes and time series analyses. Monte Carlo scheme for parameter estimation and
inference in conceptual rainfall-runoff modeling.
The chapter concluded with an introduction to Water Resources Research, 37(4), 937947.
a range of univariate and multivariate stochastic Beard, L. R. (1960). Probability estimates based on small
models that are used to generate stochastic normal-distribution samples. Journal of Geophysical
streamflow, precipitation depths, temperatures, Research, 65(7), 21432148.
Beard, L. R. (1997). Estimating flood frequency and
and evaporation. These methods have been average annual damages. Journal of Water Resources
widely used to generate temporal and spatial Planning and Management, 123(2), 8488.
stochastic process that serve as inputs to Benjamin, J. R., & Cornell, C. A. (1970). Probability,
stochastic simulation models for system design, statistics and decisions for civil engineers. New York:
McGraw-Hill Book Company.
for system operations studies, and for the eval- Bickel, P. J., & Doksum, K. A. (1977). Mathematical
uation of the reliability and precision of different statistics: Basic ideas and selected topics. San Fran-
estimation algorithms. The nal section of this cisco: Holden-Day Inc.
chapter provides an example of stochastic simu- Bobe, B. (1975). The log Pearson Type 3 distribution
and its applications in hydrology. Water Resources
lation, and the use of statistical methods to Research, 14(2), 365369.
summarize the results of such simulations. Bobe, B., & Ashkar, F. (1991). The gamma distribution
This chapter is merely an introduction to some and derived distributions applied in hydrology. Lit-
of the tools available for use when dealing with tleton, CO: Water Resources Press.
Bobe, B., & Robitaille, R. (1977). The use of the Pearson
uncertain data. Many of the concepts introduced Type 3 distribution and Log Pearson Type 3 distribution
in this chapter will be used in the chapters that revisited. Water Resources Research, 13(2), 427443.
follow on constructing and implementing various Box, G. E. P., Jenkins, G. M., & Risinsel, G. C. (1994).
Times series analysis: Forecasting and control (3rd
types of optimization, simulation, and statistical
ed.). New Jersey: Prentice-Hall Inc.
models. The references provided in the next Camacho, F., McLeod, A. I., & Hipel, K. W. (1985).
section provide additional and more detailed Contemporaneous autoregressive-moving average
information. (CARMA) modeling in water resources. Water
Resources Bulletin, 21(4), 709720.
Although many of the methods presented in
Carlin, B. P., & Louis, T. A. (2000). Bayes and empirical
this and the following two chapters can describe bayes methods for data analysis (2nd ed.). New York,
many of the characteristics and consequences of NY: Chapman and Hall, CRC.
uncertainty, it is unclear as to whether or not Chowdhury, J. U., & Stedinger, J. R. (1991). Condence
intervals for design floods with estimated skew
society knows exactly what to do with that
coefcient. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering, 117
information. Nevertheless there seems to be an (7), 811831.
increasing demand from stakeholders involved in Chowdhury, J. U., Stedinger, J. R., & Lu, L.-H. (1991).
planning processes for information related to the Goodness-of-t tests for regional GEV flood distribu-
tions. Water Resources Research, 27(7), 17651776.
uncertainty associated with the impacts predicted
Claps, P., Rossi, F., & Vitale, C. (1993).
by models. The challenge is not only to quantify Conceptual-stochastic modeling of seasonal runoff
that uncertainty, but also to communicate it in using autoregressive moving average models and
effective ways that inform, and not confuse, the different scales of aggregation. Water Resources
Research, 29(8), 25452559.
decision-making process.
Cohn, C. A., Lane, W. L., & Stedinger, J. R. (2001).
Condence intervals for EMA flood quantile esti-
mates. Water Resources Research, 37(6), 16951706.
References Cohn, T. A., Lane, W. L., & Baier, W. G. (1997). An
algorithm for computing moments-based flood quantile
estimates when historical flood information is available.
Ayyub, B. M., & McCuen, R. H. (2002). Probability, Water Resources Research, 33(9), 20892096.
statistics, and reliability for engineers and scientists. Crainiceanu, C. M., Ruppert, D., Stedinger, J. R., & Behr,
Boca Raton: Chapman & Hill, CRC Press. C. T. (2002). Improving MCMC mixing for a GLMM
Bartolini, P., & Salas, J. (1993). Modeling of streamflow describing pathogen concentrations in water supplies,
processes at different time scales. Water Resources in case studies in Bayesian analysis. New York:
Research, 29(8), 25732587. Springer.
References 283

DAgostino, R. B., & Stephens, M. A. (1986). Gupta, V. K., Mesa, O. J., & Dawdy, D. R. (1994).
Goodness-of-t procedures (p. 560). New York: Multiscaling theory of flood peaks: Regional quantile
Marcel Dekker Inc. analysis. Water Resources Research, 30(12), 3405
David, H. A. (1981). Order statistics (2nd ed.). New 3412.
York: Wiley. Haan, C. T. (1977). Statistical methods in hydrology.
Fiering, M. B. (1967). Streamflow synthesis. Cambridge, Ames, Iowa: Iowa State University Press.
Mass: Harvard University Press. Haas, C. N., & Scheff, P. A. (1990). Estimation of
Fill, H., & Stedinger, J. (1995). L-moment and PPCC averages in truncated samples. Environmental Science
goodness-of-t tests for the Gumbel distribution and and Technology, 24(6), 912919.
effect of autocorrelation. Water Resources Research, Helsel, D. R. (1990). Less than obvious: Statistical
31(1), 225229. treatment of data below the detection limit. Environ-
Fill, H., & Stedinger, J. (1998). Using regional regression mental Science and Technology, 24(12), 17671774.
within index flood procedures and an empirical Helsel, D. R., & Cohn, T. A. (1988). Estimation of
Bayesian estimator. Journal of Hydrology, 210(14), descriptive statistics for multiple censored water
128145. quality data. Water Resources Research, 24(12),
Filliben, J. J. (1975). The probability plot correlation test 19972004.
for normality. Technometrics, 17(1), 111117. Hirsch, R. M. (1979). Synthetic hydrology and water
Fishman, G. S. (2001). Discrete-event simulation: Model- supply reliability. Water Resources Research, 15(6),
ing, programming, and analysis. Berlin: Springer. 16031615.
Gabriele, S., & Arnell, N. (1991). A hierarchical approach Hirsch, R. M., & Stedinger, J. R. (1987). Plotting
to regional flood frequency analysis. Water Resources positions for historical floods and their precision.
Research, 27(6), 12811289. Water Resources Research, 23(4), 715727.
Gelman, A., Carlin, J. B., Stern, H. S., & Rubin, D. B. Hoshi, K., Burges, S. J., & Yamaoka, I. (1978). Reservoir
(1995). Bayesian data analysis. Boca Raton: Chap- design capacities for various seasonal operational
man & Hall, CRC. hydrology models. In Proceedings of the Japanese
Giesbrecht, F., & Kempthorne, O. (1976). Maximum Society of Civil Engineers (No. 273, pp. 121134).
likelihood estimation in the three-parameter log nor- Hoshi, K., Stedinger, J. R., & Burges, S. (1984).
mal distribution. Journal of the Royal Statistical Estimation of log normal quantiles: Monte Carlo
Society B, 38(3), 257264. results and rst-order approximations. Journal of
Gilks, W. R., Richardson, S., & Spiegelhalter, D. Hydrology, 71(1/2), 130.
J. (Eds.). (1996). Markov chain Monte Carlo in Hosking, J. R. M. (1990). L-Moments: Analysis and
practice. London, New York: Chapman & Hall. estimation of distributions using linear combinations
Greenwood, J. A., & Durand, D. (1960). Aids for tting of order statistics. Journal of Royal Statistical Society,
the gamma distribution by maximum likelihood. B, 52(2), 105124.
Technometrics, 2(1), 5565. Hosking, J. R. M., & Wallis, J. R. (1987). Parameter and
Grifs, V. W., & Stedinger, J. R. (2007a). The LP3 quantile estimation for the generalized Pareto distri-
distribution and its application in flood frequency bution. Technometrics, 29(3), 339349.
analysis, 1. Distribution characteristics. Journal of Hosking, J. R. M., & Wallis, J. R. (1995). A comparison
Hydraulic Engineering, 12(5), 482491. of unbiased and plotting-position estimators of
Grifs, V. W., & Stedinger, J. R. (2007b). The LP3 L-moments. Water Resources Research, 31(8),
distribution and its application in flood frequency 20192025.
analysis, 2. Parameter estimation methods. Journal of Hosking, J. R. M., & Wallis, J. R. (1997). Regional
Hydraulic Engineering, 12(5), 492500. frequency analysis: An approach based on
Grygier, J. C., & Stedinger, J. R. (1988). Condensed L-moments. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
disaggregation procedures and conservation correc- Hosking, J. R. M., Wallis, J. R., & Wood, E. F. (1985).
tions. Water Resources Research, 24(10), 15741584. Estimation of the generalized extreme-value distribu-
Grygier, J. C., & Stedinger, J. R. (1991). SPIGOT: A tion by the method of probability weighted moments.
synthetic flow generation software package, users Technometrics, 27(3), 251261.
manual and technical description, Version 2.6. IACWD (Interagency Advisory Committee on Water
Ithaca, NY: School of Civil and Environmental Data). (1982). Guidelines for determining flood flow
Engineering, Cornell University. frequency. Reston Virginia: Bulletin 17B, U.S.
Gumbel, E. J. (1958). Statistics of extremes (p. 375). New Department of the Interior, U.S. Geological Survey,
York: Columbia University Press. Ofce of Water Data Coordination.
Gupta, V. K., & Dawdy, D. R. (1995a). Physical Jenkins, G. M., & Watts, D. G. (1968). Spectral analysis
interpretation of regional variations in the scaling and its applications. San Francisco: Holden-Day, Inc.
exponents of flood quantiles. Hydrological Processes, Kendall, M. G., & Stuart, A. (1966). The advanced theory
9(3/4), 347361. of statistics (Vol. 3). New York: Hafner Publishing
Gupta, V. K., & Dawdy, D. R. (1995b). Multiscaling and Co., Inc.
skew separation in regional floods. Water Resources Kirby, W. (1972). Computer oriented wilson-hilferty
Research, 31(11), 27612776. transformation that preserves the rst 3 moments and
284 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

lower bound of the Pearson type 3 distribution. Water modeling extreme hydrologic events 1. At-site mod-
Resources Research, 8(5), 12511254. eling. Water Resources Research, 33(4), 747758.
Kirby, W. (1974). Algebraic boundness of sample Madsen, H., Pearson, C. P., & Rosbjerg, D. (1997b).
statistics. Water Resources Research, 10(2), 220222. Comparison of annual maximum series and partial
Kite, G. W. (1988). Frequency and risk analysis in duration series methods for modeling extreme hydro-
hydrology. Littleton, CO: Water Resources logic events 2. Regional modeling. Water Resources
Publications. Research, 33(4), 759770.
Kottegoda, M., & Rosso, R. (1997). Statistics, probabil- Madsen, H., & Rosbjerg, D. (1997a). The partial duration
ity, and reliability for civil and environmental engi- series method in regional index flood modeling. Water
neers. New York: McGraw-Hill. Resources Research, 33(4), 737746.
Koutsoyiannis, D., & Manetas, A. (1996). Simple disag- Madsen, H., & Rosbjerg, D. (1997b). Generalized least
gregation by accurate adjusting procedures. Water squares and empirical bayesian estimation in regional
Resources Research, 32(7), 21052117. partial duration series index-flood modeling. Water
Kroll, K., & Stedinger, J. R. (1996). Estimation of Resources Research, 33(4), 771782.
moments and quantiles with censored data. Water Maheepala, S., & Perera, B. J. C. (1996). Monthly
Resources Research, 32(4), 10051012. hydrologic data generation by disaggregation. Journal
Kuczera, G. (1982). Combining site-specic and regional of Hydrology, 178, 277291.
information, an empirical Bayesian approach. Water Marco, J. B., Harboe, R., & Salas, J. D. (Eds.). (1989).
Resources Research, 18(2), 306314. Stochastic hydrology and its use in water resources
Kuczera, G. (1983). Effects of sampling uncertainty and systems simulation and optimization. Dordrecht:
spatial correlation on an empirical bayes procedure for NATO ASI Series, Kluweer Academic Publishers.
combining site and regional information. The Journal Martins, E. S., & Stedinger, J. R. (2000). Generalized
of Hydrology, 65(4), 373398. maximum likelihood GEV quantile estimators for
Kuczera, G. (1999). Comprehensive at-site flood fre- hydrologic data. Water Resources Research, 36(3),
quency analysis using Monte Carlo Bayesian infer- 737744.
ence. Water Resources Research, 35(5), 15511557. Martins, E. S., & Stedinger, J. R. (2001a). Generalized
Landwehr, J. M., Matalas, N. C., & Wallis, J. R. (1978). maximum likelihood Pareto-Poisson flood risk analy-
Some comparisons of flood statistics in real and log sis for partial duration series. Water Resources
space. Water Resources Research, 14(5), 902920. Research, 37(10), 25592567.
Landwehr, J. M., Matalas, N. C., & Wallis, J. R. (1979). Martins, E. S., & Stedinger, J. R. (2001b). Historical
Probability weighted moments compared with some information in a GMLE-GEV framework with partial
traditional techniques in estimating Gumbel parame- duration and annual maximum series. Water
ters and quantiles. Water Resources Research, 15(5), Resources Research, 37(10), 25512557.
10551064. Matalas, N. C. (1967). Mathematical assessment of
Lane, W. (1979). Applied stochastic techniques (users synthetic hydrology. Water Resources Research, 3
manual), Bureau of reclamation. Denver, Colorado: (4), 937945.
Engineering and Research Center, December. Matalas, N. C., & Wallis, J. R. (1973). Eureka! It ts a
Langbein, W. B. (1949). Annual floods and the partial Pearson Type 3 distribution. Water Resources
duration flood series, EOS. Transactions of AGU, 30 Research, 9(3), 281289.
(6), 879881. Matalas, N. C., & Wallis, J. R. (1976). Generation of
Ledolter, J. (1978). The analysis of multivariate time synthetic flow sequences. In A. K. Biswas (Ed.),
series applied to problems in hydrology. Journal of Systems approach to water management. New York:
Hydrology, 36(34), 327352. McGraw-Hill Book Company.
Lettenmaier, D. P., & Burges, S. J. (1977a). Operational Mejia, J. M., & Rousselle, J. (1976). Disaggregation
assessment of hydrologic models of long-term persis- models in hydrology revisited. Water Resources
tence. Water Resources Research, 13(1), 113124. Research, 12(2), 185186.
Lettenmaier, D. P., & Burges, S. J. (1977b). An NERC (Natural Environmental Research Council).
operational approach to preserving skew in hydrologic (1975). Flood studies report. Hydrological studies
models of long-term persistence. Water Resources (Vol. I, 550 pp). London, England.
Research, 13(2), 281290. North, M. (1980). Time-dependent stochastic model of
Lettenmaier, D. P., Wallis, J. R., & Wood, E. F. (1987). floods. Journal of the Hydraulics Division, ASCE, 106
Effect of regional heterogeneity on flood frequency (HY5), 649665.
estimation. Water Resources Research, 23(2), 313 OConnell, D. R. H., Ostenaa, D. A., Levish, D. R., &
324. Klinger, R. E. (2002). Bayesian flood frequency
MacBertouex, P., & Brown, L. C. (2002). Statistics for analysis with paleohydrologic bound data. Water
environmental engineers (2nd ed.). Boca Raton, Resources Research, 38(5), 161 to 164.
Florida: Lewis Publishers, CRC Press. OConnell, P. E. (1977). ARMA models in synthetic
Madsen, H., Pearson, C. P., Rasmussen, P. F., & hydrology. In T. A. Ciriani, V. Maione, & J. R. Wallis
Rosbjerg, D. (1997a). Comparison of annual maxi- (Eds.), Mathematical models for surface water hydrol-
mum series and partial duration series methods for ogy. New York: Wiley.
References 285

Pishro-Nik, H. (2014). Introduction to probability, statis- Slack, J. R., Wallis, J. R., & Matalas, N. C. (1975). On the
tics, and random processes. Kappa Research. LLC value of information in flood frequency analysis.
ISBN/ASIN: 0990637204, ISBN-13: 9780990637202, Water Resources Research, 11(5), 629648.
744 pp. www.probabilitycourse.com Smith, R. L. (1984). Threshold methods for sample
Press, W. H., Flannery, B. P., Teukolsky, S. A., & extremes. In J. Tiago de Oliveira (Ed.), Statistical
Vetterling, W. T. (1986). Numerical recipes, the art of extremes and applications (pp. 621638). Dordrecht,
scientic computing. Cambridge: Cambridge Univer- Holland: D. Reidel Publishing Company.
sity Press. Stedinger, J. R. (1980). Fitting log normal distributions to
Raiffa, H., & Schlaifer, R. (1961). Applied statistical hydrologic data. Water Resources Research, 16(3),
decision theory. Cambridge, Mass: MIT Press. 481490.
Rasmussen, P. F., & Rosbjerg, D. (1989). Risk estimation Stedinger, J. R. (1981). Estimating correlations in mul-
in partial duration series. Water Resources Research, tivariate streamflow models. Water Resources
25(11), 23192330. Research, 17(1), 200208.
Rasmussen, P. F., & Rosbjerg, D. (1991a). Evaluation of Stedinger, J. R. (1983). Estimating a regional flood
risk concepts in partial duration series. Stochastic frequency distribution. Water Resources Research, 19
Hydrology and Hydraulics, 5(1), 116. (2), 503510.
Rasmussen, P. F., & Rosbjerg, D. (1991b). Prediction Stedinger, J. R. (1997). Expected probability and annual
uncertainty in seasonal partial duration series. Water damage estimators. Journal of Water Resources
Resources Research, 27(11), 28752883. Planning and Management, 123(2), 12535 [With
Rasmussen, R. F., Salas, J. D., Fagherazzi, L., Rassam, discussion, Leo R. Beard, Journal of Water Resources
J. C., & Bobee, R. (1996). Estimation and validation Planning and Management, 124(6), 365366, 1998].
of contemporaneous PARMA models for streamflow Stedinger, J. R. (2000). Flood frequency analysis and
simulation. Water Resources Research, 32(10), 3151 statistical estimation of flood risk (Chapter 12). In E.
3160. E. Wohl (Ed.), Inland flood hazards: Human, Ripar-
Robinson, J. S., & Sivapalan, M. (1997). Temporal scales ian and aquatic communities. Stanford, United King-
and hydrologic regimes: Implications for flood fre- dom: Cambridge University Press.
quency scaling. Water Resources Research, 33(12), Stedinger, J. R., & Baker, V. R. (1987). Surface water
29812999. hydrology: Historical and paleoflood information.
Rosbjerg, D. (1985). Estimation in partial duration series Reviews of Geophysics, 25(2), 119124.
with independent and dependent peak values. Journal Stedinger, J. R., & Cohn, T. A. (1986). Flood frequency
of Hydrology, 76, 183195. analysis with historical and paleoflood information.
Rosbjerg, D., & Madsen, H. (1998). In H. Wheater & C. Water Resources Research, 22(5), 785793.
Kirby (Eds.), Design with uncertain design values, Stedinger, J. R., & Lu, L. (1995). Appraisal of regional
hydrology in a changing environment (Vol. III, and index flood quantile estimators. Stochastic
pp. 155163). New York: Wiley. Hydrology and Hydraulics, 9(1), 4975.
Rosbjerg, D., Madsen, H., & Rasmussen, P. F. (1992). Stedinger, J. R., Pei, D., & Cohn, T. A. (1985).
Prediction in partial duration series with generalized A disaggregation model for incorporating parameter
Pareto-distributed exceedances. Water Resources uncertainty into monthly reservoir simulations. Water
Research, 28(11), 30013010. Resources Research, 21(5), 665667.
Salas, J. D. (1993). Analysis and modeling of hydrologic Stedinger, J. R., & Taylor, M. R. (1982a). Synthetic
time series (Chapter 17). In D. Maidment (Ed.), streamflow generation, part I. Model verication and
Handbook of hydrology. New York: McGraw-Hill validation. Water Resources Research, 18(4), 919
Book Company. 924.
Salas, J. D., Delleur, J. W., Yejevich, V., & Lane, W. L. Stedinger, J. R., & Taylor, M. R. (1982b). Synthetic
(1980). Applied modeling of hydrologic time series. streamflow generation, part II. Effect of parameter
Littleton, Colorado: Water Resources Press uncertainty. Water Resources Research, 18(4), 919
Publications. 924.
Salas, J. D., & Fernandez, B. (1993). Models for data Stedinger, J. R., & Vogel, R. (1984). Disaggregation
generation in hydrology: Univariate techniques. procedures for the generation of serially correlated flow
In J. B. Marco, R. Harboe, & J. D. Salas (Eds.), vectors. Water Resources Research, 20(1), 4756.
Stochastic hydrology and its use in water resources Stedinger, J. R., Vogel, R. M., & Foufoula-Georgiou, E.
systems simulation and optimization (pp. 7695). (1993). Frequency analysis of extreme events (Chapter
Dordrecht: Kluwer Academic Publishers. 18). In D. Maidment (Ed.), Handbook of hydrology.
Salas, J. D., & Obeysekera, J. T. B. (1992). Conceptual New York: McGraw-Hill, Inc.
basis of seasonal streamflow time series. Journal of Tao, P. C., & Delleur, J. W. (1976). Multistation,
Hydraulic Engineering, 118(8), 11861194. multiyear synthesis of hydrologic time series by
Schaake, J. C., & Vicens, G. J. (1980). Design length of disaggregation. Water Resources Research, 12(6),
water resource simulation experiments. Journal of 13031311.
Water Resources Planning and Management, 106(1), Tarboton, D. G., Sharma, A., & Lall, U. (1998).
333350. Disaggregation procedures for stochastic hydrology
286 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

based on nonparametric density estimation. Water Wang, Q. (2001). A bayesian joint probability approach
Resources Research, 34(1), 107119. for flood record augmentation. Water Resources
Tasker, G. D., & Stedinger, J. R. (1986). Estimating Research, 37(6), 17071712.
generalized skew with weighted least squares regres- Wang, Q. J. (1997). LH moments for statistical analysis of
sion. Journal of Water Resources Planning and extreme events. Water Resources Research, 33(12),
Management, 112(2), 225237. 28412848.
Thom, H. C. S. (1958). A note on the gamma distribution. Wilk, M. B., & Gnanadesikan, R. (1968). Probability
Monthly Weather Review, 86(4), 117122. plotting methods for the analysis of data. Biometrika,
Thomas, H. A., Jr., & Fiering, M. B. (1962). Mathemat- 55(1), 117.
ical synthesis of streamflow sequences for the analysis Wilks, D. S. (1998). Multisite generalization of a daily
of river basins by simulation. In A. Maass, M. stochastic precipitation generation model. Journal of
M. Hufschmidt, R. Dorfman, H. A. Thomas Jr., S. Hydrology, 210, 178191.
A. Marglin, & G. M. Fair (Eds.), Design of water Wilks, D. S. (2002). Realizations of daily weather in
resources systems. Cambridge, MA: Harvard Univer- forecast seasonal climate. Journal of Hydrometeorol-
sity Press. ogy, 3, 195207.
Thyer, M., & Kuczera, G. (2000). Modeling long-term Young, G. K. (1968). Discussion of mathematical
persistence in hydroclimatic time series using a hidden assessment of synthetic hydrology by N.C. Matalas,
state markov model. Water Resources Research, 36 and Reply. Water Resources Research, 4(3), 681683.
(11), 33013310. Zellner, A. (1971). An introduction to bayesian inference
Valdes, J. R., Rodriguez, I., & Vicens, G. (1977). in econometrics. New York: Wiley.
Bayesian generation of synthetic streaamflows, 2. Zrinji, Z., & Burn, D. H. (1994). Flood frequency analysis
The multivariate case. Water Resources Research, 13 for ungauged sites using a region of influence
(2), 291295. approach. Journal of Hydrology, 13, 121.
Valencia, R., & Schaake, J. C., Jr. (1973). Disaggregation
processes in stochastic hydrology. Water Resources
Research, 9(3), 580585. Additional References
Vicens, G. J., Rodrguez-Iturbe, I., & Schaake, J. C., Jr.
(1975). A bayesian framework for the use of regional (Further Reading)
information in hydrology. Water Resources Research,
11(3), 405414. Claps, P. (1993). Conceptual basis for stochastic models of
Vogel, R. M. (1987). The probability plot correlation monthly streamflows. In J. B. Marco, R. Harboe, &
coefcient test for the normal, lognormal, and gumbel J. D. Salas (Eds.), Stochastic hydrology and its use in
distributional hypotheses. Water Resources Research, water resources systems simulation and optimization
22(4), 587590 (1986; correction, 23(10), 2013). (pp. 229235). Dordrecht: Kluwer Academic Publishers.
Vogel, R. M., & Fennessey, N. M. (1993). L-Moment Kumar, D. N., Lall, U., & Peterson, M. R. (2000).
diagrams should replace product moment diagrams. Multisite disaggregation of monthly to daily stream-
Water Resources Research, 29(6), 17451752. flow. Water Resources Research, 36(7), 18231833.
Vogel, R. M., & Shallcross, A. L. (1996). The moving Pegram, G. G. S. (1989). Why stochastic hydrology?
blocks bootstrap versus parametric time series models. Developments in Water Engineering (Die Siviele
Water Resources Research, 32(6), 18751882. Ingenieur in Suid-Afrika, October 1989).
Vogel, R. M., & Stedinger, J. R. (1988). The value of Young, G. K., & Pisano, W. C. (1968). Operational
stochastic streamflow models in over-year reservoir hydrology using residuals. Journal of the Hydraulics
design applications. Water Resources Research, 24(9), Division, ASCE, 94(HY4), 909923.
14831490.
Vogel, R. W., & McMartin, D. E. (1991). Proability plot
goodness-of-t and skewness estimation procedures
for the Pearson type 3 distribution. Water Resources Exercises
Research, 27(42), 31493158. December.
Wallis, J. R. (1980). Risk and uncertainties in the 6:1 Identify a water resources planning study
evaluation of flood events for the design of hydraulic with which you have some familiarity.
structures. In E. Guggino, G. Rossi, & E. Todini
(Eds.), Piene e Siccita (pp. 336). Catania, Italy: Make a list of the basic information used
Fondazione Politecnica del Mediterraneo. in the study and the methods used trans-
Wallis, J. R., Matalas, N. C., & Slack, J. R. (1974a). Just a form that information into decisions, rec-
moment! Water Resources Research, 10(2), 211219. ommendations, and conclusions.
Wallis, J. R., Matalas, N. C., & Slack, J. R. (1974b). Just
a moment! Appendix, National Technical Information (a) Indicate the major sources of uncer-
Service, PB-231 816.
tainty and possible error in the basic
Exercises 287

information and in the transformation (a) Show that the probability of at least
of that information into decisions, one 100-year flood in a 5-year period
recommendations, and conclusions. is 0.049.
(b) In systems studies, sources of error (b) What is the probability of at least
and uncertainty are sometimes one 100-year flood in a 100-year
grouped into three categories period?
(c) If floods at 1000 different sites occur
1. Uncertainty due to the natural
independently, what is the probability
variability of rainfall, temperature,
of at least one 100-year flood at some
and stream flows which affect a
site in any single year?
systems operation.
2. Uncertainty due to errors made in
6:4 The price to be charged for water by an
the estimation of the models
irrigation district has yet to be deter-
parameters with a limited amount
mined. Currently it appears as if there is
of data.
as 60% probability that the price will be
3. Uncertainty or errors introduced
$10 per unit of water and a 40% proba-
into the analysis because concep-
bility that the price will be $5 per unit.
tual and/or mathematical models
The demand for water is uncertain. The
do not reflect the true nature of the
estimated probabilities of different
relationships being described.
demands given alternative prices are as
Indicate, if applicable, into which category
follows:
each of the sources of error or uncertainty
you have identied falls.
Price/Quantity Prob. of quantity demanded given
6:2 The following matrix displays the joint price
probabilities of different weather conditions 30 55 80 100 120
and of different recreation benet levels
$5 0.00 0.15 0.30 0.35 0.20
obtained from use of a reservoir in a state
park: $10 0.20 0.30 0.40 0.10 0.00

Weather Possible recreation benets


(a) What is the most likely value of future
revenue from water sales?
RB1 RB2 RB3
(b) What are the mean and variance of
Wet 0.10 0.20 0.10 future water sales?
Dry 0.10 0.30 0.20 (c) What is the median value and in-
terquartile range of future water sales?
(a) Compute the probabilities of recre- (d) What price will maximize the revenue
ation levels RB1, RB2, RB3, and of dry from the sale of water?
and wet weather.
(b) Compute the conditional probabilities P 6:5 Plot the following data on possible recre-
(wetRB1), P(RB3dry), and P(RB2wet). ation losses and irrigated agricultural
yields. Show that use of the expected
6:3 In flood protection planning, the 100-year storage level or expected allocation
flood, which is an estimate of the quantile underestimates the expected value of the
x0.99, is often used as the design flow. convex function describing reservoir los-
Assuming that the floods in different years ses while it overestimates the expected
are independently distributed value of the concave function describing
288 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

crop yield. A concave function f(x) has the discount rate is high and the life is rela-
property that f(x) f(x0) + f(xo)(x x0) tively long, the uncertainty may not very
for any x0; prove that use of f(E[X]) will important. However, if the life of a reser-
always overestimate the expected value of voir, or of a wastewater treatment facility,
a concave function f(X) when X is a ran- or any other such project, relatively short,
dom variable. the practice of using the expected life to
calculate present costs or benets may be
Irrigation Crop Probability of misleading.In this problem, assume that a
water yield/Hectare allocation project results in $1000 of net benets at
allocation
the end of each year is expected to last
10 6.5 0.2 between 10 and 30 years. The probability
20 10 0.3 of ending at the end of each year within the
30 12 0.3 range of 1130 is the same. Given a dis-
40 11 0.2 count rate of 10%
Summer Decrease in Probability of
storage level recreation storage level
(a) Compute the present value of net
benets benets NB0, assuming a 20-year
200 5 0.1 project life.
250 2 0.2
(b) Compare this with the expected pre-
sent net benets E[NB0] taking
300 0 0.4
account of uncertainty in the project
350 1 0.2
lifetime.
400 4 0.1 (c) Compute the probability that the
actual present net benets is at least
$1000 less than NB0, the benet esti-
12

Decrease
Yield in
Benefits

10 20 30 40 200 250 300 350 400


Irrigation water allocation Summer Storage Level

6:6 Complications can be added to the eco- mate based on a 20-year life.
nomic evaluation of a project by uncer- (d) What is the chance of getting $1000
tainty concerning the usefulness life of the more than the original estimate NB0?
project. For example, the time at which the
useful life of a reservoir will end due to 6:7 A continuous random variable that could
silting is never known with certainty when describe the proportion of sh or other
the reservoir is being planned. If the animals in different large samples which
Exercises 289

have some distinctive features is the beta Find a value of x0 and y0 for which
distribution whose density is (a > 0, b > 0)
 FYjX y0 jx0 \FY y0
a1 b1
fX x cx 1  x 0x1
6:9 Let X and Y be two continuous indepen-
0 otherwise
dent random variables. Prove that
(a) Directly calculate the value of c and EgXhY EgXEhY
the mean and variance of X for
= = 2. for any two real-valued functions g and
(b) In general, c = ( + )/()(), h. Then show that Cov(X, Y) = 0 if X and
where () is the gamma function Y are independent.
equal to ( 1)! for integer . Using 6:10 A frequent problem is that observations
this information, derive the general (X, Y) are taken on such quantities as
expression for the mean and variance of flow and concentration and then a
X. To obtain a formula which gives the derived quantity g(X, Y) such as mass
values of the integrals of interest, note flux is calculated. Given that one has
that the expression for c must be such estimates of the standard deviations of
that the integral over (0, 1) of the den- the observations X and Y and their cor-
sity function is unity for any and . relation, an estimate of the standard
deviation of g(X, Y) is needed. Using a
6:8 The joint probability density of rainfall at second-order Taylor series expansion for
two places on rainy days could be descri- the mean of g(X, Y) as a function of its
bed by partial derivatives and of the means,

2=x y 13 x; y  0 variances, covariance of the X and
fX;Y x; y Y. Using a rst-order approximation of g
0 otherwise
(X, Y), obtained an estimates of the
Calculate and graph variances of g(X, Y) as a function of its
partial derivatives and the moments of
(a) FXY(x, y), the joint distribution func- X and Y. Note, the covariance of X and
tion of X and Y. Y equals
(b) FY(y), the marginal cumulative distri-
bution function of Y, and fY(y), the EX  lX Y  lY  r2XY
density function of Y.
(c) fY|X(y|x), the conditional density func- 6:11 A study of the behavior of water waves
tion of Y given that X = x, and FY|X(y| impinging upon and reflecting off a
x), the conditional cumulative distri- breakwater located on a sloping beach was
bution function of Y given that conducted in a small tank. The height
X = x (the cumulative distribution (crest-to-trough) of the waves was mea-
function is obtained by integrating the sured a short distance from the wave
density function). generator and at several points along the
Show that beach different distances from the break-
water were measured and their mean and
FYjX yjx 0 [ FY y for y [ 0 standard error recorded.
290 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Location Mean wave Standard error of What are the maximum likelihood esti-
height (cm) mean (cm) mates of and ? Note that
Near wave 3.32 0.06 
generator d 1 x[b
jx  bj
1.9 cm from 4.42 0.09 db 1 x\b
breakwater
1.9 cm from 2.59 0.09 Is there always a unique solution for ?
breakwater 6:14 Derive the equations that one would need
1.9 cm from 3.26 0.06 to solve to obtain maximum likelihood
breakwater estimates of the two parameters and of
the gamma distribution. Note an analytical
At which points were the wave heights expression for d()/d is not available so
signicantly different from the height near that a closed-form expression for maxi-
wave generator assuming that errors were mum likelihood estimate of is not
independent? available. What is the maximum likeli-
Of interest to the experimenter is the ratio of hood estimate of as a function of the
the wave heights near the breakwater to the maximum likelihood estimate of ?
initial wave heights in the deep water. Using 6:15 The log-Pearson Type-III distribution is
the results in Exercise 6.10, estimate the often used to model flood flows. If X has a
standard error of this ratio at the three points log-Pearson Type-III distribution then
assuming that errors made in measuring the
height of waves at the three points and near Y lnX  m
the wave generator are independent. At
which point does the ratio appear to be has a two-parameter gamma distribution
signicantly different from 1.00? where em is the lower bound of X if > 0
Using the results of Exercise 6.10, show and em is the upper bound of X if < 0.
that the ratio of the mean wave heights is The density function of Y can be written
probably a biased estimate of the actual
ratio. Does this bias appear to be bya1
fY ydy expbydby
important? Ca
6:12 Derive Kirbys bound, Eq. 6.45, on the 0\by\ 1
estimate of the coefcient of skewness by
computing the sample estimates of the Calculate the mean and variance of X in
skewness of the most skewed sample it terms of , and m. Note that
would be possible to observe. Derive also
the upper bound (n 1)1/2 for the estimate EX r  EexpY mr 
of the population coefcient of variation mxx exprmEexprY
when all the observations must be
nonnegative. To evaluate the required integrals
6:13 The errors in the predictions of water remember that the constant terms in the
quality models are sometimes described denition of fY(y) ensure that the integral
by the double exponential distribution of this density function must be unity for
whose density is any values of and so long as > 0 and
y > 0. For what values of r and does
a the mean of X fail to exist? How do the
f x expajx  bj
2 values of m, and affect the shape and
 1\x\ 1 scale of the distribution of X?
Exercises 291

6:16 When plotting observations to compare Date Maximum Date Maximum


the empirical and tted distributions of discharge discharge
streamflows, or other variables, it is nec- (m3/s) (m3/s)
essary to assign a cumulative probability 03/26/33 445 03/13/54 750
to each observation. These are called 12/11/33 1410 02/27/55 603
plotting positions. As noted in the text, for 11/17/34 475 04/08/56 880
the ith largest observation Xi, 03/13/36 978 01/03/57 485
12/18/36 461 12/15/58 812
EFX Xi  i=n 1
12/15/37 362 12/23/59 1420
Thus the Weibull plotting position 04/08/39 530 01/16/60 4090
i/(n + 1) is one logical choice. Other 02/04/40 350 01/26/61 376
commonly used plotting positions are the 02/21/41 1100 03/24/62 904
Hazen plotting position (i 3/8)/ 02/25/42 980 01/07/63 4120
(n + 1/4). The plotting position (i 3/8)/
12/20/42 575 12/21/63 1740
(n + 1/4) is a reasonable choice because
02/29/44 694 03/02/65 973
its use provides a good approximation to
the expected value of Xi. In particular for 12/21/44 612 02/23/66 378
standard normal variables 12/24/45 540 10/11/66 827
05/15/47 381 04/01/68 626
EXi  U1 i  3=8=n 1=4 05/11/48 334 02/28/69 3170
05/11/49 670 01/13/70 2790
where () is the cumulative distribution
01/01/50 769 04/04/71 1130
function of a standard normal variable.
12/30/50 1570 01/18/72 437
While much debate centers on the appro-
priate plotting position to use to estimate 01/26/52 512 02/16/73 312
pi = FX(Xi), often people fail to realize 01/20/53 613
how imprecise all such estimates must be.
Noting that
(a) Construct a histogram of the Sebou
in  i  1 flood flow data to see what the flow
Varpi ;
n 12 n 2 distribution looks like.
(b) Calculate the mean, variance, and
contrast the difference between the esti- sample skew. Based on Table 6.3,
mates ^ pi of pi provided by these three does the sample skew appear to be
plotting positions and the standard devia- signicantly different from zero?
tion of pi. Provide a numerical example. (c) Fit a normal distribution to the data
What do you conclude? and use the KolmogorovSmirnov test
6:17 The following data represent a sequence of to determine if the t is adequate.
annual flood flows, the maximum flow Draw a quantile-quantile plot of the
rate observed each year, for the Sebou tted quantiles F1[(i 3/8)/
River at the Azib Soltane gaging station in (n + 1/4)] versus the observed quan-
Morocco. tiles xi and include on the graph the
292 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

KolmogorovSmirnov bounds on Signicance level


each xi, as shown in Figs. 6.2a, b. n 1% 5% 10%
(d) Repeat part (c) using a two-parameter
10 0.876 0.917 0.934
lognormal distribution.
20 0.925 0.950 0.960
(e) Repeat part (c) using a three-parameter
lognormal distribution. The Kol- 30 0.947 0.964 0.970
mogorovSmirnov test is now 40 0.958 0.972 0.977
approximate if applied to loge[Xi ], 50 0.965 0.977 0.981
where is calculated using Eq. 6.81 or 60 0.970 0.980 0.983
some other method of your choice.
(f) Repeat part (c) for two- and three- The probability of observing a value of
parameter versions of the gamma r less than the given value, where the
distribution. Again, the Kolmogorov- observations actually drawn from a
Smirnov test is approximate. normal distribution, equals the specied
(g) A powerful test of normality is pro- probability. Use this test to determine
vided by the correlation test. As whether a normal or two-parameter
described by Filliben (1975), one lognormal distribution provides an
should approximate pi = FX(xi) by adequate model for these flows.
8
< 1  0:51=n i1
^pi i  0:3175=n 0:365 i 2; . . .; n  1 6:18 A small community is considering the
:
0:51=n in immediate expansion of its wastewater
treatment facilities so that the expanded
Then one obtains a test for normality facility can meet the current decit of 0.25
by calculation of the correlation MGD and the anticipated growth in demand
r between the ordered observations Xi over the next 25 years. Future growth is
and mi the median value of the ith expected to result in the need of an addi-
largest observation in a sample of tional 0.75 MGD. The expected demand for
n standard normal random variables capacity as a function of time is
so that  
Demand 0:25MGD G 1  e0:23t
mi U1 ^pi
where t is the time in years and G = 0.75
where (x) is the cumulative distribu- MGD. The initial capital costs and main-
tion function of the standard normal tenance and operating costs related to
distribution. The value of r is then capital are $1.2 106 C0.70 where C is the
Pn plant capacity (MGD). Calculate the
i1 xi   x2 mi  m  2 loss Primary>Loss of economic efciency
r q
Pn P LEE and the misrepresentation of minimal
i1 xi   x2 ni1 mj  m  2
costs (MMC) that would result if a
designer incorrectly assigned G a value of
Some signicance levels for the value 0.563 or 0.938 (25%) when determining
of r are (Filliben 1975) the required capacity of the treatment
Exercises 293

plant. [Note: When evaluating the true is made in estimating or r, what are the
cost of a nonoptimal design which pro- losses of economic efciency (LEE) and
vides insufcient capacity to meet demand the misrepresentation of minimal costs
over a 25-year period, include the cost of (MMC)? When nding the optimal deci-
building a second treatment plant; use an sion with each set of parameters, nd the
interest rate of 7% per year to calculate the time of the second expansion to the
present value of any subsequent expan- nearest year; a computer program that
sions.] In this problem, how important is nds the total present value of costs as a
an error in G compared to an error in the function of the time of the second
elasticity of costs equal to 0.70? expansion t for t = 1, , 50 would be
One MGD, a million gallons per day, is helpful. (A second pipe need not be
equivalent to 0.0438 m3/s. built.)
6:19 A municipal water utility is planning the 6:20 A national planning agency for a small
expansion of their water acquisition sys- country must decide how to develop the
tem over the next 50 years. The demand water resources of a region. Three devel-
for water is expected to grow and is given opment plans have been proposed, which
by are denoted d1, d2, and d3. Their respective
costs are 200f, 100f, and 100f where f is a
D 10t1  0:006t million farths, the national currency. The
national benets which are derived from
where t is the time in years. It is expected the chosen development plan depend, in
that two pipelines will be installed along part, on the international market for the
an acquired right-of-way to bring water to goods and agricultural commodities that
the city from a distant reservoir. One pipe would be produced. Consider three possi-
will be installed immediately and then a ble international market outcomes, m1, m2,
second pipe when the demand just equals and m3. The national benets if develop-
the capacity C in year t is ment plan 1 selected would be, respec-
tively, 400, 290, 250. The national benets
PV a bCc ert
from selection of plan 2 would be 350,
where 160, 120, while the benets from selection
of plan 3 would be 250, 200, 160.
a 29:5
(a) Is any plan inferior or dominated?
b 5:2
(b) If one felt that probabilities could not
c 0:5 be assigned to m1, m2, and m3 but
r 0:07=year wished to avoid poor outcomes, what
would be an appropriate decision
Using a 50-year planning horizon, what is criterion, and why? Which decisions
the capacity of the rst pipe which min- would be selected using this
imizes the total present value of the criterion?
construction of the two pipelines? When (c) If Pr[m1] = 0.50 and Pr[m2] = Pr
is the second pipe built? If a 25% error [m3] = 0.25, how would each of the
294 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

expected net benets and expected Replicate Benets


regret criteria rank the decisions? Policy 1 Policy 2
1 6.27 4.20
6:21 Show that if one has a choice between two
2 3.95 2.58
water management plans yielding benets
X and Y, where X is stochastically smaller 3 4.49 3.87
than Y, then for any reasonable utility 4 5.10 5.70
function, plan Y is preferred to X. 5 5.31 4.02
6:22 A reservoir system was simulated for 6 7.15 6.75
100 years and the average annual benets 7 6.90 4.21
and their variance were found to be 8 6.03 4.13
9 6.35 3.68
B 4:93
10 6.95 7.45
s2B 3:23
11 7.96 6.86

The correlation of annual benets was also Mean, Xi 6.042 1.570


calculated and is: Standard deviation 1.217 4.859
of values, sxi

k rk
0 1.000
1 0.389 (a) Construct a 90% condence limits for
2 0.250 each of the two means X i .
(b) With what condence interval can you
3 0.062
state that Policy 1 produces higher
4 0.079
benets than Policy 2 using the sign
5 0.041 test and using the t-test?
(c) If the corresponding replicate with
(a) Assume that (l) = 0 for l > k, com- each policy were independent, esti-
pute (using Eq. 6.137) the standard mate with what condence one could
error of the calculated average benets have concluded that Policy 1 produces
for k = 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5. Also cal- higher benets with the t-test.
culate the standard error of the calcu-
lated benets, assuming that annual 6:24 Assume that annual streamflow at a gaging
benets may be thought of as a site have been grouped into three cate-
stochastic process with a correlation gories or states. State 1 is 515 m3/s, state
structure B(k) = [B(1)]k. What is the 2 is 1525 m3/s, and state 3 is 2535 m3/s,
effect of the correlation structure and these grouping contain all the flows on
among the observed benets on the records. The following transition proba-
standard error of their average? bilities have been computed from record:
(b) At the 90 and 95% levels, which of the
Pij j
rk are signicantly different from zero,
assuming that B(l) = 0 for l > k? 1 2 3
i 1 0.5 0.3 0.2
6:23 Replicated reservoir simulations using two 2 0.3 0.3 0.4
operating policies produced the following 3 0.1 0.5 0.4
results:
Exercises 295

(a) If the flow for the current year is 6:27 Assume that there exist two possible dis-
between 15 and 25 m3/s, what is the crete flows Qit into a small reservoir in
probability that the annual flow each of two periods t each year having
2 years from now will be in the range probabilities Pit. Find the steady-state
2535 m3/s? operating policy (release as a function of
(b) What is the probability of a dry, an initial reservoir volumes and current peri-
average, and a wet year many years ods inflow) for the reservoir that mini-
from now? mizes the expected sum of squared
deviations from storage and release targets.
6:25 A Markov chain model for the stream- Limit the storage volumes to integer values
flows in two different seasons has the that vary from 3 to 5. Assume a storage
following transition probabilities volume target of 4 and a release target of 2
in each period t. (Assume only integer
Streamflow in Season Streamflow next Season 2 values of all states and decision variables
1
03 36 6 m3/s and that each periods inflow is known at
m3/s m3/s the beginning of the period.) Find the
010 m3/s 0.25 0.50 0.25 annual expected sum of squared deviations
10 m3/s 0.05 0.55 0.40 from the storage and release targets.
Streamflow in Season Streamflow next Season 1
2 Period, t Flows, Qit Probabilities,
010 m3/s 10 m3/s
Pit
03 m3/s 0.70 0.30
i=1 i=2 i=1 i=2
36 m3/s 0.50 0.50
1 1 2 0.17 0.83
2 3 4 0.29 0.71
Calculate the steady-state probabilities of
the flows in each interval in each season.
This is an application of Exercise 6.26
6:26 Can you modify the deterministic discrete
except the flow probabilities are indepen-
DP reservoir operating model to include
dent of the previous flow.
the uncertainty, expressed as Ptij, of the
6:28 Assume that the streamflow Q at a par-
inflows, as in Exercise 6.25?
ticular site has cumulative distribution
(Hints: The operating policy would dene
function FQ(q) = q/(1 + q) for q 0.
the release (or nal storage) in each season
Show how to compute the mean stream-
as a function of not only the initial storage
flow, and the probability that any specied
but also the inflow. If the inflows change,
value of streamflow, q, will be exceeded.
so might the release or nal storage vol-
6:29 Assume that a potential water user can
ume. Hence you need to discretize the
withdraw water from an unregulated
inflows as well as the storage volumes.
stream, and that the probability distribu-
Both storage and inflow are state variables.
tion function FQ() of the available
Assume for this model you can predict
streamflow Q is known. Calculate the
with certainty the inflow in each period at
value of the withdrawal target T that will
the beginning of the period. So, each node
maximize the expected net benets from
of the network represents a known initial
the waters use given the two short-run
storage and inflow value. You cannot
benet functions specied below.
predict with certainty the following peri-
ods flows, only their probabilities. What (a) The benets from streamflow Q when
does the network look like now? the target is T are
296 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

 fact that observations are paired (i.e.,


B0 bT cQ  T Q  T
BQjT simulation j for 11 j 20 in both tables
B0 bT dQ  T Q\T
were obtained with the same streamflow
sequence) to perform the analysis with the
where > > . In this case, the
sign test.
optimal target T* can be expressed as
(b) Use the sign test to demonstrate that the
a function of P* = FQ(T) = Pr{Q
average decit with Policy 1 (Table 6.14)
T}, the probability that the random
is stochastically smaller than with Policy 2
streamflow Q will be less than or
(Table 6.15); use all simulations.
equal to T. Prove that
6:32 The accompanying table provides an
P b  c=d  c: example of the use of non-parametric
statistics for examining the adequacy of
(b) The benets from streamflow Q when synthetic streamflow generators. Here the
the target is T are maximum yield that can be supplied with
a given size reservoir is considered. The
BQjT B0 bT  dQ  T2 following table gives the rank of the
maximum yield obtainable with the his-
toric flows among the set consisting of the

Benefits

Bo

T Flow q
fQ(q)

P* 1-P*

6:30 If a random variable is discrete, what effect historic yield and the maximum yield
does this have on the specied condence achievable with 1000 synthetic sequences
of a condence interval for the median or of 25 different rivers in North America.
any other quantile? Give an example.
6:31 (a) Use Wilcoxon test for unpaired sam- (a) Plot the histogram of the ranks for
ples to test the hypothesis that the distri- reservoir sizes S/Q = 0.85, 1.35,
bution of the total shortage TS in 2.00. (Hint: Use the intervals 0100,
Table 6.14 is stochastically less than the 101200, 201300, etc.) Do the ranks
total shortage TS reported in Table 6.15. look uniformly distributed?
Use only the data from the second 10 Rank of the Maximum Historic Yield
simulations reported in the table. Use the among 1000 Synthetic Yields
Exercises 297

River number Normalized active storage, S/Q 500 and below 501 and above. You
0.35 0.85 1.35 2.00 could then use the binomial distribu-
tion to determine the signicance of
1 47 136 128 235
the results.)
2 296 207 183 156
(c) Use the KolmogrovSmirnov test to
3 402 146 120 84 check if the distribution of the yields
4 367 273 141 191 obtainable with storage S/Q = 1.35 is
5 453 442 413 502 signicantly different from uniform
6 76 92 56 54 FU(u) = u for 0 u 1. How
7 413 365 273 279 important do you feel this result is?
8 274 191 86 51
6:33 Section 7.3 dismisses the bias in 2x for
9 362 121 50 29
correlated Xs as unimportant to its variance.
10 240 190 188 141
11 266 66 60 118 (a) Calculate the approximate bias in 2x
12 35 433 562 738 for the cases corresponding to
13 47 145 647 379
Table 6.10 and determine if this
assertion is justied.
14 570 452 380 359
(b) By numerically evaluating the bias
15 286 392 424 421
and variance of 2x , when n = 25,
16 43 232 112 97 determine if the same result holds if
17 22 102 173 266 x(k) = 0.5(0.9)k, which is the auto-
18 271 172 260 456 correlation function of an ARMA(1,
19 295 162 272 291 1) process sometimes used to describe
20 307 444 532 410 annual streamflow series.
21 7 624 418 332
6:34 Consider the crop irrigation problem in
22 618 811 801 679
Exercise 4.31. For the given prices 30 and
23 1 78 608 778 25 for crop A and B, the demand for each
24 263 902 878 737 crop varies over time. Records of demands
25 82 127 758 910 show for crop A the demand ranges from 0
Source A.I. McLeod and K.W. Hipel, Critical Drought to 10 uniformly. There is an equal proba-
Revisited, Paper presented at the international Symposium bility of that the demand will be any value
on Risk and Reliability in Water Resources, Waterloo,
between 0 and 10. For crop B the demand
Ont., June 2628, 1978
ranges from 5 units to 15 units, and the
(b) Do you think this streamflow genera- most likely demand is 10. At least 5 units
tion model produces streamflows and no more than 15 units of crop B will
which are consistent with the historic be demanded. The demand for crop B can
flows when one uses as a criterion the be dened by a triangular density function,
maximum possible yield? Construct a beginning with 5, having a mean of 10 and
statistical test to support your conclu- an upper limit of 15. Develop and solve a
sion and show that it does support model for nding the maximum expected
your conclusion. (Idea: You might net revenue from both crops, assuming the
want to consider if it is equally likely costs of additional resources are 2/unit of
that the rank of the historical yield is water, 4/unit of land, 8/unit of fertilizer,
298 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

and 5/unit of labor. The cost of borrowed that the flows are adequately modeled
money, i.e., the borrowing interest rate, is by a normal distribution. A lower tri-
8 percent per growing season. How does angular B matrix that satises M = BBT
the solution change if the resource costs may be found by equating the elements
are 1/10th of those specied above? of BBT to those of M as follows:
6:35 In Sect. 6.9.2 generated synthetic stream-
p
flows sequences were used to simulate a M11 b211 ! b11 M11
reservoirs operation. In the example, a M21 M21
M21 b11 b21 ! b21 p
Thomas-Fiering model was used to gen- b11 M11
erate ln(Q1y) and ln(Q2y,) the logarithms of M31 M31
M31 b11 b31 ! b31 p
the flows in the two seasons of each year b11 M11
q
y, so as to preserve the season-to-season M22 b221 b222 ! b222 M22  b221
correlation of the untransformed flows. q
Noting that the annual flow is the sum of M22  M21 2 =M
11
the untransformed seasonal flows Q1y and
Q2y, calculate the correlation of annual
and so forth for M23 and M33. Note
flows produced by this model. The
that bij = 0 for i < j and M must be
required data are given in Table 6.13.
symmetric because BBT is necessarily
(Hint: You need to rst calculate the
symmetric.
covariance of ln(Q1y) and ln(Q1,y+1) and
(b) Determine A and BBT for the Markov
then of Q1y and Q2,y+1).
model which would preserve the
6:36 Part of New York Citys municipal water
variances and cross-covariances of the
supply is drawn from three parallel reser-
flows at each site, but not necessarily
voirs in the upper Delaware River basin.
the lag 1 cross covariances of the
The covariance matrix and lag-1 covari-
flows. Calculate the lag 1 cross-
ance matrix, as dened in Eqs. 6.166 and
covariances of flows generated with
6.168, were estimated based on the
your calculated A matrix.
50-year flow record to be (in m3/s):
(c) Assume that some model has been
2 3 built to generate the total annual flow
20:002 21:436 6:618
6
S0 4 21:436 25:141
7
6:978 5 CovQiy ; Qyj 
into the three reservoirs. Construct and
6:618 6:978 2:505 calculate the parameters of a disag-
2 3
6:487 6:818 1:638 gregation model that, given the total
6 7
S1 4 7:500 7:625 1:815 5 CovQiy 1 ; Qyj  annual inflow to all three reservoirs,
2:593 2:804 0:6753 will generate annual inflows into each
of the reservoirs preserving the vari-
Other statistics of the annual flow are ances and cross-covariances of the
flows. [Hint: The necessary statistics
Site Reservoir Mean Standard r1 of the total flows can be calculated
flow deviation from those of the individual flows.]
1 Pepacton 20.05 4.472 0.3243
2 Cannosville 23.19 5.014 0.3033
6:37 Derive the variance of an ARMA(1, 1)
process in terms of 1, 1, and v2. [Hint:
3 Neversink 7.12 1.583 0.2696
Multiply both sides of the equation to
obtain a second. Be careful to remember
(a) Using these data, determine the values which Vts are independent of which Zts.]
of the A and B matrices of the lag 1 6:38 The accompanying table presents a
model dened by Eq. 6.165. Assume 60-year flow record for the normalized
Exercises 299

flows of the Gota River near Sjotop- (d) Using the estimated model in (c),
Vannersburg in Sweden. generate a 50-year synthetic stream-
flow record and demonstrate that the
(a) Fit an autoregressive Markov model to
mean, variance, and show that rst
the annual flow record.
autocorrelations of the synthetic flows
(b) Using your model, generate a 50-year
deviate from the modeled values by no
synthetic flow record. Demonstrate the
more than would be expected as a
mean, variance, and correlation of your
result of sampling error.
generated flows deviate from the spec-
ied values no more than would be
6:39 (a) Assume that one wanted to preserve
expected as a result of sampling error.
the covariance matrices S0 and S1 of
(c) Calculate the autocorrelations and par-
the flows at several site Zy using the
tial autocovariances of the annual flows
multivariate or vector ARMA(0, 1)
for a reasonable number of lags. Calcu-
model
late the standard errors of the calculated
values. Determine reasonable value of Zy 1 AVy  BVy1
p and q for an ARMA(p, q) model of the
flows. Determine the parameter values where Vy contains n independent stan-
for the selected model. dard normal random variables. What is
Annual Flows, Gota River near the relationship between the values of
Sjotop-Vannersburg, Sweden S0 and S1 and the matrices A and B?
1898 1.158 1918 0.948 1938 0.892 (b) Derive estimates of the matrices A, B,
1899 1.267 1919 0.907 1939 1.020
and C of the multivariate AR(2) model
1900 1.013 1920 0.991 1940 0.869
Zy 1 AZy BZy1 CVy
1901 0.935 1921 0.994 1941 0.772
1902 0.662 1922 0.701 1942 0.606 using the covariance matrices S0, S1,
1903 0.950 1923 0.692 1943 0.739 and S2.
1904 1.120 1924 1.086 1944 0.813 6:40 Create a model for the generation of
1905 0.880 1925 1.306 1945 1.173 monthly flows. The generated monthly
1906 0.802 1926 0.895 1946 0.916 flows should have the same marginal
1907 0.856 1927 1.149 1947 0.880
distributions as were tted to the
observed flows of record and should
1908 1.080 1928 1.297 1948 0.601
reproduce (i) the month-to-month corre-
1909 0.959 1929 1.168 1949 0.720
lation of the flows, (ii) the month-to-
1910 1.345 1930 1.218 1950 0.955
season correlation between each monthly
1911 1.153 1931 1.209 1951 1.186
flow and the total flow the previous
1912 0.929 1932 0.974 1952 1.140 season, and (iii) the month-to-year cor-
1913 1.158 1933 0.834 1953 0.992 relation between each monthly flow and
1914 0.957 1934 0.638 1954 1.048 the total 12-month flow in the previous
1915 0.705 1935 0.991 1955 1.123 year. Show how to estimate the models
1916 0.905 1936 1.198 1956 0.774 parameters. How many parameters
1917 1.000 1937 1.091 1957 0.769 does your model have? How are the
Source V.M. Yevdjevich, Fluctuations of Wet and Dry Years, values of the seasonal model? How
Part I, Hydrology Paper No. 1, Colorado State University, do you think this model could be
Fort Collins, Colo., 1963 improved?
300 6 An Introduction to Probability, Statistics, and Uncertainty

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
Modeling Uncertainty
7

Decision-makers are increasingly willing to can be identied and quantied. These models
consider the uncertainty associated with model are called probabilistic or stochastic models.
predictions of the economic, environmental, or Most probabilistic models provide a range of
social impacts associated with possible decisions. possible values for each output variable along
Information on uncertainty does not make with their probabilities. Stochastic models
decision-making easier, but to ignore it is to attempt to model the random processes that occur
ignore reality. Incorporating what is known about over time, and provide alternative time series of
the uncertainty of input parameters and variables outputs along with their probabilities. In other
used in optimization and simulation models can cases sensitivity analyses (solving models under
help in quantifying the uncertainty in the result- different assumptions) can be carried out to
ing model output. This chapter outlines and estimate the impact of any uncertainty on the
illustrates some approaches for doing this. decisions being considered. In some situations
uncertainty may not signicantly impact the
decisions that should be made. In other situations
7.1 Introduction it will. Sensitivity analyses can help guide efforts
needed to reduce that uncertainty. Model sensi-
Water resource planners and managers work in tivity and uncertainty analysis are discussed in
an environment of change and uncertainty. Water more detail in the next chapter.
supplies are always uncertain, if not in the short This chapter is divided into two main sections.
term at least in the long term. Water demands and The rst section introduces a number of
the multiple purposes and objectives water serve approaches to probabilistic optimization and
tend to change over time, and these changes simulation modeling. Probabilistic models will
cannot always be predicted. Many of the be developed and applied to some of the same
parameters of models used to predict the multiple water resources management problems used to
hydrologic, economic, environmental, ecologi- illustrate deterministic modeling in previous
cal, and social impacts are also uncertain. Indeed, chapters. These modeling methods could be, and
models used to predict these impacts are, at least have been, applied to numerous other water
in part, based on many uncertain assumptions. resources planning and management problems as
This uncertainty associated with planning and well. The purpose here, however, is simply to
managing cannot be avoided (WWAP 2012). illustrate some of these commonly used approa-
To the extent that probabilities can be inclu- ches to probabilistic modeling and show how
ded where appropriate in models and their inputs they can be applied to water resources system
at least some of the uncertainty of their outputs design and operating problems.

The Author(s) 2017 301


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_7
302 7 Modeling Uncertainty

7.2 Generating Values from Known Integrating this function over the entire range
Probability Distributions of r, converts the density function to a cumula-
tive distribution function, FR(r*), ranging from 0
As discussed in the previous chapter, variables to 1, as illustrated in Fig. 7.2.
whose values cannot be predicted with certainty
are called random variables. Often inputs to Zr
hydrologic simulation models are observed or fR rdr Prr   R FR r  7:1
synthetically generated values of rainfall or 0
streamflow. Other examples of such random
variables could be evaporation losses, point and Given any value of p* from 0 to 1, one can
nonpoint source wastewater discharges, demands nd its corresponding random variable value r*
for water, spot prices for energy that may impact from the inverse of the cumulative distribution
the amount of hydropower to produce, etc. function.
Random processes are considered stationary if
FR1 p r  7:2
the statistical attributes of the process are not
changing. If there is no serial correlation in the From the distribution shown in Fig. 7.1 it is
spatial or temporal sequence of observed values, obvious that the likelihood of different values of
then such stationary random processes can be the random variable varies; values in the vicinity
characterized by single probability distributions. of r* are much more likely to occur than are
These probability distributions are often based on values at the tails of the distribution. A uniform
past observations of the values of the random distribution is one that looks like a rectangle; any
variable. These past observations or measure- value of the random variable between its lower
ments are used either to dene the probability and upper limits is equally likely. Using Eq. 7.2,
distribution itself or to estimate parameter values together with a series of uniformly distributed
of an assumed type of distribution. (all equally likely) values of p* over the range
Let R be a random variable whose probability from 0 to 1 (i.e., along the vertical axis of
density distribution, fR(r), is as shown in Fig. 7.1. Fig. 7.2), a corresponding series of random
This distribution indicates the probability or variable values, r*, associated with any distri-
likelihood of an observed value of the random bution can be generated. These random variable
variable R being between any two values of r on values will have a cumulative distribution as
the horizontal axis. For example, the probability shown in Fig. 7.2, and hence a density distribu-
of an observed value of R being between 0 and r* tion as shown in Fig. 7.1, regardless of the
is p*, the shaded area to the left of r* in Fig. 7.1. types or shapes of those distributions. The mean
The entire area under a probability density dis- and variance of the distributions will be
tribution, as shown in Fig. 7.1, is 1. maintained.
The mean and variance of continuous distri-
butions are
Z
rfR rdr ER 7:3

Z
rER2 fR rdr VarR 7:4

The mean, variance and serial correlations of


Fig. 7.1 Probability density distribution of a random discrete distributions having possible values
variable R. The probability that r is less than or equal r* is p* denoted by ri with probabilities pi are
7.2 Generating Values from Known Probability Distributions 303

Fig. 7.2 Cumulative


distribution function of a
random variable R showing
the probability of any
observed random value of
R being less than or equal
to a given value r. The
probability of an observed
value of R being less than
or equal to r* is p*

X together with the mean of the distribution, E[R],


ri pi ER 7:5
i
and the correlation coefcient . If there is no
correlation ( is 0), the expected value of Rt+1 is
X the mean of the population, E[R]. If there is
ri ER2 pi Var[R 7:6 perfect correlation ( is 1), the expected value of
i Rt+1 is rt. In general, the expected value of Rt+1
given an observed value rt of Rt is
If a time series of T random variable values, rt,
generated from the distribution of the same sta- ERt 1 jRt rt  ER qrt ER: 7:8
tionary random variable, R, exist, then the serial
or autocorrelations of rt and rt+k in this time The variance of the random variable Rt+1
series for any positive integer k are depends on the variance of the distribution, Var
X X [R], and the lag one correlation coefcient, .
qR k rt ERrt k ER= rt ER2
t1;Tk t1;T VarRt 1 jRt rt  VarR1  q2 : 7:9
7:7
If there is perfect correlation ( = 1) the pro-
The probability density and corresponding cess is deterministic and there is no variance. The
cumulative probability distributions can be of any value for rt+1 is rt. If there is no correlation, i.e.,
shape, not just those named distributions com- serial correlation does not exist ( = 0), the
monly found in probability and statistics books. generated value for rt+1 is its mean, E[R], plus
The process of generating a time sequence some randomly generated deviation from a nor-
t = 1, 2, of inputs, rt, from the probability mal distribution having a mean of 0 and a stan-
distribution of a random variable R where the lag dard deviation of 1, denoted as N(0, 1). In this
1 serial correlation, R(1) = , is to be preserved case the value rt+1 is not dependent on rt.
is a little more complex. The expected value of When the serial correlation is more than 0 but
the random variable Rt+1 depends on the less than 1, then both the correlation and the
observed value, rt, of the random variable Rt, standard deviation (the square root of the
304 7 Modeling Uncertainty

Fig. 7.3 Diagram showing the calculation of a sequence of values of the random variable R from a multivariate normal
distribution in a way that preserves the mean, variance and correlation of the random variable

variance) influence the value of rt+1. A sequence


of random variable values from a multivariate 7.3 Monte Carlo Simulation
normal distribution that preserves the mean, E
[R], overall variance, Var[R], and lag one corre- To illustrate Monte Carlo simulation, consider
lation , can be obtained from Eq. 7.10. the allocation problem involving three rms,
each of which receives a benet, Bi(xit), from the
rt 1 ER qrt  ER N0; 1r1  q2 1=2 : amount of water, xit, allocated to it in each period
7:10 t. This situation is shown in Fig. 7.4. Monte
Carlo simulation can be used to nd the proba-
The term N(0, 1) in Eq. 7.10 is a random bility distribution of the benets to each rm
number generated from a normal distribution associated with the rms allocation policy.
having a mean of 0 and a variance of 1. The Suppose the policy is to keep the rst two
process involves selecting a random number units of flow in the stream, to allocate the next 3
from a uniform distribution ranging from 0 to 1, units to Firm 3, and the next 4 units to rms 1
and using it in Eq. 7.2 for a N(0, 1) distribution and 2 equally. The remaining flow is to be allo-
to obtain a value of random number for use in cated to each of the three rms equally up to the
Eq. 7.10. This positive or negative number is limits desired by each rm, namely 3.0, 2.33, and
substituted for the term N(0, 1) in Eq. 7.10 to 8.0, respectively. Any excess flow will remain in
obtain a value rt+1. This is shown on the graph in the stream. The plots in Fig. 7.5 illustrate this
Fig. 7.3. policy. Each allocation plot reflects the priorities
Simulation models that have random inputs, given to the three rms and the users further
such as a series of rt values, will generally pro- downstream.
duce random outputs. After many simulations, A simulation model can now be created. In
the probability distributions of each random each of a series of discrete time periods t, the
output variable value can be dened. These then flows Qt are drawn from a probability distribu-
can be used to estimate reliabilities and other tion, such as from Fig. 7.2 using Eq. 7.2. Once
statistical characteristics of those output distri- this flow is determined, each successive alloca-
butions. This process of generating multiple tion, xit, is computed. Once an allocation is made
random inputs for multiple simulations to obtain it is subtracted from the streamflow and the next
multiple random outputs is called Monte Carlo allocation is made based on that reduced
simulation. streamflow, in accordance with the allocation
7.3 Monte Carlo Simulation 305

Fig. 7.4 Stream flow allocations in each period t result in benets, Bi(xit), to each rm i. The flows, Qit, at each
diversion site i are the random flows Qt less the upstream withdrawals, if any

(a) (b)

(c) (d)

Fig. 7.5 a Water allocation policy for Firm 1 based on based on the flow at its diversion site. This policy applies
the flow at its diversion site. This policy applies for each for each period t. d Streamflow downstream of site 3
period t. b Water allocation policy for Firm 2 based on the given the streamflow Q3t at site 3 before the diversion.
flow at its diversion site for that rm. This policy applies This applies for each period t
for each period t. c Water allocation policy for Firm 3

policy dened in Fig. 7.5. After numerous time Having dened the probability distribution of
steps the probability distributions of the alloca- the allocations, based on the allocation policy,
tions to each of the rms can be dened. one can now consider each of the allocations as
Figure 7.6 shows a flow chart for this simu- random variables, X1, X2, and X3 for rms 1, 2
lation model. and 3, respectively.
306 7 Modeling Uncertainty

Fig. 7.6 Monte Carlo simulation to determine probability distributions of allocations to each of three water users, as
illustrated in Fig. 7.4. The dash lines represent information (data) flows

time. Chance constraints specify the probability


7.4 Chance Constrained Models of a constraint being satised, or the fraction of
the time a constraint has to apply. Consider, for
For models that include random variables it may example, the allocation problem shown in
be appropriate in some situations to consider Fig. 7.4. For planning purposes, the three rms
constraints that do not have to be satised all the may want to set allocation targets, not expecting
7.4 Chance Constrained Models 307

to have those targets met 100% of the time. To the values of the three targets that maximize the
insure, for example, that an allocation target, Ti, total benets obtained with a reliability of, say, at
of rm i will be met at least 90% of the time, one least 90%.
could write the chance constraint      
Maximize 6T1 T12 7T2  1:5T22 8T3  0:5T32
PrfTi  Xi g  0:90 i 1; 2; and 3 7:11 7:13
In this constraint, the allocation target Ti is an Subject to:
unknown decision variable, and Xi is a random
variable whose distribution has just been com- PrfT1 T2 T3  Qt  minQt ; 2g  0:90
puted and is known. for all periods t
To include chance constraints in optimization
7:14
models, their deterministic equivalents must be
dened. The deterministic equivalents of these
where Qt is the random streamflow variable
three chance constraints in Eq. 7.11 are
upstream of all diversion sites. If the same
unconditional probability distribution of Qt applies
Ti  x0:10
it i 1; 2; and 3 7:12
for each period t then only one Eq. 7.14 is needed.
Assuming the value of the streamflow, q0:10 ,
where x0:10
it is the particular value of the random t
that is equaled or exceeded 90% of the time, is
variable Xi that is equaled or exceeded 90% of
greater than 2 (the amount that must remain in
the time. This value is shown on the probability
the stream), the deterministic equivalent of
distribution for Xi in Fig. 7.7.
chance constraint Eq. 7.14 is
To modify the allocation problem somewhat,
assume the benet obtained by each rm is a   
T1 T2 T3  q0:10
t  min q0:10
t ;2 7:15
function of its target allocation and that the same
allocation target applies in each time period
The value of the flow that is equaled or
t. The equipment and labor used in the rm is
exceeded 90% of the time, q0:10
t , can be obtained
presumably based on the target allocations. Once
from the cumulative distribution of flows as
the target is set assume there are no benets
illustrated in Fig. 7.8.
gained by excess allocations of water. If the
Assume this 90% reliable flow is 8. The deter-
benets obtained are to be based on the tar-
ministic equivalent of the chance constraint
get allocations, rather than the actual allocations,
Eq. 7.14 for all periods t is simply T1 + T2 +
then the optimization problem is one of nding
T3 6. The optimal solution of the chance

Fig. 7.7 Probability density distribution of the random


allocation Xi to rm i. The particular allocation value x0:10
it Fig. 7.8 Example cumulative probability distribution
has a 90% chance of being equaled or exceeded, as showing the particular value of the random variable,
indicated by the shaded region q0:10
t , that is equaled or exceeded 90% of the time
308 7 Modeling Uncertainty

constrained target allocation model, Eqs. 7.13 X


31
and 7.15, is, as seen before, T1 = 1, T2 = 1, and VarQ qt  3:1552 =31 1:95 7:17
T3 = 4. The next step would be to simulate this t1
problem to see what the actual reliabilities might
be for various sequences of flows qt.
Lag-one correlation coefficient q
" #
X30 X
31
qt 1  3:155qt  3:155 = qt  3:1552
7.5 Markov Processes t1 t1

and Transition Probabilities 0:50


7:18
Time series correlations can be incorporated into
models using transition probabilities. To illus- The probability distribution of the flows in
trate this process, consider the observed flow Table 7.1 can be approximated by a histogram.
sequence shown in Table 7.1. Histograms can be created by subdividing the
The estimated mean, variance and correlation entire range of random variable values, e.g.,
coefcient of the observed flows shown in flows, into discrete intervals. For example, let
Table 7.1 can be calculated using Eqs. 7.16, 7.17 each interval be 2 units of flow. Counting the
and 7.18. number of flows in each interval and then
dividing those interval counts by the total num-
X
31
EQ qt =31 3:155 7:16 ber of counts results in the histogram shown in
t1 Fig. 7.9. In this case, just to compare this with
what will be calculated later, the rst flow, q1, is
ignored.

Table 7.1 Sequence of flows for 31 time periods t


7.5 Markov Processes and Transition Probabilities 309

number of times a flow in interval j followed a


flow in interval i.
Given an observed flow in an interval i in
period t, the probabilities of being in one of the
possible intervals j in the next period t + 1 must
sum to 1. Thus each number in each row of the
matrix in Table 7.2 can be divided by the total
number of flow transitions in that row (the sum of
the number of flows in the row) to obtain the
probabilities of being in each interval j in t + 1
Fig. 7.9 Histogram showing an equal 1/3 probability given a flow in interval i in period t. In this case
that the values of the random variable Qt will be in any there are 10 flows that followed each flow
one of the three 2-flow unit intervals interval i, hence by dividing each number in each
row of the matrix by 10 denes the transition
Figure 7.9 shows a uniform unconditional probabilities Pij.
probability distribution of the flow being in any
of the possible discrete flow intervals. It does not Pij PrfQt 1 in interval jjQt in interval ig
show the possible dependency of the probabili- 7:19
ties of the random variable value, qt+1, in period
t + 1 on the observed random variable value, qt, These conditional or transition probabilities,
in period t. It is possible that the probability of shown in Table 7.3, correspond to the number of
being in a flow interval j in period t + 1 depends transitions shown in Table 7.2.
on the actual observed flow interval i in period t. Table 7.3 is a matrix of transition probabili-
To see if the probability of being in any given ties. The sum of the probabilities in each row
interval of flows is dependent on the past flow equals 1. Matrices of transition probabilities
interval one can create a matrix. The rows of the whose rows sum to one are also called stochastic
matrix are the flow intervals i in period t. The matrices or rst-order Markov chains.
columns are the flow intervals j in the following If each rows probabilities were the same, this
period t + 1. Such a matrix is shown in would indicate that the probability of observing
Table 7.2. The numbers in the matrix are based any flow interval in the future is independent of
on the flows in Table 7.1 and indicate the the value previous flows. Each row would have

Table 7.3 Matrix showing the probabilities Pij of having


Table 7.2 Matrix showing the number of times a flow in
a flow in interval j in period t + 1 given an observed flow
interval i in period t was followed by a flow in interval j in
in interval i in period t
period t + 1
310 7 Modeling Uncertainty

the same probabilities as the unconditional dis- interval i in period t = 2 and making a transition
tribution shown in Fig. 7.9. In this example the to interval j in period t = 3.
probabilities in each row differ, showing that low
flows are more likely to follow low flows, and PrfQ3 in interval jg PQj;3
X
high flows are more likely to follow high flows. PrfQ2 in interval ig PrfQ3 in interval jjQ2 in interval ig
i
Thus the flows in Table 7.1 are positively cor-
7:20
related, as indeed has already determined from
Eq. 7.18.
The last term in Eq. 7.20 is the transition
Using the information in Table 7.3, one can
probability, from Table 7.3, that in this example
compute the probability of observing a flow in
remains the same for all time periods t. These
any interval at any period on into the future given
transition probabilities, Pr{Qt+1 in interval j | Qt
the present flow interval. This can be done one
in interval i} can be denoted as Pij.
period at a time. For example assume the flow in
Referring to Eqs. 7.19, 7.20 can be written in
the current time period t = 1 is in interval i = 3.
a general form as
The probabilities, PQj,2, of being in any of the
three intervals in the following time period t + 1 X
PQj;t 1 PQit Pij
are the probabilities shown in the third row of the i 7:21
matrix in Table 7.3. for all intervals j and periods t
The probabilities of being in an interval j in
the following time period t = 3 is the sum over This operation can be continued to any future
all intervals i of the joint probabilities of being in time period. Table 7.4 illustrates the results of

Table 7.4 Probabilities of observing a flow in any flow interval i in a future time period t given a current flow in
interval i = 3

These probabilities are derived using the transition probabilities Pij in Table 7.3 in Eq. 7.21 and assuming the flow
interval observed in period 1 is in interval 3
7.5 Markov Processes and Transition Probabilities 311

such calculations for up to six future periods, selected, knowing that there is some probability
given a present period (t = 1) flow in interval that in reality, or in a simulation model, the
i = 3. actual flow may be less than the selected value
Note that as the future time period t increases, q. Hence if the constraint x q is binding
the flow interval probabilities are converging to (x = q), the actual allocation may be less than the
the unconditional probabilities, in this example value of the allocation or diversion variable
1/3. 1/3, 1/3, as shown in Fig. 7.9. The predicted x produced by the optimization model.
probability of observing a future flow in any If the value of x affects one of the systems
particular interval at some time in the future performance indicators, e.g., the net benets, B
becomes less and less dependent on the current (x), to the user, a more accurate estimate of the
flow interval as the number of time periods users net benets will be obtained from con-
increases between the current period and that sidering a range of possible allocations x,
future time period. depending on the range of possible values of the
When these unconditional probabilities are random flow Q. One way to do this is to divide
reached, PQit will equal PQi,t+1 for each flow the known probability distribution of flows q into
interval i. To nd these unconditional probabili- discrete ranges, i, each range having a known
ties directly, Eq. 7.21 can be written as probability PQi. Designate a discrete flow qi for
X each range. Associated with each known flow qi
PQj PQi Pij for all intervals j less one is an unknown allocation xi. Now the determin-
i istic constraint x q can be replaced with the set
7:22 of constraints xi qi and the term B(x) in the
original objective function can be replaced by its
Equation 7.22 along with Eq. 7.23 can be P
expected value, i POi Bxi .
used to calculate all the unconditional probabil-
Note, when dividing a continuous known
ities PQi directly.
probability distribution into discrete ranges, the
X discrete flows qi selected to represent each range
PQi 1 7:23
i i having a given probability PQi, should be
selected so as to maintain at least the mean and
Conditional or transition probabilities can be variance of that known distribution as dened by
incorporated into stochastic optimization models Eqs. 7.5 and 7.6.
of water resource systems. To illustrate this consider a slightly more
involved example involving the allocation of
water to consumers upstream and downstream of
7.6 Stochastic Optimization a reservoir. Both the policies for allocating water
to each user and the reservoir release policy are
To illustrate the development and use of to be determined. This example problem is
stochastic optimization models consider rst the shown in Fig. 7.10.
allocation of water to a single user. Assume the If the allocation of water to each user is to be
flow in the stream where the diversion takes based on a common objective, such as the min-
place is not regulated and can be described by a imization of the total sum, over time, of squared
known probability distribution based on histori- deviations from prespecied target allocations,
cal records. Clearly the user cannot divert more each allocation in each time period will depend
water than is available in the stream. A deter- in part on the reservoir storage volume.
ministic model would include the constraint that Consider rst a deterministic model of the
the diversion x cannot exceed the available water above problem, assuming known flows Qt and
Q. But Q is a random variable. Some discrete upstream and downstream allocation targets UTt
value, q, of the random variable Q will have to be and DTt in each of T within-year periods t in a
312 7 Modeling Uncertainty

Fig. 7.10 Example water


resource system involving
water diversions from a
river both upstream and
downstream of a reservoir
of known capacity

year. Assume the objective is to minimize the Allocation restrictions for each period t:
sum of squared deviations of actual allocations,
ut and dt, from their respective target allocations, ut  Qt 7:27
UTt and DTt in each within-year period t.

T n
X o dt  Rt 7:28
Minimize UTt ut 2 DTt dt 2
t
Equations 7.25 and 7.28 could be combined
7:24 to eliminate the release variable Rt since in this
problem knowledge of the total release in each
The constraints include:
period t is not required. In this case Eq. 7.25
would become an inequality.
(a) Continuity of storage involving initial stor-
The solution for this model, Eqs. 7.247.28,
age volumes St, net inflows Qt ut, and
would depend on the known variables (the tar-
releases Rt. Assuming no losses
gets UTt and DTt, flows Qt and reservoir capacity
K). It would identify the particular upstream and
downstream allocations and reservoir releases in
St Qt  ut  Rt St 1 each period t. It would not provide a policy that
7:25 denes what allocations and releases to make for
for each period t; T 1 1
a range of different inflows and initial storage
volumes in each period t. A backward-moving
dynamic programming model can provide such a
(b) Reservoir capacity limitations. Assuming a policy. This policy will identify the allocations
known active storage capacity K, and releases to make based on various initial
storage volumes, St, as well flows, Qt, as dis-
cussed in Chap. 4.
This deterministic discrete dynamic program-
St  K for each period t 7:26 ming allocation and reservoir operation model
7.6 Stochastic Optimization 313

can be written for different discrete values of where


storage volumes St from 0 St capacity K as
ut  Qt 7:31
n o
Ftn St ; Qt min UTt  ut 2 DTt  dt 2 Ftn1
1 St 1 ; Qt 1

ut ; Rt ; dt
ut  Qt
dt  St Qt  ut  St 1 7:32
Rt  St Qt  ut
Rt  St Qt  ut  K This local optimization can be solved to
dt  Rt identify the ut and dt allocations for each feasible
St 1 St Qt  ut  Rt combination of St and St+1 in each period t.
7:29 Given these optimal allocations, the dynamic
programming model can be simplied to include
There are three variables to be determined at only one discrete decision variable, either Rt or
each stage or time period t in the above dynamic St+1. If the decision variable St+1 is used in each
programming model. These three variables are period t, the releases Rt in those periods t do not
the allocations ut and dt and the reservoir release need to be considered. Thus the dynamic pro-
Rt. Each decision involves three discrete decision gramming model expressed by Eq. 7.29 can be
variable values. The functions Ftn St ; Qt dene written for all discrete storage volumes St from 0
the minimum sum of squared deviations given an to K and for all discrete flows Qt as
initial storage volume St and streamflow Qt in  2
UTt ut St ;St 1
time period or season t with n time periods Ftn St ; Qt min 2
St 1 DTt dt St ;St 1
remaining until the end of reservoir operation. St 1  K
One can reduce this three-decision variable
7:33
model to a single variable model by realizing that
for any xed discrete initial and nal storage
where the functions ut(St, St+1) and dt(St, St+1)
volume states, there can be a direct tradeoff
have been determined using Eqs. 7.307.32.
between the upstream and downstream alloca-
As the total number of periods remaining, n,
tions given the particular streamflow in each
increases, the solution of this dynamic pro-
period t. Increasing the upstream allocation will
gramming model will converge to a steady or
decrease the resulting reservoir inflow and this in
stationary state. The best nal storage volume
turn will reduce the release by the same amount.
St+1 given an initial storage volume St will likely
This reduces the amount of water available to
differ for each within-year period or season t, but
allocate to the downstream use.
for a given season t it will be the same in suc-
Hence for this example problem involving
cessive years. In addition, for each storage vol-
these upstream and downstream allocations, a
ume St, streamflow, Qt, and within-year period
local optimization can be performed at each time
t the difference between Ftn T St ; Qt and
step t for each combination of storage states St
Ftn St ; Qt will be the same constant regardless of
and St+1. This optimization nds the allocation
the storage volume St, flow Qt and period t. This
decision variables ut and dt that
constant is the optimal, in this case minimum,
annual value of the objective function, Eq. 7.24.
minimizeUTt  ut 2 DTt  dt 2 7:30
There could be additional limits imposed on
storage variables and release variables, such as for
314 7 Modeling Uncertainty

flood control storage or minimum downstream range of storage volume values from 0 to the
flows, as might be appropriate in specic situations. active reservoir capacity K. Each Skt is a discrete
The above deterministic dynamic program- storage volume that represents the range of
ming model (Eq. 7.33) can be converted to a storage volumes in interval k at the beginning of
stochastic model. Stochastic models consider each period t.
multiple discrete flows as well as multiple dis- Let the index l denote different nal storage
crete storage volumes, and their probabilities, in volume intervals. Each Sl,t+1 is a discrete volume
each period t. A common way to do this is to that represents the storage volume interval l at the
assume that the sequence of flows follow a end of in each period t or equivalently at the
rst-order Markov process. Such a process beginning of period t + 1. As previously dened,
involves the use of transition or conditional let the indices i and j denote the different flow
probabilities of flows as dened by Eq. 7.20. intervals, and each discrete qit and qj,t+1 represent
To develop these stochastic optimization the flows in those flow intervals i and j in periods
models it is convenient to introduce some addi- t and t + 1, respectively.
tional indices or subscripts. Let the index k de- These subscripts and the volume or flow
note different initial storage volume intervals. intervals they represent are illustrated in
These discrete intervals divide the continuous Fig. 7.11.

Fig. 7.11 Discretization of streamflows and reservoir storage volumes. The area within each flow interval i below the
probability density distribution curve is the unconditional probability, PQit, associated with the discrete flow qit
7.6 Stochastic Optimization 315

With this notation it is now possible to develop The sum over all flow intervals j of these
a stochastic dynamic programming model that conditional probabilities times the
will identify the allocations and releases that are n1
 
Ft 1 Sl;t 1 ; qj;t 1 values is the expected mini-
to be made given both the initial storage volume,
mum sum of future squared deviations from
Skt, and the flow, qit. It follows the same structure
allocation targets with n 1 periods remaining
as the deterministic models dened by Eqs. 7.30
given an initial storage volume of Skt and flow of
7.32, and 7.33.
qit and nal storage volume of Sl,t+1. The value
To identify the optimal allocations in each
Ftn Skt ; qit is the expected minimum sum of
period t for each pair of feasible initial and nal
squared deviations from the allocation targets
storage volumes Skt and Sl,t+1, and inflows qit, one
with n periods remaining given an initial storage
can solve Eqs. 7.347.36.
volume interval of Skt and flow interval of qit.
Stochastic models such as these provide expected
minimizeUTt  ukit 2 DTt  dkilt 2 7:34
values of objective functions.
where Another way to write the recursion equations
of this model, Eq. 7.37, is by using just the
ukit  qit for all k; i; t: 7:35 indices k and l to denote the discrete storage
volume variables Skt and Sl,t+1 and indices i and
j to denote the discrete flow variables qit and qj,t+1:
dkilt  Skt qit  ukit  Sl;t 1
7:36
for all feasible k; i; l; t: Ftn k; i minfUTt  ut k; i2 DTt  dt k; i; l2
X
Pt F n1 l; jg
j ij t 1
The solution to these equations for each fea-
l such that
sible combination of intervals k, i, l, and period
Sl;t 1  K
t denes the optimal allocations that can be
expressed as ut(k, i) and dt(k, i, l). Sl;t 1  Skt qit
The stochastic version of Model 7.33, again 7:38
expressed in a form suitable for backward mov-
ing discrete dynamic programming, can be The steady-state solution of this dynamic
written for different discrete values of Skt from 0 programming model will identify the preferred
to K and for all qit as nal storage volume Sl,t+1 in period t given the
particular discrete initial storage volume Skt and
Ftn Skt ; qit minfUTt  ut k; i2 DTt  dt k; i; l2 flow qit. This optimal policy can be expressed as
X
Pt F n1 S ;q g a function that identies the best interval
j ij t 1 l;t 1 j;t 1
l given intervals k, i and period t.
Sl;t 1
Sl;t 1  K
l k; i; t 7:39
Sl;t 1  Skt qit
7:37 All values of l given k, i, and t, dened by
Eq. 7.39, can be expressed in a matrix, one for
Each Ptij in the above recursive equation is each period t.
the known conditional or transition probability of Knowing the best nal storage volume interval
a flow qj,t+1 within interval j in period t + 1 given l given an initial storage volume interval k and
a flow of qit within interval i in period t. flow interval i, the optimal downstream alloca-
 tion, dt(k, i), can, like the upstream allocation, be
Ptij Pr flow qj;t 1 within interval j in t 1jflow of qit
expressed in terms of only k and i in each period t.
within interval i in tg Thus knowing the initial storage volume Skt and
316 7 Modeling Uncertainty

flow qit is sufcient to dene the optimal alloca- result in a nal volume interval l. This relation-
tions ut(k, i) and dt(k, i), nal storage volume ship is dened by Eq. 7.39 (l = (k, i, t)).
Sl,t+1, and hence the release Rt(k, i). While Eq. 7.41 must apply, it is not sufcient.
The joint probability of a nal storage volume in
Skt qit  ut k; i  Rt k; i Sl;t 1 interval l in period t and an inflow j in period
7:40
8k; i; t where l k; i; t t + 1 must equal the joint probability of an initial
storage volume in the same interval l and an
inflow in the same interval j in period t + 1.
7.6.1 Probabilities of Decisions Multiplying the joint probability Pkit times the
conditional probability Ptij and then summing
Knowing the function l = (k, i, t) permits a over all k and i that results in a nal storage
calculation of the probabilities of the different interval l denes the former, and the joint prob-
discrete storage volumes, allocations, and flows. ability Pl,j,t+1 denes the latter.
Let XX
Pl;j;t 1 Pkit Ptij 8l; j; t l k; i; t
PSkt = the unknown probability of an initial k i

storage volume Skt being within some interval 7:42


k in period t.
PQit = the steady-state unconditional probability Once again the sums in Eq. 7.42 are over all
of flow qit within interval i in period t. combinations of k and i that result in the desig-
Pkit = the unknown probability of the upstream nated storage volume interval l as dened by the
and downstream allocations ut(k, i) and policy (k, i, t).
dt(k, i) and reservoir release Rt(k, i) in period t. Finally, the sum of all joint probabilities Pkit
in each period t must equal 1.
As previously dened XX
Pkit 1 8t 7:43
k i
Ptij = the known conditional or transition proba-
bility of a flow within interval j in period t + 1 Note the similarity of Eqs. 7.42 and 7.43 to
given a flow within interval i in period t. the Markov steady-state flow Eqs. 7.22 and 7.23.
Instead of only one flow interval index consid-
These transition probabilities Ptij can be dis- ered in Eqs. 7.22 and 7.23, Eqs. 7.42 and 7.43
played in matrices, similar to Table 7.3, but as a include two indices, one for storage volume
separate matrix (Markov chain) for each period t. intervals and the other for flow intervals. In both
The joint probabilities of an initial storage cases, one of Eqs. 7.22 and 7.42 can be omitted
interval k, an inflow in the interval i, Pkit in each in each period t since it is redundant with that
period t must satisfy two conditions. Just as the periods Eqs. 7.23 and 7.43, respectively.
initial storage volume in period t + 1 is the same The unconditional probabilities PSkt and PQit
as the nal storage volume in period t, the can be derived from the joint probabilities Pkit.
probabilities of these same respective discrete X
storage volumes must also be equal. Thus PSkt Pkit 8k; t 7:44
X XX i
Pl;j;t 1 Pkit 8l; t 7:41
j k i X
PQit Pkit 8i; t 7:45
where the sums in the right hand side of Eq. 7.41 k
are over only those combinations of k and i that
7.6 Stochastic Optimization 317

Each of these unconditional joint or marginal The constraints include


probabilities, when summed over all their vol-
ume and flow indices, will equal 1. For example (a) Continuity of storage involving initial stor-
X X age volumes Skt, net inflows qit ukit, and at
PSkt PQit 1 7:46 least partial releases dkit. Again assuming no
k i losses:

Note that these probabilities are determined Skt qit  ukit  dkit  Sl;t 1 8k; i; t
7:48
based only on the relationships among flow and l k; i; t
storage intervals as dened by Eq. 7.39, l = (k,
i, t) in each period t, and the Markov chains Reservoir capacity limitations.
dening the flow interval transition or condi-
tional probabilities, Ptij . It is not necessary to Skit  K 8k; i; t 7:49
know the actual discrete storage values repre-
Allocation restrictions.
senting those intervals. Thus assuming any rela-
tionship among the storage volume and flow ukit  qit 8k; i; t 7:50
interval indices, l = (k, i, t) and a knowledge of
the flow interval transition probabilities Ptij , one
can determine the joint probabilities Pkit and their 7.6.2 A Numerical Example
marginal or unconditional probabilities PSkt. One
does not need to know what those storage A simple numerical example may help to illus-
intervals are to calculate their probabilities. trate how these stochastic models can be devel-
(Amazing, isnt it?) oped without getting buried in detail. Consider,
Given the values of these joint probabilities for simplicity, two within-year periods each year.
Pkit, the deterministic model dened by Eqs. 7.24 The random flows Qt in each period t are divided
7.28 can be converted to a stochastic model to into two intervals. These flow intervals are rep-
identify the best storage and allocation decision resented by discrete flows of 1 and 3 volume
variable values associated with each storage units per second in the rst period and 3 and 6
interval k and flow interval i in each period t. volume units per second in the second period.
XXX
T n o Their transition probabilities are shown in
Minimize Pkit UTt  ukit 2 DTt  dkit 2 Table 7.5.
k i t
Assuming equal within-year period durations,
7:47 these three discrete flow rates are equivalent to

Table 7.5 Transition probabilities for two ranges of flows in two within-year periods
318 7 Modeling Uncertainty

about 16, 47 and 95 million volume units per particular state and season have come close to a
period. common constant value.
Assume the active storage volume capacity While the differences between corresponding
nT
K in the reservoir equals 50 million volume Ft and Ftn have not yet reached a common
units. This capacity can be divided into different constant value to the nearest unit deviation (they
intervals of storage. For this simple example range from, 3475.5 to 3497.1 for an average of
assume three storage volume intervals repre- 3485.7), the policy has converged to that shown
sented by 10, 25, and 40 million volume units. in Tables 7.8 and 7.9.
Assume the allocation targets remain the same in Given this policy, the probabilities of being in
each period at both the upstream and downstream any of these volume and flow intervals can be
sites. The upstream allocation target is approxi- determined by solving Eqs. 7.427.45.
mately 2 volume units per second or 30 million Table 7.10 shows the results of these equations
volume units in each period. The downstream applied to the data in Tables 7.5 and 7.8. It is
allocation target is approximately 5 volume units obvious that if the policy from Table 7.9 is fol-
per second or 80 million volume units in each lowed, the steady-state probabilities of being in
period. storage interval 1 in period 1 and in interval 3 in
With these data we can use Eqs. 7.347.36 to period 2 are 0.
determine the allocations that minimize the sum Multiplying these joint probabilities by the
of squared deviations from targets and what that corresponding SDkit values in the last column of
sum is, for all feasible combinations of initial and Table 7.6 provides the annual expected squared
nal storage volumes, and flows. Table 7.6 deviations, associated with the selected discrete
shows the results of these optimizations. These storage volumes and flows. This is done in
results will be used in the dynamic programming Table 7.11 for those combinations of k, i, and
model to determine the best nal storage vol- l that are contained in the optimal solution as
umes given initial volumes and flows. listed in Table 7.9.
With the information in Tables 7.5 and 7.6, The sum of products of the last two columns
the dynamic programming model, Eq. 7.38 or as in Table 7.11 for each period t equals the
expressed in Eq. 7.51, can be solved to nd the expected squared deviations in the period. For
optimal nal storage volumes given an initial period t = 1 the expected sum of squared devi-
storage volume and flow. The iterations of the ations are 1893.3 and for t = 2 they are 1591.0.
recursive equation, sufcient to reach a steady The total annual expected squared deviations are
state, are shown in Table 7.7. 3484.3. This compares with the expected squared
X deviations derived from the dynamic program-
Ftn k; i minfSDkil Ptij Ftn1
1 l; jg ming model, after nine iterations, ranging from
j
3475.5 to 3497.1 (as calculated from data in
over all l such that Table 7.8).
Sl;t 1  K The policy for reservoir releases is a function
Sl;t 1  Skt Qit not only of the initial storage volumes, but
also of the current inflow, i.e., the total water
7:51
available in the period. Reservoir release rule
This process can continue until a steady-state curves now must become two-dimensional.
policy is dened. Table 7.8 summarizes the next However, the inflow for each period usually
ve iterations. At this stage, the annual differ- cannot be predicted at the beginning of each
ences in the objective values associated with a period. Thus the reservoir release policy has to be
7.6 Stochastic Optimization 319

Table 7.6 Optimal allocations associated with given initial storage, Sk, flow, Qi, and nal storage, Sl, volumes

These allocations uki and dkil minimize the sum of squared deviations, DSkil = (30 uki)2 + (80 dkil)2, from upstream
and downstream targets, 30 and 80, respectively, subject to uki flow Qi, and dkil release (Sk + Qi uki Sl)
320 7 Modeling Uncertainty

Table 7.7 First four iterations of dynamic programming model, Eq. 7.51, moving backward in successive periods n,
beginning in season t = 2 with n = 1

(continued)
7.6 Stochastic Optimization 321

Table 7.7 (continued)

(continued)
322 7 Modeling Uncertainty

Table 7.7 (continued)

(continued)
7.6 Stochastic Optimization 323

Table 7.7 (continued)

The iterations stop when the nal storage policy given any initial storage volume and flow repeats itself in two
successive years. Initially, with no more periods remaining, F10 k; i 0 for all k and i
324 7 Modeling Uncertainty

Table 7.8 Summary of objective function values Ftn k; i and optimal decisions for stages n = 59 periods remaining

Table 7.9 Optimal reservoir policy l = (k, i, t) for the example problem
7.6 Stochastic Optimization 325

Table 7.10 Probabilities of flow and storage volume intervals associated with policy as dened in Table 7.9 for the
example problem

expressed in a way that it can be followed discrete expected releases can be used to dene a
without knowledge of the current inflow. One continuous range of releases for the continuous
way to do this is to compute the expected value range of storage volumes from 0 to full capacity,
of the release for each discrete storage volume, 50. Figure 7.12 also shows the hedging that
and show it in a release rule. This is done in might take place as the reservoir storage volume
Fig. 7.12. The probability of each discrete decreases.
release associated with each discrete river flow is These and modications of these policies can
the probability of the flow itself. Thus in period 1 be simulated to determine improved release
when the storage volume is 40, the expected rules. Simulation modeling is the subject of the
release is 46(0.41) + 56(0.59) = 52. These following chapter.
326 7 Modeling Uncertainty

Table 7.11 The optimal operating policy and the probability of each state and decision

E020829k
sum squared

probability
deviations
allocation
time period

optimal
interval
storage

storage

indices
initial

joint
final
flow

Sk Qi S1 k, i, l ukit dkit SDkit P kit

10 16 10 1,1,1 1 0.0 16.0 4996.0 0.0


10 47 10 1,2,1 1 0.0 47.0 1989.0 0.0
25 16 10 2,1,1 1 0.0 31.0 3301.0 0.2964706
25 47 10 2,2,1 1 6.0 56.0 1152.0 0.1270588
40 16 10 3,1,1 1 0.0 46.0 2056.0 0.1152941
40 47 25 3,2,2 1 6.0 56.0 1152.0 0.4611765
sum = 1.0

10 47 25 1,2,2 2 0.0 32.0 3204.0 0.2851765


10 95 25 1,3,2 2 7.5 57.5 1012.5 0.2536471
25 47 25 2,2,2 2 0.0 47.0 1989.0 0.1383529
25 95 40 2,3,2 2 15.0 65.0 450.0 0.3228235
40 47 40 3,2,3 2 0.0 47.0 1989.0 0.0
40 95 40 3,3,3 2 22.5 72.5 112.5 0.0

sum = 1.0

Fig. 7.12 Reservoir release rule showing an interpolated release, increasing as storage volumes increase
7.7 Summary 327

7.7 Summary and constraints, the use of deterministic models


for a preliminary screening of alternatives prior
This chapter has introduced some approaches for to a more precise probabilistic screening is often
including risk into optimization and simulation warranted.
models. The discussion began with ways to
obtain values of random variables whose proba-
bility distributions are known. These values, for Reference
example streamflows or parameter values, can be
inputs to simulation models. Monte Carlo simu- WWAP (United Nations World Water Assessment Pro-
lation involves the use of multiple simulations gramme) World Water Development Report 4. (2012).
using these random variable values to obtain the Managing water under uncertainty and risk (867 pp).
probability distributions of outputs, including Paris: UNESCO.
various system performance indicators.
Two methods were reviewed for introducing
random variables along with their probabilities Additional References
into optimization models. One involves the use (Further Reading)
of chance constraints. These are constraints that
must be met, as all constraints must be, but now Bassson, M. S., Allen, R. B., Pegram, G. G. S., & van
Rooyen, J. A. (1994). Probabilistic management of
with a certain probability. As in any method there
water resource and hydropower systems. Highlands
are limits to the use of chance constraints. These Ranch, CO: Water Resources Publications.
limitations were not discussed, but in cases Birge, J. R., & Louveaux, F. (1997). Introduction to
where chance constraints are applicable, and if stochastic programming. NY: Springer.
DeGroot, M. H. (1980). Optimal statistical decisions. NY:
their deterministic equivalents can be dened,
McGraw-Hill.
they are probably the only method of introducing Dempster, M. A. H. (1980). Stochastic programming.
risk into otherwise deterministic models that do London: Academic Press.
not add to the model size. Dorfman, R., Jacoby, H. D., & Thomas, H. A., Jr. (1972).
Models for managing regional water quality. Cam-
Alternatively, the range of random variable
bridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
values can be divided into discrete ranges. Each Ermoliev, Y. (1970). Methods of stochastic programming.
range can be represented by a specic or discrete Moscow: Nauka. (in Russian).
value of the random variable. These discrete Ermoliev, Y., & Wets, R. (Eds.). (1988). Numerical
techniques for stochastic optimization. Berlin:
values and their probabilities can become part of Springer.
an optimization model. This was demonstrated Heyman, D. P., & Sobel, M. J. (1984). Stochastic models
using transition probabilities incorporated into in operations research, Volume II. Stochastic opti-
both linear and dynamic programming models. mization. NY: McGraw-Hill.
Hillier, F. S., & Lieberman, G. J. (1990). Introduction to
The examples used in this chapter to illustrate stochastic models in operations research. NY:
the development and application of stochastic McGraw-Hill.
optimization and simulation models are relatively Howard, R. A. (1960). Dynamic programming and
simple. These and similar probabilistic and Markov processes. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.
Hufschmidt, M. M., & Fiering, M. B. (1966). Simulation
stochastic models have been applied to numerous techniques for design of water-resource systems.
water resources planning and management Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
problems. They can be a much more effective Loucks, D. P., Stedinger, J. S., & Haith, D. A. (1981).
screening tool than deterministic models based Water resource systems planning and analysis. Engle-
wood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
on the mean or other selected values of random Maass, A., Hufschmidt, M. M., Dorfman, R., Thomas, H.
variables. But sometimes they are not. Clearly if A., Jr., Marglin, S. A., & Fair, G. M. (1962). Design of
the system being analyzed is very complex, or water-resource systems. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
just very big in terms of the number of variables University Press.
328 7 Modeling Uncertainty

Prkopa, A. (1995). Stochastic programming. Dordrecht, policy (release as a function of initial


NL: Kluwer Academic Publishers. reservoir volumes and current periods
Raiffa, H., & Schlaifer, R. (1961). Applied statistical
decision theory. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University inflow) for the reservoir that minimizes the
Press. expected sum of squared deviations from
ReVelle, C. (1999). Optimizing reservoir resources. NY: storage and release targets. Limit the stor-
Wiley. age volumes to integer values that vary
Ross, S. M. (1983). Introduction to stochastic dynamic
programming. NY: Academic Press. from 3 to 5. Assume a storage volume target
Somlydy, L., & Wets, R. J- B. Stochastic optimization of 4 and a release target of 2 in each period
models for lake eutrophication management. Opera- t. (Assume only integer values of all states
tions Research, 36, 660681. and decision variables and that each peri-
Wets, R. J- B. (1989). Stochastic programming. In G.
L. Nemhauser, A. H. G. Rinnooy Kan, & M. J. Todd ods inflow is known at the beginning of the
(Eds.), Handbooks in Operations Research and Man- period.) Find the annual expected sum of
agement Science (Vol. 1, pp. 573629). North-Holland, squared deviations from the storage and
Amsterdam: Elsevier Science Publishers. release targets.
Wurbs, R. A. (1996). Modeling and analysis of reservoir
system operations. Upper Saddle River, NJ: Prentice
Hall. Period, t Flows, Qit Probabilities,
Pit
i=1 i=2 i=1 i=2
1 1 2 0.17 0.83
2 3 4 0.29 0.71
Exercises

7:1 Can you modify the deterministic discrete This is an application of Exercise 6.27 except
DP reservoir operating model to include the the flow probabilities are independent of the
uncertainty, expressed as Ptij , of the inflows, previous flow.
as in Exercise 6.25?
7:3 Develop a linear model for dening the
(Hints: The operating policy would dene
optimal joint probabilities of predened dis-
the release (or nal storage) in each season
crete initial storage volumes, discrete
as a function of not only the initial storage
inflows, and discrete nal storage volumes in
but also the inflow. If the inflow changes, so
a reservoir in each period t. Let values of the
might the release or nal storage volume.
index k represent the different discrete initial
Hence you need to discretize the inflows as
storage volumes, Skt. Similarly, let the index
well as the storage volumes. Both storage
i represent the inflows, Qit, and the index
and inflow are state variables. Assume, for
l represent the nal storage volumes, Sl,t+1, in
this model, you can predict with certainty
period t. Let the index j represent the discrete
the inflow in each period at the beginning of
inflows, Qj,t+1, and m represent the discrete
the period. So, each node of the network
nal storage volumes, Sm,t+2, in period t + 1.
represents a known initial storage and
Let PRkilt be the unknown joint probability of
inflow value. You cannot predict with cer-
a discrete initial storage, Skt, an inflow, Qit,
tainty the following periods flows, only
and a nal storage volume, Sl,t+1, in period
their probabilities. What does the network
t. It is also the probability of a release asso-
look like now?
ciated with a particular combination of k, i,
7:2 Assume that there exist two possible dis-
and l in period t. The objective is to maxi-
crete flows Qit into a small reservoir in each
mize the expected net benets, however,
of two periods t each year having proba-
measured. The net benets associated with
bilities Pit. Find the steady-state operating
any combination represented by k, i, and l in
Exercises 329

period t is Bkilt. These net benets and the (a) Generate values of x that come from this
conditional inflow probabilities. Ptij distribution.
 
Pr Qj;t 1 jQit ; are known. Show how the
optimal operating policy can be determined To do this you need to
once the values of the joint probabilities,
PRkilt, are known. Determine the equations of the cumulative
distribution.
The same policy can be found by
Generate uniformly distributed random val-
DP. Develop a DP model to nd the optimal
ues of probabilities p.
operating policy.
For each p nd corresponding value of x. The
7:4 Referring to Exercise 7.3, instead of dening
inverse of the cumulative probability function
a nal volume subscript l and m for com-
puting joint probabilities PRkilt, assume that FX(x) denoted as FX1 p.
subscripts d and e were used to denote dif- Using this inverse function, generate a series
ferent reservoir release volumes. How would of 100 random variable values x that would
the linear programming model developed be have a probability distribution as shown
altered to include d and e in place of l and m? above.
How would the dynamic programming
recursion equation be altered? (b) Calculate the mean, variance, and standard
7:5 Given joint probabilities PRkilt found from deviation of this distribution based on the
Exercise 7.3, how would one derive the random values you computed. What is the
probability distribution of reservoir releases effect on these statistics of increasing the
and storage volumes in each period t? number of sample values of the random
7:6 Assume that the streamflow Q at a particular variable, say from 100 to 1000 to 9000?
site has cumulative distribution function (c) Calculate and compare with the true mean
FQ(q) = q/(1 + q) for q 0. The withdrawal and variance.
x at that location must satisfy a chance con- (d) Next, suppose these random values of X are
straint of the form Pr[x Q] 1 . Write flows entering a reservoir having a capacity
the deterministic equivalent for each of the of 6. The purpose of the reservoir is to
following chance constraints: release a target flow of 5 in each time period.
Simulate the operation of the reservoir
Prx  Q  0:90 Prx  Q  0:80 assuming that if there is insufcient water to
Prx  Q  0:95 Prx  Q  0:10 meet the target release of 5, release what is
Prx  Q  0:75 available, leaving an empty reservoir. Find
the mean, variance, and standard deviation of
reservoir storage and release values.
7:7 Monte Carlo Simulation: (e) Finally assume the reservoir releases are to
Consider the symmetric triangular probabil- be allocated to three water users whose target
ity density function that ranges from 0 to 10 allocations are 3, 2.33, and 8. Actual allo-
whose mean and most likely value is 5 cations should not exceed these target allo-
cations. Make the allocations such that in
fX x) each time period the maximum percentage
decit allocation is minimized. Find the
mean, variance and standard deviation of
0 5 10 x each users percentage decit allocations.
330 7 Modeling Uncertainty

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
System Sensitivity and Uncertainty
Analysis 8

The usefulness of any model is in part dependent Some input data uncertainties can be reduced
on the accuracy and reliability of its output data. by additional research and further data collection
Yet, because all models are abstractions of real- and analysis. Before spending money and time to
ity, and because precise input data are rarely if gather and analyze additional data, it is reason-
ever available, all output values are subject to able to ask what improvement in estimates of
imprecision. The input data and modeling system performance or what reduction in the
uncertainties are not independent of each other. uncertainty associated with those estimates
They can interact in various ways. The end result would result if all data and model uncertainties
is imprecision and uncertainty associated with could be reduced if not eliminated. Such infor-
model output. This chapter focuses on ways of mation helps determine how much one would be
identifying, quantifying, and communicating the willing to pay to reduce model output uncer-
uncertainties in model outputs. tainty. If the uncertainty on average is costing a
lot, it may pay to invest in additional data col-
lection, in more studies, or in developing better
8.1 Introduction models, all aimed at reducing that uncertainty. If
that uncertainty only a very modest, impact on
Models are the primary way we have to estimate the likely decision that is to be made, one should
the multiple impacts of alternative water resource nd other issues to worry about.
system design and operating policies. Models are If it appears that reducing uncertainty is
used to estimate the values of various system worthwhile, then the question is how best to do
performance indicators resulting from specic it. If doing this involves obtaining additional
design and/or operating policy decisions. Model information, then it is clear that the value of this
outputs are based on model structure, hydrologic additional information, however measured,
and other time series inputs and a host of should exceed the cost of obtaining it. The value
parameters whose values characterize the system of such information will be the benets of more
being simulated. Even if these assumptions and precise estimates of system performance, or the
input data reflect, or are at least representative of, reduction of the uncertainty, that one can expect
conditions believed to be true, we know the from obtaining such information. If additional
model outputs or results will be wrong. Our information is to be obtained, it should be
models are always simplications of the real focused on that which reduces the uncertainties
systems we are analyzing. Furthermore, we considered important, not the unimportant ones.
simply cannot forecast the future with precision. This chapter reviews some methods for iden-
So we know the model outputs dening future tifying and communicating model output uncer-
conditions are uncertain estimates, at best. tainty. The discussion begins with a review of the

The Author(s) 2017 331


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_8
332 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

causes of risk and uncertainty in model output. It performing sensitivity and uncertainty analyses
then examines ways of measuring or quantifying will differ from those that are based on assumed
uncertainty and model output sensitivity to known events and their probabilities.
model input imprecision, concentrating on Uncertainty in information is inherent in
methods that seem most relevant or practical for future-oriented planning efforts. Uncertainty
analyses of large-scale regional systems. It builds stems from inadequate information and incorrect
on some of the statistical and stochastic modeling assumptions, as well as from the variability and
methods reviewed in the previous two chapters. possibly the nonstationarity of natural processes.
Water managers often need to identify both the
uncertainty as well as the sensitivity of system
8.2 Issues, Concerns, performance due to any changes in possible input
and Terminology data. They are often obligated to reduce any
uncertainty to the extent practicable. Finally, they
Outcomes or events that cannot be predicted with need to communicate the residual uncertainties
certainty are often called risky or uncertain. clearly so that decisions can be made with this
Some individuals draw a special and interesting knowledge and understanding.
distinction between risk and uncertainty. In par- Sensitivity analysis can be distinguished from
ticular, the term risk is often reserved to describe uncertainty analysis. Sensitivity analysis proce-
situations for which probabilities are available to dures explore and quantify the impact of possible
describe the likelihood of various possible events changes (errors) in input data on predicted model
or outcomes. Often risk refers to these probabil- outputs and system performance indices. Simple
ities times the magnitude of the consequences of sensitivity analysis procedures can be used to
these events or outcomes. If probabilities of illustrate either graphically or numerically the
various events or outcomes cannot be quantied, consequences of alternative assumptions about
or if the events themselves are unpredictable, the future. Uncertainty analyses employing
some would say the problem is then one of probabilistic descriptions of model inputs can be
uncertainty, and not of risk. In this chapter what used to derive probability distributions of model
is not certain is considered uncertain, and outputs and system performance indices. Fig-
uncertainty is often estimated or described using ure 8.1 illustrates the impact of both input data
probability distributions. When the ranges of sensitivity and input data uncertainty on model
possible events are known and their probabilities output uncertainty.
are measurable, risk is called objective risk. If the It is worthwhile to explore the transformation of
probabilities are based solely on human judg- uncertainties in model inputs and parameters into
ment, the risk is called subjective risk. uncertainty in model outputs when conditions
Such distinctions between objective and sub- differ from those reflected by the model inputs.
jective risk, and between risk and uncertainty, Historical records of system characteristics are
rarely serve any useful purpose to those develop- typically used as a basis for model inputs. Yet
ing and using models. Likewise the distinctions conditions in the future may change. There may be
are often unimportant to those who should be changes in the frequency and amounts of precipi-
aware of the risks or uncertainties associated with tation, changes in land cover and topography, and
system performance indicator values. If the prob- changes in the design and operation of control
abilities associated with possible events or out- structures, all resulting in changes of water stages
comes are unknown, and especially if the events and flows, and their qualities, and consequently
themselves are unknown, then the approaches for changes in the impacted ecosystems.
8.2 Issues, Concerns, and Terminology 333

Fig. 8.1 Schematic diagram showing relationship among model input parameter uncertainty and sensitivity to model
output variable uncertainty (Lal 1995)

If asked how the system would operate with Clearly a sensitivity analysis needs to consider
inputs similar to those observed in the past, the how well a model can replicate current opera-
model should be able to provide a fairly precise tions, and how similar the target conditions or
estimate. Still that estimate will not be perfect. scenarios are to those that existed in the past. The
This is because our ability to reproduce current greater the required extrapolation from what has
and recent operations is not perfect, though it been observed, the greater will be the importance
should be fairly good. If asked to predict system of parameter and model uncertainties.
performance for situations very different from The relative and absolute importance of dif-
those in the past, or when the historical data are ferent parameters will depend on the system
not considered representative of what might performance indicators of interest. Seepage rates
happen in the future, say due to climate or may have a very large local effect, but a small
technology change, such predictions become global effect. Changes in system-wide evapo-
much less precise. There are two reasons why. transpiration rates will likely impact system-wide
First, our description of the characteristics of flows. The precision of model projections and the
those different situations or conditions may be relative importance of errors in different param-
imprecise. Second, our knowledge base may not eters will depend upon the:
be sufcient for calibrating model parameters in
ways that would enable us to reliably predict how (1) precision with which the model can repro-
the system will operate under conditions unlike duce observed conditions,
those that have been experienced historically. (2) difference between the conditions predicted
The more conditions of interest are unlike those in the future and the those that occurred in
in the past, the less condence we have that the the past, and the
model is providing a reliable description of sys- (3) system performance characteristics of
tems operation. Figure 8.2 illustrates this issue. interest.
334 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

Fig. 8.2 The precision of


model predictions is
affected by the difference
between the conditions or
scenarios of interest and the
conditions or scenarios for
which the model was
calibrated

Errors and approximations in input data gained and new information accumulates. When
measurement, parameter values, model structure predictions are highly unreliable, responsible
and model solution algorithms, are all sources of managers should favor actions that are robust
uncertainty. While there are reasonable ways of (e.g., good under a wide range of situations), gain
quantifying and reducing these errors and the information through research and experimenta-
resulting range of uncertainty of various system tion, monitor results to provide feedback for the
performance indicator values they are impossible next decision, update assessments and modify
to eliminate. Decisions will still have to be made policies in the light of new information, and
in the face of a risky and uncertain future. Some avoid irreversible actions and commitments.
decisions may be able to be modied as new data
and knowledge are obtained in a process of
adaptive management. 8.3 Variability and Uncertainty
There is also uncertainty with respect to in Model Output
human behavior and reaction related to particular
outcomes and their likelihoods, i.e., to their risks Differences between model output and observed
and uncertainties. As important as risks and values can result from either natural variability,
uncertainties associated with human reactions are say caused by unpredictable rainfall, evapotran-
to particular outcomes, they are not usually part spiration, water consumption, and the like, and/or
of the models themselves. Social uncertainty may by both known and unknown errors in the input
often be the most signicant component of the data, the model parameters, or the model itself.
total uncertainty associated with just how a water The later is sometimes called knowledge uncer-
resource system will perform. For this reason, we tainty but it is not always due to a lack of
should seek designs and operating policies that knowledge. Models are always simplications of
are flexible and adaptable. reality and hence imprecision can result.
When uncertainties associated with system Sometimes imprecision occurs because of a lack
operation under a new operating regime are of knowledge, such as just how much rainfall,
large, one should anticipate the need to make evapotranspiration and consumption will occur,
changes and improvements as experience is or just how a particular species will react to
8.3 Variability and Uncertainty in Model Output 335

various environmental and other habitat condi- particular set of goals or objectives will be con-
tions. Other times known errors are introduced sidered in the future and the relative importance
simply for practical reasons. of each of them.
Imperfect representation of processes in a Rather than contrasting knowledge uncer-
model constitutes model structural uncertainty. tainty versus natural variability versus decision
Imperfect knowledge of the values of parameters uncertainty, one can classify uncertainty in
associated with these processes constitutes model another way based on specic sources of uncer-
parameter uncertainty. Natural variability tainty, such as those listed below, and address
includes both temporal variability and spatial ways of identifying and dealing with each source
variability, to which model input values may be of uncertainty.
subject. Informational Uncertainties:
Figure 8.3 illustrates these different types of
uncertainty. For example, the rainfall measured imprecision in specifying the boundary and
at a weather station within a particular model grid initial conditions that impact the output vari-
cell may be used as an input value for that cell, able values
but the rainfall may actually vary at different imprecision in measuring observed output
points within that cell and its mean value will variable values
vary across the landscape. Knowledge uncer-
tainty can be reduced through further measure- Model Uncertainties:
ment and/or research. Natural variability is a
property of the natural system, and is usually not uncertain model structure and parameter
reducible. Decision uncertainty is simply an values
acknowledgement that we cannot predict ahead variability of observed input and output val-
of time just what decisions individuals and ues over a region smaller than the spatial
organizations will make, or even just what scale of the model

Fig. 8.3 One way of classifying types of uncertainty


336 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

variability of observed model input and out- Errors result if meteorological values are not
put values within a time smaller than the measured or recorded accurately, or if mistakes
temporal scale of the model. (e.g., rainfall and are made when creating computer data les.
depths and flows within a day) Furthermore, there is no assurance the statistical
errors in linking models of different spatial properties of historical data will accurately rep-
and temporal scales resent the statistical properties of future data.
Actual future precipitation and temperature sce-
Numerical Errors: narios will be different from those in the past, and
this difference in many cases may have a larger
errors in the model solution algorithm affect than the uncertainty due to incorrect
parameter values. However, the effects of uncer-
tainties in the parameter values used in stochastic
generation models are often much more signi-
8.3.1 Natural Variability cant than the effects of using different stochastic
generation models (Stedinger and Taylor 1982).
The main source of hydrologic model output While variability of model output is a direct
value variability is the natural variability in result of variability of model input (e.g., hydro-
hydrological and meteorological input series. logic and meteorological data), the extent of the
Periods of normal precipitation and temperature variability, and the lower and upper limits of that
can be interrupted by periods of extended variability, may also be affected by errors in the
drought and intense meteorological events such inputs, the values of parameters, initial boundary
as hurricanes and tornadoes. There is reason to conditions, model structure, processes and solu-
think such events will continue to occur and tion algorithms.
become even more frequent and extreme. Figure 8.4 illustrates the distinction between
Research has demonstrated that climate has been the variability of a system performance indicator
variable in the past and concerns about anthro- due to input data variability, and the extended
pogenic activities that may increase that vari- range of variability due to the total uncertainty
ability increase each year. Sensitivity analysis associated with any combination of the causes
can help assess the effect of errors in predictions listed in the previous section. This extended
if those predictions are based only on past range is what is of interest to water resource
records of historical time series data describing planners and managers.
precipitation, temperature, and other exogenous In practice a time series of system performance
forces in and on the border of the regions being indicator values can range anywhere within or
studied. even outside the extended range, assuming the
Time series input data are often actual, or at condence level of that extended range is less
least based on, historical data. The time series than 100%. The condence one can have that
values typically describe historical conditions some future value of a time series will be within a
including droughts and wet periods. What is given range is dependent on two factors. The rst
distinctive about natural uncertainty, as opposed is the number of measurements used to compute
to errors and uncertainty due to modeling limi- the condence limits. The second is on the
tations, is that natural variability in meteorolog- assumption that those measurements are repre-
ical forces cannot be reduced by improving the sentative ofcome from the same statistical or
models structure, increasing the resolution of the stochastic process yieldingfuture measure-
simulation, or by better calibration of model ments. Figure 8.5 illustrates this point. Note that
parameters. the time series may even contain values outside
8.3 Variability and Uncertainty in Model Output 337

Fig. 8.4 Time series of model output or system perfor- measurement, parameter value estimation, model structure
mance showing variability over time. Range a results and errors in model solution algorithms. The extent of this
from the natural variability of input data over time. The range will depend on the condence level associated with
extended range b results from the variability of natural that range
input data as well as from imprecision in input data

Fig. 8.5 Typical time series of model output or system measurement, parameter value estimation, model structure
performance indicator values that are the result of input and errors in model solution algorithms
data variability and possible imprecision in input data

the range b dened in Fig. 8.4 if the condence uncertainties. First, we consider parameter value
level of that range is less than 100%. Condence uncertainty including boundary condition uncer-
intervals associated with less than 100% certainty tainty, and then model and solution algorithm
will not include every possible value that might uncertainty.
occur. Furthermore, it is unlikely one will ever
know the 100% condent interval that includes 8.3.2.1 Parameter Value Uncertainty
all values that could ever occur. A possible source of uncertainty in model output
results from uncertain estimates of various model
parameter values. If the model calibration pro-
8.3.2 Knowledge Uncertainty cedure was repeated using different data sets, it
would have been resulted in different parameter
Referring to Fig. 8.3, knowledge uncertainty values. Those values would yield different sim-
includes model structure and parameter value ulated system behavior, and thus different
338 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

predictions. We can call this parameter uncer- goals, interests, activities, demands, and impacts.
tainty in the predictions because it is caused by An example of this is the deviation from standard
imprecise parameter values. If such parameter or published operating policies by operators of
value imprecision was eliminated, then the pre- infrastructure such as canal gates, pumps, and
diction would always be the same and so the reservoirs in the eld, as compared to what is
parameter value uncertainty in the predictions specied in documents and incorporated into the
would be zero. But this does not mean that pre- water systems models. Comparing eld data with
dictions would be perfectly accurate. model data for model calibration may yield
In addition to parameter value imprecision, incorrect calibrations if operating policies actu-
uncertainty in model output can result from ally implemented in the eld differ signicantly
imprecise specication of boundary conditions. from those built into the models. What do oper-
These boundary conditions can be either xed or ators do in times of stress? And can anyone
variable. However, because they are not being identify a place where deviations from published
computed based on the state of the system, their policies do not occur? Policies implemented in
values can be uncertain. These uncertainties can practice tend to address short-term changes in
affect the model output, especially in the vicinity policy objectives.
of the boundary, in each time step of the What humans will want to achieve in the
simulation. future may not be the same as what they want
today. Predictions of what people will want in
8.3.2.2 Model Structural the future are clearly sources of uncertainty.
and Computational Errors A perfect example of this is in the very flat
Uncertainty in model output can also result from Greater Everglades region of south Florida in the
errors in the model structure compared to the real US. Sixty years ago, folks wanted the swampy
system, and approximations made by numerical region protected from floods and drained for
methods employed in the simulation. No matter agricultural and urban development. Today,
how good our parameter value estimates, our many want just the opposite at least where there
models are not perfect and there is a residual are no human settlements. They want a return to
model error. Increasing model complexity to a more natural hydrologic system with more
more closely represent the complexity of the real wetlands and unobstructed flows, but now for
system may not only add to the cost of data ecological restoration objectives that were not a
collection, but also introduce even more param- major concern or much appreciated half a century
eters, and thus even more potential sources of ago. Once the mosquitoes return and if the sea
error in model output. It is not an easy task to level continues to rise, future populations who
judge the appropriate level of model complexity, live there may want more flood control and
and to estimate the resulting levels of uncertainty drainage again. Who knows? Complex changing
associated with various assumptions regarding social and economic processes influence human
model structure and solution methods. Kuczera activities and their demands for water resources
(1988) provides an example of a conceptual and environmental amenities over time.
hydrologic modeling exercise with daily time Sensitivity scenarios that include human
steps where model uncertainty dominated activities can help dene the effects of those
parameter value uncertainty. human activities within an area. It is important
that these alternative scenarios realistically cap-
ture the forces or stresses that the system may
8.3.3 Decision Uncertainty face. The history of systems studies is full of
examples where the issues studied were rapidly
Uncertainty in model predictions can result from overwhelmed by much larger social forces
unanticipated changes in what is being modeled. resulting from, for example, the relocation of
These can include changes in nature, human major economic activities, an oil embargo,
8.3 Variability and Uncertainty in Model Output 339

changes in national demand for natural resources, 8.4.1 Uncertainty Analyses


economic recession, sea-level rise, an act of ter-
rorism, or even war. One thing is sure: the future Recall that uncertainty involves the notion of
will be different than the past, and no one can be randomness. If a value of a performance indica-
certain just how. tor or performance measure, or in fact any vari-
able (like the phosphorus concentration or the
8.3.3.1 Surprises depth of water at a particular location) varies and
Water resource managers may also want to this variation over space and time cannot be
consider how vulnerable a system is to undesir- predicted with certainty, it is called a random
able environmental surprises. What havoc might variable. One cannot say with certainty what the
an introduced species like the zebra mussel value of a random variable will be but only the
invading the Great Lakes of North America have likelihood or probability that it will be within
in a particular watershed? Might some introduced some specied range of values. The probabilities
disease suddenly threaten key plant or animal of observing particular ranges of values of a
species? Might management plans have to be random variable are described or dened by a
restructured to address the survival of some probability distribution. Here we are assuming
species such as salmon in the Rhine River in we know, or can compute, or can estimate, this
Europe or in the Columbia River in North distribution.
America? Such uncertainties are hard to antici- Suppose the random variable is X. If the
pate when by their nature they are truly surprises. observed values of this random variable can be
But surprises should be expected. Hence system only discrete values, the probability distribution
flexibility and adaptability should be sought to of X can be expressed as a histogram, as shown
deal with changing management demands, in Fig. 8.6a. The sum of the probabilities for all
objectives, and constraints. possible outcomes must equal 1. If the random
variable is a continuous variable that can assume
any real value over a range of values, the prob-
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty ability distribution of X can be expressed as a
Analyses continuous distribution as shown in Fig. 8.6b.
The shaded area under the density function for
An uncertainty analysis is not the same as a the continuous distribution is 1. The area
sensitivity analysis. An uncertainty analysis between two values of the continuous random
attempts to describe the entire set of possible variable, such as between u and v in Fig. 8.6c,
outcomes, together with their associated proba- represents the probability that the observed value
bilities of occurrence. A sensitivity analysis x of the random variable value X will be within
attempts to determine the relative change in that range of values.
model output values given modest changes in The probability distribution, PX(x) shown in
model input values. A sensitivity analysis thus Fig. 8.6a is called a probability mass function.
measures the change in the model output in a The probability distributions shown in Fig. 8.6b,
localized region of the space of inputs. However, c are called probability density functions
one can often use the same set of model runs for (pdf) and are denoted by fX(x). The subscript X of
both uncertainty analyses and sensitivity analy- PX and fX represents the random variable, and the
ses. It is possible to carry out a sensitivity analysis variable x (on the horizontal axes in Fig. 8.6) is
of the model around a current solution and then some value of that random variable X.
use it as part of a rst-order uncertainty analysis. Uncertainty analyses involve identifying
This discussion begins by focusing on some characteristics of various probability distributions
methods of uncertainty analysis. Then various of model input and output variables, and subse-
ways of performing and displaying sensitivity quently functions of those random output
analyses are reviewed. variables that are performance indicators or
340 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

(a) (b) (c)

Fig. 8.6 Probability distributions for a discrete or con- c is the probability that the observed value x of the
tinuous random variable X. The area under the distribu- random variable X will be between u and v
tions (shaded areas in a and b) is 1, and the shaded area in

measures. Often targets associated with exceeding a performance measure target (e.g., a
these indicators or measures are themselves pollutant concentration standard) introduces a
uncertain. conflict where a tradeoff must be made.
A complete uncertainty analysis would
involve a comprehensive identication of all 8.4.1.1 Model and Model Parameter
sources of uncertainty that contribute to the joint Uncertainties
probability distributions of each input or output Consider a situation as shown in Fig. 8.8, in
variable. Assume such analyses were performed which for a specic set of model inputs, the
for two alternative project plans, A and B, and model outputs differ from the observed values,
that the resulting probability density distributions and for those model inputs, the observed values
for a specied performance measure were as are always the same. Here nothing randomly
shown in Fig. 8.7. Figure 8.7 also identies the occurs. The model parameter values or model
costs of these two projects. The introduction of structure needs to be changed. This is typically
two performance criteria, cost and probability of done in a model calibration process.

Fig. 8.7 Tradeoffs


involving cost and the
probability that a maximum
desired target value will be
exceeded. In this
illustration, we want the
lowest cost (B is best) and
the lowest probability of
exceedance (A is best)
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses 341

Fig. 8.8 A deterministic system and a simulation model of that system needing calibration or modication in its
structure. There is no randomness, only parameter value or model structure errors to be identied and if found, corrected

Given specic inputs, the outputs of deter- If a model calibration or identication exer-
ministic models are always going to be the same cise nds the best values of the parameters to be
each time those inputs are simulated. If for outside reasonable ranges of values based on sci-
specied inputs to any simulation model the entic knowledge, then the model structure or
predicted output does not agree with the algorithm might be in error. Assuming the algo-
observed value, as shown in Fig. 8.8, this could rithms used to solve the models are correct and
result from imprecision in the measurement of observed measurements of system performance
observed data. It could also result from impre- vary for the same model inputs, as shown in
cision in the model parameter values, the model Fig. 8.9, it can be assumed that the model structure
structure, or the algorithm used to solve the does not capture all the processes that are taking
model. place and that impact the value of the performance
Next consider the same deterministic simula- measures. This is often the case when relatively
tion model but now assume at least some of the simple and low-resolution models are used to
inputs are random, i.e., not predictable, as may estimate the hydrological and ecological impacts
be case when random outputs of one model are of water and land management policies. However,
used as inputs into another model. Random even large and complex models can fail to include
inputs will yield random outputs. The model or adequately describe important phenomena.
input and output values can be described by In the presence of informational uncertainties,
probability distributions. If the uncertainty in the there may be considerable uncertainty about the
output is due only to the uncertainty in the input, values of the best parameters during calibra-
the situation is similar to that shown in Fig. 8.8. tion. This problem becomes even more pro-
If the distribution of performance measure output nounced with increases in model complexity.
values does not t or is not identical to the dis- An example: Consider the prediction of a pollutant
tribution of observed performance measure val- concentration at some site downstream of a pol-
ues, then calibration of model parameter values lutant discharge site. Given a streamflow Q (in
or modication of model structure may be units of 1000 m3/day), the distance between the
discharge site and the monitoring site, X (m), the
needed.
342 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

Fig. 8.9 A deterministic simulation model of a random may need to vary over distributions of values and/or the
or stochastic system. To produce the variability in the model structure may need modication along with
model output that is observed in the real system, even additional model inputs
given the same input values, the models parameter values

pollutant decay rate constant k (day1), and the the assumed parameter distribution of k was simply
pollutant discharge W (kg/day), we can use the the result of the distribution of streamflow tem-
following simplied model to predict the concen- peratures on the term kT20.
tration of the pollutant C (g/m3 = mg/l) at the
downstream monitoring site: If the output were still random given constant
values of all the inputs, then another source of
C W=QexpfkX=U g uncertainty exists. This uncertainty might be due to
additional random loadings of the pollutant, pos-
sibly from nonpoint sources. Once again the model
In the above equation assume the velocity could be modied to include these additional
U (m/day) is a known function of the streamflow Q. loadings if they are knowable. Assuming these
additional loadings are not known, a new random
In this case the observed value of the pollutant parameter could be added to the input variable
concentration C may differ from the computed W or to the right hand side of the equations above
value of C even for the same inputs of W, Q, k, X, that would attempt to capture the impact on C of
and U. Furthermore, this difference varies in dif- these additional loadings. A potential problem,
ferent time periods. This apparent variability, as however, might be the likely correlation between
illustrated in Fig. 8.9, can be simulated using the those additional loadings and the streamflow Q.
same model but by assuming a distribution of
values for the decay rate constant k. Alternatively While adding model detail removed some
the model structure can be modied to include the uncertainty in the above example, increasing
impact of streamflow temperature T on the pre-
diction of C.
model complexity will not always eliminate
or reduce uncertainty in model output. Adding
C W=QexpfkhT20 X=U g complexity is generally not a good idea when
the increased complexity is based on pro-
Now there are two model parameters, the decay cesses whose parameters are difcult to mea-
rate constant k and the dimensionless temperature sure, the right equations are not known at the
correction factor , and an additional model input,
the streamflow temperature, T. It could be that the scale of application, or the amount of data for
variation in streamflow temperature was the sole calibration is small compared to the number of
cause of the rst equations uncertainty and that parameters.
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses 343

Even if more detailed models requiring more considerable investments of money and time for
input data and more parameter values were to be data preparation and model calibration.
developed, the likelihood of capturing all the What is needed is a way to predict the vari-
processes occurring in a complex system is small. ability evident in the system shown in Fig. 8.9.
Hence those involved will have to make decisions Instead of a xed output vector for each xed
taking this uncertainty into account. Imprecision input vector, a distribution of outputs is needed
will always exist due to less than a complete for each performance measure based on xed
understanding of the system and the hydrologic inputs (Fig. 8.9) or a distribution of inputs
processes being modeled. A number of studies (Fig. 8.10). Furthermore, the model output dis-
have addressed model simplication, but only in tribution for each performance measure should
some simple cases have statisticians been able to match as well as possible the observed distri-
identify just how one might minimize model bution of that performance measure.
output uncertainty due to model structure.
The problem of determining the optimal 8.4.1.2 What Uncertainty Analysis Can
level of modeling detail is particularly important Provide
when simulating the hydrologic events at many An uncertainty analysis takes a set of randomly
sites over large areas. Perhaps the best approach chosen input values (that can include parameter
for these simulations is to establish condence values), passes them through a model (or transfer
levels for alternative sets of models and then function) to obtain the distributions (or statistical
statistically compare simulation results. But even measures of the distributions) of the resulting
this is not a trivial or costless task. Increases in outputs. As illustrated in Fig. 8.11, the output
the temporal or spatial resolution typically distributions can be used to
require considerable data collection and/or pro-
cessing, model recalibrations, and possibly the Describe the range of potential outputs of the
solution of stability problems resulting from the system at some probability level.
numerical methods used in the models. Obtain- Estimate the probability that the output will
ing and implementing alternative hydrologic exceed a specic threshold or performance
simulation models will typically involve measure target value.

Fig. 8.10 Simulating variable inputs to obtain probability distributions of predicted performance indices that match the
probability distributions of observed performance values
344 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

Fig. 8.11 The distribution of performance measures probability that the target value will be exceeded. This
denes range of potential values and the likelihood that probability is shown in the probability of exceedance plot
a specied target value will be exceeded. The shaded area on the right
under the density function on the left represents the

Common uses for uncertainty analyses are to when used to assess system performance for
make general inferences, such as the following: alternative scenarios, as well as detailed infor-
mation addressing the relative signicance of
Estimating the mean and standard deviation errors in various parameters. As a result, sensi-
of the outputs. tivity results should be of interest to the general
Estimating the probability the performance public, federal and state management agencies,
measure will exceed a specic threshold. local watershed planners and managers, model
Putting a reliability level on a function of the users, and model developers.
outputs, e.g., the range of function values that Clearly, upper level management and the
is likely to occur with some probability. public may be interested in more general state-
Describing the likelihood of different poten- ments of model precision, and should be pro-
tial outputs of the system. vided such information along with model
predictions. On the other hand, detailed studies
Implicit in any uncertainty analysis are the addressing the signicance and interactions
assumptions that statistical distributions for the among individual parameters would likely be
input values are correct and that the model is a meaningful to model developers and some model
sufciently realistic description of the processes users. They can use such data to interpret model
taking place in the system. Neither of these results and to identify where efforts to improve
assumptions is likely to be entirely correct. models and their input values should be directed.
Initial sensitivity analysis studies could focus
on two products:
8.4.2 Sensitivity Analyses
(1) detailed results to guide research and assist
Sensitivity analysis is aimed at describing how model development efforts, and
much model output values are affected by chan- (2) calculation of general descriptions of uncer-
ges in model input values. It is the investigation tainty associated with model predictions so
of the importance of imprecision or uncertainty that policy decisions can reflect both the
in model inputs in a decision-making or model- predicted system performance and the pre-
ing process. The exact character of sensitivity cision of such predictions.
analysis depends upon the particular context and
the questions of concern. Sensitivity studies can In the rst case, knowing the relative uncer-
provide a general assessment of model precision tainty in model projections due to possible errors
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses 345

in different sets of parameters and input data values of a particular output variable or perfor-
should assist in efforts to improve the precision mance indicator at a particular location and time.
of model projections. This knowledge should If the range of uncertainty of only some of the
also contribute to a better understanding of the output data is of interest, then undoubtedly only
relationships between model assumptions, those input data that signicantly impact the
parameters, data and model predictions. values of those output data need be included in
For the second case, knowing the relative the sensitivity analysis.
precision associated with model predictions If input data estimates are based on repeated
should have a signicant effect on policy devel- measurements, a frequency distribution can be
opment. For example, the analysis may show estimated that characterizes input data variability.
that, given data inadequacies, there are very large The shorter the record of measurements, the
error bands associated with some model variable greater will be the uncertainty regarding the
values. When such large uncertainties exist, long-term statistical characteristics of that vari-
predictions should be used with appropriate ability. If obtaining a sufcient number of repli-
skepticism. Incremental strategies should be cate measurements is not possible, subjective
explored along with monitoring so that greater estimates of input data ranges and probability
experience can accumulate to resolve some of distributions are often made. Using a mixture of
those uncertainties. subjective estimates and actual measurements
Sensitivity analysis features are available in does not affect the application of various sensi-
many linear and nonlinear programming (opti- tivity analysis methods that can use these sets or
mization) packages. They identify the changes in distributions of input values, but it may affect the
the values of the objective function and unknown conclusions that can be drawn from the results of
decision variables given a change in the model these analyses.
input values, and a change in levels set for var- It would be nice to have available accurate
ious constraints (Chap. 4). Thus sensitivity and easy-to-use analytical methods for relating
analysis addresses the change in optimal sys- errors in input data to errors in model outputs,
tem performance associated with changes in and to errors in system performance indicator
various parameter values, and also how opti- values that are derived from model outputs. Such
mal decisions would change with changes in analytical methods do not exist for complex
resource constraint levels, or target output simulation models. However, methods based on
requirements. This kind of sensitivity analysis simplifying assumptions and approximations can
provides estimates of how much another unit of be used to yield useful sensitivity information.
resource would be worth, or what cost a pro- Some of these are reviewed in the remainder of
posed change in a constraint places on the opti- this chapter.
mal solution. This information should be of value
to those making investment decisions. 8.4.2.1 Sensitivity Coefficients
Various techniques have been developed to One measure of sensitivity is the sensitivity
determine how sensitive model outputs are to coefcient. This is the derivative of a model
changes in model inputs. Most approaches output variable with respect to an input variable
examine the effects of changes in a single or parameter. A number of sensitivity analysis
parameter value or input variable assuming no methods use these coefcients. First-order and
changes in all the other inputs. Sensitivity anal- approximate rst-order sensitivity analyses are
yses can be extended to examine the combined two such methods that will be discussed later.
effects of multiple sources of error as well. The difculty of
Changes in particular model input values can
affect model output values in different ways. It is 1. obtaining the derivatives for many models,
generally true that only a relatively few input 2. needing to assume mathematical (usually
variables dominate or substantially influence the linear) relationships when obtaining estimates
346 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

of derivatives by making small changes of A dimensionless expression of sensitivity is


input data values near their nominal or most the elasticity index, EIPQ that measures the rel-
likely values, and ative change in output Q for a relative change in
3. having large variances associated with most input P.
hydrologic process models have motivated
the replacement of analytical methods by EIPQ Po =QPo SIPQ 8:4
numerical and statistical approaches to sen-
sitivity analysis.
8.4.2.2 A Simple Deterministic
By varying the input probability distributions, Sensitivity Analysis
one can determine the sensitivity of these distri- Procedure
butions on the output distributions. If the output This deterministic sensitivity analysis approach
distributions vary signicantly, then the output is is very similar to those most often employed in
sensitive to the specication of the input distri- the engineering economics literature. It is based
butions and hence they should be dened with on the idea of varying one uncertain parameter
care. A relatively simple deterministic sensitivity value, or set of parameter values, at a time, and
analysis can be of value here (Benaman 2002). observing the results.
A sensitivity coefcient can be used to measure The output variable of interest can be any
the magnitude of change in an output variable performance measure or indicator. Thus one does
Q per unit change in the magnitude of an input not know if more or less of a given variable is
parameter value P from its base value Po. Let better or worse. Perhaps too much and/or too
SIPQ be the sensitivity index for an output vari- little is undesirable. The key idea is that, whether
able Q with respect to a change P in the value employing physical measures or economic met-
of the input variable P from its base value Po. rics of performance, various parameters (or sets
Noting that the value of the output Q(P) is a of associated parameters) are assigned high and
function of P, a sensitivity index could be low values. Such ranges may reflect either the
dened as differences between the minimum and maximum
values for each parameter, the 5 and 95 per-
SIPQ QPo DP  QPo  DP=2DP centiles of a parameters distribution, or points
8:1 corresponding to some other criteria. The system
model is then run with the various alternatives,
Other sensitivity indices could be dened one at a time, to evaluate the impact of those
(McCuen 1973). Let the index i represent a errors in various sets of parameter values on the
decrease and j represent an increase in the output variable.
parameter value from its base value Po, the sen- Table 8.1 illustrates the character of the
sitivity index SIPQ for parameter P and output results that one would obtain. Here Y0 is the
variable Q could be dened as nominal value of the model output when all
parameters assume the estimated best values, and
SIPQ fjQo  Qi =Po Yi,L and Yi,H are the values obtained by increasing
  or decreasing the values of the ith set of
Pi j j Qo  Qj =Po  Pj jg=2 8:2 parameters.
A simple water quality example is employed
or to illustrate this deterministic approach to sensi-
tivity analysis. The analysis techniques illustrated
SIPQ maxfjQo  Qi =Po here are just as applicable to complex models.
    The primary difference is that more work would
Pi j;  Qo  Qj = Po  Pj g 8:3 be required to evaluate the various alternatives
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses 347

Table 8.1 Sensitivity of model output Y to possible Data for Lake Ontario in North America
errors in four parameter sets containing a single parameter would suggest that reasonable values of the
or a group of parameters that vary together
parameters are L = 680 mg/m2a; q = 10.6 m/a;
and z = 84 m, yielding P = 16.8 mg/m3. Values
of phosphorus concentrations less than 10 mg/m3
are considered oligotrophic, whereas values
greater than 20 mg/m3 generally correspond to
eutrophic conditions. Reasonable ranges reflect-
ing possible errors in the three parameters yield
the values in Table 8.2.
One may want to display these results so they
can be readily visualized and understood. A tor-
nado diagram (Eschenback 1992) would show
the lower and upper values of P obtained from
variation of each parameter, with the parameter
with the widest limits displayed on top, and the
with a more complex model, and the model re- parameter having smallest limits on the bottom.
sponses might be more complicated. Tornado diagrams (Fig. 8.12) are easy to con-
The simple water quality model is provided struct and can include a large number of
by Vollenweiders empirical relationship for the parameters without becoming crowded.
average phosphorus concentration in lakes These error bars shown in Fig. 8.12 indicate
(Vollenweider 1976). He found that the phos- there is substantial uncertainty associated with
phorus concentration, P (mg/m3), is a function of the phosphorus concentration P, primarily due to
the annual phosphorus loading rate, L (mil- uncertainty in the loading rate L.
ligrams per square meter per year, mg/m2 a), the An alternative to tornado diagrams is a Pareto
annual hydraulic loading, q (m/a or more exactly chart showing the width of the uncertainty range
m3/m2 a), and the mean water depth, z (m). associated with each variable, ordered from lar-
h i gest to smallest. A Pareto chart is illustrated in
P L=q= 1 z=q0:5 8:5 Fig. 8.13.
Another visual presentation is a spider plot
L/q and P have the same units; the denominator showing the impact of uncertainty in each
is an empirical factor that compensates for parameter on the variable in question, all on the
nutrient recycling and elimination within the same graph (Eschenback 1992; DeGarmo 1993,
aquatic lake environment. p. 401). A spider plot, Fig. 8.14, shows the

Table 8.2 Sensitivity of estimates of phosphorus concentration (mg/m3) to model parameter values

The two right most values in each row correspond to the low and high values of the parameter, respectively
348 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

Fig. 8.12 A Tornado diagram showing the range of the Parameters are sorted so that the largest range is on top,
output variable representing phosphorus concentrations and the smallest on the bottom
for high and low values of each of the parameter sets.

Fig. 8.13 A Pareto Chart showing the range of the output variable representing phosphorus concentrations resulting
from high and low values of each parameter set considered

Fig. 8.14 Spider Plot


illustrates the relationships
between phosphorus
concentrations and
variations in each of the
parameter sets, expressed
as a percentage deviation
from their nominal values
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses 349

particular functional response of the output to investigated. However, one immediately runs
each parameter on a common scale, so one needs into a combinatorial problem. If each of m pa-
a common metric to represent changes in all of rameters can have three values (high, nominal,
the parameters. Here we use percentage change and low) there are 3m combinations, as opposed
from the nominal or best values. to 2m + 1 if each parameter is varied separately.
Spider plots are a little harder to construct [For m = 5, the differences are 35 = 243 versus 2
than tornado diagrams, and can generally include (5) + 1 = 11.] These numbers can be reduced by
only 45 variables without becoming crowded. considering instead only combinations of
However, they provide a more complete view of extremes so that only 2m + 1 cases need be
the relationships between each parameter and the considered [25 + 1 = 33], which is a more
performance measure. In particular, a spider plot manageable number. However, all of the
reveals nonlinear relationships and the relative parameters would be at one extreme or the other,
sensitivity of the performance measure to (per- and such situations would be unlikely.
centage) changes in each variable. Two factors at a time. A compromise is to
In the spider plot, the linear relationship consider all pairs of two parameters at a time.
between P and L and the gentle nonlinear rela- There are m(m 1)/2 possible pairs of m
tionship between P and q is illustrated. The range parameters. Each parameter has a high and low
for z has been kept small given the limited value. Since there are four combinations of high
uncertainty associated with that parameter. and low values for each pair, there are a total of
2m(m 1) combinations. [For m = 5 there are
8.4.2.3 Multiple Errors and Interactions 40 combinations of two parameters each having
An important issue that should not be ignored is two values.]
the impact of simultaneous errors in more than The presentation of these results could be
one parameter. Probabilistic methods directly simplied by displaying for each case only the
address the occurrence of simultaneous errors, maximum error, which would result in m
but the correct joint distribution needs to be (m 1)/2 cases that might be displayed in a
employed. With simple sensitivity analysis pro- Pareto diagram. This would allow identication
cedures, errors in parameters are generally of those combinations of two parameters that
investigated one at a time, or in groups. The idea might yield the largest errors and thus are of most
of considering pairs or sets of parameters is concern.
discussed here. For the water quality example, if one plots the
Groups of factors. It is often the case that absolute value of the error for all four combina-
reasonable error scenarios would have several tions of high (+) and low () values for each pair
parameters changing together. For example, of parameters, they obtain Fig. 8.15.
possible errors in water depth would be accom- Considering only the worst error for each pair
panied with corresponding variations in aquatic of variables yields Fig. 8.16.
vegetation and chemical parameters. Likewise, Here we see, as is no surprise, the worst error
alternatives related to changes in model structure results from the most unfavorable combination of
might be accompanied with variations in several L and q values. If both parameters have their
parameters. In other cases, there may be no most unfavorable values, the predicted phos-
causal relationship among possible errors (such phorus concentration would be 27 mg/m3.
as model structure versus inflows at the boundary Looking for nonlinearities. One might also
of the modeled region), but they might still display in a Pareto diagram the maximum error
interact to affect the precision of model for each pair as a percentage of the sum of the
predictions. absolute values of the maximum error from each
Combinations. If one or more non-grouped parameter separately. The ratio of the joint error
parameters interact in signicant ways, then to the individual errors would illustrate poten-
combinations of one or more errors should be tially important nonlinear interactions. If the
350 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

Fig. 8.15 Pareto diagram showing errors in phosphorus indicates a low value for indicated parameter. L is the
concentrations for all combinations of pairs of input phosphorus loading rate, q is the hydraulic loading, and
parameters errors. A + indicates a high value, and a z is the mean lake depth

Fig. 8.16 Pareto diagram


showing worst error
combinations for each pair
of input parameters. A +
indicates a high value, and
a indicates a low value
for indicated parameter

model of the system and the physical measure or a given performance indicator, one can use
economic metric were strictly linear, then the multivariate linear analyses to evaluate the
individual ratios should add to one. approximate impact on the performance indices
of uncertainty in various parameters. As shown
8.4.2.4 First-Order Sensitivity Analysis below, the impact depends upon the square of the
The above deterministic analysis has trouble sensitivity coefcients (partial derivatives) and
representing reasonable combinations of errors in the variances and covariances of the parameter
several parameter sets. If the errors are inde- sets.
pendent, it is highly unlikely that any two sets For a performance indicator I = F(Y), which
would actually be at their extreme ranges at the is a function F() of model outputs Y, that are in
same time. By dening probability distributions turn a function g(P) of input parameters P, one
of the values of the various parameter sets, and can use a multivariate Taylor series approxima-
specifying their joint distributions, a probabilistic tion of F to obtain the expected value and vari-
error analysis can be conducted. In particular, for ance of the indicator:
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses 351

EI  F based on mean values of input parameters Benjamin and Cornell (1970). Equation 8.6
XX
1=2 @F2 =@Pi @Pj  Cov Pi ; Pj g for E[I] shows that in the presence of substantial
i j uncertainty, the mean of the output from non-
8:6 linear systems is not simply the system output
corresponding to the mean of the parameters
and (Gaven and Burges 1981, p. 1523). This is true
XX     for any nonlinear function.
VarI  @F=@Pi @F=@Pj Cov Pi ; Pj Of interest in the analysis of uncertainty is the
i j approximation for the variance Var[I] of indica-
8:7 tor I. In Eq. 8.10 the contribution of Pi to the
variance of I equals Var[Pi] times [F/Pi]2,
where (F/Pi) are the partial derivative of the which are the squares of the sensitivity coef-
function F with respect to Pi evaluated at the cients for indicator I with respect to each input
mean value of the input parameters Pi, and F2/ parameter value Pi.
PiPj are the second partial derivatives. The
covariance of two random input parameters Pi An Example of First-Order Sensitivity Analysis
and Pj is the expected value of the product of It may appear that rst-order analysis is difcult
differences between the values and their means. because the partial derivatives of the perfor-
  mance indicator I are needed with respect to the
Cov Pi ; Pj EPi  EPi Pj  EPj  various parameters. However, reasonable
8:8 approximations of these sensitivity coefcients
can be obtained from the simple sensitivity
If all the parameters are independent of each analysis described in Table 8.3. In that table,
other, and the second-order terms in the expres- three different parameter sets, Pi, are dened in
sion for the mean E[I] are neglected, one obtains which one parameter of the set is at its high
value, PiH, and one is at its low value, PiL, to
EI  F based on mean values of input parameters produce corresponding values (called high, IiH,
8:9 and low, IiL) of a system performance indicator I.
It is then necessary to estimate some repre-
and sentation of the variances of the various param-
X   eters with some consistent procedure. For a
Var I  @F=@Pi 2 Var Pi  8:10 normal distribution, the distance between the 5
i
and 95 percentiles is 1.645 standard deviations

Table 8.3 Approximate parameter sensitivity coefcients


352 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

on each side of the mean, or 2(1.645) = 3.3 phosphorus concentration P is associated in the
standard deviations. Thus, if the high/low range phosphorus loading rate L and the remaining
is thought of as approximately a 595 percentile 24% is associated with the hydrologic loading
range for a normally distributed variate, a rea- q. Eliminating the uncertainty in z would have a
sonable approximation of the variance might be negligible impact on the overall model error.
Likewise, reducing the error in q would at best
VarPi  fPiH  PiL =3:3g2 : 8:11 have a modest impact on the total error.
Due to these uncertainties, the estimated
This is all that is needed. Use of these average phosphorus concentration has a standard devia-
sensitivity coefcients is very reasonable for tion of 3.48. Assuming the errors are normally
modeling the behavior of the system perfor- distributed, and recalling that 1.645 standard
mance indicator I over the indicated ranges. deviations around the mean dene a 595 per-
As an illustration of the method of rst-order centile interval, the 595 percentile interval
uncertainty analysis, consider the lake quality would be about
problem described above. The system perfor-
mance indicator in this case is the model output, 16:8  1:6453:48mg=m3 16:8  5:7 mg=m3
the phosphorus concentration P, and the input 11:1 to 22:5 mg=m3 :
parameters, now denoted as X = L, q, and z. The 8:13
standard deviation of each parameter is assumed
to be the specied range divided by 3.3. Average The upper bound of 22.5 mg/m3 is consider-
sensitivity coefcients P/X were calculated. ably less than the 27 mg/m3 that would be
The results are reported in Table 8.4. obtained if both L and q had their most unfavorable
Assuming the parameter errors are values. In a probabilistic analysis with indepen-
independent: dent errors, such a combination is highly unlikely.

VarP 9:18 2:92 0:02 12:12 8:12 Warning on Accuracy


First-order uncertainty analysis is indeed an
The square root of 12.12 is the standard approximate method based upon a linearization
deviation and equals 3.48. This agrees well with of the response function represented by the full
a Monte Carlo analysis reported below. simulation model. It may provide inaccurate
Note that 100 * (9.18/12.12), or about 76% of estimates of the variance of the response variable
the total parameter error variance in the for nonlinear systems with large uncertainty in

Table 8.4 Calculation of approximate parameter sensitivity coefcients


8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses 353

the parameters. In such cases, Monte Carlo variable or parameter were allowed to provide a
simulation (discussed below and in the previous more reasonable description of a continuous
chapter) or the use of higher order approximation variable, the three-input data problem would
may be required. Beck (1987, p. 1426) cites require 43 or 64 simulation runs. Clearly, this is not
studies that found that Monte Carlo and a useful tool for large regional water resources
rst-order variances were not appreciably differ- simulation models.
ent, and a few studies that found specic differ- A fractional factorial design involves simu-
ences. Differences are likely to arise when the lating only a fraction of what is required from a
distributions used for the parameters are bimodal full factorial design method. The loss of infor-
(or otherwise unusual), or some rejection algo- mation prevents a complete analysis of the
rithm is used in the Monte Carlo analysis to impacts of each input variable or parameter on
exclude some parameter combinations. Such the output.
errors can result in a distortion in the ranking of To illustrate the fractional factorial design
predominant sources of uncertainty. However, in method, consider the two-level with three-input
most cases very similar results were obtained. variable or parameter problem. Table 8.5 shows
the 8 simulations required for a full factorial
8.4.2.5 Fractional Factorial Design design method. The + and the show the
Method upper and lower levels of each input variable or
An extension of rst-order sensitivity analysis parameter Pi where i = 1, 2, 3. If all eight sim-
would be a more complete exploration of the ulations were performed, seven possible effects
response surface using a careful statistical design. could be estimated. These are the individual
First consider a complete factorial design. Input effects of the three inputs P1, P2, and P3, the
data are divided into discrete levels. The sim- three two-input variable or parameter interac-
plest case is two levels. These two levels can be tions, (P1)(P2), (P1)(P3), and (P2)(P3), and the
dened as a nominal value, and a high (low) value. one three-input variable or parameter interaction
Simulation runs are made for all combinations of (P1)(P2)(P3).
parameter levels. For n different inputs, this would Consider an output variable Y, where Yj is the
require 2n simulation runs. Hence for a three-input value of Y in the jth simulation run. Then an
variable or parameter problem, 8 runs would be estimate of the effect, denoted (Y|Pi) that input
required. If four discrete levels of each input variable or parameter Pi has on the output

Table 8.5 A three-input factorial design


354 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

variable Y, is the average of the four separate dYjP3 dYjP1 ; P2


effects of varying Pi: 0:5fY8  Y3  Y2  Y5 g 8:18
For i = 1:
The separate effects of P3 and of P1P2 are not
dYjP1 0:25Y2  Y1 Y4  Y3
available from the output. This is the loss in
Y6  Y5 Y8  Y7  8:14 information resulting from fractional instead of
complete factorial design.
Each difference in parentheses is the difference
between a run in which P1 is at its upper level and 8.4.2.6 Monte Carlo Sampling Methods
a run in which P1 is at its lower level, but the other The Monte Carlo method of performing sensi-
two parameter values, P2 and P3, are unchanged. tivity analyses, illustrated in Fig. 8.17, rst
If the effect is equal to 0, then, in this case, P1 has selects a random set of input data values drawn
no impact on the output variable Y. from their individual probability distributions.
Similarly the effects of P2 and P3, on variable These values are then used in the simulation
Y can be estimated as: model to obtain some model output variable
values. This process is repeated many times, each
d YjP2 0:25fY3  Y1 Y4  Y2 time making sure the model calibration is valid
for the input data values chosen. The end result is
Y7  Y5 Y8  Y6 g 8:15 a probability distribution of model output vari-
ables and system performance indices that results
and from variations and possible errors in all of the
input values.
dYjP3 0:25fY5  Y1 Y6  Y2
Using a simple Monte Carlo analysis, values
Y7  Y3 Y8  Y4 g 8:16 of all of the parameter sets are selected randomly
from distributions describing the individual and
Consider next the interaction effects between joint uncertainty in each, and then the modeled
P1 and P2. This is estimated as the average of the system is simulated to obtain estimates of the
difference between the average P1 effect at the selected performance indices. This must be done
upper level of P2, and the average P1 effect at the many times (often well over 100) to obtain a
lower level of P2. This is the same as the dif- statistically signicant description of system
ference between the average P2 effect at the performance variability. The number of replica-
upper level of P1 and the average P2 effect at the tions needed is generally not dependent on the
lower level of P1: number of parameters whose errors are to be
analyzed. One can include in the simulation the
dYjP1 ; P2 1=2fY8  Y7 Y4  Y3 =2 uncertainty in parameters as well as natural
Y2  Y1 Y6  Y5 =2g 1=4fY8  Y6 variability. This method can evaluate the impact
Y4  Y2   Y3  Y1 Y7  Y5 g of single or multiple uncertain parameters.
8:17 A signicant problem that arises in such
simulations is that some combinations of
Similar equations can be derived for looking parameter values may result in unreasonable
at the interaction effects between P1 and P3, and models. For example, model output based on
between P2 and P3 and the interaction effects calibrated data sets might be inconsistent with
among all three inputs P1, P2, and P3. available data sets. The calibration process places
Now assume only half of the simulation runs interesting constraints on different sets of
were performed, perhaps runs 2, 3, 5, and 8 in parameter values. Thus, such Monte Carlo
this example. If only outputs Y2, Y3, Y5, and Y8 experiments often contain checks that exclude
are available, for our example: combinations of parameter values that are
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses 355

Fig. 8.17 Monte Carlo sampling and simulation proce- more uncertain input variables at a time. The output
dure for nding distributions of output variable values distributions will reflect the combined effects of this input
based on distributions, for specied reliability levels, of uncertainty over the specied ranges
input data values. This technique can be applied to one or
356 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

Table 8.6 Monte Carlo analysis of lake phosphorus levels

unreasonable. In these cases the generated results were generated independently from normal dis-
are conditioned on this validity check. tributions with the means and variances as shown
Whenever sampling methods are used, one in Table 8.6.
must consider possible correlations among input The table contains the specied means and
data values. Sampling methods can handle spatial variances for the generated values of L, q, and z,
and temporal correlations that may exist among and also the actual values of the means and
input data values, but the existence of correlation variances of the 200 generated values of L, q,
requires dening appropriate conditional z and also of the 200 corresponding generated
distributions. output phosphorus concentrations, P. Fig-
One major limitation of applying Monte Carlo ure 8.18 displays the distribution of the gener-
methods to estimate ranges of risk and uncer- ated values of P.
tainty for model output variable values, and One can see that given the estimated levels of
system performance indicator values based on uncertainty, phosphorus levels could reasonably
these output variable values, is the computing range from below 10 to above 25. The proba-
time required. To reduce the computing times bility of generating a value greater than
needed to perform sensitivity analyses using 20 mg/m3 was 12.5%. The 5% to 95 percentile
sampling methods, some tricks and as well as range was 11.123.4 mg/m3. In the gure, the
stratied sampling methods are available. The cumulative probability curve is rough because
discussion below illustrates the idea of a simple only 200 values of the phosphorus concentration
modication (or trick) using a standardized were generated, but these are clearly enough to
Monte Carlo analysis. The more general Latin give a good impression of the overall impact of
Hypercube Sampling procedure is also discussed. the errors.

Simple Monte Carlo Sampling Sampling Uncertainty


To illustrate the use of Monte Carlo sampling In this example, the mean of the 200 generated
methods consider again Vollenweiders empiri- values of the phosphorus concentration, P, was
cal relationship, Eq. 8.5, for the average phos- 17.07. However, a different set of random values
phorus concentration in lakes (Vollenweider would have generated a different set of P values
1976). Two hundred values of each parameter as well. Thus it is appropriate to estimate the
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses 357

Fig. 8.18 Distribution of


lake phosphorus
concentrations from Monte
Carlo analysis

standard error, SE, of this average. The standard Making Sense of the Results
error equals the standard deviation of the A signicant challenge with complex models is
P values divided by the square root of the sample to determine from the Monte Carlo simulation
size n: which parameter errors are important. Calculat-
ing the correlation between each generated input
SE r=n0:5 3:61=2000:5 0:25: 8:19 parameter value and the output variable value is
one way of doing this. As Table 8.7 shows,
From the central limit theorem of mathematical based upon the magnitudes of the correlation
statistics, the average of a large number of inde- coefcients, errors in L were most important, and
pendent values should have very nearly a normal those in q second in importance.
distribution. Thus, 95% of the time, the true mean One can also use regression to develop a
of P should be in the interval 17.1 1.96 (0.25), linear model dening variations in the output
or 16.617.6 mg/m3. This level of uncertainty based on errors in the various parameters. The
reflects the observed variability of P and the fact results are shown in Table 8.8. The t is very
that only 200 values were generated. good, and R2 = 98%. If the model for P had been

Table 8.7 Correlation analysis of Monte Carlo results


358 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

Table 8.8 Results of regression analysis on Monte Carlo Results

linear, a R2 value of 100% should have resulted. Standardized Monte Carlo Analysis
All of the coefcients are signicantly different Using a standardized Monte Carlo analysis,
from zero. one could adjust the generated values of L, q, and
Note that the correlation between P and z was z above so that the generated samples actually
positive in Table 8.7, but the regression coef- have the desired mean and variance. While
cient for z is negative. This occurred because making that correction, one can also shuffle their
there is a modest negative correlation between values so that the correlations among the gener-
the generated z and q values. Use of partial ated values for the different parameters are near
correlation coefcients can also correct for such zero, as is desired. This was done for the 200
spurious correlations among input parameters. generated values to obtain the statistics shown in
Finally we display a plot, Fig. 8.19, based on Table 8.9.
this regression model illustrating the reduction in Repeating the correlation analysis from before
the variance of P that is due to dropping each (shown in Table 8.10) now yields much clearer
variable individually. Clearly L has the biggest results that are in agreement with the regression
impact on the uncertainty in P, and z the least. analysis. The correlation between P and both

Fig. 8.19 Reduction in the variance of P that is due to dropping from the regression model each variable individually.
Clearly L has the biggest impact on the uncertainty in P, and z the least
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses 359

Table 8.9 Standardized Monte Carlo analysis of lake phosphorus levels

Table 8.10 Correlation analysis of standardized Monte Carlo results

q and z are now negative as they should be. regressions were also repeated and yielded very
Because the generated values of the three similar results. The only real difference was that
parameters have been adjusted to be uncorre- the parameter estimates had small standard errors
lated, the signal from one is not confused with and were more signicant because of the elimi-
the signal from another. nation of correlation between the generated
The mean phosphorus concentration changed parameters.
very little. It is now 17.0 instead of 17.1 mg/m3.
Using control variates with a linear predictive Generalized Likelihood Estimation
model in conjunction with the standardized Beven (1993) and Binley and Beven (1991) sug-
Monte Carlo variates, the standard deviation of gest a Generalized Likelihood Uncertainty Esti-
the errors associated with the 200 observations is mation (GLUE) technique for assessment of
only 0.45. Thus the standard error for this esti- parameter error uncertainty using Monte Carlo
mate of the mean of P is 0.45/(200)0.5 or just simulation. It is described as a formal method-
0.03. Thus this is a highly accurate result. The ology for some of the subjective elements of
360 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

model calibration (Beven 1989, p. 47). The basic to use some data to calibrate the model and to
idea is to begin by assigning reasonable ranges for generate a prior or initial distribution for the
the various parameters and then to draw parameter parameters that is at least centered in the best
sets from those ranges using a uniform or some range (Beven 1993, p. 48). Then use of a dif-
similar (and flat) distribution. These generated ferent calibration period to generate the p(Pi)
parameter sets are then used on a calibration data allows an updating of those initial probabilities to
set so that unreasonable combinations can be reflect the information provided by the additional
rejected, while reasonable values are assigned a calibration period with the adopted likelihood
posterior probability based upon a likelihood measures.
measure which may reflect several dimensions After the accepted sequences are used to gen-
and characteristics of model performance. erate sets of predictions, the likelihood weights
Let L(Pi) > 0 be the value of the likelihood would be used in the calculation of means, vari-
measure assigned to the ith parameter sets cali- ances and quantiles, rather than the customary
bration sequence. Then the model predictions procedure of giving all the generated realizations
generated with parameter set/combination Pi are equal weight. The resulting conditional distribu-
assigned posterior probability, p(Pi). tion of system output reflects the initial probability
distributions assigned to parameters, the rejection
X  
pPi LPi = L Pj 8:20 criteria, and the likelihood measure adopted to
j assign likelihood weights.

These probabilities reflect the form of Bayes 8.4.2.7 Latin Hypercube Sampling
theorem, which is well supported by probability For the simple Monte Carlo simulations descri-
theory (Devore 1991). This procedure should bed above, with independent errors, a probability
capture reasonably well the dependence or cor- distribution is assumed for each input parameter
relation among parameters, because reasonable or variable. In each simulation run, values of all
sequences will all be assigned larger probabili- input data are obtained from sampling those
ties, whereas sequences that are unable to individual and independent distributions. The
reproduce the system response over the calibra- value generated for an input parameter or vari-
tion period will be rejected or assigned small able is usually independent of what that value
probabilities. was in any previous run, or what other input
However, in a rigorous probabilistic frame- parameter or variable values are in the same run.
work, the L would be the likelihood function for the This simple sampling approach can result in a
calibration series for particular error distributions. clustering of parameter values and hence a
(This could be checked with available goodness- redundancy of information from repeated sam-
of-t procedures; for example, Kuczera 1988.) pling in the same regions of a distribution and a
When relatively ad hoc measures are adopted for lack of information from no sampling in other
the likelihood measure with little statistical valid- regions of the distributions.
ity, the p(Pi) probabilities are best described as A stratied sampling approach ensures more
pseudo-probabilities or likelihood weights. even coverage of the range of input parameter or
Another concern with this method is the variable values with the same number of simu-
potential efciency. If the parameter ranges are lation runs. This can be accomplished by divid-
too wide, a large number of unreasonable or very ing the input parameter or variable space into
unlikely parameter combinations will be gener- sections and sampling from each section with the
ated. These will either be rejected or else will appropriate probability.
have small probabilities and thus little effect on One such approach, Latin hypercube sampling
the analysis. In this case the associated process- (LHS), divides each input distribution into sec-
ing would be a waste of effort. A compromise is tions of equal probability for the specied
8.4 Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analyses 361

Fig. 8.20 Schematic representation of a Latin hypercube sampling procedure for six simulation runs
362 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

probability distribution, and draws one observa- 8.5 Performance Indicator


tion randomly from each range. Hence the ranges Uncertainties
of input values within each section actually occur
with equal frequency in the experiment. These 8.5.1 Performance Measure Target
values from each interval for each distribution Uncertainty
are randomly assigned to those from other
intervals to construct sets of input values for the Another possible source of uncertainty is the
simulation analysis. Figure 8.20 shows the steps selection of performance measure target values.
in constructing a LHS for six simulations For example, consider a target value for a pol-
involving three inputs Pj (P1, P2, and P3) and six lutant concentration based on the effect of
intervals of their respective normal, uniform and exceeding it in an ecosystem. Which target value
triangular probability distributions. is best or correct? When this is not clear, there

Fig. 8.21 Combining the probability distribution of the condence one has in the probability of exceeding a
performance measure values with the probability distri- maximum desired target value
bution of performance measure target values to estimate
8.5 Performance Indicator Uncertainties 363

are various ways of expressing the uncertainty Fig. 8.20 represents the most likely or median
associated with any target value. One such target value, the associated probability of
method is the use of qualitative approaches exceedance is either the most likely, as indicated
involving membership functions (Chap. 5). Use in Fig. 8.20, or that for which we are only 50%
of grey numbers or intervals instead of white condent.
or xed target values is another. When some Figure 8.21 attempts to show how to interpret
uncertainty or disagreement exists over the the reliabilities when the uncertain performance
selection of the best target value for a particular targets are
performance measure, it seems to us the most
direct and transparent way to do this is to sub- minimum acceptable levels that are to be
jectively assume a distribution over a range of maximized,
possible target values. Then this subjective maximum acceptable levels that are to be
probability distribution can be factored into the minimized or
tradeoff analysis, as outlined in Fig. 8.21. optimum levels.
One of the challenges associated with dening
and including in an analysis the uncertainty An example of a minimum acceptable target
associated with a target or threshold value for a level might be the population of wading birds in
performance measure is that of communicating an area. An example of a maximum acceptable
just what the result of such an analysis means. target level might be, again, the phosphorus
Referring to Fig. 8.20, suppose the target value concentration of the flow in a specic wetland or
represents some maximum limit of a pollutant, lake. An example of an optimum target level
say phosphorus, concentration in the flow during might be the depth of water most suitable for
a given period of time at a given site or region, selected species of aquatic vegetation during a
and it is not certain just what that maximum limit particular period of the year.
should be. Subjectively dening the distribution For performance measure targets that are not
of that maximum limit, and considering that expressed as minimum or maximum limits but
uncertainty along with the uncertainty (proba- that are the best values, referring to Fig. 8.22,
bility of exceedance function) of pollutant con- one can state that one is 90% condent that the
centrationsthe performance measureone can probability of achieving the desired target is no
attach a condence to any probability of more than B. The 90% condence level proba-
exceeding the maximum desired concentration bility of not achieving the desired target is at
value. least A + C. The probability of the performance
The 95% probability of exceedance shown on measure being too low is at least A and the
Fig. 8.20, say P0.95, should be interpreted as we probability of the performance measure being too
can be 95% condent that the probability of the high is at least C, again at the 90% condence
maximum desired pollutant concentration being levels. As the condence level decreases the
exceeded will be no greater than P0.95. We can bandwidth decreases, and the probability of not
be only 5% condent that the probability of meeting the target increases.
exceeding the desired maximum concentration Now, clearly there is uncertainty associated
will be no greater than the lower P0.05 value. with each of these uncertainty estimations, and
Depending on whether the middle line through this raises the question of how valuable is the
the subjective distribution of target values in quantication of the uncertainty of each
364 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

Fig. 8.22 Interpreting the results of combining perfor- measure. The letters A, B, and C represent proportions of
mance measure probabilities with performance measure the probability density function of performance measure
target probabilities depends on the type of performance values. (Hence probabilities A + B + C = 1)

additional component of the plan in an evaluation maximum desired upper limit (e.g., of some
process. Will plan evaluators and decision mak- pollutant concentration).
ers benet from this additional information, and In the case shown in Fig. 8.23, the tradeoff is
just how much additional uncertainty information clearly between cost and reliability. In this
is useful? example, no matter what condence one chooses,
Now consider again the tradeoffs that need to Plan A is preferred to Plan B with respect to
be made as illustrated in Fig. 8.7. Instead of reliability, but Plan B is preferred to Plan A with
considering a single target value as shown on respect to cost. The tradeoff is only between
Fig. 8.7, assume there is a 90% condence range these two performance indicators or measures.
associated with that single performance measure Consider however a third plan, as shown in
target value. Also assume that the target is a Fig. 8.24. This situation adds to the complexity
8.5 Performance Indicator Uncertainties 365

Fig. 8.23 Two plans showing ranges of probabilities, maximum target. The 5% condent levels are associated
depending on ones condence, that an uncertain desired with the more desirable lower probabilities of exceeding
maximum (upper limit) performance target value will be the desired maximum target. Plan A with reduced
exceeded. The 95% condence levels are associated with probabilities of exceeding the upper limit costs more than
the higher probabilities of exceeding the desired Plan B

Fig. 8.24 Tradeoffs among cost, reliabilities, and the desired (maximum limit) target may depend on the
condence level of those reliabilities. The relative ranking condence given to that probability
of plans with respect to the probability of exceeding the

of making appropriate tradeoffs. Now there are there will be multiple performance measure tar-
three criteria: cost, probability of exceedance gets, each expressed in terms of their maximum
(reliability) and the condence in those reliabil- probabilities of exceedance and the condence in
ities or probabilities. Add to this the fact that those probabilities.
366 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

In Fig. 8.23, in terms of cost the plans are cases, one would expect one policy to be better
ranked, from best to worst, B, C, and A. In terms than the other. One measure might be the dif-
of reliability at the 95% condence level, they ference in the mean of the variables. For exam-
are ranked A, B, and C but at the 5% condence ple, is E[Y1] < E[Y2]? Alternatively one could
level the ranking is A, C, and B. check the difference in the median (50 percentile)
If the plan evaluation process has difculty of the two distributions.
handling all this it may indicate the need to focus In addition, one could look for a change in the
the uncertainty analysis effort on just what is variability or variance, or a shift in both the mean
deemed important, achievable, and benecial. and the variance. Changes described by a dif-
Then when the number of alternatives has been ference in the mean or median often make the
narrowed down to only a few that appear to be the most sense and many statistical tests are available
better ones, a more complete uncertainty analysis that are sensitive to such changes. For such
can be performed. There is no need nor benet in investigations parametric and nonparametric tests
performing sensitivity and uncertainty analyses for paired and unpaired data can be employed.
on all possible management alternatives. Rather Consider the differences between paired and
one can focus on those alternatives that look the unpaired data. Suppose that the meteorological
most promising, and then carry out additional data for 19411990 is used to drive a simulation
uncertainty and sensitivity analyses only when model generating data as described in
important uncertain performance indicator values Table 8.11.
demand more scrutiny. Otherwise the work is not Here there is one sample, Y1(1) through Y1(50),
likely to affect the decision anyway. for policy 1, and another sample, Y2(1) through
Y2(50), for policy 2. However, the two sets of
observations are not independent. For example, if
8.5.2 Distinguishing Differences 1943 was a very dry year, then we would expect
Between Performance both Y1(3) for policy 1 in that year and Y2(3) for
Indicator Distributions policy 2 to be unusually small. With such paired
data, one can use a paired hypothesis test to check
Simulations of alternative water management for differences. Paired tests are usually easier than
infrastructure designs and operating policies the corresponding unpaired tests that are appro-
require a comparison of the simulation outputs priate in other cases. (For example, if one were
the performance measures or indicatorsasso- checking for a difference in average rainfall depth
ciated with each alternative. Now the question is between 19411970, and 19712000, they would
whether or not the observed differences are sta- have two sets of independent measurements for the
tistically signicant. Can one really tell if one
alternative is better than another or are the Table 8.11 Possible flow data from a 50-year simulation
observed differences explainable by random
variations attributable to variations in the inputs
and how the system responds?
This is a common statistical issue that is
addressed by standard hypothesis tests (Devore
1991; Benjamin and Cornell 1970). Selection of
an appropriate test requires that one rst resolve
what type of change one expects in the variables.
To illustrate, consider the comparison of two
different operating policies. Let Y1 denote the set
of output performance variable values with the
rst policy, and Y2 the set of output performance
variable values of the second policy. In many
8.5 Performance Indicator Uncertainties 367

two periods. With such data, one should use a important if uncertainty analyses and character-
two-sample unpaired test.) izations are to be of value in a decision-making
Paired tests are generally based on the dif- process. In spite considerable efforts by those
ferences between the two sets of output, involved in risk assessment and management, we
Y1(i) Y2(i). These are viewed as a single know very little about how to ensure effective
independent sample. The question is then: are risk communication to gain the condence of
the differences positive (say Y1 tends to be larger stakeholders, incorporate their views and
then Y2), or negative (Y1 tends to be smaller), or knowledge, and influence favorably the accept-
are positive and negative differences are equally ability of risk assessments and risk management
likely (there is no difference between Y1 and Y2). decisions.
Both parametric and nonparametric families The best way to communicate concepts of
of statistical tests are available for paired data. uncertainty may well depend on what the audi-
The common parametric test for paired data (a ences already know about risk and the various
one-sample T test) assumes that the mean of the types of probability distributions (e.g., density,
differences cumulative, exceedance) based on objective and
X i Y1 i  Y2 i 8:21 subjective data, and the distinction between
mean or average values and the most likely
is normally distributed. Then the hypothesis of values. Undoubtedly graphical representations of
no difference is rejected if the T statistic is suf- these ways of describing uncertainty consider-
ciently large, given the sample size n. ably facilitate communication.
Alternatively, one can employ a nonpara- The National Research Council (NRC 1994)
metric test and avoid the assumption that the addressed the extensive uncertainty and vari-
differences X(i) are normally distributed. In such ability associated with estimating risk and con-
a case, one can use the Wilcoxon Signed Rank cluded that risk characterizations should not be
test. This nonparametric test ranks the absolute reduced to a single number or even to a range of
values |X(i)| of the differences. If the sum S of the numbers intended to portray uncertainty. Instead,
ranks of the positive differences deviates suf- the report recommended managers and the
ciently from its expected value, n(n + 1)/4 (were interested public should be given risk charac-
there no difference between the two distribu- terizations that are both qualitative and quanti-
tions), one can conclude that there is a statisti- tative and both verbal and mathematical.
cally signicant difference between the Y1(i) and In some cases, communicating qualitative
Y2(i) series. Standard statistical texts have tables information about uncertainty to stakeholders
of the distribution of the sum S as a function of and the public in general may be more effective
the sample size n, and provide a good analytical than quantitative information. There are, of
approximation for n > 20 (for example, Devore course, situations in which quantitative uncer-
1991). Both the parametric t test and the non- tainty analyses are likely to provide information
parametric Wilcoxon Signed Rank test require that is useful in a decision-making process. How
that the differences between the simulated values else can tradeoffs such as illustrated in Figs. 8.10
for each year be computed. and 8.27 be identied? Quantitative uncertainty
analysis often can be used as the basis of qual-
itative information about uncertainty, even if the
8.6 Communicating Model Output quantitative information is not what is commu-
Uncertainty nicated to the public.
One should acknowledge to the public the
Spending money on reducing uncertainty would widespread confusion regarding the differences
seem preferable to spending it on ways of cal- between variability and uncertainty. Variability
culating and describing it better. Yet attention to does not change through further measurement or
uncertainty communication is critically study, although better sampling can improve our
368 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

knowledge about variability. Uncertainty reflects


gaps in information about scientically observ-
able phenomena.
While it is important to communicate uncer-
tainties and condence in predictions, it is equally
important to clarify who or what is at risk, pos-
sible consequences, and the severity and irre-
versibility of an adverse effect should a target
value, for example, not be met. This qualitative
information is often critical to informed
decision-making. Risk and uncertainty commu-
nication is always complicated by the reliability
and amounts of available relevant information as
well as how that information is presented. Effec-
tive communication between people receiving
Fig. 8.25 Reducing risk by orders of magnitude is not
information about who or what is at risk, or what
equivalent to linear reductions
might happen and just how severe and irre-
versible an adverse effect might be should a target
value not be met, is just as important as the level One approach to make uncertainty more
of uncertainty and the condence associated with meaningful is to make risk comparisons. For
such predictions. A two-way dialog between example, a ten-parts-per-billion target for a par-
those receiving such information and those giving ticular pollutant concentration is equivalent to
it can help identify just what seems best for a 10 s in over 31 years. If this is an average daily
particular audience. concentration target that is to be satised 99%,
Risk and uncertainty communication is a of the time, this is equivalent to an expected
two-way street. It involves learning and teaching. violation of less than one day every three
Communicators dealing with uncertainty should months.
learn about the concerns and values of their Many perceive the reduction of risk by an
audience, their relevant knowledge, and their order of magnitude as though it were a linear
experience with uncertainty issues. Stakeholders reduction. An alternative way to illustrate orders
knowledge of the sources and reasons for of magnitude of risk reduction is shown in
uncertainty needs to be incorporated into Fig. 8.25, in which a bar graph depicts better
assessment and management and communication than words that a reduction in risk from one in a
decisions. By listening, communicators can craft 1000 (103) to one in 10,000 (104) is a reduc-
risk messages that better reflect the perspectives, tion of 90% and that a further reduction to one in
technical knowledge, and concerns of the 100,000 (105) is a reduction 10-fold less than
audience. the rst reduction of 90%. The percent of the risk
Effective communication should begin before that is reduced by whatever measures is an easier
important decisions have been made. It can be concept to communicate than reductions expres-
facilitated in communities by citizen advisory sed in terms of estimated absolute risk levels,
panels. Citizen advisory panels can give planners such as 105.
and decision-makers a better understanding of Risk comparisons can be helpful, but they
the questions and concerns of the community and should be used cautiously and tested if possible.
an opportunity to test its effectiveness in com- There are dangers in comparing risks of diverse
municating concepts and specic issues regard- character, especially when the intent of the
ing uncertainty. comparison is seen as minimizing a risk (NRC
8.6 Communicating Model Output Uncertainty 369

Fig. 8.26 Different types


of displays used to show
model output Y or system
performance indicator
values F(Y)

1989). One difculty in using risk comparisons is performs it. Another way is to develop utility
that it is not always easy to nd risks that are functions using weights, where, for example
sufciently similar to make a comparison mean- reduced phosphorus load by half is equivalent to
ingful. How is someone able to compare two a 25% shorter hydroperiod in that area, but again
alternatives having two different costs and two each persons utility or preferred tradeoff may
different risk levels, for example, as is shown in differ.
Fig. 8.7? One way is to perform an indifference At a minimum, graphical displays of uncer-
analysis (as discussed in the next chapter), but tainty can be helpful. Consider the common
that can lead to different results depending who system performance indicators that include:

Fig. 8.27 Plots of ranges


of possible model output
Y or system indicator
values F(Y) for different
types of displays
370 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

Time series plots for continuous time- of uncertainty in different input variables to the
dependent indicators (Fig. 8.26 upper left) uncertainty in different output variables and
Probability exceedance distributions for con- system performance indices. These relative con-
tinuous indicators (Fig. 8.26 upper right), tributions may differ depending upon which
Histograms for discrete event indicators output variables and indices are of interest.
(Fig. 8.26 lower left), and A sensitivity analysis can provide a systematic
Overlays on maps for space-dependent dis- assessment of the impact of parameter value
crete events (Fig. 8.26 lower right). imprecision on output variable values and per-
formance indices, and of the relative contribution
The rst three graphs in Fig. 8.26 could show, of errors in different parameter values to that
in addition to the single curve or bar that repre- output uncertainty. Once the key variables are
sents the most likely output, a range of outcomes identied, it should be possible to determine the
associated with a given condence interval. For extent to which parameter value uncertainty can
overlays of information on maps, different colors be reduced through eld investigations, devel-
could represent the spatial extents of events opment of better models, and other efforts.
associated with different ranges of risk or Model calibration procedures can be applied to
uncertainty. Figure 8.27, corresponding to individual catchments and subsystems, as well as to
Fig. 8.26, illustrates these approaches for dis- composite systems. Automated calibration proce-
playing these ranges. dures have several advantages including the explicit
use of an appropriate statistical objective function,
identication of those parameters that best repro-
8.7 Conclusions duce the calibration data set with the given objective
function, and the estimations of the statistical pre-
This chapter provides an overview of uncertainty cision of the estimated parameters.
and sensitivity analyses in the context of hydro- All of these tasks together can represent a
logic or water resources systems simulation formidable effort. However, knowledge of the
modeling. A broad range of tools are available to uncertainty associated with model predictions
explore, display, and quantify the sensitivity and can be as important to management decision and
uncertainty in predictions of key output variables policy formulation as are the predictions
and system performance indices with respect to themselves.
imprecise and random model inputs and to No matter how much attention is given to
assumptions concerning model structure. They quantifying and reducing uncertainties in model
range from relatively simple deterministic sensi- outputs, uncertainties will remain. Professionals
tivity analysis methods to more involved who analyze risk, managers and decision-makers
rst-order analyses and Monte Carlo sampling who must manage risk, and the public who must
methods. live with risk and uncertainty, have different
Because of the complexity of many water- information needs and attitudes regarding risk
sheds or river basins, Monte Carlo methods for and uncertainty. It is clear that information needs
uncertainty analyses may be a very major and differ among those who model or use models,
unattractive undertaking. Therefore it is often those who make substantial investment or social
prudent to begin with the relatively simple decisions, and those who are likely to be impacted
deterministic procedures. This coupled with a by those decisions. Meeting those needs should
probabilistically based rst-order uncertainty result in more informed decision-making. But it
analysis method can help quantify the uncer- comes at a cost that should be considered along
tainty in key output variables and system per- with the benets of having this sensitivity and
formance indices, and the relative contributions uncertainty information.
References 371

References Additional References


(Further Reading)
Beck, M. B. (1987). Water quality modeling: A review of
the analysis of uncertainty. Water Resources Anderson, J. L. (1998). Embracing uncertainty: The
Research, 23(8), 13931442. interface of Bayesian statistics and cognitive psychol-
Benaman, J. (2002). A systematic approach to uncertainty ogy. Conservation Ecology, 2(1), 2. Available from
analysis for a distributed watershed model (Ph.D. http://www.consecol.org/vol2/iss1/art2
thesis). School of Civil and Environmental Engineer- Berry, D. A. (1996). Statistics: A Bayesian perspective.
ing. Cornell University, Ithaca, NY. Belmont, CA: Duxbury.
Benjamin, J. R., & Cornell, C. A. (1970). Probability, Chapra, S. C., & Reckhow, K. H. (1979). Expressing the
statistics and decision for civil engineers. New York: phosphorus loading concept in probabilistic terms.
McGraw-Hill Book Co. Journal of the Fisheries Board of Canada, 36, 225.
Beven, K. (1989). Changing ideas in hydrologyThe Colwell, R. K. (1974). Predictability, consistency, and
case of physically-based models. Journal of Hydrol- contingency of periodic phenomena. Ecology, 55,
ogy, 105, 157172. 11481153.
Beven, K. (1993). Prophecy, reality and uncertainty in Covello, V. T. (1987). Decision analysis and risk
distributed hydrologic modelling. Advances in Water management decision-making: Issues and methods.
Resources, 16, 4151. Risk Analysis, 7, 131139.
Binley, A. M., & Beven, K. J. (1991). Physically-based Covello, V. T., & Merkhofer, M. W. (1993). Risk
modelling of catchment hydrology: A likelihood assessment methods. London: Plenum Press.
approach to reducing predictive uncertainty. In D. Deutsch, C. V., & Journel, A. G. (1992). GS-LIB:
G. Farmer & M. J. Rycroft (Eds.), Computer mod- Geostatistical software library and users guide.
elling in the environmental sciences. Oxford: Claren- Oxford: Oxford University Press.
don Press. Devore, J. L., & Peck, R. (1996). Statistics: The
DeGarmo, E. P., Sullivan, W. G., & Bontadelli, J. A. exploration and analysis of data (3rd ed.). London:
(1993). Engineering economy. New York: Brooks/Cole Publishing Co.
MacMillian. Dilks, D. W., Canale, R. P., & Meier, P. G. (1992).
Devore, J. (1991). Probability and statistics for engineer- Development of Bayesian Monte Carlo techniques for
ing and the sciences (3rd ed.). London: Brooks/Cole water quality model uncertainty. Ecological Model-
Publishing Co. ling, 62, 149162.
Eschenback, T. G. (1992). Spider plots versus tornado Dilks, D. W., & James, R. T. (2002). Application of
diagrams for sensitivity analysis. Interfaces, 22, 4046. Bayesian Monte Carlo analysis to determine the
Gaven, D. C., & Burges, S. J. (1981). Approximate error uncertainty in the Lake Okeechobee water quality
bounds for simulated hydrograph. Journal of the model. In Proceedings of Water Environment Feder-
Hydraulics Division, 107(11), 15191534. ation, Watershed.
Kuczera, G. (1988). On the validity of rst-order predic- DOE. (1998). Screening assessment and requirements for
tion limits for conceptual hydrologic models. Journal a comprehensive assessment, DOE/RL-96-16, Rev. 1,
of Hydrology, 103, 229247. U.S. Department of Energy, Richland, Washington.
Lal, W. (1995, November). Sensitivity and uncertainty Duan, Q., Soroosian, S., & Ibbitt, R. P. (1988). A max-
analysis of a regional model for the natural system of imum likelihood criterion for use with data collected at
South Florida. South Florida Water Management unequal time intervals. Water Resources Research, 24
District, West Palm Beach, FL, Draft report. (7), 11631173.
McCuen, R. (1973). The role of sensitivity analysis in Fedra, K. (1983). A Monte Carlo approach to estimation
hydrologic modeling. Journal of Hydrology, 18(1), and prediction. In M. B. Beck & G. Van Straten
3753. (Eds.), Uncertainty and forecasting of water quality
National Research Council (NRC). (1989). Improving risk (pp. 259291). Berlin: Springer.
communication. Washington, D.C.: National Acad- Fitz, H. C., Voinov, A., & Costanza, R. (1995). The
emy Press. everglades landscape model: Multiscale sensitivity
National Research Council (NRC). (1994). Science and analysis. South Florida Water Management District,
judgment in risk assessment. Washington, D.C.: Everglades Systems Research Division, West Palm
National Academy Press. Beach, FL, 88 p.
Stedinger, J. R., & Taylor, M. R. (1982). Synthetic Fontaine, T. A., & Jacomino, V. M. F. (1997). Sensitivity
streamflow generation, part II. Effect of Parameter analysis of simulated contaminated sediment transport.
Uncertainty, Water Resources Research, 18(4), 919 Journal of the American Water Resources Associa-
924. tion, 33(2), 313326.
Vollenweider, R. A. (1976). Advances in dening critical Frey, H. C., & Patil, S. R. (2002). Identication and
loading levels for phosphorus in lake eutrophication. review of sensitivity analysis methods. Risk Analysis,
Memorie dellIstituto Italiano di Idrobiologia, 33, 53 22(3), 553578.
83.
372 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

Gardner, R. H., Rojder, B., & Bergstrom, U. (1983). Kelly, E., & Roy-Harrison, W. (1998). A mathematical
PRISM: A systematic method for determining the effect construct for ecological risk: A useful framework for
of parameter uncertainties on model predictions assessments. Human and Ecological Risk Assessment,
(technical report, Studsvik Energiteknik AB report An International Journal, 4(2), 229241.
NW-83-/555). Nykoping, Sweden. Lal, A. M. W. (2000, May). Numerical errors in
Gelman, A., Carlin, J., Stern, H., & Rubin, D. B. (1995). groundwater and overland flow models. Water
Bayesian data analysis. London: Chapman and Hall. Resources Research, 36(5), 12371248.
Gleick, J. (1987). Chaos: Making a new science. New Lal, W., Obeysekera, J., & van Zee, R. (1997, August).
York: Penguin. Sensitivity and uncertainty analysis of a regional
Gupta, V. K., & Sorooshian, S. (1985a). The automatic simulation model for the natural system in South
calibration of conceptual watershed models using Florida, in managing water: Coping with scarcity and
derivative-based optimization algorithms. Water abundance. In Proceedings, 27th Congress of Inter-
Resources Research, 21(4), 473485. national Association for Hydraulic Research. San
Gupta, V. K., & Sorooshian, S. (1985b). The relationship Francisco, CA.
between data and the precision of parameter estimates Lemons, J. (Ed.). (1996). Scientic uncertainty and
of hydrologic models. Journal of Hydrology, 81, 57 environmental problem solving. Cambridge, MA:
77. Blackwell.
Haimes, Y. Y. (1998). Risk modelling, assessment and Lopez, A., & Loucks, D. P. (1999). Uncertainty repre-
management. New York: Wiley. sentations in water quality prediction. Manuscript,
Harlin, J., & Kung, C.-S. (1992). Parameter uncertainty in civil and environmental engineering. Ithaca, NY:
simulation of design of floods in sweden. Journal of Cornell University.
Hydrology, 137, 20092230. Loucks, D. P., Stedinger, J. R., & Haith, D. A. (1981).
Hendrickson, J. D., Sorooshian, S., & Brazil, L. E. (1988). Water resource systems planning and analysis. Engle-
Comparison of Newton-type and direct-search algo- wood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
rithms for calibration of conceptual rainfall-runoff Ludwig, D., Hilborn, R., & Walters, C. (1993). Uncer-
models. Water Research Research, 24(5), 691700. tainty, resource exploitation, and conservation: Les-
Holling, C. S. (1978). Adaptive environmental assessment sons from history. Science, 260, 1736.
and management. Chichester, UK: Wiley. Majoni, H., & Quade, E. S. (1980). Pitfalls of analysis.
Ibrekk, H., & Morgan, M. G. (1987). Graphical commu- New York: Wiley.
nication of uncertain quantities to nontechnical people. McCarthy, J. J., Canziani, O. F., Leary, N. A., Dokken, D.
Risk Analysis, 7(4), 519529. J., White, K. S., (Eds.). (2001). Climate change 2001:
Isaaks, E. H., & Srivastava, R. M. (1989). An introduction Impacts, adaptation, and vulnerability. Contribution
to applied geostatistics. New York: Oxford University of Working Group II to the Third Assessment Report
Press. of the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change,
Jaffe, P. R., Paniconi, C., & Wood, E. F. (1988). Model Published for the Intergovernmental Panel on
calibration based on random environmental fluctua- Climate Change. http://www.ipcc.ch/pub/tar/wg2/
tions. Journal of Environmental Engineering, 114(5), index.htm
11361145. McCuen, R. H., & Snyder, W. M. (1983). Hydrologic
Jain, S., & Lall, U. (2001, December). Floods in a modeling: Statistical methods and applications.
changing climate: Does the past represent the future? Prentice-Hall, NJ: Englewood Cliffs.
Water Resources Research, 37(12), 31933205. Meixner, T., Gupta, H. V., Bastidas, L. A., & Bales, R. C.
Jensen, F. V. (2001). Bayesian networks and decision (1999). Sensitivity analysis using mass flux and
graphs. New York: Springer. concentration. Hydrological Processes, 13, 2233
Kann, A., & Weyant, J. P. (1999). A comparison of 2244.
approaches for performing uncertainty analysis in Miser, H. J. (1980). Operations research and systems
integrated assessment models. Journal of Environ- analysis. Science, 209, 174182.
mental Management and Assessment, 5(1), 2946. Morgan, M. G., & Henrion, M. (1990). Uncertainty, A
Kelly, E., & Campbell, K. (2000, February). Separating guide to dealing with uncertainty in quantitative risk
variability and uncertainty-making choices. Human and policy analysis. Cambridge, UK: Cambridge
and Ecological Risk Assessment, An International University Press.
Journal (in press). National Research Council (NRC). (1996). Committee on
Kelly, E. J., Campbell, K., & Henrion, M. (1997, risk characterization, understanding risk: Informing
November). To separate or not to separateThat is decision in a democratic society (P. S. Stern & H.
the questionA discourse on separating variability V. Fineberg, Eds.). Washington, D.C.: National
and uncertainty in environmental risk assessments, Academy Press.
learned discourses, society of environmental toxicol- Nearing, M. A., Deer-Ascough, L., & Laflen, J. F. (1990).
ogy and chemistry (SETAC) news. Sensitivity analysis of the WEPP hillslope prole
References 373

erosion model. Transactions of the American Society Tattari, S., & Barlund, I. (2001). The concept of
of Agricultural Engineers, 33(3), 839849. sensitivity in sediment yield modelling. Physics and
Phillips, D. L., & Marks, D. G. (1996). Spatial uncertainty Chemistry of the Earth, 26(1), 2731.
analysis: Propagation of interpolation errors in spa- van Griensven, A., Francos, A., & Bauwens, W. (2001).
tially distributed models. Ecological Modelling, 91, Sensitivity analysis and auto-calibration of an integral
213229. dynamic model for river water quality (in progress).
Press, S. J., & Tanur, J. M. (2001). The subjectivity of van Harn Adams, B. A. (1998). Parameter distributions
scientists and the Bayesian approach. New York: for uncertainty propagation in water quality modeling
Wiley. (Doctoral dissertation). Duke University.
Reckhow, K. H. (1994). Water quality simulation mod- van Straten, G. (1983). Maximum likelihood estimation of
eling and uncertainty analysis for risk assessment and parameters and uncertainty in phytoplankton models.
decision making. Ecological Modelling, 72, 120. In M. B. Beck & G. van Straten (Eds.), Uncertainty
Reckhow, K. H. (1999). Water quality prediction and and forecasting of water quality. New York: Springer.
probability network models. Canadian Journal of von Winterfeldt, D., & Edwards, W. (1986). Decision
Fisheries and Aquatic Sciences, 56, 11501158. analysis and behavioral research. Cambridge, UK:
Reckhow, K. (2002, January). Applications of water Cambridge University Press.
models: Prediction uncertainty and decision making. Warwick, J. J., & Cale, W. G. (1987). Determining
Presentation at Model Uncertainty Workshop, South likelihood of obtaining a reliable model. Journal of
Florida Water Management District, West Palm Environmental Engineering, 113(5), 11021119.
Beach, FL.
Saltelli, A., Chan, K., & Scott, E. M. (Eds.). (2000).
Sensitivity analysis. Chichester, UK: Wiley.
Schweppe, F. C. (1973). Uncertain dynamic systems. Exercises
Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Shapiro, H. T. (1990). The willingness to risk failure.
8:1 Distinguish between sensitivity analysis and
Science, 250(4981), 609.
Simon, I.-I. A. (1988). Prediction and prescription in uncertainty analysis.
system modeling, 15th anniversary of IIASA. Laxen- 8:2 Consider the allocation model used in pre-
burg, Austria: International Institute for Applied vious chapters involving three water con-
Systems Analysis.
sumers i. Allocations xi of water can be made
Sklar, F. H., & Hunsaker, C. T. (2001). The use and
uncertainties of spatial data for landscape models: An from a given total amount Q to the three
overview with examples from the Florida Everglades, consumers. The respective benets are
Chapter 2 in spatial uncertainty in ecology, implica- (6x1 x21), (7x2 1.5x22) and (8x3 0.5x23).
tions for remote sensing and GIS applications (Hun-
Discuss possible sources of uncertainty in
saker et al., Eds.). Berlin: Springer.
Sorooshian, S., Duan, Q., & Gupta, V. K. (1993). model structure and model output, and
Calibration of rainfall-runoff models: Application of identify and display parameter sensitivity.
global optimization to the Sacramento soil moisture 8:3 Discuss how model output uncertainty is
accounting model. Water Resources Research, 29(4),
impacted by both model input uncertainty as
11851194.
Sorooshian, S., Gupta, V. K., & Fulton, J. L. (1983). well as parameter sensitivity.
Evaluation of maximum likelihood parameter estima- 8:4 In many water resources studies considerable
tion techniques for conceptual rainfall-runoff models attention is given to the uncertainty of water
Influence of calibration data variability and length
supplies (precipitation, streamflows, evapo-
on model credibility. Water Resources Research, 19
(1), 251259. ration, inltration, etc.) and much less
Soutter, M., & Musy, A. (1999). Global sensitivity attention is given to the uncertainty of the
analyses of three pesticide leaching models using a management objectives, the costs and bene-
Monte-Carlo approach. Journal of Environmental
Quality, 28, 12901297.
ts of infrastructure, the political support
Spear, R. C., & Hornberger, G. M. (1980). Eutrophication associated with alternative possible deci-
in peel inletII. Identication of critical uncertainties sions, and the like. Develop a simple water
via generalized sensitivity analysis. Water Research, resources planning model involving the
14, 4349.
Stokey, E., & Zeckhauser, R. (1977). A primer for policy
management of water quantity and quality
analysis. New York, NY: W. W. Norton and Co., Inc. and show how these management objective
Suter, G. W., II. (1993). Ecological risk assessment. Boca uncertainties may actually dominate the
Raton, FL: Lewis Publishers. hydrologic uncertainties.
374 8 System Sensitivity and Uncertainty Analysis

8:5 Perform a deterministic sensitivity analysis Estimating the mean and standard devia-
for the consumer 1 in Exercise 8.2. Consider tion of the outputs.
the three parameters, Q, 6 and 1; the latter Estimating the probability the performance
two numbers are the parameters of the ben- measure will exceed a specic threshold.
et function. Low values of these three Assigning a reliability level on a function
parameters are 3, 3, and 0.5, respectively. of the outputs, e.g., the range of function
Most likely values are 6, 6, and 1. High values that is likely to occur with some
values are 12, 9, and 1.5. Display the results probability.
using a Pareto chart, a tornado diagram, and Describing the likelihood of different
a spider plot. potential outputs of the system.
8:6 Referring to water allocation problem dened
in Exercise 9.2, assume the available amount Show the application of Monte Carlo sam-
of water Q is uncertain. Its cumulative prob- pling and analysis, Latin hypercube sampling,
ability distribution is dened by q/(6 + q) for generalized likelihood uncertainty estimation and
values q 0 of the random variable Q. The factorial design methods.
expected value of Q does not exist. Perform
an uncertainty analysis showing how to
dene, at least approximately:

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
Performance Criteria
9

Water resource systems typically provide a interested stakeholders to nd the best compro-
variety of economic, environmental, and eco- mise decision.
logical services. They also serve a variety of If every system performance measure or
purposes (e.g., water supply, flood protection, objective could be expressed in the same units,
hydropower production, navigation, recreation, and if there was only one decision-maker and one
and waste assimilation and transport). Perfor- objective or goal, then decision-making would be
mance criteria provide measures of just how well relatively straight forward. Such is not the case
a plan or management policy performs. There are when dealing with the publics water resources.
a variety of criteria one can use to judge and A cost-benet framework, used for many
compare alternative system performances. Some decades in water resources planning and man-
of these performance criteria may be conflicting. agement, converted the different types of impacts
In these cases tradeoffs exist among conflicting into a single monetary metric. Once that was
criteria and these tradeoffs should be considered done, the task was to nd the plan or policy that
when searching for the best compromise. This maximized the net benets, i.e., the benets less
chapter presents ways of identifying and working the costs. If the maximum difference between
with these performance criteria in the political benets and costs was positive, that was the best
process of selecting the best decision. plan or policy. But not all system performance
criteria we consider today can be easily expres-
sed in monetary units. Even if monetary units
9.1 Introduction could be used for each objective, that in itself
does not address the distributional issues
Decision-makers and those who influence them involving who benets and who pays and by
are people, and peoples opinions and experi- how much. While all stakeholders may agree that
ences and goals may differ. These differences maximizing total net benets is a desirable
force one to think in terms of tradeoffs. Decisions objective, not everyone, if indeed anyone, will
in water resources management inevitably likely agree on to how best to allocate or share
involve making tradeoffs among competing those net benets among them.
opportunities, goals or objectives. One of the Clearly, water resource planning and man-
tasks of water resource system planners or agement takes place in a multiple criteria envi-
managers involved in evaluating alternative de- ronment. A key element of many problems
signs and management plans or policies is to facing designers and managers is the need to deal
identify the tradeoffs, if any, among competing explicitly with multiple ecological, economical,
opportunities, goals or objectives. It is then up to and social impacts, expressed in multiple metrics
the largely political process involving all that may result from the design, management,

The Author(s) 2017 375


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_9
376 9 Performance Criteria

and operation of water resource systems. the likelihoods of events for which decisions
Approaches that fail to recognize and explicitly are needed,
include ways of handling conflict among multi- the socially acceptable alternatives that
ple system performance measures and objectives address and meet each objective, and
and among multiple stakeholders are not likely to the key tradeoffs among all interests and
be very useful (Hipel et al. 2015). objectives involved.
Successful decision-making involves creating
a consensus among multiple participants in the When the objectives and general alternative
planning and management process. These ways of meeting these objectives are not well
include stakeholdersindividuals or interest dened, no amount of quantitative modeling and
groups who have an interest in the outcome of analysis will make up for this weakness. The
any management plan or policy. The relatively identication of objectives and general alterna-
recent acknowledgement that stakeholders need tives are the foundation upon which water
to be fully included in the decision-making pro- resource managers can develop appropriate
cesses only complicates the life of professional quantitative models. These models will provide
planners and managers. Increasingly important additional insight and denition of alternatives
sources of information come from discussion and their expected impacts. Models cannot
groups, public hearings, negotiations, and identify new ideas or so called out-of-the-box
dispute-resolution processes. Using the types of alternatives that no one has thought of before.
modeling methods discussed in this chapter can Neither can they identify the best criteria that
potentially inform the debates that occur in these should be considered in specic cases. Only our
meetings. In addition, the application of game minds can do this, individually, and then
theory may be helpful in reaching a consensus collectively.
among stakeholders having different objectives For example, periodic municipal water supply
and desires (Madani 2010; Madani and Hipel shortages might be reduced by increasing surface
2011). water reservoir storage capacity or by increasing
Eventually someone or some organization groundwater pumping. Assuming the objective
must make a decision. Even if water resource in this case is to increase the reliability of some
analysts view their job as one of providing specied level of water supply, models can be
options or tradeoffs for someone else to consider, developed to identify the tradeoffs between the
even they are making decisions that dene or cost of increased reservoir storage and pumping
limit the range of those options or tradeoffs. The capacities and the increased reliability of meeting
importance of making informed effective deci- the supply target. However these models will not
sions applies to everyone. identify and evaluate completely different alter-
natives, such as importing water by trucks or the
use of canals or pipelines from other river basins,
9.2 Informed Decision-Making implementing water use restrictions, or water
reuse, unless of course those options are included
Informed decision-making involves both, quali- in those models. Someone has to think of these
tative thinking and analysis as well as quantita- general alternatives before models can help
tive modeling (Hammond et al. 1999). identify just how many trucks or the capacities of
Qualitative thinking and analysis typically fol- canals or pipes or how to best implement water
lows quantitative analyses. Qualitative analyses reuse and for what uses.
are useful for identifying Time needs to be taken to identify the relevant
objectives and general alternatives that then can
the real objectives of concern to all stake- be included in quantitative analyses. Clearly
holders (which may be other than those some preliminary screening of general alterna-
expressed by them), tives is and should be carried out at the
9.2 Informed Decision-Making 377

qualitative level, but the alternatives that remain surprising, are the analyses providing new
(assuming the best is not obvious) should then be knowledge and understanding or have errors
further analyzed using quantitative modeling been made? How sensitive are the results to
methods. This includes the methods of quanti- various assumptions with respect to the input
fying qualitative objectives and constraints dis- data and models themselves?
cussed in Chap. 5. Thus the modeling process ends with some
Being creative in the identication of possible more qualitative study. Models do not replace
objectives and general alternatives is helped by human judgment. Humans, not quantitative
addressing the following questions: What is an models, are responsible for water resources
ideal decision? What does each stakeholder think planning and management decisions as well as
other stakeholders ideal decisions would be? the decision-making process itself that identies
What is to be avoided? What makes a great performance criteria and general alternatives.
alternative, even an infeasible one, so great?
What makes a terrible alternative so terrible?
How would each individuals best alternative be 9.3 Performance Criteria
justied to someone else? When each manager and General Alternatives
and stakeholder has gone through such thinking,
the combined set of responses may be more There is a way to identify performance criteria
comprehensive and less limited by what others that matter most to stakeholders (Gregory and
say or believe. They can become a basis for Keeney 1994). One can begin with very broad
group discussions and consensus building. fundamental goals, such as public health,
General statements dening objectives can be national as well as individual security, economic
converted to ones that are short and include the development, happiness, and general wellbeing.
words maximize or minimize. For example, Almost anyone would include these as worthy
minimize cost, maximize net benets, maximize objectives. Just how these goals are to be met can
reliability, maximize water quality, maximize be expressed by a host of other more specic
ecosystem biodiversity, minimize construction objectives or criteria.
time, or minimize the maximum deviations from By asking how any specied broad funda-
some target storage volume or a target water mental criterion or objective can be achieved
allocation. Economic, environmental, ecological, usually leads, eventually, to more specic system
and purely physical objectives such as these are performance criteria or objectives and to the
able to become the objective functions that drive means of improving these criteria, i.e., to the
the solutions of optimization models, as illus- general system design and operating policy
trated in many of the previous chapters. Social alternatives themselves. As one gets further from
objectives should also be considered. Examples the fundamental objective that most will agree to,
might include maximize employment, maximize there is a greater chance of stakeholder dis-
interagency coordination, maximize stakeholder agreement. For example we might answer the
participation, and minimize legal liability and the question How can we maximize public health?
potential of future legal action and costs. by suggesting the maximization of surface and
Quantitative modeling is employed to identify groundwater water quality. How? By minimizing
more precisely the design and operation of wastewater discharges into surface water bodies
structural and nonstructural alternatives that best and groundwater aquifers. How? By minimizing
satisfy system performance criteria, and the wastewater production, or by maximizing
impacts and tradeoffs among these various per- removal rates at wastewater treatment facilities,
formance criteria. Once such analyses have been or by minimizing the concentrations of pollutants
performed, it is always wise to question whether in runoff or by increasing downstream flow
or not the results are reasonable. Are they as augmentation from upstream reservoirs or by a
expected? If not, why not? If the results are combination of flow augmentation and
378 9 Performance Criteria

wastewater treatment. How? By increasing 9.3.1 Constraints on Decisions


reservoir storage capacity and subsequent relea-
ses upstream and by upgrading wastewater Constraints limit alternatives. There are some
treatment to a tertiary level. And so on. laws of physics that obviously we cannot change.
Each how question can have multiple Water will naturally flow downhill unless of
answers. This can lead to a tree of branches, each course we pump it uphill. Society can limit what
branch representing a different and more specic can be done to satisfy any performance criterion
performance criterion or an alternative way to as well, but it is not the time to worry about them
accomplish a higher level objective. In the during the process of objective and general
example just illustrated, the answer to how to alternative identication. Be creative, and don
improve water quality might include a combi- not get stuck in the status quo, i.e., carrying on as
nation of water and wastewater treatment, flow usual or depending on a default (and often
augmentation, improved wastewater collection politically risk-free) alternative. It may turn out
systems and reduced applications of fertilizers these default or risk-free alternatives are the best
and pesticides on land to reduce nonpoint source alternatives, but that can be determined later.
pollutant discharges. There are others. If the When performing qualitative exercises to iden-
lower level objective of minimizing point source tify objectives and general alternatives enlarge
discharges had been the rst objective consid- the number of options and think creatively. If
ered, many of those other alternatives may not something seems really worth further considera-
have been identied. The more fundamental the tion, then assume it can happen. If it is really
objective, the greater will be the range of alter- worth it, engineers can do it. Lawyers can change
natives that might be considered. laws. Society can and will want to adaptagain
If any of the alternatives identied for meeting if it is really important.
some objective are not considered desirable, it is Consider for example the water that is
a good sign that there are other objectives that pumped uphill at all pumped storage hydroelec-
should be considered. For example, if flow aug- tric facilities, or the changing objectives over
mentation is not desired, it could mean that in time related to managing water and ecosystems
addition to water quality considerations, the in the Mekong, Rhine and Senegal Rivers, or in
regime of water flows, or the existing uses of the the Great Lakes, the Sacramento-San Joaquin
water are also being considered and flow aug- Delta, and Florida Everglades regions in the US.
mentation may detract from those other objec- There are other traps to avoid in the planning
tives. If a stakeholder has trouble explaining why and management process. Do not become
some alternative will not work, it is a possible anchored to any initial feasible or best-case or
sign there are other objectives and alternatives worst-case scenario. Be creative when identify-
waiting to be identied and evaluated. What are ing scenarios. Consider the whole spectrum of
they? Get them identied. Consider them along possible events that your decision responds to.
with the others that have been already dened. Do not focus solely on extreme events to the
More fundamental objectives can be identied exclusion of the more likely events. While toxic
by asking the question why? Answers to the spills and floods bring headlines, and suffering,
question why? will lead one back to increas- they are not the usual more routine events that
ingly more fundamental objectives. A funda- one must also plan for.
mental objective is reached when the only It is tempting to consider past or sunk costs
answer to why is it is what everyone really when determining where additional investments
wants or something similar. Thinking hard should be made. If past investments were a
about why will help clarify what is considered mistake, it is only our egos that motivate us to
most important. justify those past investments by spending more
9.3 Performance Criteria and General Alternatives 379

money on them instead of taking more effective technical information fails to address the real
actions. objectives or system performance measures of
Finally, target values of objectives and goals interest to stakeholders, signicant time and
should not be set too low (easy to meet). The resources can be wasted in the discussions that
chances of nding good unconventional alterna- take place in stakeholder meetings, as well as in the
tives are increased if targets are set high, even analyses that are performed in technical studies.
beyond reach. High aspirations often force indi- Finding the best compromise among com-
viduals to think in entirely new ways. Politically peting decisions is a political or social process.
it may end up that only marginal changes to the The process is helped by having available the
status quo will be acceptable, but it is not the tradeoffs among competing objectives. Models
time to worry about that when identifying that can identify these tradeoffs among quanti-
objectives and general alternatives. tative objectives cannot go the next step, i.e.,
identify the best compromise decision. While
models can help identify and evaluate alterna-
9.3.2 Tradeoffs Among Performance tives, they cannot take the place of human
Criteria judgments that are needed to make the nal
decisionthe selection of the best tradeoffs.
Tradeoffs are inevitable when there are conflict- Models can help identify nondominated
ing multiple objectives, and multiple objectives tradeoffs among competing objectives or system
are inevitable when there are many stakeholders performance indicators. These are sometimes
or participants in the planning and management called efcient tradeoffs. Efcient decisions are
process. We all want clean water in our aquifers, those that cannot be altered so as to gain more of
lakes, rivers and streams, but if it costs money to one objective without worsening one or more
achieve that desired quality there are other other objective values. If one of multiple
activities or projects involving education, health conflicting objective values is to be improved,
care, security, or even other environmental some worsening of one or more other objective
restoration or pollution prevention and reduction values will likely be necessary. Dominated or so
efforts, that compete for those same, and often called inferior decisions are those in which it is
limited, amounts of money. possible to improve at least one objective value
Tradeoffs arise because we all want more of without worsening any of the others.
good things, and many of these good things are Many will argue that these dominated deci-
conflicting. We cannot have cleaner water in our sions can be eliminated from further considera-
homes or in our environment without spending tions, since why would any rational individual
money, and minimizing costs is always worthy prefer such decisions when there are better ones
of consideration. Identifying these tradeoffs is available with respect to all the objectives being
one of the tasks of qualitative as well as quanti- considered. However, some may consider a
tative analyses. Qualitatively we can identify quantitatively nondominated or efcient solution
what the tradeoffs will involve, e.g., cleaner inferior and dominated with respect to one or
water in our streams and rivers require increased more other objectives that were omitted from the
costs. Just how much money it will cost to analysis. Eliminating inferior or dominated
increase the minimum dissolved oxygen con- alternatives from the political decision-making
centration in a specic lake by 3, or 4, or 5 mg/l process may not always be very helpful. One of
is the task of quantitative analyses. these inferior alternatives could be viewed as the
Finding a balance among all conflicting per- best by some who are considering other criteria
formance criteria characterizes water management either not included or, in their opinions, not
decision-making. Understanding the technical properly quantied in such analyses.
information that identies the efcient or non- Tradeoffs exist not only among conflicting
dominated tradeoffs is obviously helpful. Yet if the outcome objectives, system performance
380 9 Performance Criteria

indicators, or impacts. Tradeoffs can also exist height of the protected flood stage. It could have
among alternative processes of decision-making. a regional development objective quantied as
Some of the most important objectivesand increased income. Quantication does not
toughest tradeoffsinvolve process decisions require that monetary costs and benets be
that establish how a decision is going to be made. assigned to all objectives.
What is, for example, the best use of time and The following subsections review various
nancial resources in performing a quantitative economic, environmental, ecological, and social
modeling study, who should be involved in such criteria.
a study, who should be advising such a study,
and how should stakeholders be involved? Such
questions often lie at the heart of water and other 9.4.1 Economic Criteria
resource use disputes and can signicantly
influence the trust and cooperation among all Water resource system development and man-
who participate in the process. They can also agement is often motivated by economic criteria.
influence the willingness of stakeholders to It goes without saying that money is important;
support any nal decision or selected manage- its completing uses often makes it a limiting
ment policy or plan. resource Most reservoirs, canals, hydropower
facilities, groundwater-pumping systems, locks,
and flood control structures have been built and
9.4 Quantifying Performance are operated for economic reasons. The benets
Criteria and costs of such infrastructure can be expressed
in monetary units. Typical objectives have been
So far this chapter has focused on the critical either to maximize the present value of the net
qualitative aspects of identifying objectives and benets (total benets less the costs) or minimize
general alternatives. The remainder of this the costs of providing some purpose or service.
chapter will focus on quantifying various criteria To achieve the former involves benet-cost
and how to use them to compare various alter- analyses and to achieve the latter involves
natives and to identify the tradeoffs among them. cost-effectiveness analyses.
What is important here, however, is to realize Applied to water resources, maximization of
that considerable effort is worth spending on net benets requires the efcient and reliable
getting the general objectives and alternatives allocation, over both time and space, of water (in
right before spending any time on their quan- its two dimensions: quantity and quality) to its
tication. There are no quantitative aids for this, many uses, including hydropower, recreation,
just hard thinking, perhaps keeping in mine some water supply, flood control, navigation, irriga-
of the advice just presented. tion, cooling, waste disposal and assimilation and
Quantication of an objective is the adoption of habitat enhancement. The following example
some quantitative (numerical) scale that provides illustrates the maximization of net benets from a
an indicator for how well the objective would be multiple-purpose reservoir.
achieved. For example, one of the objectives of a Consider a reservoir that can be used for
watershed conservation program might be pro- irrigation and recreation. Irrigation and recreation
tection or preservation of wildlife. In order to rank are not very compatible. Recreation benets are
how various plans meet this objective, a numerical greater when reservoir elevations remain high
criterion is needed, such as acres of preserved throughout the summer recreation season, just
habitat or populations of key wildlife species. when satisfying an irrigation demand that
Quantication does not require that all exceeds the inflow would normally cause a drop
objectives be described in comparable units. The in the reservoir storage level. Thus the project
same watershed conservation program could has two conflicting purposes: provision of irri-
have a flood control objective quantied as the gation water and of recreation opportunities.
9.4 Quantifying Performance Criteria 381

Fig. 9.2 Two-purpose project involving tradeoffs


Fig. 9.1 A two-purpose planning problem showing the between irrigation and recreation income and various
feasible and efcient combinations of irrigation water constant total income levels, I1 < I2 < I3
X and recreation visitor days Y

water and recreation opportunities be pX and pY,


Let X be the quantity of irrigation water to be respectively. Also assume that the entrepreneurs
delivered to farmers each year and Y the number costs are xed and independent of X and Y. In
of visitor days of recreation use on the reservoir. this case the total income is
Possible levels of irrigation and recreation are
shown in Fig. 9.1. The solid line in Fig. 9.1, I pxX pyY 9:1
termed the production-possibility frontier or ef-
ciency frontier, is the boundary of the feasible Values of X and Y that result in xed income
combinations of X and Y. levels I1 < I2 < I3 are plotted in Fig. 9.2. The
Any combination of X and Y within the sha- value of X and Y that maximizes the entrepre-
ded blue area can be obtained by operation of the neurs income is indicated by the point on the
reservoir (i.e., by regulating the amount of water production-possibility frontier yielding an
released for irrigation and other uses). Obviously income of I3. Incomes greater than I3 are not
the more of both X and Y the better. Thus possible.
attention generally focuses on the Now assume the reservoir is owned and
production-possibility frontier which comprises operated by a public agency and that competitive
those combinations of X and Y that are on the conditions prevail. The prices pX and pY reflect
frontier. They are said to be technologically the value of the irrigation water and recreation
efcient in the sense that more of either X or opportunities to the users. The aggregated value
Y cannot be obtained without a decrease in the of the project is indicated by the users willing-
other. The shape and location of the ness to pay for the irrigation and recreation out-
production-possibility frontier is determined by puts. In this case, this willingness to pay is pX
the quantity of available resources (water, reser- X + pY Y, which is equivalent to the entrepre-
voir storage capacity, recreation facilities, etc.) neurs income. Private operation of the reservoir
and their ability to satisfy various demands for to maximize income or government operation to
both X and Y. maximize user benets both should, under com-
Assume that a private entrepreneur owns this petitive conditions, produce the same result.
two-purpose reservoir in a competitive environ- When applied to water resources planning,
ment (i.e., there are a number of competing irri- benet-cost analysis presumes a similarity
gation water suppliers and reservoir recreation between decision-making in the private and
sites). Let the unit market prices for irrigation public sectors. It also assumes that the income
382 9 Performance Criteria

resulting from the project is a reasonable surro- the plan Xj are willing to pay rather than forego
gate for the projects social value. the project. This represents the aggregate value
of the project to the beneciaries. Let D(Xj) equal
9.4.1.1 Benefit and Cost Estimation the amount the non-beneciaries of plan Xj are
In a benet-cost analysis, one may need to esti- willing to pay to prevent it from being imple-
mate the monetary value of irrigation water, mented. This includes the social value of the
shoreline property, land inundated by a lake, lake resources that will be unavailable to society if
recreation, shing opportunities, scenic vistas, project or plan Xj is implemented. The aggregate
hydropower production, navigation, or the loss of net willingness to pay W(Xj) for plan Xj is equal
a wild river. The situations in which benets and to the difference between B(Xj) and D(Xj),
costs may need to be estimated are sometimes      
grouped into four categories, reflecting the way W Xj B Xj D Xj 9:2
prices can be determined. These situations are
Plans Xj can be ranked according to the aggregate
1. market prices exist and are an accurate net willingness to pay, W(Xj). If, for example, W
reflection of marginal social values (i.e., (Xj) > W(Xk), it is inferred that plan Xj is
marginal willingness to pay for all individu- preferable or superior to plan Xk.
als). This situation often occurs in the pres- One rationale for the willingness to pay cri-
ence of competitive market conditions. An terion is that if B(Xj) > D(Xj), the beneciaries
example would be agricultural commodities could compensate the losers and everyone would
that are not subsidized, i.e., do not have benet from the project. However, this compen-
supported prices (some do exist!). sation rarely happens. There is usually no
2. market prices exist but for various reasons do mechanism established for this compensation to
not reflect marginal social values. Examples be paid. Those who lose favorite scenic sites or
include price-supported agricultural crops, the opportunity to use a wild river or who must
labor that would otherwise be unemployed, or hear the noise or breathe dirtier air or who suffer
inputs whose production generates pollution, a loss in their property value because of the
the economic and social cost of which is not project are seldom compensated.
included in its price. This compensation criterion also ignores the
3. market prices are essentially nonexistent, but resultant income redistribution, which should be
for which it is possible to infer or determine considered during the plan selection process. The
what users or consumers would pay if a compensation criterion implies that the marginal
market existed. An example is outdoor social value of income to all affected parties is
recreation. the same. If a projects benets accrue primarily
4. no real or simulated market-like process is to affluent individuals and the costs are borne by
easily conceived. This category may be rela- lower-income groups, B(X) may be larger than D
tively rare. Although scenic amenities and (X) simply because the beneciaries can pay
historic sites are often considered appropriate more than the non-beneciaries. It matters who
examples, both are sometimes privately benets and who pays, i.e., who gets to eat the
owned and managed to generate income. pie and how much of it as well as how big the pie
is. Traditional benet-cost analyses typically
For the rst three categories, benets and ignore these distributional issues.
costs can be measured as the aggregate net In addition to these and other conceptual dif-
willingness to pay of those affected by the pro- culties related to the willingness-to-pay crite-
ject. Assume, for example, that alternative water rion, practical measurement problems also exist.
resources projects X1, X2, , are being consid- Many of the products of water resources plans
ered. Let B(Xj) equal the amount beneciaries of are public or collective goods. This means that
9.4 Quantifying Performance Criteria 383

they are essentially indivisible, and once pro- Market Prices Equal Social Values
vided to any individual it is very difcult not to Consider the estimation of irrigation benets in
provide them to others. Collective goods often the irrigation-recreation example discussed in the
also have the property that their non- previous section. Let X be the quantity of irri-
consumptive use by one person does not pro- gation water supplied by the project each year. If
hibit or infringe upon their use by others. the prevailing market price pX reflects the mar-
Community flood protection is an example of ginal social value of water and if that price is not
a public good. Once protection is provided for affected by the projects operation, the value of
one individual, it is often simultaneously pro- the water is just pX X. However, it often happens
vided for many others. As a result, it is not in an that large water projects have a major impact on
individuals self-interest to volunteer to help pay the prices of the commodities they supply. In
for the project by contributing an amount equal such cases, the value of water from our example
to his or her actual benets if others are willing to irrigation district would not be based on prices
pay for the project. However, if others are going before or after project implementation. Rather,
to pay for the project (such as the taxpayers), the total value of the water X to the users is the
individuals may exaggerate their own benets to total amount they would be willing to pay for it.
ensure that the project is undertaken. Let Q(p) be the amount of water the con-
Determining what benets should be attrib- sumers would want to buy at a unit price p. For
uted to a project is not always simple and the any price p, consumers will continue to buy the
required accounting can become rather involved. water until the value of another unit of water is
In a benet-cost analysis, economic conditions less than or equal to the price p. The function Q
should rst be projected for a base case in which (p) denes what is called the demand function.
no project is implemented and the benets and As illustrated by Fig. 9.3, the lower the unit
costs are estimated for that scenario. Then the price, the more water individuals are willing to
benets and costs for each project are measured buy, i.e., the greater will be the demand.
as the incremental economic impacts that occur The willingness to pay a given unit price p is
in the economy over these baseline conditions dened by the area under the demand curve. As
due to the project. The appropriate method for Fig. 9.3 suggests, there are some who would be
benet and cost estimation depends on whether willing to pay a higher price for a given amount
or not the market prices reflecting true social of water than others. As the unit price decreases,
values are available or if such prices can be more individuals are willing to buy more water.
constructed. The total willingness to pay for a given amount

Fig. 9.3 Demand function


dening how much water
Q will be purchased for a
specied unit price p. The
shaded area represents the
willingness to pay for a
quantity q*
384 9 Performance Criteria

of water q* is the area under the demand curve


from Q = 0 to Q = q*.
Z q

Willingness to pay for q Q1 qdq
0
9:3

Consumers willingness to pay for a product is


an important concept in welfare economics.

Market Prices not Equal to Social Values


It frequently occurs that market prices do not
truly reflect the true social value of the various Fig. 9.4 Estimated relationship between travel cost and
goods and services supplied by a water resources visits per capita
project. In such cases it is necessary for the
planner to estimate the appropriate values of the
quantities in question. There are several proce- access to the recreation area is free, 20,000 visits
dures that can be used depending on the situa- per year will be made from Center A at an
tion. A rather simple technique that can reach average round-trip travel cost of $1. Similarly
absurd conclusions if incorrectly applied is to 30,000 visits per year will come from Center B,
equate the benets of a service to the cost or at an average round-trip cost of $2.
supplying the service by the least expensive The benets derived from the proposed
alternative method. Thus the benets from recreation area can be estimated from an imputed
hydroelectricity generation could be estimated as demand curve. First, as illustrated in Fig. 9.4, a
the cost of generating that electricity by the graph of travel cost as a function of the average
least-cost alternative method using solar, wind, number of visits per capita can be constructed.
geothermal, coal-red, natural gas, or nuclear Two points are available: an average of two visits
energy sources. Clearly, this approach to benet per capita (from center A) at a cost of $1/visit,
estimation is only valid if in the absence of the and an average of one visit per capita (from
projects adoption, the service in question would Center B) at a cost of $2 visit. These travel cost
in fact be demanded at, and supplied by, the data are extrapolated to the ordinate and abscissa.
least-cost alternative method. The pitfalls asso- Even assuming that there are no plans to
ciated with this method of benet and cost esti- charge admission at the site, if users respond to
mation can be avoided if one clearly identies an entrance fee as they respond to travel costs, it
reasonable withand without project scenarios. is possible to estimate what the user response
In other situations, simulated or imagined might be if an entrance fee were to be charged.
markets can be used to derive the demand This information will provide a demand curve for
function for a good or service and to estimate the recreation at the site.
value of the amount of that good or service Consider rst a $1 admission price to be
generated or consumed by the project. The fol- added to the travel cost for recreation. The total
lowing hypothetical example illustrates how this cost to users from population Center A would
technique can be used to estimate the value of then be $2 per visit. From Fig. 9.4 at $2 per visit,
outdoor recreation. one visit per capita is made; hence 10,000 visits
Assume a unique recreation area is to be per year can be expected from Center A. The
developed which will serve two population cen- resulting cost to users from Center B is $3 per
ters. Center A has a population of 10,000 and the visit, and hence from Fig. 9.4 no visits would be
more distant Center B has a population or expected. Therefore, one point on the demand
30,000. From questionnaires it is estimated that if curve (10,000 visits at $1) is obtained. Similarly,
9.4 Quantifying Performance Criteria 385

regulations. These constraints are to be met per-


haps while maximizing other economic benets.
Their shadow prices or dual variables (indicating
the marginal cost associated with a unit change in
the regulation or requirement) is likely to be as
close to monetizing such non-monetary impacts
as one can get, yet recognizing the actual mon-
etary benets could be greater. Legislative and
administrative processes rarely if ever determine
the explicit benets derived from meeting these
environmental and ecological requirements or
regulations.
To a certain extent, environmental (including
Fig. 9.5 Demand function for recreation facility
esthetic) objectives, if quantied, can be incor-
porated into a multiobjective decision-making
it can be inferred that at a $2 admission price process. However, this falls short of the assign-
there will be no visits from either center. A nal ment of monetary benets that is often possible
point, corresponding to a zero admission price for the rst three categories of benets.
(no added costs) is just the expected site atten-
dance (20,000 + 30,000 = 50,000 visits). The 9.4.1.2 A Note Concerning Costs
resulting demand curve is shown in Fig. 9.5. To be consistent in the estimation of net benets
Recreation total willingness to pay benets are from water resources projects, cost estimates
equal to the area under the demand curve or should reflect opportunity costs, the value of
$35,000. Assuming no entrance fee is charged, resources in their most productive alternative
this amounts to $0.70 per visitor-day based on uses. This principle is much easier stated than
the expected 50,000 visits. implemented, and as a result true opportunity
Obviously, this example is illustrative only. costs are seldom included in a benet-cost anal-
The average cost of travel time (which differs for ysis. For example, if land must be purchased for
each population center) and the availability of a flood control project, is the purchase price
alternative sites must be included in a more (which would typically be used in a benet-cost
detailed analysis. analysis) the lands opportunity cost? Suppose
that the land is currently a natural area and its
No Market Processes alternative use is as a nature preserve and
In the absence of any market-like process (real or camping area. The lands purchase price may be
simulated) it is difcult to associate specic low, but this price unlikely reflects the lands true
monetary values with benets. The benets value to society. Furthermore, assume that indi-
associated with esthetics and with many aspects viduals who would otherwise be unemployed are
of environmental and ecosystem quality have hired to work on the land. The opportunity cost
long been considered difcult to quantify in for such labor is the marginal value of leisure
monetary terms. Although attempts (some by forgone, since there is no alternative productive
highly respected economists) have been made to use of those individuals. Yet, the labors must be
express environmental benets in monetary paid and their wages must be included in the
terms, the results have had limited success. In budget for the project.
most regions in the world, water resources The results of rigorous benet-cost analyses
management guidelines, where they exist, do not seldom dictate which of competing water
encourage the assignment of monetary values to resources projects and plans should be imple-
these criteria. Rather the approach is to establish mented. This is in part because of the multiob-
environmental and ecological requirements or jective nature of the decisions. One must
386 9 Performance Criteria

consider environmental impacts, income redis- can obtain by operating a system having xed
tribution effects, and a host of other local, , and capacities and target values. If the water resour-
national goals. ces available in the short run are those that can
Other important considerations are the nan- meet all the targets that were established when
cial, technical, and political feasibilities of alter- long-run decisions were made, then estimated
native plans. Particularly important when plan long-run benets can be achieved. Otherwise the
are proposed by government agencies is the rel- benets actually obtained may differ from those
ative political and legal clout of those who sup- expected. The goal is to determine the values of
port the plans and those who oppose them. Still, the long-run decision variables in a way that
a plans economic efciency is an important maximizes the present value of all the short run
measure of a plans value to society and often benets obtained given the varying water supply
serves as an indicator of whether it should be and demand conditions.
considered at all. The distinction between long-run and
short-run benets can be illustrated by consid-
9.4.1.3 Long- and Short-Run Benefit ering again a potential water user at a particular
Functions site. Assume that the long-run net benets asso-
When planning the capacities and target values ciated with various target allocations of water to
associated with water resource development that use can be estimated. These long-run net
projects, it is often convenient to think of two benets are those that will be obtained if the
types of benet functions: the long-run benets actual allocation Q equals the target allocation
and the short-run benets. In long-run planning, QT. This long-run net benet function can be
the capacities of proposed facilities and the tar- denoted as B(QT). Next assume that for various
get allocations of flows to alternative uses or xed values of the target QT the actual net ben-
target storage volumes in reservoirs are unknown ets derived from various allocations Q can be
decision variables. The values of these variables estimated. These short-run benet functions b(Q|
are to be determined in a way that achieves the QT) of allocations Q given a target allocation QT
most benecial use of available resources, even are dependent on the target QT and obviously on
when the available resources vary in magnitude the actual allocation Q. The relationship between
over time. In short-run planning, the capacity of the long-run net benets B(T) and the short-run
facilities and any associated targets are assumed net benets b(Q|QT) for a particular target QT is
known. The problem is one of managing or illustrated in Fig. 9.6.
operating a given or proposed system under The long-run function B(QT) in Fig. 9.6
varying supply and demand conditions. reflects the benets users receive when they have
For example, if a water-using rm is inter- adjusted their plans in anticipation of receiving
ested in building a factory requiring water from a an allocation equal to the target QT and actually
river, of interest to those designing the factory is receive it. The short-run benets function speci-
the amount of water the factory can expect to get. es the benets users actually receive when a
This in part may dictate the capacity of that particular allocation is less (e.g., Q1) or more
factory, the number of employees hired, and the (e.g., Q2) than the anticipated allocation, QT, and
amount of product produced, etc. On the other they cannot completely adjust their plans to the
hand, if the factory already exists, the likely issue resulting decit or surplus.
is how to manage or operate the factory when the Clearly the short-run benets associated with
water supply varies from the target levels that any allocation cannot be greater than the
were (and perhaps still are) expected. long-run benets obtainable had the rm planned
Long-run benets are those benets obtained or targeted for that allocation. The short-run
if all target allocations are met. Whatever the benet function is always going to be under, or
target, if it is satised, long-run benets result, tangent to, the long-run benet function, as
Short-run benets are the benets one actually shown in Fig. 9.6. In other words the short-run
9.4 Quantifying Performance Criteria 387

Fig. 9.6 Long-run and


short-run benet functions,
together with the loss, L
(Q1|QT), associated with a
decit allocation Q1 and
target allocation QT

benets b(Q|QT) will never exceed the long-run targets, it may not be necessary to dene the loss
benets B(Q) that could be obtained if the target as a function of the target QT. In this case the loss
QT were equal to the allocation Q. When the can be dened as a function of the decit
target QT equals the allocation Q, the values of D and/or as a function of the surplus (excess)
both functions are equal. E. Both the decit D or excess E can be dened
Flipping the short-run benet function upside by the constraint
down along a horizontal axis running through the
long-run benet function at the target QT denes Q QT D E 9:5
the short-run loss function, as illustrated in
Fig. 9.7. The short-run loss of any actual allo- Denote the loss function for a decit allocation as
cation Q equals the long-run benet of the tar- LD(D) and for a surplus allocation, LE(E). As
get allocation QT minus the short-run benet of indicated above, the later may be a negative loss,
the actual allocation, Q. i.e., a gain, at least for some range of E, as shown
in Fig. 9.7.
     
L QjQT B QT  b QjQT 9:4 The costs of the capacity of many components
or multipurpose projects are not easily expressed
This function denes the losses that occur when as functions of the targets associated with each
the target allocation cannot be met. When the use. For example the capacity, K, of a multi-
actual allocation equals the target allocation, the purpose reservoir is not usually equal to, or even
short-run loss is zero. It is possible there might be a function of, its recreation level target or its
short-run gains or benets if there is a surplus active or flood storage capacities. The costs of its
allocation over the target allocation, possibly for total capacity, C(K), are best dened as functions
a limited range of excess allocations. of that total capacity. If expressed as an annual
The short-run benet function, or its corre- cost it would include the annual amortized cap-
sponding loss function, usually depends on the ital costs as well as the annual operation, main-
value of the target allocation. However, if the tenance, and repair costs.
short-run losses associated with any decit allo- Assuming that the benet and loss functions
cation (QT Q1) or surplus allocation (Q2 QT) reflect annual benets and losses, the annual net
are relatively constant over a reasonable range of benets, NB, from all projects j is the sum of
388 9 Performance Criteria

Fig. 9.7 Short-run loss


function, L(Q|QT),
associated with an
allocation Q and
target allocation QT

each projects long-run benets Bj(Tj) that are allowed by available resources, including land,
functions of their targets, Tj, less short-run losses water, capital and labor. At times during any
Lj(Qj|Tj) and capacity costs Cj(Kj). growing season some changes can be made in
response to changes in prices and the actual
X      
NB Bj Tj  Lj Qj jTj  Cj Kj 9:6 availability of water.
j If the farmers frequently nd that insufcient
water is available in the short run to meet live-
The monetary net benets accrued by each group stock and crop requirements, then they will
of water users can also be determined so that the reassess and perhaps change their long-run plans.
income redistribution effects of a project can be They may shift to less water-intensive activities,
evaluated. seek additional water from other sources (such as
The formulation of benet functions as either deep wells), or sell their farms (and possibly
long- or short-run is, of course, a simplication water rights) and engage in other activities.
of reality. In reality, planning takes place on For the purposes of modeling, however, this
many time scales and for each time scale one planning hierarchy can generally be described by
could construct a benet function. Consider the two levels, denoted as long-run and short-run.
planning problems of farmers. In the very long The appropriate decisions included in each
run, they decide whether or not to own farms, category will depend on the time scale of a
and if so how big they are to be in a particular model.
area. On a shorter time scale, farmers allocate These long-run and short-run benet and loss
their resources to different activities depending functions are applicable to some water users, but
on what products they are producing and on the not all. They may apply in situations where
processes used to produce them. Different activ- benets or losses can be attributed to particular
ities, of course, require capital investments in allocations in each of the time periods being
farm machinery, storage facilities, pipes, pumps, modeled. They do not apply in situations where
etc., some of which cannot easily be transferred the benets or losses result only at the end of a
to other uses. At least on an annual basis, most series of time periods, each involving an alloca-
farmers reappraise these resource allocations in tion decision. Consider irrigation, for example. If
light of the projected market prices of the gen- each growing season is divided into multiple
erated commodities and the availability and cost periods, then the benets derived from each
of water, energy, labor and other required inputs. periods water allocation cannot be dened
Farmers can then make marginal adjustments in independent of any other periods allocation, at
the amounts of land devoted to different crops, least very easily. The benets from irrigation
animals, and related activities within the bounds come only when the crops are harvested, e.g., at
9.4 Quantifying Performance Criteria 389

the end of the last period of each growing season. free, and these can be included as objectives or
In this case some mechanism is needed to constraints in models (as discussed in Chap. 5).
determine the benets obtained from a series of Environmental performance criteria can vary
allocations over time, as will be presented in the depending on the specic sites and on the
next chapter. intended uses of water at that site. They should
be designed to assess, or dene, the risks of
adverse impacts on the health of humans and
9.4.2 Environmental Criteria aquatic life from exposure to pollutants.
Environmental performance criteria of con-
Environmental criteria for water resource pro- cern to water resource planners and managers can
jects can include water quantity and quality also relate to recreational and land use activities.
conditions. These conditions are usually expres- These typically address hydrologic conditions,
sed in terms of targets or constraints for flows, such as streamflows or lake or reservoir storage
depths, hydroperiods (duration of flooding), volume elevations during specied times or land
storage volumes, flow or depth regimes and use activities on watersheds. For example, to
water quality concentrations that are considered increase the safety of boaters and individuals
desirable for esthetic or public health reasons or shing downstream of hydropower reservoirs,
for various ecosystem habitats. These constraints release rules may have to be altered to reduce the
or targets could specify desired minimum or rate of flow increase that occurs during peak
maximum acceptable ranges, or rates of changes, power production. Performance criteria applica-
of these values, either for various times within ble to the adverse environmental impacts of
each year or over an n-year period. sediment loads, say caused by logging or con-
Water quality constituent concentrations are struction activities, or to the impact of nutrient
usually expressed in terms of some maximum or loads in the runoff, perhaps from agricultural and
minimum acceptable concentration, depending urban areas, are other examples.
on the particular constituents themselves and the
intended uses of the applicable water body. For
example, phosphorus would normally have a 9.4.3 Ecological Criteria
maximum permissible concentration and dis-
solved oxygen would normally have a minimum Criteria that apply to aquatic ecosystems involve
acceptable concentration. These limiting con- both water quantity and quality and are often
centrations and their specied reliabilities are compatible with environmental criteria. It is the
often based on standards established by govern- time-varying regimes of water quantities and
mental or international environmental or health qualities, not minimum or maximum values that
organizations. As standards they are viewed as benet and impact ecosystems. It is not possible
constraints. These standards could also be con- to manage water and its constituent concentra-
sidered as targets and the maximum or average tions in a way that maximizes the health or well
adverse deviations from these standards or tar- being, however, measured, of all living matter in
gets could be a system performance measure. an ecosystem. (Like people, its hard to satisfy
Few water quality criteria may be expressed in everyone all the time.) If one species feeds on
qualitative terms. Qualitative quality criteria can another, it is hard to imagine how to maximize
provide a fuzzy limit on the concentration of the health of both. The conditions that favor one
some constituent in the water. Such criteria might species group may not favor another. Hence
be expressed as, for example, the surface water variation in habitat conditions is important for the
shall be virtually free from floating petroleum- sustainability of both, and indeed for achieving
derived oils and non-petroleum oils of vegetable resilient biodiverse ecosystems.
or animal origin. Stakeholder membership While ecosystem habitats exhibit more
functions can dene what is considered virtually diversity when hydrologic conditions vary, as in
390 9 Performance Criteria

nature, than when they are relatively constant, hydrological attributes that can be managed.
hydrologic variation is often not desired by many Shown in this gure is the impact of hydrope-
human users of water resource systems. Reduc- riod duration on the habitat of three different
ing hydrologic variation and increasing the reli- species of periphyton located in different parts
ability of water resource systems has often been of the Everglades, and the impact of the dura-
the motivating factor in the design and operation tion of the hydroperiod as well as the number of
of hydraulic engineering works. years since the last dry period on a species of sh.
The state of ecological habitats is in part There are other functions that would influence
functions of how water is managed. One way to the growth of periphyton and sh, such as the
develop performance indicators of ecosystems is concentrations of phosphorus or other nutrients
to model the individual species making up the in the water. These are not shown. Figure 9.8
ecosystem, or at least a subset of important indi- merely illustrates the construction of habitat
cator species. This is often difcult. Alternatively suitability indices.
one can dene habitat suitability indices for these There are situations where it may be much
important indicator species. This requires (1) se- easier and more realistic to dene a range of
lecting the indicator species representative of some hydrological attribute values as being ideal.
each particular ecosystem, (2) identifying the Consider sh living in streams or rivers for
hydrological attributes that affect the wellbeing of example. Fish desire a variety of depths,
those indicator species during various stages of depending on their feeding and spawning activ-
their life cycles, and (3) quantifying the func- ities. Ideal trout habitat, for example, requires
tional relationships between the wellbeing of both deeper pools and shallower riffles in
those species and values of the applicable streams. There is no one ideal depth or velocity
hydrological attributes, usually on a scale from 0 or even a range of depths or velocities above or
to 1. A habitat suitability value of 1 is considered below some threshold value. In such cases it is
an ideal condition. A value of 0 is considered to possible to divide the hydrologic attribute
be very unfavorable. scale into discrete ranges and identify the ideal
Examples of hydrological attributes that fraction of the entire stream or river reach or
impact ecosystems could include flow depths, wetland that ideally would be within each dis-
velocities, constituent concentrations and tem- crete range. This exercise will result in a function
peratures, their durations or the rate of change in resembling a probability density function. The
any of those values over space and/or time at total area under the function is 1. (The rst and
particular times of the year. In wetlands the last segments of the function can represent any-
hydrologic attributes could include the duration thing less or greater than some discrete value,
of inundation (hydroperiod), time since last where appropriate, and if so the applicable seg-
drawdown below some threshold depth, the ments are understood to cover those ranges.)
duration of time below or above some threshold Such a function is shown in Fig. 9.10. Figure 9.9
depth, and time rates of change in depth. The happens to be a discrete distribution, but it
applicable attributes themselves, or perhaps just could have been a continuous one as well.
their functional relationships, can vary depending Any predicted distribution of attribute values
on the time of year and on the stage of species resulting from a simulation of a water manage-
development. ment policy can be compared to this ideal
Figure 9.8 illustrates three proposed habitat distribution, as is shown in Fig. 9.10. The frac-
suitability indices for periphyton (algae) and sh tion of overlapping areas of both distributions
in parts of the Everglades region of southern is an indication of the suitability of that habitat
Florida in the US. All are functions of for that indicator species.
9.4 Quantifying Performance Criteria 391

Fig. 9.8 Some proposed habitat suitability indices (SI) for three types of periphyton (algae) and a species of sh in
portions of the Everglades region in southern Florida of the US
392 9 Performance Criteria

some agreement or consensus. This just points to


the complexity of ecosystems and the nontrival
task of trying to simplify it to dene habitat
suitability performance criteria. However once
identied, these habitat suitability performance
criteria can give water resource planners and
managers an admittedly incomplete but at least
relative indication of the ecosystem impacts of
alternative water management policies or
practices.
The use of these habitat suitability functions
Fig. 9.9 Ideal range of values of a hydrologic attribute
along with other performance criteria in opti-
for a particular component of an ecosystem mization and simulation models will be dis-
cussed later in this chapter.

9.4.4 Social Criteria

Social performance criteria are often not easily


dened as direct functions of hydrological attri-
butes. Most social objectives are only indirectly
related to hydrological attributes or other mea-
sures of water resource system performance.
Economic, environmental, and ecological
impacts resulting from water management poli-
cies directly affect people. One social perfor-
Fig. 9.10 Predicted (simulated indicated in blue) and
ideal (indicated in red) distributions of attribute values for
mance criterion that has been considered in some
some ecosystem indicator species. The fraction of the area water resources development projects, especially
common to both distributions is a measure of habitat in developing regions, has been employment.
suitability Where employment is considered important,
alternatives that provide more jobs may be pre-
ferred to those that use more heavy machinery in
Habitat suitability Fraction of area under
place of labor, for example.
the ideal and simulated
Another social performance criterion is
distributions ofattribute values: human settlement displacement. The number of
9:7 families that must move from their homes
because of, for example, flood plain restoration
In Fig. 9.10, this is the red shaded area under the or reservoir construction, is always of concern.
blue curve. These impacts can be expressed as a function of
To identify a representative set of indicator the extent of flood plain restoration or reservoir
species of any ecosystem, the hydrologic attri- storage capacity, respectively. Often the people
butes or stressors that impact those indicator most affected are in the lower-income groups,
species, and nally the specic functional rela- and this raises legitimate issues of social justice
tionships between the hydrologic attributes and and equity. Human resettlement impacts have
the habitat suitability performance indicators, is both social and economic dimensions.
not a trivial task. The greater the number of Social objectives are often the more funda-
experienced individuals involved in such an mental objectives discussed earlier in this chap-
exercise, the more difcult it may be to reach ter. Asking why identies them. Why improve
9.4 Quantifying Performance Criteria 393

water quality? Why prevent flood damage? Why, information on the tradeoffs among conflicting
or why not, build a reservoir? Why restore a quantitative performance criteria. Again, any
flood plain or wetland? Conversely, if social nal decision will be based on qualitative as well
objectives are rst identied, by asking and then as this quantitative information in a political and
answering how they can be achieved usually social process, not by or in a computer.
results in the identication of economic, envi- Even if the same units of measure, e.g.,
ronmental and ecological objectives more monetary ones, can be used for each performance
directly related to water management. measure or objective, it is not always appropriate
The extent of press coverage or of public to simply sum them together into a single mea-
interest and participation in the planning and sure or objective that can be maximized or
evaluation processes can also be an indicator of minimized. Consider for example a water
social satisfaction with water management. In resources development project to be designed to
times of social stress due to, for example, floods, maximize net economic benets. In the US this is
droughts, or disease caused by waterborne bac- sometimes designated the national economic
teria, viruses, and pollutants, press coverage and development (NED) objective. Another objective
public involvement often increases. (Public may be to distribute the costs and benets of the
interest also increases when there is a lot of project in an equitable way. Both objectives are
money to be spent but this is often a result of measured in the same monetary units. While
substantial public interest as well.) It is a con- everyone may agree that the biggest pie (i.e., the
tinuing challenge to actively engage an often maximum net benets) should be obtained,
disinterested public in water management plan- subject to various environmental and ecological
ning at times when there are no critical water constraints perhaps, not everyone will likely
management impacts being felt and not a lot of agree as to how that pie should be divided up
money is being spent. Yet this is just the time among all the stakeholders. It also matters who
such planning for more stressful conditions pays and who benets, and by how much. Again,
should take place. issues of equity and social justice involve judg-
ments, and the challenge of water resource
planners and managers, and elected politicians, is
9.5 Multicriteria Analyses to make good judgments. The result is often a
plan or policy that does not maximize net eco-
Given multiple performance criteria measured in nomic benets. Requiring all producers of
multiple ways, how can one determine the best wastewater effluent to treat their wastes to the
decision, i.e., the best way to develop and man- best practical level before discharging the
age water? Just what is best, or as some put it, remaining effluent, regardless of the quality or
rational? The answer to these questions will often assimilative capacity of the receiving bodies of
differ depending on who is being asked. There is water, is one example of this compromise
rarely an alternative that makes every interest between economic, environmental, and social
group or impacted stakeholder the happiest. criteria.
When agreement is not universal and when some The irrigation-recreation example presented
objectives conflict with others, we can identify earlier in this chapter illustrates some basic
the efcient tradeoffs among the objective values concepts in multiobjective planning. As indicated
each stakeholder would like to have. In this in Fig. 9.1, one of the functions of multiobjective
section some ways of identifying efcient trade- planning is the identication of plans that are
offs are reviewed. These methods of multicriteria technologically efcient. These are plans that
or multiobjective analyses are not designed to dene the production-possibility frontier. Feasi-
identify the best solution, but only to provide ble plans that are not on this frontier are inferior
394 9 Performance Criteria

in the sense that it is always possible to identity The goal of multiobjective modeling is the
alternatives that will improve one or more generation of a set of technologically feasible and
objective values without making others worse. efcient plans. Recall that an efcient plan is one
Although the identication of feasible and that is not dominated.
efcient plans is seldom a trivial matter, it is
conceptually straightforward. Deciding which of
these efcient plans is the best is quite another 9.5.1 Dominance
matter. One needs some way to compare them.
Social welfare functions that could provide a A plan X dominates all others if it results in an
basis for comparison is impossible to construct, equal or superior value for all objectives, and at
and the reduction of multiple objectives to a least one objective value is strictly superior to
single criterion (as in Fig. 9.2), especially if they those of each other plan. In symbols, assuming
are conflicting, is seldom acceptable in practice. that all objectives j are to be maximized, plan
When the various objectives of a water alternative i, Xi, dominates if
resources planning project cannot be combined
into a single scalar objective function, a vector Zj X i Zj Xk for all objectives j and plans k
optimization representation of the problem may 9:9
be applicable. Let the vector X represent the set
of unknown decision variables whose values are and for each plan k i there is at least one
to be determined and let Zj(X) be a performance objective j* such that
criterion or objective that is to be maximized.
Each performance criterion or objective j is a Zj X i [ Zj X k 9:10
function of these unknown decision variable
values. Assuming that all objectives Zj(X) are to Not very often does one plan dominate all others.
be maximized, the model can be written If it does, pick it! More often different plans will
dominate all plans for different objectives. How-
 
maximize Z1 X; Z2 X; . . .; Zj X; . . .; ZJ X ever, if there exists two plans k and h such that the
values of all objectives j for plan k are never less
than that for plan h (Zj(Xk) Zj(Xh)), and for some
subject to: objective j*, plan k provides a higher value than
does plan h, (Zj*(Xk) > Zj*(Xh)), then plan
gi X bi i 1; 2; . . .; m 9:8
k dominates plan h and plan Xh can be dropped
The objective in Eq. 9.8 is a vector consisting of from further consideration. This assumes of
J separate objectives. The m constraints gi(X) = course that all objectives are being considered. If
bi dene the feasible region of solutions. Again, some objectives are not included in the analysis,
the vector X represents all the unknown decision perhaps because they cannot be quantied, infe-
variables whose values are to be determined by rior plans with respect to those objectives that are
solving the model. included in the analysis should not be rejected
The vector optimization model is a concise from eventual consideration just based on this
way of representing a multiobjective problem but quantitative analysis. To work, dominance anal-
it is not very useful when trying to solve it. In ysis must consider all objectives. In practice this
reality, a vector can be maximized or minimized condition is often impossible to meet.
only if it can be reduced to a scalar. Thus the Dominance analysis requires that participants
multiobjective planning problem dened by in the planning and management process specify
Model 9.8 cannot, in general, be solved without all the objectives that are to be considered. It
additional information. Various ways of solving does not require the assessment of the relative
this multiobjective model are discussed in the importance of each objective. Non-inferior, ef-
following subsections. cient, or nondominated solutions are often called
9.5 Multicriteria Analyses 395

Pareto optimal or Pareto efcient because they 9.5.2 The Weighting Method
satisfy the conditions proposed by the Italian
economist and social theorist Vilfredo Pareto The weighting approach involves assigning a
(18481923). A set of objective values is ef- relative weight to each objective to convert the
cient if in order to improve the value of any objective vector (in Eq. 9.8) to a scalar. This
single objective, one must accept a diminishment scalar is the weighted sum of the separate
of at least one other objective. objective functions. The multiobjective Model
Consider for example three alternatives A, B, 9.8 becomes
and C. Assume, as shown in Fig. 9.11, that plan
C is inferior to plan A with respect to objective maximize Z w1 Z1 X w2 Z2 X. . .
Z1(X) and also inferior to plan B with respect to wj Zj X. . . wJ ZJ X
objective Z2(X). Plan C might still be considered subject to:
the best with respect to both objectives Z1(X) and
gi X bi i 1; 2; . . .; m 9:11
Z2(X). While plan C could have been inferior to
both A and B, as is plan D in Fig. 9.11, it should
where the nonnegative weights wj are specied
not necessarily be eliminated from consideration
constants. The values of these weights wj are
just based on a pair-wise comparison. In fact plan
varied systematically, and the model is solved
D, even though inferior with respect to both
for each combination of weight values to gener-
objectives Z1(X) and Z2(X), might be the pre-
ate a set of technically efcient (or non-inferior)
ferred plan if another objective were included.
plans.
Two common approaches for identifying
The foremost attribute of the weighting
nondominated plans that together identify the
approach is that the tradeoffs or marginal rate of
efcient tradeoffs among all the objectives
substitution of one objective for another at each
Zj(X) in the Model Eq. 9.8 are the weighting and
identied point on the objective functions
constraint methods. Both methods require
production-possibility frontier is explicitly spec-
numerous solutions of a single objective man-
ied by the relative weights. The marginal rate of
agement model to generate points on the objec-
substitution between any two objectives Zj and
tive functions production-possibility frontier
Zk, at a specied constant value of X, is
(the blue line in Fig. 9.11).

Fig. 9.11 Four discrete


plans along with a
continuous efciency
frontier associated with two
objectives, Z1 and Z2.
A pair-wise comparison of
plans or objectives may not
identify all the
nondominated plans. All
objectives should be
considered before declaring
a plan inferior
396 9 Performance Criteria

Fig. 9.12 The efciency


frontier between two
objectives, Z1(X) and
Z2(X), showing the
reduction in one objective,
say Z1(X), as the relative
weight, w2, associated with
the other objective,
increases

  among conflicting objectives. After a decision is


 dZj =dZk jxconstant wk =wj 9:12
made, the weights that produce that solution
This applies when each of the objectives is might be considered the best, at least under the
continuously differentiable at the point X in circumstances and at the time when the decision
question. This is illustrated for a two-objective was made. They will unlikely be the weights that
maximization problem in Fig. 9.12. will apply in other places in other circumstances
These relative weights can be varied over at other times.
reasonable ranges to generate a wide range of A principal disadvantage of the weighting
plans that reflect different priorities. Alterna- approach is that it cannot generate the complete set
tively, specic values of the weights can be of efcient plans unless the efciency frontier is
selected to reflect preconceived ideas of the rel- strictly concave (decreasing slopes) for maxi-
ative importance of each objective. It is clear that mization, as it is in Figs. 9.1 and 9.12. If the
the prior selection of weights requires value frontier, or any portion of it, is convex, only the
judgments. If each objective value is divided by endpoints of the convex region will be identied
its maximum possible value, then the weights using the weighting method, as illustrated in
can range from 0 to 1 and sum to 1, to reflect the Fig. 9.13.
relative importance given to each objective.
For many projects within developing coun-
tries, these weights are often estimated by the 9.5.3 The Constraint Method
agencies nancing the development projects. The
weights specied by these agencies can, and The constraint method for multiobjective plan-
often do, differ from those implied by national or ning can produce the entire set of efcient plans
regional policy. But regardless of who does it, for any shape of efciency frontier, including that
the estimation of appropriate weights requires a shown in Fig. 9.13, assuming there are tradeoffs
study of the impacts on the economy, society, among the objectives. In this method one
and development priorities involved. objective, say Zk(X) is maximized subject to
Fortunately here we are not concerned with lower limits Lj, on the other objectives, j k. The
nding the best set of weights, but merely using solution of the model, corresponding to any set
these weights to identify the efcient tradeoffs of feasible lower limits Lj, produces an efcient
9.5 Multicriteria Analyses 397

Fig. 9.13 An efciency


frontier that cannot be
completely identied
within its convex region
using the weighting method
when objectives are being
maximized. Similarly for
concave regions when
objectives are being
minimized

alternative if the lower bounds on the other The number of solutions to a weighting or
objective values are binding. constraint method model can be reduced con-
In its general form, the constraint model is siderably if the participants in the planning and
management process can identify the acceptable
maximize Zk X 9:13 weights or lower limits. However this is not the
language of decision-makers. Decision-makers
subject to who count on the support of each stakeholder
interest group are not happy in assigning weights
gi X bi i 1; 2; . . .; m 9:14
that imply the relative importance of those vari-
ous stakeholder interests. In addition, decision-
Zj X  Lj 8j 6 k: 9:15 makers should not be expected to know what
they may want until they know what they can
Note that the dual variables associated with the get, and at what cost (often politically as much as
right-hand-side values Lj are the marginal rates of economically). However, there are ways of
substitution or rate or change of Zk(X) per unit modifying the weighting or constraint methods to
change in Lj (or Zj(X) if binding). reduce the amount of effort in identifying these
Figure 9.14 illustrates the constraint method tradeoffs as well as the amount of information
for a two-objective problem. generated that is of no interest to those making
An efciency frontier identifying the tradeoffs decisions. This can be done using interactive
among conflicting objectives can be dened by methods that will be discussed shortly.
solving the model many times for many values of The weighting and constraint methods are
the lower bounds. Just as with the weighting among many methods available for generating
method, this can be a big job if there are many efcient or non-inferior solutions (see, for exam-
objectives. If there are more than two or three ple, Steuer 1986). The use of methods that gen-
objectives the results cannot be plotted. Pair-wise erate many solutions, even just efcient ones,
tradeoffs that can easily be plotted do not always assumes that once all the non-inferior alternatives
clearly identify nondominated alternatives, as have been identied, the participants in the
previously demonstrated. planning and management process will be able to
398 9 Performance Criteria

Fig. 9.14 The constraint


method for identifying the
efciency frontier by
maximizing Z1(X) while
constraining Z2(X) to be no
less than L2

select the best compromise alternative from each objective that is to be maximized. Those
among them. In some situations this has worked. alternatives that do not meet these minimum
Undoubtedly, there will be planning activities in performance values are eliminated from further
the future where the use of these non-inferior consideration. Those that remain can again be
solution generation techniques alone will con- screened if the minimal acceptable values of one
tinue to be of value. However, in many other or more objectives are increased. When used in
planning situations, they alone will not be suf- an iterative fashion, the number of non-inferior
cient. Often, the number of feasible non-inferior alternatives can be reduced down to a single best
alternatives is simply too large. Participants in the compromise or a set of plans which the partici-
planning and management process will not have pants in the planning and management process
the time or patience to examine, evaluate and are essentially indifferent. This process is illus-
compare each alternative plan. Planners or man- trated in Fig. 9.15.
agers may also need help in identifying which Of course, sometimes the participants in the
alternatives they prefer. If they are willing to planning process will be unwilling or unable to
work with analysts, these analysts can help them sufciently narrow down the set of available
identify what alternatives they prefer without non-inferior plans with the iterative satisfying
generating and comparing all the other plans. method. Then it may be necessary to examine in
There are a number of methods available for more detail the possible tradeoffs among the
assisting in selecting the most desirable non- competing alternatives.
dominated plan. Some of the more common and
simpler ones are described next.
9.5.5 Lexicography

9.5.4 Satisficing Another simple approach is called lexicography.


To use this approach, the participants in the
One method of further reducing the number of planning process must rank the objectives in
alternatives is called satiscing. It requires that order of priority. This ranking process takes
the participants in the planning and management place without considering the particular values of
process specify a minimum acceptable value for these multiple objectives. Then, from among the
9.5 Multicriteria Analyses 399

Fig. 9.15 Two successive


iterations of the satiscing
method in which minimum
levels of each objective are
set thereby eliminating
those alternatives that do
not meet these minimum
levels

non-inferior plans that satisfy minimum levels of 9.5.6 Indifference Analysis


each objective, the plan that is the best with
respect to the highest priority objective will be Another method of selecting the best plan is
the one selected as superior. called indifference analysis. To illustrate the
If there is more than one plan that has the possible application of indifference analysis to
same value of the highest priority objective, then plan selection, consider a simple situation in
among this set of preferred plans the one that which there are only two alternative plans (A and
achieves the highest value of the second priority B) and two planning objectives (1 and 2) being
objective is selected. If here too there are multi- considered. Let ZA1 and ZA2 be the values of the
ple such plans, the process can continue until two respective objectives for plan A and let ZB1
there is a unique plan selected. and ZB2 be the values of the two respective
This method assumes such a ranking of the objectives for plan B. Comparing both plans
objectives is possible. Often the relative values when a different objective is better for each plan
of the objectives of each alternative plan are of can be difcult. Indifference analysis can reduce
more importance to those involved in the the problem to one of comparing the values of
decision-making process. Consider, for exam- only one objective.
ple, the problem of purchasing apples and Indifference analysis rst requires the selec-
oranges. Assuming you like both types of fruit, tion of an arbitrary value for one of the objec-
which type of fruit should you buy if you have tives, say Z*2 for objective 2 in this two-objective
only enough money to buy one type? If you example. It is usually a value within the range of
know you already have lots of apples, but no the values ZA2 and ZB2 , or in a more general case
oranges, perhaps you would buy oranges, and between the maximum and minimum of all
vice versa. Hence the ranking of objectives can objective 2 values.
depend on the current state and needs of those Next, a value of objective 1, say Z1 must be
who will be impacted by the plan. selected such that the participants involved are
400 9 Performance Criteria

indifferent (equally happy or satised) between focus now is on the tradeoff between the values of
the hypothetical plan that would have as its ob- objectives 1 and 2 given the same Z*3. A value zzi1
jective values (Z1, Z*2) and plan A that has as its must be selected such that the participants are
objective values (ZA1 , ZA2 ). In other words, Z1 must indifferent between (zi1, Zi2, Z*3) and (zzil, Z*2, Z*3).
be determined such that (Z1, Z*2) is as desirable as Hence for all plans i, the participants are indif-
or equivalent to (ZA1 , ZA2 ). ferent between two hypothetical plans and the
    actual one. The last hypothetical plans differ only
Z1 ; Z2  Z1A ; Z2A : 9:16 by the value of the rst objective. The plan that
has the largest value for objective 1 will be the
Next another value of the rst objective, say Z1, best plan. This was achieved by pair-wise com-
must be selected such that the participants are parisons only.
indifferent between a hypothetical plan (Z1, Z*2) In the rst step objective 2 remained constant
and the objective values (ZB1 , ZB2 ) of plan B. and only objectives 1 and 3 were compared to get
     i i i
Z10 ; Z2  Z1B ; Z2B 9:17 Zl ; Z2 ; Z3 :  zil ; Z2i ; Z3 9:18

These comparisons yield hypothetical but In the next step involving the hypothetical
equally desirable plans for each actual plan. plans just dened objective 3 remained constant
These hypothetical plans differ only in the value and only objectives 1 and 2 were compared to get
of objective 1 and hence they are easily com-  
zi1 ; Z2i ; Z3  zzi1 ; Z2 ; Z3 9:19
pared. If both objectives are to be maximized and
Z1 is larger than Z1, then the rst hypothetical
Hence
plan yielding Z1 is preferred to the second
 i i i  
hypothetical plan yielding Z1. Since the two Z1 ; Z2 ; Z3  zi1 ; Z2i ; Z3  zzi1 ; Z2 ; Z3
hypothetical plans are equivalent to plans A and
9:20
B, respectively, plan A must be preferred to plan
B. Conversely, if Z1 is larger than Z1 then plan Having done this for all n plans, there are now
B is preferred to plan A. n hypothetical plans (zzil, Z*2, Z*3) that differ only
This process can be extended to a larger in the value of zzil. All n plans can be ranked just
number of objectives and plans, all of which may based on the value of this single objective.
be ranked by a common objective. For example, Each of these plan selection techniques
assume that there are three objectives Zi1, Zi2, Zi3, requires the prior identication of discrete alter-
and n alternative plans i. A reference value Z*3 for native plans.
objective 3 can be chosen and a value zi1 esti-
mated for each alternative plan i such that one is
indifferent between (Zil, Zi2, Z*3) and (Zil, Zi2, Zi3). 9.5.7 Goal Attainment
The second objective value remains the same as
in the actual alternative in each of the hypothet- The goal attainment method combines some of
ical alternatives. Thus the focus is on the tradeoff the advantages of both the weighting and con-
between the values of objectives 1 and 3. straint plan generation methods already dis-
Assuming that each objective is to be maximized, cussed. If the participants are unable to specify
if Z*3 is selected so that Z*3 < Zi3, then zil will no these weights, the analyst must select them and
doubt be greater than Zi3. Conversely, if Z*3 > Zi3, then later change them on the basis of their
then zil will be less than Zi3. reactions to the generated plans.
Next, a new hypothetical plan containing a The goal attainment method identies the
reference value Z*2 and Z*3 can be created. The plans that minimize the maximum weighted
9.5 Multicriteria Analyses 401

deviation of any objective value, Zj(X), from its 9.5.8 Goal Programming
specied target, Tj. The problem is to
Goal programming methods also require speci-
minimize D 9:21 ed target values along with relative losses or
penalties associated with deviations from these
subject to target values. The objective is to nd the plan
that minimizes the sum of all such losses or
gi X bi i 1; 2; . . .; m 9:22
penalties. Assuming for this illustration that all
such losses can be expressed as functions of
  deviations from target values, and again assum-
wj Tj Zj X  D j 1; 2; . . .; J 9:23
ing each objective is to be maximized, the gen-
Constraints 9.22 contain the relationships among eral goal programming problem is to
the decision variables in the vector X. They X  
dene the feasible region of decision variable minimize j
Lj Dj 9:24
values.
This method of multicriteria analysis can subject to:
generate efcient or non-inferior plans by
adjusting the weights and targets. It is illustrated gi X bi i 1; 2; . . .; m 9:25
for a two-objective problem in Fig. 9.16.
If the weights are equal, then the deviations
Tj Zj X  Dj j 1; 2; . . .; J 9:26
will be equal and the resulting feasible solution
will be the closest to the ideal but infeasible one. If the loss functions are linear or piecewise linear
Unless Tj Zj(X) some plans generated from a the model can be solved using linear program-
goal attainment method may be inferior with ming methods. Again, the target and loss values
respect to the objectives being considered. can be changed to generate alternative plans X.

Fig. 9.16 The goal


attainment method of
generating points on the
efciency frontier using
different values of the
weights w1 and w2 for xed
objective target values T1
and T2
402 9 Performance Criteria

9.5.9 Interactive Methods concerning how much more important it is to


obtain various improvements of each objective,
Interactive methods allow participants in the the methods proceed from that inferior solution
planning process to explore the range of possible to more improved solutions. The end result is
decisions without having to generate all of them, either a solution everyone agrees is best, or an
especially those of little interest to the efcient one where no more improvements can
participants. be made in one objective without decreasing the
One such iterative approach, called the step value of another.
method, requires, at each iteration preference, These iterative interactive approaches are
information from the participants in the process. illustrated in Fig. 9.17. To work, they require the
This information identies constraints on various participation of the participants in the planning
objective values. The weighting method is used and management process.
to get an initial solution on the efciency frontier.
The weights, wj, are calculated based on the
relative range of values each objective j can 9.5.10 Plan Simulation
assume, and on whether or not the participants and Evaluation
have indicated satisfaction regarding a particular
objective value obtained from a previous solu- The methods outlined above provide a brief
tion. If they are satised with the value of, say, introduction to some of the simpler approaches
an objective Zj(X), they must indicate how much available for plan identication and selection.
of that value they would be willing to give up to Details on these and other potentially useful
obtain unspecied improvements in objectives techniques can be found in many books, some of
whose values they consider unsatisfactory. This which are devoted solely to this subject of mul-
denes a lower bound on Zj(X). Then the weight tiobjective planning (Cohon 1978; Steuer 1986).
wj for that objective is set to 0, and the weights of Most have been formulated in an optimization
all remaining objectives are recalculated. The framework. This section describes ways of
problem is again solved. The process is repeated evaluating alternative water management plans
until some best compromise plan is identied. or policies based on the time series of perfor-
This step method guides the participants in the mance criteria values derived from simulation
planning and management process among models.
non-inferior alternatives toward the plan or Simulation models of water resource systems
solution the participants consider best without yield time series of output variable values. These
requiring an exhaustive generation of all values in turn impact multiple system perfor-
non-inferior alternatives. Even if the best com- mance criteria, each pertaining to a specic
promise solution is not identied or agreed upon, interest and measured in its appropriate units.
the method provides a way for participants to A process for evaluating alternative water
learn what the tradeoffs are in the region of resource management plans or policies based on
solutions of interest to them. However, the par- these simulation model results includes the fol-
ticipants must be willing to indicate how much of lowing steps:
some objective value can be reduced to obtain
some unknown improvement of other objective 1. Identify system performance indicators that
values. This is not as easy as indicating how are impacted by one or more hydrologic
much more is desired of any or all objectives attributes whose values will vary depending
whose values are unsatisfactory. on the management policy or plan being
To overcome this objection to the step simulated. For example, navigation benets,
method, other interactive methods have been measured in monetary units, might depend on
developed. These begin with an obviously infe- water depths and velocities. Hydropower
rior solution. Based on a series of questions production is affected by water heads and
9.5 Multicriteria Analyses 403

Fig. 9.17 Two interactive


iterative multiple criteria
approaches for identifying
the tradeoffs of interest and
possibly the best decision

Fig. 9.18 Performance


indicators expressed as
functions of simulated
hydrological attributes
404 9 Performance Criteria

Fig. 9.20 Combining multiple time series of values of a


specied performance indictor into a single time series of
values of that performance indicator

hydrologic attributes. Figure 9.18 illustrates


such functions. The units on each axis may
differ for each such function.
3. Simulate to obtain time-series of hydrologic
attribute values and map them into a time
Fig. 9.19 Mapping a time series of hydrological attri- series of performance indicator values using
bute values into a corresponding time series of perfor- the functional relationships dened in step 2.
mance indicator values
This step is illustrated in Fig. 9.19.
4. Combine multiple time series values for the
discharges through the power plant. Water same performance criterion, as applicable, as
quality might be expressed as the average or shown in Fig. 9.20. This can be done using
maximum concentration of various potential maximum or minimum values, or arithmetic
pollutants over a xed time period at certain or geometric means, as appropriate. For
locations, and will depend in part on the example, flow velocities, depths, and algal
flows. Ecological habitats may be impacted biomass concentrations may impact recre-
by flows, water depths, water quality, flood- ational boating. The three sets of time series
ing frequency or duration, and/or rates of of recreational boating benets or suitability
changes in these attributes. can be combined into one time series, and
2. Dene the functional relationships between statistics of this overall time series can be
these performance indicators and the compared to similar statistics of other
9.5 Multicriteria Analyses 405

performance indicators. This step gives the wide and extremely flat river of grass flowing
modeler an opportunity to calibrate the generally south into, eventually, the Atlantic
resulting single system performance Ocean and Gulf of Mexico. This ecosystem
indicator. restoration project has involved numerous local,
5. Develop and compare system performance state and federal agencies. The project impacts a
exceedance distributions, or divide the range large population and agricultural industry that
of performance values into color-coded ran- want secure and reliable water supplies and flood
ges and display on maps or in scorecards, as protection. Its current estimated cost over some
illustrated in Fig. 9.21. three decades is about $8 billon. Hence it
involves politics. But its goal is primarily
The area under each exceedance curve is the focused on restoring a unique ecosystem that is
mean. Different exceedance functions will result increasingly degraded due to extensive alter-
from different water management policies, as ations in its hydrology over the past half-century.
illustrated in Fig. 9.22. The motto of the Everglades restoration pro-
One can establish thresholds to identify dis- ject in south Florida is to get the water right.
crete zones of performance indicator values and Those who manage the regions water are
assign a color to each zone. Measures of relia- attempting to restore the ecosystem by restoring
bility, resilience and vulnerability can then be the hydrologic regime, i.e., the flows, depths,
calculated and displayed as well. hydroperiods, and water qualities, throughout
Scorecards can show the mean values of each this region to what they think existed some
indicator for any set of sites. The best value for 60 years ago. The trick is to accomplish this and
each indicator can be colored green; the worst still meet water supply, flood protection, and land
value for each indicator can be colored red. The development needs of those who live in the
water management alternative having the most region. Clearly achieving a hydrologic condition
number of green boxes will stand out and will that existed before people began populating that
probably be considered more seriously than the region in signicant numbers will not be possi-
alternative having the most number of red (worst ble. Hence the question: what if water managers
value) boxes. are not able to get the water right? What if they
This ve-step process has been used in a study can only get the water right on 90 % of the area,
of improved ways of managing lake levels and or what if they can only get 90 % of the water
flows in Lake Ontario and its discharges into the right on all the area? In either case what will be
St. Lawrence River in North America. Perfor- its likely impact on the ecosystem? Are there
mance criteria were dened for domestic and opportunities for changing hydrology to improve
industrial water supplies, navigation depths, ecology? Where?
shore bank erosion, recreational boating, hydro- To address questions such as these in the
power production, flooding, water quality, eco- Everglades, at least in a preliminary way prior to
logical habitats. The performance measures for when more detailed ecological models will
each of these interests were identied and become available, this ve-step approach out-
expressed as functions of one or more hydrologic lined above is being applied. It is being used to
variable values related to flow and lake level extend their simulated hydrological predictions
management. Models designed to simulate to produce relative values of ecological habitat
alternative lake level and flow management suitability indicators for selected indicator spe-
policies were used to generate sets of time series cies, as illustrated in Fig. 9.8, and topographic
for each system performance criterion. These in characteristics.
turn were combined, summarized and compared. This ve-step procedure does not nd an
The same ve-step process has been imple- optimal water management policy. It can how-
mented in the Everglades restoration project in ever contribute useful information to the political
southern Florida. The Everglades is a long very debate that must take place in the search of that
406 9 Performance Criteria

Fig. 9.21 Ways of summarizing and displaying time showing changes over time. Green and red colored
series performance indicator data involving exceedance scorecard entries indicate best and worst plan or strategy,
distributions, and color-coded maps and scorecards. respectively, for associated performance indicator
Color-coded map displays on computers can be dynamic,
9.5 Multicriteria Analyses 407

Fig. 9.22 Two


exceedance functions
showing decrease in mean
performance value if policy
2 is followed compared to
Policy 1

optimum. Each step of the approach can and Another way to summarize and compare time
should include and involve the various stake- series data is to calculate and compare the vari-
holders and publics in the basin. These individ- ance of the data.
uals are sources of important inputs in this Consider a time series of T values Xt whose
evaluation process. Stakeholders who will be mean is X. For example, suppose the time series
influencing or making water management deci- consisted of 8, 5, 4, 9, 2, 1, 1, 3, 6, and 7. The
sions need to understand just how this multiob- mean of these 10 values is 4.6. The variance is
jective evaluation process works if they are to XT
accept and benet from its results. Stakeholder t
Xt X2 =T
involvement in this process can help lead to a h i
84:62 54:62 . . . 74:62 =10
common understanding (or shared vision) of
how their system works and the tradeoffs that 7:44
exist among conflicting objectives. The extent to 9:27
which all stakeholders understand this evaluation
approach or procedure and how it is applied in A plot of these values and their mean is shown in
their basin will largely determine their ability to Fig. 9.23.The mean and variance for the time
participate effectively in the political process of series shown in Fig. 9.23 however are the same
selecting the best water management policy or for its upside down image, as shown in Fig. 9.24.
practice. They do not even depend on the order of the time
series data.
Consider these two sets of time series shown
9.6 Statistical Summaries again in Fig. 9.25, each having the same mean
of Performance Criteria and variance. Assume that any value equal or
less than the dashed line (just above 2) is con-
There are numerous ways of summarizing time sidered unsatisfactory. This value is called a
series data in addition to the methods just men- threshold value, dividing the time series data into
tioned above. Weighted arithmetic mean values satisfactory and unsatisfactory values.
or geometric mean values are two ways of sum- It is clear from Fig. 9.25 that the impact of
marizing multiple time series data. The overall these two time series could differ. The original
mean itself generally provides too little informa- time series shown in a red line remained in an
tion about a dynamic process. Multiple time ser- unsatisfactory condition for a longer time than
ies plots themselves are often hard to compare. did the time series shown in blue. However, the
408 9 Performance Criteria

Fig. 9.23 Plot of time


series data having a mean
value of 4.6 and a variance
of 7.44

Fig. 9.24 A plot of two


different time series having
the same mean and
variance

Fig. 9.25 Threshold value


distinguishing values con-
sidered satisfactory, and
those considered
unsatisfactory
9.6 Statistical Summaries of Performance Criteria 409

maximum extent of failure when it, the red series, Resilience[X number of times a satisfactory
failed was less than the blue time series. These
value follows an unsatisfactory value=number
characteristics can be captured by the measures
of reliability, resilience and vulnerability of times an unsatisfactory value occurred
(Hashimoto et al. 1982). 9:29

Resilience is not dened if no unsatisfactory


9.6.1 Reliability values occur in the time series. For the time
series shown in red, the resilience is 1/3, again
The reliability of any time series can be dened assuming the value of 2 or less is considered a
as the number of data in a satisfactory state failure. For the time series shown in blue the
divided by the total number of data in the time resilience is 2/2 = 1. We cannot judge the resi-
series. Assuming satisfactory values in the time lience of the blue time series based on the last
series Xt containing n values are those equal to or failure in period 10 because we do not have an
greater than some threshold XT, then observation in period 11.

Reliabilty[X number of time periods t


9:28 9.6.3 Vulnerability
such that Xt  X T =n

The reliability of the red time series is 0.7. It Vulnerability is a measure of the extent of the
failed three times in 10. The reliability of the blue differences between the threshold value and
time series is also 0.7, failing three times in 10. the unsatisfactory time series values. Clearly this is
Is a more reliable system better than a less a probabilistic measure. Some use expected values,
reliable system? Not necessarily. Reliability some use maximum observed values, and others
measures tell one nothing about how quickly a may assign a probability of exceedance to their
system recovers and returns to a satisfactory vulnerability measures. Assuming an expected
value, nor does it indicate how bad an unsatis- value measure of vulnerability is to be used
factory value might be should one occur. It may   
VulnerabilityX sum of positive values of X T  Xt
well be that a system that fails relatively often,
=number of times an unsatisfactory value occurred]
but by insignicant amounts and for short dura-
tions will be preferred to one whose reliability is 9:30
much higher, but when a failure does occur, it is
likely to be much more severe. Resilience and The expected vulnerability of the original red
vulnerability measures can provide measures of time series is [(2 2) + (2 1) + (2 1)]/
these system characteristics. 3 = 0.67. The expected vulnerability of the time
series shown by the blue line in Fig. 9.25 is
[(2 1.2) + (2 0.2)]/2 = 1.3.
9.6.2 Resilience So, while in this example the reliability of red
time series equals that of the blue time series, the
Resilience can be expressed as the probability resilience of the blue time series is better than
that if in an unsatisfactory state, the next state that of the red time series. Yet the expected
will be satisfactory. It is the probability of having vulnerability of the red time series is less than
a satisfactory value in time period t + 1 given an that of the rotated blue time series. This shows
unsatisfactory value in any time period t. It can the typical tradeoffs one can observe using these
be calculated as three measures of system performance.
410 9 Performance Criteria

9.7 Conclusions too explicit in quantifying political values. They


might prefer that the analyst make these trade-
Many theoretical and practical approaches have offs and just not discuss them. (We writers have
been proposed in the literature for identifying participated in such situations.) Planners, engi-
and quantifying objectives and for considering neers, or analysts are often very willing to make
multiple criteria or objectives in water resources these tradeoffs because they pertain to subject
planning. The discussion and techniques pre- areas in which they often consider themselves
sented in this chapter serve merely as an intro- expert. However when political tradeoffs are at
duction to this subject. These tools, including issue, no one is an expert. No one has the optimal
their modications and extensions, are designed answer, but professionals should be engaged in
to provide information that can be of value to the and informing and facilitating the process of
planning and decision-making process. coming to an acceptable, and often compromise,
Water resource systems planners and man- decision.
agers and the numerous other participants typi- Through further development and use of
cally involved in decision-making face a practical analytical multiobjective planning
challenge when they are required to select one of techniques, analysts can begin to interact with all
many alternatives, each characterized by different participants in the planning and management
values among multiple performance criteria. It process and can enlighten any who would argue
requires a balancing of the goals and values of that water resources policy evaluation and anal-
the various individuals and groups concerned yses should not be political. Analysts, managers
with the project. There is virtually no way in and planners have to work in a political envi-
which the plan selection step can be a normative ronment. They need to understand the process of
process or procedure; there can be no standard decision-making, what information is most use-
set of criteria or methods which will identify the ful to that process, and how it can best be pre-
preferred project. At best, an iterative procedure sented. Knowledge of these facts in a particular
in which those using tools similar to those planning situation might dictate substantially the
described in this chapter together with all the particular approach to objective identication
interested stakeholders may reach some shared and quantication and to plan selection that is
vision of what is best to do, at least until con- most appropriate.
ditions change or new knowledge or new goals The method deemed most appropriate for a
or new requirements emerge. This may be the particular situation will depend not only on the
only way to identify a plan that is politically as physical scale of the situation itself but also on the
well as technically, socially, nancially, and decision-makers, the decision-making process,
institutionally feasible. and the responsibilities accepted by the analysts,
To many participants in the planning process the participants, and the decision-makers.
some of these approaches for objective quanti- Finally, a reminder that the decisions being
cation and multiobjective planning may seem made at the current time are only those in a
theoretical or academic. Many may be reluctant to sequence of decisions that will continue to be
learn quantitative policy analysis techniques or to made on into the future. No one can predict with
spend time answering seemingly irrelevant ques- certainty what future generations will consider as
tions that might lead eventually to a compromise being important or what they will want to do, but
plan. Reluctance to engage in quantication of spending some time trying to guess is not an idle
tradeoffs among particular objectives of alterna- exercise. It pays to plan ahead, as best one can,
tive plans, and by implication tradeoffs among the and ask ourselves if the decisions being consid-
interests of multiple stakeholder groups, may stem ered today will be those we think our descen-
from the support decision-makers desire from all dants would have wanted us to make. This kind
of these conflicting interest groups. In such situ- of thinking gets us into issues of adaptive man-
ations it is obviously to their advantage not to be agement and sustainability (ASCE 1999).
References 411

References distribution systems using a structure messy genetic


algorithm approach. Journal of Water Resources
Planning and Management ASCE, 123(3), 137146.
American Society of Civil Engineers (ASCE). (1999). Hashimoto, T., Stedinger, J. R., & Loucks, D. P. (1982a).
Sustainability criteria for water resource systems, Reliability resiliency and vulnerability criteria for
ASCE Press, Reston, Va. (also in D. P. Loucks & water resource system performance evaluation. Water
J. S. Gladwell (Eds.), 2000. Cambridge, UK: Cam- Resources Research, 18(1), 1420.
bridge University Press. Hashimoto, T., Loucks, D. P., & Stedinger, J. R. (1982b).
Cohon, J. L. (1978). Multiobjective programming and Robustness of water resource systems. Water
planning. New York: Academic Press. Resources Research, 18(1), 2126.
Gregory, R. S., & Keeney, R. L. (1994). Creating policy Keeney, R. L., & Raiffa, H. (1976). Decisions with
alternatives using stakeholder values. Management multiple objectives: Preferences and value tradeoffs.
Science, 40, 10351048. New York: Wiley.
Hammond, J. S., Keeney, R. L., & Raiffa, H. (1999). Loucks, D. P., Stedinger, J. R., & Haith, D. A. (1981).
Smart choices: A practical guide to making better Water resource systems planning and analysis. Engle-
decisions. Boston, Mass: Harvard Business School wood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Press. Maas, A., et al. (1962). Design of water resource systems.
Hipel, K. W., Fang, L., Cullman, J., & Bristow, M. (Eds.). Cambridge: Harvard University Press.
(2015). Conflict resolution in water resources and Reed, P. M., Minsker, B. S., & Goldberg, D. E. (2001).
environmental management, conflict resolution in A multiobjective approach to cost effective long-term
water resources and environmental management. groundwater monitoring using an elitist nondominated
Heidelberg, New York, Dordrecht, London: Springer sorted genetic algorithm with historical data. Journal
Cham. of Hydroinformatics, 3(2), 7189. April.
Madani, K. (2010). Game theory and water resources. Ritzel, B. J., Eheart, J. W., & Ranjithan, S. (1994). Using
Journal of Hydrology, 381(3), 225238. genetic algorithms to solve a multiple objective
Madani, K., & Hipel, K. W. (2011). Non-cooperative groundwater pollution containment problem. Water
stability denitions for strategic analysis of generic Resources Research, 30(5), 15891603. May.
water resources conflicts. Water Resources Manage- Sawaragi, Y., Nakayama, H., & Tanino, T. (1985).
ment, 25(8), 19491977. Theory of multiobjective optimization. Orlando, Flor-
Steuer, R. E. (1986). Multiple criteria optimization: Theory, ida: Academic Press Inc.
computation, and application. New York: Wiley. Statnikov, R. B., & Matusov, J. B. (1995). Multicriteria
optimization and engineering. New York: Chapman
and Hall.
Yeh, C.-H., & Labadie, J. W. (1997). Multiobjective
watershed-level planning of storm-water detention
systems. Journal of Water Resources Planning and
Additional References Management, 123(6), 336343. November/December.
(Further Reading) Zeleny, M. (1982). Multiple criteria decision making.
New York: McGraw-Hill.
Chen, H. W., & Chang, N.-B. (1998). Water pollution
control in the river basin by fuzzy genetic
algorithm-based multiobjective programming model-
ing. Water Science and Technology, 37(8), 5563. Exercises
Cieniawski, S. E., Eheart, J. W., & Ranjithan, S. (1995).
Using genetic algorithms to solve a multiobjective
groundwater monitoring problem. Water Resources 9:1 Distinguish between multiple purposes and
Research, 31(2), 399409. multiple objectives and give some examples
Eschenauer, H., Koski, J., & Osyczka, A. (1990). of complementary and conflicting purposes
Multicriteria design optimization. Berlin:
and objectives of water resources projects.
Springer-Verlag.
Gupta, H. V., Sorroshian, S., & Yapo, P. O. (1998). 9:2 Assume that farmers demand for water q is
Towards improved calibration of hydrologic models: a linear function a b(p) of the price p,
Multiple and non-commensurable measures of infor- where a, b > 0. Calculate the farmers
mation. Water Resources Research, 34(4), 751763.
willingness to pay for a quantity of water
Haimes, Y. Y., Hall, W. A., & Freedman, H. T. (1975).
Multiobjective optimization in water resources sys- q. If the cost of delivering a quantity of
tems. Amsterdam: Elsevier Scientic. water q is cq, c > 0, how much water
Halhal, D., Walters, G. A., Ouazar, D., & Savic, D. A. should a public agency supply to maximize
(1997). Multi-objective improvement of water
willingness to pay minus total cost? If the
412 9 Performance Criteria

local water district is owned and operated year. The maximum irrigation demand
by a private rm whose objective is to (capacity) is 4 106 m3. Let X1 be the
maximize prot, how much water would allocation of water to irrigation and X2 the
they supply and how much would they allocation for downstream flow augmenta-
earn? The farmers consumer surplus is tion. Assume that there are two objectives,
their willingness to pay minus what they expressed as
must pay for the resource. Compare the
farmers consumer surplus in two cases. Do Z1 4X1 X2
the farmers loose more than the private rm Z2 2X1 6X2
gains by moving from the social optimum
to the point that maximizes the rms
prot? Illustrate these relationships with a
graph showing the demand curve and the (a) Write the multiobjective planning
unit cost c of water. Which areas on the model using a weighing approach and a
graph represent the rms prots and the constraint approach.
farmers consumer surplus? (b) Dene the efcient frontier. This
9:3 Consider the water allocation problem used requires a plot of the feasible combi-
in the earlier chapters of this book. The nations of X1 and X2.
returns, Bi(Xi) from allocating Xi amount of (c) Assume that various values are
water to each of three uses i are as follows, assigned to a weight W1 for Z1 whereas
along with the optimal allocations from the weight W2 for Z2 is constant and equal
point of view of each use. to 1, verify the following solutions to
the weighing model.
B1 X1 6X1  X12 ! X1opt 3
 
and Bmax
1 B1 X1opt 9
W1 X1 X2 Z1 Z2
B2 X2 7X2  1:5X22 ! X2opt 7=3
 
and Bmax
2 B2 X2opt 147=18 >6 4 0 16 8
B3 X3 8X3  0:5X32 ! X3opt 8 6 4 0 to 12 16 to 14 8 to 4
 
and Bmax
3 B3 X3opt 32 <6 4 2 14 4
to >1.6
1.6 4 to 2 to 6 14 to 6 4 to 36
Consider this a multiobjective problem. 0
Instead of nding the best overall allocation that <1.6 0 6 6 36
maximizes the total return assume the objectives
are to maximize the returns from each user.
Show how the weighting, constraint, goal 9:6 Show that the following benet, loss, and
attainment, and goal programming methods can cost functions can be included in a linear
be used to identify the tradeoffs among each of optimization problem for nding the active
the three objectives for any limiting total amount storage volume target Ts, annual release
of water, for example, 6. target TR and the actual storage releases Rt
in each within-year period t, and the reser-
9:4 Under what circumstances will the weight- voir capacity K. The objective is to maxi-
ing and constraint methods fail to identify mize annual net benets from the
efcient solutions? construction and operation of the reservoir.
9:5 A reservoir is planned for irrigation and low Assume that the inflows are known in each
flow augmentation for water quality control. of 12 within-year periods t. Note that the
A storage volume of 6 106 m3 will be loss function associated with reservoir
available for those two conflicting uses each recreation is independent of the value of Ts,
Exercises 413

unlike the loss function associated with variables used that are not dened below.
reservoir releases. Structure the complete Let tTR be the known release target in
linear programming model. Dene all period t.

St = initial storage
volume
K = reservoir

Recreation
Annual 1 Loss in 8
recreation periods t= -10
benefits 3 6 through 9
(0 otherwise)
20 5
-6 TS 2

3 10
Storage target T S 5 7
Storage Volume St

LRBF
6
SRBF
3

Release 10
benefit
in period t
8

0
15 10 tT R
-20
Reservoir
release Rt

Annual 8
Cost of
reservoir 3

5
(if K > 0) 20

(if K = 0) 0
20 30
Reservoir capacity K
414 9 Performance Criteria

9:7 For the river basin shown, potential reser- weighting and constraint (or target)
voirs exist at sites i = 1, 2, and 4 and a approaches.
diversion can be constructed between sites 1 (b) Discuss how you would use the model
and 2. The cost Ci(Ki) of each reservoir i is to identify efcient, non-inferior
a function of its active storage capacity Ki. (Pareto-optimal) solutions.
The cost of the diversion canal is Ci(Qi) (c) Effluent standards at sites A and B and
where Q is the flow capacity of the canal. ambient stream standards at sites j could
The cost of diverting a flow Qijt from site be replaced by other planning objectives
i to site j is Cij(Qijt). The two users at sites 3 (e.g., the minimization of waste dis-
and 5 have known target allocations (de- charged into the stream). What would
mands) Tit in each period t. The return flow these objectives be, and how could they
from use 3 is 40 % of that allocated to use be included in the multiobjective model?
3. Construct a model for nding the least
cost of meeting various percentages of the 9:9 (a) What conditions must apply if the goal
target demands. Assume that the natural attainment method is to produce only
streamflows Qit at each site i in each period non-inferior alternatives for each
t, are known. assumed target Tk and weight wk?
(b) Convert the goal programming objective
3 T3t deviation components wi (zi  zi x) to
1 a form suitable for solution by linear
programming.
4 9:10 Water quality objectives are sometimes
difcult to quantify. Various attempts
5 T5t have been made to include the many
2
aspects of water quality in single water
quality indices. One such index was
9:8 Suppose that there exist two polluters, A proposed by Dinius (Social Accounting
and B, who can provide additional treat- Systems for Evaluating Water Resour-
ment, XA and XB, at a cost of CA(XA) and ces, Water Resources Research, Vol. 8,
CB(XB), respectively. Let WA and WB be the 1972. pp. 11591177). Water quality, Q,
waste produced at sites A and B, and measured in percent is given by
WA(1 XA) and WB(1 XB) be the result-
ing waste discharges at site A and B. These w1 Q1 w2 Q2 . . . wn Qn
Q
discharges must be no greater than the w1 w2 . . . wn
effluent standards EmaxA and Emax
B . The
resulting pollution concentration where Qi is the ith quality constituent
aAj(WA(1 XA)) + aBj(WB(1 XB)) + qj at (dissolved oxygen, chlorides, etc.) and
various sites j must not exceed the stream wi is the weight or relative importance of
standards Smax
j . Assume that total cost and the ith quality constituent. Write a
cost inequity [i.e., CA(XA) + CB(XB) and| critique on the use of such an index in
CA(XA) CB(XB)] are management objec- multiobjective water resources planning.
tives to be determined 9:11 Let objective Z1(X) = 5X12X2 and
objective Z2(X) = X1 + 4 X2. Both are
(a) Discuss how you would model this to be maximized. Assume that the con-
multiobjective problem using the straints on variables X1 and X2 are:
Exercises 415

1. X1 + X2 3 where Zi* represents the best value of objective


2. X1 6 i with all weights w equal to 1 and equal to 1, 2,
3. X1 + X2 8 and .
4. X2 4
5. X1, X2 0 9:12 Illustrate the procedure for selecting
among three plans, each having three
objectives, using indifference analysis. Let
(a) Graph the Pareto-optimal or non-inferior
Zji represent the value of objective i for
solutions in decision space.
plan j. The values of each objective for
(b) Graph the efcient combination of Z1 and Z2
each plan are given below. Assume that
in objective space.
each objective is to be maximized. Assume
(c) Reformulate the problem to illustrate the
that an identical indifference function for
weighting method for dening all efcient
all trade-offs between pairs of objectives,
solutions of part (a) and illustrate this method
namely one that implies you are willing to
in decision and objective space.
give up twice as many units of your higher
(d) Reformulate the problem to illustrate the
(larger) objective value to gain one unit of
constraint method of dening all efcient
your lower (smaller) objective value. [For
solutions of part (a) and illustrate this method
example, you would be indifferent to two
in decision and objective space.
plans having as their three objective values
(e) Solve for the compromise set of solu-
(30, 5, 10) and (20, 5, 15).] Rank these
tions using compromise programming as
three plans in order of preference.
dened by
Plan 1 : 5; 25; 15;
  a  a 1=a Plan 2 : 10; 20; 10;
Minimize w1 Z1  Z1 w2 Z2  Z2
Plan 3 : 15; 10; 15

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
Water Quality Modeling
and Prediction 10

The most fundamental human needs for water are of using lower quality water. As populations and
for drinking, cooking, and personal hygiene. The economies grow, more wastewater pollutants are
quality of the water used to meet these needs generated. Many of these are discharged into
must pose no risk to human health. The quality of surface and ground water bodies. Increasingly
the water in nature also impacts the condition of the major efforts and costs involved in water
all living organisms found in aquatic ecosystems management are aimed at water quality protec-
that we depend upon for our own wellbeing. At tion and management. Conflicts among various
the same time watersheds and their water bodies users of water are increasingly over issues
serve as convenient sinks for domestic, indus- involving water quality.
trial, and agricultural wastes. Runoff from agri- Natural water bodies are able to serve many
cultural and urban lands containing excess uses. One of them is the transport and assimila-
nutrients, oils, and solid wastes together with tion of many waterborne wastes. As natural water
direct point source discharges of wastewaters bodies transport and assimilate wastes, their
into water bodies degrades the quality of those quality changes. If the quality of water drops to
water bodies. Water resources management the extent that other uses are adversely impacted,
involves the monitoring and management of the assimilative capacities of those water bodies
water quality as much as the monitoring and have been exceeded with respect to those
management of water quantity. Various models impacted uses. Water management measures are
can assist in predicting the water quality impacts actions taken to ensure that the total pollutant
of alternative land and water management poli- loads discharged into receiving water bodies do
cies and practices. This chapter introduces some not exceed the waste assimilative capacity of
approaches to water quality modeling, leaving those water bodies and that the quality meets the
descriptions of more advanced methods to text- quality standards set for those waters.
books devoted solely to this subject. What uses depend on water quality? Almost
all one can identify. As everyone knows, all liv-
ing organisms require water of sufcient quantity
10.1 Introduction and quality to survive. Different aquatic species
can tolerate different levels of pollutant concen-
Water quality management is a critical compo- trations that impact water quality. In much of the
nent of overall integrated water resources man- developed world it is no longer safe to drink
agement. Most users of water depend on natural surface or ground waters. Treatment is
adequate levels of water quality. When these usually required before these waters are safe for
levels are not met, water users must then either humans to drink. Treatment is not a practical
pay for water treatment or incur increased risks option for improving the quality of water found in

The Author(s) 2017 417


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_10
418 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

nature yet this is the water that impacts the health standards to non-point source pollutants. Pollu-
of sh and shellsh and other organisms in natural tant loadings from non-point sources can be
aquatic ecosystems. Hence the focus in practice is much higher than point source loadings. Man-
on the use of wastewater treatment facilities to agement of non-point water quality impacts
improve the quality of effluents being discharged requires a more ambient-focused water quality
into natural water bodies. management program.
Standards specifying minimum acceptable The goal of an ambient water quality man-
levels of quality are commonly set for most agement program is to establish appropriate
ambient waters. Various uses may have their own standards for water quality in water bodies
quality requirements as well. Irrigation water receiving pollutant loads and then to ensure that
must not be too saline nor contain toxic sub- these standards are met. Realistic standard setting
stances that can be absorbed by the plants or takes into account the basins hydrologic, eco-
destroy the microorganisms in the soil. Water logical, and land use conditions, the potential
quality standards for industry can be very uses of the receiving water bodies, and the
demanding, depending on course of the require- institutional capacity to set and enforce water
ments of particular industrial processes. quality standards.
Domestic wasteloads can contain high con- Ambient-based water quality prediction and
centrations of bacteria, viruses, and other management involves considerable uncertainty.
organisms that impact human health. High No one can predict what pollutant loadings will
organic loadings can reduce dissolved oxygen be in the future, especially from area-wide
(DO) to levels that can kill parts of the aquatic non-point sources. In addition to uncertainties
ecosystem and cause obnoxious odors. Nutrient inherent in measuring water quality, there are
loadings from both urban and agricultural land uncertainties in models used to predict the
runoff can cause excessive algae growth that in effectiveness of actions taken to meet water
turn may degrade the water aesthetically, inhibit quality standards. The models available to help
boating and swimming, and upon death cause managers predict water quality impacts are rela-
low DO levels. Toxic heavy metals and other tively simple compared to the complexities of
micropollutants can accumulate in the bodies of actual water systems. If water quality models are
aquatic organisms, including sh, making them being used to inform those setting standards and
unt for human consumption even if they permissible waste loadings, these limitations and
themselves survive. uncertainties should be understood and
Pollutant discharges originate from point to addressed.
non-point sources. A common approach to con-
trolling point source discharges, such as from
stormwater outfalls, municipal wastewater treat- 10.2 Establishing Ambient Water
ment plants or industries, is to impose standards Quality Standards
specifying maximum allowable pollutant loads or
concentrations in their effluents. This is often A rst step in setting water quality standards for
done in ways that are not economically efcient a water body is to identify the intended uses of
or even environmentally effective. Effluent stan- that water body, whether a lake, a section of a
dards typically do not take into account the stream, or areas of an estuary. The most restric-
particular assimilative capacities of the receiving tive (in terms of water quality) of the specic
water body. Nevertheless they are relatively easy desired uses of a water body is termed a desig-
to monitor and control. nated use. Barriers to achieving the designated
Non-point sources such as agricultural runoff use are the presence of pollutants or hydrologic
or atmospheric deposition are not as easily con- and geomorphic changes that impact the quality
trolled and hence it is difcult to apply effluent of the water body.
10.2 Establishing Ambient Water Quality Standards 419

The designated use dictates the appropriate sewage treatment plant. Ambient water quality
type of water quality standard. For example, the standards must be realistic.
standards of a water body whose designated use Decisions regarding the appropriate use for
involves human contact recreation should protect water bodies can be informed by the use of water
humans from exposure to microbial pathogens quality prediction models. However, the nal
while swimming, wading, or boating. Other uses standard selection should reflect a social con-
might require standards to protect humans and sensus made in consideration of the current
aquatic life including sh, shellsh, and other condition of the watershed, its pre-disturbance
wildlife from consuming harmful substances. condition, the advantages derived from a certain
Standards set upstream may impact the uses of designated use, and the costs of achieving the
water downstream. For example, the water designated use.
quality of small headwater streams may affect the
ability of a downstream area to achieve a par-
ticular designated use such as being shable or 10.2.1 Water Use Criteria
swimmable. In this case, the designated use for
the smaller upstream water body may be dened The designated use is a qualitative description of
in terms of the achievement of the designated use a desired condition of a water body. A criterion is
of the larger downstream water body. a measurable indicator surrogate for use attain-
In many areas human activities have suf- ment. The criterion may be positioned at any
ciently altered the landscape and aquatic point in the causal chain of boxes shown in
ecosystems to the point where they cannot be Fig. 10.1.
restored to their pre-disturbance condition. For Box 1 of Fig. 10.1 contains information about
example, a reproducing trout shery in down- the pollutant discharges, e.g., from a treatment
town Paris, Philadelphia, Phnom Penh, or Prague plant or in runoff (e.g., biological oxygen
may be desired by some, but may not be attain- demand, ammonia (NH3), pathogens, and sus-
able because of the development history of the pended sediments). Effluent standards specifying
areas or the altered hydrologic regimes of the maximum permissible loadings may apply to
rivers flowing through them. Similarly, health these pollutant loadings. Criteria in Boxes 2 and
considerations would preclude designating an 3 are possible measures of ambient water quality
area for shellsh harvesting near the outfall of a conditions. Box 2 includes measures of a water

Fig. 10.1 Factors


considered when
determining designated use
and associated water
quality standards
420 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

quality parameter such as DO, pH, nitrogen 10.3 Water Quality Model Use
concentration, suspended sediment, or tempera-
ture. Criteria closer to the designated use (e.g., Monitoring data are the preferred form of infor-
Box 3) include more combined or comprehensive mation for identifying impaired waters. Model
measures of the biological community as a predictions might be used in addition to or
whole, such as the condition of the algal com- instead of monitoring data for several reasons
munity (chlorophyll a) or a measure of contam-
inant concentration in sh tissue. Box 4 1. Modeling could be feasible in some situations
represents criteria that are associated with sour- where monitoring is not.
ces of pollution other than pollutants. These 2. Integrated monitoring and modeling systems
criteria might include measures such as flow could provide better information than moni-
timing and pattern (a hydrologic criterion), toring or modeling alone for the same total
abundance of nonindigenous taxa, some quan- cost. For example, regression analyses that
tication of channel modication (e.g., decrease correlate pollutant concentration with some
in sinuosity), etc. (NRC 2001). more easily measurable factor (e.g., stream-
The more precise the statement of the desig- flow) could be used to extend monitoring data
nated use, the more accurate the criterion will be for preliminary planning purposes. Models
as an indicator of that use. For example, the can also be used to determine preliminary
criterion of fecal coliform count may be a suit- probability distributions of impairment that
able criterion for water contact recreation. The can help direct monitoring efforts and reduce
maximum allowable count itself may differ the quantity of monitoring data needed for
among water bodies that have water contact as making listing decisions at a given level of
their designated use, however. reliability (see Chaps. 7 and 9).
Surrogate indicators are often selected for use 3. Modeling can be used to assess (predict)
as criteria because they are easy to measure and future water quality situations resulting from
in some cases are politically appealing. Although different management strategies. For exam-
a surrogate indicator may have appealing attri- ple, assessing the improvement in water
butes, its usefulness can be limited unless it can quality after a new wastewater treatment plant
be logically related to a designated use. begins operating, or the effect of increased
As with setting designated uses, the connec- industrial growth and effluent discharges.
tions among water bodies and segments must be
considered when determining criteria. For A simple, but useful, modeling approach that
example, where a segment of a water body is may be used in the absence of monitoring data is
designated as a mixing zone for a pollutant dis- dilution calculations. In this approach the rate
charge, the criterion adopted should assure that of pollutant loading from point sources in a water
the mixing zone use will not adversely affect the body is divided by the stream flow to give a set
surrounding water body uses. Similarly, as pre- of estimated pollutant concentrations that may be
viously discussed, the desired condition of a compared to the standard. Simple dilution cal-
small headwater stream may need to be chosen as culations assume conservative movement of
it relates to other water bodies downstream. pollutants. Thus, the use of dilution calculations
Thus, an ambient nutrient criterion may be set in will tend to be conservative and lead to higher
a small headwater stream to ensure a designated than actual concentrations for decaying pollu-
use downstream, even if there are no local tants. Of course one could include a best estimate
adverse impacts resulting from the nutrients in of the effects of decay processes in the dilution
the small headwater stream. Conversely, a high model.
fecal coliform criterion may be permitted Combined runoff and water quality prediction
upstream of a recreational area if the fecal load models link stressors (sources of pollutants and
dissipates before the flow reaches that area. pollution) to responses. Stressors include human
10.3 Water Quality Model Use 421

activities likely to cause impairment, such as the build another one if an existing model will suf-
presence of impervious surfaces in a watershed, ce. This section discusses criteria that can be
cultivation of elds close to the stream, used to select a particular model.
over-irrigation of crops with resulting polluted Water quality predictive models can include
return flows, the discharge of domestic and both mathematical expressions and expert sci-
industrial effluents into water bodies, installing entic judgment. They may be process-based
dams and other channelization works, introduc- (mechanistic) models or data-based (statistical)
tion of nonindigenous taxa, and over-harvesting models. Quality models used for planning and
of shes. Indirect effects of humans include land management should link management options to
cover changes that alter the rates of delivery of meaningful response variables (e.g., pollutant
water, pollutants, and sediment to water bodies. sources and water quality standard parameters).
Direct and indirect environmental effects of They should incorporate the entire chain from
human activities can include stressors to responses. Process-based models
should be consistent with scientic theory.
alterations in physical habitat, Model prediction uncertainty should be reported.
modications in the seasonal flow of water, This provides decision-makers with estimates of
changes in the food base of the system, the risks of alternative options. To do this
changes in interactions within the stream requires prediction error estimates (Chap. 6).
biota, and Water quality management models should be
release of contaminants (conventional pollu- appropriate to the complexity of the situation and
tants) (Karr 1990; NRC 1992, 2001). to the available data. Simple water quality
problems can be addressed with simple models.
Ideally, models designed to manage water Complex water quality problems may or may not
quality should consider all ve types of alterna- require the use of more complex models. Models
tive management measures. The broad-based requiring large amounts of monitoring data
approach that considers these ve features pro- should not be used in situations where such data
vides a more integrative approach to reduce the are unavailable. Models should be flexible
cause or causes of degradation (NRC 1992). enough to allow updates and improvements as
Models that relate stressors to responses can appropriate based on new research and monitor-
be of varying levels of complexity. Sometimes, ing data.
models are simple qualitative conceptual repre- Stakeholders need to accept the models pro-
sentations of the relationships among important posed for use in any water quality management
variables and indicators of those variables. More study. Given the increasing role of stakeholders
quantitative models can be used to make pre- in water management decision processes, they
dictions about the assimilative capacity of a need to understand and accept the models being
water body, the movement of a pollutant from used, at least to the extent they wish to. Finally,
various point and non-point sources through a the cost of maintaining and updating the model
watershed, or the effectiveness of certain best during its use must be acceptable.
management practices. Although predictions are typically made using
mathematical models, there are certainly situa-
tions where expert judgment can be just as good.
10.3.1 Model Selection Criteria Reliance on professional judgment and simpler
models is often acceptable, especially when
There was a time when if one needed a water limited data exist.
quality model, they had to build it. Today there Highly detailed models require more time and
exist a wide range of water quality models for are more expensive to develop and apply.
various types of water bodies, and for various Complex modeling studies should be undertaken
contaminants, and hence it makes little sense to only if warranted by the complexity of the
422 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

management problem. More complex modeling may die or become weakened and more vulner-
will not necessarily assure that uncertainty is able to disease.
reduced, and in fact added complexity can A model consisting of a sequence of condi-
compound problems of uncertainty analyses tional probabilities can be dened to predict the
(Chap. 8). probability of shellsh and sh abundance based
Placing a priority on process description on upstream nutrient loadings causing problems
usually leads to complex mechanistic model de- with sh and shellsh populations into the estu-
velopment and use over simpler mechanistic or ary. These conditional probabilities can be
empirical models. In some cases this may result judgmental, mechanistic, and/or statistical. Each
in unnecessarily costly analyses for effective conditional probability can be a separate sub-
decision-making. In addition, physical, chemical, model. Assuming each submodel can identify a
and biological processes in terrestrial and aquatic conditional probability distribution, the proba-
environments are far too complex to be fully bility Pr{C|N} of a specied amount of carbon,
represented in even the most detailed models. For C, given some specied loading of a nutrient, say
water quality management, the primary purpose nitrogen, N, equals the probability Pr{C|A} of
of modeling should be to support decision- that given amount of carbon given a concentra-
making. The inability to completely describe all tion of algae biomass, A, times the probability Pr
relevant processes can be accounted for by {A|N, R} of that concentration of algae biomass
quantifying the uncertainty in the model given the nitrogen loading, N, and the river flow,
predictions. R, times the probability Pr{R} of the river
flow, R.

10.3.2 Model Chains PrfCjN g PrfCjAgPrfAjN; RgPrfRg 10:1

Many water quality management analyses An empirical process-based model of the type
require the use of a sequence of models, one to be presented later in this chapter could be used
feeding data into another. For example, consider to predict the concentration of algae and the
the sequence or chain of models required for the chlorophyll violations based on the river flow
prediction of sh and shellsh survival as a and nitrogen loadings. Similarly to predict the
function of nutrient loadings into an estuary. Of production of carbon based on algae biomass.
interest to the stakeholders are the conditions of A seasonal statistical regression model might be
the sh and shellsh. One way to maintain used to predict the likelihood of algae blooms
healthy sh and shellsh stocks is to maintain based on algal biomass. A cross system com-
sufcient levels of oxygen in the estuary. The parison may be made to predict sediment oxygen
way to do this is to control algae blooms. This in demand. A relatively simple hydraulic model
turn requires limiting the nutrient loadings to the could be used to predict the duration of strati-
estuary that can promote algae growth and cation and the frequency of hypoxia given both
blooms, and subsequent DO decits. The mod- the stratication duration and sediment oxygen
eling challenge is to link nutrient loading to sh demand. Expert judgment and sh survival
and shellsh survival. models could be used to predict the shellsh
The negative effects of excessive nutrients abundance and shkill and sh health
(e.g., nitrogen) in an estuary are shown in probabilities.
Fig. 10.2. Nutrients stimulate the growth of The biological endpoints shell-sh survival
algae. Algae die and accumulate on the bottom and number of shkills, are meaningful indi-
where bacteria consume them. Under calm wind cators to stakeholders and can easily be related to
conditions density stratication occurs. Oxygen designated water body use. Models and even
is depleted in the bottom water. Fish and shellsh conditional probabilities assigned to each link of
10.3 Water Quality Model Use 423

Fig. 10.2 The negative impacts of excessive nutrients in an estuary (NRC 2001)

the network in Fig. 10.3 can reflect a combina- 10.3.3 Model Data
tion of simple mechanisms, statistical (regres-
sion) tting, and expert judgment. Data availability and accuracy is of concern in
Advances in mechanistic modeling of aquatic the development and use of models for water
ecosystems have resulted in our ability to include quality management. The complexity of models
greater process (especially trophic) detail and used for water quality management should be
complexity, as well as to perform dynamic sim- compatible with the quantity and quality of
ulations. Still, mechanistic ecosystem models available data. The use of complex mechanistic
have not advanced to the point of being able to models for water quality prediction in situations
predict community structure or biotic integrity. with little useful water quality data does not
In this chapter, only some of the simpler mech- compensate for a lack of data. Model complexity
anistic models will be introduced. More detail can give the impression of credibility but this is
can be found in books solely devoted to water not always true.
quality modeling (Chapra and Reckhow 1983; It is often preferable to begin with simple
Chapra 1997; McCutcheon 1989; Thomann and models and then over time add additional com-
Mueller 1987; Orlob 1983; Schnoor 1996) as plexity as justied based on the collection and
well as the current literature. analysis of additional data. This strategy makes
424 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

chlorophyll
violations
nutrient
inputs river
flow

algal harmfull
density algal
blooms

carbon
production

sediment
oxygen
demand

duration frequency
of of
stratification hypoxia

shellfish
abundance fish
health
number
of
fishkills
E020730c

Fig. 10.3 Cause and effect diagram for estuary eutrophication due to excessive nutrient loadings (Borsuk et al. 2001)

efcient use of resources. It focuses efforts Water quality models of water bodies receiv-
toward obtaining information and models that ing pollutant discharges require those pollutant
will reduce the uncertainty as the analysis pro- loadings as input data. These pollutant discharges
ceeds. Models should be selected (simple vs. can originate from point and non-point sources.
complex) in part based on the data available to Point source discharges are much easier to
support their use. measure, monitor, and estimate than non-point
10.3 Water Quality Model Use 425

source inputs. Non-point discharge data often is both a science as well as an art. Each model
come from rainfall-runoff models that attempt to reflects the creativity of its developer, the par-
predict the quantity of runoff and its constituent ticular water quality management problems and
concentrations. The reliability of the predictions issues being addressed, the available data for
from these models is not very good, especially if model parameter calibration and verication, and
short time periods (e.g., each day or week) are the time available for modeling and associated
being simulated. Their average values over uncertainty and other analyses. The fact that
longer time periods (e.g., each month or year) most, if not all, water quality models cannot
tend to be more reliable. This is mainly because accurately predict what actually happens does
the short-term inputs to those models, such as not necessarily detract from their value. Even
constituent loadings on the land and the rainfall relatively simple models can help managers
within an area, which can vary over space and understand the real-world prototype and estimate
time within the area and time period being sim- at least the relative if not actual change in water
ulated, are typically not known with any preci- quality associated with given changes in the
sion. Chapter 12 reviews some of these loading inputs resulting from water and land manage-
models and their limitations. ment policies or practices.

10.4 Models of Water Quality 10.4.1 Mass Balance Principles


Processes
The basis principle of water quality models is that
Water quality models can be applied to many of mass balance. A water system can be divided
different types of water systems including into different segments or volumes elements (e.g.,
streams, rivers, lakes, reservoirs, estuaries, stream or river reaches, lake layers, estuary seg-
coastal waters, and oceans. The models describe ments), also called computational cells. For
the main water quality processes and typically each segment or cell, there must be mass balance
require the hydrologic and constituent inputs (the for each water quality constituent over time. Most
water flows or volumes and the pollutant load- water quality simulation models simulate quality
ings). These models include terms for dispersive over a consecutive series of discrete time period
and/or advective transport depending on the durations, t. Time is divided into discrete
hydrologic and hydrodynamic characteristics of intervals and the flows are assumed constant
the water body, and terms for the biological, within each of those time period intervals. For
chemical and physical reactions among con- each segment and each time period, the mass
stituents. Advective transport dominates in balance of a substance in a segment can be
flowing rivers. Dispersion is the predominant administrated. Components of the mass balance
transport phenomenon in estuaries subject to for a segment include: (1) changes by transport
tidal action. Lake water quality prediction is (Tr) into and out of the segment, (2) changes by
complicated by the influence of random wind physical or chemical processes (P) occurring
directions and velocities that often affect surface within the segment and (3) changes by
mixing, currents, and stratication. For this and sources/discharges to or from the segment (S).
other reasons, obtaining reliable lake quality
     
predictions is often more difcult than for DMi DMi DMi
Mit D t Mit Dt Dt Dt
streams, rivers, and estuaries. In coastal waters Dt Tr Dt P Dt S
and oceans, larges scale flow patterns and tides 10:2
are the most important transport mechanisms.
As with water quantity modeling, the devel- The mass balance has the following
opment and application of water quality models components:
426 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

the mass in computational cell i at the values of x, y and z do not have to be equal.
beginning of a time step t: Mit The computational cell can have any rectangular
the mass in computational cell i at the end of shape. A computational cell can share surface
a time step t: Mit Dt areas with other computational cells, the atmo-
changes in computational cell i by transport; sphere and the bottom sediment or coast line.
DM  The following sections will look at the trans-
i
Dt Tr
changes in computational cell i by physical, port processes in more detail, dening parame-
  ters or variables and their units in terms of mass
(bio)chemical or biological processes: DM i
Dt P M, length L, and time T.
changes in computational cell i by sources
 
(e.g., waste loads, river discharges): DM i
Dt S 10.4.1.1 AdvectiveTransport
The advective transport, Tx0 A (M T1), of a con-
Transport includes both advective and dis- stituent at a site x0 is the product of the average
persive transport. Advective transport is the water velocity, vx0 (L T1), at that site, the surface
transport by flowing water. Dispersive transport or cross-sectional area, A (L2), through which
results from concentration differences. Disper- advection takes place at that site, and the average
sion in the vertical direction is important if the concentration, Cx0 (M L3), of the constituent:
water column is stratied, and dispersion in the
horizontal direction can be in one or two Tx0 A vx0 A  Cx0 10:3
dimensions. Dispersion, as dened here, includes
the physical concept of molecular diffusion as it
represents all transport that is not described by 10.4.1.2 Dispersive Transport
the advective transport. The dispersive transport, TxD0 (M T1) across a
Processes include physical processes such as surface area is assumed to be proportional to the

reaeration and settling, (bio)chemical processes concentration gradient @C 
@x xx0 at site x0 times the
such as adsorption, transformation, and denitri- surface area A. Letting Dx0 (L2 T1), be the dis-
cation and biological processes such as primary persion or diffusion coefcient at site x0:
production and predation on phytoplankton. Water 
quality processes convert one substance to another. @C
TxD0  Dx0 A   10:4
Sources include the addition of mass by waste @x xx0
loads and the extraction of mass by intakes. Mass
entering over the model boundaries can be con- Dispersion is commonly based on Ficks dif-
sidered a source as well. The water flowing into fusion law. The minus sign reflects the fact that
or flowing out of the modeled segment or volume dispersion causes net transport from higher to
element (the computational cell) is derived from lower concentrations, so in the opposite direction
monitoring data or a water quantity (possibly of the concentration gradient. The concentration
hydrodynamic) model. gradient is the difference of concentrations per
To model the transport of substances over unit length, over a very small distance across the
space, a water system can be divided into small cross section
segments or volume elements. The complete
ensemble of all the segments or elements is @C=@xjx limDx ! 0
10:5
called the grid or schematization. Each Cx 0:5Dx  Cx0:5Dx =Dx
computational cell is dened by its volume and
its dimensions in one, two, or three directions Dispersion coefcients should be calibrated or
(x, y, z) depending on the nature of the be obtained from calculations with turbulence
schematization (1D, 2D, or 3D). Note that the models.
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 427

10.4.1.3 Mass Transport @C @2C @C @2C


by Advection Dx 2  vx Dy 2
@t @x @x @y
and Dispersion @C @2C @C
If the advective and dispersive terms are added  vy D z 2  vz S fR C; t
@y @z @z
and the terms at a second surface at site x0 + x
10:10
are included, the one-dimensional equation results
 with dispersion coefcients Dj dened for each
Mi t Dt Mit Dt  mx0 Cx0  mx0 Dx Cx0 Dx direction j. If source terms S and fR are
  ! added as shown in the equation above, the
@C  @C 
Dx0  Dx0 Dx  A so-called advectiondiffusion-reaction equation
@x x0 @x x0 Dx
emerges. The additional terms represent
10:6
Discharges or waste loads (S): these source
or equivalently: terms are additional inflows of water or mass.
 As many source terms as required may be
Mi t Dt Mit Dt  Qx0 Cx0  Qx0 Dx Cx0 Dx added to Eq. 10.10. These could include
  ! small rivers, discharges of industries, sewage
@C @C  treatment plants, small waste load outfalls,
Dx0 Ax0  Dx0 Dx Ax0 Dx  ;
@x x0 @x x0 Dx etc.
10:7 Reaction terms or processes (fR).
Processes can be split into physical processes
where Qx0 (L3 T1) is the flow at site x0. and other processes. Examples of physical pro-
If the previous equation is divided by the cesses are
volume and the time interval t, then the fol-
lowing equation results in one dimension. settling of suspended particulate matter
  water movement not affecting substances, like
@C  
Cit Dt  Cit Dx0 Dx @x x0 Dx
 Dx0 @C
@x x0 evaporation

Dt Dx volatilization of the substance itself at the
vx0 Cx0  vx0 Dx Cx0 Dx water surface.

Dx
Examples of other processes are
10:8
biochemical conversions like ammonia and
Taking the asymptotic limit t 0 and oxygen forming nitrite
x 0, the advectiondiffusion equation for growth of algae (primary production)
one dimension results predation by other animals
  chemical reactions.
@C @ @C @
D  vC 10:9
@t @x @x @x These processes are described in more detail
in the remaining parts of this Sect. 10.4.
The nite volume computational method for Multiplying each term in Eq. 10.9 by the
transport can be used to solve the advectiondif- cross-sectional area A (L2), the expression DA
fusion equation. The accuracy of the method will (C/x) vAC for a one-dimensional model, or
be related to the size of x, A (=y z) and t. its equivalent in Eq. 10.10 for a three-
By adding terms for transport in the y and z- dimensional model, is termed the total flux
direction a three-dimensional model is obtained. (M T1). Flux due to dispersion, DA(C/x),
Taking the asymptotic limit again will lead to a is assumed to be proportional to the concentra-
three-dimensional advectiondiffusion equation tion gradient over distance. Constituents are
428 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

transferred by dispersion from higher concen- site x = 0, the concentration C at any distance
tration zones to lower concentrations zones. The x will equal
coefcient of dispersion D (L2 T1) depends on 
WC =Qmexpv=2D1 mx x  0
the amplitude and frequency of the tide, if Cx
applicable, as well as upon the turbulence of the WC =Qmexpv=2D1mx x  0
water body. It is common practice to include in 10:12
this dispersion parameter everything affecting the
distribution of C other than advection. The term where
vAC is the advective flux caused by the move-   1=2
m 1 4kD=v2 10:13
ment of water containing the constituent con-
centration C (M L3) at a velocity rate v (L T1)
Note from Eq. 10.13 that the parameter m is
across a cross-sectional area A.
always equal or greater than 1. Hence the expo-
The relative importance of dispersion and
nent of e in Eq. 10.12 is always negative. As the
advection depends on how detailed the velocity
distance x increases in magnitude, either in the
eld is dened. A good spatial and temporal
positive or negative direction, the concentration
description of the velocity eld within which the
C(x) will decrease. The maximum concentration
constituent is being distributed will reduce the
C occurs at x = 0 and is WC/Qm.
importance of the dispersion term. Less precise
descriptions of the velocity eld, such as aver- C0 WC =Qm 10:14
aging across irregular cross sections or approxi-
mating transients by steady flows, may lead to a These equations are plotted in Fig. 10.4.
dominance of the dispersion term. In flowing rivers not under the influence of
Many of the reactions affecting the decrease or tidal actions the dispersion is small. Assuming
increase of constituent concentrations are often the dispersion coefcient D is 0, the parameter
represented by rst-order kinetics which assumes m dened by Eq. 10.13, is 1. When D = 0, the
that the reaction rates are proportional to the maximum concentration at x = 0 is WC/Q.
constituent concentration. While higher order
C0 WC =Q if D 0: 10:15
kinetics may be more correct in certain situations,
predictions of constituent concentrations based on
Assuming D = 0 and v, Q and k > 0,
rst-order kinetics have often been considered
Eq. 10.12 becomes
acceptable for natural aquatic systems.

0 x0
Cx 10:16
WC =Qexpkx=v x  0
10.4.2 Steady-State Models
The above equation for x > 0 can be derived
Steady state means no change in the concentra- from Eqs. 10.12 and 10.13 by noting that the term
tions over time. In this case the left-hand side of (1 m) equals (1 m)(1 + m)/(1 + m) = (1
Eq. 10.9 or 10.10, C/t, equals 0. Assume the m2)/2 when D is 0. Thus, when D is 0 the
only sink is the natural decay of the constituent expression (v/2D)(1 m)x in Eq. 10.12 becomes
dened as kC where k, (T1), is the decay rate kx/v. The term x/v is sometimes denoted as a
coefcient or constant. Now Eq. 10.9 becomes single variable representing the time of flowthe
time flow Q takes to travel from site x = 0 to some
0 D@ 2 C=@x2  v@C=@x  kC 10:11 other downstream site x > 0.
As rivers approach the sea, the dispersion
Equation 10.11 can be integrated since river coefcient D increases and the net downstream
reach parameters A, D, k, v, and Q are assumed velocity v decreases. Because the flow Q equals
constant. For a constant loading, WC (M T1) at the cross-sectional area A times the velocity v,
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 429

Fig. 10.4 Constituent


concentration distributions
along a river or estuary
resulting from a constant
discharge of that
constituent at a single point
source in that river or
estuary. The top plot
represents Eq. 10.16, the
middle plot represents
Eq. 10.12, and the bottom
plot represents Eq. 10.17

Q = Av, and since the parameter m can be dened stream quality that meets the standards along a
as (v2 + 4kD)1/2/v, then as the velocity v stream or river.
approaches 0, the term Qm = Av(v2 + 4kD)1/2/v Figure 10.5 shows a schematic of a river into
approaches 2A(kD)1/2. The exponent vx(1 m)/2D which wastewater containing constituent C is
in Eq. 10.12 approaches x(k/D)1/2. being discharged at four sites. Assume maximum
Hence for small velocities, Eq. 10.4 becomes allowable concentrations of the constituent C are
specied at each of those discharge sites. To
8 h i
< WC =2AkD1=2 exp xk=D1=2 x0
estimate the needed reduction in these dis-
CX  h i charges, the river must be divided into approxi-
: WC =2AkD1=2 exp xk=D1=2 x0 mately homogenous reaches. Each reach can be
10:17 characterized by constant values of the
cross-sectional area, A, dispersion coefcient, D,
Here dispersion is much more important than constituent decay rate constant, k, and velocity, v,
advective transport and the concentration prole associated with some design flow and tem-
approaches a symmetric distribution, as shown in perature conditions. These parameter values and
Fig. 10.4, about the point of discharge at x = 0. the length, x, of each reach can differ, hence the
Water quality management models are often subscript index i will be used to denote the par-
used to assess the effect of pollutant loadings on ticular reach. These reaches are shown in
ambient waters and to compare the results with Fig. 10.5.
specic water quality standards. The above In Fig. 10.5 each variable Ci represents the
steady state equations can be used to construct constituent concentration at the beginning of
such a model for estimating the wastewater reach i. The flows Q represent the design flow
removal efciencies required at each wastewater conditions. For each reach i the product (Qi mi) is
discharge site that will result in an ambient represented by (Qm)i. The downstream (forward)
430 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

Fig. 10.5 Optimization model for nding constituent removal efciencies, Ri, at each discharge site i that result in
meeting stream quality standards, Cmax
i , at least total cost

transfer coefcient, TFi, equals the applicable The model in Fig. 10.5 incorporates both
part of Eq. 10.12, advection and dispersion. If upstream dispersion
under design streamflow conditions is not sig-
TFi expv=2D1mx 10:18 nicant in some reaches, then the upstream
(backward) transfer coefcients, TBi, for those
as does the upstream (backward) transfer coef- reaches i will equal 0.
cient, TBi.

TBi expv=2D1 mx 10:19


10.4.3 Design Streamflows
The parameter m is dened by Eq. 10.13.
for Setting
Finding the cost solution of a model such as
and Evaluating
shown in Fig. 10.5 does not mean that the
Quality Standards
least-cost wasteload allocation plan will be
In streams and rivers, the water quality may vary
implemented, but such information can help
signicantly depending on the stream or river
identify the additional costs of other imposed
flow and its quality prior to wastewater dis-
constraints, for example, to ensure equity, or
charges. If waste load discharges are fairly con-
extra safety. Models like this can be used to
stant, a high flow of high quality serves to dilute
identify the cost-quality tradeoffs inherent in any
the waste concentration while contaminant con-
water quality management program. Non eco-
centrations of low flows may become undesir-
nomic objectives can also be used to obtain other
ably high. It is therefore common practice to pick
tradeoffs.
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 431

a more critical low-flow condition for judging flows is divided by 7 and the minimum value is
whether or not ambient water quality standards selected. This is the minimum annual average
are being met. This can also be seen from 7-day flow for the year.
Eqs. 10.12, 10.14, 10.15, and 10.16. This often is These minimum 7-day average flows for each
the basis for the assumption that the smaller (or year of record dene a probability distribution,
more critical) the design flow, the more likely it whose cumulative probabilities can be plotted. As
is that the stream quality standards will be met in illustrated in Fig. 10.7, the particular flow on the
practice. This is not always the case, however. cumulative distribution that has a 90% chance of
Different regions of the world use different being exceeded is the design flow. It is the mini-
design low-flow conditions. One example of mum annual average 7-day flow expected once in
such a design flow, that is used in parts of North 10 years. This flow is commonly called the 7Q10
America, is the minimum 7-day average flow flow. Analyses have shown that this daily design
expected to be lower only once in 10 years on flow is exceeded about 99% of the time in regions
average. Each year the lowest 7-day average flow where it is used (NRC 2001). This means that there
is determined, as shown in Fig. 10.6. The sum of is on average only about a one percent chance that
each of the 365 sequences of seven average daily any daily flow will be less than this 7Q10 flow.

Fig. 10.6 Portion of


annual flow time series
showing low flows and the
calculation of average 7
and 14-day flows

Fig. 10.7 Determining the


minimum 7-day annual
average flow expected once
in 10 years, designated
7Q10, from the cumulative
probability distribution of
annual minimum 7-day
average flows
432 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

Consider now any one of the river reaches 10.4.4 Temperature


shown in Fig. 10.5. Assume an initial loading of
constituent mass, M/t, exists at the beginning of Temperature impacts almost all water quality
the reach. As the reach flow, Q, increases and the processes taking place in water bodies. For this
mass loading stays the same, the initial concen- reason modeling temperature may be important
tration, M/Q, will decrease. However, the flow when the temperature varies over the period of
velocity will increase, and thus the time, t, it interest, or when the discharge of heat into water
takes to transport the constituent mass to the end bodies is to be managed.
of that reach will decrease. This means less time Temperature models are based on a heat bal-
for the decay of the constituent. Hence it is ance in the water body. A heat balance takes into
possible that ambient water quality standards that account the sources and sinks of heat. The main
are met during low flow conditions may not be sources of heat in a water body are shortwave
met under higher flow conditions, conditions that solar radiation, longwave atmospheric radiation,
are observed much more frequently. Figure 10.8 conduction of heat from the atmosphere to the
illustrates how this might happen. This does not water and direct heat inputs. The main sinks of
suggest that low flows should not be considered heat are long wave radiation emitted by the
when allocating waste loads, but rather that a water, evaporation, and conduction from the
simulation of water quality concentrations over water to atmosphere. Unfortunately, a model
varying flow conditions may show that higher with all the sources and sinks of heat requires
flow conditions at some sites are even more measurements of a number of variables and
critical and more frequent than they are during coefcients that are not always readily available.
less frequent low-flow conditions. One temperature predictor is the simplied
Figure 10.8 shows that for a xed mass of model that assumes an equilibrium temperature
pollutant at x = 0, under low flow conditions the Te (C) will be reached under steady-state
more restrictive (lower) maximum pollutant meteorological conditions. The temperature
concentration standard in the downstream portion mass balance in a volume segment depends on
of the river is met, but that same standard is the water density (g/cm3), the heat capacity of
violated under higher flow conditions. water, cp (cal/g/C), and the water depth h (cm).

Fig. 10.8 Increasing


streamflows decreases
initial concentrations but
may increase downstream
concentrations
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 433

Assuming the net heat input, KH(Te T) proportional to the concentration of either the
(cal/cm2/day), is proportional to the difference of same or another constituent concentration. The
the actual temperature, T, and the equilibrium temperature-dependent proportionality constant
temperature, Te (C), kc (1/day) is called a rate coefcient or constant.
In general, if the rate of change in some con-
dT=dt KH Te  T =qcp h 10:20 stituent concentration Cj is proportional to the
magnitude of concentration Ci, of constituent i,
The overall heat exchange coefcient, KH then
(cal/cm2/day/C), is determined in units of
T20
W/m2/C (1 cal/cm2/day C = 0.4840 W/m2/C) dCj =dt aij ki hi Ci ; 10:22
from empirical relationships that include wind
velocity Uw (m/s), dew point temperature Td (C), where i is temperature correction coefcient for
and actual temperature T (C) (Thomann and ki at 20 C and T is the temperature in C. The
Mueller 1987). parameter aij is the grams of Cj produced (aij > 0)
The equilibrium temperature, Te, is obtained or consumed (aij < 0) per gram Ci. For the pre-
from another empirical relationship involving the diction of BOD concentration over time, Ci =
overall heat exchange coefcient, KH, the dew Cj = BOD and aij = aBOD = 1 in Eq. 10.22.
point temperature, Td, and the shortwave solar Conservative substances, such as salt, will have a
radiation Hs (cal/cm2/day), decay rate constant k of 0. The concentration of
conservative substances depends only on the
Te Td Hs =KH 10:21 amount of water, i.e., dilution.
The typical values for the rate coefcients kc
This model simplies the mathematical rela- and temperature coefcients i of some con-
tionships of a complete heat balance and requires stituents C are in Table 10.1. For bacteria, the
less data. rst-order decay rate (kB) can also be expressed
in terms of the time to reach 90% mortality (t90,
days). The relationship between these coefcients
10.4.5 Sources and Sinks is given by kB = 2.3/t90.

Sources and sinks of water quality constituents


include the physical and biochemical processes 10.4.7 Dissolved Oxygen
that are represented by the term S in Eq. 10.10.
External inputs of each constituent would have DO concentration is a common indicator of the
the form W/Q, where W (M T1) is the loading health of the aquatic ecosystem. DO was origi-
rate of the constituent and Q represents the flow nally modeled by Streeter and Phelps (1925).
of water into which the mass of waste W is Since then a number of modications and
discharged. extensions of the model have been made
depending on the number of sinks and sources of
DO being considered and how processes
10.4.6 First-Order Constituents involving the nitrogen cycle and phytoplankton,
are being modeled, as illustrated in Fig. 10.9.
The rst-order models are commonly used to The sources of DO in a water body include
predict water quality constituent decay or reaeration from the atmosphere, photosynthetic
growth. They can represent constituent reactions oxygen production from aquatic plants, denitri-
such as decay or growth in situations where the cation, and DO inputs. The sinks include oxi-
time rate of change (dC/dt) in the concentration dation of carbonaceous and nitrogenous material,
C of the constituent, say organic matter that sediment oxygen demand and respiration by
creates a biochemical oxygen demand (BOD), is aquatic plants.
434 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

Table 10.1 Typical values of the rst-order decay rate, k, and the temperature correction factor, , for some
constituents

DO2 =Dt loads transport reaeration 1.030. In practice a value of 1.024 is often used
net primary production denitrification
(Thomann and Mueller 1987). The reaeration rate
constant is a sensitive parameter. There have been
 mineralization  nitrificationSOD
numerous equations developed to dene this rate
constant. Table 10.2 lists some of them.
The rate of reaeration is assumed to be pro- The saturation concentration, DOsat, of oxy-
portional to the difference between the saturation gen in water is a function of the water tempera-
concentration, DOsat (mg/l), and the concentra- ture and salinity [chloride concentration, Cl
tion of DO, DO (mg/l). The proportionality (g/m3)], and can be approximated by
coefcient is the reaeration rate kr (1/day), dened
n
at temperature T = 20 C, which can be corrected DOsat 14:652  0:41022T 0:089392T2
for any temperature T with the coefcient (T20)
r .
The value of this temperature correction coef-  0:042685T3 gf1  Cl=100000g 10:23a
cient, , depends on the mixing condition of the
water body. Values generally range from 1.005 to
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 435

Table 10.2 Some equations for dening the reaeration rate constant, kr (1/day)

Fig. 10.9 The dissolved oxygen interactions in a water body reaeration or deaeration (if supersaturated occurs at
body, showing the decay (satisfaction) of carbonaceous, the airwater interface)
nitrogenous and sediment oxygen demands and water
436 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

Fig. 10.10 Fitted curve to


the saturation dissolved
oxygen concentration
(mg/l) as a function of
temperature (C)

Elmore and Hayes (1960) derived an analyti- oxygen demands are typically modeled as
cal expression for the DO saturation concentra- rst-order decay reactions with decay rate con-
tion, DOsat (mg/l), as a function of temperature stants kCBOD (1/day) for CBOD and kNBOD
(T, C): (1/day) for NBOD. These rate constants vary
with temperature, hence they are typically
DOsat 14:652  0:41022T 0:007991T 2 dened for 20 C. The decay rates are corrected
 0:000077774T 3 for temperatures other than 20 C using temper-
10:23b ature coefcients CBOD and NBOD, respectively.
The sediment oxygen demand (SOD)
Fitting a second-order polynomial curve to the (mg/liter/day) is usually expressed as a zero-order
data presented in Chapra (1997) results in reaction, i.e., a constant demand. One important
DOsat 14:407  0:3369T 0:0035T 2 feature in modeling NBOD is ensuring the
10:23c appropriate time lag between when it is discharged
into a water body and when the oxygen demand is
as is shown in Fig. 10.10. observed. This lag is in part a function of the level
Because photosynthesis occurs during daylight of treatment in the wastewater treatment plant.
hours, photosynthetic oxygen production follows The DO model with CBOD, NBOD, and SOD
a cyclic, diurnal, pattern in water. During the day, is
T20 T20
oxygen concentrations in water are high and can dDO=dt kCBOD hCBOD CBOD  kNBOD hNBOD NBOD
even become supersaturated, i.e., concentrations kr qrT20 DOsat  DO  SOD
exceeding the saturation concentration. At night, 10:24
the concentrations drop due to respiration and
T20
other oxygen consuming processes. dCBOD=dt kCBOD hCBOD CBOD 10:25
The biochemical oxygen demand results from
carbonaceous organic matter (CBOD, mg/l) and T20
dNBOD=dt kNBOD hNBOD NBOD 10:26
from nitrogenous organic matter (NBOD, mg/l)
in the water. There is also the oxygen demand The mean and range values for coefcients
from carbonaceous and nitrogenous organic included in these DO models are in Table 10.3.
matter in the sediments (SOD, mg/l/day). These
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 437

Table 10.3 Typical values of parameters used in the dissolved oxygen models

10.4.8 Nutrients in nutrients leads to an increase in the produc-


and Eutrophication tivity of the water system that may result in an
excessive increase in the biomass of algae or
Eutrophication is the progressive process of other primary producers such as macrophytes or
nutrient enrichment of water systems. An increase duck weed. When it is visible on the surface of the
438 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

water it is called an algae bloom. Excessive algal The uptake of the more abundant nutrient will not
biomass could affect the water quality, especially occur.
if it causes anaerobic conditions and thus impairs To account for this, algal growth is commonly
the drinking, recreational, and ecological uses. modeled as a MichaelisMenten multiplicative
The eutrophication component of the model effect, i.e., the nutrients have a synergistic effect.
relates the concentration of nutrients and the algal Model parameters include a maximum algal
biomass. For example, as shown in Fig. 10.11, growth rate l (1/day) times the fraction of a day,
consider the growth of algae A (mg/lnot to be fd, that rate applies (Fig. 10.12), the half satura-
confused with area A used in previous equations), tion constants KP and KN (mg/l) (shown as Kc in
depending on phosphate phosphorus, P (mg/l), Fig. 10.13) for phosphate and nitrate, respec-
and nitrite/nitrate nitrogen, Nn (mg/l), as the lim- tively, and a combined algal respiration and
iting nutrients. There could be other limiting specic death rate constant e (1/day) that creates
nutrients or other conditions as well, but here an oxygen demand. The uptake of phosphate,
consider only these two. If either of these two ammonia, and nitrite/nitrate by algae is assumed
nutrients is absent, the algae cannot grow to be in proportion to their contents in the algae
regardless of the abundance of the other nutrient.

Fig. 10.11 The dissolved oxygen, nitrogen, and phos- ammonium to nitratenitrogen and oxidation of organic
phorus cycles, and phytoplankton interactions in a water phosphorus in the sediment or bottom layer to phosphate
body, showing the decay (satisfaction) of carbonaceous phosphorus, phytoplankton production from nitrate and
and sediment oxygen demands, reaeration or deaeration of phosphate consumption, and phytoplankton respiration
oxygen at the airwater interface, ammonication of and death contributing to the organic nitrogen and
organic nitrogen in the detritus, nitrication (oxidation) of phosphorus
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 439

Fig. 10.12 Calculation of


the fraction, fd, of the
maximum growth rate
constant, l, to use in the
algal growth equations. The
fraction fd is the ratio of
actual production
zone/potential production
zone

Fig. 10.13 Dening the


half saturation constant for
a MichaelisMenten model
of algae. The actual growth
rate constant = lC/
(C + KC)

biomass. Dene these proportions as aP, aA, and Users of water quality simulation programs will
aN, respectively. appreciate the many different assumptions that
In addition to the above parameters, one needs can be made and the large amount of parameters
to know the amounts of oxygen consumed in the associated with most of them.
oxidation of organic phosphorus, Po, and the The source and sink terms of the relatively
amounts of oxygen produced by photosynthesis simple eutrophication model shown in Fig. 10.11
and consumed by respiration. In the model can be written as follows:
below, some average values have been assumed. For algae biomass
Also assumed are constant temperature correc-
T20
tion factors for all processes pertaining to any dA=dt lfd hA P=P KP Nn =Nn KN A
individual constituent. This reduces the number T20
 ehA A
of parameters needed, but is not necessarily
10:27
realistic. Clearly other processes as well as other
parameters could be added, but the purpose here
For organic phosphorus
is to illustrate how these models are developed.
440 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

dPo =dt kop hT20


op Po 10:28 For DO

For phosphate phosphorus T20


dDO=dt kCBOD hCBOD CBOD  4:57ka haT20 Na
T20 T20 T20
dP=dt lfd hA P=P KP Nn =Nn KN aP A  2kop hop Po 1:5 lfd  2ehA A
10:29 kr hT20
r DOsat  DO  SOD
For organic nitrogen 10:33
dNo =dt kon hT20
on No 10:30 Representative values of the coefcients for
this model are in Table 10.4.
For ammonianitrogen
Because of the growth of phytoplankton
T20 cannot occur without nutrients, the eutrophica-
dNa =dt lfd hA P=P KP Nn =Nn KN aA A
tion modeling must be coupled with that of
kon honT20 No  ka haT20 Na nutrients. Nutrient modeling must include all the
10:31 different biochemical forms of the nutrients,
For nitratenitrogen primarily nitrogen and phosphorus, as well as all
T20
the interactions between the different forms. The
dNn =dt lfd hA P=P KP Nn =Nn KN aN A sum of all these interactions is referred to a
T20
ka haT20 Na  kn hA Nn nutrient cycling.
10:32 The nitrogen cycle includes ammonium
(NH4N) and nitrate/nitrite (represented as

Table 10.4 Typical values of coefcients in the eutrophication model


10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 441

NO3N) as the main forms of dissolved nitrogen well as in the bottom sediment. Unlike nitrogen,
in water. Furthermore, nitrogen is present in there can also be inorganic phosphorus in the
algae, as well as in detritus, resulting from algae particulate phase.
mortality, and in suspended (non-detritus)
organic nitrogen. Nitrogen can also be present in
10.4.9 Toxic Chemicals
different forms in the bottom sediment.
Two important reactions in the nitrogen
Toxic chemicals, also referred to as micropol-
nutrient cycle are nitrication and denitrication,
lutants, are substances that at low concentra-
which affect the flux of ammonium and nitrate in
tions can impair the reproduction and growth of
the water column. Nitrication is the conversion
organisms including sh and human beings.
of ammonium to nitrite and nally nitrate,
These substances include heavy metals, many
requiring the presence of oxygen
synthetic organic compounds (organic microp-
NH4 2O2 ! NO3  H2 O 2H 10:34 ollutants), and radioactive substances.

Denitrication is the process occurring during 10.4.9.1 Adsorbed and Dissolved


the breakdown (oxidation) of organic matter by Pollutants
which nitrate is transformed to nitrogen gas, An important characteristic of many of these
which is then usually lost from the water system. substances is their afnity with the surface areas
Denitrication occurs in anaerobic systems of suspended or bottom sediments. Many chem-
icals preferentially sorb onto particulate matter
NO3  ! N2 10:35 rather than remaining dissolved in water. To
model the transport and fate of these substances,
The phosphorus cycle is simpler than the the adsorptiondesorption process, estimations of
nitrogen cycle because there are fewer forms in the suspended sediment concentration, resuspen-
which phosphorus can be present. There is only sion from the bottom, and settling are required.
one form of dissolved phosphorus, orthophos- Figure 10.14 depicts the adsorptiondesorp-
phorus (also called orthophosphate, PO4P). tion and rst-order decay processes for toxic
Similar to nitrogen, phosphorus also exists in chemicals and their interaction in water and
algae, in detritus, and other organic material as sediment. This applies to the water and sediment

Fig. 10.14 Schematic of


the adsorption/desorption
and decay processes of
various toxic chemicals in
water bodies and bottom
sediments
442 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

Fig. 10.15 Dening the partition coefcient Kp phases of either a water body or bottom sediments.
(liters/kg) as the slope of the xed ratio between Different constituents have different partition coefcients,
concentrations of a constituent in the water and sediment when they apply

phases in both the water body and in the bottom the model in most cases. It may be necessary to
sediments. include dissolved organic matter as well.
The adsorptiondesorption model assumes The adsorbed fractions in the water column
(conveniently but not always precisely) that an are subject to settling. The fractions in the sedi-
equilibrium exists between the dissolved (in ment are subject to resuspension. The adsorbed
water) and absorbed (on sediments) concentra- fractions in the sediment can also be removed
tions of a toxic constituent such as a heavy metal from the modeled part of the water system by
or organic contaminant. This equilibrium follows burial.
a linear relationship. The slope of that linear The rates of settling and resuspension of
relation is the partition coefcient Kp (l/kg). This micropollutants are proportional to the rates for
is shown in Fig. 10.15. particulate matter. An additional process called
Each partition coefcient Kp (liters per kilo- bioturbation leads to redistribution of the
gram or l/kg) is dened as the ratio of the par- micropollutant among sediment layers. Biotur-
ticulate concentration Cp of a micropollutant bation is caused by physical activity of organ-
(mg/kg C) divided by the dissolved concentration isms, and affects both the particulate and
Cd of a micropollutant (mg/l water). dissolved phases but with different rates. Bio-
turbation is taken into account by means of dis-
Kp Cp0 =Cd0 10:36 persion coefcients.
For modeling purposes, it is important to
Representative values of partition coefcients know how much of a toxic chemical is present as
Kp are in Table 10.5. a dissolved constituent as opposed to adsorbed.
The presence of a micropollutant in water is Assuming partition coefcients apply to a par-
described by the total concentration (sum of ticular toxic constituent, the concentration, Cw, of
dissolved and particulate concentrations), the that constituent in the water body is divided into
total particulate concentration, and the total dis- a dissolved fraction (fdw) and an absorbed frac-
solved concentration for each water and sediment tion (faw).
compartment. The particulate and dissolved
concentrations are derived from the total con- C w fdw faw Cw 10:37
centration and the respective fractions.
Because the fate of most micropollutants is In turn, the adsorbed fraction of a micropol-
largely determined by adsorption to particulate lutant is composed of the fractions adsorbed to
matter, suspended inorganic and organic matter inorganic particulate matter, fim, dead particulate
(including phytoplankton) have to be included in organic matter, fpoc, and algae, falg. The total
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 443

Table 10.5 Typical values of partition coefcients in toxic chemical model from Thomann and Mueller (1987)

micropollutant concentration, Cw (mg/m3) is the DCs fds Cs 10:43


sum of all these fractions.
 
Cw fdw fim ; fpoc falg Cw 10:38 ACs fas Cs 10:44

Considering the simple division into dissolved These fractions are dependent on the sediment
and adsorbed fractions (fdw and faw), these frac- porosity, , and density, s (kg/l).
tions depend on the partition coefcient, Kp, and
on the suspended sediment concentration, SS fds 1=/ qs 1  /Kp  10:45
(mg/l). The proportions of the total constituent
concentration in the water body, Cw, dissolved in
the water, DCw (mg/l), and adsorbed to the sus- fas 1  fds
pended sediments, ACw (mg/l) are dened as / qs 1  /Kp 1=/ qs 1  /Kp 
10:46
DCw fdw Cw 10:39
First-order decay occurs in the water and
ACw faw Cw ; 10:40 sediment phases only in the dissolved fraction
with decay rate constants kw and ks (1/day),
where the fractions respectively. Thus
 
fdw 1= 1 Kp SS 10:41
dCw =dt kw hT20
w fdw Cw  faw CwS fas Cs r
  10:47
faw 1  fdw Kp SS= 1 Kp SS 10:42

Similarly in the bottom sediments, the dis-


dCs =dt ks hT20
s fds Cs faw CwS  fas Cs r
solved concentration DCs (mg/l) and adsorbed
concentration ACs (mg/l) are fractions, fds and fas, 10:48
of the total concentration Cs (mg/l).
444 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

In the above two equations the parameter processes that affect particulate matter, such as
s represents the mass of settling sediments settling and resuspension.
(mg/day), r the mass of resuspension sediments Partitioning is described in general by sorp-
(mg/day), and the temperature correction tion to particulates, precipitation in minerals, and
coefcient of the constituent at temperature complexation in solution. Complexation with
T = 20 C. If data are not available to distinguish inorganic and organic ligands can be considered
between the values of the decay rate constants explicitly in connection with the other processes.
k in water and on sediments, they may be Sorption can be modeled as an equilibrium pro-
assumed to be the same. Similarly for the values cess (equilibrium partitioning) or as the resultant
of the temperature correction coefcients . of slow adsorption and desorption reactions (ki-
Suspended solids settling and resuspension can netic formulations). In the latter case, partitioning
be determined at each day from a sediment is assumed to proceed at a nite rate proportional
model. to the difference between the actual state and the
equilibrium state.
10.4.9.2 Heavy Metals To describe the fate of certain heavy metals in
The behavior of heavy metals in the environment reducing environments, such as sediment layers,
depends on their inherent chemical properties. the formation of metal sulfhides or hydroxides
Heavy metals can be divided into different cate- can be modeled. The soluble metal concentration
gories depending on their dissolved form and is determined on the basis of the relevant solu-
redox (reduction oxidation) status. Some metals, bility product. The excess metal is stored in a
including copper, cadmium lead, mercury, precipitated metal fraction.
nickel, tin and zinc form free or complexed Sorption and precipitation affect the dissolved
cations when dissolved in water (e.g., Cu2+ or metal concentration in different ways. Both the
CuCl). The soluble complexes are formed with adsorbed and dissolved fractions increase at
negatively charged ions such as chlorine, oxy- increasing total concentration as long as no sol-
gen, or dissolved organic compounds. These ubility product is exceeded. When it is, precipi-
heavy metals also tend to form poorly soluble tation occurs.
sulfhides under chemically reducing conditions.
These sulfhides generally settle in bottom sedi- 10.4.9.3 Organic Mircropollutants
ments and are essentially ecologically unavail- Organic micropollutants generally are biocides
able. Other metals such as arsenic and vanadium (such as pesticides or herbicides), solvents or
are present as anions in dissolved form. The combustion products and include substances
differences between groups of metals have such as hexachlorohexane, hexachlorobenzene,
important consequences for the partitioning of PCBs or polychlorobiphenyls, benzo-a-pyrene
the metals among several dissolved and particu- and fluoranthene (PAHs or polycyclic aromatic
late phases. hydrocarbons), diuron and linuron, atrazine and
Metals are non-decaying substances. The fate simazine, mevinfos and dichlorvos, and dinoseb.
of heavy metals in a water system is determined The short-term fate of organic micropollu-
primarily by partitioning to water and particulate tants in a water system is determined primarily
matter (including phytoplankton), and by trans- by partitioning to water and organic particulate
port. The partitioning divides the total amount of matter (including phytoplankton), and by
a pollutant into a dissolved fraction and several transport. Additional processes such as
adsorbed fractions (as described in Eqs. 10.39 volatilization and degradation influence organic
10.42. The fractions of a metal that are adsorbed micropollutant concentrations (this is in contrast
onto particulate matter are influenced by all the to heavy metals which do not decay). Many
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 445

toxic organic compounds have decay (or bulk) bulk concentrations, Cd Cs, all times
daughter) products that are equally, if not 106 mg/kg.
more, toxic than the original compound. The
rates of these processes are concentration and Kp 106 / Cp =Cd Cs 10:54
temperature dependent.
Organic micropollutants are generally poorly Partitioning can be simulated based on the
soluble in water and prefer to absorb to particu- above equilibrium approach or according to slow
late matter in the water, especially particulate sorption kinetics. For the latter, the rate, dCp/dt,
organic matter and algae. Therefore, the fractions of adsorption or desorption (mg/m3/day) depends
of a micropollutant adsorbed to inorganic matter, on a rst-order kinetic constant ksorp (1/day) for
fim, dead particulate organic matter, fpoc, the adsorption and desorption times the difference
dissolved fraction of a micropollutant, fd, and between equilibrium particulate concentration
algae, falg, add up to the total micropollutant Cpe of a micropollutant (mg/m3 bulk) and the
concentration, C (mg/m3). actual particulate concentration Cp (mg/m3 bulk)
of a micropollutant.
C fd fim fpoc falg C 10:49 dCp =dt ksorp Cpe  Cp 10:55
The fractions are functions of the partition The kinetic constant for sorption is not tem-
coefcients Kp [for algae (m3/g C), for inorganic perature dependent. All other kinetic constants
matter (m3 g DW1) and for dead particulate for micropollutants are temperature dependent.
organic matter (m3/g C)], the individual con- Mass balance equations are similar for all
centrations C [for algae biomass (g C/m3), for micropollutants except for the loss processes.
dissolved (in water) inorganic matter (g/m3) and Metals are conservative substances. They
for dead particulate organic matter (g C/m3)], and can be transformed into various species
the porosity (m3 water/m3 bulk). In surface either through complexation, adsorption, or pre-
water the value for porosity is 1. cipitation. Organic micropollutants are lost
by volatilization, biodegradation, photolysis,
fd /=/ Kpalg Calg Kpim Cim Kppoc Cpoc 
hydrolysis, and overall degradation. Most of
10:50 these processes are usually modeled as rst-order
processes, with associated rate constants.
The volatization rate, dCd/dt (mg/m3/day) of
fim 1  fd Kpim Cim =Kpalg Calg
10:51 dissolved micropollutant concentrations, Cd
Kpim Cim Kppoc Cpoc  (mg/m3 water) in water depends on an overall
transfer coefcient, kvol (m/day), for volatiliza-
tion and the depth of the water column, H (m).
fpoc 1  fd Kppoc Cpoc =Kpalg Calg
10:52
Kpim Cim Kppoc Cpoc  dCd =dt kvol Cd =H 10:56

The numerator (kvol Cd) is the volatilization


falg 1  fd  fim  fpoc 10:53 mass flux (mg/m2/day).
This equation is only valid when the atmo-
In terms of bulk measures, each partition spheric concentration is negligibly small, which
coefcient Kp (see Eq. 10.36) also equals the is the normal situation.
porosity times the bulk particulate concentra- All other loss rates such as biodegradation,
tion Cp (mg/m3 bulk) divided by the product of photolysis, hydrolysis, or overall degradation
the dissolved (mg/l bulk) and particulate (mg/m3 (mg/m3/day) are usually modeled as
446 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

dC=dt kC; 10:57 10.4.10 Sediments

where C is the total concentration of a microp- Sediments in water play an important role in the
ollutant (mg/m3), and k is a (pseudo) temperature transport and fate of chemical pollutants in water.
dependent rst-order kinetic rate constant for Natural waters can contain a mixture of particles
biodegradation, photolysis, hydrolysis or overall ranging from gravel (220 mm) or sand (0.07
degradation (1/day). This is similar to Eq. 10.22. 2 mm) down to very small particles classied as
silt or clay (smaller than 0.07 mm). The very ne
10.4.9.4 Radioactive Substances fractions can be carried as colloidal suspension
The fate of most radionuclides such as isotopes for which electrochemical forces play a pre-
of iodine (131I) and cesium (137Cs) in water is dominant role. Considering the large adsorbing
determined primarily by partitioning to water and capacities, the ne fraction is characterized as
particulate matter (including phytoplankton), by cohesive sediment. Cohesive sediment can
transport, and by decay. Cesium (Ce+) adsorbs to include silt and clay particles as well as partic-
particulate inorganic matter, to dead particulate ulate organic matter such as detritus and other
organic material, and to phytoplankton, both forms of organic carbon, diatoms and other
reversibly and irreversibly. The irreversible algae. Since flocculation and adsorbing capaci-
fraction increases over time as the reversible ties are of minor importance for larger particles,
fraction gradually transforms into the irreversible they are classied as non-cohesive sediment.
fraction. Radioactive decay proceeds equally for The behavior of this ne-grained suspended
all fractions. Precipitation of cesium does not matter impacts water quality. First, turbidity and
occur at low concentrations in natural water its effect on the underwater light is an important
systems. environmental condition for algae growth. The
Iodine is only present in soluble form as an presence of suspended sediment increases the
anion (IO3) and does not adsorb to particulate attenuation of light in the water column that leads
matter. Consequently, the transport iodine is only to an inhibition of photosynthetic activity and
subject to advection and dispersion. hence, a reduction in primary production. Sec-
Concentrations of radionuclides, CR (mg/m3) ond, the fate of contaminants in waters is closely
are essentially conservative in a chemical sense, related to suspended solids due to their large
but they decay by falling apart in other nuclides adsorbing capacities. Like dissolved matter,
and various types of radiation. The radioactive sediment is transported by advection and by
decay rate (mg/m3/day) is usually modeled as a turbulent motion. In addition, the fate of the
rst-order process involving a kinetic radioactive suspended cohesive sediment is determined by
decay constant, kdec (1/day). This kinetic constant settling and deposition, as well as by bed pro-
is derived from the half-life time of the cesses of consolidation, bioturbation, and
radionuclide. The initial concentration may be resuspension.
expressed as radioactivity, in order to simulate
the activity instead of the concentration. These
state variables can be converted into each other 10.4.11 Processes in Lakes
using and Reservoirs

Ac 103 NA kdec CR =86400 Mw; 10:58 The water quality modeling principles discussed
above are applicable to different types of water
whereAc = activity of the radionuclide (Bq/m3/s) systems such as streams, rivers, lakes, estuaries,
NA = Avogadros number (6.02 1023 mol) and even coastal or ocean waters. This section
Mw = molecular weight of the radionuclide presents some of the unique aspects of water
(g/mole) quality modeling in lakes. The physical character
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 447

and water quality of rivers draining into lakes aquatic organisms and damage irrigated crops.
and reservoirs are governed in part by the Inadequate water purication resulting in the
velocity and the volume of river water. The discharge of bacteria, viruses, and other organ-
characteristics of the river water typically isms into natural waters can be a primary cause
undergo signicant changes as the water enters of waterborne disease. Although dangerous to
the lake or reservoir, primarily because its human health worldwide, such problems are
velocity reduces. Portions of the sediment and particularly severe in developing countries.
other material carried in the faster flowing water There can be major differences between deep
settle out in the basin. and shallow lakes or reservoirs. Deep lakes,
The structure of the biological communities particularly in nontropical regions, usually have
also changes from organisms suited to living in poorer water quality in lower layers, due to
flowing waters to those that thrive in standing or stratication (see Sect. 4.11.3). Shallow lakes do
pooled waters. Greater opportunities for the not exhibit this depth differentiation in quality.
growth of algae (phytoplankton) and the devel- Their more shallow, shoreline areas have rela-
opment of eutrophication are present. tively poorer water quality because those sites are
Reservoirs typically receive larger inputs of where pollutants are discharged and have a
water, as well as soil and other materials carried greater potential for disturbance of bottom muds,
in rivers than lakes. As a result, reservoirs may etc. The water quality of a natural lake usually
receive larger pollutant loads than lakes. How- improves as one moves from the shoreline to the
ever, because of greater water inflows flushing deeper central part.
rates are more rapid than in lakes. Thus, although In contrast, the deepest end of a reservoir is
reservoirs may receive greater pollutant loads usually immediately upstream of the dam. Water
than lakes, they have the potential to flush out the quality usually improves along the length of a
pollutants more rapidly than do lakes. Reservoirs reservoir, from the shallow inflow end to the
may therefore exhibit fewer or less severe neg- deeper, lake-like end near the dam, as shown in
ative water quality or biological impacts than Fig. 10.16.
lakes for the same pollutant load. Reservoirs, particularly the deeper ones, are
The water quality of lakes and reservoirs is also distinguished from lakes by the presence of
dened by a longitudinal gradient in physical, chemical, and
biological water quality characteristics from the
water clarity or transparency (greater water upstream river end to the downstream dam end.
clarity usually indicates better water quality), Because of this, reservoirs have been character-
concentration of nutrients (lower concentra- ized as comprising three major zones: an
tions indicate better water quality), upstream riverine zone, a downstream lake-like
quantity of algae (lower levels indicate better zone at the dam end, and a transitional zone
water quality), separating these two zones (Fig. 10.16). The
oxygen concentration (higher concentrations relative size and volume of the three zones can
are preferred for sheries), vary greatly in a given reservoir.
concentration of dissolved minerals (lower
values indicate better water quality), and 10.4.11.1 Water Quality Changes
acidity (a neutral pH of 7 is preferred). and Impacts
Dams can produce changes in the downstream
Many lakes and reservoirs receive discharges river channels below them. These are quite unlike
of waste chemical compounds from industry, downstream changes from lakes. Because reser-
some with toxic or deleterious effects on humans voirs act as sediment and nutrient traps, the water at
and/or other water-dependent organisms and the downstream dam end of a reservoir is typically
products. Some of these pollutants can kill of higher quality than water entering the reservoir.
448 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

Fig. 10.16 Longitudinal zonation of water quality and other variables in reservoirs

This higher quality water subsequently flows into Many reservoirs, especially those used for
the downstream river channel below the dam. This drinking water supplies, have water release or
is sometimes a problem in that the smaller the discharge structures located at different vertical
quantity of sediments and other materials trans- levels in their dams (Fig. 10.17). This allows for
ported in the discharged water, the greater the the withdrawal or discharge of water from dif-
quantity that can be picked up and transported as it ferent layers within the reservoir, so-called se-
moves downstream. Because it contains less sedi- lective withdrawal. Depending on the quality of
ment, the discharged hungry water can scour the water discharged, selective withdrawal can
and erode the streambed and banks, picking up signicantly affect water quality within the
new sediment as it continues downstream. This reservoir itself, as well as the chemical compo-
scouring effect can negatively impact the flora, sition and temperature of the downstream river.
fauna, and biological community structure in the Being able to regulate both quantities and qual-
downstream river channel. The removal of sedi- ities of the downstream hydrological regimes can
ments from a river by reservoirs also has important impact both flora and fauna and possibly even
biological effects, particularly on floodplains. the geomorphology of the stream or river.
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 449

Fig. 10.17 A multiple


outlet reservoir can be
better used to regulate the
temperature and water
quality downstream and
possibly the sediment in the
reservoir

Constructing a reservoir may have signicant oxygen and noxious aquatic plants impact lakes
social and economic implications, including the and reservoirs. Often, several pollutants and
potential for stimulating urban and agricultural processes impact a single lake. For example, a
development adjacent to, and below, the reser- process such as removal of shoreline vegetation
voir. These activities can have both positive and may accelerate erosion of sediment and nutrients
negative impacts on downstream water quality, into a lake. Extreme acidity (low pH) resulting
depending on the nature and size of development. from acid rain can eliminate sh in isolated lakes.
Agricultural and urban runoff is often the Urban runoff and storm sewers, municipal sew-
leading source of pollution in lakes. Healthy lake age treatment plants, and hydrologic modica-
ecosystems contain nutrients in small quantities tions are also sources of lake pollutants.
from natural sources, but extra inputs of nutrients
(primarily nitrogen and phosphorus) adversely 10.4.11.2 Lake Quality Models
impact lake ecosystems. When temperature and The prediction of water quality in surface water
light conditions are favorable, excessive nutrients impoundments is based on mass balance relation-
stimulate population explosions of undesirable ships similar to those used to predict water quality
algae and aquatic weeds. After they die the algae concentrations in streams and estuaries. There are
sink to the lake bottom, where bacteria consume also signicant problems in predicting the water
DO as they decompose the algae. Fish kills and quality of lakes or reservoirs compared to those of
foul odors may result if dissolved is depleted. river and estuarine systems. One is the increased
Heavy metals are another major cause of lake importance of wind-induced mixing processes and
quality impairment. Heavy metals accumulate in thermal stratication. Another for reservoirs is the
sh tissue. Since it is difcult to measure heavy impact of various reservoir-operating policies.
metals (e.g., mercury) in ambient water and since Perhaps the simplest way to begin modeling
they accumulate in sh tissue, sh samples are lakes is to consider shallow well-mixed
commonly used to monitor heavy metal con- constant-volume lakes subject to a constant pol-
tamination. Common sources of heavy metals are lutant loading. The flux of any constituent con-
smoke-stack industries, including power centration, C, in the lake equals the mass input of
plants, whose airborne discharges of mercury the constituent less the mass output less losses
eventually end up in our water supplies. due to decay or sedimentation, if any, all divided
In addition to nutrients and metals siltation, by the lake volume V (m3). Given a constant
enrichment by organic wastes that deplete constituent input rate WC (g/day) of a constituent
450 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

having a net decay and sedimentation rate con- (1 ) of the initial concentration C(0) (i.e.,
stant kC (1/day) into a lake having a volume C(t)/Ce = 1 ). The result is Eq. 10.62.
V (m3) and inflow and outflow rate of Equation 10.60 can be used to form an opti-
Q (m3/day), then the rate of change in the con- mization model for determining the wasteload
centration C (g/m3/day) is inputs to this well-mixed lake that meet water
quality standards. Assuming that the total of all
dC=dt 1=VWC  QC  kC CV 10:59 natural wasteloads WC(t), inflows and outflows
Q(t), and the maximum allowable constituent
Integrating this equation yields a predictive concentrations in the lake, C(t)max, may vary
expression of the concentration C(t) of the con- among different within-year periods t, the mini-
stituent at the end of any time period t based in mum fraction, X, of total waste removal required
part on what the concentration, C(t 1), was at can be found by solving the following linear
the end of that previous time period, t 1. For a optimization model:
period duration of t days,
Minimize X 10:65
Ct WC =Q kC V 1  expfDtQ=V kC g
Ct  1expfDtQ=V kC g The following mass balance and constituent
concentration constraints apply for each period t :
10:60
Ct WC t1  X=Qt kC V 
The equilibrium concentration, Ce, can be 1  expfDtQt=V kC g
obtained by setting the rate, dC/dt, in Eq. 10.59
Ct  1expfDtQt=V kC g
to 0. The net result is
10:66
Ce WC =Q kC V 10:61
Ct  Ctmax 10:67
The time, t, since the introduction of a mass
input WC that is required to reach a given fraction If each period t is a within-year period, and if
of the equilibrium concentration (i.e., the waste loadings and flows in each year are the
C(t)/Ce = ) is same, then no initial concentrations need be
assumed and a steady-state solution can be found.
ta Vln1  a=Q KC V 10:62 This solution will indicate, for the loadings WC(t),
the fraction X of waste removal that meet the
Similar equations can be developed to esti- quality standards, C(t)max, throughout the year.
mate the concentrations and times associated
with a decrease in a pollutant concentration. For 10.4.11.3 Stratified Impoundments
the perfectly mixed lake having an initial con- Many deep reservoirs and lakes become stratied
stituent concentration C(0), say after an acci- during particular times of the year. Vertical
dental spill, and no further additions, the change temperature gradients arise that imply vertical
in concentration with respect to time is density gradients. The depth-dependent density
gradients effectively prevent complete vertical
dC=dt CQ kC V =V 10:63
mixing. Particularly in the summer season, two
zones may form, an upper volume of warm water
Integrating this equation, the concentration C
called the epilimnion and a lower colder volume
(t) is
called the hypolimnion. The transition zone or
Ct C0expftQ=V KC 10:64 boundary between the two zones is called the
thermocline (Fig. 10.17).
In this case one can solve for the time t Because of stratication many models divide
required for the constituent to reach a fraction the depth of water into layers, each of which is
10.4 Models of Water Quality Processes 451

assumed to be fully mixed. To illustrate this mass inflow, WC(t), and outflow, Ce(t)Qout(t), the
approach without getting into too much detail, net vertical transfer across the thermocline, (v/DT)
consider a simple two-layer lake in the summer [Ch(t)Vh(t) Ce(t)Ve(t)], the settling on sediment
that becomes a one-layer lake in the winter. This interface, sHh(t) Ch(t), and the decay, kCe(t):
is illustrated in Fig. 10.18.
Discharges of a mass WC of constituent C in a dCe t=dt 1=Ve tfWC t  Ce tQout t
flow Qin(t) into the lake in period t have con- v=DT Ch tVh t  Ce tVe tg
centrations of WC/Qin(t). The concentration in the  kCe t
outflows from the summer epilimnion is Ce(t) for
10:68
each period t in the summer season. The con-
centration of the outflows from the winter lake as dCh t=dt kCh t
a whole is C(t) for each period t in the winter  v=DT Ch t  Ce tVe t=Vh t
season. The summer time rates of change in the  sHh tCh t
epilimnion constituent concentrations Ce(t) and
10:69
hypolimnion concentrations Ch(t) depend on the

Fig. 10.18 Lake stratication during summer and complete mixing during winter season
452 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

In the above two equations, Ve and Vh (m3) are of plug flow and continuously stirred reactor
the time-dependent volumes of the epilimnion approaches to pollutant transport. Users must
and hypolimnion, respectively, k (1/day) is the divide streams, rivers, and lakes and reservoirs
temperature corrected decay rate constant, into a series of well-mixed segments or volume
v (m/day) is the net vertical exchange velocity elements. A hydrologic or hydrodynamic model
that includes effects of vertical dispersion, ero- calculates the flow of water between all the seg-
sion of hypolimnion, and other processes that ments and volume elements. In each simulation
transfer materials across the thermocline of time step plug flow enters these segments or vol-
thickness DT (m), s is the settling rate velocity ume elements from upstream segments or ele-
(m/day) and Hh(t) is the average depth of the ments. Flow also exits these segments or volume
hypolimnion (m). elements to downstream segments or elements.
In the winter season the lake is assumed to be During this time the constituents can decay or
fully mixed. Thus for all periods t in the winter grow, as appropriate, depending the conditions in
season the initial concentration of a constituent is those segments or volume elements. At the end of
each time step the volumes and their constituents
Ct Ce tVe t Ch tVh t=Ve Vh  within each segment or element are fully mixed.
The length of each segment or the volume in each
10:70
element reflects the extent of dispersion in the
system.
dCt=dt 1=VtfWC t  CtQout t
 decay kCe t  sHtCt
10.5.1 Numerical Accuracy
10:71

At the beginning of the summer season, each As presented in Sect. 10.4, equations describing
epilimnion and hypolimnion concentration will water quality processes typically include time
be the same. rate of change terms such as dC/dt. While it is
possible to solve analytically some of these dif-
Ce t Ct 10:72 ferential equations, most water quality simulation
models use numerical methods. The purpose of
this section is not to explain how this can be
Ch t Ct 10:73 done, but rather to point to some of the restric-
tions placed on the modeler because of these
numerical methods.
10.5 Simulation Methods Consider rst the relationship between the
stream, river, or lake segments and the duration
Most who will be using water quality models will of time steps, t. The basic rst-order decay flux,
be using simulation models that are commonly dC/dt (g/m3/day), for a constituent concentration,
available from governmental agencies (e.g., US C, that is dependent on a rate constant, k (1/day),
EPA), universities, or private consulting and is
research institutions such as the Danish Hydrau-
lics Institute, Wallilngford software or Deltares dC=dt kC 10:74
(Ambrose et al. 1996; Brown and Barnwell 1987;
The nite difference approximation of this
Cerco and Cole 1995; DeMarchi et al. 1999;
equation can be written
Ivanov et al. 1996; Reichert 1994; USEPA 2001;
WL|Delft Hydraulics 2003).
Ct Dt  Ct CtkDt 10:75
These simulation models are typically based on
numerical methods incorporating a combination or
10.5 Simulation Methods 453

Ct Dt Ct1  kDt 10:76 error is cumulative. Whenever t > n/k the pre-
dicted concentrations will alternate between
This equation can be used to illustrate the positive and negative values, either diverging,
restriction placed on the term kt. That term converging or just repeating the cycle, depending
cannot exceed a value of 1 or else C(t + t) will on how much t exceeds n/k. In any event, the
be negative. predicted concentrations are not very useful.
Figure 10.19 is a plot of various values of Letting m = n/kt, Eq. 10.78 can be written
C(t + t)/C(t) versus kt. This plot is compared as
with the analytical solution resulting from the
integration of Eq. 10.110, namely Ct Dt Ct1 1=mmkDt 10:80

Ct Dt CtexpfkDtg 10:77 As n approaches innity so does the variable


m, and hence the expression (1 + 1/m)m becomes
Reducing the value of t will increase the the natural logarithm base e = 2.718282. Thus as
accuracy of the numerical solution. Any value of n approaches innity, Eq. 10.80 becomes
t can be divided by a positive integer n to Eq. 10.77, the exact solution to Eq. 10.74.
become 1/nth of its original value. In this case
the predicted concentration C(t + t) will equal
10.5.2 Traditional Approach
Ct Dt Ct1  kDt=nn 10:78
Most water quality simulation models simulate
For example if kt = 1, and n = 2, the nal quality over a period of time. Time is divided
concentration ratio will equal into discrete intervals and the water and
wastewater flows are assumed constant within
Ct Dt=Ct 1  1=22 0:25 10:79 each of those time period intervals. Each water
body is divided into segments or volume ele-
Compare this 0.250.37, the exact solution, ments and these computational cells are con-
and to 0.0, the approximate solution when n is 1. sidered to be in steady-state conditions within
Having n = 2 brings a big improvement. If each simulation time period. Advection or plug
n = 3, the concentration ratio will be 0.30, an flow (i.e., no mixing or dispersion) is assumed
even greater improvement compared to 0. How- during each time period. At the end of each
ever no matter what value of n is selected, the period mixing occurs within each segment or
predicted concentration will always less than the volume element to obtain the concentrations in
actual value based on Eq. 10.77, and hence the the segment or volume element at the beginning

Fig. 10.19 Plot of


numerical approximation
(red line) based on
Eq. 10.77 compared to the
true analytical (blue line)
value obtained from
Eq. 10.76
454 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

of the next time step. The larger the computa- of constituents, plus some of the immediately
tional cell the greater is the dispersion. upstream segments water and its end-of-period
This method is illustrated in Fig. 10.20. The concentrations of constituents. These two vol-
indices i 1, i and i + 1 refer to stream or river umes of water and their respective constituent
reach segments. The indices t and t + 1 refer to concentrations are then mixed to achieve a con-
two successive time periods, respectively. At the stant concentration within the entire segment.
beginning of time period t, each segment is This is done for all segments in each time
completely mixed. During the time interval t of step. Included in this plug flow and then mixing
period t the water quality model predicts the process are the inputs to the reach from point and
concentrations assuming plug flow in the direc- non-point sources of constituents.
tion of flow from segment i toward segment In Fig. 10.20, a mass of waste enters reach i at
i + 1. The time interval t is such that the flow a rate of Wit . The volume in each reach segment
from any segment i does not pass through any is denoted by V and the flows from one segment
following segment i + 1. Hence at the end of to the next are denoted by Q. The drawing shown
each time period, each segment has some of its on the left represents a portion of a stream or
original water that was there at the beginning of river divided into well-mixed segments. During a
the period, and its end-of-period concentrations period t waste constituents enter reach segment

Fig. 10.20 Water quality modeling approach showing a water system schematized into reach segments or
computational cells
10.5 Simulation Methods 455

i from the immediate upstream reach i 1 and computational times. Thus, the balance between
from the point waste source. In this illustration, computational speed and numerical accuracy
the mass of each of these wastes is assumed to restricts the model efciency in the traditional
decay during each time period, independent of approach to simulating water quality.
other wastes in the water. Depending on the
types of wastes, the decay, or even growth,
10.5.3 Backtracking Approach
processes that take place may be more complex
than those assumed in this illustration. At the end
An alternative backtracking approach to water
of each time period, these altered wastes are
quality simulation eliminates the need to consider
mixed together to create an average concentra-
the simulation time step duration restriction
tion for the entire reach segment. This illustration
indicated by Eq. 10.82 (Manson and Wallis
applies for each reach segment i and for each
2000; Yin 2002). The backtracking approach
time period t.
permits any simulation time step duration to be
The length, xi, of each completely mixed
used along with any segmenting scheme. Unlike
segment or volume element depends on the
the traditional approach, water can travel through
extent of dispersion. Reducing the length of each
any number of successive segments or volume
reach segment or size of each volume element
elements in each simulation time step.
reduces the dispersion within the entire stream or
This approach differs from the traditional one
river. Reducing segment lengths, together with
in that instead of following the water in a seg-
increasing flow velocities, also reduces the
ment or volume element downstream, the system
allowable duration of each time period t. The
tracks back upstream to nd the source concen-
duration of each simulation time step t must be
trations of the contaminants at time t that will be
such that flow from any segment or element
in the control volume or segment i + 1 at the
enters only the adjacent downstream segment or
beginning of time period t + 1.
element during that time step. Stated formally,
The backtracking process works from
the restriction is
upstream to downstream. It starts from the seg-
Dt  Ti 10:81 ment of interest, i, and nds all the upstream
sources of contaminants that flow into segment
where Ti is the residence time in reach segment i during time period t having a time interval t.
or volume element i. For a 1-dimensional stream The contaminants could come from segments in
or river system consisting of a series of segments the same river reach or storage site, or from
i of length xi, cross-section area Ai and average upstream river reach or storage volume segments.
flow Qit, the restriction is They could also come from incremental flows into
upstream segments. Flows between the source site
Dt  minfDxi Ai =Qit ; 8i; tg 10:82 and the segment i + 1 transport the contaminants
from their source sites to segment i during the time
If time steps are chosen which violate this interval t, as shown in Fig. 10.21.
condition, then numerical solutions will be in The simulation process for each segment and
error. The restriction dened by Eq. 10.82 is for each time period involves three steps. To
often termed the courant condition. It limits the compute the concentration of each constituent in
maximum time step value. Since the flows being segment i at the end of time period t, as shown in
simulated are not always known, this leads to the Fig. 10.21, the approach rst backtracks
selection of very small time steps, especially in upstream to locate all the contaminant particles at
water bodies having very little dispersion. While the beginning of period t that will be in the
smaller simulation time steps increase the accu- segment i at the end of period t. This is achieved
racy of the model they also increase the by nding the most upstream and downstream
456 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

Fig. 10.21 The backtracking approach for computing the concentrations of constituents in each reach segment or
volume element i during time step duration of t

positions of all reach intervals that will be at the done for each segment i in each time period t,
corresponding boundaries of segment i at the end proceeding in the downstream direction.
of time period t. This requires computing the If no dispersion is assumed, the backtracking
velocities through each of the intermediate seg- process can be simplied to consider only the
ments or volume elements. Second, the changes end points of each reach. Backtracking can take
in the amounts of the modeled quality con- place to each end-of-reach location whose time
stituents, e.g., temperature, organics, nutrients of travel to the point of interest is just equal or
and toxics, are calculated assuming plug flow greater than t. Then using interpolation between
during the time interval, t, using the appropriate end-of-period constituent concentrations at those
differential equations and numerical methods for upstream sites, plus all loadings between those
solving them. Finally, all the multiple incoming sites and the downstream site of interest, the
blocks of water with their end-of-period con- constituent concentrations at the end of the time
stituent concentrations are completely mixed in period t at the downstream ends of each reach
the segment i to obtain initial concentrations in can be computed. This process, like the one
that segment for the next time step, t + 1. This is involving fully mixed reach segments, must take
10.5 Simulation Methods 457

into account the possibility of multiple paths from incomplete knowledge or lack of sufcient
from each pollutant source to the site of interest, data needed to estimate the probabilities of var-
and the different values of rate constants, tem- ious events that might happen. Sometimes it is
peratures, and other water quality parameters in difcult to even identify possible future events.
each reach along those paths. This type of uncertainty [sometimes called epis-
Figure 10.21 illustrates an example of back- temic (Stewart 2000)] stems from our incomplete
tracking involving simple rst-order decay pro- conceptual understanding of the systems under
cesses. Assume contaminants that end up in reach study, by models that are necessarily simplied
segment i at time the beginning of period t + 1 representations of the complexity of the natural
come from J sources with initial concentrations and socioeconomic systems, as well as by limited
Ct1 ; Ct2 ; Ct3 ; . . .; CtJ at the beginning of time period data for testing hypotheses and/or simulating the
t. Decay of mass from each source j during time systems.
t in each segment or volume element is deter- Limited conceptual understanding leads to
mined by the following differential equation: parameter uncertainty. For example, there is an
ongoing debate about the parameters that can
T20
dCjt =dt kj hj Cjt 10:83 best represent the fate and transfer of pollutants
through watersheds and water bodies. Arguably
The decay rate constant kj, temperature cor- more complete data and more work on model
rection coefcient j and water temperature T are development can reduce this uncertainty. Thus, a
all temporally and spatially varied variables. Their goal of water quality management should be to
values depend on the particular river reaches and increase the availability of data, improve their
storage volume sites through which water travels reliabilities, and advance our modeling
during the period t from sites j to segment i. capabilities.
Integrating Eq. 10.83 yields: However, even if it were possible to eliminate
knowledge uncertainty, complete model predic-
T20
Cjt 1 Cjt expfkj hj Dtg 10:84 tion certainty in support of water quality man-
agement decisions will likely never be achieved
Since t is the time it takes water having an until we can predict the variability of natural
initial concentration Cjt to travel to reach i, the processes. This is the other signicant source of
values Cjt 1 can be denoted as Cijt 1 . uncertainty in water quality management mod-
els. This type of uncertainty arises in systems
Tij20
Cijt 1 Cjt expfkij hj Dtg 10:85 characterized by randomness. Assuming past
observations are indicative of what might hap-
In Eq. 10.85 the values of the parameters are pen in the future and with the same frequency,
the appropriate ones for the stream or river i.e., assuming stationary stochastic processes, we
between the source segments j and the destina- can estimate from these past observations the
tion segment i. These concentrations times their possible future events or outcomes that could
respective volumes, Vjt , can then be mixed occur and their probabilities. Even if we think
together to dene the initial concentration, Cit 1 , we can estimate how likely any possible type of
in segment i at the beginning of the next time event may be in the future we cannot predict
period t + 1. precisely when or to what extent that event will
occur.
For ecosystems, we cannot be certain we
know even what events may occur in the future,
10.5.4 Model Uncertainty let alone their probabilities. Ecosystems are
open systems in which it is not possible to know
There are two signicant sources of uncertainty in advance what all the possible biological
in water quality management models. One stems outcomes will be. Surprises are not only
458 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

possible, but likely. Hence both types of An adaptive management process begins with
uncertainty, knowledge uncertainty, and unpre- initial actions that have reasonable chances of
dictable variability or randomness, cannot be succeeding. Future actions must be based on
eliminated. continued monitoring of the water body to
Thus, uncertainty is a reality of water quantity determine how it responds to the actions taken.
and quality management. This must be recog- Plans for future regulatory rules and public
nized when considering the results of water spending should be subject to revision as stake-
quality management models that relate actions holders learn more about how the system
taken to meet the desired water quality criteria responds to actions taken. Monitoring is an
and designated uses of water bodies. Chapters 6, essential aspect of adaptive water quality man-
7, and 8 suggests some ways of characterizing agement and modeling.
this uncertainty. Regardless of what immediate actions are
taken, there may not be an immediate measurable
response. For example there may be signicant
10.6 ConclusionsImplementing time lags between when actions are taken to
a Water Quality Management reduce nutrient loads and the resulting changes in
Policy nutrient concentrations. This is especially likely
if nutrients from past activities are bound to
This chapter provides only a brief introduction to sediments or if nutrient-contaminated ground-
some of the relationships contained in water water has a long residence time before its release
quality models. As can be said for other chapters to surface water. For many reasons, lags between
as well, entire texts, and very good ones, have actions taken and responses must be expected.
been written on this subject (see, for example, Water bodies should be monitored to establish
Chapra and Reckhow 1983; Chapra 1997; whether the trajectories of the measured water
McCutcheon 1989; Orlob 1983; Schnoor 1996; quality criteria point toward attainment of the
Thomann and Mueller 1987). Water quality designated use.
modeling and management require skill and data. Waste load allocations will inevitably be
Skill comes with experience. required if quality standards are not being met.
If accompanied by eld data and uncertainty These allocations involve costs. Different allo-
analysis, many existing models can be used to cations will have a different total costs and dif-
assist those responsible for developing water ferent distributions of those costs; hence they will
quality management plans in an adaptive have different perceived levels of fairness.
implementation or management framework. A minimum cost policy may result in a cost
Adaptive implementation or management will distribution that places most of the burden on just
allow for both model and data improvements some of the stakeholders. But until such a policy
over time. Adaptive approaches strive toward is identied one will not know this. An alterna-
achieving water quality standards while relying tive may be to reduce loads from all sources by
on monitoring and experimentation to reduce the same proportion. Such a policy has prevailed
uncertainty. This is often a way one can proceed in the US over the past several decades. Even
given the complexity of the real world compared though not very cost effective from the point of
to the predictive models and data and time view of water quality management, the ease of
usually available at the time a water quality administration and the fulllment of other
analysis is needed. Starting with simple analyses objectives must have made such a policy politi-
and iteratively expanding data collection and cally acceptable, even though expensive. How-
modeling as the need arises is a reasonable ever, more than these types of waste load
approach. allocations policies will be needed for many of
10.6 ConclusionsImplementing a Water Quality Management Policy 459

the ecosystem restoration efforts that are Chapra, S. C., & Reckhow, K. H. (1983). Engineering
increasingly being made. Restoration activities approaches for lake management (Vol. 2, Mechanistic
modeling). Ann Arbor, MI: Ann Arbor Press, Inc.
are motivated in part by a recognition of the DeMarchi, C., Ivanov, P., Jolma, A., Masliev, I., Smith,
services ecosystems provide for water quality M., & Somlydy, L. (1999). Innovative tools for water
management. quality management and policy analysis: DESERT
Our capabilities of including ecosystem and STREAMPLAN. Water Science and Technology,
40(10), 103110.
components within water quantity and quality Elmore, H. L., & Hayes, T. W. (1960). Solubility of
management models are at a fairly elementary atmospheric oxygen in water. Jouranl of Environmen-
level. Given the uncertainty, especially with tal Engineering Division ACSE, 86(SA4), 4153.
respect to the prediction of how ecosystems will Ivanov, P., Masliev, I., De Marchi, C., & Somlydy, L.
(1996). DESERTDecision support system for eval-
respond to water management actions, together uating river basin strategies, users manual. Laxen-
with the need to take actions now, the popular burg, Austria: International Institute for Applied
call is for adaptive management. The trial and Systems Analysis.
error aspects of adaptive management based on Karr, J. R. (1990). Bioassessment and non-point source
pollution: An overview (pp 4-1 to 4-18 in second
monitoring and imperfect models may not satisfy national symposium on water quality assessment).
those who seek more denitive direction from Washington, DC: EPA Ofce of Water.
water quality analysts and their predictive mod- Manson, J. R., & Wallis, S. G. (2000). A conservative
els. Stakeholders and responsible agencies seek- semi-lagrangian fate and transport model for fluvial
systemsI. Theoretical development. Water
ing assurances that the actions taken will always Resources, 34(15), 37693777.
work, as predicted, may be disappointed. Even McCutcheon, S. C. (1989). Water quality modeling (Vol.
the best predictive capabilities of science cannot 1). Boca Raton, FL: CRC Press.
National Research Council (NRC). (1992). Restoration of
assure that an action leading to attainment of
aquatic ecosystems. Washington, D.C.: National
designated uses will be initially identied. Academy Press.
Adaptive management is a reasonable option in National Research Council (NRC). (2001). Assessing the
most cases for allowing water quality manage- TMDL approach to water quality management com-
mittee to assess the scientic basis of the total
ment programs to move forward in the face of
maximum daily load approach to water pollution
considerable uncertainties. reduction (122 p). Washington, D.C.: Water Science
and Technology Board, National Academy Press.
Orlob, G. T. (Ed.). (1983). Mathematical modeling of
References water quality: Streams, lakes and reservoirs. Chich-
ester, UK: Wiley.
Reichert, P. (1994). AQUASIMA tool for simulation
Ambrose, R. B., Barnwell, T. O., McCutcheon, S. C., & and data analysis of aquatic systems. Water Science
Williams, J. R., (1996). Computer models for water and Techonolgy, 30(2), 2130.
quality analysis. In L. W. Mays (Ed.), Water resources Schnoor, J. L. (1996). Environmental modeling, fate and
handbook. New York: McGraw-Hill. transport of pollutants in water, air and soil. New
Borsuk, M. E., Stow, C. A., Higdon, D., & Reckhow, K. York: Wiley.
H. (2001). A Bayesian hierarchical model to predict Stewart, T. R. (2000). Uncertainty, judgment, and error in
benthic oxygen demand from organic matter loading prediction. In D. Sarewitz, R. A. Pielke Jr., & R. Byerly Jr.
in estuaries and coastal zones. Ecological modeling. (Eds.), Prediction: Science, decision making, and the
Durham, NC: Duke University. future of nature. Washington, D.C.: Island Press.
Brown, L. C., & Barnwell, T. O., Jr., (1987). The Streeter, H. W., & Phelps, E. B. (1925). A Study of the
enhanced stream water quality models QUAL2E and Pollution and Natural Purication of the Ohio River,
QUAL2E-UNCAS: Documentation and user manual. III. Factors concerned in the phenomena of oxidation
EPA-600/3-87/007. Athens, GA: EPA Environmental and reaeration. Washington, D.C.: U.S. Public Health
Research Laboratory. Service.
Cerco, C. F., & Cole, T. (1995). Users guide to the Thomann, R. V., & Mueller, J. A. (1987). Principles of
CE-QUAL-ICM three-dimensional eutrophication surface water quality modeling and control. New
model, release version 1.0. Technical Report York: Harper & Row Publishers.
EL-95-15, US Army Eng. Waterways Experiment USEPA. (2001). BASINS version 3.0 users manual.
Station, Vicksburg, MS. EPA-823-B-01-001 (337 p.). Washington, DC: EPA
Chapra, S. C. (1997). Surface water-quality modeling Ofce of Water and Ofce of Science and Technology.
(p. 844). New York: McGraw-Hill.
460 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

WL|Delft Hydraulics. (2003). Delft3D-WAQ, user man- Engelund, F., & Hansen, E. (1967). A monograph on
ual; Versatile water quality modeling in 1D, 2D, or sediment transport in alluvial streams. Copenhagen,
3D systems including physical, (bio)chemical and DK: Teknisk forlag.
biological processes. Fagerbakke, K. M., Heldal, M., & Norland, S. (1996).
Yin, H. (2002). Development of a watershed information Content of carbon, nitrogen, oxygen, sulfur and
system, ms thesis. Ithaca, NY: Civil and Environmen- phosphorus in native aquatic and cultured bacteria.
tal Engineering, Cornell University. Aquatic Microbial Ecology, 10, 1527.
Gromiec, M. J., Loucks, D. P., & Orlob, G. T. (1982).
Stream quality modeling. In G. T. Orlob (Ed.),
Mathematical modeling of water quality. Chichester,
UK: Wiley.
Additional References Hornberger, G. M., & Spear, R. C. (1981). An approach
(Further Reading) to the preliminary analysis of environmental systems.
Journal of Environmental Management, 12, 718.
Hornberger, G. M., & Spear, R. C. (1983). An approach
ASCE. (1999). National stormwater best management to the analysis of behavior and sensitivity in environ-
practices (bmp) data-base. Version 1.0. Prepared by mental systems. In M. B. Beck & G. van Straten
Urban Water Resources Research Council of ASCE, (Eds.), Uncertainty and forecasting of water quality
and Wright Water Engineers, Inc., Urban Drainage (pp. 101116). Berlin: Springer.
and Flood Control District, and URS Greiner Wood- Karr, J. R. (2000). Health, integrity, and biological
ward Clyde, in cooperation with EPA Ofce of Water, assessment: The importance of whole things. In D.
Washington, DC. Users Guide and CD. Pimentel, L. Westra, & R. F. Noss, (Eds.), Ecological
Beck, M. B. (1987). Water quality modeling: A review of integrity: integrating environment, conservation, and
the analysis of uncertainty. Water Resources health (pp. 209226, 214215). Washington, DC:
Research, 23, 13931442. Island Press.
Beck, M. B., & van Straten, G. (Eds.). (1983). Uncertainty Karr, J. R., & Dudley, D. R. (1981). Ecological perspec-
and forecasting of water quality. Berlin: Springer. tive on water quality goals. Environmental Manage-
Biswas, A. K. (Ed.). (1997). Water resources: Environ- ment, 5, 5568.
mental planning, management, and development. New Karr, J. R., & Chu, E. W. (2000). Sustaining living rivers.
York: The McGraw-Hill Companies Inc. Hydrobiologia, 422(423), 114.
Bowie, G. L., Mills, W. B., Porcella, D. B., Campbell, C. Krone, R. B. (1962). Flume studies of the transport of
L., Pagenkopf, J. R., Rupp, G. L., et al. (1985). Rates, sediment in estuarial shoaling processes. Berkeley:
constants, and kinetics formulations in surface water University of California, Hydraulic and Sanitary
quality modeling (2nd edn). Athens, GA: Report Engineering Laboratory.
EPA/600/3-85/040, US EPA. Langbien, W. B., & Durum, W. H. (1967). The aeration
Churchill, M. A., Elmore, H. L., & Buckingham, R. A. capacity of streams (p. 542). Washington, D.C.:
(1962). Prediction of stream reaeration rates. Journal USGS.
of the Sanitary Engineering Division ASCE SA4.1, Los, F. J. (1991). Mathematical Simulation of algae
Proc. Paper 3199. blooms by the model BLOOM II, Version 2, T68. WL|
Delvigne, G. A. L. (1980). Natural reaeration of surface Delft Hydraulics Report.
water. WL|Delft Hydraulics, Report on literature study Los, F. J. et al. (1992). Process formulations DBS. WL|
R1149 (in Dutch), Delft, NL. Delft Hydraulics, Model documentation T542 (in
DiToro, D. M., Paquin, P. R., Subburamu, K., & Gruber, Dutch), Delft, NL.
D. A. (1990). Sediment oxygen demand model: Maidment, D. R. (Ed.). (1993). Handbook of hydrology.
Methane and ammonia oxidation. Journal of Environ- New York: McGraw-Hill.
mental Engineering, ACSE 116(5), 945986. Masliev, I., Somlydy, L., & Koncsos, L. (1995). On
Dobbins, W. E. (1964). BOD and oxygen relationships in reconciliation of traditional water quality models and
streams. Journal of the Sanitary Engineering Division, activated sludge models. Working Paper WP 9518,
90(SA3), 5378. International Institute for Applied Systems Analysis,
EU. (2001a). The EU water framework directive. http:// Laxenburg, Austria.
europa.eu.int/water/water-framework/index_en.html. Mills, W. B., Porcella, D. B., Ungs, M. J., Gherini, S. A.,
Accessed 21 June 2001. Summers, K. V., Mok, L., et al. (1985). Water quality
EU. (2001b). Water protection and management, frame- assessment: A screening procedure for toxic and
work directive in the eld of water policy. http://www. conventional pollutants in surface and ground water,
europa.eu.int/scadplus/leg/en/lvb/l28002b.htm. Parts I and II. EPA/600/6-85/002a,b.
Accessed 20 June 2001. Monbaliu, J., Hargreaves, J. C., Carretero, J.-C., Gerrit-
EU. (2001c). Water protection and management, urban waste sen, H., & Flather, R. A. (1999). Wave modelling in
water treatment. http://www.europa.eu.-int/scadplus/leg/ the PROMISE project. Coastal Engineering, 37(34),
en/lvb/l28008.htm. Accessed 20 June 2001. 379407.
References 461

Morgan, M. G., & Henrion, M. (1990). Uncertainty hydrology (D. R. Maidment Ed.). New York:
(p. 332). New York: Cambridge University Press. McGraw-Hill, Inc.
National Academy of Public Administration. (2000). Smith, R. A., Schwarz, G. E., & Alexander, R. B.
Transforming environmental protection for the 21st (1997). Regional interpretation of water-quality
century. Washington, D.C.: National Academy of monitoring data. Water Resources Research, 33(12),
Public Administration. 27812798.
Novotny, V. (1999). Integrating diffuse/nonpoint pollu- Smits, J. (2001). DELWAQ-BLOOM-switch. Delft, NL:
tion control and water body restoration into watershed Delft Hydraulics.
management. Journal AWRA, 35(4), 717727. Somlydy, L. (1982). Water quality modeling: A com-
Novotny, V., & Olem, H. (1994). Water quality: Preven- parison of transport-oriented and ecology-oriented
tion, identication and management of diffuse pollu- approaches. Ecological Modelling, 17, 183207.
tion. New York: Van Nostrand-Reinhold (distributed Somlydy, L., & van Straten, G. (Eds.). (1986). Modeling
by Wiley, Ohio EPA). and managing shallow lake eutrophication, with
OConnor, D. J. (1961). Oxygen balance of an estuary. application to lake balaton. Berlin: Springer.
Journal of Sanitary Engineering Division ASCE, 86 Somlydy, L., & Varis, O. (1993). Modeling the quality
(SA3), 3555. of rivers and lakes. In P. Zannetti (Ed.), Environmen-
OConnor, D. J., & Dobbins, W. E. (1958). Mechanism of tal modeling: Computer methods and software for
reaeration in natural streams. Transactio of ASCE, environmental modeling: Computer methods and
123, 641666. software for simulating environmental pollution and
Owens, M., Edwards, R. W., & Gibbs, J. W. (1964). its adverse effects (Vol. 1, pp. 213257). Southamp-
Some reaeration studies in streams. International ton, UK: CMP.
Journal of Air and Water Pollution, 8, 469486. Somlydy, L., Henze, M., Koncsos, L., Rauch, W.,
Partheniades, E. (1962). A study of erosion and deposition Reichert, P., Shanahan, P., et al. (1998). River water
of cohesive soils in salt water. Berkeley: University of quality modeling: III. Future of the art. Water Science
California. and Technology, 38(11), 253260.
Peters, R. H. (1991). A critique for ecology (p. 366). Spanou, M., & Chen, D. (2001). Water-quality modeling
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. of the upper Mersey River system using an
Reichert, P. (1995). Design techniques of a computer object-oriented framework. Journal of Hydroinfor-
program for the identication of processes and the matics, 3(3), 173194.
simulation of water quality in aquatic systems. Envi- Spear, R., & Hornberger, G. M. (1980). Eutrophication in
ronmental Software, 10(3), 199210. peel inletII. Identication of critical uncertainties
Reichert, P. (2001). River water quality model no. via generalized sensitivity analysis. Water Research,
1 (RWQM1): Case study II. Oxygen and nitrogen 14, 4349.
conversion processes in the River Glatt (Switzerland). Stumm, W., & Morgan, J. J. (1981). Aquatic chemistry.
Water Science and Technology, 43(5), 5160. New York: Wiley.
Reichert, P., Borchardt, D., Henze, M., Rauch, W., Thomas, H. A., Jr. (1948). Pollution load capacity of
Shanahan, P., Somlydy, L., et al. (2001a). River streams. Water Sewage Works, 95, 409.
water quality model no. 1 (RWQM1): II. Biochemical Toxopeus A. G. (1996). An interactive spatial and
process equations. Water Science and Technology, 43 temporal modeling system as a tool in ecosystem
(5), 1130. management. International Institute for Aerospace
Reichert, P., & Vanrolleghem, P. (2001). Identiability Survey and Earth Sciences. ITC.
and uncertainty analysis of the River Water Quality Ulanowicz, R. E. (1997). Ecology, the ascendant
Model No. 1 (RWQM1). Water Science and Technol- perspective (p. 201). New York: Columbia University
ogy 43(7), 329338. Press.
Roesner, L. A., Giguere, P. R., & Evenson, D. E. (1981). USEPA. (1993). The watershed protection approach. The
Computer program documentation for the stream Annual Report 1992. EPA 840-S-93-001. Washing-
quality model QUALII. Report EPA 600/981014, ton, D.C.: EPA Ofce of Water.
US EPA, Athens, GA. USEPA. (1994). Water quality standards handbook:
Shanahan, P., Borchardt, D., Henze, M., Rauch, W., Second edition. EPA 823-B-94-005a. Washington,
Reichert, P., Somlydy, L., et al. (2001). River water D.C.: EPA Ofce of Water.
quality model no. 1 (RWQM1): I Modeling approach. USEPA. (1995a). Environmental indicators of water
Water Science and Technology, 43(5), 19. quality in the United States. EPA 841-R-96-002.
Shanahan, P., Henze, M., Koncsos, L., Rauch, W., Washington, D.C.: Ofce of Policy, Planning, and
Reichert, P., Somlydy, L., et al. (1998). River water Evaluation.
quality modeling: II. Problems of the art. Water USEPA. (1995b). A conceptual framework to support
Science and Technology, 38(11), 245252. development and use of environmental information
Shen, H. W., & Julien, P. Y. (1993). Erosion and in decision-making. EPA 239-R-95-012. Washington,
sediment transport, chapter 12 of handbook of D.C.: Ofce of Policy, Planning, and Evaluation.
462 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

USEPA. (1995c). Ecological restoration: A tool to 10:2 Based on the integrated differential equa-
manage stream quality. Report EPA 841F95 tions in Exercise 10.1
007. Washington, D.C.: US EPA.
USEPA. (1998). Lake and reservoir bioassessment and (a) Derive the equation for the distance Xc
biocriteria: Technical guidance document. EPA
downstream from a single point
841-B-98-007. Washington, D.C.: EPA Ofce of Water.
USEPA. (1999). Draft guidance for water quality-based source of BOD that for a given
decisions: The TMDL process (2nd ed.). Washington, streamflow will have the lowest dis-
D.C.: EPA Ofce of Water. solved oxygen concentration.
USEPA. (2000). Stressor identication guidance document.
(b) Determine the relative sensitivity of
EPA-822-B-00-025. Washington, D.C.: EPA Ofce of
Water and Ofce of Research and Development. the deoxygenation rate constant Kd and
van der Molen, D. T., Los, F. J., van Ballegooijen, L., van the reaeration rate constant Ka on the
der Vat, M. P. (1994). Mathematical modelling as a critical distance Xc and on the corre-
tool for management in eutrophication control of
sponding critical decit Dc. For initial
shallow lakes. Hydrobiologia, 275/276, 479492.
Van Pagee, J. A. (1978). Natural reaeration of surface conditions, assume that the reach has a
water by the wind. WL|Delft Hydraulics, Report on velocity of 2 m/s (172.8 km/day), a Kd
literature study R1318-II (in Dutch). of 0.30 per day, and a Ka of 0.4 per
Van Rijn, L. C. (1984). Bed load transport (part I),
day. Assume that the DO saturation
suspended load transport (part II). Journal of Hydrau-
lic Engineering, 110(10, 11), 14311456, 16131641. concentration is 8 mg/l, the initial
Van Straten, G. (1983). Maximum likelihood estimation of decit is 1.0 mg/l, and the BOD con-
parameters and uncertainty in phytoplankton models. centration at the beginning of the reach
In M. B. Beck & G. van Straten (Eds.), Uncertainty and
(including that discharged into the
forecasting of water quality. Berlin: Springer.
Young, P. (1998). Data-based mechanistic modeling of reach at that point) is 15 mg/l.
environmental, ecological, economic and engineering
systems. Environmental Modeling & Software, 13, 10:3 To account for settling of BOD, in pro-
105122. portion to the BOD concentration, and for
Young, W. J., Lam, D. C. L., Ressel, V., & Wong, J. W. a constant rate of BOD addition R due to
(2000). Development of an environmental flows
decision support system. Environmental Modeling & runoff and scour, and oxygen production
Software, 15, 257265. (A > 0) or reduction (A < 0) due to plants
and benthal deposits, the following dif-
ferential equations have been proposed:

Exercises
a dBOD=ds K d K s BOD R

1. The common version of the Streeter 10:86


Phelps equations for predicting biochemi-
cal oxygen demand BOD and DO decit b dD=ds Kd BOD  Ka D  A;
D concentrations are based on the fol- 10:87
lowing two differential equations
where Ks is the settling rate constant (T1) and s
is the time of flow. Integrating these two equa-
a dBOD=dt K d BOD tions results in the following decit equation:

 
Kd R
b dD=dt Kd BOD  Ka D; Ds BOD0 
Ka  Kd Ks Kd KS
fexpKd KS   expKa sg
where Kd is the deoxygenating rate constant  
Kd R A
(T1), Ka is the reaeration-rate constant (T1),  1  expKa s
Ka Kd Ks Kd
and is the time of flow along a uniform reach of
D0 expKa s
stream in which dispersion is not signicant.
Show the integrated forms of (a) and (b). 10:88
Exercises 463

where BODo and Do are the BOD and DO dT=ds kTE  T =qcD
decit concentrations at s 0.
(a) Compare this equation with that found (a) Assuming that k, D, and TE are con-
in Exercise 10.1 if Ks, R, and A are 0 stant over interval of time of flow
(b) Integrate Eq. (10.86) to predict the t2 t1, integrate the equation above
BOD at any flow time . to derive the temperature T1 at
locations X1.
10:4 Develop nite difference equations for (b) Develop a model for predicting the
predicting the steady-state nitrogen com- temperature at a point in a nondisper-
ponent and DO decit concentrations D in sive stream downstream from multiple
a multi-section one-dimensional estuary. point sources (discharges) of heat.
Dene every parameter or variable used.
10:5 Using MichaelisMenten kinetics develop 10:7 Consider three well-mixed bodies of water
equations for that have the following constant volumes
and freshwater inflows
(a) Predicting the time rate of change of a
nutrient concentration N dN=dt as a Water Volume Flow Displacement
function of the concentration of bac- body (m3) (m3/s) time
terial biomass B; 1 3 1012 3 103 3.17 years
(b) Predicting the time rate of change in 2 3 108
3 102 11.6 days
the bacterial biomass BdB=dt as a
3 3 104
3 10 4
2.8 h
function of its maximum growth rate
lmax
B , temperature T, B, N, and the
specic-loss rate of bacteria qB ; and The rst body is representative of the Great
(c) Predicting the time rate of change in Lakes in North America, the second is charac-
DO decit dD=dt also as a function teristic in size to the upper New York harbor with
of N; B; qB ; and the reaeration-rate the summer flow of the Hudson River, and the
third is typical of a small bay or cove. Compute
constant Ka T 1 .
the time required to achieve 99% of the equi-
librium concentration, and that concentration, of
How would these three equations be altered by
a substance having an initial concentration, and
the inclusion of protozoa P that feed on bacteria,
that concentration, of a substance having an ini-
and in turn require oxygen? Also write the dif-
tial concentration of 0 (at time = 0) and an input
ferential equations for the time rate of change in
of N (M T1) for each of the three water bodies.
the concentration of protozoa PdP=dt:
Assume that the decay rate constant K is 0, 0.01,
10:6 Many equations for predicting stream
0.05, 0.25, 1.0, and 5.0 days1 and compare the
temperature use Eulerian coordinates. The
results.
actual behavior of the stream temperature
is more easily demonstrated if Lagrangian
10:8 Consider the water pollution problem as
coordinates (i.e., time of flow t rather than
shown in Figure below. There are two
distance X) are used. Assuming insigni-
sources of nitrogen, 200 mg/l at site 1 and
cant dispersion, the time-of-flow rate of
100 mg/l at site 2, going into the river,
temperature change of a water parcel as it
whereas the nitrogen concentration in the
moves downstream is
river just upstream of site 1 is 32 mg/l.
464 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

200 mg/l

2
3
32 mg/l 1

100 mg/l

The unknown variables are the fraction of [32 + 200(1 - X1)]0.25 = S 2


32 S2
nitrogen removal at each of those sites that would
achieve concentrations no greater than 20 and
25 mg/l just upstream of site 2 and at site 3, So if S2 is 20, X1 will be 0.76; if S2 is 15, X1 will
respectively, at a total minimum cost. Let those be 0.86. For S2 values of 10 or less X1 must exceed
nitrogen removal fractions be X1 and X2. Assum- 0.90 and these values are infeasible. The cost
ing unit costs of removal as $30 and $20 at site 1 associated with the link or decision will be 30 X1.
and site 2, respectively, the model can be written as Setup the dynamic programming network. It
begins with a single node representing the state
Minimize 30X1 20X2 (concentration) of 32 mg/l just upstream of
Subject to : 2001  X1 0:25 8  20 site 1. It will end with a single node represent-
2001  X1 0:15 1001X2 0:60 5  25 ing the state (concentration) 25 mg/l. The
X1  0:9; X2  0:9
maximum possible state (concentration value
just upstream of site 2 must be no greater than
Another way to write the two quality con- 20 mg/l. You can use discrete concentration
straints of this model is to dene variables Si values in increments of 5 mg/l. This will be a
(i = 1, 2, 3) as the concentration of nitrogen just very simple network. Find the least-cost solu-
upstream of site i. Beginning with a concentration tion using both forward and backward moving
of 32 mg/l just upstream of site 1, the concen- dynamic programming procedures. Please show
tration of nitrogen just upstream of site 2 will be your work.

32 2001  X1 0:25 S2 and S2  20: 10:9 Identify three alternative sets (feasible
solutions) of storage lagoon volume
The concentration of nitrogen at site 3 will be capacities V and corresponding land
application areas A and irrigation vol-
S2 1001  X2 0:60 S3 and S3  25: umes Q2t in each month t within a year
that satisfy a 10 mg/l maximum NO3N
This makes the problem easier to solve using content in the drainage water of a land
discrete dynamic programming. The nodes or disposal system. In addition to the data
states of the network can be discrete values of Si, listed below, assume that the influent
the concentration of nitrogen in the river at sites nitrogen n1t is 50 mg/l each month, with
i (just upstream of sites 1 and 2 and at site 3). The 10% ( = 0.1) of the nitrogen in organic
links represent the decision variable values, Xi form. Also assume that the soil is a
that will result in the next discrete concentration, well-drained silt loam containing
Si+1 given Si. The stages i are the different source 4500 kg/ha of organic nitrogen in the soil
sites or river reaches. A section of the network in above the drains. The soil has a monthly
stage 1 (reach from site 1 to site 2) will look like drainage capacity d of 60 cm and has a
Exercises 465

eld capacity moisture content M of removal is required at each discharge site,


10 cm. Maximum plant nitrogen uptake solve for the least-cost solution given the
values Ntmax are 35 kg/ha during April till data in the accompanying table. Can you
October, and 70 kg/ha during May till identify more than one type of model to
September. Finally, assume that because solve this problem? How would this
of cold temperatures, no wastewater irri- model be expanded to specically
gation is permitted during November till include both carbonaceous BOD and
March. December, January, and Febru- nitrogenous BOD and non-point waste
arys precipitation is in the form of snow discharges?
and will melt and be added to the soil
moisture inventory in March.

Reach no. Design BOD load (mg/l) Present % removal load Annual costs of various design BOD removal
60% 75% 85% 90%
1 248 67 0 22,100 77,500 1,20,600
2 408 30 6,30,000 7,80,000 9,87,000 11,70,000
3 240 30 2,10,000 2,77,500 3,23,000 3,78,000
4 1440 30 4,13,000 5,23,000 6,26,000 6,98,000
6 2180 30 5,00,000 6,38,000 7,90,000 9,00,000
7 279 30 8,40,000 10,72,000 12,32,500 13,50,000

Reach Time Wastewater Entering Total DO Maximum DO decit DO Conc BOD Conc Av. deoxgn Reaeration
no. of discharge reach reach saturation allowable of at at rate constant rate
flow (103 flow (103 flow conc. DO decit wastewater beginning beginning for reach constant
(days) m3/day) m3/day) (103 (mg/l) (mg/l) (mg/l) of reach of reach (days1) days1)
m3/day) (mg/l) (mg/l)

1 0.235 19 5129 5148 10.2 3.2 1 9.5 1.66 0.31 1.02

2 1.330 140 4883 5023 9.95 2.45 1 8 0.68 0.41 0.6

3 1.087 30 10,171 10,201 9 2 1 ? ? 0.36 0.63

4 2.067 53 1120 1173 9.7 3.75 1 9.54 1 0.35 0.09

5 0.306 0 11,374 11,374 9 2.5 ? ? 0.34 0.72

6 1.050 98 11,374 11,472 8.35 2.35 1 0.35 0.14

7 6.130 155 11,472 11,627 8.17 4.17 1 0.3 0.02

10:10 Consider the problem of estimating the 10:11 Discuss what would be required to ana-
minimum total cost of waste treatment in lyze flow augmentation alternatives in
order to satisfy quality standards within a Exercise 12.8. How would the costs of
stream. Let the stream contain seven flow augmentation be dened and how
homogenous reaches r, reach r = 1 being would you modify water quality models
at the upstream end and reach r = 7 at the to include flow augmentation
downstream end. Reaches r = 2 and 4 are alternatives?
tributaries entering the mainstream at the 10:12 Develop a dynamic programming model
beginning of 1, 3, 5, 6, and 7. Point to estimate the least-cost number, capac-
sources of BOD enter the stream at the ity, and location of articial aerators to
beginning of reaches 1, 2, 3, 4, 6, and 7. ensure meeting minimum allowable DO
Assuming that at least 60% BOD standards where they would otherwise be
466 10 Water Quality Modeling and Prediction

violated during an extreme low-flow particular period t were 1.1, 0.1, and
design condition in a nonbranching sec- 0.8 mg/l, respectively. Assume that all
tion of a stream. Show how wastewater other nutrients required for algal growth
treatment alternatives, and their costs, are in abundance. The algal species of
could also be included in the dynamic concern are three in number and are
programming model. denoted by j = 1, 2, 3. The data required
10:13 Using the data provided, nd the to estimate the probable maximum algal
steady-state concentrations Ct of a con- bloom biomass concentration are given in
stituent in a well-mixed lake of constant the accompanying table. Compute this
volume 30 106 m3. The production Nti bloom potential for all ki and k equal to 0,
of the constituent occurs at three sites i, 0.8, and 1.0.
and is constant in each of four seasons in
the year. The required fractions of con- Parameter (algae species Parameter value
stituent removal Pi at each site i are to be index j) 1 2 3
set so that they are equal at all sites i and a1j = mg N/mg dry wt of 0.04 0.01 0.20
the maximum concentration in the lake algae j
in each period t must not exceed a2j = mg P/mg dry wt of 0.06 0.02 0.10
20 mg/l. algae j
a3j = mg Si/mg dry wt of 0.08 0.01 0.03
Period, Days Flow, Qt Constituent decay algae j
t in (103 rate, constant, Kt Dj = morality and grazing 0.6 0.4 0.20
period m3/day) (days1) rate constant (days1)
1 100 90 0.02 dj = morality rate constant, 0.3 0.1 0.10
2 80 150 0.03 (days1)
3 90 200 0.05 v = extinction reduction 0.07 0.07 0.07
rate constant for dead algae,
4 95 120 0.04
(days1)
Constituent discharge Constituent production hmax = max. extinction 0.07 0.07 0.10
j
site, i (kg/day)
coef. (m1)
1 38,000
gmin
j Z = min. extinction
0.01 0.03 0.03
2 25,000 coef. (m1)
3 47,000 gj = increase in extinction 0.05 0.164 0.04
coef. per unit increase in
mg/l (g/m3) of dry wt of
species j (m2/g)
10:14 Suppose that the solution of a model such
as that used in Exercise 10.13, or mea- Nutrient index i 1 2 3
sured data, indicated that for a well- Nutrient N P Si
mixed portion of a saltwater lake, the li = mineralization rate 0.02 0.69 0.62
concentrations of nitrogen (i = 1), phos- constant, (days1)
phorus (i = 2), and silicon (i = 3) in a
Exercises 467

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
River Basin Modeling
11

Multipurpose river basin development typically


11.1 Introduction
involves the identication and use of both
structural and nonstructural measures designed to
Various types of models can be used to assist
increase the reliability and decrease the cost of
those responsible for planning and managing
municipal, industrial, and agriculture water sup-
various components of river systems. These
plies, to protect against droughts and floods, to
components include streams, rivers, lakes, reser-
improve quality, to provide for commercial
voirs, and wetlands, and diversions to demand
navigation and recreation, to enhance aquatic
sites that could be within or outside the basin
ecosystems, and to produce hydropower, as
boundaries. Each of these components can be
appropriate for the particular river basin. Struc-
impacted by water management policies and
tural measures may include diversion canals,
practices. The management of any single com-
reservoirs, hydropower plants, levees, flood
ponent can impact the performance of other
proong, irrigation delivery and drainage sys-
components in the basin. Hence, for the overall
tems, navigation locks, recreational facilities,
management of the water in river basin systems, a
groundwater wells, and water and treatment
systems view is usually taken. This systems view
treatment plants along with their distribution and
requires the modeling of multiple interacting and
collection systems. Nonstructural measures may
interdependent components. These multicompo-
include land-use controls and zoning, flood
nent models are useful for analyzing alternative
warning and evacuation measures, and economic
designs and management policies for improving
incentives that affect human behavior with regard
the performance of integrated river basin systems.
to water and watershed use. Planning the devel-
The discussion in this chapter is limited to
opment and management of water resource sys-
water quantity management. Clearly the regimes
tems involves identifying just what and when and
of flows, velocities, volumes, and other properties
where structural or nonstructural measures are
of water quantity will impact the quality of that
needed, the extent to which they are needed, and
water as well. However, unless water allocations
their combined economic, environmental, eco-
allocations and uses are based on requirements for
logical, and social impacts. This chapter intro-
water quality, such as for the dilution of pollution,
duces some modeling approaches for doing this.
water quality does not normally affect water
Having just reviewed some water quality mod-
quantity. For this reason among others, it is
eling approaches in the previous chapter, this
common to separate discussions of water quantity
chapter focuses on quantity management.

The Author(s) 2017 469


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_11
470 11 River Basin Modeling

management from water quality management end of the applicable river basin to the lower end
(Chap. 10). However, when attempting to predict of the basin. In this case stream and river flows
the impacts of any management policy on both can be dened by simple mass balance or conti-
water quantity and quality, both water quantity nuity equations. For shorter duration time periods
and quality models are needed. flow routing may be required.
This chapter begins with a discussion of The actual length or duration of each
selecting appropriate model time periods that will within-year period dened in a model may vary
depend on the issues being addressed as well as from period to period. Modeled time period time
on the variability of the water supplies and periods need not be equal. Generally what is
demands. Discussed next are methods for esti- important is to capture in the model the needed
mating streamflows at various sites of interest capacities of infrastructure that are determined in
throughout a basin based on gage (measured) large measure by the variation in supplies and
flows at other sites. Following these discussions demands. These variations should be captured in
several methods are reviewed and compared for the model by appropriately selecting the number
estimating reservoir storage requirements for and duration of time periods. If say over a
water supplies. Model components are dened three-month period there is little variation in both
for withdrawals and diversions, and for reservoir water supplies and demands or for the purposes
storage. Reservoir storage can serve the needs water serves, such as flood control, hydropower,
over time for water supply, flood control, recre- or recreation, there is no need to divide that
ation, and hydroelectric power generation. Next three-month period into multiple time periods.
flood control structures, such as levees and Another important factor to consider in mak-
channel flow capacity improvements at potential ing a decision regarding the number and duration
flood damage in a river basin are introduced. of time periods to include in any model is the
These components are then combined into a purpose for which the model is to be used. Some
multiple purpose multi-objective planning model analyses are concerned only with identifying
for a hypothetical river basin. The chapter con- designs designs and operating policies of various
cludes with an introduction to some dynamic engineering projects for managing water resour-
models for assisting in the scheduling and time ces at some xed time (say a typical year) in the
sequencing of multiple projects within a river future. Multiple years of hydrological records are
basin. used, usually in simulation models, to obtain an
estimate of just how well a system might per-
form, at least in a statistical sense, in that future
11.2 Model Time Periods time period. The within-year period durations
can have an impact on those performance indi-
When analyzing and evaluating various water cator values as well as on the estimate of
management plans designed to distribute the over-year as well as within-year storage that may
natural unregulated flows over time and space, it be needed to meet various goals. These static
is usually sufcient to consider average condi- analyses are not concerned with investment
tions within discrete time periods. In optimization project scheduling or sequencing.
models, weekly, monthly, or seasonal flows are Dynamic planning models are used to esti-
commonly used as opposed to daily flows. The mate the impacts of changing conditions over
shortest time period duration usually considered time. These changes could include hydrological
in optimization models developed for identifying inputs, economic, environmental and other
and evaluating alternative water management objectives, water demands, and design and
plans and operating policies is one that is no less operating parameters. As a result, dynamic
than the time water takes to flow from the upper models generally span many more years than do
11.2 Model Time Periods 471

static models, but they may have fewer gage sites 1 and 9. Knowledge of the flows Qst in
within-year periods. each period t at gage sites 1 and 9 permits the
estimation of flows at any other site in the basin
as well as the incremental flows between those
11.3 Streamflow Estimation sites in each period t.
The method used to estimate flows at ungaged
Water resource managers need estimates of sites will depend on the characteristics of the
streamflows at each site, where management watershed or river basin. In humid regions where
decisions are being considered. These streamflow streamflows increase in the downstream direction
estimates can be based on the results of due to rainfall runoff, and the spatial distribution
rainfall-runoff models or on measured historical of average monthly or seasonal rainfall is more or
flows at gage sites. For modeling alternative less the same from one part of the river basin to
management policies, these gage-based flows at another, the runoff per unit land area is typically
the sites of interest should be those that would assumed constant. In these situations, estimated
have occurred under natural conditions. These are flows, qst , at any site s can be based on the
called naturalized flows that have been derived watershed areas, As, contributing flow to those
from measured flows or rainfallrunoff models sites, and the corresponding streamflows and
and then adjusted to take into account any watershed areas above the nearest or most rep-
upstream regulation and diversions. Many gage resentative gage sites.
flow values reflect actions such as diversions and For each gage site, the runoff per unit land area
reservoir releases that occurred upstream that can be calculated by dividing the gage flow Qst by
altered the downstream flows, unless such the upstream drainage area, As. This can be done
upstream water management and use policies are for each gage site in the basin. Thus for any gage
to continue, these measured gage flows should be site g, the runoff per unit drainage area in month
converted to unregulated or natural flows prior to or season t is Qgt divided by Ag. This runoff per
their use in management models. unit land area times the drainage area upstream of
Assuming that unregulated streamflow data any site s of interest will be the estimated
are available at gage sites, these data can be used streamflow in that period at that site s. If there are
to estimate the unregulated flows at sites where multiple gage sites, such as illustrated in
they are needed. These sites would include any Fig. 11.1, the estimated streamflow at some
place where diversions might occur or where ungaged site s can be a weighted combination of
reservoirs for regulating flows might be built. those unit area runoffs times the area contributing
Consider, for example, the simple river basin to the flow at site s. The nonnegative weights, wg,
illustrated in Fig. 11.1. Assume streamflows that sum to 1, reflect the relative signicance of
have been recorded over a number of years at each gage site with respect to site s. Their values

Fig. 11.1 River basin


gage sites where
streamflows are measured
and recorded
472 11 River Basin Modeling

will be based on the judgments of those who are length of stream or river as a function of the
familiar with the basins hydrology. magnitude of flow.
( ) In watersheds characterized by signicant
X elevation changes and consequently varying
Qst wg Qgt =Ag As 11:1 rainfall and runoff runoff, other methods may be
g
required for estimating average streamflows at
ungaged sites. The selection of the most appro-
In all the models developed and discussed priate method to use, as well as the most
below, the variable Qst will refer to the mean appropriate gage sites to use for estimating the
natural (unregulated) flow (L3/T) at a site s in a streamflow, Qst , at a particular site s can be a
period t. matter of judgment. The best gage site need not
The difference between the natural stream- necessarily be the nearest gage to site s, but
flows at any two sites is called the incremental rather the site most similar with respect to
flow. Using Eq. 11.1 to estimate streamflows will important hydrologic variables.
result in positive incremental flows. The down- The natural incremental flow between any two
stream flow will be greater than the upstream sites is simply the difference between their
flow. In arid regions runoff is not constant over respective natural flows.
the region. Incremental flows may not exist and
hence due to losses, the flows may be decreasing
in the downstream direction. In these cases there 11.4 Streamflow Routing
is a net loss in flow in the downstream direction.
This might be the case when a stream originates If the duration of a within-year period is less than
in a wet area and flows into a region that receives the time of flow throughout the stream or river
less rainfall. In such arid areas the runoff is often system being modeled, and the flows vary within
less than the evapotranspiration and inltration the system, some type of streamflow routing
into the ground along the stream channel. must be used to keep track of where the varying
For stream channels where there exist rela- amounts of water are in each time period. There
tively uniform conditions affecting loss loss, are many proposed routing methods (as descri-
where there are no known sites where the stream bed in any hydrology text or handbook, e.g.,
abruptly enters or exits the ground, as can occur Maidment 1993). Many of these more traditional
in karst conditions, the average streamflow for a methods can be approximated with sufcient
particular period t at site s can be based on the accuracy using relatively simple methods. Two
nearest or most representative gage flow, Qgt , and such methods are described in the following
a loss rate per unit length of the stream or river, paragraphs.
Lgs between gage site g and an ungaged site s. If The outflow, Ot, from a reach of stream or
there are at least two gage sites along the portion river during a time period t is a function of the
of the stream or river that is in the dry region, one amount of water in that reach, i.e., its initial
can compute the loss of flow per unit stream storage, St, and its inflow, It. Because of bank
length, and apply this loss rate to various sites storage, that outflow is often dependent on whe-
along the stream or river. This loss rate per unit ther the quantity of water in the reach is increas-
length may not be constant over the entire length ing or decreasing. If bank inflows and outflows
between the gage stations, or even for all flow are explicitly modeled, or if bank storage is
rates, however. Losses will likely increase with not that signicant, the outflow from a reach
increasing flows simply because more water in any period t can be expressed as a simple
surface is exposed to evaporation and seepage. In two-parameter power function of the form
these cases one can dene a loss rate per unit a(St + It)b. Mass balance equations, that may take
11.4 Streamflow Routing 473

into account losses, update the initial storage Note the flexibility available when using the
volumes in each succeeding time period. The three- or four-parameter routing approach. Even
reachdependent parameters a and b can be blocks of flow can be routed a specied distance
determined through calibration procedures such downstream over a specied time, regardless of
as genetic algorithms (Chap. 5) using a time series the actual flow. This can be done by setting and
of reach inflows and outflows. The resulting to 1, to 0, and the number of segments n to
outflow function is typically concave (the the number of time periods it takes to travel that
parameter b will be less than 1), and thus the distance. This may not be very realistic, but there
minimum value of St + It must be at least 1. If due exist some river basin reaches where managers
to evaporation or other losses the reach volume believe this particular routing applies.
drops below this or any preselected higher
amount, the outflow can be assumed to be 0.
Alternatively one can adopt a three- or 11.5 Lakes and Reservoirs
four-parameter routing approach that ts a wider
range of conditions. Each stream or river reach Lakes and reservoirs are sites in a basin where
can be divided into a number of segments. That surface water storage needs to be modeled. Thus,
number n is one of the parameters to be deter- variables dening the water volumes at those
mined. Each segment s can be modeled as a sites must be dened. Let Sst be the initial storage
storage unit, having an initial storage volume, Sst, volume of a lake or reservoir at site s in period
and an inflow, Ist. The three-parameter approach t. Omitting the site index s for the moment, the
assumes the outflow, Ost, is a linear function of nal storage volume in period t, St+1, (which is
the initial storage volume and inflow: the same as the initial storage in the following
period t + 1) will equal the initial volume, St,
Ost a Sst bIst 11:2 plus the net surface and groundwater inflows, Qt,
less the release or discharge, Rt, and evaporation
Equation 11.2 applies for all time periods and seepage losses, Lt. All models of lakes and
t and for all reach segments s in a particular reservoirs include this mass balance equation for
reach. Different reaches will likely have different each period t being modeled.
values of the parameters n, , and . The cali-
brated values of and are nonnegative and no St Qt Rt Lt St 1 11:4
greater than 1. Again a mass balance equation
updates each segments initial storage volume in The release from a natural lake is a function of
the following time period. The outflow from each its surrounding topography and its water surface
reach segment is the inflow into the succeeding elevation. It is determined by nature, and unless
reach segment. it is made into a reservoir its discharge or release
The four-parameter approach assumes that the is not controlled or managed. The release from a
outflow, Ost, is a nonlinear function of the initial reservoir is controllable, and, as discussed in
storage volume and inflow Chaps. 4 and 8, is usually a function of the
reservoir storage volume and time of year.
Ost a Sst bIst c 11:3 Reservoirs also have xed storage capacities,
K. In each period t, reservoir storage volumes, St,
The parameter is greater than 0 and no cannot exceed their storage capacities, K.
greater than 1. In practice is very close to 1.
Again the values of these parameters, including St  K for each period t: 11:5
the number of reaches n, can be found using
nonlinear optimization methods, such as genetic Equations 11.4 and 11.5 are the two funda-
algorithms, together with a time series of mental equations required when modeling water
observed reach inflows and outflows. supply reservoirs. They apply for each period t.
474 11 River Basin Modeling

The primary purpose of all reservoirs is to water supply, recreational development or


provide a means of regulating downstream sur- hydropower production; (2) the the dead storage
face water flows over time and space. Other used for sediment collection; and (3) the flood
purposes may include storage volume manage- storage capacity reserved to reduce potential
ment for recreation and flood control, and storage downstream flood damage during flood events.
and release management for hydropower pro- These separate storage capacities are illustrated
duction. Reservoirs are built to alter the natural in Fig. 11.2. The distribution of active and flood
spatial and temporal distribution of the stream- control storage capacities may change over the
flows. The capacity of a reservoir together with year. For example there is no need for flood
its release (or operating) policy determine the control storage in seasons that are not likely to
extent to which surface water flows can be stored experience floods.
for later release. The next several sections of this chapter
The use of reservoirs for temporarily storing address how these capacities may be determined.
streamflows often results in a net loss of total
streamflow due to increased evaporation and
seepage. Reservoirs also bring with them chan- 11.5.1 Estimating Active Storage
ges in the ecology of a watershed and river Capacity
system. They may also displace humans and
human settlements. When considering new 11.5.1.1 Mass diagram Analyses
reservoirs, any benets derived from regulation Perhaps one of the earliest methods used to cal-
of water supplies, from flood damage reduction, culate the active storage capacity required to
from hydroelectric power, and from any navi- meet a specied reservoir release, Rt, in a
gational and recreational activities should be sequence of periods t, was developed by Rippl
compared to any ecological and social losses and (1883). His mass diagram analysis is still used
costs. The benets of reservoirs can be substan- today by many planners. It involves nding the
tial, but so may the costs. Such comparisons of maximum positive cumulative difference
benets and costs are always challenging between a sequence of prespecied (desired)
because of the difculty of expressing all such reservoir releases Rt and known inflows Qt. One
benets and costs in a common metric (Chap. 9). can visualize this as starting with a full reservoir,
Reservoir storage capacity can be divided and going through a sequence of simulations in
among the three major uses: (1) the active stor- which the inflows and releases are added and
age used for downstream flow regulation and for subtracted from that initial storage volume value.

Fig. 11.2 Total reservoir


storage volume capacity
consisting of the sum of
dead storage, active
storage, and flood control
storage capacities
11.5 Lakes and Reservoirs 475

Doing this over two cycles of the record of over some interval of time within two successive
inflows will identify the maximum decit vol- record periods, T.
ume associated with that release. This is the " #
required reservoir storage. Having this initial X
j

storage volume, the reservoir would always have Ka maximum Rt Qt ; 11:6
ti
enough water to meet the desired releases.
However, this only works if the sum of all the where 1 i j 2T.
desired releases does not exceed the sum of all Equation 11.6 is the analytical equivalent of
the inflows over the same sequence of time graphical procedures proposed by Rippl for
periods. Reservoirs cannot make water. nding the active storage requirements. Two of
Equation 11.6 represents this process. The these graphical procedures are illustrated in
active storage capacity, Ka, will equal the maxi- Figs. 11.3 and 11.4 for a 9-period inflow record
mum accumulated storage decit one can nd of 1, 3, 3, 5, 8, 6, 7, 2, and 1. Rippls original

Fig. 11.3 The Rippl or


mass diagram method for
identifying reservoir active
storage capacity
requirements. The releases
Rt are assumed constant for
each period t

Fig. 11.4 Alternative plot


for identifying reservoir
active storage capacity
requirements
476 11 River Basin Modeling

approach, shown in Fig. 11.3, involves plotting indeed it does in the example 9-period record of
Pt
t1 Qs versus time
the cumulative inflow 1, 3, 3, 5, 8, 6, 7, 2, and 1.
t. Assuming a constant reservoir release, R, in
each period t, a line with slope R is placed so that Kt Rt Qt Kt1 if positive;
11:7
it is tangent to the cumulative inflow curve. To 0 otherwise
the right of these points of tangency the release
R exceeds the inflow Qt. The maximum vertical The maximum of all Kt is the required storage
distance between the cumulative inflow curve capacity for the specied releases Rt and inflows,
and the release line of slope R equals the maxi- Qt. Table 11.1 illustrates this sequent peak pro-
mum water decit, and hence the required active cedure for computing the active capacity Ka, i.e.,
storage capacity. Clearly, if the average release the maximum of all Kt, required to achieve a
R is greater than the mean inflow, a reservoir will release Rt = 3.5 in each period given the series of
not be able to meet the demand no matter what its 9 streamflows. Note this method does not require
active storage capacity. all releases to be the same.
An alternative way to identify the required
reservoir storage capacity is to plot the cumula-
P
tive nonnegative deviations, ts Rs  Qs , and 11.5.2 Reservoir Storage-Yield
note the biggest total deviation, as shown in Functions
Fig. 11.4.
These graphical approaches do not account Reservoir storage-yield functions dene the
for losses. Furthermore, the method shown in minimum active active storage capacity required
Fig. 11.3 is awkward if the desired releases in to insure a given constant release rate for a
each period t are not the same. The equivalent specied sequence of reservoir inflows. Mass
method shown in Fig. 11.4 is called the sequent diagrams, sequent peak analyses, and linear
peak method. If the sum of the desired releases optimization (Chap. 4) are three methods that can
does not exceed the sum of the inflows, calcu- be used to dene these functions. Given the same
lations over at most two successive hydrologic sequence of known inflows and specied relea-
records of flows are needed to identify the largest ses, each method will provide identical results.
cumulative decit inflow. After that the proce- Using optimization models, it is possible to
dure will produce repetitive results. It is much obtain such functions from multiple reservoirs
easier to consider changing release values when and to account for losses based on storage vol-
determining the maximum decit by the sequent ume surface areas, as will be discussed later.
peak method. There are two ways of dening a linear opti-
mization (linear programming) model to estimate
11.5.1.2 Sequent peak analyses the active storage capacity requirements. One
The sequent peak procedure is illustrated in approach is to minimize the active storage
Table 11.1. Let Kt be the maximum total storage capacity, Ka, subject to minimum required con-
requirement needed for periods 1 up through stant releases, Y, the yield. This minimum active
period t. As before, let Rt be the required release storage capacity is the maximum storage volume,
in period t, and Qt be the inflow in that period. St, required given the sequence of known inflows
Setting K0 equal to 0, the procedure involves Qt, and the specied yield, Y, in each period
calculating Kt using Eq. 11.7 consecutively for t. The problem is to nd the storage volumes, St,
up to twice the total length of record. This and releases, Rt that
assumes that the record repeats itself to take care
of the case when the critical sequence of flows Minimize Ka 11:8
occurs at the end of the streamflow record, as
11.5 Lakes and Reservoirs 477

Table 11.1 Illustration of the sequent peak procedure for computing active storage requirements

subject to Alternatively one can maximize the constant


mass balance constraints release yield, Y, for various values of active
storage capacity, Ka, subject to the same con-
St Qt Rt St 1 t 1; 2; . . .; T; straint Eqs. 11.911.11.
11:9
T 1 1
Maximize Y 11:12
capacity constraints
Constraints 11.9 and 11.11 can be combined
St  Ka t 1:2; . . .; T 11:10 to reduce the model size by T constraints.

minimum release constraints St Qt Y  St 1 t 1; 2; . . .; T;


11:13
T 1 1
Rt  Y t 1:2; . . .; T 11:11
The solutions of these two linear programming
for various values of the yield, Y. models, using the 9-period flow sequence referred
478 11 River Basin Modeling

Fig. 11.5 Storage-yield


for the sequence of flows 1,
3, 3, 5, 8, 6, 7, 2, and 1

to above and solved for various values of yield or into account (as discussed in Chaps. 6 and 8).
capacity, respectively, are plotted in Fig. 11.5. This will provide alternative sequences as well as
The results are the same as could be found using more intervals between ranked flows.
the mass diagram or sequent peak methods. While the mass diagram and sequent peak
There is a probability that the storage-yield procedures are relatively simple, they are not
function just dened will fail. A record of only 9 readily adaptable to reservoirs where evaporation
flows, for example, is not very long and hence losses and/or lake level regulation are important
will not give one much condence that they will considerations, or to problems involving more
dene the critical low-flow period of the future. than one reservoir. Mathematical programming
One rough way to estimate the reliability of a (optimization) methods provide this capability.
storage-yield function is to rearrange and rank These optimization methods are based on mass
the inflows in order of their magnitudes. If there balance equations for routing flows through each
are n ranked inflows there will be n + 1 intervals reservoir. The mass balance or continuity equa-
separating them. Assuming there is an equal tions explicitly dene storage volumes (and
probability that any future flow could occur in hence storage areas from which evaporation
any interval between these ranked flows, there is occurs) at the beginning of each period t.
a probability of 1/(n + 1) that a future flow will
be less than the lowest recorded flow. If that
record low flow occurs during a critical low-flow 11.5.3 Evaporation Losses
period, more storage may be required than indi-
cated in the function. Evaporation losses, Lt, from lakes and reservoirs,
Hence for a record of only 9 flows that are if any, take place on their surface areas. Hence to
considered representative of the future, one can compute these losses their surface areas must be
be only about 90% condent that the resulting estimated in each period t. Storage surface areas
storage-yield function will apply in the future. are functions of the storage volumes, St. These
One can be only 90% sure of the predicted yield functions are typically concave, as shown in
Y associated with any storage volume K. A much Fig. 11.6.
more condent estimate of the reliability of any In addition to the storage area-volume func-
derived sstorage-yield function can be obtained tion, seasonal surface water evaporation loss
by synthetic flows to supplement any measured depths, Emax
t , must be assumed, perhaps based on
streamflow record, taking parameter uncertainty measured evaporation losses over time.
11.5 Lakes and Reservoirs 479

Fig. 11.6 Storage surface


area as a function of
reservoir storage volume
along with its linear
approximation. The slope
parameter a is the assumed
increase in surface area
associated with a unit
increase in the storage
volume

Multiplying the average surface area, At, based An alternative way to estimate evaporation
on the initial and nal storage volumes, St and St loss that does not require a surface areastorage
max
+1, by the loss depth, Et , yields the volume of volume relationship, such as shown in Fig. 11.6,
evaporation loss, Lt, in the period t. The linear is to dene the storage elevation-storage volume
approximation of that loss is function. Subtracting the evaporation loss depth
from the initial surface elevation associated with
Lt ao aSt St 1 =2Etmax 11:14 the initial storage volume will result in an
adjusted storage elevation which in turn denes
Letting the initial storage volume after evaporation losses
have been deducted. This adjusted initial volume
at 0:5 a Etmax 11:15
can be used in continuity Eqs. 11.9 or 11.13.
This procedure assumes that evaporation is only
the mass balance equation for storage volumes
a function of the initial storage volume in each
that include evaporation losses in each period
time period t. For relatively large volumes and
t can be approximated as
short time periods such an assumption is usually
1  at St Qt Rt ao Etmax 1 at St 1 satisfactory.
11:16
11.5.4 Over- and Within-Year
If Eq. 11.16 are used in optimization models Reservoir Storage
for identifying preliminary designsof a proposed and Yields
reservoir and if the active storage storage capacity
turns out to be essentially zero, or just that required An alternative approach to modeling reservoirs is
to provide for the xed evaporation loss, ao Emax t , to separate out over-year storage and within-year
then clearly any reservoir at the site is not justied. storage, and to focus not on total reservoir
These mass balance equations together with any releases, but on parts of the total releases that can
reservoir storage capacity constraints should be be assigned specic reliabilities. These release
removed from the model before resolving it again. components we call yields. To dene these yields
This procedure is simpler than introducing 0,1 and the corresponding reservoir rules, we divide
integer variables that will remove the terms ao this section into four parts. The rst outlines a
Emax
t in Eq. 11.16 if the active storage volume is 0 method for estimating the reliabilities of various
(using methods discussed in Chap. 4). constant annual minimum flows or yields. The
480 11 River Basin Modeling

second discusses a modeling approach for esti- available streamflow data for each within-year
mating over-year and within-year active storage season at a potential reservoir site. These
requirements to deliver a specied annual and streamflows are used to solve and compare the
within-year period yields having a specied re- solutions of various yield models as well as to
liability. The third and fourth parts expand this illustrate the concept of yield reliability.
modeling approach to include multiple yields
having different reliabilities, evaporation losses, 11.5.4.1 Reliability of Annual yields
and the construction of reservoir operation rule The maximum flow that can be made available at
curves using these flow release yields. a specic site by the regulation of the historic
It will be convenient to illustrate the yield streamflows from a reservoir of a given size is
models and their solutions using a simple often referred to as the rm yield or safe
example consisting of a single reservoir and two yield. These terms imply that the rm or safe
within-year periods per year. This example will yield is that yield which the reservoir will always
be sufcient to illustrate the method that can be be able to provide. Of course, this may not be
applied to models having more within-year true. If historical flows are used to determine this
periods. Table 11.2 lists the nine years of yield, then the resulting yield may be better

Table 11.2 Recorded unregulated historical streamflows at a reservoir site


11.5 Lakes and Reservoirs 481

called an historical yield. Historical and rm 11.5.4.2 Estimation of Active


yield are often used synonymously. Reservoir Storage
A minimum flow yield is 100% reliable only Capacities
if the sequence of flows in future years will never for Specified Yields
sum to a smaller amount than those that have A reservoir with active over-year storage capac-
occurred in the historic record. Usually one ity provides a means of increasing the magnitude
cannot guarantee this condition. Hence associ- and/or the reliabilities of various annual yields.
ated with any historic yield is the uncertainty, For example, the sequent peak algorithm dened
i.e., a probability, that it might not always be by Eq. 11.7 provides a means of estimating the
available in the future. There are some ways of reservoir storage volume capacity required to
estimating this probability. meet various rm yields Y0.9, associated with
Referring to the nine-year streamflow record the nine annual flows presented in Table 11.1.
listed in Table 11.2, if no reservoir is built to The same yields can be obtained from a linear
increase the yields downstream of the reservoir optimization model that minimizes active
site, the historic rm yield is the lowest flow on over-year storage capacity, Koa,
record, namely 1.0 that occurred in year 5. The
reliability of this annual yield is the probability Minimize Kao 11:17
that the streamflow in any year is greater than or
equal to this value. In other words, it is the This active over-year storage capacity must
probability that this flow will be equaled or satisfy the following storage continuity and
exceeded. The expected value of the exceedance capacity constraint equations involving only
probability of the lowest flow in an n-year record annual storage volumes, Sy, inflows, Qy, yields,
is approximately n/(n + 1), which for the Yp, and excess releases, Ry. For each year y:
n = 9 year flow record is 9/(9 + 1), or 0.90. This
Sy Qy  Yp  Ry Sy 1 11:18
is based on the assumption that any future flow
has an equal probability of being in any of the
intervals formed by ordering the record of 9 Sy  Kao 11:19
flows from the lowest to the highest value, and
that the lowest value has a rank of 9. Once again, if the year index y = n, the last
Ranking the n flows of record from the highest year of record, then year y + 1 is assumed to
to the lowest and assigning the rank m of 1 to the equal 1. For annual yieldsof 3 and 4, the
highest flow, and n to the lowest flow, the over-year storage requirements are 3 and 8,
expected probability p that any flow of rank m will respectively, as can be determined just by
be equaled or exceeded in any year is approxi- examining the right-hand column of annual flows
mately m/(n + 1). An annual yield having a in Table 11.2.
probability p of exceedance will be denoted as Yp. The over-year model, Eqs. 11.1711.19,
For independent events, the expected number identies only annual or over-year storage
of years until a flow of rank m is equaled or requirements based on specied (known) annual
exceeded is the reciprocal of its probability of flows, Qy, and specied constant annual yields,
exceedance p, namely 1/p = (n + 1)/m. The re- Yp. Within-year periods t requiring constant
currence time or expected time until a failure (a yields ypt that sum to the annual yield Yp may
flow less than that of rank m) is the reciprocal of also be considered in the estimation of the
the probability of failure in any year. Thus, the required over-year and within-year or total active
expected recurrence time Tp associated with a storage capacity, Ka. Any distribution of the
flow having an expected probability p of excee- over-year yield within the year that differs from
dance is 1/(1 p). the distribution of the within-year inflows may
482 11 River Basin Modeling

require additional active reservoir storage require 2nT continuity and capacity constraints.
capacity. This additional capacity is called the Not all these constraints are necessary, however.
within-year storage capacity. It is only a subset of the sequence of flows within
The sequent peak method, Eq. 11.7, can be the total record of flows that generally determines
used to obtain the total over-year and within-year the required active storage capacity Ka of a
active storage capacity requirements for specied reservoir. This is called the critical period. This
within-year period yields, ypt. Alternatively a critical period is often used in engineering studies
linear programming model can be developed to to estimate the historical yield of any particular
obtain the same information along with associ- reservoir or system of reservoirs.
ated reservoir storage volumes. The objective is Even though the severity of future droughts is
to nd the minimum total active storage capacity, unknown, many planners accept the traditional
Ka, subject to storage volume continuity and practice of using the historical critical drought
capacity constraints for every within-year period period for reservoir design and operation studies
of every year. This model is dened as on the assumption that having observed such an
event in the past, it is certainly possible to
minimize Ka 11:20 experience similar conditions in the future. In
some parts of the world, notably those countries
subject to in the lower portions of the southern hemisphere,
historical records are continually proven to be
Sty Qty  ypt  Rty St 1;y 8t; y 11:21
unreliable indicators of future hydrological con-
ditions. In these regions especially, synthetically
Sty  Ka 8t; y 11:22 generated flows based on statistical methods
(Chap. 6) are more acceptable as a basis for yield
In Eq. 11.21, if t is the nal period T in year y, estimation.
the next period T + 1 = 1 in year y + 1, or year 1
if y is the last year of record, n. Over and within-year storage Capacity
The within-year storage requirement, Kwa , is To begin the development of a smaller, but more
the difference in the active capacities resulting approximate, model, consider each combined
from these two models, Eqs. 11.1711.19, and over-year and within-year storage reservoir to
Eqs. 11.2011.22. consist of two separate reservoirs in series
Table 11.3 shows some results from solving (Fig. 11.7). The upper reservoir is the over-year
both of the above models. The over-year storage storage reservoir, whose capacity required for an
capacity requirements, Koa, are obtained from annual yield is determined by an over-year
Eqs. 11.1711.19. The combined over-year and model, e.g., Eqs. 11.1711.19. The purpose of
within-year capacities, Ka, are obtained from the downstream within-year reservoir is to
solving Eqs. 11.2011.22. The difference between distribute as desired in each within-year period
the over-year storage capacity, Koa, required to t a portion of the annual yield produced by the
meet only the annual yields and the total capacity, upstream over-year reservoir. Within-year
Ka, required to meet each specied within-year storage capacity would not be needed if the
yield distribution of those annual yields is the distribution of the average inflows into the upper
within-year active storage capacity Kwa . over-year reservoir exactly coincided with the
Clearly, the number of continuity and reser- desired distribution of within-year yields.
voir capacity constraints in the combined Otherwise within-year storage may be required.
over-year and within-year model (Eqs. 11.20 The two separate reservoir capacities summed
11.22) can become very large when the number together will be an approximation of the total
of years n and within-year periods T are large. active reservoir storage requirement needed to
Each reservoir site in the river system will provide those desired within-year period yields.
11.5 Lakes and Reservoirs 483

Table 11.3 Active Storagerequirements for various within-year yields

Assume the annual yield produced and


released by the over-year reservoir is distributed
in each of the within-year periods in the same
ratio as the average within-year inflows divided
by the total average annual inflow. Let the ratio
of the average period t inflow divided by the total
annual inflow be t. The general within-year
model is to nd the minimum within-year storage
capacity, Kwa , subject to within-year storage vol-
ume continuity and capacity constraints.

Minimize Kaw 11:23

subject to

st bt Yp  ypt st 1 8t T 1 1
11:24
Fig. 11.7 Approximating a combined over-year and
within-year reservoir as two separate reservoirs, one for
creating annual yields, the other for distributing them as
desired in the within-year periods
484 11 River Basin Modeling

st  Kaw 8t 11:25 annual inflow in the two within-year periods


shown in Table 11.2, 0.25 of the total annual
Since the sum of t over all within-year peri- yield flows into the ctitious within-year reser-
ods t is 1, the model guarantees that the sum of voir in period t = 1, and 0.75 of the total annual
the unknown within-year yields, ypt, equals the yield flows into the reservoir in period t = 2.
annual yield, Yp. Suppose the two desired within-year yields are to
The over-year model, Eqs. 11.1711.19, and be 3 and 0 for periods 1 and 2, respectively. The
within-year model, Eqs. 11.2311.25, can be total annual yield, Y0.9, is 3. Assuming the nat-
combined into a single model for an n-year ural distribution of this annual yield of 3 in
sequence of flows period 1 is 0.25 Y0.9 = 0.75, and in period 2 it is
0.75 Y0.9 = 2.25, the within-year storage required
Minimize Ka 11:26 to redistribute these yields of 0.75 and 2.25 to
become 3 and 0, respectively, is Kwa = 2.25.
subject to From Tables 11.2 or 11.3 we can see that an
annual yield of 3 requires an over-year storage
Sy Qy  Yp  Ry Sy 1 8y capacity of 3. Thus, the estimated total storage
11:27
if y n; y 1 1 capacity required to provide yields of 3 and 0 in
periods 1 and 2 is the over-year capacity of 3
plus the within-year capacity of 2.25 equaling
Sy  Kao 8y 11:28 5.25. This compares with 3 plus 2.5 of actual
within-year capacity required for a total of 5.50,
as indicated in Table 11.3.
st bt Yp  ypt st 1 8t There are ways to reduce the number of
11:29
if t T; T 1 1 over-year constraints without changing the
solution of the over-year model. Sequences of
years whose annual inflow values equal or
st  Kaw 8t 11:30 exceed the desired annual yield can be combined
into one constraint. If the yield is an unknown
X variable then the mean annual inflow can be used
ypt Yp 11:31 as the desired annual yield since it is the upper
t
limit of the annual yield. For example in
Table 11.2 note that the last three years and the
Ka  Kao Kaw 11:32 rst year have flows equal or greater than 4, the
mean annual inflow. Thus, these four successive
Constraint 11.31 is not required due to years can be combined into a single continuity
Eq. 11.29, but is included here to make it clear equation
that the sum of within-year yields will equal the
over-year yield. Such a constraint will be S7 Q7 Q8 Q9 Q1  4Yp  R7 S2
required for each yield of reliability p if multiple 11:33
yields of different reliabilities are included in the
model. In addition, constraint Eq. 11.30 can be This saves a total of 3 over-year continuity
combined with Eq. 11.32, saving a constraint. If constraints and 3 over-year capacity constraints.
this is done, the combined model contains Note that the excess release, R7, represents the
2n + 2T + 1 constraints, compared to the more excess release in all four periods. Furthermore,
accurate model, Eqs. 11.2011.22, that contains not all reservoir capacity constraint Eq. 11.28 are
2nT constraints. needed, since the initial storage volumes in the
If the fractions t are based on the ratios of the years following low flows will probably be less
average within-year inflow divided by average than the over-year capacity.
11.5 Lakes and Reservoirs 485

There are many ways to modify and extend


Sy Qy  apy Yp  Ry Sy 1 8y if
this yield model to include other objectives, xed 11:34
y n; y 1 1
ratios of the unknown annual yield for each
within-year period, and even multiple yields
When writing Eq. 11.34, the failure year or
having different exceedance probabilities p.
years should be selected from among those in
The number of over-year periods being mod-
which permitting a failure decreases the required
eled compared to the number of years of flow
reservoir capacity Ka. If a failure year is selected
records determines the highest exceedance
that has an excess release, no reduction in the
probability or reliability a yield can have; e.g.,
required active storage capacity will result, and
9/10 or 0.9 in the 9-year example used here. If
the reliability of the yield may be higher than
yields having lower reliabilities are desired, such
intended.
as a yield with a reliability of 0.80, then the yield
The critical year or years that determine the
variable YP can be omitted from Eq. 11.27 in that
required active storage volume capacity may be
critical year that determines the required
dependent on the yield itself. Consider, for
over-year capacity for a 0.90 reliable yield.
example, the 7-year sequence of annual flows (4,
(Since some outflow might be expected, even if it
3, 3, 2, 8, 1, 7) whose mean is 4. If a yield of 2 is
is less than the 0.90 reliable yield, the outflow
desired in each of the 7 years, the critical year
could be forced to equal the inflow for that year.)
requiring reservoir capacity is year 6. If a yield of
If a 0.70 reliable yield is desired, then the yield
4 is desired (again assuming no losses), the
variables in the two most critical years can be
critical years are years 24. The streamflows and
omitted from Eq. 11.27, and so on.
yields in these critical years determine the
The number of years of yield failure deter-
required over-year storage capacity. The failure
mines the estimated reliability of each yield. An
years, if any, must be selected from within the
annual yield that fails in f years has an estimated
critical low-flow periods for the desired yield.
probability (n f)/(n + 1) of being equaled or
When the magnitudes of the yields are
exceeded in any future year. Once the desired
unknown, some trial and error solutions may be
reliability of a yield is known, the problem is to
necessary to ensure that any failure years are
select the appropriate failure years and to specify
within the critical period of years for the associ-
the permissible extent of failure in those f failure
ated yields. To ensure a wider range of applicable
years.
yield magnitudes, the year having the lowest flow
To consider different yield reliabilities p let
within the critical period should be selected as the
the parameter py be a specied value between 0
failure year if only one failure year is selected.
and 1 that indicates the extent of a failure in year
Even though the actual failure year may follow
y associated with an annual yield having a reli-
that low-flow year, the resulting required reser-
ability of p. When py is 1 there is no failure, and
voir storage volume capacity will be the same.
when it is less than 1 there is a failure, but a
proportion of the yield Yp equal to py is released.
Multiple Yields and Evaporation Losses
Its value is in part dependent on the conse-
The yield models developed so far dene only
quences of failure and on the ability to forecast
single annual and within-year yields. Incremental
when a failure may occur and to adjust the
secondary yields having lower reliabilities can
reservoir operating policy accordingly.
also be included in the model. Referring to the
Theover-year storage continuity constraints
9-year streamflow record in Table 11.3, assume
for n years can now be written in a form appro-
that two yields are desired, one 90% reliable and
priate for identifying any single annual yield Yp
the other 70% reliable. Let Y0.9 and Y0.7 represent
having an exceedance probability p.
those annual yields having reliabilities of 0.9 and
486 11 River Basin Modeling

0.7, respectively. The incremental secondary X 


Ey ao aSy st st 1 =2 Etmax
yield Y0.7 represents the amount in addition to t
Y0.9 that is only 70% reliable. Assume that the
11:39
problem is one of estimating the appropriate
values of Y0.9 and Y0.7, their respective This annual evaporation loss applies, of
within-year allocations ypt and the total active course, only when there is a nonzero active
reservoir capacity Ka that maximizes some storage capacity requirement. These annual
function of these yield and capacity variables. evaporation losses can be included in the
In this case the over-year andwithin-year over-year continuity constraints, such as
continuity constraints can be written Eq. 11.35. If they are, the assumption is being
made that their within-year distribution will be
Sy Qy  Y0:9  a0:7
y Y0:7  Ry Sy 1 8y
dened by the fractions t. This may not be
if y n; y 1 1 realistic. If it is not, an alternative would be to
11:35 include the average within-year period losses, Lt,
in the within-year constraints.
The average within-year period loss, Lt, can
st bt Y0:9 Y0:7  y0:9;t  y0:7;t st 1 8t be dened as the sum of each loss Lyt dened by
if t T; T 1 1 Eq. 11.38 over all years y divided by the total
11:36 number of years, n.

X
n  
Now an additional constraint is needed to Lt ao aSy st st 1 =2 Etmax =n
insure that each within-year yield of a reliability y
p adds up to the annual yield of the same relia- 11:40
bility. Selecting the 90% reliable yield,
X This average within-year period loss, Lt, can
y0:9;t Y0:9 11:37 be added to the within-years highest reliability
t
yield, ypt, forcing greater total annual yields of all
Evaporation losses must be based on an reliabilities to meet corresponding total
expected storage volume in each period and year within-year yield values. Hence, combining
since the actual storage volumes are not identi- Eq. 11.37 and 11.38, for p equal to 0.9 in the
ed using these yield models. The approximate example,
storage volume in any period t in year y can ( )
X X
n
be dened as the initial over-year volume Sy, Yp ypt ao aSy st 1 =2Etmax =n
plus the estimated average within-year volume t y

(st + st+1)/2. Substituting this storage volume 11:41


into Eq. 11.14 (see also Fig. 11.6) results in an
estimated evaporation loss Lyt. Since actual reservoir storage volumes in each
  period t of each year y are not identied in this
Lyt ao aSy st st 1 =2 Etmax model, system performance measures that are
11:38 functions of those storage volumes, such as
hydroelectric energy or reservoir recreation, are
Summing Lyt over all within-year periods t only approximate. Thus, as with any of these
denes the estimated annual evaporation loss, Ey. screening models, any set of solutions should be
11.5 Lakes and Reservoirs 487

evaluated and further improved using more pre- are for all yields, Yp, being considered, it is
cise simulation methods. necessary to determine the over-year capacities
Simulation methods require reservoir operat- and within-year storage volumes required to
ing rules. The information provided by the provide each separate within-year yield ypt.
solution of the yield model can aid in dening a Plotting the curves dened by the respective
reservoir operating policy for such simulation over-year capacity plus the within-year storage
studies. volume (Koa + st) in each within-year period t will
dene a zone of storage whose yield releases
Reservoir Operation Rules ypt from that zone should have a reliability of at
Reservoir operation rules are guides for those least p.
responsible for reservoir operation. They apply to For example, assume again a 9-year flow
reservoirs being operated in a steady-state con- record and 10 within-year periods. Of interest are
dition (i.e., not lling up immediately after con- the within-year yields, y0.9,t and y0.7,t, having
struction or being operated to meet a set of new reliabilities of 0.9 and 0.7. The rst step is to
and temporary objectives). There are several compute the over-year storage capacity require-
types of rules but each indicates the desired or ment, Koa, and the within-year storage volumes,
required reservoir release or storage volumes at st, for just the yields y0.9,t. The sum of these
any particular time of year. Some rules identify values, Koa + st, in each period t can be plotted as
storage volume targets (rule curves) that the illustrated in Fig. 11.8.
operator is to maintain, if possible, and others The sum of the over-year capacity and
identify storage zones, each associated with a within-year volume Koa + st in each period t de-
particular release policy. This latter type of rule nes the zone of active storage volumes for each
can be developed from the solution of the yield period t required to supply the within-year yields
model. y0.9,t. If the storage volume is in this shaded zone
To construct an operation rule that identies shown in Fig. 11.8, only the yields y0.9,t should
storage zones, each having a specic release be released. The reliability of these yields, when
policy, the values of the dead and flood storage simulated, should be about 0.9. If at any time
capacities, KD and Kf are needed together with t the actual reservoir storage volume is within
the over-year storage capacity, Koa, and within - this zone, then reservoir releases should not
year storage volumes st in each period t. Since exceed those required to meet the yield y0.9,t if
both Koa and all st derived from the yield model the reliability of this yield is to be maintained.

Fig. 11.8 Reservoir


release rule showing the
identication of the most
reliable release zone
associated with the
within-year yields y0.9,t
488 11 River Basin Modeling

The next step is to solve the yield model for can be made to satisfy any downstream demand.
both yields Y0.9 and Y0.7. The resulting sum of Converting storage volume to elevation, this
over-year storage capacity and within-year stor- release policy is summarized in Fig. 11.10.
age volumes can be plotted over the rst zone, as These yield models focus only on the active
shown in Fig. 11.9. storage capacity requirements. They can be a part
If at any time t the actual storage volume is in of a model that includes flood storage require-
the second lighter shaded zone in Fig. 11.9, both ments as well (as previously discussed in this
the release should be the sum of the most reliable chapter). If the actual storage volume is within
yield, y0.9,t and the incremental secondary yield the flood control zone in the flood season,
y0.7,t. If only these releases are made, the prob- releases should be made to reduce the actual
ability of being in that zone, when simulated, storage to a volume no greater than the total
should be about 0.7. If the actual storage volume capacity less the flood storage capacity.
is greater than the total required over-year stor- Once again, reservoir rules developed from
age capacity Koa plus the within-year volume st, simplied models such as this yield model are
the non-shaded zone in Fig. 11.23, then a release only guides, and once developed these rules

Fig. 11.9 Reservoir


release rule showing the
identication of the second
most reliable release zone
associated with the total
within-year yields y0.9,
t + y0.7,t

Fig. 11.10 Reservoir


release rule dened by the
yield model
11.5 Lakes and Reservoirs 489

should be simulated, evaluated, and rened prior drought links various characteristics of meteo-
to their actual adoption. rological drought to agricultural impacts, focus-
ing on precipitation shortages, differences
between actual and potential evapotranspiration,
11.6 Drought and Flood Risk and soil water decits.
Reduction Hydrological droughts are described based on
the effects of low precipitation on surface or
11.6.1 Drought Planning subsurface water supply (e.g., streamflow,
and Management reservoir storage, lake levels, and groundwater )
rather than with precipitation shortfalls. Hydro-
Droughts are natural hazards that unlike floods, logical droughts usually lag the occurrence of
tornadoes, and hurricanes, occur slowly and meteorological and agricultural droughts because
gradually over a period of time. The absence of a more time elapses before precipitation decien-
precise drought threshold introduces some cies are detected in rivers, reservoirs, ground-
uncertainty about whether a drought exists and, if water aquifers, and other components of the
it does, its degree of severity. The impacts of hydrologic system. As a result, hydrological
drought are nonstructural and typically spread droughts are typically detected later than other
over a larger geographical area than are damages drought types. Water uses affected by drought
resulting from other natural hazards. All of these can include multiple purposes such as power
drought characteristics have impacted the devel- generation, flood control, irrigation, domestic
opment of effective drought preparedness plans. drinking water, industry, recreation, and ecosys-
Droughts result from a deciency of precipi- tem preservation.
tation compared to normal (long-term average) Socioeconomic droughts are linked directly to
amounts that, when extended over a season or the supply of some economic good. Increases in
especially over a longer period of time, is population can alter substantially the demand for
insufcient to meet the demands of human these economic goods over time. The incidence
activities and the environment. All types of of socioeconomic drought can increase because
drought results in water shortages for one or of a change in the frequency of meteorological
more water-using activities. drought, a change in societal vulnerability to
Droughts differ from one another in three water shortages, or both. For example, poor land
essential characteristics: intensity, duration, and use practices such as overgrazing can decrease
spatial coverage. Moreover, many disciplinary animal carrying capacity and increase soil ero-
perspectives of drought exist. Because of these sion, which exacerbates the impacts of, and
numerous and diverse disciplinary views, con- vulnerability to, future droughts.
fusion often exists over exactly what constitutes
a drought. Regardless of such disparate views, 11.6.1.2 Drought Impacts
the overriding feature of drought is its negative The impacts of drought are often widespread
impacts on people and the environment. through the economy. They can be direct and
indirect. Restrictions in water use resulting from
11.6.1.1 Drought Types drought is a direct or rst-order impact of
Droughts are normally distinguished by type: drought. However, the consequences of such
meteorological, hydrological, agricultural, and restrictions could result in loss of income, farm
socioeconomic. Meteorological drought is and business foreclosures, and government relief
expressed solely on the basis of the degree of programs) are possible indirect second- or
dryness in comparison to some normal or aver- third-order impacts.
age amount and the duration of the dry period. The impacts of drought appear to be increas-
Drought intensity and duration are the key ing in both developing and developed countries,
descriptors of this type of drought. Agricultural which in many cases reflects the persistence of
490 11 River Basin Modeling

non-sustainable development and population southeastern Australia recently witnessed,


growth. Lessening the impacts of future drought drought management has to involve the institu-
events typically requires the development of tions that not only manage water supply systems,
drought risk policies that emphasize a wide range but all those who use water, and all those who
of water conservation and early warning mea- make land-use decisions that impact water run-
sures. Drought management techniques are often off. It can involve hydrologic modeling methods
conditional on the severity of the drought. Iden- discussed in Chap. 6, and reservoir modeling as
tifying the actions to take and the thresholds discussed in Chaps. 4 and 8. Appendix C of this
indicating when to take them are best accom- book (contained on a disk or downloadable from
plished prior to a drought, as agreements among the web) discusses drought management model-
stakeholders are easier to obtain when individu- ing methods and options in more detail.
als are not having to deal with the impacts of an
ongoing drought.
Drought impacts can be economic, environ- 11.6.2 Flood Protection
mental, and social. and Damage
Economic impacts can include direct losses to Reduction
agricultural and industrial users, losses in recre-
ation, transportation, and energy sectors. Other Next consider the other extremefloods. Two
indirect economic impacts can include resulting types of structural alternatives are often used for
unemployment and loss of tax revenue to local, flood risk reduction. One is the provision of flood
state, and federal governments. storage capacity in reservoirs designed to reduce
Environmental losses include damages to downstream peak flood flows. The other is channel
plant and animal species in natural habitats, and enhancement and/or flood-proong structures that
reduced air and water quality; an increase in are designed to contain peak flood flows and
forest and range res; the degradation of land- reduce damage. This section introduces methods
scape quality; and possible soil erosion. These of modeling both of these alternatives for inclusion
losses are difcult to quantify, but growing in either benetcost or cost-effectiveness analy-
public awareness and concern for environmental ses. The latter analyses apply to situations in which
quality has forced public ofcials to focus greater a signicant portion of the flood control benets
attention on them. cannot be expressed in monetary terms and the aim
Social impacts can involve public safety, is to provide a specied level of flood protection at
health, conflicts among water users, and inequi- minimum cost.
ties in the distribution of impacts and disaster The discussion will rst focus on the estima-
relief programs. As with all natural hazards, the tion of flood storage capacity in a single reservoir
economic impacts of drought are highly variable upstream of a potential flood damage site. This
within and among economic sectors and geo- analysis will then be expanded to include
graphic regions, producing a complex assortment downstream channel capacity improvements.
of winners and losers with the occurrence of each Each of the modeling methods discussed will be
disaster. appropriate for inclusion in multipurpose river
basin planning (optimization) models having
11.6.1.3 Drought Preparedness longer time step durations than those required to
and Mitigation predict flood peak flows.
Droughts happen, and it makes no sense to wait
until realizing a drought is happening before 11.6.2.1 Reservoir Flood Storage
preparing plans and policies to mitigate the Capacity
adverse impacts from a drought. As evidenced by In addition to the active storage capacities in a
the ongoing drought (at this writing) in Califor- reservoir, some capacity may be allocated for the
nia, and the even more severe drought those in temporary storage of flood flows during certain
11.6 Drought and Flood Risk Reduction 491

periods in the flood season of the year, as shown divided by 1000 or 10,000, respectively.
in Fig. 11.2. Flood flows usually occur over time A one-hundred-year flood or greater has a
intervals lasting from a few hours up to a few probability of 1/100 or 0.01 of occurring in any
days or weeks. Computational limitations make it given year. Assuming annual floods are inde-
impractical to include such short time durations pendent, if a 100-year flood occurs this year, the
in many of our multipurpose planning models probability that a flood of that magnitude or
that typically include time periods of a week, or greater occurring next year remains 1/100 or
10 days, or months or seasons spanning several 0.01.
months. If we modeled these short daily or If PQ is the random annual peak flood flow
hourly durations, flood routing equations would and PQT is a particular peak flood flow having a
have to be included in the model; a simple mass return period of T years, then by denition the
balance would not be sufcient. Nevertheless probability of an actual flood of PQ equaling or
there are ways of including unknown flood exceeding PQT is 1/T.
storage variables within longer period optimiza-
tion models . PrPQ  PQT 1=T 11:42
Consider a potential flood damage site along
a river. A flood control reservoir can be built The higher the return period, i.e., the more
upstream of that potential damage site. The severe the flood, the lower the probability that a
question is how much flood storage capacity, if flood of that magnitude or greater will occur.
any, should the reservoir contain. For various Equation 11.42 is plotted in Fig. 11.11.
assumed capacities and operating policies, sim- The exceedance probability distribution
ulation models can be used to predict the impact shown in Fig. 11.11 is simply 1 minus the
on the downstream flood peaks. These hydraulic cumulative distribution function FPQ() of annual
simulation models must include flood routing peak flood flows. The area under the function is
procedures from the reservoir to the downstream the mean annual peak flood flow, E[PQ].
potential damage site and the flood control op- The expected annual flood damage at a
erating policy at the reservoir. For various potential flood damage site can be estimated
downstream flood peaks, water elevations and from an exceedance probability distribution of
associated economic flood damages on the peak flood flows at that potential damage site
floodplain can be estimated. To calculate the together with a flow or stage damage function.
expected annual damages associated with any The peak flow exceedance distribution at any
upstream reservoir capacity , the probability of potential damage site will be a function of the
various damage levels being exceeded in any
year needs to be calculated.
The likelihood of a flood peak of a given
Pr [PQ > PQ T ]

magnitude or greater is often described by its


expected return period. How many years would
one expect to wait, on average, to observe 1
another flood of equal or greater than a flood of
some specied magnitude? This is the reciprocal
1/T
of the probability of observing such a flood or
0
greater in any given year. A T-year flood has a 0 PQ T
probability of being equaled or exceeded in any peak flood flow
E020121u

year of 1/T. This is the probability that could be


calculated by adding up the number of years an
annual flood of a given or greater magnitude Fig. 11.11 Probability of annual peak flood flows being
is observed, say in 1000 or 10,000 years, exceeded
492 11 River Basin Modeling

upstream reservoir flood storage capacity Kf This computational process is illustrated


and the reservoir operating policy. graphically in Fig. 11.12. The analysis requires
The probability that flood damage of FDT three input functions that are shown in quadrants
associated with a flood of return period T will be (a), (b), and (c). The dashed-line rectangles
exceeded is precisely the same as the probability dene point values on the three input functions in
that the peak flow PQT that causes the damage quadrants (a), (b), and (c) and the corresponding
will be exceeded. Letting FD be a random flood probabilities of exceeding a given level of dam-
damage variable, its probability of exceedance is ages in the lower right quadrant (d). The distri-
bution in quadrant (d) is dened by the
PrFD  FDT  1=T 11:43
intersections of these dashed-line rectangles. This
The area under this exceedance probability distribution denes the probability of equaling or
distribution is the expected annual flood damage exceeding a specied damage in any given year.
, E[FD]. The (shaded) area under the derived function is
the annual expected damage, E[FD].
Z1 The relationships between flood stage and
EFD PrFD  FDT dFDT 11:44 damage, and flood stage and peak flow, dened
0
in quadrants (a) and (b) of Fig. 11.12, must be
known. These do not depend on the flood storage

Fig. 11.12 Calculation of the expected annual flood stage-flow relation (b), and the expected probability of
damage shown as the shaded area in quadrant (d) derived exceeding an annual peak flow (c)
from the expected stage damage function (a), the expected
11.6 Drought and Flood Risk Reduction 493

capacity in an upstream reservoir. The infor- If the reservoir is a single purpose flood
mation in quadrant (c) is similar to that shown in control reservoir , the eventual tradeoff is
Fig. 11.11 dening the exceedance probabilities between the expected flood reduction benets,
of each peak flow. Unlike the other three func- Bf(Kf), and the annual costs, C(Kf), of that
tions, this distribution depends on the upstream upstream reservoir capacity. The particular
flood storage capacity and flood flow release reservoir flood storage capacity that maximizes
policy. This peak flow probability of exceedance the net benets, Bf(Kf) C(Kf), may be appro-
distribution is determined by simulating the priate from a national economic efciency per-
annual floods entering the upstream reservoir in spective but it may not be best from a local
the years of record. perspective. Those occupying the potential
The difference between the expected annual damage site may prefer a specied level of pro-
flood damage without any upstream flood storage tection from that reservoir storage capacity,
capacity and the expected annual flood damage rather than the protection that maximizes
associated with a flood storage capacity of Kf is expected annual net benets, Bf(Kf) C(Kf).
the expected annual flood damage reduction. If the upstream reservoir is to serve multiple
This is illustrated in Fig. 11.13. Knowing the purposes, say for water supply, hydropower, and
expected annual damage reduction associated recreation, as well as for flood control, the
with various flood storage capacities, Kf, permits expected flood reduction benet function just
the denition of a flood damage reduction derived could be a component in the overall
function, Bf(Kf). objective function for that reservoir.

(b) (a)

(c) (d)

Fig. 11.13 Calculation of expected annual flood damage reduction benets, shown as the darkened portion of
quadrant (d), associated with a specied reservoir flood storagecapacity
494 11 River Basin Modeling

Total reservoir capacity K will equal the sum Let QNT be the unregulated natural peak flow
of dead storage capacity Kd, active storage in the flood season having a return period of
capacity Ka, and flood storage capacity Kf, T years. Assume that this peak flood flow is the
assuming they are the same in each period t. In design flood for which protection is desired. To
some cases they may vary over the year. If the protect from this design peak flow, a portion QS of
required active storage capacity can occupy the the peak flow may be reduced by upstream flood
flood storage zone when flood protection is not storage capacity. The remainder of the peak flow
needed, the total reservoir capacity K will be the QR must be contained within the channel. Hence if
dead storage, Kd, plus the maximum of either the potential damage site s is to be protected from
(1) the actual storage volume and flood storage a peak flow of QNT, the peak flow reductions due
capacity in the flood season or (2) the actual to upstream storage, QS, and channel improve-
storage volume in non-flood season. ments, QR, must at least equal to that peak flow.

K  Kd St Kf for all periods t in flood season QNT  QS QR 11:47


plus the following period that
represents the end of The extent to which a specied upstream
the flood season
reservoir flood storage capacity reduces the de-
sign peak flow at the downstream potential
11:45 damage site can be obtained by routing the
design flood through the reservoir and the
K  Kd St for all remaining periods t channel between the reservoir and the down-
stream site. Doing this for a number of reservoir
11:46
flood storage capacities permits the denition of
a peak flow reduction function, fT(Kf).
In the above equations the dead storage
capacity, Kd, is assumed known. It is included in
the capacity Eqs. 11.45 and 11.46 assuming that QS fT Kf 11:48
the active storage capacity is greater than zero.
This function is dependent on the relative
Clearly, if the active storage capacity were zero,
locations of the reservoir and the downstream
there would be no need for dead storage.
potential damage site, on the characteristics and
length of the channel between the reservoir and
11.6.2.2 Channel Capacity
downstream site, on the reservoir flood control
The unregulated natural peak flow of a particular
operating policy, and on the magnitude of the
design flood at a potential flood damage site can be
peak flood flow.
reduced by upstream reservoir flood storage
An objective function for evaluating these two
capacity or it can be contained within the channel
structural flood control measures should include
at the potential damage site by levees and other
the cost of reservoir flood storage capacity,
channel-capacity improvements. In this section,
CostK(Kf), and the cost of channel capacity
the possibility of levees or dikes and other channel
improvements, CostR(QR), required to contain a
capacity or flood-proong improvements at a
flood flow of QR. For a single purpose, single
downstream potential damage site will be consid-
damage site, single reservoir flood control prob-
ered. The approach used will provide a means of
lem, the minimum total cost required to protect
estimating combinations of flood control storage
the potential damage site from a design flood peak
capacity in upstream reservoirs and downstream
of QNT, may be obtained by solving the model:
channel capacity improvements that together will
provide a prespecied level of flood protection at  
minimize CostK Kf CostR QR 11:49
the downstream potential damage site.
11.6 Drought and Flood Risk Reduction 495

failure. The latter depends in part on how well


the levee and its foundation is constructed. Some
levees are purposely designed to fail at certain
sites at certain flood stages to reduce the likeli-
hood of more substantial failures and flood
damages further downstream.
The probability of levee failure given the flood
stage (height) in the stream or river channel is
often modeled using two flood stages. The US
Army Corps of Engineers calls the lower stage the
probable non-failure point, PNP, and the higher
stage is called the probable failure point, PFP
Fig. 11.14 Tradeoff between minimum cost of flood
protection and flood risk, as expressed by the expected (USACE 1991). At the PNP, the probability of
return period failure is assumed to be 15%. Similarly, the
probability of failure at the PFP is assumed to be
subject to 85%. A straight-line distribution between these
two points is also assumed, as shown in
QNT  fT Kf QR 11:50 Fig. 11.15. Of course these points and distribu-
tions are at best only guesses, as not many, if any,
Equations 11.49 and 11.50 assume that a data will exist to base them on at any given site.
decision will be made to provide protection from To estimate the risk of a flood in the flood-
a design flood QNT of return period T; it is only a plain protected by a levee due to overtopping or
question of how to provide the required protec- geo-structural levee failure, the relationships
tion, i.e., how much flood storage capacity and between flood flows and flood stages in the
how much levee protection. channel and on the floodplain must be dened,
Solving Eqs. 11.47 and 11.48 for peak flows just as it had to be to carry out the analyses
QNT of various return periods T will identify the shown in Figs. 11.12 and 11.13.
risk-cost tradeoff. This tradeoff function might Assuming no geo-structural levee failure, the
look like what is shown in Fig. 11.14. flood stage in the floodplain protected by a levee
is a function of the flow in the stream or river
11.6.2.3 Estimating Risk of Levee channel, the cross sectional area of the channel
Failures between the levees on either side, the channel
Levees are built to reduce the likelihood of slope and roughness, and the levee height. If
flooding on the flood plain. Flood flows pre- floodwaters enter the floodplain, the resulting
vented from flowing over a floodplain due to a water level or stage in the floodplain will depend
levee will have relatively little effect on users of on the topological characteristics of the flood
the flood plain, unless of course the levee fails to plain. Figure 11.16 illustrates the relationship
contain the flow. Levee failure can result from between the flood stage in the channel and the
flood events that exceed (overtop) the design flood stage in the flood plain, assuming no
capacity of the levee. Failure can also result from geo-structural failure of the levee. Obviously
various types of geostructural weaknesses. If any once the flood begins overtopping the levee, the
of the flow in the stream or river channel passes flood stage in the flood plain begins to increase.
over, through or under the levee and onto the Once the flood flow is of sufcient magnitude
flood plain, the levee is said to fail. The proba- that its stage without the levee is the same as that
bility of levee failure along a river reach is in part with the levee, the existence of a levee has only a
a function of the levee height, the probability negligible impact on the flood stage.
distribution of flood flows in the stream or river Figure 11.17 illustrates the relationship
channel, and the probability of geo-structural between flood flow and flood stage in a
496 11 River Basin Modeling

Fig. 11.15 Assumed cumulative probability distribution of levee failure expressed as function of flood stage in river
channel

Fig. 11.16 Influence of a levee on the flood stage in at which the levee fails due to overtopping or from
floodplain compared to stream or river flood stage. The geo-structural causes
channel flood stage where the curve is vertical is the stage

floodplain with and without flood levees, again Combining the relationship between flood
assuming no geo-structural levee failure. flow and flood stage in the channel (upper left
Combining Figs. 11.16 and 11.17 denes the quadrant of Fig. 11.18) with the probability dis-
relationship between reach flow and channel tribution of levee failure (Fig. 11.15) and the
stage. This is illustrated in the upper left quadrant probability distribution of annual peak flows
of Fig. 11.18. being equaled or exceeded (Fig. 11.11), provides
11.6 Drought and Flood Risk Reduction 497

Fig. 11.17 Relationship


between flood flow and
flood stage in a floodplain
with and without flood
levees, again assuming no
geo-structural levee failure

Fig. 11.18 Deriving the


relation (shown in the
upper left quadrant)
between flood flow and
flood stage in the channel

an estimate of the expected probability of levee quadrant of Fig. 11.18. The probability of levee
failure. Figure 11.19 illustrates this process of failure, PLF(S), a function of flood stage, S(q),
nding, in the lower right quadrant, the shaded shown in the upper right quadrant is the same as
area that equals the expected annual probability in Fig. 11.15. The annual peak flow exceedance
of levee failure from overtopping and/or probability distribution, FQ(q), (or its inverse
geo-structural failure. Q(p)) in the lower left quadrant is the same as
The channel flood-stage function, S(q), of Fig. 11.12 or that in the lower left quadrant (c) of
peak flow q shown in the upper left quadrant of Fig. 11.13. The exceedance probability function
Fig. 11.19 is obtained from the upper left in the lower right quadrant of Fig. 11.19 is
498 11 River Basin Modeling

Fig. 11.19 Derivation of


the probability of
exceeding a given
probability of levee failure,
shown in lower right
quadrant. The shaded area
enclosed by this probability
distribution is the annual
expected probability of
levee failure

derived from each of the other three functions, as exceeding a channel flow whose stage equals the
indicated by the arrows, in the same manner as levee height, as dened in the lower left quadrant
described in Fig. 11.12. of Fig. 11.19. This is shown in Fig. 11.20.
In mathematical terms, the annual expected Referring to Fig. 11.20, if the levee height is
probability of levee failure, E[PLF], found in the increased, the horizontal part of the curve in the
lower right quadrant of Fig. 11.19, equals upper right quadrant would rise, as would the
horizontal part of the curve in the upper left
Z1 quadrant as it shifts to the left. Hence given the
EPLF PLFSqf qdq same probability distribution as dened in the
0 lower left quadrant, the expected probability of
Z1 Z1 exceeding an increased levee capacity would
PLFSQpdp PLF 0 pdp; decrease, as it should.
0 0
11:51 11.6.2.4 Annual Expected Damage
from Levee Failure
where PLF(p) is the probability of levee failure A similar analysis can provide an estimate of the
associated with a flood stage of S(q) having an expected annual flood plain damage for a stream
exceedance probability of p. or river reach. Consider, for example, a parcel of
Note that if the failure of the levee was only land on a flood plain at some location i. If an
due to channel flood stages exceeding the levee economic efciency objective were to guide the
height (i.e., if the probability of geo-structural development and use of this parcel, the owner
failure were zero) the expected probability of would want to maximize the net annual eco-
levee failure would be simply the probability of nomic benets derived from its use, Bi, less the
11.6 Drought and Flood Risk Reduction 499

Fig. 11.20 Calculation of


annual probability of
equaling or exceeding any
specied probability of
levee overtopping, shown
in the lower right quadrant.
The shaded area in this
quadrant is the expected
probability of levee
overtopping, assuming
there is no geo-structural
failure

annual (non-flood damage) costs, Ci, and the


expected annual flood damages, EADi. The issue
of concern here is the estimation of these
expected annual flood damages.
Damages at location i resulting from a flood
will depend in part on the depth of flooding at
that location and a host of other factors (flood
duration, velocity of and debris in flood flow,
time of year, etc.). Assume that the flood damage
at location i is a function of primarily the flood
stage, S, at that location. Denote this potential
damage function as Di(S). Such a function is
Fig. 11.21 An example function dening the damages
illustrated in Fig. 11.21.
that will occur given any flood stage S to a parcel of land i
Integrating the product of the annual excee-
dance probability of flood stage, Fs(S), and the
potential damages, Di(S), over all stages S will The sum of these expected damage estimates
yield the annual expected damages, E[Di], for over all the parcels of land i on the floodplain is
land parcel i. the total expected damage that one can expect
each year, on average, on the floodplain.
Z
EDi  Di SFs SdS 11:52 X
EAD EDi  11:53
i
500 11 River Basin Modeling

Alternatively the annual expected flood dam- then the function would appear as shown with
age could be based on a calculated probability of leveeovertop only in Fig. 11.22.
exceeding a specied flood damage, as shown in
Fig. 11.12. For this method the potential flood 11.6.2.5 Risk-Based Analyses
damages, Di(S), are determined for various stages Risk-based analyses attempt to identify the
S and then summed over all land parcels i for uncertainty associated with each of the inputs
each of those stage values S to obtain the total used to dene the appropriate capacities of var-
potential damage function, D(S), for the entire ious flood risk reduction measures. There are
floodplain, dened as a function of flood stage S. numerous sources of uncertainty associated with
each of the functions shown in quadrants (a), (b),
X
DS Di S 11:54 and (c) in Fig. 11.25. This uncertainty translates
i to uncertainty associated with estimates of flood
risk probabilities and expected annual flood
This is the function shown in quadrant (a) in damage reductions obtained from reservoir flood
Fig. 11.12. storage capacities and channel improvements.
Levee failure probabilities, PLF(p), based on Going to the substantial effort and cost of
the exceedance probability p of peak flows, or quantifying these uncertainties, which them-
stages, as dened in Fig. 11.31 and Eq. 11.49 selves will be surely be uncertain, does however
can be included in calculations of expected provide additional information. The design of
annual damages. Expressing the damage func- any flood protection plan can be adjusted to
tion, D(S), as a function, D(p), of the stage reflect attitudes of stakeholders toward the
exceedance probability p and multiplying this uncertainty associated with specied flood peak
flood damage function D(p) times the probabil- return periods or equivalently their probabilities
ity of levee failure, PLF(p) denes the joint of occurring in any given year.
exceedance probability of expected annual dam- For example, assume a probability distribu-
ages. Integrating over all values of p yields the tion capturing the uncertainty about the expected
expected annual flood damage, EAD. probability of exceedance of the peak flows at the
potential damage site (as shown in Fig. 11.12) is
Z1 dened from a risk-based-analysis. Figure 11.23
EAD D0 p PLF 0 p dp 11:55 shows that exceedance function together with its
0 90% condence bands near the higher flood peak
return periods. To be, say, 90% sure that pro-
Note that the flood plain damages and prob- tection is provided for the T-year return period
ability of levee failure functions in Eq. 11.55 flow, PQT, one may have to for an equivalent
both increase with increasing flows or stages, but expected T + year return period flow, PQT+,
as peak flows or stages increase, their exceedance i.e., the flow having a (1/T) expected prob-
probabilities decrease. Hence with increasing ability of being exceeded. Conversely, protection
p the damage and levee failure probability from the expected T + year peak flood flow
functions decrease. The effect of levees on the will provide 90% assurance of protection from
expected annual flood damage, EAD, is shown in flows that will occur less than once in T years on
Fig. 11.22. The without levee function in the average.
lower right quadrant of Fig. 11.18, is D(p). The If society wanted to eliminate flood damage it
with levee function is the product of D(p) and could do it, but at a high cost. This would require
PLF(p). If the probability of levee failure, PLF either costly flood control structures or elimi-
(p) function were as shown in Fig. 11.18, i.e., if nating economic activities on lands subject to
it were 1.0 for values of p below some overtop- possible flooding. Both reduce expected eco-
ping stage associated with an exceedance prob- nomic returns from the floodplain. Hence such
ability p*, and 0 for values of p greater than p*, actions are not likely to be taken. There will
11.6 Drought and Flood Risk Reduction 501

Fig. 11.22 Calculation of


expected annual flood
damage taking into account
probability of levee failure

always be a risk of flood damage. Analyses such eliminated. Finding the best levels of flood pro-
as those just presented help identify these risks. tection and flood risk, together with risk insur-
Risks can be reduced and managed but not ance or subsidies (illustrated in Fig. 11.24) is the
challenge for public and private agencies alike.
Floodplain management is as much concerned
with good things not happening on them as with
Pr [PQ > PQT ]

bad thingslike floodshappening on them.


90% confidence
1 estimates

1/T
1/T-
0
0 PQ T PQT+
peak flood flow
E020 130h

Fig. 11.23 Portion of peak flow probability of excee-


dance function showing contours containing 90% of the
uncertainty associated with this distribution. To be 90% Fig. 11.24 Relationship between expected economic
certain of protection from a peak flow of PQt, protection return from flood plain use and risk of flooding. The
is needed from the higher peak flow, PQt+ expected once lowest flood risk does not always mean the best risk, and
every T + years, i.e., with an annual probability of 1/ what risk is acceptable may depend on the amount of
(T + ) or (1/T) of being equaled or exceeded insurance or subsidy provided when flood damage occurs
502 11 River Basin Modeling

11.7 Hydroelectric Power environmental impacts. Potential environmental


Production impacts of hydropower projects include altered
flow regimes below storage reservoirs or within
Hydropower plants, Fig. 11.25, convert the diverted stream reaches, water quality degrada-
energy from the flowing water to mechanical and tion, mortality of sh that pass through turbines,
then electrical energy. These plants containing blockage of sh migration, and flooding of ter-
turbines and generators are typically located restrial ecosystems by impoundments. However,
either in or adjacent to dams. Pipelines (pen- in many cases, proper design and operation of
stocks) carry water under pressure from the hydropower projects can mitigate some of these
reservoir to the powerhouse. Power transmission impacts. Hydroelectric projects can also provide
systems transport the produced electrical energy additional benets such as from recreation in
from the powerhouse to where it is needed. reservoirs or in tailwaters below dams.
The principal advantages of using hydro- Hydropower plants can be either conventional
power are the absence of polluting emissions or pumped storage. Conventional hydropower
during operation, its capability to respond rela- plants use the available water from a river, stream,
tively quickly to changing utility load demands, canal system, or reservoir to produce electrical
and its relatively low operating costs. Disad- energy. In conventional multipurpose reservoirs
vantages can include high initial capital cost and and run-of-river systems, hydropower production
potential site-specic and cumulative is just one of many competing purposes for which

Fig. 11.25 Hydropower system components


11.7 Hydroelectric Power Production 503

water resources may be used. Competing water flow, head, and plant efciency to electrical energy.
uses may include irrigation, flood control, navi- The kilowatt-hours of energy, KWHt, produced in
gation, downstream flow dilution for quality period t is proportional to the product of the plant
improvement, and municipal and industrial water efciency, e, the productive storage head Ht, and
supply. Pumped storage plants pump the water, the flow qt through the turbines.
usually through a reversible turbine that acts as a A cubic meter of water, weighing l03 kg,
pump, from a lower supply source to an upper falling a distance of 1 m, acquires 9.81 103 J
reservoir. While pumped storage facilities are net (nm) of kinetic energy. The energy generated in
energy consumers, they are income producers. one second equals the watts (joules per second)
They are valued by a utility because they can be of power produced. Hence an average flow of qt
brought online rapidly to operate in a peak power cubic meters per second falling a height of Ht
production mode when energy prices are the meters in period t yields 9.81 103qtHt watts or
highest. The pumping to replenish the upper 9.81 qtHt kilowatts of power. Multiplying by the
reservoir is performed during off-peak hours number of hours in period t yields the
when electricity costs are low. Then they are kilowatt-hours of energy produced given a head
released through the power plant when the elec- of Ht and an average flow rate of qt. The total
tricity prices are higher. The system makes kilowatt-hours of energy, KWHt, produced in
money even though it consumes more energy. period t assuming 100% efciency in conversion
This process benets the utility by increasing the of potential to electrical energy is
load factor and reducing the cycling of its base
load units. In most cases, pumped storage plants KWHt 9:81 qt Ht seconds in period t=
run a full cycle every 24 h (DOE 2002). seconds per hour
Run-of-river projects use the natural flow of 9:81 qt Ht seconds in period t=3600
the river and produce relatively little change in
11:56
the stream channel and stream flow. A peaking
project impounds and releases water when the Since the total flow, QTt through the turbines
energy is needed. A storage project extensively in period t, equals the average flow rate qt times
impounds and stores water during high-flow the number of seconds in the period, the total
periods to augment the water available during kilowatt-hours of energy produced in period
low-flow periods, allowing the flow releases and t given a plant efciency (fraction) of e equals
power production to be more constant. Many
projects combine the modes. KWHt 9:81 QTt Ht e=3600
The power capacity of a hydropower plant is 0:002725 QTt Ht e 11:57
primarily the function of the flow rate through
the turbines and the hydraulic head. The The energy required for pumped storage,
hydraulic head is the elevation difference the where instead of producing energy the turbines
water falls (drops) in passing through the plant or are used to pump water up to a higher level, is
to the tailwater, which ever elevation difference
is less. Project design may concentrate on either KWHt 0:002725 QTt Ht =e 11:58
of these flow and head variables or both, and on
the hydropower plant installed designed capacity. For Eqs. 11.57 and 11.58, QTt is expressed in
The production of hydroelectric energy during cubic meters and Ht is in meters. The storage
any period at any particular reservoir site is head, Ht, is the vertical distance between the
dependent on the installed plant capacity; the flow water surface elevation in the lake or reservoir
through the turbines; the average effective pro- that is the source of the flow through the turbines
ductive storage head; the duration of the period; the and the maximum of either the turbine elevation
plant factor (the fraction of time energy is pro- or the downstream discharge elevation. In vari-
duced); and a constant for converting the product of able head reservoirs, storage heads are functions
504 11 River Basin Modeling

of storage volumes (and possibly the reservoir during each period t. This factor is usually
release if the tailwater elevation affects the head). specied by those responsible for energy pro-
In optimization models for capacity planning, duction and distribution. It may or may not vary
these heads and the turbine flows are among the for different time periods.
unknown variables. The energy produced is The total energy produced cannot exceed the
proportional to the product of these two product of the plant factor pt, the number of
unknown variables. This results in non-separable hours, ht, in the period, and the plant capacity P,
functions in model equations that must be written measured in kilowatts.
at each hydroelectric site for each time period t.
A number of ways have been developed to KWHt  P ht pt 11:60
convert these non-separable energy production
functions to separable ones for use in linear
optimization models for estimating design and 11.8 Withdrawals and Diversions
operating policy variable values. These methods
inevitably increase the number of model variables Major demands for the withdrawal of water
and constraints. For a preliminary screening of include those for domestic or municipal uses,
hydropower capacities prior to a more detailed industrial uses (including cooling water), and
analysis (e.g., using simulation or other nonlinear agricultural uses including iirrigation. These uses
or discrete dynamic programming methods) one generally require the withdrawals of water from a
can (1) solve the model using both optimistic and river system, from reservoirs, or from other sur-
pessimistic assumed xed head values, (2) com- face or groundwater bodies. The water withdrawn
pare the actual derived heads with the assumed may be only partially consumed, and that which is
ones and adjust the assumed heads, (3) resolve the not consumed may be returned, perhaps at a dif-
model, and (4) compare the capacity values. From ferent site, at a later time period, and containing
this iterative process, one should be able to different concentrations of constituents.
identify the range of hydropower capacities that Water can also be allocated to instream uses
can then be further rened using simulation. that alter the distribution of flows in time and
Alternatively average heads, Hot , and flows, space. Such uses include (1) reservoir storage,
o
Qt , can be used in a linear approximation of the possibly for recreational use as well as for water
non-separable product terms, QTt Ht. supply; (2) for flow augmentation, possibly for
water quality control or for navigation or for
QTt Ht Hto QTt Qot Ht  Qot Hto 11:59 ecological benets; and (3) for hydroelectric
power production. The instream uses may com-
Again, the model may need to be solved plement or compete with each other or with
several times in order to identify reasonably various off-stream municipal, industrial, and
accurate average flow and head estimates, Qot and agricultural demands. One purpose of developing
Hot , in each period t. management models of river basin systems is to
The amount of electrical energy produced is help derive policies that will best serve these
limited by the installedkilowatts of plant capacity multiple uses, or at least identify the tradeoffs
P as well as on the plant factor pt. The plant among the multiple purposes and objectives.
factor is a measure of hydroelectric power plant The allocated flow qst to a particular use at site
use in each time period. Its value depends on the s in period t must be no greater than the total flow
characteristics of the power system and the available, Qst , that site and in that period.
demand pattern for hydroelectric energy. The
plant factor is dened as the average power load qst  Qst 11:61
on the plant for the period divided by the
installed plant capacity. The plant factor accounts The quantity of water that any particular user
for the variability in the demand for hydropower expects to receive in each particular period is
11.8 Withdrawals and Diversions 505

termed the target allocation. Given a annual or growing season target allocation Ts
multi-period (e.g., annual) known or unknown would be low (or zero) and presumably so would
target allocation Ts at site s, some (usually be the benets associated with that target value.
known) fraction, fst , of that target allocation will Water stored in reservoirs can often be used to
be expected in period t. If the actual allocation, augment downstream flows for instream uses
qst , is less than the target allocation, fst Ts, there such as recreation, navigation, and water quality
will be a decit, Dst . If the allocation is greater control. During natural low-flow periods in the
than the target allocation, there will be an excess, dry season, it is not only the increased volume
Est . Hence, to dene those unknown variables the but also the lower temperature of the augmented
following constraint equation can be written for flows that may provide the only means of
each applicable period t. maintaining certain species of sh and other
aquatic life. Dilution of wastewater or runoff
qst fts T s Dst Ets 11:62 from non-point sources may be another potential
benet from flow augmentation. These and other
Even though allowed, one would not expect a factors related to water quality management are
solution to contain nonzero values for both Dst discussed in greater detail in Chap. 10.
and Est . The benets derived from navigation on a
Whether or not any decit or excess allocation potentially navigable portion of a river system
should be allowed at any demand site s depends can usually be expressed as a function of the
on the quantity of water available and the losses stage or depth of water in various periods.
or penalties associated with decit or excess al- Assuming known stream or river flow-stage
locations to that site. At sites where the benets relationships at various sites in the river, a pos-
derived in each period are independent of the sible constraint might require at least a minimum
allocations in other periods, the losses associated acceptable depth, and hence flow, for those sites.
with decits and the losses or benets associated
with excesses can be dened in each period
t (Chap. 9). For example, the benets derived 11.9 Lake-Based Recreation
from the allocation of water for hydropower
production in period t in some cases will be Recreation benets derived from natural lakes as
essentially independent of previous allocations. well as reservoirs are usually dependent on their
For any use in which the benets are depen- storage levels. Where recreational facilities have
dent on a sequence of allocations, such as at been built, recreational benets will also be
irrigation sites, the benets may be based on the dependent on recreational target lake levels as
annual (or growing season) target water alloca- well. If docks, boathouses, shelters, and other
tions Ts and their within season distributions, recreational facilities were installed based on
fst Ts. In these cases one can dene the benets some assumed (target) lake level, and the lake
from those water uses as functions of the levels deviate from the target value, there can be
unknown season or annual targets, Ts, where the reduced recreational benets. These storage tar-
allocated flows qst must be no less than the gets and any deviations can be modeled similar to
specied fraction of that unknown target. Eq. 11.62. The actual storage volume at the
beginning of a recreation period t equals the target
qst  fts T s for all relevant t 11:63
storage volume less any decit or plus any excess.
If, for any reason, an allocation variable value Sst T s  Dst Ets 11:64
qst must be low, or even zero, due to other more
benecial uses, then clearly from Eq. 11.63 the
506 11 River Basin Modeling

The recreational benets in any recreational facilitated by drawing a schematic of the system
period t can be dened based on what they would at the level of detail that will address the issues
be if the target were met less the average of any being discussed and of concern to these stake-
losses that may occur from initial and nal holders. This schematic can be drawn over the
storage volume deviations, Dst or Est , from the basin as in Fig. 11.27. The schematic without the
target storage volume in each period of the basin is illustrated in Fig. 11.28.
recreation season (Chap. 9). A site number must be assigned at each point
of interest. These sites are usually where some
decision must be made. Mass balance and other
11.10 Model Synthesis constraints will need to be dened at each of
those sites.
Each of the model components discussed above As shown in the schematic in Fig. 11.28, this
can be combined, as applicable, into a model of a river has one streamflow gage site, site 1, two
river system. One such river system together with reservoirs, sites 3 and 5, two diversions, sites 2
some of its interested stakeholders is shown in and 3, one hydropower plant, site 5, and a levee
Fig. 11.26. desired at site 4 to help protect against floods in
One of the rst tasks in modeling this basin is the urban area. The reservoir at site 5 is a
to identify the actual and potential system com- pumped storage facility. The upstream reservoir
ponents and their interdependencies. This is at site 3 is used for recreation, water supply, and

Fig. 11.26 A multipurpose river system whose management is of concern to numerous stakeholders
11.10 Model Synthesis 507

Fig. 11.27 A schematic representation of the basin components and their interdependencies drawn over the map
image of the basin

Fig. 11.28 Schematic of


river system showing
components of interest at
designated sites
508 11 River Basin Modeling

flood control. The downstream reservoir is This objective function does not identify how
strictly for hydropower production. much each stakeholder group would benet and
Before developing a model of this river sys- how much they would pay. Who benets and
tem, the number of time periods t to include in who pays, and by how much, may matter. If it is
the model and the length of each within-year known how much of each of the net benets
time period should be determined. If a river derived from each site are to be allocated to each
systems reservoirs are to contain storage for the stakeholder group i, then these allocated fraction,
distribution of water among years, called fi, of the total net benets, NBs, can be included
over-year storage, then a number of periods in the overall objective:
encompassing multiple years of operation must X X
be included in the model. This will allow an Maximize wi fi NBs 11:66
evaluation of the possible benets of storing i s

excess water in wet years for release in dry years.


Using methods discussed in Chap. 9, solving
Many reservoir systems completely ll almost
the model for various assumed values of these
every year, and in such cases one is concerned
weights can help identify the tradeoffs between
only with the within-year operation of the sys-
different conflicting objectives, Eq. 11.65, or
tem. This is the problem addressed here. To
conflicting stakeholder interests, Eq. 11.66.
model the within-year operation of the system, a
The next step in model development is to
year is divided into a number of within-year
dene the constraints applicable at each site. It is
periods. The number of the periods and the
convenient to begin at the most upstream sites
duration of each period will depend on the
and work downstream. As additional variables or
variation in the hydrology, the demands, and on
functions are needed, invent notation for them.
the particular objectives, as previously discussed.
These constraints tie the decision variables
Once the number and duration of the time
together and identify the interdependencies
steps to be modeled have been identied, the
among system components. In this example the
variables and functions used at each site must be
site index is shown as a superscript.
named. It is convenient to use notation that can
be remembered when examining the model
At site 1:
solutions. The notation made up for this example
is shown in Table 11.4. No constraints are needed. It is the gage site.
For this example assume we are interested in
maximizing a weighted combination of all the At site 2:
net economic benets derived from all the des- the diverted water, X2(t), cannot exceed the
ignated uses of water. There could, and no doubt streamflow, Q2(t), at that site.
should, be other objective components dened as
well, as discussed in Chap. 9. Nevertheless these Q2 t  X 2 t 8t in the irrigation season
economic objective components serve the pur- 11:67
pose here of illustrating how a model of this river
system can be constructed: the diversion flow, X2(t), cannot exceed the
The overall objective might be a weighted diversion channel capacity, X2.
combination of all net benets, NBs, obtained at
each site s in the basin: X 2  X 2 t 8t in the irrigation season
X 11:68
Maximize ws NBs 11:65
s
11.10 Model Synthesis 509

Table 11.4 Names associated with required variables and functions at each site in Fig. 11.28

The units of these variables and parameters, however dened, must be consistent
510 11 River Basin Modeling

the diversion flow, X2(t), must meet the irri- At site 4:


gation target, 2t T2
dene decit diversion, D4(t), from site 3,
associated with target, 4t T4, if any.
X 2 t  d2t T 2 8t in the irrigation season
11:69 X 3 t d4t T 4  D4 t 8t 11:74

NB2 = benet function associated with the channel capacity, Q4, must equal peak flood
annual target irrigation allocation, T2, less the flow, PQ4t , associated with selected return
annual cost function associated with the period, T.
diversion channel capacity, X2.
Q4 PQ4T 11:75
At site 3:
storage volume mass balances (continuity of NB4 = sum of annual benet functions for T4
storage), assuming no losses. less annual cost of Q4 less annual losses
associated with all D4(t).
S3 t 1 S3 t Q3 tX 3 tR3 t
8t; T 1 1 At site 5:
11:70 continuity of pumped storage volumes,
involving inflows, QI5(t), and outflows,
dene storage decits, D3(t), and excesses, QO5(t), and assuming no losses.
E3(t), relative to recreation target, T3.
S5 t 1 S5 t QI 5 t  QO5 t 8t
3 3 3 3
S t T  D t E t 11:76
8t in recreation season plus 11:71
following period: active storage capacity involving dead stor-
age, K5D.
diverted water, X3(t), cannot exceed diversion
channel capacity, X3. S5 t  K 5  KD5 8t 11:77

X 3 t  X 3 8t 11:72 pumped inflows, QI5(t), cannot exceed the


amounts of water available at the intake. This
reservoir storage capacity constraints involv- includes the release from the upstream reser-
ing dead storage, K3D, and flood storage, K3F, voir, R3(t), and the incremental flow,
capacities. Q5(t) Q3(t).

S3 t  K 3  KD3  KF3 QI 5 t  Q5 t  Q3 t R3 t 8t
8t in flood season plus following period: 11:78
S3 t  K 3  KD3
for all other periods t:
dene the energy produced, EP5(t), given the
average storage head, H(t), flow through the
11:73
turbines, QO5(t), and efciency, e.
NB3 = sum of annual benet functions for T3
EP5 t const:HtQO5 te 8t
and K3F less annual costs of K3 and X3 less
annual recreation losses associated with all 11:79
D3(t) and E3(t).
11.10 Model Synthesis 511

dene the energy consumed, EC5(t), from the functions in the objective function compo-
pumping given the amount pumped, QI5(t). nents and constraints. Models of this size and
complexity, even though this is a rather simple
EC 5 t const:HtQI 5 t=e 8t river system, are usually solved using linear
11:80 programming algorithms simply because other
nonlinear or dynamic programming (optimiza-
Energy production, EP5(t), and consumption, tion) methods are more difcult to use.
EC5(t), constraints given power plant capac- The model just developed is for a typical
ity, P5. single year. In some cases it may be more
appropriate to incorporate over-year as well as
EP5 t  P5 hours of energy production in t within-year mass balance constraints, and yields
8t with their respective reliabilities, within this
11:81 modeling framework. This can be done as out-
lined in Sect. 5.4 of this chapter.
The information derived from optimization
EC 5 t  P5 hours of pumping in t 8t models of river systems such as this one should
11:82 not be considered as a nal answer. Rather it is
an indication of the range of system design and
Dene the average storage head, H(t), based operation policies that should be further analyzed
on storage head functions, h(S5(t)). using more detailed analyses. Optimization
models of the type just developed serve as ways
 5 5

Ht hS t 1 hS t =2 8t to eliminate inferior alternatives from further
consideration more than as ways of nding a
11:83
solution all stakeholders will accept as the best.
NB5 = Sum of benets for the energy pro-
duced, EP5(t), less the costs of the energy
consumed, EC5(t), less the annual costs of
11.11 Project Scheduling
capacities K5 and P5.
The river basin models discussed thus far in this
chapter deal with static planning situations in that
Equations 11.6711.83 together with objec-
system components and their capacities once
tive Eq. 11.65 or 11.66 dene the general
determined are not assumed to change over time.
structure of this river system model. Before the
Project capacities, targets, and operating policies
model can be solved, the actual functions must
take on xed values and one examines snapshot
be dened. Then they may have to be made
steady-state solutions for a particular time in the
piecewise linear if linear programming is to be
future. These snapshots only allow for fluctua-
the optimization procedure used to solve the
tions caused by the variability of supplies and
model. The process of dening functions may
demands. The non-hydrologic world is seldom
add variables and constraints to the model, as
static, however. Targets and goals and policies
discussed in Chaps. 4 and 9.
change in response to population growth, invest-
For T within-year periods t, this static model
ment in agriculture and industry, and shifting
of a single year includes between 14T + 8 and
priorities for water use. In addition, nancial
16T + 5 constraints, depending on the number of
resources available for water resources investment
periods in the irrigation and recreation seasons.
are limited and may vary from year to year.
This number does not include the additional
Dynamic planning models can aid those
constraints that surely will be needed to dene
responsible for the long-run development and
512 11 River Basin Modeling

expansion of water resources systems. Although dependent on what else is happening in the basin,
static models can identify target values and sys- i.e., what other projects are present and how they
tem conguration designs for a particular period are designed and operated.
in the future, they are not well adapted to Consider a situation in which n xed-scale
long-run capacity expansion planning over a 10-, discrete projects may be built during the planning
20-, or 30-year period. But static models may period. The scheduling problem is to determine
identify projects for implementation in early which of the projects to build and in what order.
years which in later year simulations do not The solution of this problem generally requires a
appear in the solutions (Chap. 4 contains an resolution of the timing problem. When should
example of this). each project be built, if at all?
This is the common problem in capacity For example, assume there are n = 3 discrete
expansion, where each project has a xed con- projects that might be benecial to implement
struction and implementation cost as well as sometime over the next 20 years. Let this 20-year
variable operating, repair, and maintenance cost period consists of four 5-year construction peri-
component. If there are two mutually exclusive ods y. The actual benets derived from any new
competing projects, one may be preferred at a project may depend on the projects that already
site when the demand at that site is low, but the exist. Let S be the set of projects existing at the
other may be preferred if the demand is, as it is beginning of any construction period. Finally let
later projected to be, much higher. Which of the Nay(S) be the maximum present value of the total
two projects should be selected now when the net benets derived in construction period y as-
demand is low, given the uncertainty of the sociated with the projects in the set S. Here
projected increase over time, especially assuming benets refer to any composite of system
it makes no economic sense to destroy and performance measures.
replace a project already built? These benet values for various combinations
Whereas static models consider how a water discrete projects could be obtained from static
resources system operates under a single set of river system models, solved for all combinations
xed conditions, dynamic expansion models of discrete projects for conditions existing at the
must consider the sequence of changing condi- end of each of these four 5-year periods. It might
tions that might occur over the planning period. be possible to just do this for one or two of these
For this reason, dynamic expansion models are four periods and apply applicable discount rates
potentially more complex and larger than are for the other periods. These static models can be
their static counterparts. However, to keep the similar to those discussed in the previous section
size and cost of dynamic models within the of this chapter. Now the challenge is to nd the
limitations of most studies, these models are sequencing of these three projects over the peri-
generally restricted to very simple descriptions of ods y that meet budget constraints and that
the economic and hydrologic variables of con- maximize the total present value of benets.
cern. Most models use deterministic hydrology This problem can be visualized as a network.
and are constrained either to stay within prede- As shown in Fig. 11.29, the nodes of this net-
termined investment budget constraints or to work represent the sets S of projects that exist at
meet predetermined future demand estimates. the beginning of the construction period. For
Dynamic expansion models can be viewed as these sets S we have the present value of their
network models for solution by linear or dynamic benets, NBy(S), in the next 5-years. The links
programming methods. The challenge in river represent the project or projects implemented in
system capacity expansion or projectscheduling that construction period. Any set of new projects
models is that each components performance, or that exceeds the construction funds available for
benets, may depend on the design and operating that period is not shown on the network. Those
characteristics of other components in the sys- links are infeasible. For the purposes of this
tem. River basin project impacts tend to be example, assume it is not nancially feasible to
11.11 Project Scheduling 513

Fig. 11.29 Project scheduling options. Numbers in nodes represent existing projects. Links represent new projects, the
difference between the existing projects at both connecting nodes

add more than one project in any single con- The optimal is to nd the best (maximum
struction period. Let Cky be the present value of benets less costs) paths through the network.
the cost of implementing project k in construc- Each link represents a net benet, NBy(S)
tion period y. over the next 5-years obtained from the set of
514 11 River Basin Modeling

projects, S, that exist less the cost of adding a $y = the maximum project implementation
new project k. funds available in period y.
Using linear programming, one can dene a Fy(S) = the present value of the total benets
continuous nonnegative unknown decision vari- over the remaining periods, y, y + 1, , 4.
able Xij for each link between node i and node j. FY+1(S) = 0 for all sets of projects S following
It will be an indicator of whether a link is on the the end of the last period.
optimum path or not. If after solving the model The recursive equations for each construction
its value is 1, the link connecting nodes i and period, beginning with the last period, can be
j represents the decision to make in that con- written
struction period. Otherwise its value is 0 indi- X
cating the link is not on the optimal path. The Fy S maximum fNBy S  Cky Fy 1 S sg
k2s
sequence of links having their Xij values equal to X
1 will indicate the most benecial sequence of for all S s 62 S Cky  $y
k2s
project implementations.
11:87
Let the net benets associated with node i be
designated NBi (that equals the appropriate
Dening Fy(S) as the present value of the
NBy(S) value), and the cost, Cky, of the new
total benets of all new projects in the set S im-
project k associated with that link. The objective
plemented in all periods up to and including
is to maximize the present value of net bene-
period y, and the subset s of projects k being
ts less project implementation costs over all
considered in period y now belonging to the set
periods y.
S of projects existing at the end of the period, the
XX recursive equations for a forward moving solu-
Maximize NBi  Cij Xij 11:84
tion procedure beginning with the rst period,
i j
can be written
Subject to X
Fy0 S maximumf NBy S  s  0
Ck;y Fy1 Ssg
Continuity at each node k2s
X
X X for all S s2S Cky  $y
Xhi Xij k2s
h j 11:85 11:88
for each node i in the network:
where F0(0) = 0.
Sum of all decision variable values on the Like the linear programming model, the
links in any one period y must be 1. For example solutions of these dynamic programming models
in period 1 identify the sequencing of projects recognizing
their interdependencies. Of interest, again, is
X00 X01 X02 X03 1 11:86
what to do in this rst constriction period. The
only reason for looking into the future is to make
The sums in Eq. 11.86 are over nodes h hav-
sure, as best as one can that the rst periods
ing links to node i and over nodes j having links
decisions are not myopic. Models like these can
from node i.
be developed and solved again with more upda-
The optimal path through this network can
ted estimates of future conditions when next
also be solved using dynamic programming.
needed.
(Refer to the capacity expansion problem illus-
Additional constraints and variables might be
trated in Chap. 4). For a backward moving
added to these scheduling models to enforce
solution procedure, let
requirements that some projects precede others or
s = subset of projects k not contained in the
that if one project is built another is infeasible.
set S (s 62 S).
11.11 Project Scheduling 515

These additional restrictions usually reduce the References


size of a network of feasible nodes and links, as
shown in Fig. 11.29. Haasnoot, M., Kwakkel, J. H., Walker, W. E., & ter Maat,
Another issue that these dynamic models can J. (2013). Dynamic adaptive policy pathways: A
address is the sizing or capacity expansion method for crafting robust decisions for a deeply
uncertain world. Global environmental Change, 23,
problem. Frequently, the scale or capacity of a
485498.
reservoir, pipeline, pumping station, or irrigation Maidment, D. R. (1993). Handbook of hydrology. NY:
is variable and needs to be determined concur- McGraw-Hill Inc.
rently with the solution of the scheduling and Rippl, W. (1883). The capacity of storage reservoirs for
water supply. In Proceedings of the Institute of Civil
timing problems. To solve the sizing problem,
Engineers (Brit.) (Vol. 71).
the costs and capacities in the scheduling model U.S. DOE. (2002, April). Hydropower program. http://
become variables. hydropower.inel.gov or http://hydropower.id.doe.gov/
This project scheduling problem by its very USACE. (1991). Hydrology and hydraulics workshop on
Riverine Levee Freeboard, Monticello, Minnesota,
nature must deal with uncertainty. A relatively
Report SP-24, Hydrologic Engineering Center, US
recent contribution to this literature is the work of Army Corps of Engineers, 272 pp.
Haasnoot et al. (2013), Walker et al. (2013). Walker, W. E., Haasnoot, M., & Kwakkel, J. H. (2013).
Adapt or Perish: A review of planning approaches for
adaptation under deep uncertainty. Sustainability, 5,
955979.
11.12 Conclusions

This chapter on river basin planning models Additional References


introduces some ways of modeling river basin (Further Reading)
components, separately and together within an
integrated model. Ignored during the develop-
Becker, L., & Yeh, W. W. G. (1974). Timing and sizing
ment of these different model types were the of complex water resource systems. Journal of the
uncertainties associated with the results of these Hydraulics Division, ASCE , 100(HYIO), 14571470.
models. As discussed in Chaps. 7 and 8, these Becker, L., & Yeh, W. W.-G. (1974a). Optimal timing,
sequencing, and sizing of multiple reservoir surface
uncertainties may have a substantial effect on water supply facilities. Water Resources Research, 10
model solution and the decision taken. (1), 5762.
Most of this chapter has been focused on the Bedient, P. B., & Huber, W. C. (1992). Hydrology and
development of simplied screening models, floodplain analysis (2nd ed.). Reading: Addison
Westley.
using simulation as well as optimization methods, Basson, M. S., Allen, R. B., Pegram, G. G. S., & van
for identifying what and where and when infras- Rooyen, J. A. (1994). Probabilistic management of
tructure projects should be implemented, and of water resource and hydropower systems. Highlands
what capacity. The solution of these screening Ranch: Water Resources Publications.
Chin, D. A. (2000). Water-resources engineering. Upper
models, and any associated sensitivity and uncer- Saddle River: Prentice Hall.
tainty analyses, can be of value prior to committing Erlenkotter, D. (1973a). Sequencing of interdependent
to more costly design modeling exercises. hydroelectric projects. Water Resources Research, 9
Preliminary screening of river basin systems, (1), 2127.
Erlenkotter, D. (1973b). Sequencing expansion projects.
especially given multiple objectives, is a chal- Operations Research, 21(2), 542553.
lenge to accomplish in an efcient and effective Erlenkotter, D. (1976). Coordinating scale and sequencing
manner. The modeling methods and approaches decisions for water resources projects. Economic Model-
discussed in this chapter serve as an introduc- ing for Water Policy Evaluation, NorthHolland/TIMS
Studies in the Management Sciences, 3, 97112.
tion to that art.
516 11 River Basin Modeling

Erlenkotter, D,. & Rogers, J. S. (1977). Sequencing Viessman, W., Jr., & Welty, C. (1985). Water management
competitive expansion projects. Operations Research, technology and institutions. NY: Harper & Row, Pubs.
25(6), 937951. Wurbs, R. A., & James, W. P. (2002). Water resources
Hall, W. A., Tauxe, G. W., & Yeh, W. W.-G. (1969). An engineering. Upper Saddle River: Prentice Hall.
alternative procedure for optimization of operations
for planning with multiple river, multiple purpose
systems. Water Resources Research, 5(6), 13671372.
Jacoby, H. D., & Loucks, D. P. (1972). Combined use of Exercises
optimization and simulation models in river basin
planning. Water Resources Research, 8(6), 14011414.
James, L. D., & Lee, R. R. (1971). Economics of water
11:1 Using the following information pertain-
resources planning. New York: McGraw-Hill Book ing to the drainage area and discharge in
Company. the Han River in South Korea, develop an
Linsley, R. K., Franzini, J. B., Freyberg, D. L., & equation for predicting the natural unreg-
Tchobanoglous, G. (1992). Water-resources engineer-
ing. NY: McGraw-Hill Inc. ulated flow at any site in the river, by
Loucks, D. P. (1976). Surface water quantity manage- plotting average flow as a function of
ment, Chap. 5. In A. K. Biswas (Ed.), Systems catchment area. What does the slope of the
approach to water management. New York: function equal?
McGraw-Hill Book Company.
Loucks, D. P., Stedinger, J. R., & Haith, D. A. (1981).
Water resource systems planning and analysis. Engle- Gage point Catchment Average flow
wood Cliffs: Prentice Hall Inc. area (km2) (106 m3/year)
Major, D. C., & Lenton, R. L. (1979). Applied water First bridge of 25,047 17,860
resources systems planning. Englewood Cliffs: Pren- the Han River
tice Hall Inc.
Maass, A., Hufschmidt, M. M., Dorfman, R., Thomas, H. A., Pal Dang dam 23,713 16,916
Jr., Marglin, S. A., & Fair, G. M. (1962). Design of water So Yang dam 2703 1856
resource systems. Cambridge: Harvard University Press.
Chung Ju dam 6648 4428
Mays, L. W. (2001). Water resources engineering. NY:
Wiley. Yo Ju dam 10,319 7300
Mays, L. W., & Tung, Y.-K. (1992). Hydrosystems Hong Chun dam 1473 1094
engineering and management. NY: McGraw-Hill Inc.
Morin, T. L. (1973). Optimal Sequencing of Capacity Dal Chun dam 1348 1058
Expansion Projects. Journal of the Hydraulics Divi- Kan Yun dam 1180 926
sion, ASCE, 99(HY9), 16051622.
Im Jae dam 461 316
Morin, T. L., & Esogbue, A. M. O. (1974). A useful theorem
in the dynamic programming solution of sequencing and
scheduling problems occurring in capital expenditure
planning. Water Resources Research, 10(1), 4950. 11:2 In watersheds characterized by signicant
National Research Council. (1999). New strategies for
Americas Watersheds. Washington, DC: National elevation changes, one can often develop
Academy Press. reasonable predictive equations for average
National Research Council. (2000). Risk analysis and annual runoff per hectare as a function of
uncertainty in flood damage reduction studies. Wash-
elevation. Describe how one would use such
ington, DC: National Academy Press.
OLaoghaire, D. T., & Himmelblau, D. M. (1974). a function to estimate the natural average
Optimal expansion of a water resources system. annual flow at any gage in a watershed
New York: Academic Press Inc. which is marked by large elevation changes
ReVelle, C. (1999). Optimizing reservoir resources. NY:
and little loss of water from stream channels
Wiley.
Thomas, H. A., Jr., & Burden, R. P. (1963). Operations due to evaporation or seepage.
research in water quality management. Cambridge: 11:3 Compute the storage-yield function for a
Harvard Water Resources Group. single reservoir system by the mass dia-
USACE. (1991a). Benet determination involving exist-
gram and modied sequent peak methods
ing levees. Policy Guidance Letter No. 26, Headquar-
ters, U.S. Army Corps of Engineers, Washington, DC. given the following sequences of annual
USACE. (1999). Risk analysis in geotechnical engineering for flows: (7, 3, 5, 1, 2, 5, 6, 3, 4). Next
support of planning studies, ETL 1110-2-556, Headquar- assume that each year has two distinct
ters, U.S. Army Corps of Engineers, Washington, DC.
Exercises 517

hydrologic seasons, one wet and the other Reservoir Flood Annual
capacity stage for capacity
dry, and that 80% of the annual inflow flood of cost
occurs in season t = 1 and 80% of the return
period T
yield is desired in season t = 2. Using the
T=1 T=2 T=5 T = 10 T = 100
modied sequent peak method, show the
0 30 105 150 165 180 10a
increase in storage capacity required for
5 30 80 110 120 130 25
the same annual yield resulting from
10 30 55 70 75 80 30
within-year redistribution requirements.
15 30 40 45 48 50 40
11:4 Write two different linear programming
20 30 35 38 39 40 70
models for estimating the maximum con- a
10 is xed cost if capacity > 0; otherwise, it is 0
stant reservoir release or yield Y given a
xed reservoir capacity K, and for esti-
mating the minimum reservoir capacity Flood stage Cost of flood damage
K required for a xed yield Y. Assume that 30 0
there are T time periods of historical flows 50 10
available. How could these models be 70 20
used to dene a storage capacity-yield 90 30
function indicating the yield Y available
110 40
from a given capacity K?
130 50
11:5(a) Construct an optimization model for esti-
mating the least-cost combination of active 150 90
storage capacities, K1 and K2, of two 180 150
reservoirs located on a single stream, used
to produce a reliable constant annual flow
or yield (or greater) downstream of the two 11:7 Develop a deterministic, static, within-year
reservoirs. Assume that the cost functions model for evaluating the development
Cs(Ks) at each reservoir site s are known alternatives in the river basin shown in the
and there is no dead storage and no evap- accompanying gures. Assume that there
oration. (Do not linearize the cost func- are t = 1, 2, 3,, n within-year periods
tions; leave them in their functional form.) and that the objective is to maximize the
Assume that 10 years of monthly unregu- total annual net benets in the basin. The
lated flows are available at each site s. solution of the model should dene the
(b) Describe the two-reservoir operating pol- reservoir capacities (active + flood storage
icy that you would incorporate into a capacity), the annual allocation targets, the
model model to check the solution levee capacity required to protect site 4
obtained from the optimization model. from a T-year flood, and the within-year

Capacities K1 K2
1 2

11:6 Given the information in the accompany- period allocations of water to the uses at
ing tables, compute the reservoir capacity sites 3 and 7. Clearly dene all variables
that maximizes the net expected flood and functions used, and indicate how the
damage reduction benets less the annual model would be solved to obtain the
cost of reservoir capacity. maximum net benet solution.
518 11 River Basin Modeling

1
3

Gage
5
2
4 7 site
6 8

Levee Potential flood


Irrigation
damage site
area

denote loss functions and C() will denote the cost


Site Fraction of
gage flow functions.
1 0 Potential reservoir for water
supply 11:8 List the potential difculties involved
2 0.3 Potential reservoir for water
when attempting to structure models for
supply, flood control dening
3 0.15 Diversion to a use, 60% of
allocation returned to river (a) Water allocation policies for irrigation
4 Existing development, during the growing season.
possible flood protection from (b) Energy production and capacity of
levee hydroelectric plants.
5 0.6 Potential reservoir for water (c) Dead storage volume requirements in
supply, recreation reservoirs.
6 Hydropower; plant (d) Active storage volume requirements in
factor = 0.30 reservoir.
7 0.9 Potential diversion to an (e) Flood storage capacities in reservoirs.
irrigation district
(f) Channel improvements for damage
8 1 Gage site reduction.
(g) Evaporation and seepage losses from
For simplicity, assume no evaporation losses reservoirs.
or dead storage requirements. Omitting the (h) Water flow or storage targets using
appropriate subscripts t for time periods and s for long-run benets and short- run loss
site, let T, K, D, E, and P be the target, reservoir functions.
capacity, decit, excess, and power plant capac-
ity variables, respectively. Let Qt and Rt be the 11:9 Assume that demand for water supply
natural streamflows and reservoir releases, and St capacity is expected to grow as t(60 t),
be the initial reservoir storage volumes in period for t in years. Determine the minimum
t. Kf will denote the flood storage capacity at site present value of construction cost of some
2 that will contain a peak flow of QS and QR is subset of water supply options described
the downstream channel flood flow capacity. The below so as to always have sufcient
relationship between QS and Kf is dened by the capacity to meet demand over the next
function (QS). The unregulated design flood 30 years. Assume that the water supply
peak flow for which protection is required is QN. network currently has no excess capacity
KWH will be the kilowatt-hours of energy, so that some project must be built imme-
H will be net storage head, ht the hours in a diately. In this problem, assume that pro-
period t. The variable q will be the water supply ject capacities are independent and thus
allocation. Benet functions will be B(), L() will can be summed. Use a discount factor
Exercises 519

equal to exp(0.07 t). Before you start, potential damage site from those
what is your best guess at the optimal design floods? Let BFT be the annual
solution? expected flood protection benets at
the damage site for a flood having
Project number Construction cost Capacity return periods of T.
1 100 200 (c) How could this model be further
2 115 250 modied to include water supply
3 190 450
requirements of At to be withdrawn
from the reservoir in each month t?
4 270 700
Assume known natural flows Qst at
each site s in the basin in each month t.
(d) How could the model be enlarged to
11:10 (a) Construct a flow diagram for a simu-
include recreation benets or losses at
lation model designed to dene a
the reservoir site? Let Ts be the
storage-yield function for a single
unknown storage volume target and
reservoir given known inflows in each
Dst be the difference between the
month t for n years. Indicate how you
storage volume Sst and the target Ts if
would obtain a steady-state solution
Sst Ts > 0, and Ets be the difference if
not influenced by an arbitrary initial
Ts Sst > 0. Assume that the annual
storage volume in the reservoir at the
recreation benets B(Ts) are a function
beginning of the rst period. Assume
of the target storage volume Ts and the
that evaporation rates (mm per month)
losses LD Dst and LE Ets are associ-
and the storage volume/surface area
functions are known. ated with the decit Dst and excess Ets
(b) Write a flow diagram for a simulation storage volumes.
model to be used to estimate the prob- 11:12 Given the hydrologic and economic
ability that any specic reservoir ca- data listed below, develop and solve a
pacity, K, will satisfy a series of known linear programming model for esti-
release demands, rt, downstream given mating the reservoir capacity K, the
unknown future inflows, it. You need flood storage capacity Kf, and the
not discuss how to generate possible recreation storage volume target T that
future sequences of streamflows, only maximize the annual expected flood
how to use them to solve this problem. control benets, Bf(Kf), plus the
11:11 (a) Develop an optimization model for annual recreation benets, B(T), less
nding the cost-effective combination all losses LD Dt and LE Et associ-
of flood storage capacity at an ated with decits Dt or excesses Et in
upstream reservoir and channel the periods of the recreation season,
improvements at a downstream minus the annual cost C(K) of storage
potential damage site that will protect reservoir capacity K. Assume that the
the downstream site from a prespeci- reservoir must also provide a constant
ed design flood of return period release or yield of Y = 30 in each
T. Dene all variables and functions period t. The flood season begins at
used in the model the beginning of period 3 and lasts
(b) How could this model be modied to through period 6. The recreation sea-
consider a number of design floods son begins at the beginning of period
T and the benets from protecting the 4 and lasts though period 7.
520 11 River Basin Modeling

Period 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 11:13 The optimal operation of multiple reser-


Inflows 50 30 20 80 60 20 40 10 70
voir systems for hydropower production
to presents a very nonlinear and often dif-
reservoir cult problem.

8 Use dynamic programming to determine the


< 12Kf if Kf  5 operating policy that maximizes the total annual
Bf Kf 60 8Kf  5 if 5  Kf  15 hydropower production of a two-reservoir sys-
:
140 4Kf  15 if Kf  15 tem, one downstream of the other. The releases
R1t from the upstream reservoir plus the unreg-
ulated incremental flow (Q2t Q1t) constitute
8
> 45 10K if 0  Kf  5 the inflow to the downstream dam. The flows Q1t
>
<
95 6Kf  5 if 5  Kf  20 into the upstream dam in each of the four seasons
CKf
>
> 185 10Kf  20 if 20  Kf  40 along with the incremental flows (Q2t Q1t) and
:
385 15K  40 if Kf  40 constraints on reservoir releases are given in the
accompanying two tables:

B(T) = 9T, where T is a particular Upstream dam (flow in 106 m3/period)


unknown value of -reservoir
Season Inflow Minimum Maximum
storage t Q1t release release through
LD Dt = 4Dt, where Dt is T St if T St turbines
LE Et = 2 Et, where Et is St T if St T 1 60 20 90
2 40 30 90
(continued)

Y = 30

Qt = inflow
Rt = release
(excess)

St = initial storage
Kf = flood storage
K = total capacity

15
4
10
8
C(K)
Bf (Kf) 6

12 12
45

0 5 15 -15 5 20 40
K
Kf
Exercises 521

Upstream dam (flow in 106 m3/period) storage might occur at each reservoir. Assume
Season Inflow Minimum Maximum
that the conversion of potential energy equals to
t Q1t release release through the product RiHi to electric energy is 70% ef-
turbines cient independent of Ri and Hi. In calculating the
3 80 20 90 energy produced in any season t at reservoir i,
4 120 20 90 use the average head during the season

 i 1 Hi t Hi t 1
H
2
Downstream dam (flow in 106 m3/period)
Season Incremental Minimum Maximum Report your operating policy and the amount
t flow, release release of energy generated per year. Find another fea-
(Q2t Q1t) through
turbines
sible policy and show that it generates less
energy than the optimal policy.
1 50 30 140
Show how you could use linear programming
2 30 40 140 to solve for the optimal operating policy by
3 60 30 140  i by a linear
approximating the product term Ri H
4 90 30 140 expression.

Note that there is a limit on the quantity of water 11:14 You are responsible for planning a pro-
that can be released through the turbines for energy ject that may involve the building of a
generation in any season due to the limited capacity reservoir to provide water supply benets
of the power plant and the desire to produce to a municipality, recreation benets
hydropower during periods of peak demand. associated with the water level in the lake
Additional information that affects the opera- behind the dam, and flood damage
tion of the two reservoirs are the limitations on reduction benets. First you need to
the fluctuations in the pool levels (head) and the determine some design variable values,
storage-head relationships: and after doing that you need to deter-
mine the reservoir operating policy.
Data Upstream Downstream
dam dam The design variables you need to determine
Maximum head, 70 90 include
Hmax (m)
Minimum head, 30 60 the total reservoir storage capacity (K),
Hmin (m) the flood storage capacity (Kf) in the rst
Maximum storage 150 106 400 106 season that is the flood season,
volume, Smax (m3)
the particular storage level where recreation
Storage-net head H = Hmax(S/ H = Hmax(S/ facilities will be built, called the storage target
relationship Smax)0.64 Smax)0.62
(ST) that will apply in seasons 3, 4, and 5
the recreation seasons and nally,
In solving the problem, discretize the storage the dependable water supply or yield (Y) for
levels in units of 10 106 m3. Do a preliminary the municipality.
analysis to determine how large a variation in
522 11 River Basin Modeling

ST
Kf

Assume you can determine these design Develop and solve a nonlinear optimization
variable values based on average flows at the model for nding the values of each of the design
reservoir site in six seasons of a year. These variables: K, Kf, ST, and Y and the maximum
average flows are 35, 42, 15, 3, 15, and 22 in the annual net benets. (There will be other variables
seasons 16, respectively. as well. Just dene what you need and put it all
The objective is to design the system to maxi- together in a model.)
mize the total annual net benets derived from Does the solution give you sufcient infor-
mation that would allow you to simulate the
flood control in season 1, system using a sequence of inflows to the
recreation in seasons 35, and reservoir that are different than the ones used to
water supply in all seasons, get the design variable values? If not how would
you dene a reservoir operating policy? After
less the annual cost of the determining the systems design variable values
using optimization, and then determining the
reservoir and reservoir operating policy, you would then sim-
any losses resulting from not meeting the ulate this system over many years to get a better
recreation storage targets in the recreation idea of how it might perform.
seasons.
11:15 Suppose you have 19 years of monthly
The flood benets are estimated to be 2 Kf .0.7
flow data at a site where a reservoir could
The recreation benets for the entire recre- be located. How could you construct a
ation season are estimated to be 8 ST. model to estimate what the required
The water supply benets for the entire year over-year and within year storage needed
are estimated to be 20 Y. to produce a specied annual yield Y that
The annual reservoir cost is estimated to be is allocated to each month t by some
3 K1.2. known fraction t. What would be the
The recreation loss in each recreation season maximum reliability of those yields? If
depends on whether the actual storage volume is you wanted to add to that an additional
lower or higher than the storage target. If it is secondary yield having only 80% relia-
lower the losses are 12 per unit average decit in bility, how would the model change?
the season, and if they are higher the losses are 4 Make up 19 annual flows and assume that
per unit average excess in the season. It is pos- the average monthly flows are specied
sible that a season could begin with a decit and fractions of those annual flows. Just using
end with an excess, or vice versa. these annual flows and the average
monthly fractions, solve your model.
Exercises 523

11:16 Capacities K1 K2
1 2

(a) Develop an optimization model for T periods t, and an operating policy that
estimating the least-cost combination denes the lagoon discharge as a func-
of active storage K1 and K2 capacities tion of the initial volume and inflow,
at two reservoir sites on a single indicate how you would estimate the
stream that are used to produce a probability distribution of lagoon stor-
reliable flow or yield downstream of age volumes.
the downstream reservoir. Assume 11:18 (a) Using the inflow data in the table
10 years of monthly flow data at each below, develop and solve a yield
reservoir site. Identify what other model for estimating the storage capac-
data are needed. ity of a single reservoir required to
(b) Describe the two-reservoir operating produce a yield of 1.5 that is 90% reli-
policy that could be incorporated into able in both of the two within-year pe-
a simulation model to check the riods t, and an additional yield of 1.0
solution obtained from the optimiza- that is 70% reliable in period t = 2.
tion model. (b) Construct a reservoir-operating rule that
denes reservoir release zones for these
Dene yields.
(c) Using the operating rule, simulate the 18
C s K s cost of active storage capacity at site s;
periods of inflow data to evaluate the
where s = 1, 2
adequacy of the reservoir capacity and
Kds dead storage capacity of reservoir at
storage zones for delivering the required
site s; Kds = 0
yields and their reliabilities. (Note that
Sst storage volume at beginning of period
in this simulation of the historical record
t at site s
the 90% reliable yield should be satis-
Ls loss of water due to evaporation at site
ed in all the 18 periods, and the
s; Ls = 0
incremental 70% reliable yield should
R12
t
release from reservoir at site 1 to site 2
fail only two times in the 9 years.)
in period t
(d) Compare the estimated reservoir capac-
Yt yield to downstream in period t
ity with that which is needed using the
Qst 10 years of monthly natural flows
sequent peak procedure.
available at each site s
aso area associated with dead storage
Year Period Inflow
volume at site s
as area per unit storage volume at site s 1 1 1.0
est evaporation depth in period t at site s 2 3.0
2 1 0.5
2 2.5
11:17 Given inflows to an effluent storage
3 1 1.0
lagoon that can be described by a simple
rst-order Markov chain in each of 2 2.0
(continued)
524 11 River Basin Modeling

Year Period Inflow during the wet season. This crop brings
the farmer the largest income per hectare;
4 1 0.5
thus they would all prefer to continue
2 1.5
growing rice during the dry season.
5 1 0.5
However, there is insufcient water dur-
2 0.5 ing the dry season for irrigating all
6 1 0.5 5000 ha of available irrigable land for
2 2.5 rice production. Assume an available
7 1 1.0 irrigation water supply of 32 106 m3 at
2 5.0 the beginning of each dry season, and a
minimum requirement of 7000 m3/ha for
8 1 2.5
rice and 1800 m3/ha for the second crop.
2 5.5
9 1 1.5 (a) What proportion of the 5000 ha
2 4.5 should the irrigation district manager
allocate for rice during the dry season
each year, provided that all available
11:19 One possible modication of the yield hectares must be given sufcient
model of would permit the solution water for rice or the second crop?
algorithm to determine the appropriate (b) Suppose that crop production func-
failure years associated with any desired tions are available for the two crops,
reliability instead of having to choose indicating the increase in yield per
these years prior to model solution. This hectare per m3 of additional water,
modication can provide an estimate of up to 10,000 m3/ha for the second
the extent of yield failure in each failure crop. Develop a model in which the
year and include the economic conse- water allocation per hectare, as well
quences of failures in the objective as the hectares allocated to each crop,
function. It can also serve as a means of is to be determined, assuming a
estimating the optimal reliability with specied price or return per unit of
respect to economic benets and losses. yield of each crop. Under what con-
Letting Fy be the unknown yield reduc- ditions would the solution of this
tion in a possible failure year y, then in model be the same as in part (a)?
place of pyYp in the over-year continuity
constraint, the term (Yp Fy) can be 11:21 Along the Nile River in Egypt, irrigation
used. What additional constraints are farming is practiced for the production of
needed to ensure (1) that the average cotton, maize, rice, sorghum, full and
shortage does not exceed (1 py)Yp or short berseem for animal production,
(2) that at most there are f failure years wheat, barley, horsebeans, and winter
and none of the shortages exceed and summer tomatoes. Cattle and buffalo
(1 py)Yp. are also produced, and together with the
11:20 In Indonesia there exists a wet season crops that require labor, water. Fertilizer,
followed by a dry season each year. In and land area (feddans). Farm types or
one area of Indonesia all farmers within management practices are fairly uniform,
an irrigation district plant and grow rice and hence in any analysis of irrigation
Exercises 525

policies in this region this distinction (e) Minimum number of animals required for
need not be made. Given the accompa- cultivation.
nying data develop a model for deter- (f) Upper bounds on summer and winter toma-
mining the tons of crops and numbers of toes (assume these are known).
animals to be grown that will maximize (g) Lower bounds on cotton areas (assume this is
(a) net economic benets based on known).
Egyptian prices, and (b) net economic
benets based on international prices. Other possible constraints
Identify all variables used in the model.
(a) Crop balances.
Known parameters (b) Fertilizer balances.
(c) Labor balance.
Ci miscellaneous cost of land preparation per
(d) Land balance.
feddan
PEi Egyptian price per 1000 tons of crop i 11:22 In Algeria there are two distinct cropping
PIi international price per 1000 tons of crop i intensities, depending upon the avail-
v value of meat and dairy production per ability of water. Consider a single crop
animal that can be grown under intensive rota-
g annual labor cost per worker tion or extensive rotation on a total of
fP cost of P fertilizer per ton A hectares. Assume that the annual water
fN cost of N fertilizer per ton requirements for the intensive rotation
Yi yield of crop i, tons/feddan policy are 16,00 m3 per ha, and for the
feddans serviced per animal extensive rotation policy they are
tons straw equivalent per ton of berseem 4000 m3 per ha. The annual net produc-
carryover from winter to summer tion returns are 4000 and 2000 dinars,
rw berseem requirements per animal in winter respectively. If the total water available is
swh straw yield from wheat, tons per feddan 320,000 m3, show that as the available
sba straw yield from barley, tons per feddan land area A increases, the rotation policy
rs straw requirements per animal in summer that maximizes total net income changes
lNi N fertilizer required per feddan of crop i from one that is totally intensive to one
lPi P fertilizer required per feddan of crop i that is increasingly extensive.
lim labor requirements per feddan in month m,
man-days Would the same conclusion hold if instead of
wim water requirements per feddan in xed net incomes of 4000 and 2000 dinars per
month m, 1000 m3 hectares of intensive and extensive rotation, the
him land requirements per month, fraction net income depended on the quantity of crop
(1 = full month) produced? Assuming that intensive rotation
produces twice as much produced by extensive
Required Constraints. (Assume known rotation, and that the net income per unit of crop
resource limitations for labor, water, and land) Y is dened by the simple linear function
5 0.05Y, develop and solve a linear program-
(a) Summer and winter fodder (berseem) ming model to determine the optimal rotation
requirements for the animals. policies if A equals 20, 50, and 80. Need this net
(b) Monthly labor limitations. income or price function be linear to be included
(c) Monthly water limitations. in a linear programming model?
(d) Land availability each month.
526 11 River Basin Modeling

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
Urban Water Systems
12

Today, a simple turn of the tap provides clean runoff, and for recreational parks and the main-
watera precious resource. Engineering advan- tenance of urban ecosystems. As urban areas
ces in managing this resourcewith water grow, so do the demands for such services. In
treatment, supply, and distribution systems addition there is an increasing need to make
changed urban life profoundly in the 20th cen- urban water systems more resilient to climate
tury, virtually eliminating waterborne diseases in change. All this leads to the realization that urban
developed nations, and providing clean and water management must be an integral part of
abundant water for communities, farms, and urban planning in general. Land use decisions
industries. So states the US National Academy impact water supply and wastewater system
of Engineering on its selection of water supply designs and operation, as well as measures nee-
systems to be among the top ve greatest ded for managing stormwater runoff. A func-
achievements of engineering in the twentieth tioning urban infrastructure system also requires
century. But providing everyone with clean tap energy which in turn typically requires water.
water, especially in urban areas, has yet to be Sustainable urban development must focus on
achieved, even in developed nations. The worlds the relationships between water, energy, and land
population is growing by about 80 million peo- use, and often on diversifying sources of water to
ple per year, and is predicted to approach assure reliable supplies. Integrated urban water
10 billion by 2050. Over 50% of people on our management (IUWM) provides both a goal and a
planet today live in urban areas and that per- framework for planning, designing, and managing
centage will grow. As populations continually urban water systems. It is a flexible process that
move to cities for improved economic opportu- responds to change and enables stakeholders to
nities and a higher standard of living and as cities participate in, and predict the impacts of, devel-
merge to form megacities, the design and man- opment decisions. It includes the environmental,
agement of water becomes an increasingly economic, social, technical, and political aspects
important part of integrated urban infrastructure of urban water management. It enables better land
planning and management. use planning and the management of its impacts on
fresh water supplies, treatment, and distribution;
wastewater collection, treatment, reuse and dis-
12.1 Introduction posal; stormwater collection, use and disposal; and
solid waste collection, recycling, and disposal
Urban water management involves the planning, systems. It makes urban development part of
design, and operation of infrastructure needed to integrated basin management oriented toward a
meet the demands for drinking water and sani- more economically, socially, and environmentally
tation, the control of inltration and stormwater sustainable mixed urbanrural landscape.

The Author(s) 2017 527


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_12
528 12 Urban Water Systems

Fig. 12.1 Schematic showing urban surface water source, water treatment prior to urban use, and some sources of
nonpoint urban drainage and runoff and its impacts

While recognizing the need for and the ben- treatment; and urban drainage works. This is
ets derived from a systems approach to urban illustrated as a simple schematic in Fig. 12.1.
planning and development, including its water Generic data-driven simulation models of
related components, this chapter will serve as an components of urban water systems have been
introduction to each of these components sepa- developed and are commonly applied to study
rately, and not all together as a system. This specic component design and operation issues.
understanding of each component is needed if Increasingly optimization models are being used
indeed they eventually will be modeled, to estimate cost-effective designs and operating
designed, and managed as part of the overall policies. Cost savings can be substantial, espe-
urban infrastructure system. cially when applied to large complex urban
These urban water infrastructure components systems (Dandy and Engelhardt 2001; Savic and
typically include water collection and storage Walters 1997).
facilities at source sites, water transport via Most urban water users desire, and many
aqueducts (canals, tunnels, and/or pipelines) require, high quality potable water. The quality of
from source sites to water treatment facilities; natural surface and/or groundwater supplies,
water treatment, storage, and distribution sys- called raw water, often cannot meet the quality
tems; wastewater collection (sewer) systems and requirements of domestic and industrial users. In
12.1 Introduction 529

such situations water treatment prior to its use is


required. Once treated, water can be stored and poor follow-up decisions at various gov-
distributed within the urban area, usually through a ernmental levels.
network of storage tanks and pipes. Pipe flows in After a change in April 2014 of the source
urban distribution systems should be under pres- of the citys drinking water, the citys water
sure to prevent contamination from groundwater distribution system became contaminated
leakage and to meet re protection and other user with lead. This has created a serious public
requirements. health danger. As a result, thousands of
After use, the wastewater is collected in a residents have severely high levels of lead in
network of sewers, or in some cases ditches, their blood and are experiencing a variety of
leading to a wastewater treatment plant or dis- serious health problems. Local, state, and
charge site. Wastewater treatment plants remove federal authorities, and political leaders, did
some of the impurities in the wastewater before not seem sufciently concerned until
discharging it into receiving water bodies or on inhabitants of Flint, with the help of others
land surfaces. Water bodies receiving effluents who performed water quality analyses and
from point sources such as wastewater treatment obtained public health statistics from local
plants may also receive runoff from the sur- hospitals, made it a national issue. In
rounding watershed area during storm events. November, 2015, some of the residents led
The discharge of point and nonpoint pollutants a federal class action lawsuit against the
into receiving water bodies can impact the quality Governor and 13 other city and state of-
of the water in those receiving water bodies. The cials. Additional lawsuits have been led
fate and transport of these pollutants in water after that and resignations have occurred. In
bodies can be predicted using water quality January 2016, the Governor declared the
models similar to those discussed in Chap. 10. city to be in a state of emergency. Less than 2
This chapter briefly describes these urban weeks later the President of the US declared
water system components and reviews some of the drinking water crisis in Flint as a federal
the general assumptions incorporated into opti- emergency authorizing additional help from
mization and simulation models used to plan and the federal government.
manage urban water infrastructure systems. The
focus of urban water systems modeling is mainly
on the prediction and management of quantity
and quality of flows and pressure heads in water 12.2 Water Treatment
distribution networks, wastewater flows in grav-
ity sewer networks, and on the design efciencies Before water is to be used for human consumption
of water and wastewater treatment plants. Other its harmful impurities need to be removed. Com-
models can be used for the real-time operation of munities that do not have adequate water treatment
various components of urban systems. facilities, common in developing regions, often
have high incidences of disease and mortality due
to contaminated water supplies. A range of syn-
Box 12.1 An urban drinking water dromes, including acute dehydrating diarrhea (c-
crisis holera), prolonged febrile illness with abdominal
This ongoing (2016) case of urban water symptoms (typhoid fever), acute bloody diarrhea
management in Flint, Michigan (US) illus- (dysentery), and chronic diarrhea (Brainerd diar-
trates what can happen even in so-called rhea) result in over 3 billion episodes of diarrhea
developed regions if decisions are made and an estimated 2 million deaths, mostly among
without adequate analyses of possible children, each year.
health impacts and the consequences of Contaminants in natural water supplies can
include microorganisms such as Cryptosporidium
530 12 Urban Water Systems

and Giardia lamblia, inorganic and organic After flocculation the water is pumped slowly
cancer-causing chemicals (such as compounds across another large settling basin. In this sedi-
containing arsenic, chromium, copper, lead, and mentation or clarication process much of the
mercury), and radioactive materials (such as remaining floc and solid material accumulates at
radium and uranium). As Box 12.1 illustrates, this the bottom of the basin. The claried water is
need to protect water supplies from such contam- then passed through layers of sand, coal, and
inants is not limited to developing regions. other granular material to remove microorgan-
To remove impurities and pathogens, a typical ismsincluding viruses, bacteria, and protozoa
municipal water purication system involves a such as Cryptosporidiumand any remaining
sequence of physical and chemical processes. floc and silt. This stage of purication mimics the
Physical and chemical removal processes include natural ltration of water as it moves through the
initial and nal ltering, coagulation, flocculation ground.
sedimentation, and disinfection, as illustrated in The ltered water is then treated with chemical
the schematic of Fig. 12.2. disinfectants to kill any organisms that remain
As shown in Fig. 12.2, one of the rst steps in after the ltration process. An effective disinfec-
most water treatment plants involves passing raw tant is chlorine but its use may cause potentially
water through coarse lters to remove sand, grit, dangerous substances such as trihalomethanes.
and large solid objects. Next, a chemical such as Alternatives to chlorine include ozone oxida-
alum is added to the raw water to facilitate coag- tion (Fig. 12.2). Unlike chlorine, ozone does not
ulation of remaining impurities. As the wastewater stay in the water after it leaves the treatment plant,
is stirred the alum causes the formation of sticky so it offers no protection from bacteria that might
globs of small particles made up of bacteria, silt, be in the storage tanks and water pipes of the water
and other impurities. Once these globs of matter distribution system. Water can also be treated with
are formed, the water is routed to a series of settling ultraviolet light to kill microorganisms, but it has
tanks where the globs, or floc, sink to the bottom. the same limitation as oxidation. It is ineffective
This settling process is called flocculation. outside the treatment plant.

Fig. 12.2 Typical processes in water treatment plants


12.2 Water Treatment 531

Fig. 12.3 A 6-million gallon per day water treatment plant at San Luis Obispo, located about halfway between Los
Angeles and San Francisco on the Central Coast of California

Figure 12.3 is an aerial view of a water center of the pipe. The parameter p is the pres-
treatment plant serving a population of about sure, e.g., newton per cubic meter (N/m3), is the
50,000. specic weight (N/m2) of water, Z is the eleva-
tion above some base elevation (m), V is the
velocity (m/s), and g is the gravitational accel-
12.3 Water Distribution eration (9.81 m/s2).
Energy can be added to the system such as by
Water distribution systems include pumping a pump, and lost from the system such as by
stations, distribution storage, and distribution friction. These changes in energy are referred to
piping. The hydraulic performance of each as head gains and losses. Balancing the energy
component in the distribution network depends across any two sites i and j in the system requires
upon the performance of other components. Of that the total heads, including any head gains HG
interest to designers are both the flows and their and losses HL (m) are equal.
pressures throughout the network.  
The energy at any point within a network of p=c Z V 2 =2g HG site i
 
pipes is often represented in three parts: the p=c Z V 2 =2g HL site j 12:1
pressure head, p/, the elevation head, Z, and the
velocity head, V2/2g. (A more precise represen- The hydraulic grade is the sum of the pressure
tation includes a kinetic energy correction factor, head and elevation head (p/ + Z). For
but that factor is small and can be ignored.) For open-channel flow the hydraulic grade is the
open-channel flows, the elevation head is the water surface slope, since the pressure head at its
distance from some datum to the top of the water surface is 0. For a pressure pipe, the hydraulic
surface. For pressure pipe flow, the elevation head is the height to which a water column
head is the distance from some datum to the would rise in a piezometera tube rising from
532 12 Urban Water Systems

the pipe. When plotted in prole along the length plotted in prole, as in Fig. 12.5, this is often
of the conveyance section, this is often referred referred to as the energy grade line, or EGL. At a
to as the hydraulic grade line, or HGL. The lake or reservoir, where the velocity is essentially
hydraulic grade lines for open-channel and zero, the EGL is equal to the HGL.
pressure pipes are illustrated in Figs. 12.4 and Specic energy, E, is the sum of the depth of
12.5. flow and the velocity head, V2/2 g. For
The energy grade is the sum of the hydraulic open-channel flow, the depth of flow, y, is the
grade and the velocity head. This is the height to elevation head minus the channel bottom eleva-
which a column of water would rise in a Pitot tion. For a given discharge, the specic energy is
tube, but also accounting for fluid velocity. When solely a function of channel depth. There may be

Fig. 12.4 The energy components along an open channel

Fig. 12.5 The energy components along a pressure pipe


12.3 Water Distribution 533

more than one depth having the same specic  


V R2=3 S1=2 =n 12:3
energy. In one case the flow is subcritical (rela-
tively higher depths, lower velocities) and in the
other case the flow is critical (relatively lower
depths and higher velocities). Whether or not the Q AV 12:4
flow is above or below the critical depth (the
The values of various friction factors n can be
depth that minimizes the specic energy) will
found in tables in hydraulics texts and
depend in part on the channel slope.
handbooks.
Friction is the main cause of head loss. There
The energy balance between two ends of a
are many equations that approximate friction loss
channel segment is dened in Eq. 12.5. For
associated with fluid flow through a given section
open-channel flow the pressure heads are 0. Thus
of channel or pipe. These include Mannings or
for a channel containing water flowing from site
Stricklers equation that is commonly used for
i to site j:
open-channel flow and Chezys or Kutters
equation, HazenWilliams equation, and Darcy    
Z V 2 =2g site i
Z V 2 =2g HL site j
Weisbach or ColebrookWhite equations that are
used for pressure pipe flow. They all dene flow 12:5
velocity, V (m/s) as an empirical function of a
flow resistance factor, C, the hydraulic radius The head loss HL is assumed to be primarily due
(cross-sectional area divided by wetted perime- to friction.
ter), R, and the friction or energy slope, S = HL/ The friction loss is computed based on the
Length. average rate of friction loss along the segment
and the length of the segment. This is the dif-
V kCRx Sy 12:2 ference in the energy grade line elevations
(EGL) between sites i and j.
The terms k, x, and y of Eq. 12.2 are parameters. 
The roughness of the flow channel usually HL EGLi  EGLj
   
determines the flow resistance or roughness fac- Z V 2 =2g site i  Z V 2 =2g site j
tor C. The value of C may also be a function of
12:6
the channel shape, depth, and fluid velocity.
Values of C for different types of pipes are listed The friction loss per unit distance along the
in hydraulics texts or handbooks (e.g., Mays channel is the average of the friction slopes at the
2000, 2001; Chin 2000). two ends divided by the channel length. This
denes the energy grade line, EGL.

12.3.1 Open-Channel Networks


12.3.2 Pressure Pipe Networks
For open-channel flow Mannings or Stricklers
equation is commonly used to predict the average The HazenWilliams equation is commonly used
velocity, V (m/s), and the flow, Q (m3/s) asso- to predict the flows or velocities in pressure
ciated with a given cross-sectional area, A (m2). pipes. Flows and velocities are again dependent
The velocity depends on the hydraulic radius on the slope, S, the hydraulic radius R (m) (that
R (m) and the slope S of the channel as well as a equals the half the pipe radius, r), and the
friction factor n. cross-sectional area, A (m2).
534 12 Urban Water Systems

V 0:849CR0:63 S0:54 12:7 Storageit Qin


it  Qit Storagei;t 1 12:12
out

In each section between nodes i and j:


Q AV p r 2 V 12:8
HLit HLjt HLijt ; 12:13
The head loss along a length L (m) of pipe of
diameter D (m) containing a flow of Q (m3/s) is where the head loss between nodes i and j is
dened as HLijt.
To compute the flows and head losses at each
HL KQ1:85 ; 12:9 node in Fig. 12.6 requires two sets of equations,
one for continuity of flows, and the other conti-
where K is the pipe coefcient dened by nuity of head losses. In this example, the direc-
Eq. 12.10. tion of flow in two links, from A to C, and from
  B to C are assumed unknown and hence each is
K 10:66L= C1:85 D4:87 12:10 represented by two nonnegative flow variables.
Let Qij be the flow from site i to site j and Hi
Another pipe flow equation for head loss is the be the head at site i. Continuity of flow in this
DarcyWeisbach equation based on a friction network requires:
factor f.
0:5 QDA QDC 12:14
HL f LV 2 =D2g 12:11

The friction factor is dependent on the Reynolds 0:1 QDA  QAC QCA  QAB 12:15
number and the pipe roughness and diameter.
Given these equations it is possible to com-
pute the distribution of flows and heads 0:25 QAB QCB  QBC 12:16
throughout a network of open channels or pres-
sure pipes. The two conditions are the continuity
0:15 QDC QAC  QCA QBC  QCB
of flows at each node, and the continuity of head
losses in loops for each time period t. 12:17
At each node i:
Continuity of heads at each node requires:

Fig. 12.6 An example of


a pipe network, showing
the values of K for
predicting head losses from
Eq. 12.10
12.3 Water Distribution 535

 between nodes A and C may not be economical, at


HD HC 22  Q1:85
DC ; 12:18
least for these flow conditions. Other flow con-
ditions may prove otherwise. But even if they do
 not, this pipe section increases the reliability of
HD HA 11  Q1:85
DA ; 12:19
the system, and reliability is an important con-
sideration in water supply distribution networks.
HA HB 22  Q1:85
AB ; 12:20

12.3.3 Water Quality


 
1:85
HC HA 25  QCA QAC ; 12:21
Many of the water quality models discussed in
Chap. 10 can be used to predict water quality
  constituent concentrations in open channels and
HC HB 11  QCB QBC 1:85 12:22 in pressure pipes. The assumption of complete
mixing such as at junctions or in short segments
Solving these Eqs. 12.1412.22 simultaneously of pipe, is made. Reactions among constituents
for the ve flow and four head variables yields can occur as water travels through the system at
the flows Qij from nodes i to nodes j and heads Hi predicted velocities. Water-resident times (the
at nodes i listed in Table 12.1. ages of waters) in various parts of the network
This solution shown in Table 12.1 assumes are important variables for water quality predic-
that the network is at a constant elevation, has no tion as constituent decay, transformation, and
storage capacity, and there are no minor losses. growth processes take place over time.
Losses are usually expressed as a linear function Computer models typically use numerical
of the velocity head, due to hydraulic structures methods to nd the hydraulic flow and head
(such as valves, restrictions, or meters) at each relationships as well as the resulting water
node. This solution suggests that the pipe section quality concentrations. Most numerical models

Table 12.1 Flows and heads of the network shown in Fig. 12.6
536 12 Urban Water Systems

assume combinations of plug flow (advection) flow, from steady to unsteady flow, and from
along pipe sections and complete mixing within uniform to gradually or rapidly varying
segments of the each pipe section at the end of non-uniform flow.
each simulation time step. Some models also use Urban drainage ditches normally have uni-
Lagrangian approaches for tracking particles of form cross sections along their lengths and uni-
constituents within a network. (See Chap. 10). form gradients. Because the dimensions of the
Computer programs (e.g., EPANET) exist that cross sections are typically one or two orders of
can perform simulations of the flows, heads, and magnitude less than the lengths of the conduit,
water quality behavior within pressurized net- unsteady free surface flow can be modeled using
works of pipes, pipe junctions, pumps, valves, one-dimensional flow equations.
and storage tanks or reservoirs. These programs When modeling the hydraulics of flow it is
are designed to predict the movement and fate of important to distinguish between the speed of
water constituents within distribution systems. propagation of the kinematic wave disturbance and
They can be used for many different kinds of the speed of the bulk of the water. In general the
applications in distribution systems design, wave travels faster than the water particles. Thus if
hydraulic model calibration, chlorine residual water is injected with a tracer the tracer lags behind
analysis, and consumer exposure assessment. the wave. The speed of the wave disturbance
They can also be used to compare and evaluate depends on the depth, width, and velocity of the
the performance of alternative management flow.
strategies for improving water quality throughout Flood attenuation (or subsidence) is the
a system. These can include: decrease in the peak of the wave as it propagates
downstream. Gravity tends to flatten, or spread
altering the sources within multiple source out, the wave along the channel. The magnitude of
systems, the attenuation of a flood wave depends on the
altering pumping and tank lling/emptying peak discharge, the curvature of the wave prole at
schedules, the peak, and the width of flow. Flows can be
use of satellite treatment, such as rechlorina- distorted (changed in shape) by the particular
tion at storage tanks, channel characteristics.
targeted pipe cleaning and replacement. Additional features of concern to hydraulic
modelers are the entrance and exit losses to the
Computer models that simulate the hydraulic conduit. Typically at each end of the conduit is a
and water quality processes in water distribution manhole. Manholes are storage chambers that
networks must be run long enough for the system provide access (for men and women) to the
to reach equilibrium conditions, i.e., conditions conduits upstream and downstream. Manholes
not influenced by initial boundary assumptions. induce some additional head loss.
Equilibrium conditions within pipes are reached Manholes usually cause a major part of the head
relatively quickly compared to those in storage losses in sewer systems. A manhole head loss
tanks. represents a combination of the and contraction
losses. For pressure flow, the head loss HL due to
contraction can be written as a function of the
12.4 Wastewater Collection downstream velocity, VD, and the upstream and
downstream flow cross-sectional areas AU and AD.
12.4.1 Sewer Networks 
HL K VD2 =2g 1  AD =AU 2 12:23
Flows in urban sewers and their pollutant con-
centrations vary throughout a typical day, a typical The coefcient K varies between 0.5 for sudden
week, and over the seasons of a year. Flow con- contraction and about 0.1 for a well-designed
ditions can range from free surface to surcharged gradual contraction.
12.4 Wastewater Collection 537

An important parameter of a given The rst stage of treatment is called preliminary


open-channel conduit is its capacity, that is, the treatment.
maximum flow that can occur without sur- Preliminary treatment removes solid materials
charging or flooding. Assuming the hydraulic (sticks, rags, large particles, sand, gravel, toys,
gradient is parallel to the bed of the conduit, each money, or anything people flush down toilets).
conduit has an upper limit to the flow that it can Equipment such as bar screens, and grit cham-
accept. bers are used to lter the wastewater as it enters a
Pressurized flow is much more complex than treatment plant. The wastewater then passes on to
free surface flow. In marked contrast to the what is called primary treatment.
propagation speed of disturbances under free Clariers and septic tanks are usually used to
surface flow conditions, the propagation of dis- provide primary treatment. Primary treatment
turbances under pressurized flow in a 1 m cir- separates suspended solids and greases from
cular conduit 100 m long can be less than a wastewater. Wastewater is held in a tank for
second. Some conduits can have the stable situ- several hours allowing the particles to settle to
ation of free surface flow upstream and pressur- the bottom and the greases to float to the top. The
ized flow downstream. solids drawn off the bottom and skimmed off the
top receive further treatment as sludge. The
claried wastewater flows on to the next sec-
12.5 Wastewater Treatment ondary stage of wastewater treatment.
Secondary treatment is typically a biological
The wastewater generated by residences, busi- treatment process designed to remove dissolved
nesses, and industries in a community is largely organic matter from wastewater. Sewage
water. Wastewater often contains less than 10% microorganisms cultivated and added to the
dissolved and suspended solid material. Its wastewater absorb organic matter from sewage as
cloudiness is caused by suspended particles whose their food supply. Three approaches are commonly
concentrations in untreated sewage range from used to accomplish secondary treatment; xed
100 to 350 mg/l. One measure of the biodegrad- lm, suspended lm, and lagoon systems.
able constituents in the wastewater is its bio- Fixed lm systems grow microorganisms on
chemical oxygen demand, or BOD5. BOD5 is the substrates such as rocks, sand, or plastic. The
amount of dissolved oxygen aquatic microorgan- wastewater is spread over the substrate. As
isms consumed in 5 days as they metabolize organic matter and nutrients are absorbed from
(eat) the organic material in the wastewater. the wastewater, the lm of microorganisms
Untreated sewage typically has a BOD5 concen- grows and thickens. Trickling lters, rotating
tration ranging from 100 to 300 mg/l. biological contactors, and sand lters are exam-
Pathogens or disease-causing organisms are ples of xed lm systems.
also present in sewage. Coliform bacteria are Suspended lm systems stir and suspend
used as an indicator of disease-causing organ- microorganisms in wastewater. Activated sludge,
isms. Sewage also contains nutrients (such as extended aeration, oxidation ditch, and sequen-
ammonia and phosphorus), minerals, and metals. tial batch reactor systems are all examples of
Ammonia can range from 12 to 50 mg/l and suspended lm systems. As the microorganisms
phosphorus can range from 6 to 20 mg/l in absorb organic matter and nutrients from the
untreated sewage (Fig. 12.8). wastewater they grow in size and number. After
As illustrated in Fig. 12.7, wastewater treat- the microorganisms have been suspended in the
ment is a multistage process. The goal is to wastewater for several hours, they are settled out
reduce or remove organic matter, solids, nutri- as sludge. Some of the sludge is pumped back
ents, disease-causing organisms, and other pol- into the incoming wastewater to provide seed
lutants from wastewater before it is released into microorganisms. The remainder is sent on to a
a body of water, or on to the land, or is reused. sludge treatment process.
538 12 Urban Water Systems

Fig. 12.7 A typical wastewater treatment plant showing the sequence of processes for removing impurities

Fig. 12.8 Wastewater treatment plant on the shores of gallons of wastewater per day (mgd) with a peak
Western Lake Superior in Minnesota, USA. The Acti- hydraulic capacity of 160 mgd. (Photo courtesy of
vated Sludge system is designed to treat 48 million Western Lake Superior Sanitary District.)
12.5 Wastewater Treatment 539

Lagoons, where used, are shallow basins that 12.6.1 Rainfall


hold the wastewater for several months to allow for
the natural degradation of sewage. These systems Surface runoff of precipitation and the need to
take advantage of natural aeration and microor- collect urban wastewater are the primary reasons
ganisms in the wastewater to renovate sewage. for designing and maintaining urban drainage
Advanced treatment is necessary in some systems. Storms are a major source of flow into
treatment systems to remove nutrients from the system. Even sanitary sewer systems that are
wastewater. Chemicals are sometimes added designed to be completely separate from storm
during the treatment process to help remove drainage sewers are often influenced by rainfall
phosphorus or nitrogen. Some examples of through illicit connections or even inltration.
nutrient removal systems include coagulant Rainfall varies over time and space. These
addition for phosphorus removal and air stripping differences are normally small when considering
for ammonia removal. short time periods and small distances but they
Final treatment focuses on removal of increase as time and distance increase. The
disease-causing organisms from wastewater. ability to account for spatial differences in rain-
Treated wastewater can be disinfected by adding fall depends on the size of the catchment area and
chlorine or by exposing it to sufcient ultraviolet on the number of functioning rainfall recording
light. High levels of chlorine may be harmful to points in the catchment. The use of radar permits
aquatic life in receiving streams. Treatment sys- more precision in estimating precipitation pat-
tems often add a chlorine-neutralizing chemical to terns over space and time, as if more rain gauges
the treated wastewater before stream discharge. were used and as if they were monitored more
Sludges are generated throughout the sewage frequently. In practice spatial effects are not
treatment process. This sludge needs to be treated measured at high resolution and therefore events
to reduce odors, remove some of the water and where signicant spatial variations occur, such as
reduce volume, decompose some of the organic in summer thunderstorms, are usually not very
matter and reduce volume, and kill disease- accurately represented.
causing organisms. Following sludge treatment, There are two categories of rainfall records:
liquid and cake sludge free of toxic compounds recorded (real) events and synthetic (not-real)
can be spread on elds, returning organic matter events. Synthetic rainfall comes in two forms: as
and nutrients to the soil. stochastically generated rainfall data and as de-
sign storms. These events are derived from
analyses of actual rainfall data and are used to
12.6 Urban Drainage Systems augment or replace those historical (real) data.
Design events are a synthesized set of rainfall
Urban drainage involves a number of hydraulic proles that have been processed to produce
and biochemical processes. These typically storms with specic return periods, i.e., how
include: often, on average, one can expect to observe
rainfall events of that magnitude or greater.
Rainfall and surface runoff Design events are derived to reduce the number
Surface loading and washoff of pollutants of runs needed to analyze system performance
Stormwater sewer and pipe flow under design flow conditions.
Sediment transport
Separation of solids at structures 12.6.1.1 Time Series Versus Design
Outfalls Storms
Professionals can argue over whether infrastruc-
These components or processes are briefly ture design capacities should be based on real
discussed in the following subsections. rainfall records or synthetic storm events. The
540 12 Urban Water Systems

argument in favor of using synthetic storms is that statistical characteristics of the rainfall, and then
they are easy to use and require only a few events to to use these statistics to produce synthetic rain-
assess the system design performance. The argu- storms of various return periods and durations.
ment in favor of a time series of real rainfall is that Three parameters are used to describe the
these data typically include a wider range of con- statistics of rainfall depth.
ditions, and therefore are likely to contain the
conditions that are critical on each catchment. The rainfall intensity or depth of rain in a
The two methods are not contradictory. The use certain period
of real rainfall involves some synthesis in choos- The length of the period over which that
ing which storms to use in a time series, and in intensity occurs
adjusting them for use on a catchment other than The frequency with which it is likely to occur,
the one where they were measured. Time series of or the probability of it occurring in any par-
rainfalls are generally used to look at aspects such ticular year.
as overflow spill frequencies and volumes. On the
other hand, synthetic design storms can be gen- In most of the work on urban drainage and
erated for a wide range of conditions including the river modeling, the risks of occurrence are
same conditions as represented by real rainfall. expressed not by probabilities but by the inverse
This is generally considered appropriate for of probability, the return period. An event that
looking at pipe network performance. has a probability of 0.2 of being equaled or
exceeded each year has an expected return period
12.6.1.2 SpatialTemporal of 1/0.2 or 5 years. An event having a probability
Distributions of 0.5 of being equaled or exceeded has an
Rainfall varies in space as well as in time, and the expected return period of 1/0.5 = 2 years.
two effects are related. Short duration storms Rainfall data show an intensitydurationfre-
typically come from small rain cells that have a quency relationship. The intensity and duration
short life, or that move rapidly over the catch- are inversely related. As the rainfall duration
ment. As these cells are small (of the order of a increases the intensity reduces. The frequency
kilometer in diameter) there is signicant spatial and intensity are inversely related so that as the
variation in rainfall intensity. Longer duration event becomes less frequent the intensity
storms tend to come from large rainfall cells increases.
associated with large weather systems. These An important part of this durationintensity
have less spatial intensity variation. relationship is the period of time over which the
Rainfall is generally measured at specic sites intensity is averaged. It is not necessarily the
using rain gauges. The recorded rainfall amount length of time for which it rained from start to
and intensity will not be the same at each site. Thus nish. In fact any period of rainfall can be ana-
the use of recorded rainfall data requires some way lyzed for a large range of durations, and each
to account for this spatial and temporal variations. duration could be assigned a different return
The average rainfall over the catchment in any period. The largest return period might be quoted
period of time can be more or less than the mea- as the return period of the storm, but it is only
sured values at one or more gauge sites. The runoff meaningful when quoted with its duration.
from a portion of a catchment exposed to a high Intensitydurationfrequency relationships or
intensity rainfall will more than the runoff from the depthdurationfrequency relationships, as
same amount of rainfall spread evenly over the shown in Fig. 12.9, are derived by analysis of a
entire catchment. long set of rainfall records. Intensityduration
frequency data is commonly available all over
12.6.1.3 Synthetic Rainfall the world and therefore it is important to be
A convenient way of using rainfall data is to aware of its method of derivation and ways it can
analyze long rainfall records to dene the be used for simulation modeling.
12.6 Urban Drainage Systems 541

Fig. 12.9 Rainfall


intensityduration
frequency (return period)
curves

The depth of rainfall is the intensity times its Most models assume that the rst part of a
duration integrated over the total storm duration. rainfall event goes to initial wetting of surfaces
and lling depression storage. The depth
12.6.1.4 Design Rainfall assumed to be lost is usually related to the sur-
Design rainfall events (hyetographs) for use in face type and condition. Rain water can be
simulation models are derived from intensity intercepted by vegetation or can be trapped in
durationfrequency data. depressions on the ground surface. It then either
The rainfall intensity during an event is not inltrates into the ground and/or evaporates.
uniform in time, and its variation both in inten- Depression storage can occur on any surface,
sity and when the peak intensity occurs during paved, or otherwise.
the storm can be characterized by the peakedness Initial loss depths are dened as the minimum
of the storm and the skew of the storm quantity of rainfall causing overland runoff. The
(Fig. 12.10). initial loss depth of rainfall for catchment surfaces
A design storm is a synthetic storm that has an can be estimated as the intercept on the rainfall axis
appropriate peak intensity and storm prole. of plots of rainfall verses runoff (Fig. 12.12). The
runoff values shown in Fig. 12.12 were obtained
for various catchments in the UK (Price 2002).
12.6.2 Runoff As rainfall increases so does depression storage.
The relationship between depression storage and
The runoff from rainfall involves a number of surface slope S is assumed to be of the form aS b,
processes and events, as illustrated in Fig. 12.11, where S is average slope of the subcatchment and
and can be modeled using various methods. Most a and b are parameters between 0 and 1. The values
of these methods assume an initial loss, a con- of a and b depend in part on the surface type.
tinuing loss, and a remainder contributing to the Evaporation, another source of initial loss, is
system runoff. generally considered to be relatively unimportant.
542 12 Urban Water Systems

Fig. 12.10 Storm peak skewness proles

Fig. 12.11 Schematic representation of urban rainfallrunoff processes


12.6 Urban Drainage Systems 543

Fig. 12.12 Estimation of


depression storage based
on data from catchments in
the UK (Price 2002)

For example, considering a heavy summer storm Runoff routing is the process of passing
(25 mm rainfall depth) falling on hot-asphalt rainfall across the surface to enter the drainage
(temperature say 60 C falling to 2030 C as a network. This process results in attenuation and
result of sensible heat-loss) a maximum evapo- delay. These are modeled using routing tech-
ration loss of 1 mm is likely to occur. niques that generally consider catchment area
Continuing losses are often separated into two size, ground slope, and rainfall intensity in
parts: evapotranspiration and inltration. These determining the flow rate into the network. The
processes are usually assumed to continue topography and surface channels and even
throughout and beyond the storm event as long upstream parts of the sewer system are usually
as water is available on the surface of the ground. lumped together into this process and are not
Losses due to vegetation transpiration and gen- explicitly described in a model. The runoff
eral evaporation are not particularly an issue for routing process is often linked to catchment
single events, but can be during the interevent surface type and empirical calibration factors are
periods where catchment drying takes place. This used accordingly.
is applicable to models where time-series data are Various models for rainfallrunoff and rout-
used and generated. Inltration is usually ing are available and are used in different parts of
assumed to account for the remaining rainfall that the world. Overland runoff on catchment surfaces
does not enter into the drainage system. The can be represented by the kinematic wave equa-
proportion of this loss can range from 100 % for tion. However, direct solution of this equation in
very permeable surfaces to 0 % for completely combination with the continuity equation has not
impermeable surfaces. been a practical approach when applied to basins
Many models try to account for the wetting of with a large number of contributing subcatch-
the catchment and the increasing runoff that takes ments. Simpler reservoir-based models, that are
place as wetting increases. The effect of this is less computationally and data demanding, rep-
shown in Fig. 12.13. resent the physical processes almost as accurately
It is impractical to take full account of the as the more complex physically based approa-
variability in urban topography, and surface ches (Price 2002). In practice, models applied to
condition. Impervious (paved) surfaces are often catchments typically assume an average or
dominant in an urban catchment and the loss of combined behavior of a number of overland flow
rainfall prior to runoff is usually relatively small. planes, gutters, and feeder pipes. Therefore, the
544 12 Urban Water Systems

Fig. 12.13 Effect of


catchment wetness on
runoff Q over time t (Price
2002)

parameters of a physically based approach (for Qt St=K; 12:24


example, the roughness value) as applied would
not relate directly to parameters representative of where K is a linear reservoir coefcient. This coef-
individual surfaces and structures. cientissometimesafunctionofthecatchmentslope,
Many overland flow routing models are based area, length of longest sewer, and rainfall intensity.
on a linear reservoir-routing concept. A single For a two linear reservoir model, two reservoirs are
reservoir model assumes that the outflow, Q applied in series for each surface type with an equiv-
(t) (m3/s), at the catchment outlet is proportional alent storageoutput relationship, as dened by
to the volume of stormwater, S(t) (m3), present Eq. 12.24,foreachreservoir.
on the ground surface of that catchment includ- The simplest models rely on xed runoff
ing the nonexplicitly modeled network that coefcients K. They best apply to impervious
contributes stormwater to that outlet point of the areas where antecedent soil moisture conditions
urban drainage system. To take into account the are not a factor.
effects of depression storage and other initial Typical values for runoff coefcients are
losses, the rst millimeter(s) of rainfall may not given in Table 12.2 (Price 2002). Use of these
contribute to the runoff. coefcients should be supported either by eld
The basic equation for runoff Q(t) (m3/s) at observations or by expert judgment.
time t is
12.6 Urban Drainage Systems 545

Table 12.2 Typical values of the runoff fraction (coefcient K)

12.6.2.1 The Horton Infiltration Model The integration of Eq. 12.25 over time denes
The Horton model describes the increasing runoff the cumulative inltration F(t).
from permeable surfaces as a rainfall event occurs 
by keeping track of decreasing inltration as the Ft fc t fo fc 1ekt =k 12:26
soil moisture content increases. The runoff from
paved surfaces is assumed to be constant while the The Horton equation variant as dened in
runoff from permeable surfaces is a function of the Eq. 12.26 represents the potential inltration
conceptual wetting and inltration processes. depth, F, as a function of time, t, assuming the
Based on inltrometer studies on small rainfall rate is not limiting, i.e., it is higher than
catchments Horton dened the inltration rate, f, the potential inltration rate. Expressed as a
either on pervious surfaces or on semipervious function of time, it is not suited for use in a
surfaces, as a function of time, t (hours), the continuous simulation model. The inltration
initial inltration rate, fo (mm/h), the minimum capacity should be reduced in proportion to the
(limiting or critical) inltration rate, fc (mm/h), cumulative inltration volume, F, rather than in
and an inltration rate constant, k (1/h). proportion to time. To do this Eq. 12.26 may be
solved iteratively to nd the time it takes to cause
f fc fo fc ekt 12:25 ponding, tp, as a function of F. That time tp is
used in Eq. 12.25 to establish the appropriate
The minimum or limiting inltration rate, fc, is inltration rate for the next time interval (Bedient
commonly set to the saturated groundwater and Huber 1992). This procedure is used, for
hydraulic conductivity for the applicable soil example, in the urban stormwater management
type. model (SWMM) (Huber and Dickinson 1988).
546 12 Urban Water Systems

A flow chart of the calculations performed in a Table 12.3, are highly variable even by an order of
simulation program in which the rainfall can vary magnitude on seemingly similar soil types. Fur-
might be as shown in Fig. 12.14. thermore, the direct transfer of values as measured
Various values for Hortons inltration model on rural catchments to urban catchments is not
are available in the published literature. Values of advised due to the compaction and vegetation
fo and fc as determined by inltrometer studies, differences associated with the latter surfaces.

Fig. 12.14 Flow chart of Horton model inltration algorithm used in each time step of a simulation model
12.6 Urban Drainage Systems 547

Table 12.3 Values for Hortons inltration model for different soil groups as dened by the US Soil Conservation
Service

12.6.2.2 The US Soil Conservation predicting the runoff, q (mm/t), over a time
Method (SCS) Model interval t given the rainfall r (mm/t), in that
The SCS method is a widely used model for pre- time interval.
dicting runoff from rural catchments, especially in
the USA, France, Germany, Australia, and parts of q r RIa RIa 2S=RIa S2 12:30
Africa. It has also been used for the permeable
component in a semi-urban environment. This This equation is used incrementally enabling the
runoff model allows for variation in runoff rainfall and runoff coefcients, r and q, to change
depending on catchment wetness. The model during the event.
relies on what are called curve numbers, CN. The two parameters S and Ia are assumed to be
The basis of the method is the continuity linearly related by
equation. The total depth (mm) of rainfall, R,
either evaporates or is otherwise lost, Ia, inl- Ia k S; 12:31
trates and is retained in the soil, F, or runs off the
where 0 < k < 0.2.
land surface, Q
The original SCS approach recommended
R Ia F Q 12:27 k = 0.2. However, other studies suggest that
k values between 0.05 and 0.1 may be more
The relationship between the depths (mm) of appropriate.
rainfall, R, runoff, Q, the actual retention, F, and The storage variable, S, itself is related to an
the maximum potential retention storage, S (not index known as the runoff curve number, CN,
including Ia), is assumed to be representing the combined influence of soil type,
land management practices, vegetation cover,
F=S Q=RIa ; 12:28 urban development, and antecedent moisture
conditions on hydrological response. CN values
when R > Ia. These equations combine to give vary between 0 and 100, 0 representing no runoff
the SCS model and 100 representing 100% runoff.
The storage parameter S is related to the curve
Q RIa 2 =RIa S 12:29 number CN by

This model can be modied for use in continuous S 25400=CN  254 12:32
simulation models.
Numerical representation of the derivative of Curve number values depend on antecedent
Eq. 12.29 can be written as Eq. 12.30 for moisture conditions (AMC) and hydrologic soil
548 12 Urban Water Systems

group. The antecedent moisture conditions are different conditions are available from various
divided into three classes, as dened in sources. Table 12.6 lists some of these relevant
Table 12.4. to urban areas and antecedent moisture condition
The four hydrologic soil groups are dened in class AMC II.
Table 12.5. Figure 12.15 identies the CN values for
The CN value can either be dened globally antecedent moisture content (AMC) classes I and
for the catchment model or can be associated III based on class II values.
with specic surface types. CN values for

Table 12.4 Antecedent moisture classes (AMC) for determining curve numbers CN

Table 12.5 SCS hydrologic soil groups used in Tables 12.3 and 12.6
12.6 Urban Drainage Systems 549

Table 12.6 Initial CN values for AMC II with various urban land use, cover quality, and hydrologic soil groups
(dened in Table 12.5)

12.6.2.3 The SWMM RainfallRunoff 12.6.3 Surface Pollutant Loading


Model and Washoff
The rainfallrunoff element of the popular
SWMM model generally assumes 100% runoff The modeling of surface pollutant loading and
from impermeable surfaces and uses Horton or washoff into sewer systems is very imprecise.
the GreenAmpt model for permeable runoff. Pollutants that build up on the surface of an
The GreenAmpt model is similar to the Horton urban area originate from wind blown dust,
model, in that it has a conceptual inltration rate debris that is both natural and human-made,
that varies with time. It is therefore applicable to including vehicular transport emissions. When
pervious or semipervious catchments (Huber and rainfall takes place some of this material, as
Dickinson 1988; Roesner et al. 1988). dissolved pollutants and ne solids, is washed
550 12 Urban Water Systems

Fig. 12.15 Runoff curve


numbers for AMC classes I
and III based on curve
numbers for AMC II

into the stormwater sewers or gullies. During A common hypothesis for pollutant accumu-
buildup time many of the pollutants degrade. lation during dry periods is that the mass loading
Deposition of this material is not homoge- rate, mP, (kg/ha/day) of pollutant P is constant.
neous but rather is a function of climate, geog- This assumed constant loading rate on the surface
raphy, land use, and human activity. The of the ground can vary over space and is related to
mechanism of washoff is obviously a function of the land use of that catchment. In reality these
location, land use, rainfall intensity, slope, flow loadings on the land surface will not be the same,
rate, vehicle disturbance, etc. None of these neither over space nor over time. Hence to be
factors are explicitly modeled in most washoff more statistically precise, a time series of loadings
and sewer flow models. may be created from one or more probability
Measurements made of pollutant accumula- distributions of observed loadings. (Just how this
tion and washoff have been the basis of empirical may be done is discussed in Chaps. 6 and 7.)
equations representing both loading and washoff Different probability distributions may apply
processes. In practice the level of information when, for example, weekend loadings differ from
available and the complexity of the processes workday loadings. However, given all the other
being represented make the models of pollutant uncertain assumptions in any urban loading and
loading and washoff a tool whose outputs must washoff model, the effort may not be justied.
be viewed for what they are, merely guesses. As masses of pollutants accumulate over a dry
Modeling does not change this, it only has the period they may degrade as well. The time rate of
potential of making those guesses better. degradation of a pollutant P is commonly
assumed to be proportional to its total accumu-
12.6.3.1 Surface Loading lated mass MP (kg/ha). Assuming a proportion-
Pollutant loadings and accumulation on the sur- ality constant (decay rate constant) of kP (1/day),
face of an urban catchment occur during dry the rate of change in the accumulated mass MP
periods between rainstorms. over time t is
12.6 Urban Drainage Systems 551

dMP =dt mP kP MP 12:33 The sediments of each diameter size class are
commonly assumed to have a xed amount of
As the number of days during the dry period gets pollutants attached to them. The fraction of each
very large the limiting accumulation of a mass attached pollutant, sometimes referred to as the
MP of pollutant P is mP/kP. If there is no decay, potency factor of the pollutant, is expressed as kg
then of course kP is 0 and the limiting accumu- of pollutant per kg of sediment. Potency factors
lation is innite. are one method for dening pollutant inputs into
Integrating Eq. 12.33 over the duration t the system.
(days) of a dry period yields the mass, MP(t)
(kg/ha) of each pollutant available for washoff at 12.6.3.2 Surface Washoff
the beginning of a rainstorm. Pollutants in the washoff can be dissolved in
water, or they can be attached to the sediments.
  
MP Dt MP 0 ekpDt mP 1ekpDt =kP ; Many models of the transport of dissolved and
particulate pollutants through a sewerage system
12:34
assume each pollutant is conservativeit does
where MP(0) is the initial mass of pollutant P on not degrade with time. For practical purposes this
the catchment surface at the beginning of the dry is a reasonable assumption when the time of flow
period, i.e., at the end of the previous rainstorm. in the sewers is relative short. Otherwise it may
Sediments (that become suspended solids in not be a good assumption, but at least it is a
the runoff) are among the pollutants accumulating conservative one.
on the surface of urban catchments. They are Pollutants can enter the sewer system from a
important by themselves, but also because some number of sources. A major source is the washoff
of the other pollutants that accumulate become of pollutants from the catchment surface during a
attached to these sediments. Sediments are typi- rainfall event. Their removal is caused by the
cally dened by their medium diameter size value impact of rainfall and by erosion from runoff
(d50). Normally a minimum of two sediment flowing across the surface. Figure 12.16 shows
fractions are modeled, one coarse high-density schematically some sources of pollution in the
material (grit) and one ne (organics). washoff model.

Fig. 12.16 Some sources of pollutants in the washoff to sewer systems from land surfaces
552 12 Urban Water Systems

The rate of pollutant washoff is dependent on part. The total mass of pollutant P in the runoff
an erosion coefcient, P, and the quantity, MP, must also include those attached fractions (po-
of available pollutant, P. As the storm event tency factors), if any, of each sediment size class
proceeds and pollutants are removed from the being modeled as well.
catchment, the quantities of available pollutants As the sediments are routed through the sys-
decrease, hence the rate of pollutant washoff tem those from different sources are mixed
decreases even with the same runoff. together. The concentrations of associated pol-
When runoff occurs, a fraction of the accu- lutants therefore change during the simulation as
mulated load may be contained in that runoff. different proportions of sediment from different
This fraction will depend on the extent of runoff. sources are mixed together. The results are given
If a part of the surface loading of a pollutant is as concentrations of sediment, concentrations of
attached to sediments, its runoff will depend on dissolved pollutants, and concentrations of pol-
the amount of sediment runoff, which in turn is lutants associated with each sediment fraction.
dependent on the amount of surface water runoff.
The fraction of total surface loading mass 12.6.3.3 Stormwater Sewer and Pipe
contained in the runoff will depend on the runoff Flow
intensity. The following approximate relation Flows in pipes and sewers have been analyzed
may apply for the fraction, fRt , of pollutant P in extensively and their representation in models is
the runoff Rt in period t: generally accurately dened. The hydraulic
characteristics of sewage are essentially the same
ftP aP Rt =1 aP Rt 12:35 as clean water. Time-dependent effects are, in
part, a function of the change in storage in
The greater the runoff Rt the greater will be the manholes. Difculties in obtaining convergence
fraction fPt of the total remaining pollutant load- occurs at pipes with steep to flat transitions, dry
ing in that runoff. The values of the parameters pipes, etc., and therefore additional features and
P are indicators of the effectiveness of the runoff checks are needed to achieve satisfactory model
in picking up and transporting the particular results.
pollutant mass. Their values are dependent on the
type of pollutant P and on the land cover and 12.6.3.4 Sediment Transport
topography of particular basin or drainage area. Pollutant transport modeling of both sediment
They can be determined based on measured and dissolved fractions involves dening the
pollutant mass surface loadings and on the mass processes of erosion and deposition and advec-
of pollutants contained in the rainfall and sedi- tion and possibly dispersion. One-dimensional
ment runoff, preferably at the basin of interest. models by their very nature cannot predict the
Since such data are difcult, or at least expensive, sediment gradient in the water column. In addi-
to obtain, they usually are based on experiments tion the concept of the sewer being a bioreactor is
in laboratories. not included in most simulation models. Most
A mass balance of pollutant loadings can models assume pollutants are conservative dur-
dene the total accumulated load, MPt+1 at the ing the time in residence in the drainage system
end of each simulation time period t or equiva- before being discharged into a water body. All
lently at the beginning of each time period t + 1. these processes that take place in transient are
Assuming a daily simulation time step, generally either ignored or approximated using a
 range of assumptions.
MPt 1 1ftP MPt ekP mP 12:36
12.6.3.5 Structures and Special Flow
Of interest, of course, is the total pollutant mass Characteristics
in the runoff. For each pollutant type P in each Manholes, valves, pipes, pumping stations,
period t these will be fPt (MPt) for the dissolved overflow weirs, etc., that impact the flows and
12.6 Urban Drainage Systems 553

head losses in sewers can be explicitly included practice the lower roughness values are used as
in deterministic simulation models. The impact flow states of interest are usually extreme events
of some of these structures can only be predicted and therefore sewers are operating in surcharge.
using 2- or 3-dimensional models. However, the
ever-increasing power of computers is making 12.6.4.3 Pollution Impact
higher dimensional fluid dynamic analyses on the Environment
increasingly available to practicing engineers. The effects of combined sewer outflows (CSOs)
The biggest limitation may be more related to or discharges are particularly difcult to quantify
data and calibration than to computer models and and regulate because of their intermittent and
costs. varied nature. Their immediate impact can only
be measured during a spill event, and their
chronic effects are often difcult to isolate from
12.6.4 Water Quality Impacts other pollution inputs. Yet CSOs are one of the
major causes of poor river water quality. Stan-
12.6.4.1 Slime dards and performance criteria specically for
Slime can build up on the perimeter of sewers intermittent discharges are therefore needed to
that contain domestic sewage. The buildup of reduce the pollutants in CSOs.
slime may have a signicant effect on roughness. Drainage discharges that affect water quality
In a combined system the effect will be less as include:
the maximum daily flow of domestic sewage will
not usually be a signicant part of pipe capacity. (1) oxygen-demanding substances. These can be
The extent to which the roughness is either organic, such as fecal matter, or inor-
increased by sliming depends on the relation ganic. (Heated discharges, such as cooling
between the sewage discharge and the pipe-full waters, reduce the saturated concentration of
capacity. Sliming will occur over the whole of dissolved oxygen),
the perimeter below the water level that corre- (2) substances that physically hinder reoxy-
sponds to the maximum daily flow. The slime genation at the water surface, such as oils,
growth will be heaviest in the region of the (3) discharges containing toxic compounds,
maximum water level. Over the lower part of the including ammonia, pesticides, and some
perimeter, the surface will still be slimed, but to a industrial effluents, and
lesser extent than at the waterline. Above the (4) discharges that are high in suspended solids
maximum waterline the sewer surface will tend and thus inhibit biological activity by
to be fairly free of slime. excluding light from water or by blanketing
the bed.
12.6.4.2 Sediment
When sediment is present in the sewer the Problems arise when pollutant loads exceed
roughness increases quite signicantly. It is dif- the self-purication capacity of the receiving
cult to relate the roughness to the nature and water, harming aquatic life, and restricting the
time history of the sediment deposits. Most use of the water for consumption and many
stormwater sewers contain some sediment industrial and recreational purposes. The assim-
deposits, even if only temporarily. The only data ilative capacity for many toxic substances is very
available suggest that the increase in head loss low. Water polluted by drainage discharges can
can range from 30 to 300 mm, depending on the create nuisances such as unpleasant odors. It can
conguration of the deposit and on the flow also be a direct hazard to health, particularly in
conditions. The higher roughness value is more tropical regions where waterborne diseases such
appropriate when the sewer is flowing part full as cholera and typhoid prevail.
and when considerable energy is lost as a result The aim of good drainage design, with respect
of the generation of surface disturbances. In to pollution, is to balance the effects of
554 12 Urban Water Systems

continuous and intermittent discharges against the reliance of a diverse fauna population on
the assimilation capacity of the water, so as to dissolved oxygen. These relationships are used
achieve in a cost and socially effective way the by biologists to argue for greater emphasis on
desired quality of the receiving water. biological indicators of pollution as they respond
Figure 12.17 shows the effect of a discharge to intermittent discharges better than chemical
that contains suspended solids and organic mat- tests which, if not continuous, may miss the
ter. The important indicators showing the effect pollution incident. There are a number of bio-
of the discharge are the dissolved oxygen in logical indexes in use in most countries in
diagram a and the clean water fauna shown in Europe.
diagram d. The closeness with which the clean In Fig. 12.17 the BOD in diagram a rises or
water fauna follow the dissolved oxygen reflects stays constant after release despite some of the

(a)

(b)

(c)

(d)

Fig. 12.17 Pollution impact along a waterway downstream from its discharge
12.6 Urban Drainage Systems 555

pollutant being digested and depleting the dis- concentration is temperature dependent. The
solved oxygen. This is because there is a time lag hotter the water is the lower the DO saturation
of up to several days while the bacteria, which concentration.
digest the pollutant, multiply. The suspended All higher forms of life in a river require
solids (SS) settle relatively quickly and they can oxygen. In the absence of toxic impurities there
then be a source of pollutants if the bed is dis- is a close correlation between DO and biodiver-
turbed by high flows. This can create a subse- sity. For example, most game sh die when the
quent pollution incident especially if the DO concentration falls below about 4 mg/l.
suspended solids contain quantities of toxic Perhaps of more pragmatic signicance is the
heavy metals. fact that oxygen is needed in the many natural
Diagram b of Fig. 12.17 shows ammonium treatment processes performed by microorgan-
ions (NH4+) that are discharged as part of the isms that live in natural water bodies. The
dissolved pollutants being oxidized to nitrates quantity of oxygen required by these organisms
(NO3). The rise in the ammonium concentration to breakdown a given quantity of organic waste
downstream of the discharge is relevant due to is, as previously discussed, the biochemical
the very low tolerance many aquatic organisms, oxygen demand (BOD). It is expressed as mg of
particularly sh, have to the chemical. The dissolved oxygen required by organisms to digest
ammonium concentration rises if the conditions and stabilize the waste in a liter of water. These
are anaerobic and will then decline once aerobic organisms take time to fully digest and stabilize
conditions return and the ammonium ions are the waste. The rate at which they do so depends
oxidized to nitrates. on the temperature of, and the quantity of these
Diagrams c and d show the effect of organisms available in, the water at the start.
combined sewer overflows (CSOs) on flora and Since the BOD test measures only the
fauna. The increased quantities of phosphate and biodegradable material it may not give an accu-
nitrate nutrients that they consume can lead to rate assessment of the total quantity of oxidizable
eutrophication. The fauna show perhaps the material in a sample in all circumstances (e.g., in
clearest pattern of response. The predictability of the presence of substances toxic to the oxidizing
this response has lead to the development of the bacteria). In addition, measuring the BOD of a
many biological indices of pollution. The rapid sample of water typically takes a minimum of
succession of organisms illustrates the pattern of 5 days. The chemical oxygen demand (COD)
dominance of only a few species in polluted test is a quicker method and measures the total
conditions. For example, tubicid worms can oxygen demand. It is a measure of the total
exist in near anaerobic conditions, and having amount of oxygen required to stabilize all the
few competitors, they can multiply prolically. waste. While the value of COD is never less than
As the oxygen levels increase these organisms the value of BOD, it is the faster reacting BOD
are succeeded by Chironomids (midge larvae) that impacts water quality. And this is what most
and so on until in clean well-oxygenated water, people care about. However, determining a
there is a wide diversity of species all competing relationship between BOD and COD at any site
with each other. can provide guideline values for BOD based on
In most circumstances, the concentration of COD values.
dissolved oxygen (DO) is the best indicator of Tables 12.7 and 12.8 provide some general
the health of a water source. A clean water ranges of pollutant concentrations in CSOs from
source with little or no biodegradable pollutants urban catchments.
will have an oxygen concentration of about 9 Water quality models for urban drainage are
10 mg/l when in equilibrium with air in a tem- similar, or simpler versions of water quality
perate environment. This maximum saturation models for other water bodies (as discussed in
556 12 Urban Water Systems

Table 12.7 Typical quality of domestic sewage

Table 12.8 Pollutant concentrations (mg/l) in urban runoff


12.6 Urban Drainage Systems 557

Chap. 10). Often just a simple mixing and dilu- COD, suspended solids, ammonia, nitrates, and
tion model will be sufcient to predict the con- similar constituents.
centration of pollutants at any point in a sewer
system. For example, such models may be suf- 12.6.4.5 Oil and Toxic Contaminants
cient for some toxic substances that are not Oils are typically discharged into sewers by
broken down. Once the flows in the CSO enter people, industries, or are picked up in the runoff
the receiving water body, models discussed in from roads and road accidents. Since oil floats on
Chap. 10 can be used to estimate their fate as water surfaces and disperses rapidly into a thin
they travel with the water in the receiving water layer, a small quantity of oil discharged into a
body. water body can prevent reoxygenation at the
A factor that makes predicting the impacts of surface and thus suffocate the organisms living
overflow discharges particularly difcult is the there. The dispersal rate changes with oil vis-
noncontinuous nature of the discharges and their cosity and the length of time the oil is a problem
pollutant concentrations. In the rst sanitary or will partly depend on the surface area of the
foul flush the ne sediments deposited in the receiving water as well.
pipes during dry periods are swept up and There are three main sources of toxic con-
washed out of the system. Most existing models, taminants that may be discharged from CSOs:
termed constant concentration models, do not
account for this phenomenon. Since many of the Industrial effluents. These could be anything
most signicant pollution events occur when the from heavy metals to herbicides.
river has low flows, and hence low dilution fac- Surface washoff contaminants. These may be
tors, the quantity of spill in the rst flush may be contaminants washed off the surface in heavy
very important in the overall pollution impact. rainstorms that in agricultural and suburban
residential areas will probably include pesti-
12.6.4.4 Bacteriological cides and herbicides. In many cases these
and Pathogenic Factors contaminants make a larger contribution to
The modeling of pathogenic microorganisms is the pollutant load than the domestic sanitary
particularly difcult since there are a very large flow.
number of pathogenic organisms, each usually Substances produced naturally in the sewer.
with a unique testing procedure, many of which Various poisonous gases are produced in
are expensive. Also many pathogens may present sewers. From the point of view of water
a signicant risk to human health in very small quality, ammonia is almost certainly the most
numbers. Incubation periods of over 24 h are not important though nitrogen sulde can also be
uncommon and there are as yet no automatic signicant.
real-time monitoring techniques in commercial
use. 12.6.4.6 Suspended Solids
The detection of pathogens relies heavily on Discharges high in suspended solids pose a
indicator organisms that are present in feces in number of problems. They almost invariably
far higher numbers than the pathogenic organ- exert an oxygen demand. If they remain in sus-
isms. Escherichia Coliform (E. coli) bacteria is pension they can prevent light from penetrating
the most common fecal indicator. This indicator the water and thus inhibit photosynthesis. If
is commonly used throughout the world to test deposited they become a reservoir of oxygen
water samples for fecal contamination. demanding particles that can form an anaerobic
Because of the problems in measuring layer on the bed, decreasing biodiversity. They
microbiological parameters involved in CSOs, also can degrade the bed for sh (such as salmon)
most sophisticated methods of determining the spawning. If these suspended solids contain toxic
quality of sewer water restrict themselves to substances, such as heavy metals, the problems
more easily measured determinants such as BOD, can be more severe and complex.
558 12 Urban Water Systems

12.6.5 Green Urban Infrastructure overflows by 12 billion gallons a yearover 2


billion gallons a year more than the current
Many urban areas are being recognized for suc- all-gray strategywhile saving New Yorkers
cessfully using natural ecosystems to reduce the $2.4 billion (NYCDEP 2012).
costs of providing clean drinking water and
managing stormwater. Moreover, this green
12.7 Urban Water System Modeling
infrastructure provides many quality-of-life ben-
ets, by improving air quality, increasing shad-
Optimization and simulation models are becom-
ing, contributing to higher property values, and
ing increasingly available and used to analyze a
enhancing streetscapes. New York City in the
variety of design and operation problems
US, for example, estimates that such efforts have
involving urban water systems. Many are incor-
saved ratepayers billions of dollarsby elimi-
porated within graphics user interfaces that
nating the need for construction of hard gray
facilitate the use of the models and the under-
infrastructure such as storm sewers and ltration
standing and further analyses of their results.
plantswhile preserving large tracts of natural
areas. The departments Green Infrastructure
Plan lays out how the city will improve the water 12.7.1 Optimization
quality in New York Harbor by capturing and
retaining stormwater runoff before it enters the Methods for nding optimal solutions are
sewer system using streetside swales, tree pits, becoming increasingly effective in the design and
and blue and green rooftop detention techniques planning of urban infrastructure. Yet they are
to absorb and retain stormwater (Fig. 12.18). challenged by the complexity and nonlinearity of
This hybrid approach reduces combined sewer especially urban water distribution networks.

Fig. 12.18 Examples of green and blue (upper center) rooftop infrastructures for reducing urban storm runoff and
at the same time enhancing the attractiveness of the urban environment. Some go to extremes
12.7 Urban Water System Modeling 559

Numerous calibration procedures for water subject to a number of loading conditions and a
distribution system models have been developed large number of constraints. Constraints on the
since the 1970s. Trial and error approaches system include maximum and minimum pres-
(Rahal et al. 1980; Walski 1983) were replaced sures, maximum velocities in pipes, tank rell
with explicit type models (Ormsbee et al. 1986; conditions, and maximum and minimum tank
Boulos et al. 1990). More recently, calibration levels.
problems have been formulated and solved as As part of any planning process, water author-
optimization problems. Most of the approaches ities need to schedule the capital improvements to
used so far are either local or global search their system over a specied planning period.
methods. Local search gradient methods have These capital improvements could include water
been used by Shamir (1974), Lansey et al. (1991), treatment plant upgrades, new water sources as
Datta et al. (1994), Reddy et al. (1996), Pudar well as new, duplicate or replacement pipes, tanks,
et al. (1992), and Liggett et al. (1994) to solve pumps, and valves. This scheduling process
various steady-state and transient model calibra- requires estimates of how water demands are
tion problems (Datta et al. 1994; Savic et al. 1995; likely to grow over time in various parts of the
Greco et al. 1999; Vitkovsky et al. 2000). system. The output of a scheduling exercise is a
Evolutionary search algorithms, discussed in plan that identies what facilities should be built,
Chap. 5, are now commonly used for the design installed, or replaced, to what capacity and when,
and calibration of various highly nonlinear over the planning horizon.
hydraulic models of urban systems. They are The application of optimization to master
particularly suited for search in large and com- planning for complex urban water infrastructure
plex decision spaces (e.g., in water treatment, presents a signicant challenge. Using opti-
storage and distribution networks). They do not mization methods to nd the minimum cost
need complex mathematical matrix inversion design of a system of several thousand pipes for a
methods and they permit easy incorporation of single demand at a single point in time is difcult
additional calibration parameters and constraints enough on its own. The development of
into the optimization process (Savic et al. 1995; least-cost system designs over a number of time
Vitkovsky and Simpson 1997; Tucciarelli et al. periods experiencing multiple increasing
1999; Vitkovsky et al. 2000). demands can be much more challenging.
In addition to calibration, these evolutionary Consider, for example, developing a master
search methods have been used extensively to nd plan for the next 20 years divided into four
least-cost designs of water distribution systems 5-year construction periods. The obvious way to
(Simpson et al. 1994; Dandy et al. 1996; Savic and model this problem is to include the system
Walters 1997). Other applications include the design variables for each of the next four 5-year
development of optimal replacement strategies for periods given the expected demands at those
water mains (Dandy and Engelhardt 2001), nd- times. The objective function for this optimiza-
ing the least expensive locations of water quality tion model might be to minimize the present
monitoring stations (Al-Zahrani and Moied 2001), value of all construction, operation, and mainte-
minimizing the cost of operating water distribution nance costs.
systems (Simpson et al. 1999), and identifying the Dandy et al. (2002) have developed and
least-cost development sequence of new water applied two alternative modeling approaches.
sources (Dandy and Connarty 1995). One approach is to nd the optimal solution for
These search methods are also nding a role the system for only the nal or target year. The
in developing master or capital improvement solution to this rst optimization problem iden-
plans for water authorities (Murphy et al. 1996; ties those facilities that will need to be con-
Savic et al. 2000). In this role they have shown structed sometime during the 20-year planning
their ability to identify low cost solutions for period. A series of subproblems are then opti-
highly complex water distribution systems mized, one for each intermediate planning stage,
560 12 Urban Water Systems

to identify when each facility that is to be built construction periods solution that should be of
should be built. For these subproblems, the interest. Prior to the end of that period the
decisions are either to build or not to build to a planning exercise with updated information can
predetermined capacity. If a component is to be be performed again to obtain a better estimate of
built, its capacity has already been determined in what the next periods decisions should be.
the target year optimization.
For the second planning stage, all options
selected in the rst planning stage are locked in 12.7.2 Simulation
place and a choice is made from among the
remaining options. Therefore, the search space is Dynamic simulation models are increasingly
smaller for this case. A similar situation applies replacing steady-state models for analyzing water
for the third planning stage. quantity, pressure and water quality in distribution
An alternative approach is to solve the rst and collection networks. Dynamic models provide
optimization problem for just the rst planning estimates of the time-variant behavior of water
stage. All options and all sizes are available. The flows and their contaminants in distribution net-
decisions chosen at this time are then xed, and works, even arising from flow reversals. The use
all options are considered in the next planning of long time-series analysis provides a continuous
stage. These options include duplication of pre- representation of the variability of flow, pressure,
viously selected facilities. This pattern is repe- and quality variables throughout the system. It
ated until the nal target year is reached. also facilitates the understanding of transient
Each method has its advantages and disad- operational conditions that may influence, for
vantages. For the rst Build-to-Target method, example, the way contaminants are transported
the optimum solution is found for the target within the network. Dynamic simulation also
year. This is not necessarily the case for the lends itself well to statistical analyses of exposure.
Build-up method. On the other hand, the latter This methodology is practical for researchers and
buildup method nds the optimal solution for the practitioners using readily available hardware and
rst planning stage that the Build-to-Target software (Harding and Walski 2002).
method does not necessarily do. As the demands Models used to simulate a sequence of time
in the rst planning stage are known more pre- periods must be capable of simulating systems
cisely than those for the target year, this may that operate under highly variable conditions.
be an advantage. Urban water systems are driven by water use and
The buildup method allows small pipes to be rainfall, which by its nature is stochastic. Changes
placed at some locations in the rst time planning in water use, control responses and dispatch of
stage, if warranted, and these can be duplicated at a sources, and random storms over different parts of
later time; the build-to-target method does not. This the catchment all can affect flow quantities, the
allows greater flexibility, but may produce a solu- flow direction and thus the spatial distribution of
tion that has a higher cost in present value terms. contaminants. Because different water sources
The results obtained by these or any other often have different quality, changing water
optimization methods will depend on the sources can cause changes in the quality of water
assumed growth rate in demand, the durations of within the system (see Box 12.1).
the planning intervals, the economic discount The simulation of water quantities and quali-
rate if present value of costs is being minimized, ties in urban catchments serve three general
and the physical conguration of the system purposes:
under consideration. Therefore, the use of both
methods is recommended. Their outputs, toge- Planning/DesignThese studies dene sys-
ther with engineering judgment, can be the basis tem congurations, size or locate facilities, or
of developing an adaptive master development dene long-term operating policies. They
plan. Remember, it is only the current adopt a long-term perspective but, under
12.7 Urban Water System Modeling 561

current practices, use short, hypothetical sce- of the waters into which urban runoff is dis-
narios based on representative operating charged. In most urban areas in developed
conditions. In principle, the statistical distri- regions, government regulations require designers
bution of system conditions should be an and operators of urban water systems to meet three
important consideration, but in practice vari- sets of standards. Pressures must be adequate for
ability is considered only by analyses inten- re protection, water quality must be adequate to
ded to represent worst-case conditions. protect public health, and urban drainage of waste
OperationsThese short-term studies ana- and stormwaters must meet effluent and receiving
lyze scenarios that are expected to occur in water body quality standards. This requires mon-
the immediate future so as to inform imme- itoring as well as the use of various models for
diate operational decisions. These are based detecting leaks and for predicting the impacts of
on current system conditions and expected alternative urban water treatment, distribution,
operating conditions. These analyses are often and collection system designs and operating,
driven by regulations. maintenance and repair policies.
ForensicsThese studies are used to link Modeling the water and wastewater flows,
presence of contaminants to the risk or actual pressure heads, and quality in urban water con-
occurrence of disease. Depending on whether veyance, treatment, distribution, and collection
the objective is cast in terms of acute or systems is a challenging exercise, not only
chronic exposures, such studies may adopt because of its hydraulic complexity, but also
short- or long-term perspectives. Because because of the stochastic inputs to and demands
there are often dose/response relationships on the system. This chapter has attempted to
and issues of latency in the etiology of dis- provide an overview of some of the basic con-
ease, explicit consideration of the spatial siderations used by modelers who develop
distribution, timing, frequency, duration and computer-based optimization and simulation
level of contamination is important to these models for design and/or operation of parts
studies (Rodenbeck and Maslia 1998; Aral of such systems. These same considerations
et al. 1996; Webler and Brown 1993). should be in the minds of those who use such
models as well. Much more detail can be found in
many of the references listed at the end of this
chapter.
12.8 Conclusions

Urban water systems must include not only the References


reservoirs, groundwater wells, and aqueducts that
are the sources of water supplies needed to meet Al-Zahrani, M. A., & Moied, K. (2001). Locating water
the varied demands in an urban area, but also the quality monitoring stations in water distribution
water treatment plants, the water distribution systems. ASCE, Orlando, Florida: Proceedings of the
World Water and Environmental Resources Congress.
systems that transport that water, together with Aral, M. M., Maslia, M. L., Ulirsch, G. V., & Reyes,
the pressures required, to where the demands are J. J. (1996). Estimating exposure to volatile organic
located. Once water is used, the now wastewater compounds from municipal water supply systems: Use
needs to be collected and transported to where it of a better computer model. Archives of Environmen-
tal Health, 51(4), 300309.
can be treated and either reused or discharged Bedient, P. B., & Huber, W. C. (1992). Hydrology and
back into the environment. Overlaying all of this floodplain analysis, 2nd ed. Reading, MA:
hydraulic infrastructure and plumbing is the Addison-Westley Pub. Co.
urban stormwater drainage system. Boulos, P. F., & Wood, D. J. (1990). Explicit calculation
of pipe-network parameters. Journal of Hydraulic
Well-designed and operated urban water sys- Engineering, ASCE, 116(11), 13291344.
tems are critically important for maintaining Chin, D. A. (2000). Water-resources engineering. Upper
public health as well as for controlling the quality Saddle River, NJ: Prentice Hall.
562 12 Urban Water Systems

Dandy G., Kolokas, L., Frey, J., Gransbury, J., Duncker, Price, R. K. (2002). Urban drainage modeling, course
A., & Murphy, L. (2002). Optimal staging of capital notes. Delft, NL: International Institute for Infrastruc-
works for large water distribution systems, In Pro- tural, Hydraulic and Environmental Engineering.
ceedings, ASCE Environmental and Water Resources Pudar, R. S., & Liggett, J. A. (1992). Leaks in pipe
Planning Symposium, Roanoke, Va. networks. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering, ASCE,
Dandy, G. C., & Connarty, M. (1995). Use of genetic 118(7), 10311046.
algorithms for project sequencing, integrated water Rahal, C. M., Sterling, M. J. H., & Coulbeck, B. (1980).
resources planning for the 21st century. In Proceed- Parameter tuning for simulation models of water
ings of the 22nd Annual Conference, Water Resources distribution networks. Proceedings of Institution of
Planning and Management Division (pp. 540543). Civil Engineers, Part 2, 69, 751762.
Cambridge, Mass: ASCE. Reddy, P. V. N., Sridharan, K., & Rao, P. V. (1996).
Dandy, G. C., & Engelhardt, M. (2001). The optimal WLS method for parameter estimation in water
scheduling of water main replacement using genetic distribution networks. Journal of Water Resources
algorithms. Journal of Water Resources Planning and Planning and management, ASCE, 122(3), 157164.
Management, ASCE, 127(4), 214223. Rodenbeck, S. E., & Maslia, M. L. (1998). Groundwater
Dandy, G. C., Simpson, A. R., & Murphy, L. J. (1996). modeling and GIS to determine exposure to TCE at
An improved genetic algorithm for pipe network Tucson. Practice Periodical of Hazardous, Toxic, and
optimization. Water Resources Research, 32(2), Radioactive Waste Management, ASCE, 2(2), 5361.
449458. Roesner, L. A., Aldrich, J. A., & Dickinson, R. E. (1988).
Datta, R. S. N., & Sridharan, K. (1994). Parameter Storm Water Management Model Users Manual,
estimation in water-distribution systems by least Version 4: Addendum I, EXTRAN,
squares. Journal of Water Resources Planning and EPA/600/3-88/001b (NTIS PB88236658/AS). Athens,
Management, ASCE, 120(4), 405422. GA: Environmental Protection Agency. 203 pp.
Department of Environmental Protection. (2012). NYC Savic, D. A., & Walters, G. A. (1995). Genetic algorithm
2012 Green Infrastructure Annual Report. http://www. techniques for calibrating network models, Report
nyc.gov/html/dep/pdf/green_infrastructure/gi_annual_ No. 95/12, Centre for Systems and Control Engineer-
report_2013.pdf ing, University of Exeter, p. 41.
Greco, M., & Del Guidice, G. (1999). New approach to Savic, D. A., & Walters, G. (1997). Genetic algorithms
water distribution network calibration. Journal of for least-cost design of water distribution networks.
Hydraulic Engineering, ASCE, 125(8), 849854. Journal of Water Resources Planning and Manage-
Harding, B. L., & Walski, T. M. (2002). Long time-series ment, ASCE, 123(2), 6777.
simulation of water quality in distribution systems. Savic, D. A., Walters, G. A., Randall Smith, M., &
Proceedings, ASCE Environmental and Water Atkinson, R. M. (2000). Cost savings on large water
Resources Planning Symposium, Roanoke, Va. distribution systems: Design through GA optimisation.
Huber, W. C., & Dickinson, R. E. (1988). Storm water Proceedings, Joint Conference on Water Resources
management model, Version 4, Users Manual. Engineering and Water Resources Planning and
EPA/600/3-88/001a (NTIS PB88-236641/AS), U.S. Management, ASCE, Minneapolis, Minnesota.
EPA, Athens, GA, 30605. 595 pp. Also see http:// Shamir, U. (1974). Optimal design and operation of water
www.epa.gov/ednnrmrl/swmm/. distribution systems. Water Resources Research,
Lansey, K. E., & Basnet, C. (1991). Parameter estimation 10(1), 2736.
for water distribution networks. Journal of Water Simpson, A. R., Dandy, G. C., & Murphy, L. J. (1994).
Resources Planning and Management, ASCE, 117(1), Genetic algorithms compared to other techniques for
126144. pipe optimization. Journal of Water Resources Plan-
Liggett, J. A., & Chen, L. C. (1994). Inverse transient ning and Management, ASCE, 120(4), 423443.
analysis in pipe networks. Journal of Hydraulic Simpson, A. R., Sutton, D. C., Keane, D. S., & Sheriff,
Engineering, ASCE, 120(8), 934955. S. J. (1999). Optimal control of pumping at a water
Mays, L. W. (Ed.). (2000). Water distribution systems ltration plant using genetic algorithms. In D. A. Savic &
handbook. New York: McGraw-Hill. G. A. Walters (Eds.), Water industry systems: Modelling
Mays, L. W. (2001). Water resources engineering. New and optimization applications (Vol. 2, pp. 407415).
York: Wiley. Baldock, England: Research Studies Press Ltd.
Murphy, L. J., Simpson, A. R., Dandy, G. C., Frey, J. P., Tucciarelli, T., Criminisi, A., & Termini, D. (1999). Leak
& Farrill, T. W. (1996). Genetic algorithm optimiza- analysis in pipeline systems by means of optimal valve
tion of the Fort Collins-Loveland water distribution regulation. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering, ASCE,
systems, Specialty Conference on Computers in the 125(3), 277285.
Water Industry (pp. 181185). Chicago, Illinois: Vitkovsky, J. P., & Simpson, A. R. (1997). Calibration
AWWA. and leak detection in pipe networks using inverse
Ormsbee, L. E., & Wood, D. J. (1986). Explicit pipe transient analysis and genetic algorithms, Report
network calibration. Journal of Water Resources No. R 157, Department of Civil and Environmental
Planning and Management, 112(2), 166182. Engineering, University of Adelaide, p. 97.
References 563

Vitkovsky, J. P., Simpson, A. R., & Lambert, M. F. water systems environment. Science Technology, 47,
(2000). Leak detection and calibration using transients 1072110726. dx.doi.org/10.1021/es4007096
and genetic algorithms. Journal of Water Resources Hutton, C. J., Vamvakeridou-Lyroudia, L. S., Kapelan,
Planning and Management, ASCE, 126(4), 262265. Z., & Savic, D. A. (UNEXE). (2011). Uncertainty
Walski, T. M. (1983). Technique for calibrating network quantication and reduction in urban water systems
models. Journal of Water Resources and Planning (UWS) modelling: Evaluation Report D3.6.1 prepared
Management, ASCE, 109(4), 360372. 2011.005, A framework for integrated modeling of
Webler, T., & Brown, I. S. (1993). Exposure to urban systems.
Tetrachloroethylene via contaminated drinking water Islam, M. R., & Chaudry, M. H. (1998). Modeling of
pipes in Massachusetts: A predictive model. Archives constituent transport in unsteady flows in pipe
of Environmental Health, 48(5), 293297. networks. Journal of Hydraulic Engineering, ASCE,
124(11), 11151124.
Medows, M. E., Walski, T. M., et al. (Eds.). (1997).
Computer applications in hydraulic engineering.
Additional References Waterbury, CT: Haestad Press, Haestad Methods Inc.
(Further Reading) Morley, M. S., Atkinson, R. M., Savic, D. A., & Walters,
G. A. (2001). GAnet: Genetic algorithm platform for
pipe network optimisation. Advances in Engineering
Alegre, H., & Coelho, S. T. (2012). Infrastructure asset
Software, 32(6), 467475.
management of urban water systems, chapter 3. In A.
Grimm, N. B., Grove, J. M., Pickett, S. T. A., & Redman,
Ostfeld (Ed.), Water supply system analysisselected
C. L. (2000). Integrated approaches to long-term
topics. doi:10.5772/52377, ISBN 978-953-51-0889-4
studies of urban ecological systems. BioScience, 50
Axworthy, D. H., & Karney, B. W. (1996). Modeling low
(7), 571584.
velocity/high dispersion flow in water distribution
Ormsbee, L. E. (1989). Implicit network calibration.
systems. Journal of Water Resources Planning and
Journal of Water Resources Planning and Manage-
Management, ASCE, 122(3), 218221.
ment, ASCE, 115(2), 243257.
Bahri, A. (2012). Integrated urban water management,
Ostfeld, A. (ed). (2012). Water supply system analysis
TEC background paper 16 global water partnership
selected topics, ISBN 978-953-51-0889-4, 158 pages,
SE-111 51. Stockholm, Sweden: Printed by Elanders.
Publisher: InTech, doi:10.5772/2882
Chaudry, M.H., & Islam, M. R. (1995). Water quality
Pickett, S. T. A., Cadenasso, M. L., Grove, J. M., Nilon, C. H.,
modeling in pipe networks. In E. Cabreran & A.
Pouyat, R. V., Zipperer, W. C., & Costanza, R. (2001).
F. Vela (Eds.), Improving efciency and reliability in
Linking terrestrial ecological, physical, and socioeco-
water distribution systems. Dordrecht: Kluwer Aca-
nomic components of metropolitan areas, urban ecological
demic Publishers.
systems. Annual Review of Ecology System, 32, 12757.
Clark, R. M., Males, R., & Stevie, R. G. (1984). Water
Rossman, L. A., Boulos, P. F., & Altman, T. (1993).
supply simulation model volumes I, II and III., U.S.
Discrete volume-element method for network water
EPA, Cincinnati, OH.
quality models. Journal of Water Resources Planning
Clark, R. M., Grayman, W. M., Males, R. M., & Coyle,
and Management, ASCE, 119(5), 505517.
J. M. (1986). Predicting water quality in distribution
Rossman, L. A., Clark, R. M., & Grayman, W. M. (1994).
systems, proceedings, distribution system sympo-
Modeling chlorine residuals in drinking-water distri-
sium, AWWA, September 710 (pp. 155180). Min-
bution systems. Journal of Environmental Engineer-
nesota: Minneapolis.
ing, ASCE, 120(4), 803820.
EPA. (1992). CEAM Systems Development Life Cycle
Shamir, U., & Howard, C. D. D. (1968). Water distribu-
Methodology (SDLCM) Statement of Policy, Stan-
tion systems analysis. Journal of the Hydraulic
dards, and GuidelinesVersion 1.00. U.S. EPA,
Division, ASCE, 94(1), 219234.
Athens, GA, 30605.
Tang, K., Karney, B., Pendlebury, M., & Zhang, F.
Feyen, J., Shannon, K., & Neville, M. (2008). Water and
(1999). Inverse transient calibration of water distribu-
urban development paradigms: Towards an integra-
tion systems using genetic algorithms. In D. A. Savic
tion of engineering, design and management
& G. A. Walters (Eds.), Proceedings of Water
approaches. Boca Raton: CRC Press.
Industry Systems: Modelling and Optimisation Appli-
Grayman, W. M., Clark, R. M., & Males, R. M. (1988).
cations (Vol. 1, pp. 317326). Exeter, UK.
Modeling distribution system water quality: Dynamic
Todini, E. (1999). Using a Kalman Filter approach for
approach. Journal of Water Resources Planning and
looped water distribution network calibration. In D.
Management, ASCE, 114(3), 295312.
A. Savic & G. A. Walters (Eds.), Proceedings of
Grayman, W. M., Loucks, D. P., & Saito, L. (Eds.).
Water Industry Systems: Modelling and Optimisation
(2012). Toward a sustainable water future: Visions for
Applications (Vol. 1, pp. 327336), Exeter, UK.
2050. Reston, VA: ASCE Press.
United Nations World Water Development Report No. 4.
Hering, J. G., Waite, T. D., Luthy, R. G., Drewes, J. E., &
(2012). World Water Assessment Programme. Paris:
Sedlak, D. L. (2013). A changing framework for urban
UNESCO.
564 12 Urban Water Systems

Viessman, W. Jr., & Welty, C. (1985). Water Manage- 12:4 There exists a modest-sized urban subdi-
ment Technology and Institutions. New York: Harper vision of 100 ha containing 2000 people.
& Row, Pub.
Land uses are 60% single-family residen-
tial, 10% commercial, and 30% undevel-
oped. An evaluation of the effects of
Exercises
street-cleaning practices on nutrient los-
ses in runoff is required for this catchment.
12:1 Dene the components of the infrastruc-
ture needed to bring water into your home
This evaluation is to be based on the 7-month
and then collect the wastewater and treat it
precipitation record given below. Present the
prior to discharging it back into a receiv-
results of the simulations as 7-month PO4 and N
ing water body. Draw a schematic of such
losses as functions of street-cleaning interval and
a system and show how it can be modeled
efciency (i.e., show these losses for ranges of
to determine the best design variable val-
intervals and efciencies). Assume a runoff
ues. Dene the data needed to model such
threshold for washoff of Qo = 0.5 cm.
a system and then make up values of the
needed parameters and solve the model of
Precipitation (cm)
the system.
12:2 Compare the curve number approach to Day A M J J A S O
the use of Mannings equation to estimate 1 0.6 1.4 0.7 1.9
urban runoff quantities. Then dene how 2 1.1 0.4 0.5
you would predict quality and sediment 3 0.1 0.1
runoff as well. 4 0.1 1.5
12:3 Develop a simple model for predicting the 5 0.1 0.9 1.4 1.9 0.3
runoff of water, sediment, and several
6 0.1 1.4 1.0 0.5
chemicals from a 10-ha urban watershed
7 0.1 1.1 0.7
in the northeastern United States during
S 0.1 0.1 0.7 0.4
August 1976. Recorded precipitation was
as follows: 9 0.6 1.6 0.1 1.5
10 0.1
Day 1 6 7 8 9 10 13 14 15 26 29 11
R1(cm) 1.8 0.7 2.6 2.9 0.1 0.3 2.9 0.1 1.4 3.7 0.8 12 02 02 02
13 0.1 0.2 1.5
Solids (sediment) buildup on the watershed at 14 02 0.5 3.5 0.8
the rate of 50 kg/ha-day, and chemical concen- 15 1.0
trations in the solids are 100 mg/kg. Assume that 16 4.3 2.8
each runoff event washes the watershed surface 17 0.7 0.8 0.5 0.8 1.9
clean. Assume also that there is no initial sediment 18 0.5 0.4 0.1 0.8 0.1
buildup on August. The watershed is 30% imper-
19 0.4 0.4 0.9
vious. For each storm use your model to compute:
20 0.7 03 2.3
(a) Runoff in cm and m3. 21 0.3
(b) Sediment loss (kg). 22 0.1 0.1 0.4
(c) Chemical loss (g), in dissolved and 23 2.0
solid-phase form for chemicals with three 24 3.2 0.1 02 4.7
different adsorption coefcients, k = 5, 25 0.1 0.6 2.8
100, 1000. (continued)
Exercises 565

Precipitation (cm) with the design of such networks that your


model may not be considering.
26 3.0 1.6
12:7 Consider a wastewater treatment plant and
27
associated effluent detention pond
28 0.3 0.1
designed to release treated and stored
29 02 1.1 effluent into a stream so as to adapt to
30 0.1 0.6 varying effluent concentration standards
31 0.2 associated with varying stream assimila-
tive capacities as its flow and water tem-
12:5 Managing the quantity and quality of perature and existing pollutant loads vary
stormwater runoff is a common urban over time. Develop a model for estimating
problem. Discuss the factors to be con- the treatment plant efciency for BOD
sidered when planning storm sewer net- removal, and the size of the detention
works and detention basins, and how basin, needed to meet the varying effluent
might simulation and/or optimization standards of the receiving stream, at a
methods be used to help do this. minimum cost. Dene the data you will
12:6 Multiple connected pipeline networks are need to do this, and all model parameters.
commonly make up urban water distribu- Why might this proposed adaptive treat-
tion systems. Dene a simple pipeline ment scheme not be very practical?
network and develop an optimization 12:8 Urban Infrastructural Asset Management
model for nding the flows and heads in is increasingly becoming a key topic in the
the network needed to provide required move toward increased sustainability of
flow discharges and pressures at various water supply and wastewater systems. List
nodes or junctions of the network. Discuss some characteristics of sustainable infras-
some of the complicating issues associated tructural systems.

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
Project Planning: Putting It All
Together 13

Water resources planning and management


13.1 Water Management
issues are rarely simple. Projects focused on
Challenges
addressing and nding solutions to these issues
are also rarely simple. These projects too need to
Managing water is important. The effectiveness
be planned and executed in ways that will max-
of strategies for dealing with water availability,
imize their likelihood of success, i.e., will lead to
quality, and variability is a major determinant of
useful results. When decision-makers and other
the survival of species, the functioning and
stakeholders disagree over what they want, and
resilience of ecosystems, the vitality of societies,
what they consider useful and helpful, the chal-
and the strength of economies. Humans have
lenge facing project planners and managers is
been managing water and adapting to surpluses
even more challenging. This chapter offers some
and shortfalls since the dawn of civilization, and
suggestions on project planning and manage-
especially since the early origins of agriculture.
ment. These suggestions reflect years of experi-
There is evidence across the globe of thousands
ences the writers and their institutions, have had
of years of dam building and canal construction
planning and participating in various water
to direct water toward crops of various kinds.
resources development projects, at various
Though the tools and infrastructure water man-
scales, in many river basins and watersheds
agers can use today are dramatically more
throughout much of the world.
sophisticated than those used in the past and the
Each water resources system is unique, and
scale on which water managers work is much
the specic application of any planning and
larger in almost all cases, the activities are still
analysis approach needs address the particular
very much the same: managing floods and
issues of concern as well as adapt to the political
droughts through harvesting and storing water
environment in which decisions are made. What
above or underground, delivering water across
is important in all cases is that such planning and
long distances through pipelines and canals,
analyses activities are comprehensive, systematic
treating, distributing water supplies to where they
and transparent, and are performed in full and
are needed, collecting, and treating the resulting
constant collaboration with the regions planners,
wastewaters all designed to meet a variety of
decision-makers, and the interested and affected
economic, public health, environmental, and
public.
social objectives.

The Author(s) 2017 567


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1_13
568 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

In regions witnessing increasing human pop- is unreasonable to think that models of water
ulations demanding more energy and more food resource systems will or even should include
together with a more uncertain climate has led to each component of this interconnected interde-
a complicated dynamic interconnected web of pendent nexus of components, analysts must be
physical, economic, and social components with cognizant that the part of system that they model
many opportunities for intelligent adaptive is interacting with and being influenced by those
management interventions. These interventions components assumed exogenous to the system.
that change the distribution of water quantities
and qualities over time and space can result in
substantial economic, environmental, and social 13.2 Water Resources System
benets. They can also introduce unexpected Components, Functions,
costs and risks. The constraints are physical (as and Decisions
with the large inputs of energy required for
desalination), geographical (depending on the 13.2.1 Components
available suitable locations for reservoirs),
nancial (building, operating and maintaining For the purposes of planning and management
infrastructure required to manage water is water resource systems include three
expensive), political (nobody wants to relinquish components:
rights to scarce water without compensation),
and ethical (what uses deserve to be prioritized, The natural resource system (NRS) compo-
and how they relate to the needs of the nent consists of the streams, rivers, lakes, and
environment). their embankments and bottoms, and the
Trade-offs are fundamental when allocating groundwater aquifers, and the water itself. This
water to various sectors of society. Water is includes the abiotic or physical, biological, and
linked to the production of energy, food, indus- chemical (ABC) components in and above
trial products and to human health and the con- the soil. It also includes the infrastructure
dition of the broader environment. For many needed to collect, store, treat, and transport
kinds of water uses, allocating water to one use water such as canals, reservoirs, dams, weirs,
usually means less water available for other uses. sluices, wells, pumping stations, pipes, sewers,
Consumptive use for agriculture, industry, or and water and wastewater treatment plants, and
cities almost always involves trade-offs, as do the policies or rules for operating them.
mandates for instream flows to protect ecosys- The socioeconomic system (SES) component
tems or sheries. But even consumptive uses do is the water using and water-related human
not diminish the total amount of global water. activities. This component can also include
Consumption shifts water to a different part of the stakeholders, i.e., the interested and
the hydrological cycle: for example, from liquid affected public.
to vapor, from clean to contaminated, or from The administrative and institutional system
fresh to salty. (AIS) component are the institutions that are
Choices about managing water trade-offs responsible for the administration, legislation
involve more than hydrology and economics. and regulation of the supply (NRS) and the
They involve peoples values, ethics, and prior- demand (SES) components of the water
ities that have evolved and been embedded in resource system (WRS). This component
societies over thousands of years. The juxtapo- includes those institutions that plan and build
sition of hydrology, economics, and values is at and operate the infrastructure required to
the crux of the waterclimatefoodenergyen- insure that water is where and when and in the
vironmental and society (people) nexus. While it condition needed in ways benecial to society.
13.2 Water Resources System Components, Functions, and Decisions 569

13.2.2 Functions 13.2.2.1 Subsistence Functions


Communities depend to a large extent on water
Table 13.1 presents a framework of water for household uses, and for irrigating home gar-
resource system functions. This framework dis- dens and community outdoor green and recre-
tinguishes between tangible and intangible ation areas. They may also use streams, paddy
functions. Tangible functions can be described elds, ponds, and lakes for shing. These uses
quantitatively. For example, hydropower gener- are often neglected in national economic
ation or municipal water supply, may be assigned accounts, as they are not marketed or otherwise
a monetary value. Intangible functions are assigned a monetary value. However, if the WRS
activities such as nature conservation or pre- becomes unable to provide these products or
serving a beautiful view that are hard to quantify services, this may well be considered an eco-
in monetary terms. In between are environmental nomic loss.
functions, some of which may be given quanti-
tative values and others valued only indirectly, 13.2.2.2 Commercial Functions
such as by using the opportunity cost associated Commercial uses of water resources are reflected
with a particular target. The self-purication in national economic accounts because they are
process of a river, for example, may be assigned marketed or otherwise given a monetary value,
a value by comparing this work done by nature e.g., the price to be paid for domestic water sup-
with the costs of the least cost alternative that plies. Catching sh for sale by individuals and
accomplishes the same results, such as con- commercial enterprises is an example. These uses
structing, maintaining and operating a wastewa- have a commercial value and most are also con-
ter collection and treatment system. sumptive in nature. The concept of

Table 13.1 Functions of the water resources system


570 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

nonconsumptive use should be regarded with 13.2.2.4 Ecological Functions


certain reservations. Nonconsumptive water use Rivers, streams, and lakes and their associated
may alter the performance of the WRS in various wetlands, floodplains, and marshes offer an envi-
ways. For example, consider reservoirs built for ronment for aquatic species. Landwater ecotones
hydropower. Reduced sediment and sh passage (transition areas between adjacent ecological
and increased evaporation losses may impact communities) are known to harbor a rich assem-
downstream ecosystems and users. Second, blage of species, and are also important for the
operation of the reservoirs for the production of diversity of adjacent ecological communities.
peak power may alter the flow regimes down- These ecological entities have an intrinsic eco-
stream, and this can adversely affect downstream logical value irrespective of actual or potential
ecological habitats and users. Finally, water human use. There are many concepts and expres-
quality problems resulting from reservoirs may sions that describe this ecological value: heritage
impact users and ecosystems. Another example of value, aesthetic value, nature value, option
partly nonconsumptive use is inland water trans- value, existence value, among others.
portation. Oil and chemical pollution caused by
water transport activities can affect other users
Box 13.1. Definitions
and the ecosystem that depend upon the water
Policy goal: what do we want to
resources. Moreover, inland water transportation
accomplish?
may involve a real consumptive demand for
Strategy: how do we want to do it?
water. If water depths are to be maintained at a
Decision: what are we going to do?
certain level for navigational purposes, releases
Scenario: the external economic, envi-
from reservoirs may be required which provide
ronmental, or political situation affecting
no value to other water users. An example is the
our strategy and decision.
Lower Nile system, where water is released from
Lake Nasser to enable navigation and energy
generation during the so-called winter closure.
This water could otherwise remain stored for
(consumptive) use by agriculture during the
growing season. 13.2.3 Goals, Strategies, Decisions,
and Scenarios
13.2.2.3 Environmental Functions
The drainage basin of a river fullls a series of In planning projects the terms goal, strategy,
environmental functions that require no human decision, and scenario are frequently used. In
intervention, and thus have no need of regulatory popular use their distinction is often confusing.
systems. These functions include self-purication In this book we have used the following
of the water and recreational and tourism uses. It meanings:
is sometimes difcult to assign values to envi-
ronmental functions. They may be assessed by A goal denes what is to be achieved or how
using opportunity costs, calculated as the costs of some target is to be met. Goals identify needs,
providing similar functions in other ways, e.g., prioritize issues and dene targets and con-
the cost of additional wastewater treatment. straints on the actions to be taken to meet the
Lower bounds on recreational and tourism values targets. Goals may dene preferred courses of
may be estimated by assessing the economic action. For example, the goal might be to
benets accruing from the use of tourist facilities apply user-oriented demand management
including hotels, and/or the revenue obtained measures rather than relying on large-scale
from the sale of shing licenses. water supply infrastructure development.
13.2 Water Resources System Components, Functions, and Decisions 571

A strategy is dened as a logical combination variables relating to benets and costs. What
of individual measures or decisions that should be considered as a scenario and what as
accomplishes the stated goals and satises the a decision variable may depend on the system
constraints imposed on the WRS. For exam- boundaries that have been dened.
ple, the construction of a reservoir plus the
widening of the canal downstream and the
increase of the intakes of the irrigation system
all in an effort to reduce the risk of damage to 13.2.4 Systems Approaches to WRS
the agriculture sector in a drought prone area Planning and Decision
is one strategy. An alternative strategy might Making
be to implement a cropping pattern that uses
less water. Literature on the systems approach to planning
A decision is the implementation of a par- often emphasizes the mathematical techniques
ticular strategy or course of action. A distinc- used by practitioners of this approach. This book
tion can be made between: is no exception. Most of it is devoted to modeling
Technical (structural) measures: modi- water systems. The use of mathematical tools,
cations of elements of the water resources however, is only part of what constitutes a sys-
infrastructure such as canals, pumping tems approach. The approach applied to complex
stations, reservoirs, and sh ladders. systems of many interdependent components,
Technical measures often include man- involves:
agerial measures such as better ways of
using the infrastructure. building predictive models to explain system
Ecological (nonstructural) measures to behavior,
improve the functioning of ecosystems, devising courses of action (strategies) that
for example, by introducing sh fry in combine observations with the use of models
spawning areas, or large herbivores. and informed judgments,
Economical measures to induce water comparing the alternative courses of action
consumers to alter their use of water by available to decision-makers,
changing the price of the resource use communicating the results to the
(through charges, taxes, or subsidies). decision-makers in meaningful ways,
Regulatory measures to alter the use of recommending and making decisions based
water (through land-use zoning, permits, on the information provided during these
pollution control and other forms of exchanges between analysts, planners, and
restrictive legislation). decision-makers and stakeholders, and
Institutional measures specifying which monitoring and evaluating the results of the
governmental agencies are responsible for strategies implemented.
which functions of the WRS, and speci-
fying the necessary interactions between Systems analysis and policy analysis are often
the public and private sectors involved. considered as being the same. If a distinction is
A scenario is dened as the environment to be made, one might dene systems analysis as
exogenous to the water system under consid- being applicable to more than just policy issues
eration that cannot be controlled. Examples of or problems. It can be applied to any system one
scenario variables include rainfall and other wants to analyze for whatever reason. System
aspects of the climate, demographical trends diagrams or conceptual models identifying sys-
and changes, production functions (including tem components and their linkages are important
crop water requirements), and most economic tools in systems analysis. A system diagram
572 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

Fig. 13.1 Identication of a water resources management (WRM) problem

represents causeeffect relations among the


components of the overall system. An example 13.3 Conceptual Description
of the use of system diagrams in analyzing water of WRS
resources problems is presented in Fig. 13.1.
As Fig. 13.1 shows, water using activities may Water resources management aims to increase
face two problems. First, the quantity demanded the benets to society from the existence and use
may be greater than the supply; second, they of water (NRS). Just how best to do it is societys
adversely impact the natural system (e.g., gener- (SES) choice, commonly made through its gov-
ate pollution or alter the water level). The per- erning institutions (AIS). These three entities
ception of these problems can motivate analysis are depicted in Fig. 13.2.
and planning activities, which in turn can result in The management actions among the com-
management actions. The gure shows that the ponents of a WRS system are depicted by the
problems can be addressed in two ways: either by arrows shown in Fig. 13.2. The arrows repre-
implementing demand-oriented measures (ad- sent only the actions, not the information flows.
dressing the water use, i.e., SES), or by devel- There must be information feedbacks, otherwise
oping infrastructure that impacts the NRS). effective management would be impossible.
Demand-oriented measures aim to reduce water Each of the three systems is embedded within
use and effluent discharge per unit of output. its own environment. The NRS is bounded by
Supply-oriented measures on the other hand are climate and physical conditions; the SES is
aimed at increasing the water supply so that the formed by the demographic, social, and eco-
magnitude and frequency of shortages are nomic conditions of the surrounding econo-
reduced or at increasing the assimilative capacity mies; and the AIS is formed and bounded by the
of the receiving water bodies. Which measure or constitutional, legal, and political system it
combination of measures is most effective operates within. Boundary conditions are usu-
depends on the criteria selected by the imple- ally considered xed, but in some cases they
menting authority. may not be. For example, climatic conditions
13.3 Conceptual Description of WRS 573

Fig. 13.2 Context for


water resources planning
involving the natural
resource, socioeconomic
and administrative
institutional systems

may be considered to be changing due to global 13.3.1 Characteristics


warming. Similarly for laws and regulations. of the Natural
Whether and, if so, when to consider the pos- Resources System
sibility of changes in this external environ-
ment should be decided at the start of any The natural resources system (NRS) is dened by
planning project. its boundaries, its processes, and its control
Consider, for example, regional economic . measures.
This predicted growth is often treated as given. If
the water resources available cannot sustain this 13.3.1.1 System Boundaries
projected growth (or only at very high costs), it The study area of a planning project will often
may be appropriate to reconsider this assumed coincide with an administrative boundary (state,
growth. By learning the consequences of unre- county, district, province, etc.). However, a WRS
stricted growth at the regional level, planners can is typically dened by its hydrologic boundary.
consider the desirability of other options that These political and hydrologic boundaries can
might be considered at higher (usually national) differ. Clearly, any planning project for a WRS
planning levels. This is represented in Fig. 13.2 must include the larger of these boundaries, but
by the border frame socioeconomic develop- not necessarily everything within them depend-
ment plans. In fact, the arrow pointing inwards ing on the purpose of the study and the particular
to the SES is reversed in such a case: the analysis WRS. The consideration of problem sheds that
provides information to a higher planning level contain the components that impact water sheds
that can change the boundary conditions. is often useful.
574 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

For the purposes of modeling it has often 13.3.2 Characteristics


proven useful to subdivide the NRS into smaller of the Socioeconomic
units with suitable boundaries. Examples are System
subdivisions into a groundwater and a surface
water system, subdivision of a surface water Like the NRS, the SES has its boundaries, pro-
system into catchments and sub-catchments, and cesses, and control measures.
subdivision of a groundwater system into differ-
ent aquifers or aquifer components. The deni- 13.3.2.1 System Boundaries
tion of (sub) systems and their boundaries should The economic and social system generally does
be done in such a way that the transport of water not have a physical boundary like that of the
across area boundaries can be reasonably deter- natural system. Economic and social activities in
mined and modeled. a river basin, for example, are connected to the
world outside that basin through the exchange of
13.3.1.2 Physical, Chemical, goods, people, and services. The factors that
and Biological determine the socioeconomic activities to include
Characteristics in a project planning exercise will depend on the
The physical processes in an NRS are transport and context of the problems and development
storage within and between its subsystems. For the opportunities being considered. Outside the
surface water system, a distinction is usually made boundary of the socioeconomic system are fac-
between the infrastructure of rivers, canals, reser- tors or conditions that are beyond the control of
voirs, and regulating structures (the open channel the WRS decision-makers.
network) and the catchments draining to the open
channel network. The biological and chemical 13.3.2.2 System Elements
characteristics dene the biological and chemical and Parameters
composition of groundwater and surface water and The socioeconomic part of the WRS can be
the transport, degradation and adsorption pro- dened by identifying the main water using and
cesses that may influence this composition. The water-related activities, the expected changes and
level of detail to which these characteristics are developments in the study area, and the param-
considered will depend on the requirements and eters whose values dene these changes and
threats they impose on the water using and developments. Examples of activities or eco-
water-based activities. nomic sectors that may be relevant and of the
type of information that has to be obtained to be
13.3.1.3 Control Measures able to describe the SES include:
By adding or changing the values of system
parameters dening design and operating policy Agriculture and sheries: present practice,
options of NRS, water resources managers can location and area of irrigated agriculture,
change the state of the system. An example is the desired and potential developments, water use
rule curve dening how much water to release efciency, and so on.
and when for different purposes. Another exam- Power production: existing and planned
ple is the flow capacity of feeder canals. reservoirs and power stations, operation and
Increasing the capacity of these canals permits capacity, future demands for electric energy.
greater allocations of water to farmers. An Public water supply: location of centers of
example of nonphysical control that changes the population and industrial activities, expected
state of the biotic system is the release of growth, alternative resources.
predator sh in reservoirs to reach a desired Recreation: nature and location, expected and
balance of species in the ecosystem. desired development, water quality conditions.
13.3 Conceptual Description of WRS 575

Navigation: water depths in relevant parts of 13.3.3.1 System Elements


the open channel system. Administrative and institutional settings vary with
Nature conservation: location of valuable and scale, and with the way governing institutions
vulnerable areas and their dependence on exist and operate. In many countries, but certainly
water quality and quantity regimes. not all, the institutional framework consists of:

Some examples of important system parame- the central government, divided into sectors
ters of the SES are labor force and wage rates, such as public works, irrigation, agriculture,
price levels in relation to national and interna- forestry, environment, housing, industry,
tional markets, subsidies, efciency of produc- mining, and transport
tion and water use, and income distribution. a coordinating body, for example, a national
When identifying and analyzing activities in water board, to coordinate actions by various
the study area, it is important to consider possible sectors of the national government
discrepancies between the opinions of individual regional bodies based upon the normal sub-
actors or stakeholders and their representatives. divisions of government, for example, pro-
For example, individual farmers may have dif- vinces, districts, cities, and villages
ferent interests than suggested by the ofcial regional bodies based on a division according
agricultural organizations. to the physical characteristics of the area,
such as river basin authorities
13.3.2.3 Control Measures water user organizations, representing the
The functioning of the SES can be influenced by interests of directly involved stakeholders, for
legislative and regulatory measures, and the price example, in irrigation districts.
of water may be a particularly important factor in
deciding how much is demanded. This price can When initiating broad comprehensive water
be influenced by the water resources managers planning projects knowing the following infor-
and used as a control variable. When the cost of mation is useful:
water use represents only a small portion of the
total cost of an activity, however, an increase in the ministries and coordinating bodies having
its price may have little if any impact on water authority and responsibilities related to water
use. In some cases water use is a necessity of life resources management
no matter how high the costs. In such cases, the the agencies involved in the preparation of
price of water (or taxation for waste water dis- water resources development plans
charges) may not be an acceptable control vari- existing national and regional water resources
able (except perhaps to inform stakeholders on development plans and the authorities
the consequences of possible cost reduction responsible for implementing these plans,
measures). establishing and enforcing regulations, and
overseeing infrastructure construction and
operation
13.3.3 Characteristics the existing legislation (laws and regulations)
of the Administrative concerning water rights, allocation of water
and Institutional resources, water quality control, and the nan-
System cial aspects of water resources management.

The AIS, like the NRS and SES, has its bound- Other often useful information includes the
aries (its authority or limits) and its processes policies and plans of various water-related sec-
including its ways of reorganizing for improved tors such as environment, agriculture, economy,
performance. transportation, urban development and energy.
576 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

13.3.3.2 Control Measures duration of a planning project and the imple-


From a systems point of view, the decision or mentation of the selected development. To
control variables that can be changed in the AIS ignore this increases the risk of generating plans
are less clear than in the case of the NRS and and policies that are no longer relevant or of
SES. Often measures can be taken to improve the interest to the client. Regular reporting (incep-
functioning of the system, for example, by tion and interim reports, etc.) helps in effective
establishing coordinating bodies when these are communication, but a continuous dialogue is
not present, shifting responsibilities toward lower important throughout all stages or phases of the
levels of government, privatization, and other analysis.
measures. If they cannot be changed, at least Decision makers and stakeholders should be
possible benecial changes can be identied and involved in each of the ve (idealized) stages of
presented to those responsible for making this framework. Otherwise there is a risk of the
decisions. planning project producing results that those
potentially impacted will not support. Stake-
holder involvement brings both knowledge and
13.4 Framework for Analysis preferences to the planning processa process
and Implementation that typically will need to nd suitable compro-
mises among all decision-makers and stake-
A water resources planning study generally holders if a consensus is to be reached.
comprises ve general phases, as illustrated in The framework involves a series of decisions
Fig. 13.3. Although we do not suggest the use of at the end of each stage. The divergencecon-
any rigid framework, some distinct phases and vergence process for involving stakeholders in
activities can be recognized and used to structure decision-making on the ve analysis stages is
the analysis as a logical sequence of steps. The illustrated in the rhombus approach of Fig. 13.4.
description of these phases, the activities in them The rst inception stage of the process iden-
and the interactions among the activities in them, ties the subject of the analysis (what is to be
is referred to as the analysis framework. A co- analyzed and under what conditions), the objec-
herent set of models is typically used for the tives (the desired results of the analysis), and
quantitative analyses aimed at identifying and constraints (its limitations). On the basis of this
evaluating alternative benecial measures and analysis, during which intensive communication
strategies. with the decision-makers is essential, an agree-
A decision process is not a simple linear ment on the approach for the remainder of the
sequence of steps as suggested in Fig. 13.3, but analysis needs to be achieved. The results of the
involves feedbacks to earlier steps. Part of the inception stage can be presented in an inception
process is thus iterative. Feedback loops are report, which includes the work plan for the other
needed when: phases of the analysis.
In the situational analysis stage, the tools for
solutions fail to meet current criteria the analysis of the water resource system are
new insights change the perception of the selected or developed. Major activities in this
problem and its solutions phase typically include data collection and
essential system components and links have modeling. The models will be used to quantify
been overlooked the present and future problems in the system.
goals and objectives or the scope of study Scenarios will be developed to describe the
change (e.g., due to changing political, future boundary conditions for the system.
international, developments in society). Identifying and screening of alternative decisions
can occur in this phase. If possible no regret
Communication and interaction with the measures will be identied for immediate
decision-makers are essential throughout the implementation. A gradual improvement of the
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 577

Defining
Analysis Stakeholder
Process

and Criteria

Natural Socio-
Resources Economic
system system

Stakeholders and Decision-makers / Capacity Building


system
Base case Scenario
Analysis Analysis

Reference
Case Data
and
Measures / (Modelling)
Screening Tools
Problem

No regrets

III Strategy Building


/ Scorecard
Management
Analysis

Preferred
Strategy

Investment Planning

Feasibility
Design
and EIA

Monitoring and

Fig. 13.3 Framework for analysis and implementation of water resources projects

understanding of various characteristics of the or those they trust and communicate with are
WRS is often obtained as the study progresses involved as part of the analysis team. More for-
from limited data sets and simple tools to more mal interaction can be structured through pre-
detailed data and models. Interaction with the sentations of results in meetings and in interim
decision-makers will be greatly enhanced if they progress reports.
578 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

decision
decision

decision

decision
III. Strategy V. Implemen-
analysis building planning

start end

Convergence
level of knowledge

Divergence

Fig. 13.4 Divergenceconvergence process in decision-making

In the strategy building stage alternative implementation plan when this appears to be
strategies will be developed and discussed with needed, for example, because the conditions
the decision makers/stakeholders. This will (e.g., nances, social pressures, political mood)
include adaptive management elements to ensure change.
that the preferred strategy is sufcient robust and Each stage or phase needs to provide the
flexible in case the future develops differently information desired by those institutions who
than expected. will decide on what is best to do, and when, and
In the action planning stage the selected how. What those governing institutions need to
strategy will be prepared for implementation. An know to be better informed before making their
implementation plan will be developed that decisions will of course vary among different
describes what will be done, by who, how it will planning projects. But whatever that informa-
be nanced, etc. This stage often requires also tion is the purpose of performing analyses is to
additional work on components of the strategy create and communicate it. The results of the
(such as feasibility and design studies), and analyses performed in a planning project should
environmental impact assessments (EIA). Pro- be of no surprise to those reading them in a nal
motion of the he selected strategy is needed to project report. Again, communication between
sell the proposed measures to public. Finally, the project and the requesting institutions, and
institutional arrangements will have to be made the affected publicthe stakeholdersis
to ensure a smooth implementation. essential throughout the project. This commu-
Finally, in the implementation stage the actual nication may not guarantee a consensus but it
implementation will take place. Continuous can certainly help the project team in their
monitoring and evaluation is needed to adjust the efforts to nd it.
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 579

13.4.1 Step IInception Phase the analysis. For this activity, intensive commu-
nication is required with authorities involved in
Water resources planning studies are often trig- water resources planning and the stakeholders.
gered by specic management problems such as They can provide information on the require-
the need to increase power production or water ments of various interest groups related to water
supply reliability, the occurrence of droughts or and on expected problems. It is not uncommon to
floods, or the threat of water quality deterioration. have the stated objectives of a study differ from
The need for water resources planning in relation the actual (often unstated) objectives of the client
to other sector planning efforts may also be a (including just stalling for time hoping stake-
trigger. Which parts of the WRS are studied and holders will lose interest in a particular issue).
under what conditions follows primarily from the Furthermore, objectives can change over time.
objectives of the study (and from the available As emphasized above, constant and effective
budget, data, and time). The initiators of the study communication between analysts and their cli-
generally have more or less concrete ideas about ents is absolutely essential to the success of any
the objectives and purpose of the analysis. planning project. We mention this often as it is
However, these can change during a study. not always easy given busy time schedules and
The clients ideas about the problems and often having to learn the differences in the
issues to be addressed will usually be described meanings of various words or expressions (jar-
in a Project Formulation Document (PFD) or gon) used by all parties.
Terms of Reference (ToR). The very rst activity
of the project is to review and discuss the con- 13.4.1.1 The Enabling Conditions
tents of these documents. If the subject (what In order to successfully carry out a good planning
needs analyzing) and objectives (what is to be study certain conditions should be met. Most of
accomplished) are adequately described in the these conditions are external to the project
ToR, the next step of the study is to specify and activities. This means that they should have been
agree on the approach (how). set before the planning exercise starts. A generic
In many situations, however, the next task of description of the enabling conditions for inte-
the project will be to assist the decision-makers grated planning is given in Background Paper no.
in further specifying the objectives and subject of 4 (GWP 2000) and is illustrated in Fig. 13.5.

Fig. 13.5 Enabling


conditions (the pillars)
for IWRM
580 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

Enabling environment at national level: The time horizon(s) for the study:
national water legislation and national this may include short term (e.g., 5 years),
policies that guide the planning process medium term (e.g., 20 years) and long
and enables enforcement. term (>25 years);
Institutional framework: The discount rate to be applied in the eco-
existence of water institutions at national nomic analysis:
and regional level with qualied staff; taken as specied by (e.g.) the Ministry of
in case of river basin studies, existence of Finance or Economic Affairs, or by the
some kind of river basin organization nancier of the planned investments (e.g.,
(RBO) at river basin level. ADB, World Bank and JICA);
Management instruments: System boundaries of NRS, SES, and AIS
availability of data, information, and tools the components and the level of detail that
that enables informed decision making. will be included:
e.g., will the coastal zone be included in a
In the Inception stage it should be determined river basin study?
which conditions are relevant for the specic are the results to be presented at local
planning exercise. This depends on the issues government unit level?
involved. If needed, institutional measures can be Time periods based on within- and over-year
part of the planning project. variability of systems processes and inputs
Scenario assumptions concerning factors
13.4.1.2 Setting Up the Stakeholder external to the WRS, such as the growth of
Involvement Process population, food and energy consumption and
The very rst step is to set up the stakeholder prices. See also Sect. 13.4.2.4.
involvement process. Which stakeholders to System assumptions. These concern factors
involve and how will depend on the specic internal to the WRS, such as the response of
basin and the issues to be addressed. In general crop production to improved cultivation
two categories of stakeholders can be identied: practices, or the effectiveness of price incen-
tives on per capita water consumption. These
the people and organizations that will be system assumptions can be subject of addi-
affected by the plan; and tional (sensitivity) analysis.
the people and organization that are needed to Data, time, and budget constraints. Studies
implement the plan. have to be executed within constraints of
available data, time, and budget.
In some cases a stakeholder analysis might be
needed to determine the best stakeholder The choice of the time horizon is often given
involvement process. More detail on involving insufcient attention. Ofcial planning horizons
stakeholders is given in Sect. 13.5.1. (e.g., 5, 10, and 25 years) are typically used as
time horizons for elements of the analysis.
13.4.1.3 Defining Analysis Conditions However, one should also consider the time-
In addition to the more legal and institutional scales of the system and the processes within it.
oriented conditions as described in Sect. 13.4.1.1 System components will have characteristic time
it is necessary to get agreement on the analysis scales. For example:
conditions for the planning study. This includes:
Economic activities have life cycles that are
The base year for the study: usually determined by the amortization period
the most recent year for which basic data of the investments. Time horizons of planning
on the present situation is available; processes can be based on these conditions.
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 581

Social institutions have time horizons that refer to national policy priorities and indicate the
depend on the pace of legal/institutional and contribution the plan will make to the various
political decision making. development goals. Required information is
Physicalchemical systems have time scales usually described in various national policy
that depend on the response or restoration documents. In addition to the national policy
times of the systems. Restoration of polluted documents any existing regional/provincial pol-
rivers, for example, may be achieved within a icy documents need to be taken into account.
few months, while the restoration of a pol- Each plan need to have an agreed objective that
luted groundwater aquifer may take decades. not only focuses on the main, but also expresses
Ecosystems may have a time scale of a few the relation with above mentioned national and
weeks (algae blooms) or tens of years other sector plans, as well as the contribution the
(degradation of mangrove forests), depending basin can make in realizing these higher level
on the type of process or intervention. plans.

To study the sustainability and ecological Operational objectives, criteria and targets
integrity of the resource system, time horizons If needed, the general objectives as stated in the
should be tuned to the response times of the national policy documents have to be translated
system rather than to a planning horizon only. into operational objectives for the specic area
Although more attention is now paid to sustain- under consideration, e.g., a river basin. This
ability, no operational procedure has been gen- should be done by specifying them in socioeco-
erally adopted to properly consider long-term nomic terms, amongst others, which are mean-
effects in the evaluation process. ingful to the decision makers and stakeholders.
Decision-makers tend to focus on short-range For each objective evaluation criteria should be
decisions even if they impose possible risks in dened as a measure of how far the dened
the long term, because their political time hori- objectives have been achieved and, if possible,
zons are often limited to (or renewable in) short clear targets should be specied. Monitoring will
terms and hence they prefer short-term political indicate how far the objectives have actually
gains. been achieved. This process, illustrated in
Fig. 13.6, is discussed in more detail in Chap. 9.
13.4.1.4 Objectives and Criteria The evaluation criteria need to be compre-
An essential activity in the inception phase is the hensive (i.e., sufciently indicative of the degree
translation of general objectives, as described in to which the objective is achieved) and measur-
the ToR or in policy documents, into operational able. The criteria do not all have to be expressed
objectives that can be quantied. Examples of in a single measurement scale. Criteria can be
objectives and criteria are discussed throughout expressed in monetary and nonmonetary terms.
this book and especially in Chap. 9. The objectives It may be useful to incorporate sustainability
and criteria used in a water resources management as an objective, and if so, it may also be useful to
study in West Java, Indonesia are presented as an relate them to the UN Sustainable Development
illustration at the end of this chapter. Goals (SDGs), the SDG targets and the indica-
tors, that have been selected to monitor the
National and regional development
SDGs.
objectives
An essential component of an integrated plan is Illustrative river basin case
the connection of the plan and its objective to Table 13.2 presents a scorecard that summarizes
national development goals as well as to com- results of an analysis for a river basin case. The
mon international goals (e.g., the Sustainable results of the Inception step (i.e., the objectives
Development GoalsSDGs). The plan should and criteria), for this river basin are given in the
582 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

Objective 1: Provide safe water and sanitation


for the people;
(e.g. food security) % people access to safe drinking water;
% people access to sanitation facilities;
Objective 2: Increase food production;
(e.g. achieve self-suciency in rice) Irrigation area (ha);
Number of animal water points (#);
Objective 3: Support economic sectorsin-
(e.g. self-suciency index in %) dustry and energy;
Water supplied to mining (% of demand);
Target Water supplied to industry (% of
(e.g. 100 %) demand);
Hydropower generated (MWh);
Objective 4: Protect the Environment;
(e.g. 80 %)
Protected watershed area (km2);
Number of springs/sources protected (#);
Average class water quality rivers (class A
Fig. 13.6 Making objectives operational to D);
Objective 5: Decrease vulnerability to floods
and droughts;
Vulnerability to floodsaverage damage
rst two columns of the table. They show that for
($/year);
this case ve objectives were formulated. For
Vulnerability to droughtsaverage dam-
each objective 2 or 3 criteria were identied that
age ($/year).
expresses in how far the objective is or will be
In addition two implementation-related crite-
achieved:
ria were formulated to evaluate the strategies:

Table 13.2 Example of a scorecard showing objective values associated with various strategies

Base Alternative (investment) strategies


Objectives and criteria Year Targets Ref. case (no action) Strategy 1 Strategy 2
unit 2010 2020 2030 Perfect 2020 2030 2020 2030 2020 2030
Obj.1: Water and Sanitation
% people access to safe drinking water % 50% 63% 73% 100% 63% 73% 63% 73% 63% 73%
% people access to sanitation facilities % 30% 50% 70% 100% 50% 70% 50% 70% 50% 70%

Obj.2: Food production


Irrigation area 1000 ha 24 30 35 40 26 28 28 31 30 35
# animal water points # 300 500 900 1000 400 700 500 900 500 900

Obj.3: Industry and Energy


Water supplied to mining % 30% 80% 90% 100% 40% 50% 50% 70% 80% 90%
Water supplied to industry % 70% 80% 90% 100% 70% 70% 80% 90% 80% 90%
Hydropower generated MWh 34 80 120 120 34 34 70 110 80 120

Obj.4: Environment
2
Protected watershed area km 1200 2500 3500 3500 2000 2500 2500 3000 2500 3500
Number of springs/sources protected # 300 600 900 900 400 600 500 700 600 850
Average class water quality rivers I-V II III IV V II III III III III IV

Obj.5: Vulnerability
Vulnerability to floods - average damage m/yr 120 < 78 < 50 0 100 80 100 80 78 50
Vulnerability to droughts - average damage m/yr 200 < 50 < 30 0 160 120 80 40 50 30

Implementation information
Required investments m - - - 400 650 600 1200
B/C ratio economic categories (Obj.2, Obj.3) - > 1,3 > 1,2 - 1.3 1. 2 1.2 1.1
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 583

Required investments ($); start of the project, the study will have to obtain
Benet/Cost ratios of economic categories the additional detail needed fulll the objectives
(</>). of the analyses. Sometimes the right level of
detail is chosen, but team members may be
13.4.1.5 Work Plan tempted to spend too much time addressing more
and Decision-Making detailed questions of interest to them and fail to
Once it is clear what will, as well as what will come up with the information desired within the
not, be analyzed and why, analysts can specify available time. Maintaining the proper level of
how this will be done. A description of the detail is one of the main reasons for feedback
system to be analyzed includes the conditions loops in the analysis process.
and the assumptions under which the analysis
will be performed. Computational Requirements
All required activities can be combined in a An important element of the work plan will be
work plan. It is often advantageous to develop a the determination of the computational resources
critical path network of the various analysis needed for the analysis. This includes mathe-
tasks. Critical path networks dene the sequence matical models, databases, GIS, and the like.
of various tasks required to complete an analysis, Together these must be used in a way that
or indeed the entire planning project, and their describes the system and permits an evaluation of
start and nish times. This will guide the allo- possible measures and strategies under different
cation of personnel and identify the time needed scenarios at the level of detail desired. Often a
to perform such tasks. These networks can be combination of simulation and optimization
updated as the project proceeds. Such networks models has proven useful.
are useful for scheduling activities and personnel For the purposes of analysis, the study area is
involved in the project, and for ensuring (or at typically subdivided over space and time into
least increasing the probability) that data and smaller units considered to be homogeneous with
personnel will be available for each activity when respect to their characteristic parameters. Each
needed and when decision-makers and stake- unit can be included in mathematical model(s).
holders are to be involved in the analyses or in The number of elements required for the analysis
workshops or meetings focused on improved depends on the issues being addressed, the
understanding of project progress and goals. complexity of the study area, the measures to be
studied and the availability of data. It generally is
Data Availability
wise to start with a preliminary schematization
An important boundary condition for studies is
with the minimum number of elements. If more
often the availability of data and other informa-
spatial or temporal detail is required model ele-
tion required for the study. The availability of
ments can be subdivided. The assumptions and
data determines the level of detail and accuracy
conditions under which analyses are undertaken
that can be achieved in the analysis. If few data
should be specied in close cooperation with
are available, a more qualitative analysis may
those institutions overseeing and contributing to
have to be performed. The required level of detail
the study.
will primarily depend on the problems to be
addressed and the objectives to be satised.
Work Plan
Level of detail One of the main tasks of a The results of the inception phase are docu-
project leader is to motivate and manage the mented in an inception report. This report can
experts from various disciplines. Not staying serve as a reference during the execution of the
focused on the appropriate level of detail is one study. An essential part of the report is the pro-
of the most common causes for project failure. If posed work plan, in which time, budget and
the needed level of detail is underestimated at the human resource allocations to various activities
584 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

are specied. This work plan typically includes will be collected and where necessary and pos-
bar charts (possibly derived from critical path sible the system components will be captioned in
analyses) for activities and stafng, time sched- models. As much as possible this should be done
ules for deliverables, milestones, reporting pro- in close collaboration with the stakeholders to
cedures and similar features. The report should ensure that the analysts and stakeholders have the
include a communication plan that describes the same understanding of the system. Once these
interaction between the decision-makers and models are available a structured analysis can be
stakeholders and the analysis team. carried out to quantify the present and future
problems and a start can be made with identify-
Inception Report ing measures to address these problems.
An inception report is a specic and concrete
result of the inception phase. It contains the 13.4.2.1 Understanding
ndings of and decisions made during the incep- and Describing
tion phase. It should make clear what will be the Water Resources
studied, and why and how. In many cases it will System
also specify what will not be studied and why. The A WRS comprises:
content of the inception report follows the sub-
jects mentioned above. It is an important product Natural (Resources) System (NRS);
because it contains all that has been learned in this Socioeconomic System (SES); and
rst inception phase and that has been agreed Administrative and Institutional System
upon between the analyst and the client (the (AIS).
decision-makers and the stakeholders).
A possibly even more important result of the Each of the three systems is embedded within
inception phase, however, is the interaction its own environment. The Natural Resources
between the analyst and the client that took place System is bounded by climate and (geo)physical
during this phase. It should state the clients conditions. The SES is formed by the demo-
views about problems, objectives and other graphic, social and economic conditions of the
aspects. Project analysts must understand the surrounding economies. The AIS is formed and
clients concerns, problems and objectives. Cli- bounded by the constitutional, legal and political
ents should feel they own the results of the system. The interlinkages of the three systems
inception phase and view the inception report as are illustrated in Fig. 13.7.
their own product, not merely a report of the It is important that the plan includes a good
planners, analysts or consultants. To achieve description of the integrated elements of the
such ownership, frequent interaction must have
taken place among the analysts, the
decision-makers and stakeholders, to a much
greater extent than is indicated in Fig. 13.3. This
can be done in specic workshops, such as those
devoted to the problem statement or to the
specication of objectives and criteria.

13.4.2 Step IISituation Analysis

In the situation analysis phase the study starts to


dig deeper in the water resource system. Its
various components will be studied in detail, data Fig. 13.7 Systems components of a WRS
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 585

WRS. Most decision-makers and stakeholders system is used to study the influence they have on
will be nontechnical or only know about a lim- the user functions or the biological system. The
ited part of the overall system. To be able to components and processes that are to be consid-
make balanced decisions they should understand ered in the analysis should have been selected in
how the overall system functions and how the inception phase. The analysis of the biological
interventions in one part of the system will system aims to determine the response of the
impact other systems elements. ecosystems to water resources management (see
The situational analysis starts with an inven- Chap. 10). Since often there is too little exact
tory of the characteristics of the WRS. This information on individual biotic components and
requires the reduction of a complex reality into a their behavior under different hydrologic and
comprehensible description of system compo- chemical regimes, models of ecosystems typically
nents and linkages. Choices have to be made depend on habitat parameters.
about what (the detail that) should be included
and what can be ignored. Such choices require Analysis of the Socioeconomic System
engineering and economic judgment in combi- (SES)
nation with an understanding of the problems and Developments in the SES determine the way
possible measures that can be taken to improve demands on the NRS may change. Conversely, the
system performance. The next step will be an development of economic activities within the
inventory of the activities and ongoing develop- study area may depend on the availability of water.
ments that will determine how the system will For example, good supplies of relatively cheap
perform in the future and what kind of additional surface water may stimulate the development of
activities can be expected. This can include irrigated agriculture, or attract industrial activities
autonomous developments (such as population that require large quantities of water for their
and urban growth) as well as policy decisions production processes. Another example is the
that have been or may be taken that could development of water-based recreation activities
influence the characteristics and performance of adjacent to a reservoir. These SES developments
the WRS. An inventory of policies and institu- in turn increase the water demands. Economists or
tions is helpful for identifying who is involved in planners may be able to estimate future levels of
the management and development of the system the activities dependent on water discharges and
(and hence who should be involved in the anal- storage levels. These relations can be incorporated
yses) and their objectives and opinions. This into water resource planning models.
knowledge will contribute to the development of
The starting point for an analysis of the SES is
scenarios for the analyses.
an assessment of the present economic situation
Analysis of the Natural Resources System with respect to the water-related activities and the
(NRS) factors that determine these activities. Past trends
The NRS comprises the natural and engineered can help provide information on factors that have
infrastructure, including the hydrometeorological been decisive in bringing about the present sit-
boundary conditions. Models can be used to uation and that may give clues about the likely
simulate the processes of water distribution impacts of future developments. Ones attention
through the infrastructure, taking into account the should be on the most important factors that
storage of water and water withdrawals to satisfy determine relevant water-related activities rather
the demands of water-using activities. Such than on analyses of the total economy. However,
models have been introduced in many of the the difculty in forecasting economic develop-
previous chapters of this book. ment is the uncertainty about which factors will
The results of the water quantity modeling be decisive for this development.
may be the inputs for water quality models. The Part of the data needed to develop planning
analysis of chemical components in the water models is the relation between the economic
586 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

activities and their water use. Data are needed Future water demands are often dependent on
that dene the type and amount of water used by future scenarios. A water demand scenario is a
various activities. Data are needed identify the logical but assumed combination of basic SES
following with respect to each identied activity: parameters and their effects on water-related
activities, including the resulting water demands.
the amounts of water (quantity and quality) An understanding of the functioning of the SES
demanded and consumed during which peri- developed through the assessment of past and
ods of the year and at which locations present trends is often helpful when formulating
the amounts of water discharged and the a limited number of consistent scenarios.
pollution loads during which periods of the Box 13.2 is an example of one such scenario.
year and at which locations
the benets to the user if these amounts are
Box 13.2. Example demand scenario
made available
The water demand in an agricultural area
the damage to the user if these amounts are
depends largely on the availability of land
not available
and the crops being irrigated. The demand
costs that can be recovered by having the user
for agricultural products, however, will
pay for the water and its influence (both at the
develop in an autonomous way. If the
intake and the discharge sites of his activity)
availability of water resources in a region is
on the water use pattern.
limited, the autonomous development of
the agriculture sector will be limited as
All these data should be able to contribute to
well, and one would predict a small
the estimates of future water demands, con-
increase in agricultural water demand. If the
sumption and wastewater discharges per unit of
demand for agricultural products increases
activity. As well as the level of activities and the
considerably and self-sufciency in food
resulting water demands, knowledge of the geo-
production is an objective, then the political
graphical location of water using activities (the
pressure for agricultural development to
pattern of activities) is necessary. If the pattern of
meet this objective may be considerable.
activities is not expected to change, the analysis
The water demand corresponding to this
can be focused on the present situation in the
desired agricultural development could
study area. If new activities are expected to
show the need for further development of
develop within the study area and their water use
the water resources in the region.
characteristics are unknown, it may be necessary
to study the water use characteristics of similar
activities in other regions.
Analysis of the Administrative and Institu-
The resulting water demand data need not
tional System (AIS)
always be considered as given. Water-use
An analysis of the AIS is required to identify any
coefcients can be changed through measures
legal or regulatory or institutional constraints on
such as water pricing that aim at reaching a
water resources management. Attention must be
socially preferred use pattern. Technological
given to the interaction between various author-
developments may result in less water use and
ities involved in water resources management
pollution load per person or unit of product. If
and to the effectiveness of the AIS. Arrange-
supplies and demands are matched before the
ments made in the past concerning the use of
effects of such incentives are analyzed then one
water (water rights) should be identied, since
may over estimate needed capacities, because the
these may signicantly constrain the options for
given demands may be lower if water users are
water resources development.
confronted with the costs as well as the benets
Water resources management studies are often
of water use. This type of internal feedback
limited to the preparation of policies for a certain
should be considered in the study.
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 587

agency. In this situation, the analysis of the AIS analyze a river basin under drought conditions.
will mainly serve to identify measures that the The reservoirs in the system involve sedimenta-
agency can implement effectively. The respon- tion and hydropower generation. The core of this
sible agency should be aware of the possible role modeling framework is formed by the core
they may have in solving the management models block in the upper right corner of the
problems. Sometimes, the analysis of the AIS gure. In this block the demand for water is
may result in recommendations for institutional determined, followed by a balancing of supply
and legal changes. through water allocation decisions. Links among
these core models are automatic. Other models
13.4.2.2 Data and Modeling are linked through le transfer. This applies to
The result of the data collection and modeling the required input on macroeconomic and
activities is a quantitative representation of the hydrometeorological conditions (generated by
WRS at an appropriate level of detail. The scenarios) as well as the side analysis of the
framework is designed to assess the effects of sedimentation and water quality in the reservoirs.
individual measures or combinations of mea- The last parts of the computational framework
sures, expressed in values for the evaluation are the modules that determine the nancial and
criteria chosen. If computer programs for running economic aspects (investments, operation and
models have to be developed or if existing maintenance, benetcost, etc.) and support a
computer programs have to be adapted in a sig- multi-criteria analysis.
nicant way, a considerable effort may be At various places in this modeling framework,
required which may consume a large part of the one can change the values of input parameters.
available budget and time. Careful selection of Scenarios can be analyzed by changing the
the phenomena to be represented by the models, macroeconomic and hydrometeorological
tuned to the needs of the project, is important. conditions.
During the modeling activity, more informa- Figure 13.8 is just an example. Other problem
tion on the study area and the type of measures to situations may require different modeling
be considered may become available. This could frameworks. The goal in creating such model
lead to changes in model structure. The models frameworks is to make them as simple and
should therefore be flexible and adaptable to new transparent as possible, and still adequately
information. address the problems to be solved. Sometimes
complexity is necessary. In any event it saves
Model Integration
time and money to start as simple as possible and
The various models and components developed
only add more detail when necessary to carry out
for the NRS and SES describe parts of the total
a proper analysis.
system. Some models may produce output that is
needed as input for another model. For example, Collaborative modeling
the output of a water quantity model may be the Involving decision-makers and stakeholders in
input to a water quality model requiring different the analysis process has till recently been limited
spatial and temporal resolutions. Some models to the more general analysis about problems and
may include links to various sub-models and run solutions. The quantitative information, e.g.
interactively, others not. Depending on the mod- resulting from models, was provided by the ana-
els and the problem situation, single or multiple lysts (e.g., consultants) as input for the discus-
linked models may be included within an inter- sions. More and more we see that stakeholders do
active decision support system. In other cases, a not accept this black box approach anymore. They
clear description of information flow from one want to understand what went into the model, how
independent model to another may be sufcient. the models work and, preferably, they want to
Figure 13.8 provides an example in which play with the model themselves. This is a
various simulation models are combined to promising development as this will increase the
588 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

Fig. 13.8 Example of typical computational framework of simulation models

understanding of the stakeholders on how the collaborative modeling are currently being
system works and let them see the opportunities developed, sometimes under different names such
and constraints of that system. Having stake- as Collaborative Modeling for Decision Support
holders involved in the development and running (e.g., shared vision modeling), Mediated Model-
of the models requires that these models are made ing, Group Model Building, Companion Model-
more accessible and intuitive, in particular their ing, Interactive Modeling, Networked
input/output interfaces. It requires also a different Environments for Stakeholder Participation or
attitude of the modelers. Various approaches to Model-supported Collaborative Planning.
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 589

13.4.2.3 The Need for a Structured next section on more information about devel-
Quantified Analysis oping scenarios.
Process
Decision making on measures and strategies to Reference case
improve the performance of the WRS should be The reference case addresses the future situation
based on quantied information about the present by considering the present infrastructure, to which
problems (e.g., average flood damage) and the measures are added that have already been decided
impacts of proposed measures (e.g., the reduction or are being executed, together with selected sce-
in flood damage) and the costs of these measures. nario conditions. In the reference case an analysis
To be able to produce this quantied information of the performance of the WRS is undertaken if
the following is needed: present policies and regulations are continued and
followed by the government and the water users.
a structured analysis process (this section);
and Problem descriptionpresent and future
a computational framework (see previous The problem description should be carried out
section). based on the results obtained from the base and
reference case analyses in combination with the
The analysis process starts with a quantied problems and issues perceived by the
problem description. The analysis of the present decision-makers and stakeholders. A problem
situation is called the Base Case analysis. To be analysis should be expressed as far as possible in
able to predict possible future problems scenarios terms of the socioeconomic and environmental
should be dened on how this future might impacts that have a meaning to the decision
develop. The computational framework will makers and stakeholders. An integrated approach
calculate the impacts (the future problems) of is crucial for a solid understanding of the system
these possible external developments. This is and its associated problems. The integrated
often called the Reference Case analysis. approach can only be achieved if the plan denes
the main problems and issues in the basin and its
Base case
interlinkages. For this, it is important that the
The performance of the WRS is studied for the
plan is aligned with other related plans such as
infrastructure and water demands in the base
Watershed Plans (erosion), Flood Risk Manage-
case. The base case is based on the base year,
ment (FRM), and Integrated Coastal Zone Man-
which is the most recent year for which a com-
agement (ICZM), amongst others.
plete set of data can be collected. The base case
describes thus the performance of the WRS in the
Inventory of potential measures and selec-
present situation. A comparison of the base case
tion of promising measures
with the criteria (and possible targets) specied
Once the present and future problems are known
in the WRM objectives will result in a quantied
measures (including no regrets that can
problem statement.
immediately be implemented) can be identied
that will address these problems. An inventory
Scenario conditions
should be made of all the measures that the
A good plan should also address the expected
stakeholders are planning or considering. Based
water-related problems in the future. The analysis
on the quantied problem analysis additional
for the future time horizon(s) should include
measures might be formulated. The computa-
different scenario conditions. Possible scenario
tional framework can be used to determine the
conditions for WRM are socioeconomic devel-
impacts of these measures. The most promising
opments (change in demand and pollution) and
measures will be kept for detailed analysis in the
climate change (including sea level rise). See the
next step: Strategy Building.
590 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

base case analysis reference case analysis


scenario analysis

present expected future


problems and issues problems and issues

promising measures
inventory of measures

No-regret
measures

. to Strategy
Building phase Planning phase

Fig. 13.9 Structured analysis process

The above described structured analysis pro- economic evaluation of the plan it might be
cess is illustrated in Fig. 13.9. needed to make assumption about the future
prices of energy and food. Changes in diet (e.g.,
13.4.2.4 Scenario Analysis the consumption of more meat) can also be
A good plan should not only address the present important.
problems but should also prepare for problems The most used combination of scenario ele-
that might arise in future. To predict the future ments are presented in a quadrant of low and
scenario assumptions have to be made. Scenarios high economic growth versus slow and fast cli-
are possible developments external to the WRS, mate change. Ideally the whole analysis should
i.e., outside the control of the decision makers be carried out for all kind of scenario combina-
involved in the project. The most usual scenario tions and the selection of the best strategy should
components for water resources studies are be based on the evaluation which strategy is able
socioeconomic developments (e.g., growth of to cope with all these possible future develop-
population and economic activities) and climate ments. In reality most analyses are carried out for
change (including sea-level rise). For the the most likely scenario based on a trend analysis
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 591

or Business-As-Usual (BAU). The strategy that all possible kinds of actions that can be taken will
follows out of this is then analyzed in a scenario in general result in hundreds of discrete possi-
analysis, to test that strategy on robustness and bilities. In most cases it will not be practicable to
flexibility for other possible futures. See also analyze all of them in detail. A screening process
Sect. 13.4.3.2 on adaptive management analysis. is needed to select the most promising ones. This
can be done in several ways. As mentioned in
13.4.2.5 Quantified Problem Analysis various chapters of this book, separate opti-
A problem analysis should address and be mization models can be used to eliminate less
expressed in terms of the socioeconomic and attractive or less promising alternatives. It can
environmental or ecosystem impacts that are of also be done by using the modeling framework
interest to the decision makers. Not all stake- developed for the project but limiting the analy-
holders may be able to relate to predicted changes sis to a few criteria, such as economic or envi-
in flows, water levels, or pollutant concentrations. ronmental ones. A third kind of screening
Some may want to know how much money is analysis is to apply judgment as to criteria
involved, the rate of shore line erosion, the rela- effectiveness, efciency, legitimacy and sustain-
tive change in sh population, or the number of ability. Box 13.3 describes these criteria.
people affected by flooding. Expressing outcomes
in terms of socioeconomic impacts makes it easier
Box 13.3. Criteria for screening
to relate the problems to the (socioeconomic)
Effectiveness. Measures to be taken are
development objectives that decision-makers
those which solve the most serious prob-
have formulated for the particular region or sys-
lems and have the highest impact on the
tem under consideration.
objectives. Measures to prevent problems
A good problem analysis will also indicate the
will be preferred to those that solve them.
measures that can be taken to eliminate, reduce
Similarly, measures that solve problems
or alleviate the identied problems or to take
will be preferred to those that only control
advantage of new benecial opportunities. The
them.
identication of measures not only helps to
Efciency. Measures to be taken should
clarify the problems and possible solutions; but
not meet the explicit objectives at the
also helps in the design of the computational
expense of other implicit objectives. The
framework and the data collection activities.
costbenet analysis (at the national level)
These activities should be designed in such a way
is one indicator of efciency. An example
that the measures can be evaluated in the analysis
is to create a law that forces industrial rms
phases of the study.
to incur the full cost of end-of-pipe
On completion of the initial analysis, project
wastewater treatment. In Egypt, this
staff (and the decision makers/stakeholders)
would improve the Nile system water
should have a clear idea about what will be
quality, and thus improve health of those
studied in subsequent phases, for what purpose
who drink it and reduce environmental
and under what conditions.
damage. On the other hand it might impose
high costs to the rms, possibly resulting in
13.4.2.6 Identification and Screening
loss of employment. An efcient decision
of Potential Measures
may be to opt only for cost sharing rather
Once the base and reference cases have been
than full cost recovery.
dened, and the problems and bottlenecks iden-
Legitimacy. Measures to be included in
tied, measures to address resource management
the strategy should not rely on uncertain
problems can be considered. Measures can be
legal/institutional changes. Measures
divided into different categories. An inventory of
should also be as fair as possible, thus
592 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

13.4.3 Step IIIStrategy Building


reducing public opposition so that they will
be favored by as many stakeholders as In the Strategy Building step, promising measures
possible. are combined into strategies. The effects of various
Sustainability. Measures to be taken are strategies are assessed and a limited set of
those that improve (or at least do not promising ones is dened. For these promising
degrade) the present environmental and strategies, the effects are assessed in more detail.
socioeconomic conditions for future The sensitivity of these effects to the values
generations. assigned to the uncertain model parameters is then
assessed. Finally, the results of the selected strate-
gies should be presented to the decision-makers.
The aim of the screening process is to identify The selection process is depicted in Fig. 13.10.
those measures that should be further analyzed.
The screening of measures is a cyclic process. 13.4.3.1 Strategy Design and Impact
Assessing the measures will contribute to a better Assessment
understanding of their effectiveness and new ones Strategy design involves the development of
may be identied (comprehension loop). Combi- coherent combinations of promising measures to
nations of measures may be considered for satisfy the management objectives and meet the
specic parts of the WRS, for instance for solving management targets if possible. As there are
the water quality problems in a subbasin. The generally many criteria related to these objec-
result of the screening process is a set of promis- tives, and probably many expressed in different
ing measures that can be used for strategy design. units, strategy design is not a simple process.
The whole process of base case and reference case Relations among combinations of measures and
analysis and screening is depicted in Fig. 13.9. their scores on the evaluation criteria are com-
No regrets plex. The optimum combination may depend on
A special category of promising measures are the who is asked. Trade-offs among the values of
no regrets. More realistic we should speak of different criteria, and disagreements among var-
likely no regrets and low-regret measures. ious stakeholders, are inevitable.
These are measures on which there is a very large The design of strategies is an iterative process.
agreement among the decision-makers and One can start by developing strategies on the
stakeholders that these should absolutely be basis of a single objective such as, for example,
implemented, preferably as soon as possible. It reliability of food and energy production or
should be ascertained that these measures will maximum net economic benets. These strate-
not have negative impacts on other measures or gies dene the boundaries of the solution space.
will prevent other possible promising measures Comparison of the impacts of these strategies can
to be implemented. The reason to dene such no lead to the construction of compromise strategies
regret measures is that in quite some situations by changing elements in the strategy. A resulting
there is a huge pressure to actual implement loss with respect to one criterion is then com-
measures and not to wait till (another) big inte- pared with gains to another.
grated study has been completed and accepted in Evaluation of Alternative Strategies
its full extend. In particular in developing coun- Strategies can be compared based on their criteria
tries there is a big need for proposals for such values or scores. To facilitate the comparison, the
measures. These measures can proceed immedi- number of evaluation criteria should be limited.
ately to step IV on Action Planning. Criteria have to be comprehensive (sufciently
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 593

Fig. 13.10 Activities in


the strategy building phase
promising measures scenarios on future
developments

design of

impact assessment

analysis

comparison of strategies ranking of strategies


based on achieving

and flexibillity
promising strategies

preferred strategy

indicative of the degree to which the objective is Generally, there will not be a single strategy
met) and measurable, i.e., it should be possible to that is superior to all other ones with respect to
assign a value on a relevant measurement scale. all criteria used in the assessment. That means
Where possible, criteria should be aggregated; that an evaluation method is required for the
for example, some nancial criteria might be ranking of alternative strategies.
processed into a single value when distribution
Scenario and Sensitivity Analysis
issues are not going to be important.
Before drawing conclusions from planning pro-
It is usually impossible to express all criteria
jects involving uncertain information, and indeed
in a single measurement scale such as a monetary
predictions of possible futures, one should ana-
value. (We say this recognizing the many
lyze the effects of changes in the uncertain
attempts to do so by highly respected econo-
assumptions made throughout the analyses. If the
mists.) Criteria related to environmental quality
selection of a different scenario would signi-
or ecosystem vitality or the beauty of a scenic
cantly change the attractiveness of a selected
view can often be expressed quantitatively but in
strategy, then additional study may be required to
nonmonetary terms. This should, however, be
reduce the uncertainties in that scenario. The
done in such a way that a ranking is possible on
sensitivity of the results to changes in model
the basis of the chosen criteria.
594 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

parameter values and assumptions should be basin. The development of implementing


determined and addressed in a similar way. stand-alone projects to adaptive management is
illustrated in Fig. 13.11.
The message on how to follow an adaptive
management approach is given in the right two
13.4.3.2 Adaptive Management
columns of Fig. 13.11 and is the logical
Analysis
follow-up from the project oriented develop-
The analysis approach described in the previous
ments in the two rst columns. The gure
section is based on the assumption that it is
explains that:
known what will happen in future. Predictions
are made on how population growth, economic
The project-based approach is straightforward
growth, spatial developments (e.g., urbanization)
and easy to implement. This approach does
and climate change will take place. Some of
not consider the (positive and negative)
these developments are quite certain, e.g., pop-
interaction of the project with other projects.
ulation growth for which one can make reason-
The interaction is taken into account when
able good projections. Other developments are
related projects are considered in a package of
much more uncertain such as economic growth
projects. However, the overall system is not
and climate change. While we want to be pre-
integrated yet and not optimized.
pared for these future conditions we do not want
The traditional master planning tries to opti-
to run the risk that huge infrastructural invest-
mize the overall system. The projects are
ments are being made which later appear to have
implemented as components of an integrated
been overdesigned or even unnecessary.
strategy. The implementation of the strategy
The way to deal with future uncertainty is to
includes an optimization of the various pro-
follow an adaptive management approach. An
jects over the planning period which is usu-
adaptive management approach has to replace
ally between 15 and 30 years, for which a
the traditional approach of master plans for the
costbenet analysis usually applies. Such a

Fig. 13.11 Planning approaches in water resources management


13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 595

master planning approach does not consider climate change risks to new development pro-
the long-term uncertainties that are involved jects. DAPP identies tipping points that deter-
in socioeconomic developments and climate mine in time when a certain policy or action is no
change. If the predicted changes in socioe- longer acceptable and (another) action is needed.
conomic conditions and climate do not By exploring all possible actions you can develop
materialize this might lead to future regret. adaptation pathways that will minimize the regret.
To reduce future regret a planning period of The Adaptive Pathway Approach is illustrated in
up to 50 or even 100 years needs to be con- Fig. 13.12. The approach requires that many
sidered. As the lifetime of most structural conditions are explored (pathways, scenarios,
measures (dikes, floodways, reservoirs, etc.) long time series). For that reason the models used
are designed for a period of 50100 years, it in an adaptive pathway analysis are sometimes
is wise to incorporate future uncertainties in limited versions (meta-models) of the ones
boundary conditions in their designs and described in this book. See Haasnoot et al. (2014).
make them part of a dynamic strategy. The Following an adaptive pathways approach
adaptive approach not only tells us what to do basically means that two additional criteria
now but also gives directions on what to do should be considered in decision-making:
when the conditions develop differently.
Robustness: how robust is the existing
strategy when the future develops differently
Adaptive pathways
than expected? Will the strategy then still
Various methods have been developed that enable
achieve the objectives?
us to deal with future uncertainties. Recent
Flexibility: how changeable is the strategy
methods include Decision Trees (Ray and Brown
when it appears that the future develops dif-
2015) and Dynamic Adaptation Policy Pathways
ferently than expected and we need to change
(DAPP; Haasnoot et al. 2013). The Decision
the strategy?
Trees is a repeatable method for evaluation of

Fig. 13.12 Adaptive pathways approach


596 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

Robustness and flexibility often have a strong required as many authorities will be involved in
relationship with costs. A robust strategy can be the implementation. The action plan will have an
more costly (big reservoirs, high dikes, etc.). open and rolling character, meaning that it is
A flexible strategy (many small reservoirs, build not static or prescriptive, and leaves room for
in time) can also appear to be more expensive in individual decision-makers to further elaborate
the end. These costs need to be taken into upon in relation to their own responsibilities. On
account when deciding on a strategy. the other hand, the action plan should be con-
crete, by assigning clear responsibilities for car-
13.4.3.3 Presentation of Results rying out the activities involved. It also should
Preferred Strategy include the budgetary requirements for the
Presentation of the selected promising strategies implementation, including investments and
to decision-makers may be by means of brief- recurrent costs.
ings, presentations, and summary reports among
other means. The level of detail and the way 13.4.4.1 Investment and Action Plan
project results are presented should give an The action plan translates the selected strategy in
overview of the results at an appropriate level of concrete actions. For each of these actions it
detail for the audience involved. Visual aids such should be clear:
as score cards and interactive computer presen-
tations of study results are often very helpful for what: concrete actions that have to be carried
promoting a discussion of the results of the out for each of the measures included in the
analysis. strategy to get it implemented?
The results of selected strategies can be pre- who: the prime decision-maker/stakeholder
sented in matrix form on scorecards. The col- responsible for carrying out the action and
umns of the scorecard represent the alternative who will take the lead in the implementation;
cases used in the analysis. The rows represent the how: the steps to be taken and the consulta-
impact of different alternatives with respect to a tive process involved;
given criterion. An example is depicted in when: the time planning; and
Table 13.2. Scorecards can contain numbers nancing: where will the money to implement
only, or the relative value of the criteria can be the action come from?
expressed by plusses and minuses, or a color or
shading. The purpose of scorecard presentations
What
is to present a visual picture of the relative
An integrated planning analysis is usually carried
attractiveness of the alternatives based on various
out at pre-feasibility level. A rough description of
criteria. Scorecards can also help viewers detect
the measures will been included in the strategy
clusters of criteria for which alternatives have a
and the assessment was based on rst estimates of
consistently better score. The presentation of the
costs and benets. Depending on the type of
results in scorecards allows a decision-maker to
measure, feasibility studies should be completed
give each impact the weight he considers most
before the measures can actually be implemented.
appropriate.
Often these feasibility studies are combined with
detailed (technical) design of the measures.
13.4.4 Steps IV and VAction
Planning Who and How
and Implementation The Action Plan aims to stimulate the coordi-
nated development and management of the water
Once the preferred strategy has been selected this resources. This is illustrated in Fig. 13.13, which
strategy should be translated into concrete presents the Implementation Plan for water
actions. Careful planning and coordination is resource development in Central Cebu in the
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 597

Fig. 13.13 Implementation plan (taken from Cebu study)

Philippines. The measures included in the plan sustainable benet of the particular measure. In
will involve or affect many stakeholders. All general the following roles can be distinguished:
these stakeholders (based on the outcomes of the
stakeholder analysis and designed participatory Responsible: the stakeholder has the rst
planning process) should therefore be included in responsibility for the implementation of the
some way in the implementation process in order measure but will co-operate with and/or
to guarantee a successful implementation and a consult other stakeholders in this process. In
598 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

Fig. 13.13 this is indicated by the symbol: from local (province, municipality) budgets. In
. some cases private funding can be considered in
Co-operate: the stakeholder has an important PPP (Public Private Participation) constructions.
say in the implementation of the measure but This seems in particular attractive when there is a
is not the rst responsible and is expected to good possibility for payment by the stakeholders
work with other stakeholders in this matter. In of the services that will be provided. Examples
the gure this is indicated by the symbol: . where PPPs can be considered are urban public
Consult: the stakeholder has an interest in the water supply and hydropower production.
implementation of the measure and will be The investment plan should also address how
consulted by the rst responsible. In certain the recurrent costs (operation and maintenance) of
cases permission will be needed before the the implemented projects will be recovered.
implementation can take place. In the gure Preferably this should be done based on fees to be
this is indicated by the symbol: x. paid by the people that benet from the project.

When 13.4.4.3 Feasibility Studies


The action plan should also specify the timing of and Environmental
the implementation. When will (the preparation Impact Assessment
of) the implementation start, and when should the A feasibility study should include a more
implementation be nalized. This information is detailed study of the projects (measures) pro-
needed for the overall investment plan but also posed in the plan. Commonly a feasibility study
because some measures will depend on the includes some 5 areas of feasibility:
completion of other measures.
technical
13.4.4.2 FinancingInvestment Plan social/environmental
An important, if not the most important, part of the political/legal
Action Plan is to determine how the action will be nancial/ economic
nanced. The sources of the nancing will largely operational and scheduling
depend on the type and size of the measure. As
water resources management is mainly a govern- A feasibility study for a good implementation
mental task, most of the nances will come from planning will often include a more detailed
public sources. These can be from the national assessment of the possible socioeconomic and
budget (possibly supported by donor funds) or environmental impacts of some of the measures

Fig. 13.14 Applying SEA


(OECD 2006)
13.4 Framework for Analysis and Implementation 599

that comprise the preferred strategy. There are implementation will assist in making them
several types of assessment depending on the enthusiastic about the project. To do this effec-
focus of the study. As depicted in Fig. 13.14 the tively, a mix of marketing options can be used.
most well-known are: Environmental Impact Appropriate marketing options might be:
Assessment (EIA, for infrastructure projects),
Strategic Environmental Assessment (SEA, mass one-way communication for the general
mainly used in policy development) and Sus- public (such as newspapers, radio, television
tainability Appraisal (SA). plus more traditional media in the more rural
areas);
13.4.4.4 Promotion selective one-way communication for selected
After the action plan has been established one stakeholders groups (direct mail, brochures
needs to nd ways to increase the influence of with more specic information dedicated for
stakeholder groups that favor the implementation the selected group); and
of the action but lack influence; to change the personal two-way communication between
attitude of influential groups that are opposing the project promoter and selected stakehold-
this action; and to use the positive attitude of ers groups (education method, outreach
influential groups that are in favor of this action. method or more risky word-of-mouth
The results of the stakeholder analysis are used method).
for the identication of the stakeholder groups.
As illustrated, the matrix highlights the strategy 13.4.4.5 Monitoring and Evaluation
toward project acceptability or appreciation and An overview of the implementation framework is
therefore smooth implementation. given in Fig. 13.15. This implementation
To create maximum awareness, enthusiasm framework applies for both Steps IV (Action
and support for selected projects within the Planning) and V (Implementation). The actual
Action Plan the selected stakeholder groups need implementation of most of the measures will take
to be provided with the right information on the place by decentralized agencies of national
project. Additionally, involving a selection of ministries or at local governmental level and their
stakeholders in project preparation and related utilities, districts, and associations. Where

Action Plan

Promotion
Monitoring-evaluation
- progress
- effectivity
Technical Secretariat

Feasibility studies /
project prep.

Implementation
Implementing
partners

Fig. 13.15 Implementation framework


600 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

needed feasibility and engineering studies will be that is being addressed. In general the stakehold-
carried out before the actual implementation ers will be all people and/or organizations that:
and/or construction can take place.
Above the implementation level there should will be effected by the plan; and
be a guidance and coordination level, e.g., a are needed to implement the plan.
Technical Secretariat (TS) at basin level. Peri-
odically a monitoring report compiled by the TS An integrated plan and its implementation
can track the progress made in implementing the depend to a large extend on the acceptance and
measures of the Action Plan and the effectiveness ownership of the plan by the decision makers and
of these measures in meeting their objectives. stakeholders at national and basin levels. A par-
Insufcient progress may lead to an adjustment ticipatory planning process is therefore indis-
of the Action Plan. The TS may also provide pensable for sustainable WRM. A participatory
assistance to the implementing partners, e.g. the planning process is the results of a set of steps, as
local government agencies, as they carry out depicted in Fig. 13.16. However, the order of the
feasibility studies. The TS should be able to steps can vary according to the local situation
support them by providing data and possibly and conditions. The prerequisite for the design of
other relevant information from their Manage- a participatory planning process is a good
ment Information System (MIS). stakeholder analysis. The stakeholder analysis is
a supporting planning tool that supports the
identication of stakeholders and its engagement.
13.5 Making It Work Particularly, this analysis technique supports the
task of identifying and in some occasions clas-
The framework of analysis presented in Fig. 13.3 sifying the stakeholders according to their func-
includes next to the ve steps of analysis two tions, capacities, interests, concerns and needs, as
crucial blocks that play a role in several of these well as their dependencies (including power
steps and deserve special attention. The rst one relations among them).
is the stakeholder engagement in the analysis. Based on the results of the stakeholder analysis
Involving stakeholders and making sure that their the participatory planning process is dened. First,
ideas and suggestions are taken into account is an it is crucial to dene the levels of participation of
absolute requirement to develop a consensus and the various stakeholders. The level of participation
support for the ultimate plan that is to be of each group of stakeholders varies depending on
implemented. There is no guarantee that a con- the stakeholder analysis and on the maximum
sensus will be reached, however. Involving level of participation that the client of the study
stakeholders in each stage of the planning wants to achieve. The second step is the design of
framework takes extra time and money, but if the participatory process. This will be adapted to
any ultimate plan is to be accepted and prove the agreed levels of participation and stakeholders
sustainable, there is no other choice. At a mini- involved. The design of the participatory process
mum, any plan that is derived from this process needs to take into account the modeling approach
should be an informed one, based on inputs from (informed decision making) so it is carried out in a
all affected stakeholders and decision makers. participatory manner (step 3). Finally, as illus-
trated in Fig. 13.16, the design of the participatory
planning process needs to consider the informa-
13.5.1 Stakeholder Engagement tion and communication tools used for dissemi-
nating and communicating the information to the
The stakeholders that should be involved in a various groups of stakeholders as illustrated in the
planning process will depend on the specic basin power-interest matrix of Fig. 13.17.
13.5 Making It Work 601

Fig. 13.16 Steps in a


stakeholder analysis and
participatory planning Stakeholder mapping
process

Stakeholder analysis
Interests and needs

Dependency analysis

Stakeholder analysis (1) Situation analysis as point of departure.


A stakeholder analysis provides a better under- (2) Inventory of the stakeholders involved (e.g.,
standing of the perceptions, concerns, roles, primary, secondary and tertiary
interests, and needs of the stakeholders and stakeholders).
contributes to a better approach to the solution. It (3) Mapping of formal relations according to
also helps reduce the possibility of forgetting their functions and responsibilities.
important risks. Finally, this technique increases (4) Inventory of interests, perceptions, and
the chance that the various groups of stakehold- needs.
ers are willing to cooperate in solving the iden- (5) Mapping of interdependencies.
tied problems and issues.
Levels of Participation
A good stakeholder analysis should contain at
The various stakeholders are grouped into the
least the following steps:
different levels of participation according to the
602 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

(a) (b)

(c) (d)

Fig. 13.17 Power-interest matrix

outcomes of the stakeholder analysis, as illus- Consultation: where a stakeholder is asked to


trated in Fig. 13.18: provide information inputs to the planning
process. Information flows are likewise
Ignorance: where a stakeholder is not aware one-way, but in the opposite direction. That
of what is happening; is, information is extracted from stakeholders
Awareness: where a stakeholder is aware that although no commitment is given to use it;
something is happening; Discussion: at this level are fully participat-
Informed: where a stakeholder has been ing and are asked to give advice and recom-
specically provided with information and is mendations. Here information flows in both
left to decide what to do with it. The emphasis directions between stakeholders operating
is on the one-way provision of information, with different interests and levels of influence,
with no formal option for the stakeholder to and also between these stakeholders and the
provide feedback, negotiate, or participate in organizing team (technical team). Since
the decision-making process; two-way interactions occur, there is room for
13.5 Making It Work 603

Fig. 13.18 Levels of participation

alternative ideas, solutions and/or strategies to tools used. Participatory planning tools and
emerge; techniques enable participants (stakeholders) to
Co-Design: at this level stakeholders are influence development initiatives and decisions
actively involved in problem analysis and affecting them. The tools promote sharing of
problem design, which fosters ownership, but knowledge, building up commitment to the pro-
where nal decision-making powers reside cess and empower the group to develop sus-
with the governing agencies; tainable strategies.
Co-Decision-Making: here decision making The participatory and informed planning
powers are shared with those participating process makes use of the Circles of Influence
stakeholders, leading to their empowerment model (Fig. 13.19) that enables to structure par-
with respect to the policy/planning decision ticipation to limit numbers but not the influence
taken. Typically decisions in these contexts of specic groups of stakeholders (Cardwell et al.
would emerge from a process of stakeholder 2008; Bourget 2011). Under this model trust is
negotiation. developed in concentric circles; planners and
managers work to develop trust with leaders and
The rst levels (from Ignorance to Consulta- organizations that other stakeholders already
tion) could be thought of as top-down trust. That is, those most directly involved in
management/planning approaches toward partic- policy analysis activities (i.e., planners, man-
ipation, where stakeholders have little control agers, and modelers who do most of the actual
over the decision-making process. The nal three work; Circle A) who communicate with trusted
levels are more appropriately considered as leaders and major stakeholder representatives at
bottom-up approaches toward participation the next level (Circle B). These stakeholders then
where stakeholders are much more active and in turn provide a trusted link to all other inter-
have much more control over the ested parties, who have much less direct
decision-making process. involvement (Circle C). Ideally, Circle B partic-
ipants would be active in professional or
Design of the participatory planning
issues-oriented organizations and provide links to
process
others whose interests they represent. Hence,
The design of the participatory planning process
Circle C stakeholders should see their interests
needs to take into consideration the River Basin
represented in Circle B, and have formal
planning framework and the data and modeling
604 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

Fig. 13.19 Participatory


planning structure based on
circles of influence (source
Cardwell et al. 2008)

opportunities to shape the work of Circles A and the modeling process, (ii) construction of the
B via these representatives. The levels of model, (iii) some of the activities prior to
involvement of those stakeholders in Circle C model construction, or (iv) only after the nal
can vary from Consultation to Awareness. model has been built.
A fourth circle (Circle D) includes decision Type of stakeholder involvement. This can be
makers such as agency heads and elected of- either individually, with homogeneous
cials, who have been given the authority to (stakeholders with similar interests and
accept or reject the recommendations of the problem perceptions) or heterogeneous
policy analysis. For a good participatory and groups.
informed planning process it should be clearly Information and communication tools. Infor-
identied and engaged throughout the planning mation dissemination (e.g. face-to-face work-
process with direction and information flows shops or online platforms) and communication
possible to and from all circles. tools need to be adapted to the background
Other aspects to be considered for the design conditions of the various groups of stake-
of the participatory planning process are: holders. This is particularly important for
participatory model construction and use, as
Timing of stakeholder involvement. This will well as, for the promotion of the plan. The
be dependent on the Circles of Influence and selected marketing options for creating
levels of participation. awareness, enthusiasm and support for selec-
Stakeholder participation in the modeling ted projects within the action plan by stake-
process (Participatory Modeling). Mainly holders will vary depending on the results of
those stakeholders in the Circles A and B will the stakeholder analysis (Fig. 13.17) and
be regularly involved in some of the phases of levels of stakeholder involvement
the modeling process. The involvement can (Fig. 13.18). For more information about plan
be concentrated in (i) early and later stages of promotion see Sect. 13.4.4.3.
13.5 Making It Work 605

13.5.2 Using Models in a Planning what was changed, why a particular simulation
Process was made or what was learned. It is also com-
monly difcult if not impossible for third parties
13.5.2.1 Managing Modeling Projects to continue from the point at which any previous
There are some steps that, if followed in model- project terminated. These problems are caused by
ing projects, can help reduce potential problems a lack of information on how the study was
and lead to more effective outcomes. These steps carried out. What was the pattern of thought that
are illustrated in Fig. 13.20. Some of the steps took place? Which actions and activities were
illustrated in Fig. 13.20 may not be relevant in carried out? Who carried out what work and
particular modeling projects and if so, these parts why? What choices were made? How reliable are
of the process can be skipped. Each of these the end results? These questions should be
modeling project steps is discussed in the next answerable if a model journal is kept. Just like
several sections. computer-programming documentation, project
documentation is often neglected under the
Creating a Model Journal
pressure of time and perhaps because it is not as
One common problem of modeling projects once
interesting as running the models themselves.
they are underway occurs when one wishes to go
back over a series of simulation results to see Initiating the Modeling Project
Project initiation involves dening the problem
to be modeled and the objectives that are to be
accomplished. There can be major differences in
perceptions between those who need information
and those who are going to provide it. The
problem as stated is often not the problem as
understood by either the client or the modeler.
In addition, problem perceptions and modeling
objectives can change over the duration of a
modeling project.
The appropriate spatial and time scales also
need to be identied. The essential natural system
processes must be identied and described. One
should ask and answer the question of whether or
not a particular modeling approach, or even
modeling in general, is the best way to obtain the
needed information. What are the alternatives to
modeling or a particular modeling approach?
The objective of any modeling project should
be clearly understood with respect to the domain
and the problem area, the reason for using a
particular model, the questions to be answered by
the model, and the scenarios to be modeled.
Throughout the project these objective compo-
nents should be checked to see if any have
changed and if they are being met.
The use of a model nearly always takes place
Fig. 13.20 The modeling project process is typically an within a broader context. The model itself can
iterative procedure involving specic steps or tasks also be part of a larger whole, such as a network
606 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

of models in which many are using the outputs of wishes or requirements may also influence model
other models. These conditions may impose choice. An important practical criterion is whe-
constraints on the modeling project. ther there is an accessible manual for operating
Proposed modeling activities may have to be the model program and if help is available to
justied and agreements made where applicable. address any possible problems.
Any client at any time may wish for some jus- The decision to use a model, and which model
tication of the modeling project activities. to use, is an important part of water resources
Agreement should be reached on how this justi- plan formulation. Even though there are no clear
cation will take place. Are intermediate reports rules on how to select the right model to use, a
required, have conditions been dened that will few simple guidelines can be stated:
indicate an ofcial completion of the modeling
project, is verication by third parties required, Use the simplest method that will yield ade-
and so on? It is particularly important to record quate accuracy and provide the answer to
beforehand the events or times when the client your questions.
must approve the simulation results. Finally, it is Select a model that ts the problem rather
also sensible to reach agreements with respect to than trying to t the problem to a model.
quality requirements and how they are deter- Question whether increased accuracy is worth
mined or dened, as well as the format, scope the increased effort and increased cost of data
and contents of modeling project outputs (data collection.
les) and reports. Consider model and computational cost.
Today computing costs are rarely an issue
Selecting the Model
except perhaps for some groundwater man-
The selection of an existing model to be used in
agement problems.
any project, as opposed to developing a new one,
Do not forget the assumptions underlying the
depends in part on the processes that will be
model used and do not read more signicance
modeled (perhaps as dened by the conceptual
into the simulation results than is actually
model), the data available and the data required
there.
by the model. The available data should include
system observations for comparison of the model
results. They should also include estimates of the Analyzing the Model
degree of uncertainty associated with each of the Once a modeling approach or a particular model
model parameters. At a minimum this might only has been selected, its strengths and limitations
be estimates of the ranges of all uncertain should be assessed. The rst step is to set up a plan
parameter values. At best it could include sta- for testing and evaluating the model. These tests
tistical distributions of them. In this step of the can include mass (and energy) balance checks and
process it is sufcient to know what data are parameter sensitivity analyses (see Chap. 8). The
available, their quality and completeness, and model can be run under extreme input data con-
what to do about missing or outlier data. ditions to see if the results are as expected.
Determining the boundaries of the model is an Once a model is tested satisfactorily, it can be
essential consideration in model selection and calibrated. Calibration focuses on the comparison
use. These boundaries dene what is to be between model results and eld observations. An
included in a model and what is not. Any model important principle is: the smaller the deviation
selected will contain a number of assumptions. between the calculated model results and the
These assumptions should be identied and jus- eld observations, the better the model. This is
tied, and later tested. indeed the case to a certain extent, as the devi-
Project-based matters such as the computers ations in a perfect model are only due to mea-
to be used, the available time and expertise, the surement errors. In practice, however, a good t
modelers personal preferences, and the clients is by no means a guarantee of a good model.
13.5 Making It Work 607

The deviations between the model results and experienced? A models answer to this question
the eld observations can be due to a number of should also include the uncertainties attached to
factors. These include possible software errors, these predictions.
inappropriate modeling assumptions such as the
Using the Model
(conscious) simplication of complex structures,
Once the model has been judged good enough,
neglect of certain processes, errors in the math-
it may be used to obtain the information desired.
ematical description or in the numerical method
One should develop a plan on how the model is
applied, inappropriate parameter values, errors in
to be used, identifying the input to be used, the
input data and boundary conditions, and mea-
time period(s) to be simulated, and the quality of
surement errors in the eld observations. To
the results to be expected. Again, close com-
determine whether or not a calibrated model is
munication between the client and the modeler is
good, it should be validated or veried. Cali-
essential, both in setting up this plan and
brated models should be able to reproduce eld
throughout its implementation, to avoid any
observations not used in calibration. Validation
unnecessary misunderstandings about what
can be carried out for calibrated models as long
information is wanted and the assumptions on
as an independent data set has been kept aside for
which that information is to be based.
this purpose. If all available data are used in the
Before the end of this model use step, one
calibration process in order to arrive at the best
should determine whether all the necessary
possible results, validation will not be possible.
model runs have been performed and whether
The decision to leave out validation is often a
they have been performed well. Questions to ask
justiable one especially when data are limited.
include:
Philosophically, it is impossible to know if a
model of a complex system is sufciently cor-
Did the model fulll its purpose?
rect. There is no way to prove it. [All models
Are the results valid?
are wrong but some are useful Box (1976).]
Are the quality requirements met?
Experimenting with a model, by carrying out
Was the discretization of space and time
multiple validation tests, can increase ones
chosen well?
condence in that model. After a sufcient
Was the choice of the model restrictions
number of successful tests, one might be willing
correct?
to state that the model is good enough, based
Were the correct model and/or model pro-
on the modeling project requirements. The model
gram chosen?
can then be regarded as having been validated, at
Was the numerical approach appropriate?
least for the ranges of input data and eld
Was the implementation performed correctly?
observations used in the validation.
Are the sensitive parameters (and other fac-
If model predictions are to be made for situ-
tors) clearly identied?
ations or conditions for which the model has
Was an uncertainty analysis performed?
been validated, one may have a degree of con-
dence in the reliability of those predictions. Yet
Some of these questions may not apply, but if
one cannot be certain. Much less condence can
any of the answers to these questions is no, then
be placed on model predictions for conditions
the situation should be corrected. If it cannot be
outside the range for which the model was vali-
corrected, then there should be a good reason for
dated. While a model should not be used for
this.
extrapolations as commonly applied in predic-
tions and in scenario analyses, this is often Interpreting Model Results
exactly the reason for the modeling project. What Interpreting the information resulting from sim-
is likely to happen given events we have not yet ulation models is a crucial step in a modeling
608 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

project, especially in situations in which the cli- 13.5.2.2 Evaluating Modeling Success
ent may only be interested in those results and There are a number of ways one can judge the
not the way they were obtained. The model extent of success (or failure) in applying models
results can be compared to those of other similar and performing analyses in practice. Goeller
studies. Any unanticipated results should be (1988) suggested three measures as a basis for
discussed and explained. The results should be judging success:
judged with respect to the modeling project
objectives. 1. How the analysis was performed and pre-
The results of any water resources modeling sented (analysis success).
project typically include large les of time series 2. How it was used or implemented in the
data. Only the most dedicated of clients will want planning and management processes (appli-
to read those les, so the data must be presented in cation success).
a more concise form. Statistical summaries should 3. How the information derived from models
explicitly include any restrictions and uncertain- and their application affected the system
ties in the results. They should identify any gaps in design or operation and the lives of those who
the domain knowledge, thus generating new use the system (outcome success).
research questions or identifying the need for
more eld observations and measurements. It is often hard to judge the extent to which
particular models, methods and styles of pre-
Reporting Model Results
sentation are appropriate for the problem being
Although the results of a model should not be the
addressed, the resources and time available for
sole basis for policy decisions, modelers have a
the study, and the institutional environment of
responsibility to translate their model results into
the client. Review panels and publishing in
policy recommendations. Policymakers, man-
peer-review journals are two ways of judging. No
agers, and indeed the participating stakeholders
model or method is without its limitations. Two
often want simple, clear and unambiguous
other obvious indications are the feelings that
answers to complex questions. The executive
analysts have about their own work and, very
summary of a report will typically omit much of
importantly, the opinions the clients have about
the scientically justied discussion in its main
the analysts work. Client satisfaction may not be
body regarding, say, the uncertainties associated
an appropriate indicator if, for example, the cli-
with some of the data. This executive summary is
ents are unhappy only because they are learning
often the only part read by those responsible for
something they do not want to accept. Producing
making decisions. Therefore, the conclusions of
results primarily to reinforce a clients prior
the model study must not only be scientically
position or opinions might result in client satis-
correct and complete, but also concisely formu-
faction, but, most would agree, this is not an
lated, free of jargon, and fully understandable by
appropriate goal of modeling.
managers and policymakers. The report should
Application or implementation success
provide a clear indication of the validity,
implies that the methods and/or results developed
usability and any restrictions of the model
in a study were seriously considered by those
results. The use of visual aids, such as graphs and
involved in the planning and management pro-
GIS, can be very helpful.
cess. One should not, it seems to us, judge suc-
The nal report should also include sufcient
cess or failure on the basis of whether or not any
detail to allow others to reproduce the model
of the model results (the computer printouts)
study (including its results) and/or to proceed were directly implemented. What one hopes for
from the point where this study ended.
is that the information and understanding
13.5 Making It Work 609

resulting from model application helped dene Problem situations and criteria for judging the
the important issues and identify possible solu- extent of success will change over time, of
tions and their impacts. Did the modelling help course. By the time one can evaluate the results,
influence the debate among stakeholders and the system itself may have changed enough for
decision-makers about what decisions to make or the outcome to be quite different than what was
actions to take? The extent to which this occurs is predicted in the analysis. Monitoring the perfor-
the extent to which a modeling study will have mance of any decision, whether or not based on a
achieved application or implementation success. successfully analyzed and implemented model-
Outcome success is based on what happens to ing effort, is often neglected. But monitoring is
the problem situation once a decision largely very important if changes in system design,
influenced by the results of modeling has been management and operation are to be made to
made and implemented. The extent to which the adapt to changing and unforeseen conditions.
information and understanding resulting from If the models, data, computer programs, doc-
modeling helped solve the problems or resolve umentation and know-how are successfully
the issues, if it can be determined, is a measure of maintained, updated, and transferred to and used
the extent of outcome success. It is clear that by the client institutions, there is a good chance
success in terms of the second or third criteria that this methodology will be able to provide
will depend heavily on the success of the pre- useful information relevant to the changes that
ceding one(s). Modeling applications may be are needed in system design, management, or
judged successful in terms of the rst two mea- operation. Until relatively recently, the success-
sures but, perhaps because of unpredicted events, ful transfer of models and their supporting tech-
the problems being addressed may have become nology has involved a considerable commitment
worse rather than improved, or while those par- of time and money for both the analysts and the
ticular problems were eliminated, their elimina- potential users of the tools and techniques. It has
tion may have caused other severe problems. All been a slow process. Developments in interactive
of us can think of examples where this has computer-based data-driven decision support
happened. systems that provide a more easily understood
For example, any river restoration project humanmodeldatacomputer interface have
involving the removal of engineering infrastruc- substantially facilitated this technology transfer
ture is a clear indication of changing objectives process, particularly among model users. These
or new knowledge. Who knows whether or not a technology developments have had, and we think
broader systems study might have helped earlier will continue to have, a major impact on the state
planners, managers, and decision-makers foresee of the practice in using models in support of
the adverse ecological consequences of convert- water resources planning and management
ing rivers to canals, and whether or not anyone activities.
will care. Hindsight is always clearer than fore-
sight. Some of what takes place in the world is
completely unpredictable. We can be surprised 13.6 Conclusions
now and then. Given this, it is not clear whether
we should hold modelers or analysts, or even The effectiveness of strategies for dealing with
planners or managers, completely responsible for issues of water quantity and quality, and their
any lack of outcome success if unforeseen variability, has a major impact on the well-being of
events that changed goals, or priorities or living species, and even the survival of some. How
understanding did indeed take place. well water is managed also impacts the function-
ing and resilience of ecosystems, the vitality of
610 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

societies, and the strength and growth of econo- these ongoing changes as well as the linkages
mies. Fortunately we humans can determine between environmental and societal factors in
which water resources development and man- specic basins and regions all lead to major
agement strategy will work best in a given situa- uncertainties in the future.
tion, not only for the immediate future but in the The guidelines discussed in this chapter have
long-run as well. And if conditions change, our been developed and used by Dutch experts in
strategies can adapt. To accomplish this we need Deltares to assess water resources systems and to
to identify and evaluate the effectiveness of the develop plans and strategies for managing them.
water resources development and management Deltares has been actively involved in numerous
alternatives available to us in an economic, water resources planning and management pro-
hydrologic and sociopolitical environment that jects throughout the world. The approach
seems to be a constantly changing. We can do this described in this chapter illustrates how these
through the use of various models, developing projects are conducted, and the major factors that
preferred strategies based in part on their results, are considered while conducting them. The
and informed by the concerns and objectives of effects and impacts of some of their projects have
stakeholders and the decision making institutions. been relatively local and required consideration
This book has focused on ways of developing of only a few sectors of the economy. Other,
and using various optimization and simulation more comprehensive projects have had national
modeling methods for analyzing and evaluating or international impacts, and led to transbound-
water resource development and management ary (international) compacts.
alternatives. This nal chapter has presented Clearly each water resources system is unique
some guidelines for carrying out water resources with respect to its management issues and prob-
planning projects, including its modeling com- lems and its institutional environment. Project
ponents. Such projects are typically very com- planning and analysis approaches must adapt to
plex and challenging. these situations. Hence, each project will differ,
Water management planning projects must and will no doubt need to deviate from the sug-
address a complex and interconnected web of gested guidelines presented in this chapter. Other
science, engineered infrastructure, legal regula- approaches are possible and may be equally ef-
tions governing water use, societal expectations, fective. What remains important in all cases is
and institutional structures and authorities that the establishment of a comprehensive, systematic
have evolved over time. Much of the current process of planning and analysis together with
complexity that exists in various regions of the constant communication among planners,
world has developed over time in response to decision-makers and the interested and affected
changing interests and objectives of water users public. The end result should be an improved,
and environmental considerations. Although the more sustainable, and equitable water resources
impacts of changes in the climate on water sup- development plan and management policy,
plies and demands are generally recognized, appropriate for the region and its people.
13.6 Conclusions 611

Box 13.4. Example 1: Objectives and criteria adopted in West Java WRM study

Objectives Evaluation criteria


Socio-economic objectives and criteria
1. Improve employment () Increase of employment by WRM strategies
Number of permanent jobs (#)
Number of temp. jobs (mn-year)
2. Increase income of people Farmer net income (Rp/year)
Improve income position of farmers Difference in benets of WRM strategies per capita
Improve equity in income distribution between:
Kabupatens (%)
Urban/rural areas (%)
Income groups (%)
3. Increase the non-oil export production Export value (Rp/year)
(shrimps, tea, and rubber)
4. Support economic development in an economically Total annual. benets (Rp/year)
efcient way Total annualized costs (Rp/year)
B/C ratio ()
IRR (%)
NPV (Rp/year)
Total capital required (Rp)
Foreign currency required (%)
Total construction costs (Rp)
Total O&M costs (Rp)
Sectoral value added (Rp/year)
GRP (Rp/year)
User-related (sectoral) objectives and criteria
1. Increase agricultural production Padi (ton/year)
(3% per year) Palawija (ton/year)
Export value of crops (or import substitution)
(Rp/year)
Unit costs water supply (Rp/m3)
% failure meeting demand (%)
2. Increase power production () Installed capacity (MW)
Power production (GWh/year)
Failure meeting rm power (%)
Price of power prod. (Rp/Kwh)
Energy production value (Rp)
3. Increase sh production () Fish produced (ton/year)
Fish pond area (ha)
Export value (Rp/year)
4. Support industrial development Amount of supply (m3/s)
Water supply for industry (full supply) Cost of water supply (Rp/year)
Provision of opportunity for discharge of waste water Unit costs water supply (Rp/m3)
% failure meeting demand (%)
Cost to maintain water quality standards (Rp/year)
5. Enhance water-related recreation
Environmental and public health related objectives and criteria
1. Improve public health Supply (1/day/ capital)
Improve drinking water supply % of people connected (Rp/m3)
urban: BNA, IKK and major city programs: Price of drinking water (%)
60 l/cap/day, serving 70 % % failure meeting demand (%)
rural: 55 % Volume of flushing water (m3/s)
improve flushing Unit costs (Rp/m3)
(1 L/s/ha in urban area) % failure meeting demand (%)
(continued)
612 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

Objectives Evaluation criteria


2. Improve/conserve natural resources and environment Area severely eroding (ha)
Erosion and sedimentation control Erosion (mm/year)
(erosion <1 mm/year) Sediment yield (tons/year)
Conservation of nature Reafforestated area (ha)
Water quality Replanted area (ha)
Terraced area (ha)
% external wood supply to total wood demand (%)
Concentration water quality parameters (ppm)
3. Provide flood protection - return period [years]
(return period: depending on value of endangered area) - flood alleviation benets (reduced damage)
[Rp/year]
- flood control cost [Rp/year]
- number of people in endangered areas [#]
- flooded area [ha]
Planning and implementation related objectives and criteria
1. Take care of maximum agreement with existing policies Deviations from/conflicts with existing policies
in other elds of planning (e.g. economic regional planning)
2. Maximize flexibility of proposed strategy Degree to which strategy can be adjusted to changes
in demands, standards, technological innovations
3. Maximize reliability of proposed strategy Degree of certainty with which proposed strategy
will meet the realization of objectives
4. Provide sufcient acceptance of proposed strategy by Degree of acceptance by parties involved
public, interest groups and executing authorities
5. Takes care of maximum agreement of proposed strategy Deviations from/conflicts with existing competence
with existing competence and responsibilities of agencies and responsibilities
concerned
a
Kabupaten = Indonesian administrative unit
b
Padi = Rice crop
c
Paliwija = Non-rice crop
d
Rp = Rupiah

Box 13.5 Example 2: Score-card Egyptian National Water Resources Plan study

Unit 1997 2017 reference Strategy facing the


base case challenge
General (middle scenario)
Population Million 59.3 83.1 83.1
Urbanization Ratio 0.44 0.48 0.48
GDP at economic growth of 6% Billion LE 246 789 789
Economic development objectives
Agriculture: irrigation area Mfeddan 7.985 11.026 10.876
Gross production value Billion LE 34.46 35.76 38.50
Crop intensity Ratio 2.1 1.5 1.7
Net value production per feddan LE/feddan 2812 2075 2153
3
Net value production per unit of water LE/m 0.64 0.66 0.60
Export/import value Ratio 0.09 0.12 0.20
(continued)
13.6 Conclusions 613

Unit 1997 2017 reference Strategy facing the


base case challenge
Industry: costs polluted intake water LE/m3 0.65 0.651.10 2.00
1.10
Wastewater treatment costs LE/m3 0.22 0.220.50 1.00
0.50
Fishery: production (index 100 in Index 100 86 95
1997)
Tourism: navigation bottlenecks Index 100 114 0
Social objectives
Create living space in desert areas % of tot. 1.5% 23% 22%
pop
Employment and income M pers. 5.01 6.24 7.30
Employment in agriculture year
Employment in industry M pers. 2.18 4.99 4.99
year
Average income farmers LE/year 5362 4629 4309
Drinking water supply Percentage 97.3% 100% 100%
Coverage
Sanitation Percentage 28% 60% 60%
Coverage
Equity , 0, + 0 + +
Equity water distribution in
agriculture
Self-sufciency in food: cereals Percentage 73% 53% 46%
Meeting water needs
Water resources development BCM 55.8 55.5 55.5
Available Nile water
Abstraction deep groundwater BCM 0.71 3.96 3.96
Water use efciency Nile system BCM 16.3 17.6 12.5
Outflow to sinks from Nile system
Overall water use efciency Nile Percentage 70% 67% 77%
system
Water in agriculture Ratio 1.00 0.80 0.92
Supply/demand ratio (1997 assumed
1.0)
Water availability per feddan Nile m3/ 4495 3285 3866
system feddan/yr
Public water supply Percentage 34% 34% 25%
UFW losses
Supply/demand ratio Ratio 0.67 0.76 1.00
Health and environment
Pollution and health Index 100 121 110
E. coli standard violation
(1997 = 100)
(continued)
614 13 Project Planning: Putting It All Together

Unit 1997 2017 reference Strategy facing the


base case challenge
Water quality shallow groundwater , 0, + 0
Ecology and sustainability Abstr/pot 0.15 1.00 1.00
Sustainability: use of deep groundw.
Condition Bardawil (Ramsar site) , 0, + + +
Condition coastal lakes , 0, + 0 0
a
UFW = Unaccounted for water (the water that is lost in the system)
b
feddan = 0.42 ha
c
LE = Egyptian pound

design, the decision tree framework. Washington,


References United States: World Bank.

Bourget, L. (Ed.). (2011). Converging waters: Integrating


collaborative modeling with participatory processes Additional References
to make water resources decisions. Institute for Water (Further Reading)
Resources, U.S. Army Corps of Engineers.
Box, G. (1976). Science and statistics. Journal of the
ADB, GIWP, UNESCO, WWF. (2013). River basin
American Statistical Association, 71, 791799. doi:10.
planning, principles, procedures and approaches for
1080/01621459.1976.10480949.
strategic basin planning.
Cardwell, H., Langsdale, S., & Stephenson, K. (2008).
Asian Water Development Outlook. (2013). Measuring
The shared vision planning primer: How to incorpo-
water security in Asia and the Pacic.
rate computer aided dispute resolution in water
Bousset, J.-P., Macombe, C., & Taverne, M. (2005).
resources planning. Alexandria, VA: Institute for
Participatory methods, guidelines and good practice
Water Resources. IWR Report 08-R-02 (2008).
guidance to be applied throughout the project to
Goeller, B. F. (1988). A framework for evaluating success
enhance problem denition, co-learning, synthesis
in systems analysis. Report P-7454. Santa Monica:
and dissemination. SEAMLESS.
Rand Corporation.
Common Implementation Strategy for the Water Frame-
GWP. (2000). Integrated water management, TEC Back-
work Directive. (2000/60/EC). Guidance document 8 on
ground Paper no. 4. Stockholm: GWP.
public participation in relation to the water framework
Haasnoot, M., Van Deursen, W. P. A., Guillaume,
directive. http://ec.europa.eu/environment/water/water-
J. H. A., Kwakkel, J. H., Van Beek, E., & Mid-
framework/facts_gures/guidance_docs_en.htm
delkoop, H. (2014). Fit for purpose? Building and
GWP. (2005). Integrated water resources management
evaluating a fast, integrated model for exploring water
plansTraining manual and operational guide.
policy pathways. Environmental Modelling & Soft-
Stockholm: GWP.
ware, 60, 99120. ISSN 1364-8152.
GWP Toolbox www.gwp.org/ToolBox/
Haasnoot, M., Kwakkel, J. H., Walker, W. E., & Maat, J. T.
GWP, INBO. (2009). A handbook for IWRM in basins.
(2013). Dynamic adaptive policy pathways: A method
Stockholm/Paris: GWP/INBO.
for crafting robust decisions for a deeply uncertain
NSMC. (2010). What is social marketing? www.thensmc.
world. Global Environmental Change, 23(2), 485498.
com/content/what-social-marketing-1
OECD. (2006). Applying strategic environmental assessment
UNESCO-IHP, NARBO, WWAP. (2009). IWRM guideli-
Good practice guidance for development co-operation.
nes at River Basin level. http://www.unesco.org/water/
www.oecd-ilibrary.org/development/applying-strategic-
Voinov, A., & Bousquet, F. (2010). Modelling with
environmental-assessment_9789264026582-en
stakeholders. Environmental Modelling and Software,
Ray, P. A., & Brown, C. M. (2015). Confronting climate
25(11), 12681281.
uncertainty in water resources planning and project
References 615

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.
Index

A C
Adaptive management, 12, 40, 43, 49, 88, 334, 410, 458, Calibration, 55, 80, 144, 145, 147, 179181, 336338,
459, 568, 578, 591, 594 340342, 354, 360, 370, 425, 473, 536, 543, 559,
Advective transport, 425, 426, 429 606
Aeration, 537 Capacity expansion, 75, 115, 116, 155, 174, 512, 514,
Agriculture, 12, 37, 41, 138, 469, 511, 567, 568, 570, 515
571, 574, 575, 585, 613 Capital, 24, 74, 95, 172, 216, 292, 387, 388, 559
Algae eutrophication modelling, 438 Capital recovery factor, 96
Allocations, 30, 75, 83, 85, 9799, 101, 102, 105111, Case studies, 2
113115, 155, 166, 167, 169, 172, 175, 188190, Censored data, 245
197, 207, 209, 210, 305307, 311313, 315, 319, Central limit theorem, 357
329, 386, 387, 389, 458, 469, 505, 518, 583 Chance constraints, 306, 327, 329
Alternatives, 6, 34, 35, 38, 40, 45, 60, 69, 73, 76, 79, 81, Climate change, 2, 527, 589, 590, 594, 595
82, 88, 94, 96, 151, 163, 233, 270, 327, 346, 349, Coasts beaches
366, 376379, 394, 397, 398, 402, 414, 465, 490, management, 2, 5, 40, 41, 43, 207, 425
530, 596, 610 zones, 2, 40, 43, 580, 589
Anaerobic, 438, 441, 555, 557 Coefcient of skewness, 220, 222, 223, 225, 235,
Annual value, 96, 137, 313 237240, 244, 263, 290
Aquatic systems, 428 Coefcient of variation, 220, 224, 225, 236, 240, 241,
Aquifer, 2, 5, 6, 31, 38, 67, 71, 151, 258, 379, 568, 574 248, 256, 290
Articial neural networks, 55, 63, 179181, 183, 207 Coliform bacteria, 537
Autocorrelations, 251, 254, 256, 257, 260, 270, 299, 303 Collective goods, 382
Autoregressive-moving average (ARMA) models, 269, Compensation criterion, 382
270 Competitive conditions, 381
Average values, 215, 367, 425, 439 Concave functions, 98, 157, 160, 161
Concentration gradient, 426, 427
Condence intervals, 231, 233, 277, 337
B Constituents conservative
Benet-cost analyses ratio, 165, 583 rst-order, 433
Benets, 1, 16, 20, 24, 30, 33, 35, 37, 38, 41, 62, 75, 83, Constraint method, 395397, 412, 415
85, 90, 9496, 98, 99, 102, 107109, 111, 114, Constraints, 71, 75, 79, 85, 102105, 121, 129, 138, 142,
137, 155, 156, 158, 169, 171, 196, 210, 259, 288, 149, 151, 158, 163, 176, 211, 243, 307, 317, 327,
293295, 307, 328, 373, 380, 383, 385387, 393, 339, 378, 389, 402, 464, 477, 482484, 486, 506,
474, 493, 504, 505, 508, 512514, 519, 520, 522, 508, 511, 515, 525, 559, 576, 586, 588, 606
558, 592 Continuous variables, 339, 353
Bias, 183, 186, 211, 220, 222, 229, 256, 290, 297 Convex functions, 101, 159161
Biochemical oxygen demand (BOD), 433, 436, 462, 537, Correlation, 233, 234, 248, 251, 255, 260264, 266270,
555 289, 292, 294, 298, 299, 302, 303, 308, 342,
Boundary conditions, 104, 336, 338, 572, 573, 576, 585, 357359, 555
595, 607 Cost, 2, 10, 31, 34, 37, 41, 73, 7679, 9496, 116, 117,
Box-Jenkins models, 269 119, 120, 146, 148150, 153, 155, 156, 165, 166,
Budget, 58, 385, 512, 579, 580, 583, 587, 598 168, 169, 172174, 177, 196, 211, 292, 293, 338,

The Editor(s) (if applicable) and The Author(s) 2017 617


D.P. Loucks and E. van Beek, Water Resource Systems Planning and Management,
DOI 10.1007/978-3-319-44234-1
618 Index

340, 365, 373, 377, 379, 382, 384, 385, 411, 419, Droughts
458, 469, 494, 500, 510, 512, 514, 517, 522, 554, El Nio and La Nia
559, 569, 575, 589, 596, 606 indices, 259
Cost-effectiveness, 380, 490 management, 490
Count, 61, 308, 397, 420 triggers, 31, 579
Covariance, 193, 261, 263, 265, 268, 281, 298, 299 virtual exercises
Critical value, 214, 231, 233, 234 Dynamic expansion, 512
Crop, 1, 5, 172176, 297, 388, 421, 524526, 571 Dynamic programming
Cross-correlation, 248, 267, 269 backward-moving, 108, 109, 111, 112, 118, 120, 169,
312
deterministic, 312, 314
D dimensionality, 115
Data forward-moving, 112, 113, 117, 119, 168
collection, 39, 78, 151, 331, 338, 343, 458, 576, 587, network, 105, 108, 112, 115, 169
591, 606 stochastic, 315
management, 173
mining, 63
Dead storage, 474, 494, 510, 517, 518, 523 E
Decision-making, 35, 51, 63, 64, 69, 74, 79, 94, 108, 117, Ecology
120, 123, 151, 367, 399, 410, 422, 583, 602, 603 ecological criteria, 389
Decision support systems Economics
uncertainty, 181 criteria, 165, 380
variables, 181 economies of scale, 117, 174
Decit value, 175, 278, 292, 296, 462 long-run benets, 386, 388
Degrees of freedom, 269 loss functions, 387, 388, 519
Demand short-run benets, 386, 387
agricultural, 12, 504 Ecosystems, 1, 2, 5, 12, 18, 30, 32, 3638, 43, 56, 59,
function, 101, 167, 170, 383385 281, 332, 378, 389, 392, 417419, 423, 449, 457,
industrial, 1, 20, 31, 37, 267, 418, 504, 574, 585 459, 469, 502, 527, 558, 567, 568, 570, 571, 581,
municipal, 1, 2, 34, 37, 116, 267, 293, 469, 504, 582 585, 609
Depression storage, 541, 543, 544 Effective, 32, 3537, 39, 41, 45, 54, 60, 93, 97, 121, 165,
Depth, 10, 12, 33, 37, 121, 215, 218, 220, 226, 245, 257, 169, 193, 248, 282, 327, 367, 368, 376, 379, 418,
261, 282, 336, 339, 347, 349, 350, 389, 390, 402, 422, 430, 458, 489, 503, 515, 530, 554, 558, 572,
404, 405, 432, 447, 450, 452, 478, 499, 505, 523, 576, 579, 605, 610
532, 540, 541, 543, 547, 570, 575 Environmental criteria
Design, 2, 25, 28, 39, 42, 51, 53, 57, 59, 63, 73, 75, 77, impacts, 389
78, 81, 93, 94, 138, 144, 166, 172, 183, 219, 258, Epilimnion, 450452
270, 280, 287, 301, 331, 334, 353, 366, 374, 375, Equity, 38, 204206, 392, 393, 430, 611, 613
377, 390, 429, 431, 469, 470, 479, 494, 500, 504, Equivalent, 22, 95, 96, 102, 159, 166, 176, 197, 218, 235,
511, 515, 519, 522, 528, 536, 539, 541, 559, 565, 240, 248, 264, 266, 293, 318, 368, 369, 381, 400,
574, 591, 592, 595, 596, 600, 603, 604 427, 475, 476, 500, 544
Deterministic equivalent, 307, 327, 329 Error, 79, 81, 105, 122, 144, 152, 156, 184, 188, 222,
Deterministic modeling, 137, 213, 301, 311, 315, 317, 255, 257, 286, 290, 293, 294, 299, 332334,
327, 341 336338, 344, 345, 347, 349, 350, 352, 354, 356,
Differential equations, 105, 166, 452, 456, 462, 463 357, 360, 377, 421, 453, 455, 459, 485, 559, 606
Differential persistence, 264 Estimation
Dimensionality, 115 estimators, 219, 220, 222224, 227, 229, 233, 235,
Disaggregation, 265, 267269, 298 239, 243, 245248, 250
Discount factors, 95, 168, 519 Eutrophication, 1, 14, 57, 424, 437, 439, 440, 447, 555
Dispersion Evaporation, 22, 123, 213, 226, 258, 282, 302, 373, 427,
bulk, 1, 445, 536 432, 472474, 478480, 485, 486, 517519, 523,
Dispersive transport, 426 541, 570
Dissolved oxygen, 54, 379, 389, 414, 418, 420, 422, 433, Excess value, 154, 155
435, 436, 438, 440, 449, 462, 463, 465, 537, Expansion, 116, 118120, 137, 154, 155, 168, 174, 289,
553555 292, 293, 511, 512, 536
Distribution systems, 187, 527529, 531, 536, 559, 561, Expectations, 2, 45, 56, 218, 266, 268, 610
565 Expected value, 213, 214, 218, 221, 222, 256, 257, 259,
Diversions, 5, 97, 312, 469471, 504, 506 281, 287, 291, 303, 311, 315, 325, 350, 367, 374,
Dominance, 394, 428, 555 409, 481
Index 619

F Hydroelectric power, 3, 24, 37, 470, 474, 502, 504


Failure, 1, 38, 39, 53, 59, 61, 215, 259, 275, 277, 278, Hydrological models
280, 409, 481, 485, 495497, 499501, 524, 608, groundwater, 37, 207, 489
611 parameters, 75, 81, 207, 213, 336, 341, 470, 547
Feasible, 20, 41, 59, 79, 81, 83, 106, 107, 116, 118, 123, processes, 213, 267
127, 140, 142, 149, 150, 163, 188190, 243, 274, surface water, 267, 489
313, 315, 318, 377, 378, 381, 393, 394, 396, 398, Hypolimnion, 450452
401, 410, 420, 515, 521 Hypothesis, 233, 296, 366, 550
Finite difference, 452, 463
Firm yield, 481
First-order, 251, 261, 289, 309, 314, 345, 350352, 370, I
428, 433, 434, 436, 441, 445, 452, 457, 489, 523 Impervious, 421, 543, 544, 564
Fixed costs, 117, 152, 153, 156, 159, 174 Incremental flow, 91, 99, 455, 472, 510, 521
Flood Index-flood method, 247, 248
control reservoir, 491, 493 Indifference analysis, 369, 399, 415
damage, 31, 37, 393, 470, 474, 490495, 499501, Inequality constraints, 104
517, 519, 522, 589 Inltration, 373, 472, 527, 539, 543, 545547, 549
flood dikes and levees, 496, 497 Inflation, 95, 251
flood storage capacity, 126, 210, 474, 488, 490, Interest, 2, 7, 16, 23, 30, 37, 38, 40, 44, 55, 63, 66, 67, 76,
492494, 518520, 522 84, 95, 96, 117, 165, 173, 226, 230, 243, 247, 265,
management, 19 289, 333, 344, 351, 370, 376, 386, 397, 402, 405,
protection, 12, 16, 31, 74, 123, 287, 375, 383, 405, 422, 456, 471, 507, 508, 514, 552, 553, 560, 575,
490, 494, 495, 500, 501, 519, 612 576, 579, 583, 591, 598, 600, 601, 603, 604, 610,
return period, 492, 495, 500, 519 612
risk, 41, 250, 489, 490, 495, 500, 501, 589 Internal rate of return, 165
storage, 75, 126, 209, 210, 387, 474, 487, 488, 490, Interquartile range, 219, 275, 287
492494, 500, 510, 518520, 522 Investments, 19, 38, 73, 96, 143, 166, 343, 378, 388, 580,
Flow augmentation, 377, 412, 465, 504, 505 583, 587, 594, 596
Fractional factorial design, 353 Irreversibility, 368
Fuzzy models Irrigation, 13, 5, 19, 37, 88, 175, 209, 272, 287, 380,
optimization, 196, 204 381, 383, 393, 412, 418, 464, 489, 504, 515, 524,
sets, 196 571, 575, 582, 612

G J
Generalized likelihood estimates, 359 Joules, 503
Genetic algorithms, 180, 181, 187, 189193, 207, 210,
473
Genetic programming, 181, 187, 193, 195, 207 K
Global optimum, 104, 190 Kilowatts, 503, 504
Goal attainment, 400, 401, 412, 414 Knowledge uncertainty, 334, 335, 337, 457
Goal programming, 401, 412, 414 KolmogorovSmirnov, 231, 233, 234, 291
Goodness-of-t, 224, 233, 234, 360
Groundwater
flow, 37, 260 L
interactions, 19, 207 Lagrange multipliers, 97, 99, 103105, 108, 110, 166
management, 34, 606 Lake
modeling, 207 outflow, 33, 8890, 211, 450, 441, 472, 473, 485, 510,
Growth, 33, 54, 248, 292, 390, 418, 420, 422, 427, 433, 544
439441, 446, 447, 455, 463, 535, 553, 560, 573, quality, 352, 425, 449
574, 585, 590, 594, 610 recreation, 1, 18, 24, 30, 34, 120, 123, 381, 382, 405,
493, 504, 505, 506
Land, 1, 3, 5, 8, 14, 16, 22, 25, 33, 37, 38, 41, 59, 74, 172,
H 176, 250, 341, 385, 405, 421, 469, 490, 500, 525,
Hazen plotting position, 291 527, 547, 550, 564
Heat, 432, 463, 543 Latin hypercube sampling, 356, 360, 361, 374
Heavy metals, 32, 418, 441, 444, 449, 555, 557 Level, 1, 10, 16, 19, 20, 31, 39, 42, 45, 67, 69, 93, 139,
Hill-climbing methods, 99, 170 149, 184, 209, 214, 215, 251, 287, 294, 338, 343,
620 Index

345, 353, 354, 356, 363, 365, 374, 381, 388, 405, optimization, 51, 77, 79, 81, 84, 85, 93, 94, 97, 111,
417, 421, 459, 492, 503, 522, 570, 576, 583, 585, 116, 117, 137, 138, 144, 146, 163, 175, 196, 199,
590, 596, 600, 602, 604 201, 204, 207, 250, 270, 307, 311, 314, 327, 394,
Lexicography, 398 430, 450, 470, 476, 479, 481, 491, 504, 511, 517,
Light, 41, 153, 334, 446, 449, 530, 539, 553, 557 519, 522, 523, 528, 559, 565, 583, 591
Linear programming output, 51, 59, 62, 65, 67, 179, 185, 187, 301,
linearizations, 151, 152 331333, 334, 336, 337, 339, 340, 342, 343, 345,
piecewise linearization, 154, 158 347, 352, 354, 367, 369, 373, 455
Loading, 1, 12, 54, 57, 342, 347, 418, 419, 422, 424, 428, selection criteria, 421
432, 450, 539, 549, 550, 552, 559 shared-vision, 68
Local optima, 104 simulation, 40, 63, 7375, 81, 85, 91, 93, 105, 138,
Log-likelihood, 227, 243 179, 187, 215, 258, 259, 270, 273, 282, 301, 304,
Long-run, 42, 386388, 519, 610 311, 325, 327, 341343, 345, 352354, 366, 392,
Loss, 5, 24, 28, 32, 292, 353, 387, 401, 445, 472, 474, 402, 452, 453, 491, 517, 519, 523, 528, 529, 541,
478, 479, 486, 517, 519, 523, 533, 534, 536, 541, 545547, 552, 558, 560, 561, 588, 607
543, 553, 569 steady-state, 428, 560
structure, 51, 75, 194, 331, 334338, 340343, 349,
373, 587
M success, 53, 61, 607608
Management verication, 55, 81, 425, 606
adaptive, 12, 40, 43, 49, 88, 334, 410, 458, 459, 568, Moments
578, 591, 594 L-moments, 224, 225, 228, 242, 243
approaches, 34, 41, 43 Monitoring network
models, 39, 53, 60, 145147, 149, 150, 155, 206, 395, plan, 12
421, 429, 457, 459, 471, 504, 545 sampling
Marginal, 95, 96, 98, 99, 103, 104, 126, 149, 150, 166, Monte Carlo
211, 218, 261, 269, 317, 382, 385, 395, 397 sampling, 354, 355, 370, 374
Market prices, 381384, 388 simulation, 304, 306, 327, 329, 353, 357, 359, 360
Markov Multi-criteria analyses
chains, 215, 229, 250, 251, 254, 265, 295, 309, 316, constraint method, 395, 396, 397, 415
317, 523 dominance, 394
processes, 250, 251, 261, 263, 266, 308, 314 goal-attainment, 400, 401, 414
Mass diagram, 474476, 478, 517 goal-programming, 401, 412, 414
Mass transport, 427 indifference analysis, 369, 399, 415
Maximum likelihood estimates, 228, 236, 237, 239, 290 interactive methods, 397, 402
Mean, 1, 31, 37, 42, 75, 86, 123, 138, 140, 175, 203, 214, lexicography, 398
219, 220, 222, 224, 228, 236, 241, 246, 249, 251, satiscing, 398, 399
255, 261, 262, 264, 269, 277, 278, 289, 294, 303, weighting method, 395397, 402, 415
308, 329, 347, 352, 357, 366, 404, 407, 408, 430, Multiple criteria or objectives, 410
472, 484, 505, 579, 593, 595, 606 Multiple purposes, 30, 301, 411, 489, 504
Median, 213, 214, 219, 235, 236, 247, 275, 278, 287, Multiple yields, 480, 484, 485
292, 296, 363, 366 Multiplier, 97, 99, 103105, 164, 166, 171
Method of moments, 228, 236, 238, 243 Multivariate models, 265
MichaelisMenten kinetics, 463
Mineralization, 434
Model N
adequacy, 230, 466 National economic development, 393
calibration, 55, 80, 144, 179, 180, 337, 338, 340, 341, Navigation, 7, 8, 16, 24, 37, 44, 380, 469, 504, 570
343, 354, 360, 370, 536, 559 Network, 35, 67, 68, 105108, 114, 117, 123, 127, 169,
data, 338, 423 172, 181, 183, 184, 210, 211, 328, 423, 512, 529,
development, 40, 59, 65, 66, 70, 74, 75, 80, 93, 94, 531, 534, 535, 540, 559, 565, 574, 583, 605
151, 194, 344, 422, 457, 508 Nitrogen
dynamic, 68, 452, 470, 512, 515, 560 cycle, 433, 440, 441
errors, 269, 338, 352 models, 54, 422, 433, 438, 440, 463, 464, 466
fuzzy, 204 Non-inferior, 394, 395, 397399, 401, 402, 414, 415
journal, 605 Non-point
linear, 138, 143, 153, 156, 173, 226, 268, 328, 357 models, 418, 421, 424, 425, 454, 465
Index 621

quality, 418, 421, 424, 425, 454, 465 Planning


runoff, 418, 420, 425 approaches, 594
Normal distributions, 234, 244, 264, 356 economic, 96
Nutrients nancial, 32, 38, 45, 56, 58, 79, 151, 380, 410, 511,
cycling, 441 512, 568, 587, 593, 598
models, 440 integrated, 34, 40, 45, 579, 581, 596, 600
Plant capacity, 168, 292, 503, 504, 511, 518
Plant factor, 503, 504
O Plotting positions, 231, 233, 234, 246, 291
Objective, 2, 7, 34, 35, 38, 43, 51, 55, 5759, 64, 69, 71, Population, 1, 5, 16, 36, 187, 189, 190, 193, 228, 290,
73, 75, 76, 78, 81, 85, 94, 104, 112, 126, 137, 150, 380, 384, 385, 490, 531, 574, 585, 590, 594, 612
169, 187, 189, 197, 201, 210, 312, 332, 370, Precipitation, 249, 260, 265, 267, 282, 332, 336, 373,
376380, 393396, 398402, 410, 411, 414, 415, 444, 446, 489, 539, 564
494, 511, 524, 579, 581, 582, 592, 595, 605, 608, Present value, 95, 116, 118, 165, 168, 174, 293, 512, 514,
609, 611 519
OMR costs, 96 Primary treatment, 537
Operating policy, 73, 75, 81, 82, 84, 94, 137, 167, 171, Principal of optimality, 115
270, 273, 274, 278, 281, 326, 328, 377, 491, 504, Probability
521523, 574 beta, 230, 234, 243, 289
Operating rule, 39, 487, 524 conditional distribution, 217, 218, 261, 310, 356, 360
Operations research, 71 cumulative, 219, 230, 241, 291, 303, 307, 329, 356,
Opportunity cost, 38, 385, 569, 570 374, 431, 496
Optimal, 42, 64, 69, 79, 85, 94, 105, 114, 115, 127, 151, density, 216218, 227, 229, 230, 236, 237, 239, 289,
167, 197, 201, 293, 315, 319, 326, 328, 345, 414, 302, 307, 329, 339, 364, 390
513, 514, 521, 526, 560 exceedance, 246, 249, 481, 485, 491, 492, 497, 499,
Optimization, 40, 51, 63, 73, 79, 81, 84, 85, 90, 93, 94, 500
97, 99, 105, 116, 137, 138, 163, 181, 196, 201, exponential, 231, 233, 237, 240, 245, 249, 250, 290
213, 250, 307, 311, 314, 327, 345, 392, 412, 450, functions, 497, 500
476, 479, 491, 511, 515, 517, 522, 523, 529, gamma, 222, 223, 226, 237245, 263, 264, 289, 290,
558560, 583, 594, 610 292
Organics micropollutants, 441, 444, 445 Gumbel and GEV, 231, 241
Over-year storage, 258, 481, 482, 484, 485, 488, 508 joint, 216, 227, 289, 316, 328, 340
Oxygen, 33, 54, 418, 422, 427, 433, 434, 436, 438, 439, lognormal, 226, 227, 230, 232237, 240, 244, 247,
441, 447, 449, 462, 463, 553555, 557 264, 292
log-pearson Type 3, 239, 240
marginal, 95, 96, 98, 99, 103, 104, 126, 149, 150, 166,
P 211, 217, 218, 260, 261, 263, 264, 269, 289, 299,
Parameter 317, 379, 382, 385, 387, 395, 397
calibration, 425 normal, 236
performance measures, 67, 73, 85, 122, 156, 195, 340, transition, 252, 310, 315, 316
341, 343, 344, 349, 363, 364, 366, 375, 389, 486, unconditional, 252, 307, 309, 314, 316
512 Project
uncertainty, 259, 333, 335, 338, 457, 478 management, 5, 43, 173, 567, 605
value, 63, 74, 75, 78, 81, 145, 147, 148, 170, 181, scheduling, 470, 511513, 515
191, 203, 210, 211, 247, 259, 261, 265, 299, 302, Public, 3, 12, 34, 44, 56, 96, 344, 367, 376, 381, 389,
327, 334338, 340342, 345, 346, 354, 370, 607 407, 490, 561, 567, 575, 598, 611, 613
Peak flow, 490, 491, 494, 496, 497, 500, 518
Performance criteria, 30, 35, 76, 135, 179, 195, 274, 340,
375, 377, 379, 380, 389, 392, 402, 410, 553 Q
Phosphorus Quality Impacts, 417, 418, 553
cycle, 438, 441 Quantity
model, 169, 339, 347, 352, 356, 357, 359, 389, 390, flows, 12, 37, 472, 529
438440, 446 storage, 278, 381
Photosynthesis, 436, 439, 557 velocities, 425, 469
Plan formulation Quantiles, 219, 223, 229, 232, 233, 239, 241, 246, 248,
implementation, 607 360
selection, 75
622 Index

R Revenue, 38, 102, 104, 167, 170, 287, 570


Radioactive substances, 441, 446 River basins
Radionuclides, 446 management, 19, 33, 34, 64, 504
Rainfall simulation, 91, 251, 258, 272
design rainfall, 541 Rivers, 1, 3, 6, 20, 28, 49, 379, 390, 419, 425, 428, 430,
distribution in space and time, 281 447, 452, 489, 570, 574, 581, 582, 609
models, 194, 229, 260, 336, 425, 471 Robust, 42, 81, 180, 246, 258, 334, 578, 595
synthetic rainfall, 539, 540 Routing, 211, 470, 472, 473, 478, 491, 494, 543, 544
Random Root zone
independent, 217, 241, 255, 289 Rule curves, 121, 480, 487
variables, 215220, 226, 230, 235, 239, 250, 252, Runoff, 5, 12, 18, 31, 37, 59, 179, 207, 229, 247, 260,
256, 262264, 267, 271, 277, 280, 288, 297, 302, 377, 417, 418, 420, 425, 449, 462, 471, 472, 505,
303, 305, 308, 327, 339, 374 527, 528, 539545, 547, 549, 552, 557, 561, 564,
Rate, 20, 94, 95, 117, 165, 166, 186, 214, 249, 275, 277, 565
291, 342, 352, 395, 428, 433, 434, 439, 445, 446,
452, 457, 463, 472, 503, 545, 550, 564, 591
Reaction, 7, 213, 334, 427, 428, 433, 436, 441, 444, 535 S
Re-aeration, 426, 433, 435, 438, 462, 463 Safe yield, 480
Recreation, 7, 10, 12, 18, 24, 34, 120, 126, 172, 209, 214, Sampling
287, 375, 380, 381, 383, 384, 387, 413, 420, 469, Monte Carlo, 354356, 370, 374
470, 474, 486, 490, 502, 505, 506, 510, 520, 522, uncertainty, 356
569, 574, 611 Satiscing, 398, 399
Recurrence, 481 Scale
Recursive, 105, 111, 114, 115, 118, 142, 167, 169, 263, processes, 581, 593, 605
315, 318, 514 spatial, 33, 267, 335
Redundant constraints, 105 temporal, 34, 67, 336
Regional, 9, 19, 20, 37, 42, 63, 224, 229, 233, 241, 247, Scarcity, 22, 23, 30
248, 332, 353, 386, 396, 573, 575, 580, 581, 612 Scheduling, 470, 511513, 515, 559, 583, 598
Regionalization, 224, 228, 241, 247, 248, 282 Screening, 39, 63, 79, 86, 138, 151, 163, 327, 376, 486,
Regret, 40, 294, 576, 595 515, 576, 591, 592
Reliability, 38, 59, 76, 135, 139, 260, 272, 274, 275, 277, Search, 6, 28, 63, 79, 115, 151, 181, 187, 191, 194, 243,
280, 282, 307, 331, 344, 355, 364, 366, 368, 374, 405, 559
376, 390, 405, 409, 420, 469, 478, 480, 484487, Second-order conditions, 228
523, 535, 579, 607, 612 Sediment
Reservoir bed load, 23
active storage volume, 123, 139, 318, 412, 479, 485, burial, 443
519 resuspension and sedimentation, 33, 209, 442, 444,
capacity, 75, 83, 84, 140, 169, 171, 174, 273, 312, 446, 449
314, 317, 412, 482, 484, 485, 491, 494, 517520, settling, 35, 441, 442, 444, 446, 451
524 suspended load, 420, 427, 441443, 446
dead storage volume, 519, 523 Seepage, 123, 472474, 517, 519
flood storage volume, 75, 126, 209, 210, 387, Sensitivity Analyses
487495, 510, 517519, 521 coefcients, 345, 350352
operation, 38, 67, 75, 108, 115, 120, 126, 127, rst-order analysis, 351
130133, 137, 141, 167, 202, 207, 312, 480, 487 Sequent peak analyses, 476
optimization, 199 Series, 94
over-year storage, 258, 481, 482, 484, 485, 487 Settling
release rule, 122, 135, 318, 326, 479 detritus, 439, 441, 446
simulation, 294 inorganic, 441, 442, 444, 445
within-year storage, 470, 479, 482, 483, 487, 488 sediment, 444, 451
yield, 138141, 173, 476, 479, 481, 516, 517, 519, Sewer systems, 187, 536, 539, 549, 551
523 Silica cycle
Resilience, 135, 405, 409, 609 Simulation
Respiration, 433, 436, 438 accuracy, 277, 453, 455
Response, 2, 36, 40, 52, 196, 203, 213, 347, 349, 352, methods, 79, 163, 452, 486
360, 377, 384, 388, 420, 421, 511, 547, 555, 561, uncertainty, 277, 301, 457, 458
580, 581, 610 Social criteria, 42, 380, 392, 393
Return period, 249, 491, 492, 494, 495, 500, 510, 519, Stakeholder, 2, 11, 28, 34, 35, 39, 44, 45, 56, 61, 6466,
539541, 612 68, 75, 173, 187, 282, 368, 376380, 393, 397,
Index 623

407, 410, 421, 458, 490, 506, 527, 567, 575, 576, Temperature, 143, 144, 196, 197, 218, 257, 282, 336,
579, 580, 583585, 587, 589, 591, 592, 597604, 342, 420, 432434, 436, 439, 444, 446, 449, 456,
610 457, 463, 543, 565
State variable, 106, 115, 123, 295, 328, 446 Thermocline, 450, 451
Static analyses, 470 Thomas-Fiering model, 269, 273, 298
Stationarity, 250, 251, 259, 332 Time periods, 34, 81, 85, 95, 96, 106, 108, 117119, 121,
Statistical, 55, 115, 179181, 184, 213, 224, 226, 230, 137, 209, 304, 308, 310, 311, 313, 342, 388, 425,
231, 251, 254, 258261, 273, 280, 282, 297, 302, 454, 470, 473, 475, 479, 491, 504, 506, 517, 518,
304, 332, 336, 343346, 360, 366, 367, 407, 421, 539, 559, 560, 580
470, 560 Time series, 67, 81, 89, 95, 114, 127, 215, 250, 251, 254,
Steady-state, 127, 129, 136, 137, 142, 252, 254, 316, 318, 255, 263, 267, 269, 282, 301, 303, 308, 336, 337,
432, 463, 465, 487, 511, 519, 559, 560 402, 404, 405, 407409, 473, 539, 550, 595
Step method, 402 Time value, 96
Stochastic Toxic chemicals, 441
model, 252, 259, 261, 282, 301, 314, 315, 317, 327, Tradeoffs, 28, 35, 38, 41, 42, 69, 73, 340, 365, 367, 375,
332 376, 379, 380, 393, 396, 397, 402, 407, 410, 412,
optimization, 215, 311, 314, 327 430, 504, 508
processes, 215, 250252, 254, 260, 282, 457 Transition probability, 252, 310, 315, 316
simulation, 215, 226, 270272, 282 Transpiration, 543
variables, 187, 193, 255, 261, 263, 271, 295, 301, Transport, 9, 16, 18, 25, 194, 375, 417, 425427, 432,
457, 560 444, 446, 452, 502, 528, 529, 549, 552, 568, 574,
Storage-yield functions, 139, 140, 476 575
Storage zones Trial and error, 78, 81, 122, 188, 270, 459, 559
active, 82, 123, 139, 140, 171, 312, 318, 412, 414,
474476, 479483, 485, 487, 488, 490, 494, 510,
517, 519, 523 U
dead, 474, 494, 510, 517, 518, 523 Uncertainty
flood, 75, 126, 209, 387, 474, 487, 488, 490495, analyses, 81, 181, 213, 301, 332, 339, 343, 344, 352,
518, 519 366, 367, 373, 374, 422, 458, 515, 607
over-year, 258, 470, 480482, 484488, 508, 523, model, 338, 457
524, 580 parameter, 259, 333, 335, 338, 457, 478
within-year, 482, 486, 487, 523 Uniform, 96, 189, 271, 297, 302, 304, 309, 360, 362, 462,
Storms, 22, 539, 540, 550, 557, 560 472, 525, 536, 541
Stormwater, 81, 418, 527, 539, 552, 553, 558, 565 Urban Drainage
Stratication, 33, 54, 422, 425, 447, 449451 model, 187, 539, 540, 544
Streamflow pollutant loading, 81, 418420, 424, 425, 429, 449,
estimation, 471 549, 550, 552
gauge, 539, 540 runoff, 41, 528
generation, 257, 259, 260, 267, 297
routing, 472
synthetic values, 257, 258, 261, 264, 296, 298, 299 V
Streeter and Phelps, 433 Validation, 81, 184, 211, 607
Students t-distribution, 281 Value, 95
Substitution, 218, 255, 266, 395, 397, 611 Variability, 2, 20, 33, 34, 44, 220, 234, 251, 258, 259,
Sustainability, 30, 35, 42, 43, 49, 88, 389, 410, 565, 581, 262, 287, 332, 334337, 345, 357, 367, 457, 511,
591, 599, 614 561, 580, 609
Synthetic streamflow, 257, 258, 261, 265, 273, 274, 296, Variables
298, 299 deterministic, 213, 327
Systems analysis, 12, 39, 71, 88, 571 random, 215219, 221, 226, 227, 230, 237, 250, 252,
Systems approach, 528, 571 262, 264, 269, 271, 277, 281, 299, 302, 303, 306,
309, 327, 339, 340
Variance, 219223, 227, 228, 230, 233, 236, 238, 240,
T 242, 247, 251, 254257, 260, 262264, 280, 287,
Target, 37, 43, 73, 75, 82, 121, 123, 126, 127, 163, 166, 290, 297, 299, 302, 304, 329, 351, 352, 356, 366,
169, 171, 172, 174, 175, 198, 199, 209, 274, 275, 407
278, 295, 306, 307, 311, 318, 328, 329, 333, 343, Verication, 16, 55, 81, 425, 606
362365, 368, 379, 386, 387, 389, 401, 412, 414, Vulnerability, 135, 280, 405, 409, 489, 582
505, 508, 511, 520, 522, 560, 569, 570, 581, 592
624 Index

W Watershed, 20, 32, 33, 37, 88, 121, 181, 247, 339, 344,
Wastewater 370, 380, 389, 419, 421, 469, 471, 472, 474, 517,
collection, 378, 527, 528, 536, 569 529, 564, 567, 582, 589
discharge, 31, 143, 145, 177, 302, 377, 429, 430, 586 Weibull plotting position, 291
treatment, 37, 75, 76, 142, 143, 146, 149, 168170, Weighting method, 395397, 402, 415
172, 179, 187, 210, 288, 292, 378, 418, 420, 436, Wetlands, 5, 10, 12, 23, 25, 32, 37, 38, 338, 390, 469
465, 469, 529, 537, 538, 565, 568, 570, 613 Wilcoxon test, 296
Water Willingness to pay, 95, 381383, 385, 411
groundwater, 20, 31, 32, 34, 151, 152, 174, 191, 258, WilsonHilferty transformation, 239
270, 377, 380, 458, 469, 489, 528, 545, 561, 568, Withdrawals, 1, 2, 6, 31, 305, 470, 504, 585
574, 581, 613 Within-year
polluted, 5 periods, 34, 122, 123, 142, 311, 313, 317, 318, 412, 450,
quality, 12, 19, 20, 3032, 36, 56, 67, 74, 79, 142, 470472, 480485, 486, 487, 508, 511, 518, 524
143, 145, 146, 148, 150, 185, 202, 206, 219, 246, storage, 470, 479, 482484, 487, 488
346, 377, 378, 389, 393, 404, 412, 414, 417423,
425, 429, 432, 433, 439, 446449, 452, 454,
457459, 469, 502, 505, 535, 536, 553, 555, 560, Y
575, 582, 592, 612 Yield, 25, 28, 41, 90, 95, 99, 103, 104, 138142, 171,
quantity, 2, 12, 34, 373, 389, 417, 425, 426, 458, 459, 175, 176, 219, 227, 237, 246, 250, 263, 269, 287,
469, 585, 587, 609 296, 297, 338, 347, 358, 402, 476, 478488, 499,
surface water, 2, 5, 59, 376, 377, 389, 445, 449, 458, 511, 517, 522525, 551, 612
473, 474, 478, 489, 528, 552, 574, 585 Zooplankton

Open Access This chapter is distributed under the terms The images or other third party material in this
of the Creative Commons Attribution-NonCommercial chapter are included in the work's Creative Commons
4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/ license, unless indicated otherwise in the credit line; if
licenses/by-nc/4.0/), which permits any noncommercial such material is not included in the works Creative
use, duplication, adaptation, distribution and reproduction Commons license and the respective action is not per-
in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate mitted by statutory regulation, users will need to obtain
credit to the original author(s) and the source, provide a permission from the license holder to duplicate, adapt or
link to the Creative Commons license and indicate if reproduce the material.
changes were made.

Вам также может понравиться